summaryrefslogtreecommitdiff
path: root/Doc/zsh.texi
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
Diffstat (limited to 'Doc/zsh.texi')
-rw-r--r--Doc/zsh.texi40574
1 files changed, 40574 insertions, 0 deletions
diff --git a/Doc/zsh.texi b/Doc/zsh.texi
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..2a57fdf35
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/zsh.texi
@@ -0,0 +1,40574 @@
+\input texinfo.tex
+@c %**start of header
+@iftex
+@setchapternewpage off
+@end iftex
+@setfilename zsh.info
+@settitle zsh
+@c %**end of header
+
+@ifinfo
+@set dsq '@:'
+@set dsbq `@:`
+@end ifinfo
+@iftex
+@set dsq '{}'
+@set dsbq `{}`
+@end iftex
+@ifinfo
+@dircategory Utilities
+@direntry
+* ZSH: (zsh). The Z Shell Manual.
+@end direntry
+@end ifinfo
+
+@iftex
+@finalout
+@end iftex
+@titlepage
+@title The Z Shell Manual
+@subtitle Version 5.8
+@subtitle Updated February 14, 2020
+@author Original documentation by Paul Falstad
+@page
+This is a texinfo version of the documentation for the Z Shell, originally by
+Paul Falstad.
+
+@noindent
+Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of
+this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice
+are preserved on all copies.
+
+@noindent
+Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of this
+manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided also that the
+entire resulting derived work is distributed under the terms of a
+permission notice identical to this one.
+
+@noindent
+Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this manual
+into another language, under the above conditions for modified versions.
+@end titlepage
+@contents
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/manual.yo
+@ifnottex
+@node Top, The Z Shell Manual, (dir), (dir)
+@top The Z Shell Manual
+@end ifnottex
+@ifinfo
+This Info file documents Zsh, a freely available UNIX command interpreter
+(shell), which of the standard shells most closely resembles the Korn shell
+(ksh), although it is not completely compatible. Zsh is able to emulate
+POSIX shells, but its default mode is not POSIX compatible, either.
+
+@noindent
+@cindex version
+Version 5.8, last updated February 14, 2020.
+@end ifinfo
+
+@menu
+* The Z Shell Manual::
+* Introduction::
+* Roadmap::
+* Invocation::
+* Files::
+* Shell Grammar::
+* Redirection::
+* Command Execution::
+* Functions::
+* Jobs & Signals::
+* Arithmetic Evaluation::
+* Conditional Expressions::
+* Prompt Expansion::
+* Expansion::
+* Parameters::
+* Options::
+* Shell Builtin Commands::
+* Zsh Line Editor::
+* Completion Widgets::
+* Completion System::
+* Completion Using compctl::
+* Zsh Modules::
+* Calendar Function System::
+* TCP Function System::
+* Zftp Function System::
+* User Contributions::
+
+@noindent
+--- Indices ---
+
+@noindent
+* Concept Index::
+* Variables Index::
+* Options Index::
+* Functions Index::
+* Editor Functions Index::
+* Style and Tag Index::
+
+@noindent
+--- The Detailed Node Listing ---
+
+@noindent
+Introduction
+
+@noindent
+* Author::
+* Availability::
+* Mailing Lists::
+* The Zsh FAQ::
+* The Zsh Web Page::
+* The Zsh Userguide::
+* See Also::
+
+@noindent
+Invocation
+
+@noindent
+* Compatibility::
+* Restricted Shell::
+
+@noindent
+Shell Grammar
+
+@noindent
+* Simple Commands & Pipelines::
+* Precommand Modifiers::
+* Complex Commands::
+* Alternate Forms For Complex Commands::
+* Reserved Words::
+* Comments::
+* Aliasing::
+* Quoting::
+
+@noindent
+Expansion
+
+@noindent
+* History Expansion::
+* Process Substitution::
+* Parameter Expansion::
+* Command Substitution::
+* Arithmetic Expansion::
+* Brace Expansion::
+* Filename Expansion::
+* Filename Generation::
+
+@noindent
+Parameters
+
+@noindent
+* Array Parameters::
+* Positional Parameters::
+* Local Parameters::
+* Parameters Set By The Shell::
+* Parameters Used By The Shell::
+
+@noindent
+Options
+
+@noindent
+* Specifying Options::
+* Description of Options::
+* Option Aliases::
+* Single Letter Options::
+
+@noindent
+Zsh Line Editor
+
+@noindent
+* Keymaps::
+* Zle Builtins::
+* Zle Widgets::
+* Character Highlighting::
+
+@noindent
+Completion Widgets
+
+@noindent
+* Completion Special Parameters::
+* Completion Builtin Commands::
+* Completion Condition Codes::
+* Completion Matching Control::
+* Completion Widget Example::
+
+@noindent
+Completion System
+
+@noindent
+* Initialization::
+* Completion System Configuration::
+* Control Functions::
+* Bindable Commands::
+* Completion Functions::
+* Completion Directories::
+
+@noindent
+Completion Using compctl
+
+@noindent
+* Command Flags::
+* Option Flags::
+* Alternative Completion::
+* Extended Completion::
+* Example::
+
+@noindent
+Zsh Modules
+
+@noindent
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/manmodmenu.yo
+* The zsh/attr Module::
+* The zsh/cap Module::
+* The zsh/clone Module::
+* The zsh/compctl Module::
+* The zsh/complete Module::
+* The zsh/complist Module::
+* The zsh/computil Module::
+* The zsh/curses Module::
+* The zsh/datetime Module::
+* The zsh/db/gdbm Module::
+* The zsh/deltochar Module::
+* The zsh/example Module::
+* The zsh/files Module::
+* The zsh/langinfo Module::
+* The zsh/mapfile Module::
+* The zsh/mathfunc Module::
+* The zsh/nearcolor Module::
+* The zsh/newuser Module::
+* The zsh/parameter Module::
+* The zsh/pcre Module::
+* The zsh/param/private Module::
+* The zsh/regex Module::
+* The zsh/sched Module::
+* The zsh/net/socket Module::
+* The zsh/stat Module::
+* The zsh/system Module::
+* The zsh/net/tcp Module::
+* The zsh/termcap Module::
+* The zsh/terminfo Module::
+* The zsh/zftp Module::
+* The zsh/zle Module::
+* The zsh/zleparameter Module::
+* The zsh/zprof Module::
+* The zsh/zpty Module::
+* The zsh/zselect Module::
+* The zsh/zutil Module::
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+
+@noindent
+Calendar Function System
+
+@noindent
+* Calendar File and Date Formats::
+* Calendar System User Functions::
+* Calendar Styles::
+* Calendar Utility Functions::
+* Calendar Bugs::
+
+@noindent
+TCP Function System
+
+@noindent
+* TCP Functions::
+* TCP Parameters::
+* TCP Examples::
+* TCP Bugs::
+
+@noindent
+Zftp Function System
+
+@noindent
+* Installation::
+* Zftp Functions::
+* Miscellaneous Features::
+
+@noindent
+User Contributions
+
+@noindent
+* Utilities::
+* Recent Directories::
+* Other Directory Functions::
+* Version Control Information::
+* Prompt Themes::
+* ZLE Functions::
+* Exception Handling::
+* MIME Functions::
+* Mathematical Functions::
+* User Configuration Functions::
+* Other Functions::
+
+@noindent
+@end menu
+@node The Z Shell Manual, Introduction, Top, Top
+
+@chapter The Z Shell Manual
+@noindent
+This document has been produced from the texinfo file @t{zsh.texi},
+included in the @t{Doc} sub-directory of the Zsh distribution.
+
+@section Producing documentation from zsh.texi
+@noindent
+The texinfo source may be converted into several formats:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item The Info manual
+The Info format allows searching for topics, commands, functions, etc.
+from the many Indices. The command `@t{makeinfo zsh.texi}' is used to
+produce the Info documentation.
+
+@item The printed manual
+The command `@t{texi2dvi zsh.texi}' will output @t{zsh.dvi} which can
+then be processed with @cite{dvips} and optionally @cite{gs} (Ghostscript) to
+produce a nicely formatted printed manual.
+
+@item The HTML manual
+An HTML version of this manual is available at the Zsh web site via:
+
+@noindent
+@t{@uref{http://zsh.sourceforge.net/Doc/}}.
+
+@noindent
+(The HTML version is produced with @cite{texi2html}, which may be obtained
+from @t{@uref{http://www.nongnu.org/texi2html/}}. The command is
+`@t{texi2html --output . --ifinfo --split=chapter --node-files zsh.texi}'.
+If necessary, upgrade to version 1.78 of texi2html.)
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+For those who do not have the necessary tools to process texinfo,
+precompiled documentation (PostScript, dvi, PDF, info and HTML formats)
+is available from the zsh archive site or its mirrors, in the file
+@t{zsh-doc.tar.gz}. (See @ref{Availability} for a list of sites.)
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/intro.yo
+@node Introduction, Roadmap, The Z Shell Manual, Top
+
+@chapter Introduction
+@noindent
+@cindex introduction
+Zsh is a UNIX command interpreter (shell) usable as an interactive
+login shell and as a shell script command processor. Of the standard shells,
+zsh most closely resembles @cite{ksh} but includes many enhancements. It
+does not provide compatibility with POSIX or other shells in its
+default operating mode: see
+the section @ref{Compatibility}.
+
+@noindent
+Zsh has command line editing, builtin spelling correction, programmable
+command completion, shell functions (with autoloading), a history
+mechanism, and a host of other features.
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/metafaq.yo
+@menu
+* Author::
+* Availability::
+* Mailing Lists::
+* The Zsh FAQ::
+* The Zsh Web Page::
+* The Zsh Userguide::
+* See Also::
+@end menu
+@node Author, Availability, , Introduction
+
+@section Author
+@noindent
+@cindex author
+Zsh was originally written by Paul Falstad @t{<pf@@zsh.org>}.
+Zsh is now maintained by the members of the zsh-workers mailing
+list @t{<zsh-workers@@zsh.org>}. The development is currently
+coordinated by Peter Stephenson @t{<pws@@zsh.org>}. The coordinator
+can be contacted at @t{<coordinator@@zsh.org>}, but matters relating to
+the code should generally go to the mailing list.
+@node Availability, Mailing Lists, Author, Introduction
+
+@section Availability
+@noindent
+Zsh is available from the following HTTP and anonymous FTP site.
+
+@noindent
+@cindex FTP sites for zsh
+@cindex acquiring zsh by FTP
+@cindex availability of zsh
+@t{@uref{ftp://ftp.zsh.org/pub/}}@*
+@t{@uref{https://www.zsh.org/pub/}}
+)
+
+@noindent
+The up-to-date source code is available via Git from Sourceforge. See
+@t{@uref{https://sourceforge.net/projects/zsh/}} for details. A summary of
+instructions for the archive can be found at
+@t{@uref{http://zsh.sourceforge.net/}}.
+
+@noindent
+@node Mailing Lists, The Zsh FAQ, Availability, Introduction
+
+@section Mailing Lists
+@noindent
+@cindex mailing lists
+Zsh has 3 mailing lists:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{<zsh-announce@@zsh.org>}
+Announcements about releases, major changes in the shell and the
+monthly posting of the Zsh FAQ. (moderated)
+
+@item @t{<zsh-users@@zsh.org>}
+User discussions.
+
+@item @t{<zsh-workers@@zsh.org>}
+Hacking, development, bug reports and patches.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+To subscribe or unsubscribe, send mail
+to the associated administrative address for the mailing list.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{<zsh-announce-subscribe@@zsh.org>}
+@item @t{<zsh-users-subscribe@@zsh.org>}
+@item @t{<zsh-workers-subscribe@@zsh.org>}
+
+@noindent
+@item @t{<zsh-announce-unsubscribe@@zsh.org>}
+@item @t{<zsh-users-unsubscribe@@zsh.org>}
+@item @t{<zsh-workers-unsubscribe@@zsh.org>}
+@end table
+@sp 1
+
+@noindent
+YOU ONLY NEED TO JOIN ONE OF THE MAILING LISTS AS THEY ARE NESTED.
+All submissions to @cite{zsh-announce} are automatically forwarded to
+@cite{zsh-users}. All submissions to @cite{zsh-users} are automatically
+forwarded to @cite{zsh-workers}.
+
+@noindent
+If you have problems subscribing/unsubscribing to any of the mailing
+lists, send mail to @t{<listmaster@@zsh.org>}. The mailing lists are
+maintained by Karsten Thygesen @t{<karthy@@kom.auc.dk>}.
+
+@noindent
+The mailing lists are archived; the archives can be accessed via the
+administrative addresses listed above. There is also a hypertext
+archive, maintained by Geoff Wing @t{<gcw@@zsh.org>}, available at
+@t{@uref{https://www.zsh.org/mla/}}.
+@node The Zsh FAQ, The Zsh Web Page, Mailing Lists, Introduction
+
+@section The Zsh FAQ
+@noindent
+Zsh has a list of Frequently Asked Questions (FAQ), maintained by
+Peter Stephenson @t{<pws@@zsh.org>}. It is regularly posted to the
+newsgroup @cite{comp.unix.shell} and the @cite{zsh-announce} mailing list.
+The latest version can be found at any of the Zsh FTP sites, or at
+@t{@uref{http://www.zsh.org/FAQ/}}. The contact address for FAQ-related matters
+is @t{<faqmaster@@zsh.org>}.
+@node The Zsh Web Page, The Zsh Userguide, The Zsh FAQ, Introduction
+
+@section The Zsh Web Page
+@noindent
+Zsh has a web page which is located at @t{@uref{https://www.zsh.org/}}. This is
+maintained by Karsten Thygesen @t{<karthy@@zsh.org>}, of SunSITE Denmark.
+The contact address for web-related matters is @t{<webmaster@@zsh.org>}.
+@node The Zsh Userguide, See Also, The Zsh Web Page, Introduction
+
+@section The Zsh Userguide
+@noindent
+A userguide is currently in preparation. It is intended to complement the
+manual, with explanations and hints on issues where the manual can be
+cabbalistic, hierographic, or downright mystifying (for example, the word
+`hierographic' does not exist). It can be viewed in its current state at
+@t{@uref{http://zsh.sourceforge.net/Guide/}}. At the time of writing, chapters
+dealing with startup files and their contents and the new completion system
+were essentially complete.
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/seealso.yo
+@node See Also, , The Zsh Userguide, Introduction
+
+@section See Also
+@noindent
+man page sh(1),
+man page csh(1),
+man page tcsh(1),
+man page rc(1),
+man page bash(1),
+man page ksh(1)
+
+@noindent
+@cite{IEEE Standard for information Technology -
+Portable Operating System Interface (POSIX) -
+Part 2: Shell and Utilities},
+IEEE Inc, 1993, ISBN 1-55937-255-9.
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/roadmap.yo
+@node Roadmap, Invocation, Introduction, Top
+
+@chapter Roadmap
+@noindent
+@cindex roadmap
+The Zsh Manual, like the shell itself, is large and often complicated.
+This section of the manual provides some pointers to areas of the shell
+that are likely to be of particular interest to new users, and indicates
+where in the rest of the manual the documentation is to be found.
+
+@noindent
+
+@section When the shell starts
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+When it starts, the shell reads commands from various files. These can
+be created or edited to customize the shell. See @ref{Files}.
+
+@noindent
+If no personal initialization files exist for the current user, a function
+is run to help you change some of the most common settings. It won't
+appear if your administrator has disabled the @t{zsh/newuser} module.
+The function is designed to be self-explanatory. You can run it by hand
+with `@t{autoload -Uz zsh-newuser-install; zsh-newuser-install -f}'.
+See also
+@ref{User Configuration Functions}.
+
+@noindent
+
+@section Interactive Use
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+Interaction with the shell uses the builtin Zsh Line Editor, ZLE. This is
+described in detail in @ref{Zsh Line Editor}.
+
+@noindent
+The first decision a user must make is whether to use the Emacs or Vi
+editing mode as the keys for editing are substantially different. Emacs
+editing mode is probably more natural for beginners and can be selected
+explicitly with the command @t{bindkey -e}.
+
+@noindent
+A history mechanism for retrieving previously typed lines (most simply
+with the Up or Down arrow keys) is available; note that, unlike other
+shells, zsh will not save these lines when the shell exits unless you
+set appropriate variables, and the number of history lines retained by
+default is quite small (30 lines). See the description of the shell
+variables (referred to in the documentation as parameters) @t{HISTFILE},
+@t{HISTSIZE} and @t{SAVEHIST} in @ref{Parameters Used By The Shell}. Note that it's
+currently only possible to read and write files saving history
+when the shell is interactive, i.e. it does not work from scripts.
+
+@noindent
+The shell now supports the UTF-8 character set (and also others if
+supported by the operating system). This is (mostly) handled transparently
+by the shell, but the degree of support in terminal emulators is variable.
+There is some discussion of this in the shell FAQ,
+@t{@uref{http://www.zsh.org/FAQ/}}. Note in particular that for combining
+characters to be handled the option @t{COMBINING_CHARS} needs to be set.
+Because the shell is now more sensitive to the definition of the
+character set, note that if you are upgrading from an older version of
+the shell you should ensure that the appropriate variable, either
+@t{LANG} (to affect all aspects of the shell's operation) or
+@t{LC_CTYPE} (to affect only the handling of character sets) is set to
+an appropriate value. This is true even if you are using a
+single-byte character set including extensions of ASCII such as
+@t{ISO-8859-1} or @t{ISO-8859-15}. See the description of @t{LC_CTYPE}
+in
+@ref{Parameters}.
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Completion
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+Completion is a feature present in many shells. It allows the user to
+type only a part (usually the prefix) of a word and have the shell fill
+in the rest. The completion system in zsh is programmable. For
+example, the shell can be set to complete email addresses in
+arguments to the mail command from your @t{~/.abook/addressbook};
+usernames, hostnames, and even remote paths in arguments to scp, and so
+on. Anything that can be written in or glued together with zsh can be
+the source of what the line editor offers as possible completions.
+
+@noindent
+Zsh has two completion systems, an old, so called @t{compctl} completion
+(named after the builtin command that serves as its complete and only
+user interface), and a new one, referred to as @t{compsys},
+organized as library of builtin and user-defined functions.
+The two systems differ in their interface for specifying the completion
+behavior. The new system is more customizable and is supplied with
+completions for many commonly used commands; it is therefore to be
+preferred.
+
+@noindent
+The completion system must be enabled explicitly when the shell starts.
+For more information see
+@ref{Completion System}.
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Extending the line editor
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+Apart from completion, the line editor is highly extensible by means of
+shell functions. Some useful functions are provided with the shell; they
+provide facilities such as:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{insert-composed-char}
+composing characters not found on the keyboard
+
+@item @t{match-words-by-style}
+configuring what the line editor considers a word when moving or
+deleting by word
+
+@item @t{history-beginning-search-backward-end}, etc.
+alternative ways of searching the shell history
+
+@item @t{replace-string}, @t{replace-pattern}
+functions for replacing strings or patterns globally in the command line
+
+@item @t{edit-command-line}
+edit the command line with an external editor.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+See @ref{ZLE Functions} for descriptions of these.
+
+@noindent
+
+@section Options
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+The shell has a large number of options for changing its behaviour.
+These cover all aspects of the shell; browsing the full documentation is
+the only good way to become acquainted with the many possibilities. See
+@ref{Options}.
+
+@noindent
+
+@section Pattern Matching
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+The shell has a rich set of patterns which are available for file matching
+(described in the documentation as `filename generation' and also known for
+historical reasons as `globbing') and for use when programming. These are
+described in @ref{Filename Generation}.
+
+@noindent
+Of particular interest are the following patterns that are not commonly
+supported by other systems of pattern matching:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{**}
+for matching over multiple directories
+
+@item @t{|}
+for matching either of two alternatives
+
+@item @t{~}, @t{^}
+the ability to exclude patterns from matching when the @t{EXTENDED_GLOB}
+option is set
+
+@item @t{(}@var{...}@t{)}
+glob qualifiers, included in parentheses at the end of the pattern,
+which select files by type (such as directories) or attribute (such as
+size).
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@section General Comments on Syntax
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+Although the syntax of zsh is in ways similar to the Korn shell, and
+therefore more remotely to the original UNIX shell, the Bourne shell,
+its default behaviour does not entirely correspond to those shells.
+General shell syntax is introduced in @ref{Shell Grammar}.
+
+@noindent
+One commonly encountered difference is that variables substituted onto the
+command line are not split into words. See the description of the shell option
+@t{SH_WORD_SPLIT} in
+@ref{Parameter Expansion}.
+In zsh, you can either explicitly request the splitting (e.g. @t{$@{=foo@}})
+or use an array when you want a variable to expand to more than one word. See
+@ref{Array Parameters}.
+
+@noindent
+
+@section Programming
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+The most convenient way of adding enhancements to the shell is typically
+by writing a shell function and arranging for it to be autoloaded.
+Functions are described in @ref{Functions}. Users changing from the C shell and its
+relatives should notice that aliases are less used in zsh as they don't
+perform argument substitution, only simple text replacement.
+
+@noindent
+A few general functions, other than those for the line editor described
+above, are provided with the shell and are described in
+@ref{User Contributions}. Features include:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{promptinit}
+a prompt theme system for changing prompts easily, see @ref{Prompt Themes}
+
+@item @t{zsh-mime-setup}
+a MIME-handling system which dispatches commands according to the suffix of
+a file as done by graphical file managers
+
+@item @t{zcalc}
+a calculator
+
+@item @t{zargs}
+a version of @t{xargs} that makes the @t{find} command redundant
+
+@item @t{zmv}
+a command for renaming files by means of shell patterns.
+
+@end table
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/invoke.yo
+@node Invocation, Files, Roadmap, Top
+
+@chapter Invocation
+@noindent
+@cindex invocation
+
+@section Invocation
+@noindent
+@cindex shell options
+@cindex options, shell
+@cindex shell flags
+@cindex flags, shell
+The following flags are interpreted by the shell when invoked to determine
+where the shell will read commands from:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{-c}
+Take the first argument as a command to execute, rather than reading commands
+from a script or standard input. If any further arguments are given, the
+first one is assigned to @t{$0}, rather than being used as a positional
+parameter.
+
+@item @t{-i}
+Force shell to be interactive. It is still possible to specify a
+script to execute.
+
+@item @t{-s}
+Force shell to read commands from the standard input.
+If the @t{-s} flag is not present and an argument is given,
+the first argument is taken to be the pathname of a script to
+execute.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+If there are any remaining arguments after option processing, and neither
+of the options @t{-c} or @t{-s} was supplied, the first argument is taken
+as the file name of a script containing shell commands to be executed. If
+the option @t{PATH_SCRIPT} is set, and the file name does not contain a
+directory path (i.e. there is no `@t{/}' in the name), first the current
+directory and then the command path given by the variable @t{PATH} are
+searched for the script. If the option is not set or the file name
+contains a `@t{/}' it is used directly.
+
+@noindent
+After the first one or two arguments have been appropriated as described above,
+the remaining arguments are assigned to the positional parameters.
+
+@noindent
+For further options, which are common to invocation and the @t{set}
+builtin, see
+@ref{Options}.
+
+@noindent
+The long option `@t{-}@t{-emulate}' followed (in a separate word) by an
+emulation mode may be passed to the shell.
+The emulation modes are those described for the @t{emulate} builtin,
+see
+@ref{Shell Builtin Commands}.
+The `@t{-}@t{-emulate}' option must precede any other options (which might
+otherwise be overridden), but following options are honoured, so
+may be used to modify the requested emulation mode. Note that certain
+extra steps are taken to ensure a smooth emulation when this option
+is used compared with the @t{emulate} command within the shell: for
+example, variables that conflict with POSIX usage such as @t{path} are
+not defined within the shell.
+
+@noindent
+Options may be specified by name using the @t{-o} option. @t{-o} acts like
+a single-letter option, but takes a following string as the option name.
+For example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zsh -x -o shwordsplit scr
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+runs the script @t{scr}, setting the @t{XTRACE} option by the corresponding
+letter `@t{-x}' and the @t{SH_WORD_SPLIT} option by name.
+Options may be turned @emph{off} by name by using @t{+o} instead of @t{-o}.
+@t{-o} can be stacked up with preceding single-letter options, so for example
+`@t{-xo shwordsplit}' or `@t{-xoshwordsplit}' is equivalent to
+`@t{-x -o shwordsplit}'.
+
+@noindent
+@cindex long option
+Options may also be specified by name in GNU long option style,
+`@t{-}@t{-}@var{option-name}'. When this is done, `@t{-}' characters in the
+option name are permitted: they are translated into `@t{_}', and thus ignored.
+So, for example, `@t{zsh -}@t{-sh-word-split}' invokes zsh with the
+@t{SH_WORD_SPLIT} option turned on. Like other option syntaxes, options can
+be turned off by replacing the initial `@t{-}' with a `@t{+}'; thus
+`@t{+-sh-word-split}' is equivalent to `@t{-}@t{-no-sh-word-split}'.
+Unlike other option syntaxes, GNU-style long options cannot be stacked with
+any other options, so for example `@t{-x-shwordsplit}' is an error,
+rather than being treated like `@t{-x -}@t{-shwordsplit}'.
+
+@noindent
+@cindex --version
+@cindex --help
+The special GNU-style option `@t{-}@t{-version}' is handled; it sends to
+standard output the shell's version information, then exits successfully.
+`@t{-}@t{-help}' is also handled; it sends to standard output a list of
+options that can be used when invoking the shell, then exits successfully.
+
+@noindent
+Option processing may be finished, allowing following arguments that start with
+`@t{-}' or `@t{+}' to be treated as normal arguments, in two ways.
+Firstly, a lone `@t{-}' (or `@t{+}') as an argument by itself ends
+option processing. Secondly, a special option `@t{-}@t{-}' (or
+`@t{+-}'), which may be specified on its own (which is the standard
+POSIX usage) or may be stacked with preceding options (so `@t{-x-}' is
+equivalent to `@t{-x -}@t{-}'). Options are not permitted to be stacked
+after `@t{-}@t{-}' (so `@t{-x-f}' is an error), but note the GNU-style
+option form discussed above, where `@t{-}@t{-shwordsplit}' is permitted
+and does not end option processing.
+
+@noindent
+Except when the @cite{sh}/@cite{ksh} emulation single-letter options are in effect,
+the option `@t{-b}' (or `@t{+b}') ends option processing.
+`@t{-b}' is like `@t{-}@t{-}', except that further single-letter options
+can be stacked after the `@t{-b}' and will take effect as normal.
+
+@noindent
+@menu
+* Compatibility::
+* Restricted Shell::
+@end menu
+
+@noindent
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/compat.yo
+@node Compatibility, Restricted Shell, , Invocation
+
+@section Compatibility
+@noindent
+@cindex compatibility
+@cindex sh compatibility
+@cindex ksh compatibility
+Zsh tries to emulate @cite{sh} or @cite{ksh} when it is invoked as
+@t{sh} or @t{ksh} respectively; more precisely, it looks at the first
+letter of the name by which it was invoked, excluding any initial `@t{r}'
+(assumed to stand for `restricted'), and if that is `@t{b}', `@t{s}' or `@t{k}' it
+will emulate @cite{sh} or @cite{ksh}. Furthermore, if invoked as @t{su} (which
+happens on certain systems when the shell is executed by the @t{su}
+command), the shell will try to find an alternative name from the @t{SHELL}
+environment variable and perform emulation based on that.
+
+@noindent
+In @cite{sh} and @cite{ksh} compatibility modes the following
+parameters are not special and not initialized by the shell:
+@t{ARGC},
+@t{argv},
+@t{cdpath},
+@t{fignore},
+@t{fpath},
+@t{HISTCHARS},
+@t{mailpath},
+@t{MANPATH},
+@t{manpath},
+@t{path},
+@t{prompt},
+@t{PROMPT},
+@t{PROMPT2},
+@t{PROMPT3},
+@t{PROMPT4},
+@t{psvar},
+@t{status},
+@t{watch}.
+
+@noindent
+@vindex ENV, use of
+The usual zsh startup/shutdown scripts are not executed. Login shells
+source @t{/etc/profile} followed by @t{$HOME/.profile}. If the
+@t{ENV} environment variable is set on invocation, @t{$ENV} is sourced
+after the profile scripts. The value of @t{ENV} is subjected to
+parameter expansion, command substitution, and arithmetic expansion
+before being interpreted as a pathname. Note that the @t{PRIVILEGED}
+option also affects the execution of startup files.
+
+@noindent
+The following options are set if the shell is invoked as @t{sh} or
+@t{ksh}:
+@t{NO_BAD_PATTERN},
+@t{NO_BANG_HIST},
+@t{NO_BG_NICE},
+@t{NO_EQUALS},
+@t{NO_FUNCTION_ARGZERO},
+@t{GLOB_SUBST},
+@t{NO_GLOBAL_EXPORT},
+@t{NO_HUP},
+@t{INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS},
+@t{KSH_ARRAYS},
+@t{NO_MULTIOS},
+@t{NO_NOMATCH},
+@t{NO_NOTIFY},
+@t{POSIX_BUILTINS},
+@t{NO_PROMPT_PERCENT},
+@t{RM_STAR_SILENT},
+@t{SH_FILE_EXPANSION},
+@t{SH_GLOB},
+@t{SH_OPTION_LETTERS},
+@t{SH_WORD_SPLIT}.
+Additionally the @t{BSD_ECHO} and @t{IGNORE_BRACES}
+options are set if zsh is invoked as @t{sh}.
+Also, the
+@t{KSH_OPTION_PRINT},
+@t{LOCAL_OPTIONS},
+@t{PROMPT_BANG},
+@t{PROMPT_SUBST}
+and
+@t{SINGLE_LINE_ZLE}
+options are set if zsh is invoked as @t{ksh}.
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/restricted.yo
+@node Restricted Shell, , Compatibility, Invocation
+
+@section Restricted Shell
+@noindent
+@cindex restricted shell
+@pindex RESTRICTED
+When the basename of the command used to invoke zsh starts with the letter
+`@t{r}' or the `@t{-r}' command line option is supplied at invocation, the
+shell becomes restricted. Emulation mode is determined after stripping the
+letter `@t{r}' from the invocation name. The following are disabled in
+restricted mode:
+
+@noindent
+@itemize @bullet
+
+@item
+changing directories with the @t{cd} builtin
+@item
+changing or unsetting the @t{EGID}, @t{EUID}, @t{GID},
+@t{HISTFILE}, @t{HISTSIZE}, @t{IFS}, @t{LD_AOUT_LIBRARY_PATH},
+@t{LD_AOUT_PRELOAD}, @t{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}, @t{LD_PRELOAD},
+@t{MODULE_PATH}, @t{module_path}, @t{PATH}, @t{path}, @t{SHELL},
+@t{UID} and @t{USERNAME} parameters
+@item
+specifying command names containing @t{/}
+@item
+specifying command pathnames using @t{hash}
+@item
+redirecting output to files
+@item
+using the @t{exec} builtin command to replace the shell with another
+command
+@item
+using @t{jobs -Z} to overwrite the shell process' argument and
+environment space
+@item
+using the @t{ARGV0} parameter to override @t{argv[0]} for external
+commands
+@item
+turning off restricted mode with @t{set +r} or @t{unsetopt
+RESTRICTED}
+@end itemize
+
+@noindent
+These restrictions are enforced after processing the startup files. The
+startup files should set up @t{PATH} to point to a directory of commands
+which can be safely invoked in the restricted environment. They may also
+add further restrictions by disabling selected builtins.
+
+@noindent
+Restricted mode can also be activated any time by setting the
+@t{RESTRICTED} option. This immediately enables all the restrictions
+described above even if the shell still has not processed all startup
+files.
+
+@noindent
+A shell @emph{Restricted Mode} is an outdated way to restrict what users may
+do: modern systems have better, safer and more reliable ways to
+confine user actions, such as @emph{chroot jails}, @emph{containers} and
+@emph{zones}.
+
+@noindent
+A restricted shell is very difficult to implement safely. The feature
+may be removed in a future version of zsh.
+
+@noindent
+It is important to realise that the restrictions only apply to the shell,
+not to the commands it runs (except for some shell builtins). While a
+restricted shell can only run the restricted list of commands accessible
+via the predefined `@t{PATH}' variable, it does not prevent those
+commands from running any other command.
+
+@noindent
+As an example, if `@t{env}' is among the list of @emph{allowed} commands,
+then it allows the user to run any command as `@t{env}' is not a shell
+builtin command and can run arbitrary executables.
+
+@noindent
+So when implementing a restricted shell framework it is important to be
+fully aware of what actions each of the @emph{allowed} commands or features
+(which may be regarded as @emph{modules}) can perform.
+
+@noindent
+Many commands can have their behaviour affected by environment
+variables. Except for the few listed above, zsh does not restrict
+the setting of environment variables.
+
+@noindent
+If a `@t{perl}', `@t{python}', `@t{bash}', or other general purpose
+interpreted script it treated as a restricted
+command, the user can work around the restriction by
+setting specially crafted `@t{PERL5LIB}', `@t{PYTHONPATH}',
+`@t{BASHENV}' (etc.) environment variables. On GNU systems, any
+command can be made to run arbitrary code when performing character set
+conversion (including zsh itself) by setting a `@t{GCONV_PATH}'
+environment variable. Those are only a few examples.
+
+@noindent
+Bear in mind that, contrary to some other shells, `@t{readonly}' is not a
+security feature in zsh as it can be undone and so cannot be used to
+mitigate the above.
+
+@noindent
+A restricted shell only works if the allowed commands are few
+and carefully written so as not to grant more access to users than
+intended. It is also important to restrict what zsh module the user may
+load as some of them, such as `@t{zsh/system}', `@t{zsh/mapfile}' and
+`@t{zsh/files}', allow bypassing most of the restrictions.
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/files.yo
+@node Files, Shell Grammar, Invocation, Top
+
+@chapter Files
+@noindent
+
+@section Startup/Shutdown Files
+@noindent
+@cindex files, startup
+@cindex startup files
+@cindex files, shutdown
+@cindex shutdown files
+@pindex RCS, use of
+@pindex GLOBAL_RCS, use of
+@pindex NO_RCS, use of
+@pindex NO_GLOBAL_RCS, use of
+@vindex ZDOTDIR, use of
+@cindex zshenv
+Commands are first read from @t{/etc/zshenv}; this cannot be overridden.
+Subsequent behaviour is modified by the @t{RCS} and
+@t{GLOBAL_RCS} options; the former affects all startup files, while the
+second only affects global startup files (those shown here with an
+path starting with a @t{/}). If one of the options
+is unset at any point, any subsequent startup file(s)
+of the corresponding
+type will not be read. It is also possible for a file in @t{$ZDOTDIR} to
+re-enable @t{GLOBAL_RCS}. Both @t{RCS} and @t{GLOBAL_RCS} are set by
+default.
+
+@noindent
+Commands are then read from @t{$ZDOTDIR/.zshenv}.
+@pindex LOGIN, use of
+@cindex zprofile
+If the shell is a login shell, commands
+are read from @t{/etc/zprofile} and then @t{$ZDOTDIR/.zprofile}.
+@cindex zshrc
+Then, if the shell is interactive,
+commands are read from @t{/etc/zshrc} and then @t{$ZDOTDIR/.zshrc}.
+@cindex zlogin
+Finally, if the shell is a login shell, @t{/etc/zlogin} and
+@t{$ZDOTDIR/.zlogin} are read.
+
+@noindent
+@cindex zlogout
+When a login shell exits, the files @t{$ZDOTDIR/.zlogout} and then
+@t{/etc/zlogout} are read. This happens with either an explicit exit
+via the @t{exit} or @t{logout} commands, or an implicit exit by reading
+end-of-file from the terminal. However, if the shell terminates due
+to @t{exec}'ing another process, the logout files are not read.
+These are also affected by the @t{RCS} and @t{GLOBAL_RCS} options.
+Note also that the @t{RCS} option affects the saving of history files,
+i.e. if @t{RCS} is unset when the shell exits, no history file will be
+saved.
+
+@noindent
+@vindex HOME, use of
+If @t{ZDOTDIR} is unset, @t{HOME} is used instead.
+Files listed above as being in @t{/etc} may be in another
+directory, depending on the installation.
+
+@noindent
+As @t{/etc/zshenv} is run for all instances of zsh, it is important that
+it be kept as small as possible. In particular, it is a good idea to
+put code that does not need to be run for every single shell behind
+a test of the form `@t{if [[ -o rcs ]]; then ...}' so that it will not
+be executed when zsh is invoked with the `@t{-f}' option.
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/filelist.yo
+
+@section Files
+@noindent
+@cindex files used
+@table @asis
+@item @t{$ZDOTDIR/.zshenv}
+@item @t{$ZDOTDIR/.zprofile}
+@item @t{$ZDOTDIR/.zshrc}
+@item @t{$ZDOTDIR/.zlogin}
+@item @t{$ZDOTDIR/.zlogout}
+@item @t{$@{TMPPREFIX@}*} (default is /tmp/zsh*)
+@item @t{/etc/zshenv}
+@item @t{/etc/zprofile}
+@item @t{/etc/zshrc}
+@item @t{/etc/zlogin}
+@item @t{/etc/zlogout} (installation-specific - @t{/etc} is the default)
+@end table
+@sp 1
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+
+@noindent
+Any of these files may be pre-compiled with the @t{zcompile} builtin
+command (@ref{Shell Builtin Commands}). If a compiled file exists (named for the original file plus the
+@t{.zwc} extension) and it is newer than the original file, the compiled
+file will be used instead.
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/grammar.yo
+@node Shell Grammar, Redirection, Files, Top
+
+@chapter Shell Grammar
+@noindent
+@cindex shell grammar
+@cindex grammar, shell
+@menu
+* Simple Commands & Pipelines::
+* Precommand Modifiers::
+* Complex Commands::
+* Alternate Forms For Complex Commands::
+* Reserved Words::
+* Errors::
+* Comments::
+* Aliasing::
+* Quoting::
+@end menu
+@node Simple Commands & Pipelines, Precommand Modifiers, , Shell Grammar
+
+@section Simple Commands & Pipelines
+@noindent
+@cindex simple commands
+@cindex commands, simple
+A @emph{simple command} is a sequence of optional parameter
+assignments followed by blank-separated words,
+with optional redirections interspersed. For a description
+of assignment, see the beginning of
+@ref{Parameters}.
+
+@noindent
+The first word is the command to be executed, and the remaining
+words, if any, are arguments to the command.
+If a command name is given, the parameter assignments modify
+the environment of the command when it is executed.
+The value of a simple command is its exit status,
+or 128 plus the signal number if terminated by a signal.
+For example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+echo foo
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+is a simple command with arguments.
+
+@noindent
+@cindex pipeline
+A @emph{pipeline} is either a simple command, or a sequence of two or more
+simple commands where each command is separated from the next by `@t{|}'
+or `@t{|&}'. Where commands are separated by `@t{|}', the standard
+output of the first command is connected to the
+standard input of the next. `@t{|&}' is shorthand for `@t{2>&1 |}', which
+connects both the standard output and the standard error of the
+command to the standard input of the next. The value of a pipeline
+is the value of the last command, unless the pipeline is preceded by
+`@t{!}' in which case the value is the logical inverse of the value of the
+last command.
+For example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+echo foo | sed 's/foo/bar/'
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+is a pipeline, where the output (`@t{foo}' plus a newline) of the first
+command will be passed to the input of the second.
+
+@noindent
+@findex coproc
+@cindex coprocess
+If a pipeline is preceded by `@t{coproc}', it is executed as a coprocess;
+a two-way pipe is established between it and the parent shell. The
+shell can read from or write to the coprocess by means of the `@t{>&p}'
+and `@t{<&p}' redirection operators or with `@t{print -p}' and `@t{read -p}'.
+A pipeline cannot be preceded by both `@t{coproc}' and `@t{!}'.
+If job control is active, the coprocess can be treated in other than input
+and output as an ordinary background job.
+
+@noindent
+@cindex sublist
+A @emph{sublist} is either a single pipeline, or a sequence of two or more
+pipelines separated by `@t{&&}' or `@t{||}'. If two pipelines are separated
+by `@t{&&}', the second pipeline is executed only if the first succeeds
+(returns a zero status). If two pipelines are separated by `@t{||}', the
+second is executed only if the first fails (returns a nonzero status).
+Both operators have equal precedence and are left associative.
+The value of the sublist is the value of the last pipeline executed.
+For example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+dmesg | grep panic && print yes
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+is a sublist consisting of two pipelines, the second just a simple command
+which will be executed if and only if the @t{grep} command returns a zero
+status. If it does not, the value of the sublist is that return status, else
+it is the status returned by the @t{print} (almost certainly zero).
+
+@noindent
+@cindex list
+A @emph{list} is a sequence of zero or more sublists, in which each sublist
+is terminated by `@t{;}', `@t{&}', `@t{&|}', `@t{&!}', or a newline.
+This terminator
+may optionally be omitted from the last sublist in the list when the
+list appears as a complex command inside `@t{(}...@t{)}'
+or `@t{@{}...@t{@}}'. When a
+sublist is terminated by `@t{;}' or newline, the shell waits for it to
+finish before executing the next sublist. If a sublist is terminated
+by a `@t{&}', `@t{&|}', or `@t{&!}',
+the shell executes the last pipeline in it in the background, and
+does not wait for it to finish (note the difference from other shells
+which execute the whole sublist in the background).
+A backgrounded pipeline returns a status of zero.
+
+@noindent
+More generally, a list can be seen as a set of any shell commands
+whatsoever, including the complex commands below; this is implied wherever
+the word `list' appears in later descriptions. For example, the commands
+in a shell function form a special sort of list.
+@node Precommand Modifiers, Complex Commands, Simple Commands & Pipelines, Shell Grammar
+
+@section Precommand Modifiers
+@noindent
+@cindex precommand modifiers
+@cindex modifiers, precommand
+A simple command may be preceded by a @emph{precommand modifier},
+which will alter how the command is interpreted. These modifiers are
+shell builtin commands with the exception of @t{nocorrect} which is
+a reserved word.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex -
+@item @t{-}
+The command is executed with a `@t{-}' prepended to its
+@t{argv[0]} string.
+
+@findex builtin
+@item @t{builtin}
+The command word is taken to be the name of a builtin command,
+rather than a shell function or external command.
+
+@findex command
+@item @t{command} [ @t{-pvV} ]
+The command word is taken to be the name of an external command,
+rather than a shell function or builtin. If the @t{POSIX_BUILTINS} option
+is set, builtins will also be executed but certain special properties
+of them are suppressed. The @t{-p} flag causes a default path to be
+searched instead of that in @t{$path}. With the @t{-v} flag, @t{command}
+is similar to @t{whence} and with @t{-V}, it is equivalent to @t{whence
+-v}.
+
+@findex exec
+@item @t{exec} [ @t{-cl} ] [ @t{-a} @var{argv0} ]
+The following command together with any arguments is run in place
+of the current process, rather than as a sub-process. The shell does not
+fork and is replaced. The shell does not invoke @t{TRAPEXIT}, nor does it
+source @t{zlogout} files.
+The options are provided for compatibility with other shells.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{-c} option clears the environment.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{-l} option is equivalent to the @t{-} precommand modifier, to
+treat the replacement command as a login shell; the command is executed
+with a @t{-} prepended to its @t{argv[0]} string. This flag has no effect
+if used together with the @t{-a} option.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{-a} option is used to specify explicitly the @t{argv[0]} string
+(the name of the command as seen by the process itself) to be used by the
+replacement command and is directly equivalent to setting a value
+for the @t{ARGV0} environment variable.
+
+@findex nocorrect
+@item @t{nocorrect}
+Spelling correction is not done on any of the words. This must appear
+before any other precommand modifier, as it is interpreted immediately,
+before any parsing is done. It has no effect in non-interactive shells.
+
+@findex noglob
+@item @t{noglob}
+Filename generation (globbing) is not performed on any of
+the words.
+
+@end table
+@node Complex Commands, Alternate Forms For Complex Commands, Precommand Modifiers, Shell Grammar
+
+@section Complex Commands
+@noindent
+@cindex complex commands
+@cindex commands, complex
+A @emph{complex command} in zsh is one of the following:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex if
+@cindex if construct
+@item @t{if} @var{list} @t{then} @var{list} [ @t{elif} @var{list} @t{then} @var{list} ] ... [ @t{else} @var{list} ] @t{fi}
+The @t{if} @var{list} is executed, and if it returns a zero exit status,
+the @t{then} @var{list} is executed.
+Otherwise, the @t{elif} @var{list} is executed and if its status is zero,
+the @t{then} @var{list} is executed.
+If each @t{elif} @var{list} returns nonzero status, the @t{else} @var{list}
+is executed.
+
+@findex for
+@cindex for loops
+@cindex loops, for
+@item @t{for} @var{name} ... [ @t{in} @var{word} ... ] @var{term} @t{do} @var{list} @t{done}
+Expand the list of @var{word}s, and set the parameter
+@var{name} to each of them in turn, executing @var{list}
+each time. If the `@t{in} @var{word}' is omitted,
+use the positional parameters instead of the @var{word}s.
+
+@noindent
+The @var{term} consists of one or more newline or @t{;}
+which terminate the @var{word}s, and are optional when the
+`@t{in} @var{word}' is omitted.
+
+@noindent
+More than one parameter @var{name} can appear before the list of
+@var{word}s. If @var{N} @var{name}s are given, then on each execution of the
+loop the next @var{N} @var{word}s are assigned to the corresponding
+parameters. If there are more @var{name}s than remaining @var{word}s, the
+remaining parameters are each set to the empty string. Execution of the
+loop ends when there is no remaining @var{word} to assign to the first
+@var{name}. It is only possible for @t{in} to appear as the first @var{name}
+in the list, else it will be treated as marking the end of the list.
+
+@item @t{for ((} [@var{expr1}] @t{;} [@var{expr2}] @t{;} [@var{expr3}] @t{)) do} @var{list} @t{done}
+The arithmetic expression @var{expr1} is evaluated first (see
+@ref{Arithmetic Evaluation}). The arithmetic expression
+@var{expr2} is repeatedly evaluated until it evaluates to zero and
+when non-zero, @var{list} is executed and the arithmetic expression
+@var{expr3} evaluated. If any expression is omitted, then it behaves
+as if it evaluated to 1.
+
+@findex while
+@cindex while loops
+@cindex loops, while
+@item @t{while} @var{list} @t{do} @var{list} @t{done}
+Execute the @t{do} @var{list} as long as the @t{while} @var{list}
+returns a zero exit status.
+
+@findex until
+@cindex until loops
+@cindex loops, until
+@item @t{until} @var{list} @t{do} @var{list} @t{done}
+Execute the @t{do} @var{list} as long as @t{until} @var{list}
+returns a nonzero exit status.
+
+@findex repeat
+@cindex repeat loops
+@cindex loops, repeat
+@item @t{repeat} @var{word} @t{do} @var{list} @t{done}
+@var{word} is expanded and treated as an arithmetic expression,
+which must evaluate to a number @var{n}.
+@var{list} is then executed @var{n} times.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{repeat} syntax is disabled by default when the
+shell starts in a mode emulating another shell. It can be enabled
+with the command `@t{enable -r repeat}'
+
+@findex case
+@cindex case selection
+@cindex selection, case
+@item @t{case} @var{word} @t{in} [ [@t{(}] @var{pattern} [ @t{|} @var{pattern} ] ... @t{)} @var{list} (@t{;;}|@t{;&}|@t{;|}) ] ... @t{esac}
+Execute the @var{list} associated with the first @var{pattern}
+that matches @var{word}, if any. The form of the patterns
+is the same as that used for filename generation. See
+@ref{Filename Generation}.
+
+@noindent
+Note further that, unless the @t{SH_GLOB} option is set, the whole
+pattern with alternatives is treated by the shell as equivalent to a
+group of patterns within parentheses, although white space may appear
+about the parentheses and the vertical bar and will be stripped from the
+pattern at those points. White space may appear elsewhere in the
+pattern; this is not stripped. If the @t{SH_GLOB} option is set, so
+that an opening parenthesis can be unambiguously treated as part of the
+case syntax, the expression is parsed into separate words and these are
+treated as strict alternatives (as in other shells).
+
+@noindent
+If the @var{list} that is executed is terminated with @t{;&} rather than
+@t{;;}, the following list is also executed. The rule for
+the terminator of the following list @t{;;}, @t{;&} or @t{;|} is
+applied unless the @t{esac} is reached.
+
+@noindent
+If the @var{list} that is executed is terminated with @t{;|} the
+shell continues to scan the @var{pattern}s looking for the next match,
+executing the corresponding @var{list}, and applying the rule for
+the corresponding terminator @t{;;}, @t{;&} or @t{;|}.
+Note that @var{word} is not re-expanded; all applicable @var{pattern}s
+are tested with the same @var{word}.
+
+@findex select
+@cindex user selection
+@cindex selection, user
+@item @t{select} @var{name} [ @t{in} @var{word} ... @var{term} ] @t{do} @var{list} @t{done}
+where @var{term} is one or more newline or @t{;} to terminate the @var{word}s.
+@vindex REPLY, use of
+Print the set of @var{word}s, each preceded by a number.
+If the @t{in} @var{word} is omitted, use the positional parameters.
+The @t{PROMPT3} prompt is printed and a line is read from the line editor
+if the shell is interactive and that is active, or else standard input.
+If this line consists of the
+number of one of the listed @var{word}s, then the parameter @var{name}
+is set to the @var{word} corresponding to this number.
+If this line is empty, the selection list is printed again.
+Otherwise, the value of the parameter @var{name} is set to null.
+The contents of the line read from standard input is saved
+in the parameter @t{REPLY}. @var{list} is executed
+for each selection until a break or end-of-file is encountered.
+
+@cindex subshell
+@item @t{(} @var{list} @t{)}
+Execute @var{list} in a subshell. Traps set by the @t{trap} builtin
+are reset to their default values while executing @var{list}.
+
+@item @t{@{} @var{list} @t{@}}
+Execute @var{list}.
+
+@findex always
+@cindex always blocks
+@cindex try blocks
+@item @t{@{} @var{try-list} @t{@} always @{} @var{always-list} @t{@}}
+First execute @var{try-list}. Regardless of errors, or @t{break} or
+@t{continue} commands encountered within @var{try-list},
+execute @var{always-list}. Execution then continues from the
+result of the execution of @var{try-list}; in other words, any error,
+or @t{break} or @t{continue} command is treated in the
+normal way, as if @var{always-list} were not present. The two
+chunks of code are referred to as the `try block' and the `always block'.
+
+@noindent
+Optional newlines or semicolons may appear after the @t{always};
+note, however, that they may @emph{not} appear between the preceding
+closing brace and the @t{always}.
+
+@noindent
+An `error' in this context is a condition such as a syntax error which
+causes the shell to abort execution of the current function, script, or
+list. Syntax errors encountered while the shell is parsing the
+code do not cause the @var{always-list} to be executed. For example,
+an erroneously constructed @t{if} block in @var{try-list} would cause the
+shell to abort during parsing, so that @var{always-list} would not be
+executed, while an erroneous substitution such as @t{$@{*foo*@}} would
+cause a run-time error, after which @var{always-list} would be executed.
+
+@noindent
+An error condition can be tested and reset with the special integer
+variable @t{TRY_BLOCK_ERROR}. Outside an @var{always-list} the value is
+irrelevant, but it is initialised to @t{-1}. Inside @var{always-list}, the
+value is 1 if an error occurred in the @var{try-list}, else 0. If
+@t{TRY_BLOCK_ERROR} is set to 0 during the @var{always-list}, the error
+condition caused by the @var{try-list} is reset, and shell execution
+continues normally after the end of @var{always-list}. Altering the value
+during the @var{try-list} is not useful (unless this forms part of an
+enclosing @t{always} block).
+
+@noindent
+Regardless of @t{TRY_BLOCK_ERROR}, after the end of @var{always-list} the
+normal shell status @t{$?} is the value returned from @var{try-list}.
+This will be non-zero if there was an error, even if @t{TRY_BLOCK_ERROR}
+was set to zero.
+
+@noindent
+The following executes the given code, ignoring any errors it causes.
+This is an alternative to the usual convention of protecting code by
+executing it in a subshell.
+
+@noindent
+@example
+@{
+ # code which may cause an error
+ @} always @{
+ # This code is executed regardless of the error.
+ (( TRY_BLOCK_ERROR = 0 ))
+@}
+# The error condition has been reset.
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+When a @t{try} block occurs outside of any function,
+a @t{return} or a @t{exit} encountered in @var{try-list} does @emph{not} cause
+the execution of @var{always-list}. Instead, the shell exits immediately
+after any @t{EXIT} trap has been executed.
+Otherwise, a @t{return} command encountered in @var{try-list} will cause the
+execution of @var{always-list}, just like @t{break} and @t{continue}.
+
+@noindent
+
+
+@findex function
+@item @t{function} @var{word} ... [ @t{()} ] [ @var{term} ] @t{@{} @var{list} @t{@}}
+@itemx @var{word} ... @t{()} [ @var{term} ] @t{@{} @var{list} @t{@}}
+@itemx @var{word} ... @t{()} [ @var{term} ] @var{command}
+where @var{term} is one or more newline or @t{;}.
+Define a function which is referenced by any one of @var{word}.
+Normally, only one @var{word} is provided; multiple @var{word}s
+are usually only useful for setting traps.
+The body of the function is the @var{list} between
+the @t{@{} and @t{@}}. See @ref{Functions}.
+
+@noindent
+If the option @t{SH_GLOB} is set for compatibility with other shells, then
+whitespace may appear between the left and right parentheses when
+there is a single @var{word}; otherwise, the parentheses will be treated as
+forming a globbing pattern in that case.
+
+@noindent
+In any of the forms above, a redirection may appear outside the
+function body, for example
+
+@noindent
+@example
+func() @{ ... @} 2>&1
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The redirection is stored with the function and applied whenever the
+function is executed. Any variables in the redirection are expanded
+at the point the function is executed, but outside the function scope.
+
+@cindex timing
+@findex time
+@item @t{time} [ @var{pipeline} ]
+The @var{pipeline} is executed, and timing statistics are
+reported on the standard error in the form specified
+by the @t{TIMEFMT} parameter.
+If @var{pipeline} is omitted, print statistics about the
+shell process and its children.
+
+@cindex conditional expression
+@findex [[
+@item @t{[[} @var{exp} @t{]]}
+Evaluates the conditional expression @var{exp}
+and return a zero exit status if it is true.
+See @ref{Conditional Expressions}
+for a description of @var{exp}.
+
+@end table
+@node Alternate Forms For Complex Commands, Reserved Words, Complex Commands, Shell Grammar
+
+@section Alternate Forms For Complex Commands
+@noindent
+@cindex alternate forms for complex commands
+@cindex commands, alternate forms for complex
+Many of zsh's complex commands have alternate forms. These are
+non-standard and are likely not to be obvious even to seasoned shell
+programmers; they should not be used anywhere that portability of shell
+code is a concern.
+
+@noindent
+The short versions below only work if @var{sublist} is of the form `@t{@{}
+@var{list} @t{@}}' or if the @t{SHORT_LOOPS} option is set. For the @t{if},
+@t{while} and @t{until} commands, in both these cases the test part of the
+loop must also be suitably delimited, such as by `@t{[[} @var{...} @t{]]}' or
+`@t{((} @var{...} @t{))}',
+else the end of the test will not be recognized. For the
+@t{for}, @t{repeat}, @t{case} and @t{select} commands no such special form
+for the arguments is necessary, but the other condition (the special form
+of @var{sublist} or use of the @t{SHORT_LOOPS} option) still applies.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{if} @var{list} @t{@{} @var{list} @t{@}} [ @t{elif} @var{list} @t{@{} @var{list} @t{@}} ] ... [ @t{else @{} @var{list} @t{@}} ]
+An alternate form of @t{if}. The rules mean that
+
+@noindent
+@example
+if [[ -o ignorebraces ]] @{
+ print yes
+@}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+works, but
+
+@noindent
+@example
+if true @{ # Does not work!
+ print yes
+@}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+does @emph{not}, since the test is not suitably delimited.
+
+@item @t{if} @var{list} @var{sublist}
+A short form of the alternate @t{if}. The same limitations on the form of
+@var{list} apply as for the previous form.
+
+@item @t{for} @var{name} ... @t{(} @var{word} ... @t{)} @var{sublist}
+A short form of @t{for}.
+
+@item @t{for} @var{name} ... [ @t{in} @var{word} ... ] @var{term} @var{sublist}
+where @var{term} is at least one newline or @t{;}.
+Another short form of @t{for}.
+
+@item @t{for ((} [@var{expr1}] @t{;} [@var{expr2}] @t{;} [@var{expr3}] @t{))} @var{sublist}
+A short form of the arithmetic @t{for} command.
+
+@findex foreach
+@item @t{foreach} @var{name} ... @t{(} @var{word} ... @t{)} @var{list} @t{end}
+Another form of @t{for}.
+
+@item @t{while} @var{list} @t{@{} @var{list} @t{@}}
+An alternative form of @t{while}. Note the limitations on the form of
+@var{list} mentioned above.
+
+@item @t{until} @var{list} @t{@{} @var{list} @t{@}}
+An alternative form of @t{until}. Note the limitations on the form of
+@var{list} mentioned above.
+
+@item @t{repeat} @var{word} @var{sublist}
+This is a short form of @t{repeat}.
+
+@item @t{case} @var{word} @t{@{} [ [@t{(}] @var{pattern} [ @t{|} @var{pattern} ] ... @t{)} @var{list} (@t{;;}|@t{;&}|@t{;|}) ] ... @t{@}}
+An alternative form of @t{case}.
+
+@item @t{select} @var{name} [ @t{in} @var{word} ... @var{term} ] @var{sublist}
+where @var{term} is at least one newline or @t{;}.
+A short form of @t{select}.
+
+@item @t{function} @var{word} ... [ @t{()} ] [ @var{term} ] @var{sublist}
+This is a short form of @t{function}.
+
+@end table
+@node Reserved Words, Errors, Alternate Forms For Complex Commands, Shell Grammar
+
+@section Reserved Words
+@noindent
+@cindex reserved words
+@findex disable, use of
+The following words are recognized as reserved words when used as the first
+word of a command unless quoted or disabled using @t{disable -r}:
+
+@noindent
+@t{do done esac then elif else fi for case
+if while function repeat time until
+select coproc nocorrect foreach end ! [[ @{ @}
+declare export float integer local readonly typeset}
+
+@noindent
+Additionally, `@t{@}}' is recognized in any position if neither the
+@t{IGNORE_BRACES} option nor the @t{IGNORE_CLOSE_BRACES} option is set.
+@node Errors, Comments, Reserved Words, Shell Grammar
+
+@section Errors
+@noindent
+@cindex errors, handling of
+Certain errors are treated as fatal by the shell: in an interactive
+shell, they cause control to return to the command line, and in a
+non-interactive shell they cause the shell to be aborted. In older
+versions of zsh, a non-interactive shell running a script would not
+abort completely, but would resume execution at the next command to be
+read from the script, skipping the remainder of any functions or
+shell constructs such as loops or conditions; this somewhat illogical
+behaviour can be recovered by setting the option @t{CONTINUE_ON_ERROR}.
+
+@noindent
+Fatal errors found in non-interactive shells include:
+
+@noindent
+@itemize @bullet
+
+@item
+Failure to parse shell options passed when invoking the shell
+@item
+Failure to change options with the @t{set} builtin
+@item
+Parse errors of all sorts, including failures to parse
+mathematical expressions
+@item
+Failures to set or modify variable behaviour with @t{typeset},
+@t{local}, @t{declare}, @t{export}, @t{integer}, @t{float}
+@item
+Execution of incorrectly positioned loop control structures
+(@t{continue}, @t{break})
+@item
+Attempts to use regular expression with no regular expression
+module available
+@item
+Disallowed operations when the @t{RESTRICTED} options is set
+@item
+Failure to create a pipe needed for a pipeline
+@item
+Failure to create a multio
+@item
+Failure to autoload a module needed for a declared shell feature
+@item
+Errors creating command or process substitutions
+@item
+Syntax errors in glob qualifiers
+@item
+File generation errors where not caught by the option @t{BAD_PATTERN}
+@item
+All bad patterns used for matching within case statements
+@item
+File generation failures where not caused by @t{NO_MATCH} or
+similar options
+@item
+All file generation errors where the pattern was used to create a
+multio
+@item
+Memory errors where detected by the shell
+@item
+Invalid subscripts to shell variables
+@item
+Attempts to assign read-only variables
+@item
+Logical errors with variables such as assignment to the wrong type
+@item
+Use of invalid variable names
+@item
+Errors in variable substitution syntax
+@item
+Failure to convert characters in @t{$'}...@t{'} expressions
+@end itemize
+
+@noindent
+If the @t{POSIX_BUILTINS} option is set, more errors associated with
+shell builtin commands are treated as fatal, as specified by the POSIX
+standard.
+
+@noindent
+@node Comments, Aliasing, Errors, Shell Grammar
+
+@section Comments
+@noindent
+@cindex comments
+@pindex INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS, use of
+@vindex histchars, use of
+In non-interactive shells, or in interactive shells with the
+@t{INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS} option set, a word beginning
+with the third character of the @t{histchars} parameter
+(`@t{#}' by default) causes that word and all the following
+characters up to a newline to be ignored.
+@node Aliasing, Quoting, Comments, Shell Grammar
+
+@section Aliasing
+@noindent
+@cindex aliasing
+Every eligible @emph{word} in the shell input is checked to see if there
+is an alias defined for it.
+If so, it is replaced by the text of the alias if it is in command
+position (if it could be the first word of a simple command),
+or if the alias is global.
+If the replacement text ends with a space, the next word in the shell input
+is always eligible for purposes of alias expansion.
+@findex alias, use of
+@cindex aliases, global
+An alias is defined using the @t{alias} builtin; global aliases
+may be defined using the @t{-g} option to that builtin.
+
+@noindent
+A @emph{word} is defined as:
+
+@noindent
+@itemize @bullet
+
+@item
+Any plain string or glob pattern
+@item
+Any quoted string, using any quoting method (note that the quotes
+must be part of the alias definition for this to be eligible)
+@item
+Any parameter reference or command substitution
+@item
+Any series of the foregoing, concatenated without whitespace or
+other tokens between them
+@item
+Any reserved word (@t{case}, @t{do}, @t{else}, etc.)
+@item
+With global aliasing, any command separator, any redirection
+operator, and `@t{(}' or `@t{)}' when not part of a glob pattern
+@end itemize
+
+@noindent
+Alias expansion is done on the shell input before any other expansion
+except history expansion. Therefore, if an alias is defined for the
+word @t{foo}, alias expansion may be avoided by quoting part of the
+word, e.g. @t{\foo}. Any form of quoting works, although there is
+nothing to prevent an alias being defined for the quoted form such as
+@t{\foo} as well.
+
+@noindent
+When @t{POSIX_ALIASES} is set, only plain unquoted strings are eligible
+for aliasing. The @t{alias} builtin does not reject ineligible aliases,
+but they are not expanded.
+
+@noindent
+For use with completion, which would remove an initial backslash followed
+by a character that isn't special, it may be more convenient to quote the
+word by starting with a single quote, i.e. @t{'foo}; completion will
+automatically add the trailing single quote.
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Alias difficulties
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+Although aliases can be used in ways that bend normal shell syntax, not
+every string of non-white-space characters can be used as an alias.
+
+@noindent
+Any set of characters not listed as a word above is not a word, hence no
+attempt is made to expand it as an alias, no matter how it is defined
+(i.e. via the builtin or the special parameter @t{aliases} described in
+@ref{The zsh/parameter Module}).
+However, as noted in the case of @t{POSIX_ALIASES} above, the shell does
+not attempt to deduce whether the string corresponds to a word at the
+time the alias is created.
+
+@noindent
+For example, an expression containing an @t{=} at the start of
+a command line is an assignment and cannot be expanded as an alias;
+a lone @t{=} is not an assignment but can only be set as an alias
+using the parameter, as otherwise the @t{=} is taken part of the
+syntax of the builtin command.
+
+@noindent
+It is not presently possible to alias the `@t{((}' token that
+introduces arithmetic expressions, because until a full statement has been
+parsed, it cannot be distinguished from two consecutive `@t{(}'
+tokens introducing nested subshells.
+Also, if a separator such as @t{&&} is aliased,
+@t{\&&} turns into the two tokens @t{\&} and @t{&}, each of which may
+have been aliased separately. Similarly for @t{\<<}, @t{\>|}, etc.
+
+@noindent
+There is a commonly encountered problem with aliases
+illustrated by the following code:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+alias echobar='echo bar'; echobar
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+This prints a message that the command @t{echobar} could not be found.
+This happens because aliases are expanded when the code is read in;
+the entire line is read in one go, so that when @t{echobar} is executed it
+is too late to expand the newly defined alias. This is often
+a problem in shell scripts, functions, and code executed with `@t{source}'
+or `@t{.}'. Consequently, use of functions rather than aliases is
+recommended in non-interactive code.
+
+@noindent
+Note also the unhelpful interaction of aliases and function definitions:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+alias func='noglob func'
+func() @{
+ echo Do something with $*
+@}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Because aliases are expanded in function definitions, this causes the
+following command to be executed:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+noglob func() @{
+ echo Do something with $*
+@}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+which defines @t{noglob} as well as @t{func} as functions with the
+body given. To avoid this, either quote the name @t{func} or use the
+alternative function definition form `@t{function func}'. Ensuring the
+alias is defined after the function works but is problematic if the
+code fragment might be re-executed.
+
+@noindent
+@node Quoting, , Aliasing, Shell Grammar
+
+@section Quoting
+@noindent
+@cindex quoting
+A character may be @emph{quoted} (that is, made
+to stand for itself) by preceding it with a `@t{\}'.
+`@t{\}' followed by a newline is ignored.
+
+@noindent
+A string enclosed between `@t{$'}' and `@t{'}' is
+processed the same way as the string arguments of the
+@t{print} builtin, and the resulting string is considered to be
+entirely quoted. A literal `@t{'}' character can be included in the
+string by using the `@t{\'}' escape.
+
+@noindent
+@pindex RC_QUOTES, use of
+All characters enclosed between a pair of single quotes (@t{@value{dsq}}) that
+is not preceded by a `@t{$}' are quoted. A single quote cannot appear
+within single quotes unless the option @t{RC_QUOTES} is set, in which case
+a pair of single quotes are turned into a single quote. For example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+print @value{dsq}@value{dsq}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+outputs nothing apart from a newline if @t{RC_QUOTES} is not set, but one
+single quote if it is set.
+
+@noindent
+Inside double quotes (@t{""}), parameter and
+command substitution occur, and `@t{\}' quotes the characters
+`@t{\}', `@t{`}', `@t{"}', `@t{$}', and the first character
+of @t{$histchars} (default `@t{!}').
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/redirect.yo
+@node Redirection, Command Execution, Shell Grammar, Top
+
+@chapter Redirection
+@noindent
+@cindex redirection
+@cindex file descriptors
+@cindex descriptors, file
+If a command is followed by @t{&}
+and job control is not active,
+then the default standard input
+for the command is the empty file @t{/dev/null}.
+Otherwise, the environment for the execution of a command contains the
+file descriptors of the invoking shell as modified by
+input/output specifications.
+
+@noindent
+The following may appear anywhere in a simple command
+or may precede or follow a complex command.
+Expansion occurs before @var{word} or @var{digit}
+is used except as noted below.
+If the result of substitution on @var{word}
+produces more than one filename,
+redirection occurs for each
+separate filename in turn.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{<} @var{word}
+Open file @var{word} for reading as standard input.
+It is an error to open a file in this fashion if it does not exist.
+
+@item @t{<>} @var{word}
+Open file @var{word} for reading and writing as standard input.
+If the file does not exist then it is created.
+
+@item @t{>} @var{word}
+Open file @var{word} for writing as standard output.
+If the file does not exist then it is created.
+If the file exists, and the @t{CLOBBER} option is unset,
+this causes an error;
+otherwise, it is truncated to zero length.
+
+@item @t{>|} @var{word}
+@itemx @t{>!} @var{word}
+Same as @t{>}, except that the file is truncated to zero length
+if it exists, regardless of @t{CLOBBER}.
+
+@item @t{>>} @var{word}
+Open file @var{word} for writing in append mode as standard output.
+If the file does not exist, and the @t{CLOBBER} and @t{APPEND_CREATE}
+options are both unset, this causes an error;
+otherwise, the file is created.
+
+@item @t{>>|} @var{word}
+@itemx @t{>>!} @var{word}
+Same as @t{>>}, except that the file is created if it does not
+exist, regardless of @t{CLOBBER} and @t{APPEND_CREATE}.
+
+@item @t{<<}[@t{-}] @var{word}
+The shell input is read up to a line that is the same as
+@var{word}, or to an end-of-file.
+No parameter expansion, command substitution or
+filename generation is performed on @var{word}.
+The resulting document, called a
+@emph{here-document}, becomes the standard input.
+
+@noindent
+If any character of @var{word} is quoted with
+single or double quotes or a `@t{\}',
+no interpretation is placed upon the characters of the document.
+Otherwise, parameter and command substitution
+occurs, `@t{\}' followed by a newline is removed,
+and `@t{\}' must be used to quote the characters
+`@t{\}', `@t{$}', `@t{`}' and the first character of @var{word}.
+
+@noindent
+Note that @var{word} itself does not undergo shell expansion. Backquotes
+in @var{word} do not have their usual effect; instead they behave
+similarly to double quotes, except that the backquotes themselves are
+passed through unchanged. (This information is given for completeness
+and it is not recommended that backquotes be used.) Quotes in the form
+@t{$'}@var{...}@t{'} have their standard effect of expanding backslashed
+references to special characters.
+
+@noindent
+If @t{<<-} is used, then all leading
+tabs are stripped from @var{word} and from the document.
+
+@item @t{<<<} @var{word}
+Perform shell expansion on @var{word} and pass the result
+to standard input. This is known as a @emph{here-string}.
+Compare the use of @var{word} in here-documents above, where @var{word}
+does not undergo shell expansion.
+
+@item @t{<&} @var{number}
+@itemx @t{>&} @var{number}
+The standard input/output is duplicated from file descriptor
+@var{number} (see man page dup2(2)).
+
+@item @t{<& -}
+@itemx @t{>& -}
+Close the standard input/output.
+
+@item @t{<& p}
+@itemx @t{>& p}
+The input/output from/to the coprocess is moved to the standard input/output.
+
+@item @t{>&} @var{word}
+@itemx @t{&>} @var{word}
+(Except where `@t{>&} @var{word}' matches one of the above syntaxes;
+`@t{&>}' can always be used to avoid this ambiguity.)
+Redirects both standard output and standard error (file descriptor 2)
+in the manner of `@t{>} @var{word}'.
+Note that this does @emph{not} have the same effect as `@t{>} @var{word} @t{2>&1}'
+in the presence of multios (see the section below).
+
+@item @t{>&|} @var{word}
+@itemx @t{>&!} @var{word}
+@itemx @t{&>|} @var{word}
+@itemx @t{&>!} @var{word}
+Redirects both standard output and standard error (file descriptor 2)
+in the manner of `@t{>|} @var{word}'.
+
+@item @t{>>&} @var{word}
+@itemx @t{&>>} @var{word}
+Redirects both standard output and standard error (file descriptor 2)
+in the manner of `@t{>>} @var{word}'.
+
+@item @t{>>&|} @var{word}
+@itemx @t{>>&!} @var{word}
+@itemx @t{&>>|} @var{word}
+@itemx @t{&>>!} @var{word}
+Redirects both standard output and standard error (file descriptor 2)
+in the manner of `@t{>>|} @var{word}'.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+If one of the above is preceded by a digit, then the file
+descriptor referred to is that specified by the digit
+instead of the default 0 or 1.
+The order in which redirections are specified is significant.
+The shell evaluates each redirection in terms of the
+(@emph{file descriptor}, @emph{file})
+association at the time of evaluation.
+For example:
+
+@noindent
+@quotation
+... @t{1>}@var{fname} @t{2>&1}
+@end quotation
+
+@noindent
+first associates file descriptor 1 with file @var{fname}.
+It then associates file descriptor 2 with the file associated with file
+descriptor 1 (that is, @var{fname}).
+If the order of redirections were reversed,
+file descriptor 2 would be associated
+with the terminal (assuming file descriptor 1 had been)
+and then file descriptor 1 would be associated with file @var{fname}.
+
+@noindent
+The `@t{|&}' command separator described in
+@ref{Simple Commands & Pipelines}
+is a shorthand for `@t{2>&1 |}'.
+
+@noindent
+The various forms of process substitution, `@t{<(}@var{list}@t{)}',
+and `@t{=(}@var{list}@t{)}' for input and
+`@t{>(}@var{list}@t{)}' for output, are often used together with
+redirection. For example, if @var{word} in an output redirection is of the
+form `@t{>(}@var{list}@t{)}' then the output is piped to the
+command represented by @var{list}. See
+@ref{Process Substitution}.
+
+@section Opening file descriptors using parameters
+@noindent
+@cindex file descriptors, use with parameters
+@cindex parameters, for using file descriptors
+
+@noindent
+When the shell is parsing arguments to a command, and the shell option
+@t{IGNORE_BRACES} is not set, a different form of redirection is allowed:
+instead of a digit before the operator there is a valid shell identifier
+enclosed in braces. The shell will open a new file descriptor that
+is guaranteed to be at least 10 and set the parameter named by the
+identifier to the file descriptor opened. No whitespace is allowed
+between the closing brace and the redirection character. For example:
+
+@noindent
+@quotation
+... @t{@{myfd@}>&1}
+@end quotation
+
+@noindent
+This opens a new file descriptor that is a duplicate of file descriptor
+1 and sets the parameter @t{myfd} to the number of the file descriptor,
+which will be at least 10. The new file descriptor can be written to using
+the syntax @t{>&$myfd}. The file descriptor remains open in subshells
+and forked external executables.
+
+@noindent
+The syntax @t{@{}@var{varid}@t{@}>&-}, for example @t{@{myfd@}>&-}, may be used
+to close a file descriptor opened in this fashion. Note that the
+parameter given by @var{varid} must previously be set to a file descriptor
+in this case.
+
+@noindent
+It is an error to open or close a file descriptor in this fashion when the
+parameter is readonly. However, it is not an error to read or write a file
+descriptor using @t{<&$}@var{param} or @t{>&$}@var{param} if @var{param} is
+readonly.
+
+@noindent
+If the option @t{CLOBBER} is unset, it is an error to open a file
+descriptor using a parameter that is already set to an open file descriptor
+previously allocated by this mechanism. Unsetting the parameter before
+using it for allocating a file descriptor avoids the error.
+
+@noindent
+Note that this mechanism merely allocates or closes a file descriptor; it
+does not perform any redirections from or to it. It is usually convenient
+to allocate a file descriptor prior to use as an argument to @t{exec}.
+The syntax does not in any case work when used around complex commands
+such as parenthesised subshells or loops, where the opening brace is
+interpreted as part of a command list to be executed in the current shell.
+
+@noindent
+The following shows a typical sequence of allocation, use, and closing of a
+file descriptor:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+integer myfd
+exec @{myfd@}>~/logs/mylogfile.txt
+print This is a log message. >&$myfd
+exec @{myfd@}>&-
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Note that the expansion of the variable in the expression @t{>&$myfd}
+occurs at the point the redirection is opened. This is after the expansion
+of command arguments and after any redirections to the left on the command
+line have been processed.
+
+@section Multios
+@noindent
+@cindex multios
+@pindex MULTIOS, use of
+If the user tries to open a file descriptor for writing more than once,
+the shell opens the file descriptor as a pipe to a process that copies
+its input to all the specified outputs, similar to @cite{tee},
+provided the @t{MULTIOS} option is set, as it is by default. Thus:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+date >foo >bar
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+writes the date to two files, named `@t{foo}' and `@t{bar}'.
+Note that a pipe is an implicit redirection; thus
+
+@noindent
+@example
+date >foo | cat
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+writes the date to the file `@t{foo}', and also pipes it to cat.
+
+@noindent
+Note that the shell opens all the files to be used in the multio process
+immediately, not at the point they are about to be written.
+
+@noindent
+Note also that redirections are always expanded in order. This happens
+regardless of the setting of the @t{MULTIOS} option, but with the option
+in effect there are additional consequences. For example,
+the meaning of the expression @t{>&1} will change after a previous
+redirection:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+date >&1 >output
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+In the case above, the @t{>&1} refers to the standard output at the
+start of the line; the result is similar to the @t{tee} command.
+However, consider:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+date >output >&1
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+As redirections are evaluated in order, when the @t{>&1} is encountered
+the standard output is set to the file @t{output} and another copy of
+the output is therefore sent to that file. This is unlikely to be what
+is intended.
+
+@noindent
+If the @t{MULTIOS}
+option is set, the word after a redirection operator is also subjected
+to filename generation (globbing). Thus
+
+@noindent
+@example
+: > *
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+will truncate all files in the current directory,
+assuming there's at least one. (Without the @t{MULTIOS}
+option, it would create an empty file called `@t{*}'.)
+Similarly, you can do
+
+@noindent
+@example
+echo exit 0 >> *.sh
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+If the user tries to open a file descriptor for reading more than once,
+the shell opens the file descriptor as a pipe to a process that copies
+all the specified inputs to its output in the order specified, provided
+the @t{MULTIOS} option is set. It should be noted that each file is
+opened immediately, not at the point where it is about to be read:
+this behaviour differs from @t{cat}, so if strictly standard behaviour
+is needed, @t{cat} should be used instead.
+
+@noindent
+Thus
+
+@noindent
+@example
+sort <foo <fubar
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+or even
+
+@noindent
+@example
+sort <f@{oo,ubar@}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+is equivalent to `@t{cat foo fubar | sort}'.
+
+@noindent
+Expansion of the redirection argument occurs at the point the redirection
+is opened, at the point described above for the expansion of the variable
+in @t{>&$myfd}.
+
+@noindent
+Note that a pipe is an implicit redirection; thus
+
+@noindent
+@example
+cat bar | sort <foo
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+is equivalent to `@t{cat bar foo | sort}' (note the order of the inputs).
+
+@noindent
+If the @t{MULTIOS} option is @emph{un}set,
+each redirection replaces the previous redirection for that file descriptor.
+However, all files redirected to are actually opened, so
+
+@noindent
+@example
+echo Hello > bar > baz
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+when @t{MULTIOS} is unset will truncate `@t{bar}', and write `@t{Hello}'
+into `@t{baz}'.
+
+@noindent
+There is a problem when an output multio is attached to an external
+program. A simple example shows this:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+cat file >file1 >file2
+cat file1 file2
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Here, it is possible that the second `@t{cat}' will not display the full
+contents of @t{file1} and @t{file2} (i.e. the original contents of
+@t{file} repeated twice).
+
+@noindent
+The reason for this is that the multios are spawned after the @t{cat}
+process is forked from the parent shell, so the parent shell does not
+wait for the multios to finish writing data. This means the command as
+shown can exit before @t{file1} and @t{file2} are completely written.
+As a workaround, it is possible to run the @t{cat} process as part of a
+job in the current shell:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+@{ cat file @} >file >file2
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Here, the @t{@{}@var{...}@t{@}} job will pause to wait for both files to be
+written.
+
+@noindent
+
+@section Redirections with no command
+@noindent
+When a simple command consists of one or more redirection operators
+and zero or more parameter assignments, but no command name, zsh can
+behave in several ways.
+
+@noindent
+@vindex NULLCMD, use of
+@pindex CSH_NULLCMD, use of
+If the parameter @t{NULLCMD} is not set or the option @t{CSH_NULLCMD} is
+set, an error is caused. This is the @cite{csh} behavior and @t{CSH_NULLCMD}
+is set by default when emulating @cite{csh}.
+
+@noindent
+@pindex SH_NULLCMD, use of
+If the option @t{SH_NULLCMD} is set, the builtin `@t{:}' is inserted as a
+command with the given redirections. This is the default when emulating
+@cite{sh} or @cite{ksh}.
+
+@noindent
+@vindex READNULLCMD, use of
+Otherwise, if the parameter @t{NULLCMD} is set, its value will be used as a
+command with the given redirections. If both @t{NULLCMD} and
+@t{READNULLCMD} are set, then the value of the latter will be used instead
+of that of the former when the redirection is an input. The default for
+@t{NULLCMD} is `@t{cat}' and for @t{READNULLCMD} is `@t{more}'. Thus
+
+@noindent
+@example
+< file
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+shows the contents of @t{file} on standard output, with paging if that is a
+terminal. @t{NULLCMD} and @t{READNULLCMD} may refer to shell functions.
+
+@noindent
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/exec.yo
+@node Command Execution, Functions, Redirection, Top
+
+@chapter Command Execution
+@noindent
+@cindex command execution
+@cindex execution, of commands
+@cindex command not found, handling of
+@findex command_not_found_handler
+If a command name contains no slashes, the shell attempts to locate
+it. If there exists a shell function by that name, the function
+is invoked as described in @ref{Functions}. If there exists
+a shell builtin by that name, the builtin is invoked.
+
+@noindent
+@vindex path, use of
+Otherwise, the shell searches each element of @t{$path} for a
+directory containing an executable file by that name. If the
+search is unsuccessful, the shell prints an error message and returns
+a nonzero exit status.
+
+@noindent
+If execution fails because the file is not in executable format,
+and the file is not a directory, it is assumed to be a shell
+script. @t{/bin/sh} is spawned to execute it. If the program
+is a file beginning with `@t{#!}', the remainder of the first line
+specifies an interpreter for the program. The shell will
+execute the specified interpreter on operating systems that do
+not handle this executable format in the kernel.
+
+@noindent
+If no external command is found but a function @t{command_not_found_handler}
+exists the shell executes this function with all
+command line arguments. The return status of the function becomes the
+status of the command. If the function wishes to mimic the
+behaviour of the shell when the command is not found, it should
+print the message `@t{command not found:} @var{cmd}' to standard error
+and return status 127. Note that the handler is executed in a
+subshell forked to execute an external command, hence changes to
+directories, shell parameters, etc. have no effect on the main shell.
+
+@noindent
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/func.yo
+@node Functions, Jobs & Signals, Command Execution, Top
+
+@chapter Functions
+@noindent
+@cindex functions
+@findex function, use of
+Shell functions are defined with the @t{function} reserved word or the
+special syntax `@var{funcname} @t{()}'.
+Shell functions are read in and stored internally.
+Alias names are resolved when the function is read.
+Functions are executed like commands with the arguments
+passed as positional parameters.
+(See @ref{Command Execution}.)
+
+@noindent
+Functions execute in the same process as the caller and
+share all files
+and present working directory with the
+caller. A trap on @t{EXIT} set inside a function
+is executed after the function completes in the environment
+of the caller.
+
+@noindent
+@findex return, use of
+The @t{return} builtin is used to return from function calls.
+
+@noindent
+@findex functions, use of
+Function identifiers can be listed with the @t{functions} builtin.
+@findex unfunction, use of
+Functions can be undefined with the @t{unfunction} builtin.
+
+@section Autoloading Functions
+@noindent
+@cindex autoloading functions
+@cindex functions, autoloading
+
+@noindent
+@findex autoload, use of
+@vindex fpath, use of
+A function can be marked as @emph{undefined} using the @t{autoload} builtin
+(or `@t{functions -u}' or `@t{typeset -fu}'). Such a function has no
+body. When the function is first executed, the shell searches for its
+definition using the elements of the @t{fpath} variable. Thus to define
+functions for autoloading, a typical sequence is:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+fpath=(~/myfuncs $fpath)
+autoload myfunc1 myfunc2 ...
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The usual alias expansion during reading will be suppressed if the
+@t{autoload} builtin or its equivalent is given the option @t{-U}. This is
+recommended for the use of functions supplied with the zsh distribution.
+@findex zcompile, use of
+Note that for functions precompiled with the @t{zcompile} builtin command
+the flag @t{-U} must be provided when the @t{.zwc} file is created, as the
+corresponding information is compiled into the latter.
+
+@noindent
+For each @var{element} in @t{fpath}, the shell looks for three possible
+files, the newest of which is used to load the definition for the function:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @var{element}@t{.zwc}
+A file created with the @t{zcompile} builtin command, which is expected to
+contain the definitions for all functions in the directory named
+@var{element}. The file is treated in the same manner as a directory
+containing files for functions and is searched for the definition of the
+function. If the definition is not found, the search for a definition
+proceeds with the other two possibilities described below.
+
+@noindent
+If @var{element} already includes a @t{.zwc} extension (i.e. the extension
+was explicitly given by the user), @var{element} is searched for the
+definition of the function without comparing its age to that of other
+files; in fact, there does not need to be any directory named @var{element}
+without the suffix. Thus including an element such as
+`@t{/usr/local/funcs.zwc}' in @t{fpath} will speed up the search for
+functions, with the disadvantage that functions included must be explicitly
+recompiled by hand before the shell notices any changes.
+
+@item @var{element}@t{/}@var{function}@t{.zwc}
+A file created with @t{zcompile}, which is expected to contain the
+definition for @var{function}. It may include other function definitions
+as well, but those are neither loaded nor executed; a file found in this
+way is searched @emph{only} for the definition of @var{function}.
+
+@item @var{element}@t{/}@var{function}
+A file of zsh command text, taken to be the definition for @var{function}.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+In summary, the order of searching is, first, in the @emph{parents of}
+directories in @t{fpath} for the newer of either a compiled directory or
+a directory in @t{fpath}; second, if more than one of these contains a
+definition for the function that is sought, the leftmost in the @t{fpath}
+is chosen; and third, within a directory, the newer of either a compiled
+function or an ordinary function definition is used.
+
+@noindent
+@pindex KSH_AUTOLOAD, use of
+If the @t{KSH_AUTOLOAD} option is set, or the file contains only a
+simple definition of the function, the file's contents will be executed.
+This will normally define the function in question, but may also perform
+initialization, which is executed in the context of the function execution,
+and may therefore define local parameters. It is an error if the function
+is not defined by loading the file.
+
+@noindent
+Otherwise, the function body (with no surrounding `@var{funcname}@t{()
+@{}@var{...}@t{@}}') is taken to be the complete contents of the file. This
+form allows the file to be used directly as an executable shell script. If
+processing of the file results in the function being re-defined, the
+function itself is not re-executed. To force the shell to perform
+initialization and then call the function defined, the file should contain
+initialization code (which will be executed then discarded) in addition to
+a complete function definition (which will be retained for subsequent calls
+to the function), and a call to the shell function, including any
+arguments, at the end.
+
+@noindent
+For example, suppose the autoload file @t{func} contains
+
+@noindent
+@example
+func() @{ print This is func; @}
+print func is initialized
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+then `@t{func; func}' with @t{KSH_AUTOLOAD} set will produce both messages
+on the first call, but only the message `@t{This is func}' on the second
+and subsequent calls. Without @t{KSH_AUTOLOAD} set, it will produce
+the initialization message on the first call, and the other message on the
+second and subsequent calls.
+
+@noindent
+It is also possible to create a function that is not marked as autoloaded,
+but which loads its own definition by searching @t{fpath}, by using
+`@t{autoload -X}' within a shell function. For example, the following are
+equivalent:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+myfunc() @{
+ autoload -X
+@}
+myfunc args...
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+and
+
+@noindent
+@example
+unfunction myfunc # if myfunc was defined
+autoload myfunc
+myfunc args...
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+In fact, the @t{functions} command outputs `@t{builtin autoload -X}' as
+the body of an autoloaded function. This is done so that
+
+@noindent
+@example
+eval "$(functions)"
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+produces a reasonable result. A true autoloaded function can be
+identified by the presence of the comment `@t{# undefined}' in the body,
+because all comments are discarded from defined functions.
+
+@noindent
+To load the definition of an autoloaded function @t{myfunc} without
+executing @t{myfunc}, use:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+autoload +X myfunc
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+
+@section Anonymous Functions
+@noindent
+@cindex anonymous functions
+@cindex functions, anonymous
+
+@noindent
+If no name is given for a function, it is `anonymous' and is handled
+specially. Either form of function definition may be used: a `@t{()}' with
+no preceding name, or a `@t{function}' with an immediately following open
+brace. The function is executed immediately at the point of definition and
+is not stored for future use. The function name is set to `@t{(anon)}'.
+
+@noindent
+Arguments to the function may be specified as words following the
+closing brace defining the function, hence if there are none no
+arguments (other than @t{$0}) are set. This is a difference from the
+way other functions are parsed: normal function definitions may be
+followed by certain keywords such as `@t{else}' or `@t{fi}', which will
+be treated as arguments to anonymous functions, so that a newline or
+semicolon is needed to force keyword interpretation.
+
+@noindent
+Note also that the argument list of any enclosing script or function is
+hidden (as would be the case for any other function called at this
+point).
+
+@noindent
+Redirections may be applied to the anonymous function in the same manner as
+to a current-shell structure enclosed in braces. The main use of anonymous
+functions is to provide a scope for local variables. This is particularly
+convenient in start-up files as these do not provide their own local
+variable scope.
+
+@noindent
+For example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+variable=outside
+function @{
+ local variable=inside
+ print "I am $variable with arguments $*"
+@} this and that
+print "I am $variable"
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+outputs the following:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+I am inside with arguments this and that
+I am outside
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Note that function definitions with arguments that expand to nothing,
+for example `@t{name=; function $name @{ }@var{...}@t{ @}}', are not
+treated as anonymous functions. Instead, they are treated as normal
+function definitions where the definition is silently discarded.
+
+@noindent
+
+@section Special Functions
+@noindent
+Certain functions, if defined, have special meaning to the shell.
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Hook Functions
+@noindent
+@findex functions, hook
+@findex hook functions
+
+@noindent
+For the functions below, it is possible to define an array that has the
+same name as the function with `@t{_functions}' appended. Any element in
+such an array is taken as the name of a function to execute; it is executed
+in the same context and with the same arguments as the basic function. For
+example, if @t{$chpwd_functions} is an array containing the values
+`@t{mychpwd}', `@t{chpwd_save_dirstack}', then the shell attempts to
+execute the functions `@t{chpwd}', `@t{mychpwd}' and
+`@t{chpwd_save_dirstack}', in that order. Any function that does not exist
+is silently ignored. A function found by this mechanism is referred to
+elsewhere as a `hook function'. An error in any function causes subsequent
+functions not to be run. Note further that an error in a @t{precmd} hook
+causes an immediately following @t{periodic} function not to run (though
+it may run at the next opportunity).
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex chpwd
+@vindex chpwd_functions
+@item @t{chpwd}
+Executed whenever the current working directory is changed.
+
+@findex periodic
+@vindex periodic_functions
+@item @t{periodic}
+@vindex PERIOD
+If the parameter @t{PERIOD}
+is set, this function is executed every @t{$PERIOD}
+seconds, just before a prompt. Note that if multiple functions
+are defined using the array @t{periodic_functions} only one
+period is applied to the complete set of functions, and the
+scheduled time is not reset if the list of functions is altered.
+Hence the set of functions is always called together.
+
+@findex precmd
+@vindex precmd_functions
+@item @t{precmd}
+Executed before each prompt. Note that precommand functions are not
+re-executed simply because the command line is redrawn, as happens, for
+example, when a notification about an exiting job is displayed.
+
+@findex preexec
+@vindex preexec_functions
+@item @t{preexec}
+Executed just after a command has been read and is about to be
+executed. If the history mechanism is active (regardless of whether the
+line was discarded from the history buffer), the string that the user
+typed is passed as the first argument, otherwise it is an empty string.
+The actual command that will be executed (including expanded aliases) is
+passed in two different forms: the second argument is a single-line,
+size-limited version of the command (with things like function bodies
+elided); the third argument contains the full text that is being
+executed.
+
+@findex zshaddhistory
+@vindex zshaddhistory_functions
+@item @t{zshaddhistory}
+@cindex history, hook when line is saved
+Executed when a history line has been read interactively, but
+before it is executed. The sole argument is the complete history
+line (so that any terminating newline will still be present).
+
+@noindent
+If any of the hook functions returns status 1 (or any non-zero value
+other than 2, though this is not guaranteed for future versions of the
+shell) the history line will not be saved, although it lingers in the
+history until the next line is executed, allowing you to reuse or edit
+it immediately.
+
+@noindent
+If any of the hook functions returns status 2 the history line
+will be saved on the internal history list, but not written to
+the history file. In case of a conflict, the first non-zero status
+value is taken.
+
+@noindent
+A hook function may call `@t{fc -p} @var{...}' to switch the history
+context so that the history is saved in a different file from the
+that in the global @t{HISTFILE} parameter. This is handled specially:
+the history context is automatically restored after the processing
+of the history line is finished.
+
+@noindent
+The following example function works with one of the options
+@t{INC_APPEND_HISTORY} or @t{SHARE_HISTORY} set, in order that the line
+is written out immediately after the history entry is added. It first
+adds the history line to the normal history with the newline stripped,
+which is usually the correct behaviour. Then it switches the history
+context so that the line will be written to a history file in the
+current directory.
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zshaddhistory() @{
+ print -sr -- $@{1%%$'\n'@}
+ fc -p .zsh_local_history
+@}
+@end example
+
+@findex zshexit
+@vindex zshexit_functions
+@item @t{zshexit}
+Executed at the point where the main shell is about to exit normally.
+This is not called by exiting subshells, nor when the @t{exec}
+precommand modifier is used before an external command. Also, unlike
+@t{TRAPEXIT}, it is not called when functions exit.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Trap Functions
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+The functions below are treated specially but do not have corresponding
+hook arrays.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{TRAP}@var{NAL}
+@cindex signals, trapping
+@cindex trapping signals
+If defined and non-null,
+this function will be executed whenever the shell
+catches a signal @t{SIG}@var{NAL}, where @var{NAL} is a signal
+name as specified for the @t{kill} builtin.
+The signal number will be passed as the first parameter to the function.
+
+@noindent
+If a function of this form is defined and null,
+the shell and processes spawned by it will ignore @t{SIG}@var{NAL}.
+
+@noindent
+The return status from the function is handled specially. If it is
+zero, the signal is assumed to have been handled, and execution continues
+normally. Otherwise, the shell will behave as interrupted except that
+the return status of the trap is retained.
+
+@noindent
+Programs terminated by uncaught signals typically return the status 128
+plus the signal number. Hence the following causes the handler for
+@t{SIGINT} to print a message, then mimic the usual effect of the signal.
+
+@noindent
+@example
+TRAPINT() @{
+ print "Caught SIGINT, aborting."
+ return $(( 128 + $1 ))
+@}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The functions @t{TRAPZERR}, @t{TRAPDEBUG} and @t{TRAPEXIT} are never
+executed inside other traps.
+
+@findex TRAPDEBUG
+@item @t{TRAPDEBUG}
+If the option @t{DEBUG_BEFORE_CMD} is set (as it is by default), executed
+before each command; otherwise executed after each command. See
+the description of the @t{trap} builtin in
+@ref{Shell Builtin Commands} for details of additional features provided
+in debug traps.
+
+@findex TRAPEXIT
+@item @t{TRAPEXIT}
+Executed when the shell exits,
+or when the current function exits if defined inside a function.
+The value of @t{$?} at the start of execution is the exit status of the
+shell or the return status of the function exiting.
+
+@findex TRAPZERR
+@findex TRAPERR
+@item @t{TRAPZERR}
+Executed whenever a command has a non-zero exit status. However, the
+function is not executed if the command occurred in a sublist followed by
+`@t{&&}' or `@t{||}'; only the final command in a sublist of this type
+causes the trap to be executed. The function @t{TRAPERR} acts the same as
+@t{TRAPZERR} on systems where there is no @t{SIGERR} (this is the usual
+case).
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+@findex trap, use of
+The functions beginning `@t{TRAP}' may alternatively be defined with the
+@t{trap} builtin: this may be preferable for some uses. Setting a trap
+with one form removes any trap of the other form for the same signal;
+removing a trap in either form removes all traps for the same signal.
+The forms
+
+@noindent
+@example
+TRAPNAL() @{
+ # code
+@}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+('function traps') and
+
+@noindent
+@example
+trap '
+ # code
+' NAL
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+('list traps') are equivalent in most ways, the exceptions being the
+following:
+
+@noindent
+@itemize @bullet
+
+@item
+Function traps have all the properties of normal functions,
+appearing in the list of functions and being called with their own
+function context rather than the context where the trap was triggered.
+@item
+The return status from function traps is special, whereas a return
+from a list trap causes the surrounding context to return with the given
+status.
+@item
+Function traps are not reset within subshells, in accordance with
+zsh behaviour; list traps are reset, in accordance with POSIX
+behaviour.
+@end itemize
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/jobs.yo
+@node Jobs & Signals, Arithmetic Evaluation, Functions, Top
+
+@chapter Jobs & Signals
+@noindent
+
+@section Jobs
+@noindent
+@cindex jobs
+@pindex MONITOR, use of
+If the @t{MONITOR} option is set,
+an interactive shell associates a @emph{job} with each pipeline.
+It keeps a table of current jobs, printed by the @t{jobs}
+command, and assigns them small integer numbers.
+When a job is started asynchronously with `@t{&}',
+the shell prints a line to standard error which looks like:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+[1] 1234
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+indicating that the job which was started asynchronously was job number
+1 and had one (top-level) process, whose process ID was 1234.
+
+@noindent
+If a job is started with `@t{&|}' or `@t{&!}',
+then that job is immediately disowned. After startup, it
+does not have a place in the job table, and is not subject
+to the job control features described here.
+
+@noindent
+If you are running a job and wish to do something else you may hit the key
+^Z (control-Z) which sends a @t{TSTP} signal to the current job: this key
+may be redefined by the @t{susp} option of the external @t{stty} command.
+@cindex jobs, suspending
+@cindex suspending jobs
+The shell will then normally indicate that the job has been `suspended',
+and print another prompt. You can then manipulate the state of this job,
+@findex bg, use of
+putting it in the background with the @t{bg} command, or run some other
+commands and then eventually bring the job back into the foreground with
+@findex fg, use of
+the foreground command @t{fg}. A ^Z takes effect immediately and
+is like an interrupt in that pending output and unread input are discarded
+when it is typed.
+
+@noindent
+A job being run in the background will suspend if it tries to read
+from the terminal.
+
+@noindent
+Note that if the job running in the foreground is a shell function,
+then suspending it will have the effect of causing the shell to fork.
+This is necessary to separate the function's state from that of the
+parent shell performing the job control, so that the latter can return
+to the command line prompt. As a result, even if @t{fg} is
+used to continue the job the function will no longer be part of the
+parent shell, and any variables set by the function will not be visible
+in the parent shell. Thus the behaviour is different from the case
+where the function was never suspended. Zsh is different from many
+other shells in this regard.
+
+@noindent
+One additional side effect is that use of @t{disown} with a job
+created by suspending shell code in this fashion is delayed: the
+job can only be disowned once any process started from the parent
+shell has terminated. At that point, the disowned job disappears
+silently from the job list.
+
+@noindent
+The same behaviour is found when the shell is executing code as the
+right hand side of a pipeline or any complex shell construct such as
+@t{if}, @t{for}, etc., in order that the entire block of code
+can be managed as a single job.
+@cindex background jobs, I/O
+@cindex jobs, background, I/O
+Background jobs are normally allowed to produce output,
+but this can be disabled by giving the command `@t{stty tostop}'.
+If you set this
+tty option, then background jobs will suspend when they try to produce
+output like they do when they try to read input.
+
+@noindent
+When a command is suspended and continued later with the @t{fg} or
+@t{wait} builtins, zsh restores tty modes that were in effect when it was
+suspended. This (intentionally) does not apply if the command is
+continued via `@t{kill -CONT}', nor when it is continued with @t{bg}.
+
+@noindent
+@cindex jobs, referring to
+@cindex referring to jobs
+There are several ways to refer to jobs in the shell.
+A job can be referred to by the process ID of any process of the job
+or by one of the following:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{%}@var{number}
+The job with the given number.
+@item @t{%}@var{string}
+The last job whose command line begins with @var{string}.
+@item @t{%?}@var{string}
+The last job whose command line contains @var{string}.
+@item @t{%%}
+Current job.
+@item @t{%+}
+Equivalent to `@t{%%}'.
+@item @t{%-}
+Previous job.
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+The shell learns immediately whenever a process changes state.
+@pindex NOTIFY, use of
+It normally informs you whenever a job becomes blocked so that
+no further progress is possible. If the @t{NOTIFY} option is not set,
+it waits until just before it prints a prompt before it informs you.
+All such notifications are sent directly to the terminal, not to
+the standard output or standard error.
+
+@noindent
+When the monitor mode is on, each background job that completes
+triggers any trap set for @t{CHLD}.
+
+@noindent
+When you try to leave the shell while jobs are running or suspended, you will
+be warned that `You have suspended (running) jobs'.
+You may use the @t{jobs} command to see what they are.
+If you do this or immediately try to
+exit again, the shell will not warn you a second time; the suspended
+jobs will be terminated, and the running jobs will be sent
+a @t{SIGHUP} signal, if the @t{HUP} option is set.
+@pindex HUP, use of
+
+@noindent
+@cindex jobs, disowning
+@cindex disowning jobs
+@findex disown, use of
+To avoid having the shell terminate the running jobs, either
+use the @cite{nohup} command (see man page nohup(1))
+or the @t{disown} builtin.
+
+@section Signals
+@noindent
+The @t{INT} and @t{QUIT} signals for an invoked
+command are ignored if the command is followed by
+`@t{&}' and the @t{MONITOR} option is not active.
+The shell itself always ignores the @t{QUIT} signal.
+Otherwise, signals have the values
+inherited by the shell from its parent
+(but see the @t{TRAP}@var{NAL} special functions in @ref{Functions}).
+
+@noindent
+@cindex exiting shell, and asynchronous jobs
+@cindex asynchronous jobs, and exiting shell
+@cindex jobs, asynchronous, and exiting shell
+Certain jobs are run asynchronously by the shell other than those
+explicitly put into the background; even in cases where the shell
+would usually wait for such jobs, an explicit @t{exit} command
+or exit due to the option @t{ERR_EXIT} will cause the shell to
+exit without waiting. Examples of such asynchronous jobs are
+process substitution, see
+@ref{Process Substitution}, and the handler processes for
+multios, see
+the section Multios in @ref{Redirection}.
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/arith.yo
+@node Arithmetic Evaluation, Conditional Expressions, Jobs & Signals, Top
+
+@chapter Arithmetic Evaluation
+@noindent
+@cindex arithmetic evaluation
+@cindex evaluation, arithmetic
+@findex let, use of
+The shell can perform integer and floating point arithmetic, either using
+the builtin @t{let}, or via a substitution of the form
+@t{$((}@var{...}@t{))}. For
+integers, the shell is usually compiled to use 8-byte precision where this
+is available, otherwise precision is 4 bytes. This can be tested, for
+example, by giving the command `@t{print - $(( 12345678901 ))}'; if the
+number appears unchanged, the precision is at least 8 bytes. Floating
+point arithmetic always uses the `double' type with whatever corresponding
+precision is provided by the compiler and the library.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{let} builtin command takes arithmetic expressions as arguments; each
+is evaluated separately. Since many of the arithmetic operators, as well
+as spaces, require quoting, an alternative form is provided: for any
+command which begins with a `@t{((}', all the characters until a
+matching `@t{))}' are treated as a quoted expression and
+arithmetic expansion performed as for an argument of @t{let}. More
+precisely, `@t{((}@var{...}@t{))}' is equivalent to
+`@t{let "}@var{...}@t{"}'. The return status is 0 if the arithmetic value
+of the expression is non-zero, 1 if it is zero, and 2 if an error occurred.
+
+@noindent
+For example, the following statement
+
+@noindent
+@example
+(( val = 2 + 1 ))
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+is equivalent to
+
+@noindent
+@example
+let "val = 2 + 1"
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+both assigning the value 3 to the shell variable @t{val} and returning a
+zero status.
+
+@noindent
+@cindex arithmetic base
+@cindex bases, in arithmetic
+Integers can be in bases other than 10.
+A leading `@t{0x}' or `@t{0X}' denotes hexadecimal and a leading
+`@t{0b}' or `@t{0B}' binary.
+Integers may also be of the form `@var{base}@t{#}@var{n}',
+where @var{base} is a decimal number between two and thirty-six
+representing the arithmetic base and @var{n}
+is a number in that base (for example, `@t{16#ff}' is 255 in hexadecimal).
+The @var{base}@t{#} may also be omitted, in which case
+base 10 is used. For backwards compatibility the form
+`@t{[}@var{base}@t{]}@var{n}' is also accepted.
+
+@noindent
+An integer expression or a base given in the form
+`@var{base}@t{#}@var{n}' may contain underscores (`@t{_}') after the
+leading digit for visual guidance; these are ignored in computation.
+Examples are @t{1_000_000} or @t{0xffff_ffff} which are equivalent to
+@t{1000000} and @t{0xffffffff} respectively.
+
+@noindent
+It is also possible to specify a base to be used for output in the form
+`@t{[#}@var{base}@t{]}', for example `@t{[#16]}'. This is used when
+outputting arithmetical substitutions or when assigning to scalar
+parameters, but an explicitly defined integer or floating point parameter
+will not be affected. If an integer variable is implicitly defined by an
+arithmetic expression, any base specified in this way will be set as the
+variable's output arithmetic base as if the option `@t{-i} @var{base}' to
+the @t{typeset} builtin had been used. The expression has no precedence
+and if it occurs more than once in a mathematical expression, the last
+encountered is used. For clarity it is recommended that it appear at the
+beginning of an expression. As an example:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+typeset -i 16 y
+print $(( [#8] x = 32, y = 32 ))
+print $x $y
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+outputs first `@t{8#40}', the rightmost value in the given output base, and
+then `@t{8#40 16#20}', because @t{y} has been explicitly declared to
+have output base 16, while @t{x} (assuming it does not already exist) is
+implicitly typed by the arithmetic evaluation, where it acquires the output
+base 8.
+
+@noindent
+The @var{base} may be replaced or followed by an underscore, which may
+itself be followed by a positive integer (if it is missing the value 3
+is used). This indicates that underscores should be inserted into the
+output string, grouping the number for visual clarity. The following
+integer specifies the number of digits to group together. For example:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+setopt cbases
+print $(( [#16_4] 65536 ** 2 ))
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+outputs `@t{0x1_0000_0000}'.
+
+@noindent
+The feature can be used with floating
+point numbers, in which case the base must be omitted; grouping
+is away from the decimal point. For example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zmodload zsh/mathfunc
+print $(( [#_] sqrt(1e7) ))
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+outputs `@t{3_162.277_660_168_379_5}' (the number of decimal places
+shown may vary).
+
+@noindent
+@pindex C_BASES, use of
+@pindex OCTAL_ZEROES, use of
+If the @t{C_BASES} option is set, hexadecimal numbers are output in the standard C
+format, for example `@t{0xFF}' instead of the usual `@t{16#FF}'. If the
+option @t{OCTAL_ZEROES} is also set (it is not by default), octal numbers
+will be treated similarly and hence appear as `@t{077}' instead of
+`@t{8#77}'. This option has no effect on the output of bases other than
+hexadecimal and octal, and these formats are always understood on input.
+
+@noindent
+When an output base is specified using the `@t{[#}@var{base}@t{]}' syntax,
+an appropriate base prefix will be output if necessary, so that the value
+output is valid syntax for input. If the @t{#} is doubled, for example
+`@t{[##16]}', then no base prefix is output.
+
+@noindent
+Floating point constants are recognized by the presence of a decimal point
+or an exponent. The decimal point may be the first character of the
+constant, but the exponent character @t{e} or @t{E} may not, as it will be
+taken for a parameter name. All numeric parts (before and after the
+decimal point and in the exponent) may contain underscores after the
+leading digit for visual guidance; these are ignored in computation.
+
+@noindent
+@cindex arithmetic operators
+@cindex operators, arithmetic
+An arithmetic expression uses nearly the same syntax and
+associativity of expressions as in C.
+
+@noindent
+In the native mode of operation, the following operators are supported
+(listed in decreasing order of precedence):
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{+ - ! ~ ++ --}
+unary plus/minus, logical NOT, complement, @{pre,post@}@{in,de@}crement
+@item @t{<< >>}
+bitwise shift left, right
+@item @t{&}
+bitwise AND
+@item @t{^}
+bitwise XOR
+@item @t{|}
+bitwise OR
+@item @t{**}
+exponentiation
+@item @t{* / %}
+multiplication, division, modulus (remainder)
+@item @t{+ -}
+addition, subtraction
+@item @t{< > <= >=}
+comparison
+@item @t{== !=}
+equality and inequality
+@item @t{&&}
+logical AND
+@item @t{|| ^^}
+logical OR, XOR
+@item @t{? :}
+ternary operator
+@item @t{= += -= *= /= %= &= ^= |= <<= >>= &&= ||= ^^= **=}
+assignment
+@item @t{,}
+comma operator
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+The operators `@t{&&}', `@t{||}', `@t{&&=}', and `@t{||=}' are
+short-circuiting, and only one of the latter two expressions in a ternary
+operator is evaluated. Note the precedence of the bitwise AND, OR,
+and XOR operators.
+
+@noindent
+With the option @t{C_PRECEDENCES} the precedences (but no other
+properties) of the operators are altered to be the same as those in
+most other languages that support the relevant operators:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{+ - ! ~ ++ --}
+unary plus/minus, logical NOT, complement, @{pre,post@}@{in,de@}crement
+@item @t{**}
+exponentiation
+@item @t{* / %}
+multiplication, division, modulus (remainder)
+@item @t{+ -}
+addition, subtraction
+@item @t{<< >>}
+bitwise shift left, right
+@item @t{< > <= >=}
+comparison
+@item @t{== !=}
+equality and inequality
+@item @t{&}
+bitwise AND
+@item @t{^}
+bitwise XOR
+@item @t{|}
+bitwise OR
+@item @t{&&}
+logical AND
+@item @t{^^}
+logical XOR
+@item @t{||}
+logical OR
+@item @t{? :}
+ternary operator
+@item @t{= += -= *= /= %= &= ^= |= <<= >>= &&= ||= ^^= **=}
+assignment
+@item @t{,}
+comma operator
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+Note the precedence of exponentiation in both cases is below
+that of unary operators, hence `@t{-3**2}' evaluates as `@t{9}', not
+`@t{-9}'. Use parentheses where necessary: `@t{-(3**2)}'. This is
+for compatibility with other shells.
+
+@noindent
+@cindex mathematical functions, use of
+@cindex functions, math, use of
+Mathematical functions can be called with the syntax
+`@var{func}@t{(}@var{args}@t{)}', where the function decides
+if the @var{args} is used as a string or a comma-separated list of
+arithmetic expressions. The shell currently defines no mathematical
+functions by default, but the module @t{zsh/mathfunc} may be loaded with
+the @t{zmodload} builtin to provide standard floating point mathematical
+functions.
+
+@noindent
+An expression of the form `@t{##}@var{x}' where @var{x} is any character
+sequence such as `@t{a}', `@t{^A}', or `@t{\M-\C-x}' gives the value of
+this character and an expression of the form `@t{#}@var{name}' gives the
+value of the first character of the contents of the parameter @var{name}.
+Character values are according to the character set used in the current
+locale; for multibyte character handling the option @t{MULTIBYTE} must be
+set. Note that this form is different from `@t{$#}@var{name}', a standard
+parameter substitution which gives the length of the parameter @var{name}.
+`@t{#\}' is accepted instead of `@t{##}', but its use is deprecated.
+
+@noindent
+Named parameters and subscripted arrays can be referenced by name within an
+arithmetic expression without using the parameter expansion syntax. For
+example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+((val2 = val1 * 2))
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+assigns twice the value of @t{$val1} to the parameter named @t{val2}.
+
+@noindent
+An internal integer representation of a named parameter
+can be specified with the @t{integer} builtin.
+@cindex parameters, integer
+@cindex integer parameters
+@findex integer, use of
+Arithmetic evaluation is performed on the value of each
+assignment to a named parameter declared integer
+in this manner. Assigning a floating point number to an integer results in
+rounding towards zero.
+
+@noindent
+@cindex parameters, floating point
+@cindex floating point parameters
+@findex float, use of
+Likewise, floating point numbers can be declared with the @t{float}
+builtin; there are two types, differing only in their output format, as
+described for the @t{typeset} builtin. The output format can be bypassed
+by using arithmetic substitution instead of the parameter substitution,
+i.e. `@t{$@{}@var{float}@t{@}}' uses the defined format, but
+`@t{$((}@var{float}@t{))}' uses a generic floating point
+format.
+
+@noindent
+Promotion of integer to floating point values is performed where
+necessary. In addition, if any operator which requires an integer
+(`@t{&}', `@t{|}', `@t{^}', `@t{<<}', `@t{>>}' and their equivalents with
+assignment) is given a floating point argument, it will be silently rounded
+towards zero except for `@t{~}' which rounds down.
+
+@noindent
+Users should beware that, in common with many other programming
+languages but not software designed for calculation, the evaluation of
+an expression in zsh is taken a term at a time and promotion of integers
+to floating point does not occur in terms only containing integers. A
+typical result of this is that a division such as @t{6/8} is truncated,
+in this being rounded towards 0. The @t{FORCE_FLOAT} shell option can
+be used in scripts or functions where floating point evaluation is
+required throughout.
+
+@noindent
+Scalar variables can hold integer or floating point values at different
+times; there is no memory of the numeric type in this case.
+
+@noindent
+If a variable is first assigned in a numeric context without previously
+being declared, it will be implicitly typed as @t{integer} or @t{float} and
+retain that type either until the type is explicitly changed or until the
+end of the scope. This can have unforeseen consequences. For example, in
+the loop
+
+@noindent
+@example
+for (( f = 0; f < 1; f += 0.1 )); do
+# use $f
+done
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+if @t{f} has not already been declared, the first assignment will cause it
+to be created as an integer, and consequently the operation `@t{f += 0.1}'
+will always cause the result to be truncated to zero, so that the loop will
+fail. A simple fix would be to turn the initialization into `@t{f = 0.0}'.
+It is therefore best to declare numeric variables with explicit types.
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/cond.yo
+@node Conditional Expressions, Prompt Expansion, Arithmetic Evaluation, Top
+
+@chapter Conditional Expressions
+@noindent
+@cindex conditional expressions
+@cindex expressions, conditional
+A @emph{conditional expression} is used with the @t{[[}
+compound command to test attributes of files and to compare strings.
+Each expression can be constructed from one or more
+of the following unary or binary expressions:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{-a} @var{file}
+true if @var{file} exists.
+
+@item @t{-b} @var{file}
+true if @var{file} exists and is a block special file.
+
+@item @t{-c} @var{file}
+true if @var{file} exists and is a character special file.
+
+@item @t{-d} @var{file}
+true if @var{file} exists and is a directory.
+
+@item @t{-e} @var{file}
+true if @var{file} exists.
+
+@item @t{-f} @var{file}
+true if @var{file} exists and is a regular file.
+
+@item @t{-g} @var{file}
+true if @var{file} exists and has its setgid bit set.
+
+@item @t{-h} @var{file}
+true if @var{file} exists and is a symbolic link.
+
+@item @t{-k} @var{file}
+true if @var{file} exists and has its sticky bit set.
+
+@item @t{-n} @var{string}
+true if length of @var{string} is non-zero.
+
+@item @t{-o} @var{option}
+true if option named @var{option} is on. @var{option}
+may be a single character, in which case it is a single letter option name.
+(See @ref{Specifying Options}.)
+
+@noindent
+When no option named @var{option} exists, and the @t{POSIX_BUILTINS} option
+hasn't been set, return 3 with a warning. If that option is set, return 1
+with no warning.
+
+@item @t{-p} @var{file}
+true if @var{file} exists and is a FIFO special file (named pipe).
+
+@item @t{-r} @var{file}
+true if @var{file} exists and is readable by current process.
+
+@item @t{-s} @var{file}
+true if @var{file} exists and has size greater than zero.
+
+@item @t{-t} @var{fd}
+true if file descriptor number @var{fd}
+is open and associated with a terminal device.
+(note: @var{fd} is not optional)
+
+@item @t{-u} @var{file}
+true if @var{file} exists and has its setuid bit set.
+
+@item @t{-v} @var{varname}
+true if shell variable @var{varname} is set.
+
+@item @t{-w} @var{file}
+true if @var{file} exists and is writable by current process.
+
+@item @t{-x} @var{file}
+true if @var{file} exists and is executable by current process.
+If @var{file} exists and is a directory, then the current process
+has permission to search in the directory.
+
+@item @t{-z} @var{string}
+true if length of @var{string} is zero.
+
+@item @t{-L} @var{file}
+true if @var{file} exists and is a symbolic link.
+
+@item @t{-O} @var{file}
+true if @var{file} exists and is owned by the effective user ID of this process.
+
+@item @t{-G} @var{file}
+true if @var{file} exists and its group matches
+the effective group ID of this process.
+
+@item @t{-S} @var{file}
+true if @var{file} exists and is a socket.
+
+@item @t{-N} @var{file}
+true if @var{file} exists and its access time is
+not newer than its modification time.
+
+@item @var{file1} @t{-nt} @var{file2}
+true if @var{file1} exists and is newer than @var{file2}.
+
+@item @var{file1} @t{-ot} @var{file2}
+true if @var{file1} exists and is older than @var{file2}.
+
+@item @var{file1} @t{-ef} @var{file2}
+true if @var{file1} and @var{file2} exist and refer to the same file.
+
+@item @var{string} @t{=} @var{pattern}
+@itemx @var{string} @t{==} @var{pattern}
+true if @var{string} matches @var{pattern}.
+The two forms are exactly equivalent. The `@t{=}' form is
+the traditional shell syntax (and hence the only one generally used
+with the @t{test} and @t{[} builtins); the `@t{==}' form provides
+compatibility with other sorts of computer language.
+
+@item @var{string} @t{!=} @var{pattern}
+true if @var{string} does not match @var{pattern}.
+
+@item @var{string} @t{=~} @var{regexp}
+true if @var{string} matches the regular expression
+@var{regexp}. If the option @t{RE_MATCH_PCRE} is set
+@var{regexp} is tested as a PCRE regular expression using
+the @t{zsh/pcre} module, else it is tested as a POSIX
+extended regular expression using the @t{zsh/regex} module.
+Upon successful match, some variables will be updated; no variables
+are changed if the matching fails.
+
+@noindent
+If the option @t{BASH_REMATCH} is not set the scalar parameter
+@t{MATCH} is set to the substring that matched the pattern and
+the integer parameters @t{MBEGIN} and @t{MEND} to the index of the start
+and end, respectively, of the match in @var{string}, such that if
+@var{string} is contained in variable @t{var} the expression
+`@t{$@{var[$MBEGIN,$MEND]@}}' is identical to `@t{$MATCH}'. The setting
+of the option @t{KSH_ARRAYS} is respected. Likewise, the array
+@t{match} is set to the substrings that matched parenthesised
+subexpressions and the arrays @t{mbegin} and @t{mend} to the indices of
+the start and end positions, respectively, of the substrings within
+@var{string}. The arrays are not set if there were no parenthesised
+subexpressions. For example, if the string `@t{a short string}' is matched
+against the regular expression `@t{s(...)t}', then (assuming the
+option @t{KSH_ARRAYS} is not set) @t{MATCH}, @t{MBEGIN}
+and @t{MEND} are `@t{short}', @t{3} and @t{7}, respectively, while @t{match},
+@t{mbegin} and @t{mend} are single entry arrays containing
+the strings `@t{hor}', `@t{4}' and `@t{6}', respectively.
+
+@noindent
+If the option @t{BASH_REMATCH} is set the array
+@t{BASH_REMATCH} is set to the substring that matched the pattern
+followed by the substrings that matched parenthesised
+subexpressions within the pattern.
+
+@item @var{string1} @t{<} @var{string2}
+true if @var{string1} comes before @var{string2}
+based on ASCII value of their characters.
+
+@item @var{string1} @t{>} @var{string2}
+true if @var{string1} comes after @var{string2}
+based on ASCII value of their characters.
+
+@item @var{exp1} @t{-eq} @var{exp2}
+true if @var{exp1} is numerically equal to @var{exp2}.
+Note that for purely numeric comparisons use of the
+@t{((}@var{...}@t{))} builtin described in
+@ref{Arithmetic Evaluation} is more convenient than
+conditional expressions.
+
+@item @var{exp1} @t{-ne} @var{exp2}
+true if @var{exp1} is numerically not equal to @var{exp2}.
+
+@item @var{exp1} @t{-lt} @var{exp2}
+true if @var{exp1} is numerically less than @var{exp2}.
+
+@item @var{exp1} @t{-gt} @var{exp2}
+true if @var{exp1} is numerically greater than @var{exp2}.
+
+@item @var{exp1} @t{-le} @var{exp2}
+true if @var{exp1} is numerically less than or equal to @var{exp2}.
+
+@item @var{exp1} @t{-ge} @var{exp2}
+true if @var{exp1} is numerically greater than or equal to @var{exp2}.
+
+@item @t{(} @var{exp} @t{)}
+true if @var{exp} is true.
+
+@item @t{!} @var{exp}
+true if @var{exp} is false.
+
+@item @var{exp1} @t{&&} @var{exp2}
+true if @var{exp1} and @var{exp2} are both true.
+
+@item @var{exp1} @t{||} @var{exp2}
+true if either @var{exp1} or @var{exp2} is true.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+For compatibility, if there is a single argument that is not
+syntactically significant, typically a variable, the condition is
+treated as a test for whether the expression expands as a string of
+non-zero length. In other words, @t{[[ $var ]]} is the same as @t{[[ -n
+$var ]]}. It is recommended that the second, explicit, form be used
+where possible.
+
+@noindent
+Normal shell expansion is performed on the @var{file}, @var{string} and
+@var{pattern} arguments, but the result of each expansion is constrained to
+be a single word, similar to the effect of double quotes.
+
+@noindent
+Filename generation is not performed on any form of argument to
+conditions. However, it can be forced in any case where normal shell
+expansion is valid and when the option @t{EXTENDED_GLOB} is in effect by
+using an explicit glob qualifier of the form @t{(#q)} at the
+end of the string. A normal glob qualifier expression may appear
+between the `@t{q}' and the closing parenthesis; if none appears the
+expression has no effect beyond causing filename generation. The
+results of filename generation are joined together to form a single
+word, as with the results of other forms of expansion.
+
+@noindent
+This special use of filename generation is only available with the
+@t{[[} syntax. If the condition occurs within the @t{[} or @t{test}
+builtin commands then globbing occurs instead as part of normal command
+line expansion before the condition is evaluated. In this case it may
+generate multiple words which are likely to confuse the syntax of the
+test command.
+
+@noindent
+For example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+[[ -n file*(#qN) ]]
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+produces status zero if and only if there is at least one file in the
+current directory beginning with the string `@t{file}'. The globbing
+qualifier @t{N} ensures that the expression is empty if there is
+no matching file.
+
+@noindent
+Pattern metacharacters are active for the @var{pattern} arguments;
+the patterns are the same as those used for filename generation, see
+@ref{Filename Generation}, but there is no special behaviour
+of `@t{/}' nor initial dots, and no glob qualifiers are allowed.
+
+@noindent
+In each of the above expressions, if
+@var{file} is of the form `@t{/dev/fd/}@var{n}',
+where @var{n} is an integer,
+then the test applied to the open file whose
+descriptor number is @var{n},
+even if the underlying system does not support
+the @t{/dev/fd} directory.
+
+@noindent
+In the forms which do numeric comparison, the expressions @var{exp}
+undergo arithmetic expansion as if they were enclosed in
+@t{$((}@var{...}@t{))}.
+
+@noindent
+For example, the following:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+[[ ( -f foo || -f bar ) && $report = y* ]] && print File exists.
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+tests if either file @t{foo} or file @t{bar} exists, and if so, if the
+value of the parameter @t{report} begins with `@t{y}'; if the complete
+condition is true, the message `@t{File exists.}' is printed.
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/prompt.yo
+@node Prompt Expansion, Expansion, Conditional Expressions, Top
+
+@chapter Prompt Expansion
+@noindent
+
+@section Expansion of Prompt Sequences
+@noindent
+@cindex prompt expansion
+@cindex expansion, prompt
+Prompt sequences undergo a special form of expansion. This type of expansion
+is also available using the @t{-P} option to the @t{print} builtin.
+
+@noindent
+@pindex PROMPT_SUBST, use of
+If the @t{PROMPT_SUBST} option is set, the prompt string is first subjected to
+@emph{parameter expansion},
+@emph{command substitution} and
+@emph{arithmetic expansion}.
+See
+@ref{Expansion}.
+
+@noindent
+Certain escape sequences may be recognised in the prompt string.
+
+@noindent
+@pindex PROMPT_BANG, use of
+If the @t{PROMPT_BANG} option is set, a `@t{!}' in the prompt is replaced
+by the current history event number. A literal `@t{!}' may then be
+represented as `@t{!!}'.
+
+@noindent
+@pindex PROMPT_PERCENT, use of
+If the @t{PROMPT_PERCENT} option is set, certain escape sequences that
+start with `@t{%}' are expanded.
+Many escapes are followed by a single character, although some of these
+take an optional integer argument that
+should appear between the `@t{%}' and the next character of the
+sequence. More complicated escape sequences are available to provide
+conditional expansion.
+
+@noindent
+
+@section Simple Prompt Escapes
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Special characters
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{%%}
+A `@t{%}'.
+
+@item @t{%)}
+A `@t{)}'.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Login information
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{%l}
+The line (tty) the user is logged in on, without `@t{/dev/}' prefix.
+If the name starts with `@t{/dev/tty}', that prefix is stripped.
+
+@item @t{%M}
+The full machine hostname.
+
+@item @t{%m}
+The hostname up to the first `@t{.}'.
+An integer may follow the `@t{%}' to specify
+how many components of the hostname are desired. With a negative integer,
+trailing components of the hostname are shown.
+
+@item @t{%n}
+@t{$USERNAME}.
+
+@item @t{%y}
+The line (tty) the user is logged in on, without `@t{/dev/}' prefix.
+This does not treat `@t{/dev/tty}' names specially.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Shell state
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{%#}
+A `@t{#}' if the shell is running with privileges, a `@t{%}' if not.
+Equivalent to `@t{%(!.#.%%)}'.
+The definition of `privileged', for these purposes, is that either the
+effective user ID is zero, or, if POSIX.1e capabilities are supported, that
+at least one capability is raised in either the Effective or Inheritable
+capability vectors.
+
+@item @t{%?}
+The return status of the last command executed just before the prompt.
+
+@item @t{%_}
+The status of the parser, i.e. the shell constructs (like `@t{if}' and
+`@t{for}') that have been started on the command line. If given an integer
+number that many strings will be printed; zero or negative or no integer means
+print as many as there are. This is most useful in prompts @t{PS2} for
+continuation lines and @t{PS4} for debugging with the @t{XTRACE} option; in
+the latter case it will also work non-interactively.
+
+@item @t{%^}
+The status of the parser in reverse. This is the same as `@t{%_}' other than
+the order of strings. It is often used in @t{RPS2}.
+
+@item @t{%d}
+@itemx @t{%/}
+Current working directory. If an integer follows the `@t{%}',
+it specifies a number of trailing components of the current working
+directory to show; zero means the whole path. A negative integer
+specifies leading components, i.e. @t{%-1d} specifies the first component.
+
+@item @t{%~}
+As @t{%d} and @t{%/}, but if the current working directory starts with
+@t{$HOME}, that part is replaced by a `@t{~}'. Furthermore, if it has a named
+directory as its prefix, that part is replaced by a `@t{~}' followed by
+the name of the directory, but only if the result is shorter than
+the full path;
+@ref{Filename Expansion}.
+
+@item @t{%e}
+Evaluation depth of the current sourced file, shell function, or @t{eval}.
+This is incremented or decremented every time the value of @t{%N} is
+set or reverted to a previous value, respectively. This is most useful
+for debugging as part of @t{$PS4}.
+
+@item @t{%h}
+@itemx @t{%!}
+Current history event number.
+
+@item @t{%i}
+The line number currently being executed in the script, sourced file, or
+shell function given by @t{%N}. This is most useful for debugging as part
+of @t{$PS4}.
+
+@item @t{%I}
+The line number currently being executed in the file @t{%x}. This is
+similar to @t{%i}, but the line number is always a line number in the
+file where the code was defined, even if the code is a shell function.
+
+@item @t{%j}
+The number of jobs.
+
+@item @t{%L}
+The current value of @t{$SHLVL}.
+
+@item @t{%N}
+The name of the script, sourced file, or shell function that zsh is
+currently executing, whichever was started most recently. If there is
+none, this is equivalent to the parameter @t{$0}. An integer may follow
+the `@t{%}' to specify a number of trailing path components to show; zero
+means the full path. A negative integer specifies leading components.
+
+@item @t{%x}
+The name of the file containing the source code currently being
+executed. This behaves as @t{%N} except that function and eval command
+names are not shown, instead the file where they were defined.
+
+@item @t{%c}
+@itemx @t{%.}
+@itemx @t{%C}
+Trailing component of the current working directory.
+An integer may follow the `@t{%}' to get more than one component.
+Unless `@t{%C}' is used, tilde contraction is performed first. These are
+deprecated as @t{%c} and @t{%C} are equivalent to @t{%1~} and @t{%1/},
+respectively, while explicit positive integers have the same effect as for
+the latter two sequences.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Date and time
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{%D}
+The date in @var{yy}@t{-}@var{mm}@t{-}@var{dd} format.
+
+@item @t{%T}
+Current time of day, in 24-hour format.
+
+@item @t{%t}
+@itemx @t{%@@}
+Current time of day, in 12-hour, am/pm format.
+
+@item @t{%*}
+Current time of day in 24-hour format, with seconds.
+
+@item @t{%w}
+The date in @var{day}@t{-}@var{dd} format.
+
+@item @t{%W}
+The date in @var{mm}@t{/}@var{dd}@t{/}@var{yy} format.
+
+@item @t{%D@{}@var{string}@t{@}}
+@var{string} is formatted using the @t{strftime} function.
+See man page strftime(3) for more details. Various zsh
+extensions provide numbers with no leading zero or space
+if the number is a single digit:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{%f}
+a day of the month
+@item @t{%K}
+the hour of the day on the 24-hour clock
+@item @t{%L}
+the hour of the day on the 12-hour clock
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+In addition, if the system supports the POSIX @t{gettimeofday} system
+call, @t{%.} provides decimal fractions of a second since the epoch with
+leading zeroes. By default three decimal places are provided, but a
+number of digits up to 9 may be given following the @t{%}; hence @t{%6.}
+outputs microseconds, and @t{%9.} outputs nanoseconds. (The latter
+requires a nanosecond-precision @t{clock_gettime}; systems lacking this
+will return a value multiplied by the appropriate power of 10.) A typical
+example of this is the format `@t{%D@{%H:%M:%S.%.@}}'.
+
+@noindent
+The GNU extension @t{%N} is handled as a synonym for @t{%9.}.
+
+@noindent
+Additionally, the GNU extension that a `@t{-}' between the @t{%} and the
+format character causes a leading zero or space to be stripped
+is handled directly by the shell for the format characters @t{d}, @t{f},
+@t{H}, @t{k}, @t{l}, @t{m}, @t{M}, @t{S} and @t{y}; any other format
+characters are provided to the system's strftime(3)
+with any leading `@t{-}' present, so the handling is system dependent.
+Further GNU (or other) extensions are also passed to strftime(3)
+and may work if the system supports them.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Visual effects
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{%B} (@t{%b})
+Start (stop) boldface mode.
+
+@item @t{%E}
+Clear to end of line.
+
+@item @t{%U} (@t{%u})
+Start (stop) underline mode.
+
+@item @t{%S} (@t{%s})
+Start (stop) standout mode.
+
+@item @t{%F} (@t{%f})
+Start (stop) using a different foreground colour, if supported
+by the terminal. The colour may be specified two ways: either
+as a numeric argument, as normal, or by a sequence in braces
+following the @t{%F}, for example @t{%F@{red@}}. In the latter case
+the values allowed are as described for the @t{fg} @t{zle_highlight}
+attribute;
+@ref{Character Highlighting}. This means that numeric
+colours are allowed in the second format also.
+
+@item @t{%K} (@t{%k})
+Start (stop) using a different bacKground colour. The syntax is
+identical to that for @t{%F} and @t{%f}.
+
+@item @t{%@{}...@t{%@}}
+Include a string as a literal escape sequence.
+The string within the braces should not change the cursor
+position. Brace pairs can nest.
+
+@noindent
+A positive numeric argument between the @t{%} and the @t{@{} is treated as
+described for @t{%G} below.
+
+@item @t{%G}
+Within a @t{%@{}...@t{%@}} sequence, include a `glitch': that is, assume
+that a single character width will be output. This is useful when
+outputting characters that otherwise cannot be correctly handled by the
+shell, such as the alternate character set on some terminals.
+The characters in question can be included within a @t{%@{}...@t{%@}}
+sequence together with the appropriate number of @t{%G} sequences to
+indicate the correct width. An integer between the `@t{%}' and `@t{G}'
+indicates a character width other than one. Hence @t{%@{}@var{seq}@t{%2G%@}}
+outputs @var{seq} and assumes it takes up the width of two standard
+characters.
+
+@noindent
+Multiple uses of @t{%G} accumulate in the obvious fashion; the position
+of the @t{%G} is unimportant. Negative integers are not handled.
+
+@noindent
+Note that when prompt truncation is in use it is advisable to divide up
+output into single characters within each @t{%@{}...@t{%@}} group so that
+the correct truncation point can be found.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@section Conditional Substrings in Prompts
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{%v}
+@vindex psvar, use of
+The value of the first element of the @t{psvar} array parameter. Following
+the `@t{%}' with an integer gives that element of the array. Negative
+integers count from the end of the array.
+
+@item @t{%(}@var{x}@t{.}@var{true-text}@t{.}@var{false-text}@t{)}
+Specifies a ternary expression. The character following the @var{x} is
+arbitrary; the same character is used to separate the text for the
+`true' result from that for the `false' result.
+This separator may not appear in the @var{true-text}, except as part of a
+%-escape
+sequence. A `@t{)}' may appear in the @var{false-text} as `@t{%)}'.
+@var{true-text}
+and @var{false-text} may both contain arbitrarily-nested escape
+sequences, including further ternary expressions.
+
+@noindent
+The left parenthesis may be preceded or followed by a positive integer @var{n},
+which defaults to zero. A negative integer will be multiplied by -1, except
+as noted below for `@t{l}'.
+The test character @var{x} may be any of the following:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{!}
+True if the shell is running with privileges.
+@item @t{#}
+True if the effective uid of the current process is @var{n}.
+@item @t{?}
+True if the exit status of the last command was @var{n}.
+@item @t{_}
+True if at least @var{n} shell constructs were started.
+@item @t{C}
+@itemx @t{/}
+True if the current absolute path has at least @var{n} elements
+relative to the root directory, hence @t{/} is counted as 0 elements.
+@item @t{c}
+@itemx @t{.}
+@itemx @t{~}
+True if the current path, with prefix replacement, has at
+least @var{n} elements relative to the root directory, hence @t{/} is
+counted as 0 elements.
+@item @t{D}
+True if the month is equal to @var{n} (January = 0).
+@item @t{d}
+True if the day of the month is equal to @var{n}.
+@item @t{e}
+True if the evaluation depth is at least @var{n}.
+@item @t{g}
+True if the effective gid of the current process is @var{n}.
+@item @t{j}
+True if the number of jobs is at least @var{n}.
+@item @t{L}
+True if the @t{SHLVL} parameter is at least @var{n}.
+@item @t{l}
+True if at least @var{n} characters have already been
+printed on the current line. When @var{n} is negative, true if at least
+@t{abs}@t{(}@var{n}@t{)} characters remain before the opposite
+margin (thus the left margin for @t{RPROMPT}).
+@item @t{S}
+True if the @t{SECONDS} parameter is at least @var{n}.
+@item @t{T}
+True if the time in hours is equal to @var{n}.
+@item @t{t}
+True if the time in minutes is equal to @var{n}.
+@item @t{v}
+True if the array @t{psvar} has at least @var{n} elements.
+@item @t{V}
+True if element @var{n} of the array @t{psvar} is set and
+non-empty.
+@item @t{w}
+True if the day of the week is equal to @var{n} (Sunday = 0).
+@end table
+
+@item @t{%<}@var{string}@t{<}
+@itemx @t{%>}@var{string}@t{>}
+@itemx @t{%[}@var{xstring}@t{]}
+Specifies truncation behaviour for the remainder of the prompt string.
+The third, deprecated, form is equivalent to `@t{%}@var{xstringx}',
+i.e. @var{x} may be `@t{<}' or `@t{>}'.
+The @var{string} will be displayed in
+place of the truncated portion of any string; note this does not
+undergo prompt expansion.
+
+@noindent
+The numeric argument, which in the third form may appear immediately
+after the `@t{[}', specifies the maximum permitted length of
+the various strings that can be displayed in the prompt.
+In the first two forms, this numeric argument may be negative, in which
+case the truncation length is determined by subtracting the absolute
+value of the numeric argument from the number of character positions
+remaining on the current prompt line. If this results in a zero or
+negative length, a length of 1 is used. In other words, a negative
+argument arranges that after truncation at least @var{n} characters
+remain before the right margin (left margin for @t{RPROMPT}).
+
+@noindent
+The forms with `@t{<}' truncate at the left of the string,
+and the forms with `@t{>}' truncate at the right of the string.
+For example, if the current directory is `@t{/home/pike}',
+the prompt `@t{%8<..<%/}' will expand to `@t{..e/pike}'.
+In this string, the terminating character (`@t{<}', `@t{>}' or `@t{]}'),
+or in fact any character, may be quoted by a preceding `@t{\}'; note
+when using @t{print -P}, however, that this must be doubled as the
+string is also subject to standard @t{print} processing, in addition
+to any backslashes removed by a double quoted string: the worst case
+is therefore `@t{print -P "%<\\\\<<..."}'.
+
+@noindent
+If the @var{string} is longer than the specified truncation length,
+it will appear in full, completely replacing the truncated string.
+
+@noindent
+The part of the prompt string to be truncated runs to the end of the
+string, or to the end of the next enclosing group of the `@t{%(}'
+construct, or to the next truncation encountered at the same grouping
+level (i.e. truncations inside a `@t{%(}' are separate), which
+ever comes first. In particular, a truncation with argument zero
+(e.g., `@t{%<<}') marks the end of the range of the string to be
+truncated while turning off truncation from there on. For example, the
+prompt `@t{%10<...<%~%<<%# }' will print a truncated representation of the
+current directory, followed by a `@t{%}' or `@t{#}', followed by a
+space. Without the `@t{%<<}', those two characters would be included
+in the string to be truncated. Note that `@t{%-0<<}' is not equivalent
+to `@t{%<<}' but specifies that the prompt is truncated at the right margin.
+
+@noindent
+Truncation applies only within each individual line of the prompt, as
+delimited by embedded newlines (if any). If the total length of any line
+of the prompt after truncation is greater than the terminal width, or if
+the part to be truncated contains embedded newlines, truncation behavior
+is undefined and may change in a future version of the shell. Use
+`@t{%-}@var{n}@t{(l.}@var{true-text}@t{.}@var{false-text}@t{)}' to remove parts
+of the prompt when the available space is less than @var{n}.
+
+@end table
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/expn.yo
+@node Expansion, Parameters, Prompt Expansion, Top
+
+@chapter Expansion
+@noindent
+
+@cindex expansion
+The following types of expansions are performed in the indicated order in
+five steps:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @emph{History Expansion}
+This is performed only in interactive shells.
+
+@item @emph{Alias Expansion}
+Aliases are expanded immediately before the command line is parsed as
+explained
+in @ref{Aliasing}.
+
+@item @emph{Process Substitution}
+@itemx @emph{Parameter Expansion}
+@itemx @emph{Command Substitution}
+@itemx @emph{Arithmetic Expansion}
+@itemx @emph{Brace Expansion}
+These five are performed in left-to-right fashion. On each argument,
+any of the five steps that are needed are performed one after the other.
+Hence, for example, all the parts of parameter expansion are completed
+before command substitution is started. After these expansions, all
+unquoted occurrences of the characters `@t{\}',`@t{'}' and `@t{"}' are
+removed.
+
+@item @emph{Filename Expansion}
+If the @t{SH_FILE_EXPANSION} option is set, the order of expansion is
+modified for compatibility with @cite{sh} and @cite{ksh}. In that case
+@emph{filename expansion} is performed immediately after @emph{alias expansion},
+preceding the set of five expansions mentioned above.
+
+@cindex globbing
+@item @emph{Filename Generation}
+This expansion, commonly referred to as @cite{globbing}, is always done last.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+The following sections explain the types of expansion in detail.
+
+@noindent
+@menu
+* History Expansion::
+* Process Substitution::
+* Parameter Expansion::
+* Command Substitution::
+* Arithmetic Expansion::
+* Brace Expansion::
+* Filename Expansion::
+* Filename Generation::
+@end menu
+@node History Expansion, Process Substitution, , Expansion
+
+@section History Expansion
+@noindent
+@cindex history
+@cindex history expansion
+@cindex expansion, history
+History expansion allows you to use words from previous command
+lines in the command line you are typing. This simplifies spelling
+corrections and the repetition of complicated commands or arguments.
+
+@noindent
+@vindex HISTSIZE, use of
+Immediately before execution, each command is saved in the history list,
+the size of which is controlled by the @t{HISTSIZE} parameter. The one
+most recent command is always retained in any case. Each saved command in
+the history list is called a history @emph{event} and is assigned a number,
+beginning with 1 (one) when the shell starts up. The history number that
+you may see in your prompt (see
+@ref{Prompt Expansion}) is the number that is to be assigned to the @emph{next} command.
+
+@noindent
+@menu
+* Overview::
+* Event Designators::
+* Word Designators::
+* Modifiers::
+@end menu
+@node Overview, Event Designators, , History Expansion
+
+@subsection Overview
+@noindent
+@vindex histchars, use of
+A history expansion begins with the first character of the @t{histchars}
+parameter, which is `@t{!}' by default, and may occur anywhere on the
+command line, including inside double quotes (but not inside single quotes
+@t{'...'} or C-style quotes @t{$'...'} nor when escaped with a backslash).
+
+@noindent
+The first character is followed by an optional event designator
+(@ref{Event Designators}) and then an optional word
+designator (@ref{Word Designators}); if neither of these designators is
+present, no history expansion occurs.
+
+@noindent
+Input lines containing history expansions are echoed after being expanded,
+but before any other expansions take place and before the command is
+executed. It is this expanded form that is recorded as the history event
+for later references.
+
+@noindent
+History expansions do not nest.
+
+@noindent
+By default, a history reference with no event designator refers to the
+same event as any preceding history reference on that command line; if it
+is the only history reference in a command, it refers to the previous
+command.
+@pindex CSH_JUNKIE_HISTORY, use of
+However, if the option @t{CSH_JUNKIE_HISTORY} is set, then every history
+reference with no event specification @emph{always} refers to the previous
+command.
+
+@noindent
+For example, `@t{!}' is the event designator for the previous command, so
+`@t{!!:1}' always refers to the first word of the previous command, and
+`@t{!!$}' always refers to the last word of the previous command. With
+@t{CSH_JUNKIE_HISTORY} set, then `@t{!:1}' and `@t{!$}' function in the
+same manner as `@t{!!:1}' and `@t{!!$}', respectively. Conversely, if
+@t{CSH_JUNKIE_HISTORY} is unset, then `@t{!:1}' and `@t{!$}' refer to the
+first and last words, respectively, of the same event referenced by the
+nearest other history reference preceding them on the current command
+line, or to the previous command if there is no preceding reference.
+
+@noindent
+The character sequence `@t{^}@var{foo}@t{^}@var{bar}' (where `@t{^}' is
+actually the second character of the @t{histchars} parameter)
+repeats the last command, replacing the string @var{foo} with @var{bar}.
+More precisely, the sequence `@t{^}@var{foo}@t{^}@var{bar}@t{^}' is
+synonymous with `@t{!!:s}@t{^}@var{foo}@t{^}@var{bar}@t{^}', hence other
+modifiers (see @ref{Modifiers}) may follow the final `@t{^}'.
+In particular, `@t{^}@var{foo}@t{^}@var{bar}@t{^:G}' performs a global
+substitution.
+
+@noindent
+If the shell encounters the character sequence `@t{!"}'
+in the input, the history mechanism is temporarily disabled until
+the current list (see
+@ref{Shell Grammar}) is fully parsed. The `@t{!"}' is removed from the input, and any
+subsequent `@t{!}' characters have no special significance.
+
+@noindent
+@findex fc, use of
+A less convenient but more comprehensible form of command history support
+is provided by the @t{fc} builtin.
+@node Event Designators, Word Designators, Overview, History Expansion
+
+@subsection Event Designators
+@noindent
+@cindex history event designators
+@cindex event designators, history
+An event designator is a reference to a command-line entry in the history
+list. In the list below, remember that the initial @t{`!'} in each item
+may be changed to another character by setting the @t{histchars}
+parameter.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{!}
+Start a history expansion, except when followed by a blank, newline,
+`@t{=}' or `@t{(}'. If followed immediately by a word designator
+(@ref{Word Designators}), this forms a history reference
+with no event designator (@ref{Overview}).
+
+@item @t{!!}
+Refer to the previous command.
+By itself, this expansion
+repeats the previous command.
+
+@item @t{!}@var{n}
+Refer to command-line @var{n}.
+
+@item @t{!-}@var{n}
+Refer to the current command-line minus @var{n}.
+
+@item @t{!}@var{str}
+Refer to the most recent command starting with @var{str}.
+
+@item @t{!?}@var{str}[@t{?}]
+Refer to the most recent command containing @var{str}. The trailing
+`@t{?}' is necessary if this reference is to be followed by a modifier or
+followed by any text that is not to be considered part of @var{str}.
+
+@item @t{!#}
+Refer to the current command line typed in so far. The line is
+treated as if it were complete up to and including the word before the
+one with the `@t{!#}' reference.
+
+@item @t{!@{}...@t{@}}
+Insulate a history reference from adjacent characters (if necessary).
+
+@end table
+@node Word Designators, Modifiers, Event Designators, History Expansion
+
+@subsection Word Designators
+@noindent
+@cindex history word designators
+@cindex word designators, history
+A word designator indicates which word or words of a given command line are
+to be included in a history reference. A `@t{:}' usually
+separates the event specification from the word designator.
+It may be omitted only if the word designator begins with a
+`@t{^}', `@t{$}', `@t{*}', `@t{-}' or `@t{%}'.
+Word designators include:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{0}
+The first input word (command).
+@item @var{n}
+The @var{n}th argument.
+@item @t{^}
+The first argument. That is, @t{1}.
+@item @t{$}
+The last argument.
+@item @t{%}
+The word matched by (the most recent) @t{?}@var{str} search.
+@item @var{x}@t{-}@var{y}
+A range of words; @var{x} defaults to @t{0}.
+@item @t{*}
+All the arguments, or a null value if there are none.
+@item @var{x}@t{*}
+Abbreviates `@var{x}@t{-$}'.
+@item @var{x}@t{-}
+Like `@var{x}@t{*}' but omitting word @t{$}.
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+Note that a `@t{%}' word designator works only when used in one of
+`@t{!%}', `@t{!:%}' or `@t{!?}@var{str}@t{?:%}', and only when used after a
+@t{!?} expansion (possibly in an earlier command). Anything else results
+in an error, although the error may not be the most obvious one.
+@node Modifiers, , Word Designators, History Expansion
+
+@subsection Modifiers
+@noindent
+@cindex modifiers
+@cindex colon modifiers
+@cindex history modifiers
+@cindex globbing modifiers
+@cindex parameter modifiers
+After the optional word designator, you can add
+a sequence of one or more of the following modifiers,
+each preceded by a `@t{:}'. These modifiers also work on the result
+of @emph{filename generation} and @emph{parameter expansion}, except where
+noted.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{a}
+Turn a file name into an absolute path: prepends the current directory,
+if necessary; remove `@t{.}' path segments; and remove `@t{..}' path segments
+and the segments that immediately precede them.
+
+@noindent
+This transformation is agnostic about what is in the filesystem, i.e. is
+on the logical, not the physical directory. It takes place in the same
+manner as when changing directories when neither of the options
+@t{CHASE_DOTS} or @t{CHASE_LINKS} is set. For example,
+`@t{/before/here/../after}' is always transformed to
+`@t{/before/after}', regardless of whether `@t{/before/here}' exists or what
+kind of object (dir, file, symlink, etc.) it is.
+
+@item @t{A}
+Turn a file name into an absolute path as the `@t{a}' modifier does, and
+@emph{then} pass the result through the @t{realpath(3)} library
+function to resolve symbolic links.
+
+@noindent
+Note: on systems that do not have a @t{realpath(3)} library
+function, symbolic links are not resolved, so on those systems `@t{a}' and
+`@t{A}' are equivalent.
+
+@noindent
+Note: @t{foo:A} and @t{realpath(foo)} are different on some inputs.
+For @t{realpath(foo)} semantics, see the `@t{P}` modifier.
+
+@item @t{c}
+Resolve a command name into an absolute path by searching the command
+path given by the @t{PATH} variable. This does not work for commands
+containing directory parts. Note also that this does not usually work as
+a glob qualifier unless a file of the same name is found in the
+current directory.
+
+@item @t{e}
+Remove all but the part of the filename extension following the `@t{.}';
+see the definition of the filename extension in the description of the
+@t{r} modifier below. Note that according to that definition the result
+will be empty if the string ends with a `@t{.}'.
+
+@item @t{h} [ @var{digits} ]
+Remove a trailing pathname component, shortening the path by one
+directory level: this is the `head' of the pathname. This works like
+`@t{dirname}'. If the @t{h} is followed immediately (with no spaces or
+other separator) by any number of decimal digits, and the value of the
+resulting number is non-zero, that number of leading components is
+preserved instead of the final component being removed. In an
+absolute path the leading `@t{/}' is the first component, so,
+for example, if @t{var=/my/path/to/something}, then @t{$@{var:h3@}}
+substitutes @t{/my/path}. Consecutive `/'s are treated the same as
+a single `/'. In parameter substitution, digits may only be
+used if the expression is in braces, so for example the short form
+substitution @t{$var:h2} is treated as @t{$@{var:h@}2}, not as
+@t{$@{var:h2@}}. No restriction applies to the use of digits in history
+substitution or globbing qualifiers. If more components are requested
+than are present, the entire path is substituted (so this does not
+trigger a `failed modifier' error in history expansion).
+
+@item @t{l}
+Convert the words to all lowercase.
+
+@item @t{p}
+Print the new command but do not execute it. Only works with history
+expansion.
+
+@item @t{P}
+Turn a file name into an absolute path, like @t{realpath(3)}.
+The resulting path will be absolute, have neither `@t{.}' nor `@t{..}' components,
+and refer to the same directory entry as the input filename.
+
+@noindent
+Unlike @t{realpath(3)}, non-existent trailing components are
+permitted and preserved.
+
+@item @t{q}
+Quote the substituted words, escaping further substitutions. Works
+with history expansion and parameter expansion, though for parameters
+it is only useful if the resulting text is to be re-evaluated such as
+by @t{eval}.
+
+@item @t{Q}
+Remove one level of quotes from the substituted words.
+
+@item @t{r}
+Remove a filename extension leaving the root name. Strings with no
+filename extension are not altered. A filename
+extension is a `@t{.}' followed by any number of characters (including
+zero) that are neither `@t{.}' nor `@t{/}' and that continue to the end
+of the string. For example, the extension of
+`@t{foo.orig.c}' is `@t{.c}', and `@t{dir.c/foo}' has no extension.
+
+@item @t{s/}@var{l}@t{/}@var{r}[@t{/}]
+Substitute @var{r} for @var{l} as described below.
+The substitution is done only for the
+first string that matches @var{l}. For arrays and for filename
+generation, this applies to each word of the expanded text. See
+below for further notes on substitutions.
+
+@noindent
+The forms `@t{gs/}@var{l}@t{/}@var{r}' and `@t{s/}@var{l}@t{/}@var{r}@t{/:G}'
+perform global substitution, i.e. substitute every occurrence of @var{r}
+for @var{l}. Note that the @t{g} or @t{:G} must appear in exactly the
+position shown.
+
+@noindent
+See further notes on this form of substitution below.
+
+@item @t{&}
+Repeat the previous @t{s} substitution. Like @t{s}, may be preceded
+immediately by a @t{g}. In parameter expansion the @t{&} must appear
+inside braces, and in filename generation it must be quoted with a
+backslash.
+
+@item @t{t} [ @var{digits} ]
+Remove all leading pathname components, leaving the final component (tail).
+This works like `@t{basename}'. Any trailing slashes are first removed.
+Decimal digits are handled as described above for (h), but in this
+case that number of trailing components is preserved instead of
+the default 1; 0 is treated the same as 1.
+
+@item @t{u}
+Convert the words to all uppercase.
+
+@item @t{x}
+Like @t{q}, but break into words at whitespace. Does not work with
+parameter expansion.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+The @t{s/}@var{l}@t{/}@var{r}@t{/} substitution works as follows. By
+default the left-hand side of substitutions are not patterns, but
+character strings. Any character can be used as the delimiter in place
+of `@t{/}'. A backslash quotes the delimiter character. The character
+`@t{&}', in the right-hand-side @var{r}, is replaced by the text from the
+left-hand-side @var{l}. The `@t{&}' can be quoted with a backslash. A
+null @var{l} uses the previous string either from the previous @var{l} or
+from the contextual scan string @var{s} from `@t{!?}@var{s}'. You can
+omit the rightmost delimiter if a newline immediately follows @var{r};
+the rightmost `@t{?}' in a context scan can similarly be omitted. Note
+the same record of the last @var{l} and @var{r} is maintained across all
+forms of expansion.
+
+@noindent
+Note that if a `@t{&}' is used within glob qualifiers an extra backslash
+is needed as a @t{&} is a special character in this case.
+
+@noindent
+Also note that the order of expansions affects the interpretation of
+@var{l} and @var{r}. When used in a history expansion, which occurs before
+any other expansions, @var{l} and @var{r} are treated as literal strings
+(except as explained for @t{HIST_SUBST_PATTERN} below). When used in
+parameter expansion, the replacement of @var{r} into the parameter's value
+is done first, and then any additional process, parameter, command,
+arithmetic, or brace references are applied, which may evaluate those
+substitutions and expansions more than once if @var{l} appears more than
+once in the starting value. When used in a glob qualifier, any
+substitutions or expansions are performed once at the time the qualifier
+is parsed, even before the `@t{:s}' expression itself is divided into
+@var{l} and @var{r} sides.
+
+@noindent
+If the option @t{HIST_SUBST_PATTERN} is set, @var{l} is treated as
+a pattern of the usual form described in
+@ref{Filename Generation}. This can be used in
+all the places where modifiers are available; note, however, that
+in globbing qualifiers parameter substitution has already taken place,
+so parameters in the replacement string should be quoted to ensure
+they are replaced at the correct time.
+Note also that complicated patterns used in globbing qualifiers may
+need the extended glob qualifier notation
+@t{(#q:s/}@var{...}@t{/}@var{...}@t{/)} in order for the
+shell to recognize the expression as a glob qualifier. Further,
+note that bad patterns in the substitution are not subject to
+the @t{NO_BAD_PATTERN} option so will cause an error.
+
+@noindent
+When @t{HIST_SUBST_PATTERN} is set, @var{l} may start with a @t{#}
+to indicate that the pattern must match at the start of the string
+to be substituted, and a @t{%} may appear at the start or after an @t{#}
+to indicate that the pattern must match at the end of the string
+to be substituted. The @t{%} or @t{#} may be quoted with two
+backslashes.
+
+@noindent
+For example, the following piece of filename generation code
+with the @t{EXTENDED_GLOB} option:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+print -r -- *.c(#q:s/#%(#b)s(*).c/'S$@{match[1]@}.C'/)
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+takes the expansion of @t{*.c} and applies the glob qualifiers in the
+@t{(#q}@var{...}@t{)} expression, which consists of a substitution
+modifier anchored to the start and end of each word (@t{#%}). This
+turns on backreferences (@t{(#b)}), so that the parenthesised
+subexpression is available in the replacement string as @t{$@{match[1]@}}.
+The replacement string is quoted so that the parameter is not substituted
+before the start of filename generation.
+
+@noindent
+The following @t{f}, @t{F}, @t{w} and @t{W} modifiers work only with
+parameter expansion and filename generation. They are listed here to
+provide a single point of reference for all modifiers.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{f}
+Repeats the immediately (without a colon) following modifier until the
+resulting word doesn't change any more.
+
+@item @t{F:}@var{expr}@t{:}
+Like @t{f}, but repeats only @var{n} times if the expression
+@var{expr} evaluates to @var{n}. Any character can be used instead of
+the `@t{:}'; if `@t{(}', `@t{[}', or `@t{@{}'
+is used as the opening delimiter,
+the closing delimiter should be '@t{)}', `@t{]}', or `@t{@}}',
+respectively.
+
+@item @t{w}
+Makes the immediately following modifier work on each word in the
+string.
+
+@item @t{W:}@var{sep}@t{:}
+Like @t{w} but words are considered to be the parts of the string
+that are separated by @var{sep}. Any character can be used instead of
+the `@t{:}'; opening parentheses are handled specially, see above.
+
+@end table
+@node Process Substitution, Parameter Expansion, History Expansion, Expansion
+
+@section Process Substitution
+@noindent
+@cindex process substitution
+@cindex substitution, process
+Each part of a command argument that takes the form
+`@t{<(}@var{list}@t{)}',
+`@t{>(}@var{list}@t{)}' or
+`@t{=(}@var{list}@t{)}'
+is subject to process substitution. The expression may be preceded
+or followed by other strings except that, to prevent clashes with
+commonly occurring strings and patterns, the last
+form must occur at the start of a command argument, and the forms
+are only expanded when first parsing command or assignment arguments.
+Process substitutions may be used following redirection operators; in this
+case, the substitution must appear with no trailing string.
+
+@noindent
+Note that `@t{<<(}@var{list}@t{)}' is not a special syntax; it
+is equivalent to `@t{< <(}@var{list}@t{)}', redirecting
+standard input from the result of process substitution. Hence all
+the following documentation applies. The second form (with the space)
+is recommended for clarity.
+
+@noindent
+In the case of the @t{<} or @t{>} forms, the shell runs the commands in
+@var{list} as a subprocess of the job executing the shell command line.
+If the system supports the @t{/dev/fd}
+mechanism, the command argument is the name of the device file
+corresponding to a file descriptor; otherwise, if the system supports named
+pipes (FIFOs), the command argument will be a named pipe. If the form with
+@t{>} is selected then writing on this special file will provide input for
+@var{list}. If @t{<} is used, then the file passed as an argument will
+be connected to the output of the @var{list} process. For example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+@t{paste <(cut -f1} @var{file1}@t{) <(cut -f3} @var{file2}@t{) |
+tee >(}@var{process1}@t{) >(}@var{process2}@t{) >/dev/null}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+cuts fields 1 and 3 from the files @var{file1} and @var{file2} respectively,
+pastes the results together, and sends it to the processes
+@var{process1} and @var{process2}.
+
+@noindent
+If @t{=(}@var{...}@t{)} is used instead of
+@t{<(}@var{...}@t{)},
+then the file passed as an argument will be the name
+of a temporary file containing the output of the @var{list}
+process. This may be used instead of the @t{<}
+form for a program that expects to lseek (see man page lseek(2))
+on the input file.
+
+@noindent
+There is an optimisation for substitutions of the form
+@t{=(<<<}@var{arg}@t{)}, where @var{arg} is a single-word argument
+to the here-string redirection @t{<<<}. This form produces a file name
+containing the value of @var{arg} after any substitutions have been
+performed. This is handled entirely within the current shell. This is
+effectively the reverse of the special form @t{$(<}@var{arg}@t{)}
+which treats @var{arg} as a file name and replaces it with the file's
+contents.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{=} form is useful as both the @t{/dev/fd} and the named pipe
+implementation of @t{<(}@var{...}@t{)} have drawbacks. In
+the former case, some programmes may automatically close the file
+descriptor in question before examining the file on the command line,
+particularly if this is necessary for security reasons such as when the
+programme is running setuid. In the second case, if the
+programme does not actually open the file, the subshell attempting to read
+from or write to the pipe will (in a typical implementation, different
+operating systems may have different behaviour) block for ever and have to
+be killed explicitly. In both cases, the shell actually supplies the
+information using a pipe, so that programmes that expect to lseek
+(see man page lseek(2)) on the file will not work.
+
+@noindent
+Also note that the previous example can be more compactly and
+efficiently written (provided the @t{MULTIOS} option is set) as:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+@t{paste <(cut -f1} @var{file1}@t{) <(cut -f3} @var{file2}@t{)} @t{> >(}@var{process1}@t{) > >(}@var{process2}@t{)}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The shell uses pipes instead of FIFOs to implement the latter
+two process substitutions in the above example.
+
+@noindent
+There is an additional problem with @t{>(}@var{process}@t{)}; when
+this is attached to an external command, the parent shell does not wait
+for @var{process} to finish and hence an immediately following command
+cannot rely on the results being complete. The problem and solution are
+the same as described in the section @emph{MULTIOS} in
+@ref{Redirection}. Hence in a simplified
+version of the example above:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+@t{paste <(cut -f1} @var{file1}@t{) <(cut -f3} @var{file2}@t{)} @t{> >(}@var{process}@t{)}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+(note that no @t{MULTIOS} are involved), @var{process} will be run
+asynchronously as far as the parent shell is concerned. The workaround is:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+@t{@{ paste <(cut -f1} @var{file1}@t{) <(cut -f3} @var{file2}@t{) @}} @t{> >(}@var{process}@t{)}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The extra processes here are
+spawned from the parent shell which will wait for their completion.
+
+@noindent
+Another problem arises any time a job with a substitution that requires
+a temporary file is disowned by the shell, including the case where
+`@t{&!}' or `@t{&|}' appears at the end of a command containing a
+substitution. In that case the temporary file will not be cleaned up as
+the shell no longer has any memory of the job. A workaround is to use
+a subshell, for example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+(mycmd =(myoutput)) &!
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+as the forked subshell will wait for the command to finish then remove
+the temporary file.
+
+@noindent
+A general workaround to ensure a process substitution endures for
+an appropriate length of time is to pass it as a parameter to
+an anonymous shell function (a piece of shell code that is run
+immediately with function scope). For example, this code:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+() @{
+ print File $1:
+ cat $1
+@} =(print This be the verse)
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+outputs something resembling the following
+
+@noindent
+@example
+File /tmp/zsh6nU0kS:
+This be the verse
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The temporary file created by the process substitution will be deleted
+when the function exits.
+
+@noindent
+@node Parameter Expansion, Command Substitution, Process Substitution, Expansion
+
+@section Parameter Expansion
+@noindent
+@cindex parameter expansion
+@cindex expansion, parameter
+The character `@t{$}' is used to introduce parameter expansions.
+See
+@ref{Parameters}
+for a description of parameters, including arrays, associative arrays,
+and subscript notation to access individual array elements.
+
+@noindent
+Note in particular the fact that words of unquoted parameters are not
+automatically split on whitespace unless the option @t{SH_WORD_SPLIT} is
+set; see references to this option below for more details. This is an
+important difference from other shells. However, as in other shells,
+null words are elided from unquoted parameters' expansions.
+
+@noindent
+With default options, after the assignments:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+array=("first word" "" "third word")
+scalar="only word"
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+then @t{$array} substitutes two words, `@t{first word}' and `@t{third
+word}', and @t{$scalar} substitutes a single word `@t{only word}'. Note
+that second element of @t{array} was elided. Scalar parameters can
+be elided too if their value is null (empty). To avoid elision, use quoting as
+follows: @t{"$scalar"} for scalars and @t{"$@{array[@@]@}"} or @t{"$@{(@@)array@}"}
+for arrays. (The last two forms are equivalent.)
+
+@noindent
+Parameter expansions can involve @emph{flags}, as in `@t{$@{(@@kv)aliases@}}',
+and other operators, such as `@t{$@{PREFIX:-"/usr/local"@}}'. Parameter
+expansions can also be nested. These topics will be introduced below.
+The full rules are complicated and are noted at the end.
+
+@noindent
+In the expansions discussed below that require a pattern, the form of
+the pattern is the same as that used for filename generation;
+see @ref{Filename Generation}. Note that these patterns, along with
+the replacement text of any substitutions, are themselves subject to
+parameter expansion, command substitution, and arithmetic expansion.
+In addition to the following operations, the colon modifiers described in
+@ref{Modifiers} in @ref{History Expansion} can be
+applied: for example, @t{$@{i:s/foo/bar/@}} performs string
+substitution on the expansion of parameter @t{$i}.
+
+@noindent
+In the following descriptions, `@var{word}' refers to a single word
+substituted on the command line, not necessarily a space delimited word.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{$@{}@var{name}@t{@}}
+The value, if any, of the parameter @var{name} is substituted.
+The braces are required if the expansion is to be followed by
+a letter, digit, or underscore that is not to be interpreted
+as part of @var{name}. In addition, more complicated forms of substitution
+usually require the braces to be present; exceptions, which only apply if
+the option @t{KSH_ARRAYS} is not set, are a single subscript or any colon
+modifiers appearing after the name, or any of the characters `@t{^}',
+`@t{=}', `@t{~}', `@t{#}' or `@t{+}' appearing before the name, all of
+which work with or without braces.
+
+@noindent
+If @var{name} is an array parameter, and the @t{KSH_ARRAYS} option is not
+set, then the value of each
+element of @var{name} is substituted, one element per word. Otherwise, the
+expansion results in one word only; with @t{KSH_ARRAYS}, this is the first
+element of an array. No field splitting is done on the result unless the
+@t{SH_WORD_SPLIT} option is set.
+See also the flags @t{=} and @t{s:}@var{string}@t{:}.
+
+@item @t{$@{+}@var{name}@t{@}}
+If @var{name} is the name of a set parameter `@t{1}' is substituted,
+otherwise `@t{0}' is substituted.
+
+@item @t{$@{}@var{name}@t{-}@var{word}@t{@}}
+@itemx @t{$@{}@var{name}@t{:-}@var{word}@t{@}}
+If @var{name} is set, or in the second form is non-null, then substitute
+its value; otherwise substitute @var{word}. In the second form @var{name}
+may be omitted, in which case @var{word} is always substituted.
+
+@item @t{$@{}@var{name}@t{+}@var{word}@t{@}}
+@itemx @t{$@{}@var{name}@t{:+}@var{word}@t{@}}
+If @var{name} is set, or in the second form is non-null, then substitute
+@var{word}; otherwise substitute nothing.
+
+@item @t{$@{}@var{name}@t{=}@var{word}@t{@}}
+@itemx @t{$@{}@var{name}@t{:=}@var{word}@t{@}}
+@itemx @t{$@{}@var{name}@t{::=}@var{word}@t{@}}
+In the first form, if @var{name} is unset then set it to @var{word}; in the
+second form, if @var{name} is unset or null then set it to @var{word}; and
+in the third form, unconditionally set @var{name} to @var{word}. In all
+forms, the value of the parameter is then substituted.
+
+@item @t{$@{}@var{name}@t{?}@var{word}@t{@}}
+@itemx @t{$@{}@var{name}@t{:?}@var{word}@t{@}}
+In the first form, if @var{name} is set, or in the second form if @var{name}
+is both set and non-null, then substitute its value; otherwise, print
+@var{word} and exit from the shell. Interactive shells instead return to
+the prompt. If @var{word} is omitted, then a standard message is printed.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+In any of the above expressions that test a variable and substitute an
+alternate @var{word}, note that you can use standard shell quoting in the
+@var{word} value to selectively override the splitting done by the
+@t{SH_WORD_SPLIT} option and the @t{=} flag, but not splitting by the
+@t{s:}@var{string}@t{:} flag.
+
+@noindent
+In the following expressions, when @var{name} is an array and
+the substitution is not quoted, or if the `@t{(@@)}' flag or the
+@var{name}@t{[@@]} syntax is used, matching and replacement is
+performed on each array element separately.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{$@{}@var{name}@t{#}@var{pattern}@t{@}}
+@itemx @t{$@{}@var{name}@t{##}@var{pattern}@t{@}}
+If the @var{pattern} matches the beginning of the value of
+@var{name}, then substitute the value of @var{name} with
+the matched portion deleted; otherwise, just
+substitute the value of @var{name}. In the first
+form, the smallest matching pattern is preferred;
+in the second form, the largest matching pattern is
+preferred.
+
+@item @t{$@{}@var{name}@t{%}@var{pattern}@t{@}}
+@itemx @t{$@{}@var{name}@t{%%}@var{pattern}@t{@}}
+If the @var{pattern} matches the end of the value of
+@var{name}, then substitute the value of @var{name} with
+the matched portion deleted; otherwise, just
+substitute the value of @var{name}. In the first
+form, the smallest matching pattern is preferred;
+in the second form, the largest matching pattern is
+preferred.
+
+@item @t{$@{}@var{name}@t{:#}@var{pattern}@t{@}}
+If the @var{pattern} matches the value of @var{name}, then substitute
+the empty string; otherwise, just substitute the value of @var{name}.
+If @var{name} is an array
+the matching array elements are removed (use the `@t{(M)}' flag to
+remove the non-matched elements).
+
+@item @t{$@{}@var{name}@t{:|}@var{arrayname}@t{@}}
+If @var{arrayname} is the name (N.B., not contents) of an array
+variable, then any elements contained in @var{arrayname} are removed
+from the substitution of @var{name}. If the substitution is scalar,
+either because @var{name} is a scalar variable or the expression is
+quoted, the elements of @var{arrayname} are instead tested against the
+entire expression.
+
+@item @t{$@{}@var{name}@t{:*}@var{arrayname}@t{@}}
+Similar to the preceding substitution, but in the opposite sense,
+so that entries present in both the original substitution and as
+elements of @var{arrayname} are retained and others removed.
+
+@item @t{$@{}@var{name}@t{:^}@var{arrayname}@t{@}}
+@itemx @t{$@{}@var{name}@t{:^^}@var{arrayname}@t{@}}
+Zips two arrays, such that the output array is twice as long as the
+shortest (longest for `@t{:^^}') of @t{name} and @t{arrayname}, with
+the elements alternatingly being picked from them. For `@t{:^}', if one
+of the input arrays is longer, the output will stop when the end of the
+shorter array is reached. Thus,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+a=(1 2 3 4); b=(a b); print $@{a:^b@}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+will output `@t{1 a 2 b}'. For `@t{:^^}', then the input is repeated
+until all of the longer array has been used up and the above will output
+`@t{1 a 2 b 3 a 4 b}'.
+
+@noindent
+Either or both inputs may be a scalar, they will be treated as an array
+of length 1 with the scalar as the only element. If either array is empty,
+the other array is output with no extra elements inserted.
+
+@noindent
+Currently the following code will output `@t{a b}' and `@t{1}' as two separate
+elements, which can be unexpected. The second print provides a workaround which
+should continue to work if this is changed.
+
+@noindent
+@example
+a=(a b); b=(1 2); print -l "$@{a:^b@}"; print -l "$@{$@{a:^b@}@}"
+@end example
+
+@item @t{$@{}@var{name}@t{:}@var{offset}@t{@}}
+@itemx @t{$@{}@var{name}@t{:}@var{offset}@t{:}@var{length}@t{@}}
+This syntax gives effects similar to parameter subscripting
+in the form @t{$}@var{name}@t{[}@var{start}@t{,}@var{end}@t{]}, but is
+compatible with other shells; note that both @var{offset} and @var{length}
+are interpreted differently from the components of a subscript.
+
+@noindent
+If @var{offset} is non-negative, then if the variable @var{name} is a
+scalar substitute the contents starting @var{offset} characters from the
+first character of the string, and if @var{name} is an array substitute
+elements starting @var{offset} elements from the first element. If
+@var{length} is given, substitute that many characters or elements,
+otherwise the entire rest of the scalar or array.
+
+@noindent
+A positive @var{offset} is always treated as the offset of a character or
+element in @var{name} from the first character or element of the array
+(this is different from native zsh subscript notation). Hence 0
+refers to the first character or element regardless of the setting of
+the option @t{KSH_ARRAYS}.
+
+@noindent
+A negative offset counts backwards from the end of the scalar or array,
+so that -1 corresponds to the last character or element, and so on.
+
+@noindent
+When positive, @var{length} counts from the @var{offset} position
+toward the end of the scalar or array. When negative, @var{length}
+counts back from the end. If this results in a position smaller
+than @var{offset}, a diagnostic is printed and nothing is substituted.
+
+@noindent
+The option @t{MULTIBYTE} is obeyed, i.e. the offset and length
+count multibyte characters where appropriate.
+
+@noindent
+@var{offset} and @var{length} undergo the same set of shell substitutions
+as for scalar assignment; in addition, they are then subject to arithmetic
+evaluation. Hence, for example
+
+@noindent
+@example
+print $@{foo:3@}
+print $@{foo: 1 + 2@}
+print $@{foo:$(( 1 + 2))@}
+print $@{foo:$(echo 1 + 2)@}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+all have the same effect, extracting the string starting at the fourth
+character of @t{$foo} if the substitution would otherwise return a scalar,
+or the array starting at the fourth element if @t{$foo} would return an
+array. Note that with the option @t{KSH_ARRAYS} @t{$foo} always returns
+a scalar (regardless of the use of the offset syntax) and a form
+such as @t{$@{foo[*]:3@}} is required to extract elements of an array named
+@t{foo}.
+
+@noindent
+If @var{offset} is negative, the @t{-} may not appear immediately
+after the @t{:} as this indicates the
+@t{$@{}@var{name}@t{:-}@var{word}@t{@}} form of substitution. Instead, a space
+may be inserted before the @t{-}. Furthermore, neither @var{offset} nor
+@var{length} may begin with an alphabetic character or @t{&} as these are
+used to indicate history-style modifiers. To substitute a value from a
+variable, the recommended approach is to precede it with a @t{$} as this
+signifies the intention (parameter substitution can easily be rendered
+unreadable); however, as arithmetic substitution is performed, the
+expression @t{$@{var: offs@}} does work, retrieving the offset from
+@t{$offs}.
+
+@noindent
+For further compatibility with other shells there is a special case
+for array offset 0. This usually accesses the
+first element of the array. However, if the substitution refers to the
+positional parameter array, e.g. @t{$@@} or @t{$*}, then offset 0
+instead refers to @t{$0}, offset 1 refers to @t{$1}, and so on. In
+other words, the positional parameter array is effectively extended by
+prepending @t{$0}. Hence @t{$@{*:0:1@}} substitutes @t{$0} and
+@t{$@{*:1:1@}} substitutes @t{$1}.
+
+@item @t{$@{}@var{name}@t{/}@var{pattern}@t{/}@var{repl}@t{@}}
+@itemx @t{$@{}@var{name}@t{//}@var{pattern}@t{/}@var{repl}@t{@}}
+@itemx @t{$@{}@var{name}@t{:/}@var{pattern}@t{/}@var{repl}@t{@}}
+Replace the longest possible match of @var{pattern} in the expansion of
+parameter @var{name} by string @var{repl}. The first form
+replaces just the first occurrence, the second form all occurrences,
+and the third form replaces only if @var{pattern} matches the entire string.
+Both @var{pattern} and @var{repl} are subject to double-quoted substitution,
+so that expressions like @t{$@{name/$opat/$npat@}} will work, but obey the
+usual rule that pattern characters in @t{$opat} are not treated specially
+unless either the option @t{GLOB_SUBST} is set, or @t{$opat} is instead
+substituted as @t{$@{~opat@}}.
+
+@noindent
+The @var{pattern} may begin with a `@t{#}', in which case the
+@var{pattern} must match at the start of the string, or `@t{%}', in
+which case it must match at the end of the string, or `@t{#%}' in which
+case the @var{pattern} must match the entire string. The @var{repl} may
+be an empty string, in which case the final `@t{/}' may also be omitted.
+To quote the final `@t{/}' in other cases it should be preceded by a
+single backslash; this is not necessary if the
+`@t{/}' occurs inside a substituted parameter. Note also that the `@t{#}',
+`@t{%}' and `@t{#%} are not active if they occur inside a substituted
+parameter, even at the start.
+
+@noindent
+If, after quoting rules apply, @t{$@{}@var{name}@t{@}} expands to an array,
+the replacements act on each element individually. Note also the
+effect of the @t{I} and @t{S} parameter expansion flags below; however,
+the flags @t{M}, @t{R}, @t{B}, @t{E} and @t{N} are not useful.
+
+@noindent
+For example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+foo="twinkle twinkle little star" sub="t*e" rep="spy"
+print $@{foo//$@{~sub@}/$rep@}
+print $@{(S)foo//$@{~sub@}/$rep@}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Here, the `@t{~}' ensures that the text of @t{$sub} is treated as a
+pattern rather than a plain string. In the first case, the longest
+match for @t{t*e} is substituted and the result is `@t{spy star}',
+while in the second case, the shortest matches are taken and the
+result is `@t{spy spy lispy star}'.
+
+@item @t{$@{#}@var{spec}@t{@}}
+If @var{spec} is one of the above substitutions, substitute
+the length in characters of the result instead of
+the result itself. If @var{spec} is an array expression,
+substitute the number of elements of the result.
+This has the side-effect that joining is skipped even in quoted
+forms, which may affect other sub-expressions in @var{spec}.
+Note that `@t{^}', `@t{=}', and `@t{~}', below, must appear
+to the left of `@t{#}' when these forms are combined.
+
+@noindent
+If the option @t{POSIX_IDENTIFIERS} is not set, and @var{spec} is a
+simple name, then the braces are optional; this is true even
+for special parameters so e.g. @t{$#-} and @t{$#*} take the length
+of the string @t{$-} and the array @t{$*} respectively. If
+@t{POSIX_IDENTIFIERS} is set, then braces are required for
+the @t{#} to be treated in this fashion.
+
+@item @t{$@{^}@var{spec}@t{@}}
+@pindex RC_EXPAND_PARAM, toggle
+@cindex array expansion style, rc
+@cindex rc, array expansion style
+Turn on the @t{RC_EXPAND_PARAM} option for the
+evaluation of @var{spec}; if the `@t{^}' is doubled, turn it off.
+When this option is set, array expansions of the form
+@var{foo}@t{$@{}@var{xx}@t{@}}@var{bar},
+where the parameter @var{xx}
+is set to @t{(}@var{a b c}@t{)}, are substituted with
+`@var{fooabar foobbar foocbar}' instead of the default
+`@var{fooa b cbar}'. Note that an empty array will therefore cause
+all arguments to be removed.
+
+@noindent
+Internally, each such expansion is converted into the
+equivalent list for brace expansion. E.g., @t{$@{^var@}} becomes
+@t{@{$var[1],$var[2],}...@t{@}}, and is processed as described in
+@ref{Brace Expansion} below: note, however, the expansion
+happens immediately, with any explicit brace expansion
+happening later. If word splitting is also in effect the
+@t{$var[}@var{N}@t{]} may themselves be split into different list
+elements.
+
+@item @t{$@{=}@var{spec}@t{@}}
+@pindex SH_WORD_SPLIT, toggle
+@cindex field splitting, sh style, parameter
+@cindex sh, field splitting style, parameter
+Perform word splitting using the rules for @t{SH_WORD_SPLIT} during the
+evaluation of @var{spec}, but regardless of whether the parameter appears in
+double quotes; if the `@t{=}' is doubled, turn it off.
+@vindex IFS, use of
+This forces parameter expansions to be split into
+separate words before substitution, using @t{IFS} as a delimiter.
+This is done by default in most other shells.
+
+@noindent
+Note that splitting is applied to @var{word} in the assignment forms
+of @var{spec} @emph{before} the assignment to @var{name} is performed.
+This affects the result of array assignments with the @t{A} flag.
+
+@item @t{$@{~}@var{spec}@t{@}}
+@pindex GLOB_SUBST, toggle
+Turn on the @t{GLOB_SUBST} option for the evaluation of
+@var{spec}; if the `@t{~}' is doubled, turn it off. When this option is
+set, the string resulting from the expansion will be interpreted as a
+pattern anywhere that is possible, such as in filename expansion and
+filename generation and pattern-matching contexts like the right
+hand side of the `@t{=}' and `@t{!=}' operators in conditions.
+
+@noindent
+In nested substitutions, note that the effect of the @t{~} applies to the
+result of the current level of substitution. A surrounding pattern
+operation on the result may cancel it. Hence, for example, if the
+parameter @t{foo} is set to @t{*}, @t{$@{~foo//\*/*.c@}} is substituted by
+the pattern @t{*.c}, which may be expanded by filename generation, but
+@t{$@{$@{~foo@}//\*/*.c@}} substitutes to the string @t{*.c}, which will not
+be further expanded.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+If a @t{$@{}...@t{@}} type parameter expression or a
+@t{$(}...@t{)} type command substitution is used in place of
+@var{name} above, it is expanded first and the result is used as if
+it were the value of @var{name}. Thus it is
+possible to perform nested operations: @t{$@{$@{foo#head@}%tail@}}
+substitutes the value of @t{$foo} with both `@t{head}' and `@t{tail}'
+deleted. The form with @t{$(}...@t{)} is often useful in
+combination with the flags described next; see the examples below.
+Each @var{name} or nested @t{$@{}...@t{@}} in a parameter expansion may
+also be followed by a subscript expression as described in
+@ref{Array Parameters}.
+
+@noindent
+Note that double quotes may appear around nested expressions, in which
+case only the part inside is treated as quoted; for example,
+@t{$@{(f)"$(foo)"@}} quotes the result of @t{$(foo)}, but the flag `@t{(f)}'
+(see below) is applied using the rules for unquoted expansions. Note
+further that quotes are themselves nested in this context; for example, in
+@t{"$@{(@@f)"$(foo)"@}"}, there are two sets of quotes, one surrounding the
+whole expression, the other (redundant) surrounding the @t{$(foo)} as
+before.
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Parameter Expansion Flags
+@noindent
+@cindex parameter expansion flags
+@cindex flags, parameter expansion
+@cindex substitution, parameter, flags
+If the opening brace is directly followed by an opening parenthesis,
+the string up to the matching closing parenthesis will be taken as a
+list of flags. In cases where repeating a flag is meaningful, the
+repetitions need not be consecutive; for example, `(@t{q%q%q})'
+means the same thing as the more readable `(@t{%%qqq})'. The
+following flags are supported:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{#}
+Evaluate the resulting words as numeric expressions and output the
+characters corresponding to the resulting integer. Note that this form is
+entirely distinct from use of the @t{#} without parentheses.
+
+@noindent
+If the @t{MULTIBYTE} option is set and the number is greater than 127
+(i.e. not an ASCII character) it is treated as a Unicode character.
+
+@item @t{%}
+Expand all @t{%} escapes in the resulting words in the same way as in
+prompts (see
+@ref{Prompt Expansion}). If this flag is given twice,
+full prompt expansion is done on the resulting words, depending on the
+setting of the @t{PROMPT_PERCENT}, @t{PROMPT_SUBST} and @t{PROMPT_BANG}
+options.
+
+@item @t{@@}
+In double quotes, array elements are put into separate words.
+E.g., `@t{"$@{(@@)foo@}"}' is equivalent to `@t{"$@{foo[@@]@}"}' and
+`@t{"$@{(@@)foo[1,2]@}"}' is the same as `@t{"$foo[1]" "$foo[2]"}'.
+This is distinct from @emph{field splitting} by the @t{f}, @t{s}
+or @t{z} flags, which still applies within each array element.
+
+@item @t{A}
+Convert the substitution into an array expression, even if it otherwise
+would be scalar. This has lower precedence than subscripting, so one
+level of nested expansion is required in order that subscripts apply
+to array elements. Thus @t{$@{$@{(A}@t{)}@var{name}@t{@}[1]@}}
+yields the full value of @var{name} when @var{name} is scalar.
+
+@noindent
+This assigns an array parameter with `@t{$@{}...@t{=}...@t{@}}',
+`@t{$@{}...@t{:=}...@t{@}}' or `@t{$@{}...@t{::=}...@t{@}}'.
+If this flag is repeated (as in `@t{AA}'), assigns an associative
+array parameter. Assignment is made before sorting or padding;
+if field splitting is active, the @var{word} part is split before
+assignment. The @var{name} part may be a subscripted range for
+ordinary arrays; when assigning an associative array, the @var{word}
+part @emph{must} be converted to an array, for example by using
+`@t{$@{(AA)=}@var{name}@t{=}...@t{@}}' to activate field splitting.
+
+@noindent
+Surrounding context such as additional nesting or use of the value
+in a scalar assignment may cause the array to be joined back into
+a single string again.
+
+@item @t{a}
+Sort in array index order; when combined with `@t{O}' sort in reverse
+array index order. Note that `@t{a}' is therefore equivalent to the
+default but `@t{Oa}' is useful for obtaining an array's elements in reverse
+order.
+
+@item @t{b}
+Quote with backslashes only characters that are special to pattern
+matching. This is useful when the contents of the variable are to be
+tested using @t{GLOB_SUBST}, including the @t{$@{~}@var{...}@t{@}} switch.
+
+@noindent
+Quoting using one of the @t{q} family of flags does not work
+for this purpose since quotes are not stripped from non-pattern
+characters by @t{GLOB_SUBST}. In other words,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+pattern=$@{(q)str@}
+[[ $str = $@{~pattern@} ]]
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+works if @t{$str} is `@t{a*b}' but not if it is `@t{a b}', whereas
+
+@noindent
+@example
+pattern=$@{(b)str@}
+[[ $str = $@{~pattern@} ]]
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+is always true for any possible value of @t{$str}.
+
+@item @t{c}
+With @t{$@{#}@var{name}@t{@}}, count the total number of characters in an array,
+as if the elements were concatenated with spaces between them. This is not
+a true join of the array, so other expressions used with this flag may have
+an effect on the elements of the array before it is counted.
+
+@item @t{C}
+Capitalize the resulting words. `Words' in this case refers to sequences
+of alphanumeric characters separated by non-alphanumerics, @emph{not} to words
+that result from field splitting.
+
+@item @t{D}
+Assume the string or array elements contain directories and attempt
+to substitute the leading part of these by names. The remainder of
+the path (the whole of it if the leading part was not substituted)
+is then quoted so that the whole string can be used as a shell
+argument. This is the reverse of `@t{~}' substitution: see
+@ref{Filename Expansion}.
+
+@item @t{e}
+Perform single word shell expansions, namely @emph{parameter expansion},
+@emph{command substitution} and @emph{arithmetic expansion}, on the
+result. Such expansions can be nested but too deep recursion may have
+unpredictable effects.
+
+@item @t{f}
+Split the result of the expansion at newlines. This is a shorthand
+for `@t{ps:\n:}'.
+
+@item @t{F}
+Join the words of arrays together using newline as a separator.
+This is a shorthand for `@t{pj:\n:}'.
+
+@item @t{g:}@var{opts}@t{:}
+Process escape sequences like the echo builtin when no options are given
+(@t{g::}). With the @t{o} option, octal escapes don't take a leading
+zero. With the @t{c} option, sequences like `@t{^X}' are also processed.
+With the @t{e} option, processes `@t{\M-t}' and similar sequences like the
+print builtin. With both of the @t{o} and @t{e} options, behaves like the
+print builtin except that in none of these modes is `@t{\c}' interpreted.
+
+@item @t{i}
+Sort case-insensitively. May be combined with `@t{n}' or `@t{O}'.
+
+@item @t{k}
+If @var{name} refers to an associative array, substitute the @emph{keys}
+(element names) rather than the values of the elements. Used with
+subscripts (including ordinary arrays), force indices or keys to be
+substituted even if the subscript form refers to values. However,
+this flag may not be combined with subscript ranges. With the
+@t{KSH_ARRAYS} option a subscript `@t{[*]}' or `@t{[@@]}' is needed
+to operate on the whole array, as usual.
+
+@item @t{L}
+Convert all letters in the result to lower case.
+
+@item @t{n}
+Sort decimal integers numerically; if the first differing
+characters of two test strings are not digits, sorting
+is lexical. Integers with more initial zeroes
+are sorted before those with fewer or none. Hence the array `@t{foo1 foo02
+foo2 foo3 foo20 foo23}' is sorted into the order shown.
+May be combined with `@t{i}' or `@t{O}'.
+
+@item @t{o}
+Sort the resulting words in ascending order; if this appears on its
+own the sorting is lexical and case-sensitive (unless the locale
+renders it case-insensitive). Sorting in ascending order is the
+default for other forms of sorting, so this is ignored if combined
+with `@t{a}', `@t{i}' or `@t{n}'.
+
+@item @t{O}
+Sort the resulting words in descending order; `@t{O}' without `@t{a}',
+`@t{i}' or `@t{n}' sorts in reverse lexical order. May be combined
+with `@t{a}', `@t{i}' or `@t{n}' to reverse the order of sorting.
+
+@item @t{P}
+This forces the value of the parameter @var{name} to be interpreted as a
+further parameter name, whose value will be used where appropriate.
+Note that flags set with one of the @t{typeset} family of commands
+(in particular case transformations) are not applied to the value of
+@var{name} used in this fashion.
+
+@noindent
+If used with a nested parameter or command substitution, the result of that
+will be taken as a parameter name in the same way. For example, if you
+have `@t{foo=bar}' and `@t{bar=baz}', the strings @t{$@{(P)foo@}},
+@t{$@{(P)$@{foo@}@}}, and @t{$@{(P)$(echo bar)@}} will be expanded to
+`@t{baz}'.
+
+@noindent
+Likewise, if the reference is itself nested, the expression with the
+flag is treated as if it were directly replaced by the parameter name.
+It is an error if this nested substitution produces an array with more
+than one word. For example, if `@t{name=assoc}' where the parameter
+@t{assoc} is an associative array, then
+`@t{$@{$@{(P)name@}[elt]@}}' refers to the element of the associative
+subscripted `@t{elt}'.
+
+@item @t{q}
+Quote characters that are special to the shell in the resulting words with
+backslashes; unprintable or invalid characters are quoted using the
+@t{$'\}@var{NNN}@t{'} form, with separate quotes for each octet.
+
+@noindent
+If this flag is given twice, the resulting words are quoted in single
+quotes and if it is given three times, the words are quoted in double
+quotes; in these forms no special handling of unprintable or invalid
+characters is attempted. If the flag is given four times, the words are
+quoted in single quotes preceded by a @t{$}. Note that in all three of
+these forms quoting is done unconditionally, even if this does not change
+the way the resulting string would be interpreted by the shell.
+
+@noindent
+If a @t{q-} is given (only a single @t{q} may appear), a minimal
+form of single quoting is used that only quotes the string if needed to
+protect special characters. Typically this form gives the most readable
+output.
+
+@noindent
+If a @t{q+} is given, an extended form of minimal quoting is used that
+causes unprintable characters to be rendered using @t{$'}@var{...}@t{'}.
+This quoting is similar to that used by the output of values by the
+@t{typeset} family of commands.
+
+@item @t{Q}
+Remove one level of quotes from the resulting words.
+
+@item @t{t}
+Use a string describing the type of the parameter where the value
+of the parameter would usually appear. This string consists of keywords
+separated by hyphens (`@t{-}'). The first keyword in the string describes
+the main type, it can be one of `@t{scalar}', `@t{array}', `@t{integer}',
+`@t{float}' or `@t{association}'. The other keywords describe the type in
+more detail:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{local}
+for local parameters
+
+@item @t{left}
+for left justified parameters
+
+@item @t{right_blanks}
+for right justified parameters with leading blanks
+
+@item @t{right_zeros}
+for right justified parameters with leading zeros
+
+@item @t{lower}
+for parameters whose value is converted to all lower case when it is
+expanded
+
+@item @t{upper}
+for parameters whose value is converted to all upper case when it is
+expanded
+
+@item @t{readonly}
+for readonly parameters
+
+@item @t{tag}
+for tagged parameters
+
+@item @t{export}
+for exported parameters
+
+@item @t{unique}
+for arrays which keep only the first occurrence of duplicated values
+
+@item @t{hide}
+for parameters with the `hide' flag
+
+@item @t{hideval}
+for parameters with the `hideval' flag
+
+@item @t{special}
+for special parameters defined by the shell
+
+@end table
+
+@item @t{u}
+Expand only the first occurrence of each unique word.
+
+@item @t{U}
+Convert all letters in the result to upper case.
+
+@item @t{v}
+Used with @t{k}, substitute (as two consecutive words) both the key
+and the value of each associative array element. Used with subscripts,
+force values to be substituted even if the subscript form refers to
+indices or keys.
+
+@item @t{V}
+Make any special characters in the resulting words visible.
+
+@item @t{w}
+With @t{$@{#}@var{name}@t{@}}, count words in arrays or strings; the @t{s}
+flag may be used to set a word delimiter.
+
+@item @t{W}
+Similar to @t{w} with the difference that empty words between
+repeated delimiters are also counted.
+
+@item @t{X}
+With this flag, parsing errors occurring with the @t{Q}, @t{e} and @t{#}
+flags or the pattern matching forms such as
+`@t{$@{}@var{name}@t{#}@var{pattern}@t{@}}' are reported. Without the flag,
+errors are silently ignored.
+
+@item @t{z}
+Split the result of the expansion into words using shell parsing to
+find the words, i.e. taking into account any quoting in the value.
+Comments are not treated specially but as ordinary strings, similar
+to interactive shells with the @t{INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS} option unset
+(however, see the @t{Z} flag below for related options)
+
+@noindent
+Note that this is done very late, even later than the `@t{(s)}' flag. So to
+access single words in the result use nested expansions as
+in `@t{$@{$@{(z)foo@}[2]@}}'. Likewise, to remove the quotes in the
+resulting words use `@t{$@{(Q)$@{(z)foo@}@}}'.
+
+@item @t{0}
+Split the result of the expansion on null bytes. This is a shorthand
+for `@t{ps:\0:}'.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+The following flags (except @t{p}) are followed by one or more arguments
+as shown. Any character, or the matching pairs `@t{(}...@t{)}',
+`@t{@{}...@t{@}}', `@t{[}...@t{]}', or `@t{<}...@t{>}', may be used in place
+of a colon as delimiters, but note that when a flag takes more than one
+argument, a matched pair of delimiters must surround each argument.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{p}
+Recognize the same escape sequences as the @t{print} builtin
+in string arguments to any of the flags described below that
+follow this argument.
+
+@noindent
+Alternatively, with this option string arguments may be in the form
+@t{$}@var{var} in which case the value of the variable is substituted.
+Note this form is strict; the string argument does not undergo general
+parameter expansion.
+
+@noindent
+For example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+sep=:
+val=a:b:c
+print $@{(ps.$sep.)val@}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+splits the variable on a @t{:}.
+
+@item @t{~}
+Strings inserted into the expansion by any of the flags below are to
+be treated as patterns. This applies to the string arguments of flags
+that follow @t{~} within the same set of parentheses. Compare with @t{~}
+outside parentheses, which forces the entire substituted string to
+be treated as a pattern. Hence, for example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+[[ "?" = $@{(~j.|.)array@} ]]
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+treats `@t{|}' as a pattern and succeeds if and only if @t{$array}
+contains the string `@t{?}' as an element. The @t{~} may be
+repeated to toggle the behaviour; its effect only lasts to the
+end of the parenthesised group.
+
+@item @t{j:}@var{string}@t{:}
+Join the words of arrays together using @var{string} as a separator.
+@pindex SH_WORD_SPLIT, use of
+Note that this occurs before field splitting by the @t{s:}@var{string}@t{:}
+flag or the @t{SH_WORD_SPLIT} option.
+
+@item @t{l:}@var{expr}@t{::}@var{string1}@t{::}@var{string2}@t{:}
+Pad the resulting words on the left. Each word will be truncated if
+required and placed in a field @var{expr} characters wide.
+
+@noindent
+The arguments @t{:}@var{string1}@t{:} and @t{:}@var{string2}@t{:} are
+optional; neither, the first, or both may be given. Note that the same
+pairs of delimiters must be used for each of the three arguments. The
+space to the left will be filled with @var{string1} (concatenated as
+often as needed) or spaces if @var{string1} is not given. If both
+@var{string1} and @var{string2} are given, @var{string2} is inserted once
+directly to the left of each word, truncated if necessary, before
+@var{string1} is used to produce any remaining padding.
+
+@noindent
+If either of @var{string1} or @var{string2} is present but empty,
+i.e. there are two delimiters together at that point, the first
+character of @t{$IFS} is used instead.
+
+@noindent
+If the @t{MULTIBYTE} option is in effect, the flag @t{m} may also
+be given, in which case widths will be used for the calculation of
+padding; otherwise individual multibyte characters are treated as occupying
+one unit of width.
+
+@noindent
+If the @t{MULTIBYTE} option is not in effect, each byte in the string is
+treated as occupying one unit of width.
+
+@noindent
+Control characters are always assumed to be one unit wide; this allows the
+mechanism to be used for generating repetitions of control characters.
+
+@item @t{m}
+Only useful together with one of the flags @t{l} or @t{r} or with the
+@t{#} length operator when the @t{MULTIBYTE} option
+is in effect. Use the character width reported by the system in
+calculating how much of the string it occupies or the overall
+length of the string. Most printable characters have a width of one
+unit, however certain Asian character sets and certain special effects
+use wider characters; combining characters have zero width.
+Non-printable characters are arbitrarily counted as zero width; how they
+would actually be displayed will vary.
+
+@noindent
+If the @t{m} is repeated, the character either counts zero (if it has
+zero width), else one. For printable character strings this has the
+effect of counting the number of glyphs (visibly separate characters),
+except for the case where combining characters themselves have non-zero
+width (true in certain alphabets).
+
+@item @t{r:}@var{expr}@t{::}@var{string1}@t{::}@var{string2}@t{:}
+As @t{l}, but pad the words on the right and insert @var{string2}
+immediately to the right of the string to be padded.
+
+@noindent
+Left and right padding may be used together. In this case the strategy
+is to apply left padding to the first half width of each of the resulting
+words, and right padding to the second half. If the string to be
+padded has odd width the extra padding is applied on the left.
+
+@item @t{s:}@var{string}@t{:}
+Force field splitting at the
+separator @var{string}. Note that a @var{string} of two or more
+characters means that all of them must match in sequence; this differs from
+the treatment of two or more characters in the @t{IFS} parameter.
+See also the @t{=} flag and the @t{SH_WORD_SPLIT} option. An empty
+string may also be given in which case every character will be a separate
+element.
+
+@noindent
+For historical reasons, the usual behaviour that empty array elements
+are retained inside double quotes is disabled for arrays generated
+by splitting; hence the following:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+line="one::three"
+print -l "$@{(s.:.)line@}"
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+produces two lines of output for @t{one} and @t{three} and elides the
+empty field. To override this behaviour, supply the `@t{(@@)}' flag as well,
+i.e. @t{"$@{(@@s.:.)line@}"}.
+
+@item @t{Z:}@var{opts}@t{:}
+As @t{z} but takes a combination of option letters between a following
+pair of delimiter characters. With no options the effect is identical
+to @t{z}. @t{(Z+c+)}
+causes comments to be parsed as a string and retained; any field in the
+resulting array beginning with an unquoted comment character is a
+comment. @t{(Z+C+)} causes comments to be parsed
+and removed. The rule for comments is standard: anything between a word
+starting with the third character of @t{$HISTCHARS}, default @t{#}, up to
+the next newline is a comment. @t{(Z+n+)} causes
+unquoted newlines to be treated as ordinary whitespace, else they are
+treated as if they are shell code delimiters and converted to
+semicolons. Options are combined within the same set of delimiters,
+e.g. @t{(Z+Cn+)}.
+
+@item @t{_:}@var{flags}@t{:}
+The underscore (@t{_}) flag is reserved for future use. As of this
+revision of zsh, there are no valid @var{flags}; anything following an
+underscore, other than an empty pair of delimiters, is treated as an
+error, and the flag itself has no effect.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+The following flags are meaningful with the @t{$@{}...@t{#}...@t{@}} or
+@t{$@{}...@t{%}...@t{@}} forms. The @t{S} and @t{I} flags may also be
+used with the @t{$@{}...@t{/}...@t{@}} forms.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{S}
+With @t{#} or @t{##}, search for the match that starts closest to the start of
+the string (a `substring match'). Of all matches at a particular position,
+@t{#} selects the shortest and @t{##} the longest:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+% str="aXbXc"
+% echo $@{(S)str#X*@}
+abXc
+% echo $@{(S)str##X*@}
+a
+%
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+With @t{%} or @t{%%}, search for the match that starts closest to the end of
+the string:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+% str="aXbXc"
+% echo $@{(S)str%X*@}
+aXbc
+% echo $@{(S)str%%X*@}
+aXb
+%
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+(Note that @t{%} and @t{%%} don't search for the match that ends closest to the
+end of the string, as one might expect.)
+
+@noindent
+With substitution via @t{$@{}...@t{/}...@t{@}} or
+@t{$@{}...@t{//}...@t{@}}, specifies non-greedy matching, i.e. that the
+shortest instead of the longest match should be replaced:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+% str="abab"
+% echo $@{str/*b/_@}
+_
+% echo $@{(S)str/*b/_@}
+_ab
+%
+@end example
+
+@item @t{I:}@var{expr}@t{:}
+Search the @var{expr}th match (where @var{expr} evaluates to a number).
+This only applies when searching for substrings, either with the @t{S}
+flag, or with @t{$@{}...@t{/}...@t{@}} (only the @var{expr}th match is
+substituted) or @t{$@{}...@t{//}...@t{@}} (all matches from the
+@var{expr}th on are substituted). The default is to take the first match.
+
+@noindent
+The @var{expr}th match is counted such that there is either one or zero
+matches from each starting position in the string, although for global
+substitution matches overlapping previous replacements are ignored. With
+the @t{$@{}...@t{%}...@t{@}} and @t{$@{}...@t{%%}...@t{@}} forms, the starting
+position for the match moves backwards from the end as the index increases,
+while with the other forms it moves forward from the start.
+
+@noindent
+Hence with the string
+@example
+which switch is the right switch for Ipswich?
+@end example
+substitutions of the form
+@t{$@{}(@t{SI:}@var{N}@t{:})@t{string#w*ch@}} as @var{N} increases
+from 1 will match and remove `@t{which}', `@t{witch}', `@t{witch}' and
+`@t{wich}'; the form using `@t{##}' will match and remove `@t{which switch
+is the right switch for Ipswich}', `@t{witch is the right switch for
+Ipswich}', `@t{witch for Ipswich}' and `@t{wich}'. The form using `@t{%}'
+will remove the same matches as for `@t{#}', but in reverse order, and the
+form using `@t{%%}' will remove the same matches as for `@t{##}' in reverse
+order.
+
+@item @t{B}
+Include the index of the beginning of the match in the result.
+
+@item @t{E}
+Include the index one character past the end of the match in the result
+(note this is inconsistent with other uses of parameter index).
+
+@item @t{M}
+Include the matched portion in the result.
+
+@item @t{N}
+Include the length of the match in the result.
+
+@item @t{R}
+Include the unmatched portion in the result (the @emph{R}est).
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Rules
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+Here is a summary of the rules for substitution; this assumes that braces
+are present around the substitution, i.e. @t{$@{}@var{...}@t{@}}. Some particular
+examples are given below. Note that the Zsh Development Group accepts
+@emph{no responsibility} for any brain damage which may occur during the
+reading of the following rules.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{1.} @emph{Nested substitution}
+If multiple nested @t{$@{}@var{...}@t{@}} forms are present, substitution is
+performed from the inside outwards. At each level, the substitution takes
+account of whether the current value is a scalar or an array, whether the
+whole substitution is in double quotes, and what flags are supplied to the
+current level of substitution, just as if the nested substitution were the
+outermost. The flags are not propagated up to enclosing
+substitutions; the nested substitution will return either a scalar or an
+array as determined by the flags, possibly adjusted for quoting. All the
+following steps take place where applicable at all levels of substitution.
+
+@noindent
+Note that, unless the `@t{(P)}' flag is present, the flags and any
+subscripts apply directly to the value of the nested substitution; for
+example, the expansion @t{$@{$@{foo@}@}} behaves exactly the same as
+@t{$@{foo@}}. When the `@t{(P)}' flag is present in a nested substitution,
+the other substitution rules are applied to the value @emph{before} it is
+interpreted as a name, so @t{$@{$@{(P)foo@}@}} may differ from @t{$@{(P)foo@}}.
+
+@noindent
+At each nested level of substitution, the substituted words undergo all
+forms of single-word substitution (i.e. not filename generation), including
+command substitution, arithmetic expansion and filename expansion
+(i.e. leading @t{~} and @t{=}). Thus, for example, @t{$@{$@{:-=cat@}:h@}}
+expands to the directory where the @t{cat} program resides. (Explanation:
+the internal substitution has no parameter but a default value @t{=cat},
+which is expanded by filename expansion to a full path; the outer
+substitution then applies the modifier @t{:h} and takes the directory part
+of the path.)
+
+@item @t{2.} @emph{Internal parameter flags}
+Any parameter flags set by one of the @t{typeset} family of commands, in
+particular the @t{-L}, @t{-R}, @t{-Z}, @t{-u} and @t{-l} options for
+padding and capitalization, are applied directly to the parameter value.
+Note these flags are options to the command, e.g. `@t{typeset -Z}'; they
+are not the same as the flags used within parameter substitutions.
+
+@noindent
+At the outermost level of substitution, the `@t{(P)}' flag (rule @t{4.})
+ignores these transformations and uses the unmodified value of the
+parameter as the name to be replaced. This is usually the desired
+behavior because padding may make the value syntactically illegal as a
+parameter name, but if capitalization changes are desired, use the
+@t{$@{$@{(P)foo@}@}} form (rule @t{25.}).
+
+@item @t{3.} @emph{Parameter subscripting}
+If the value is a raw parameter reference with a subscript, such as
+@t{$@{}@var{var}@t{[3]@}}, the effect of subscripting is applied directly to
+the parameter. Subscripts are evaluated left to right; subsequent
+subscripts apply to the scalar or array value yielded by the previous
+subscript. Thus if @t{var} is an array, @t{$@{var[1][2]@}} is the second
+character of the first word, but @t{$@{var[2,4][2]@}} is the entire third
+word (the second word of the range of words two through four of the
+original array). Any number of subscripts may appear. Flags such as
+`@t{(k)}' and `@t{(v)}' which alter the result of subscripting are applied.
+
+@item @t{4.} @emph{Parameter name replacement}
+At the outermost level of nesting only, the `@t{(P)}' flag is applied. This
+treats the value so far as a parameter name (which may include a subscript
+expression) and replaces that with the corresponding value. This
+replacement occurs later if the `@t{(P)}' flag appears in a nested
+substitution.
+
+@noindent
+If the value so far names a parameter that has internal flags (rule @t{2.}),
+those internal flags are applied to the new value after replacement.
+
+@item @t{5.} @emph{Double-quoted joining}
+If the value after this process is an array, and the substitution
+appears in double quotes, and neither an `@t{(@@)}' flag nor a `@t{#}'
+length operator is present at the current level, then words of the
+value are joined with the first character of the parameter @t{$IFS},
+by default a space, between each word (single word arrays are not
+modified). If the `@t{(j)}' flag is present, that is used for joining
+instead of @t{$IFS}.
+
+@item @t{6.} @emph{Nested subscripting}
+Any remaining subscripts (i.e. of a nested substitution) are evaluated at
+this point, based on whether the value is an array or a scalar. As with
+@t{3.}, multiple subscripts can appear. Note that @t{$@{foo[2,4][2]@}} is
+thus equivalent to @t{$@{$@{foo[2,4]@}[2]@}} and also to
+@t{"$@{$@{(@@)foo[2,4]@}[2]@}"} (the nested substitution returns an array in
+both cases), but not to @t{"$@{$@{foo[2,4]@}[2]@}"} (the nested substitution
+returns a scalar because of the quotes).
+
+@item @t{7.} @emph{Modifiers}
+Any modifiers, as specified by a trailing `@t{#}', `@t{%}', `@t{/}'
+(possibly doubled) or by a set of modifiers of the form `@t{:...}' (see
+@ref{Modifiers} in @ref{History Expansion}), are applied to the words
+of the value at this level.
+
+@item @t{8.} @emph{Character evaluation}
+Any `@t{(#)}' flag is applied, evaluating the result so far numerically
+as a character.
+
+@item @t{9.} @emph{Length}
+Any initial `@t{#}' modifier, i.e. in the form @t{$@{#}@var{var}@t{@}}, is
+used to evaluate the length of the expression so far.
+
+@item @t{10.} @emph{Forced joining}
+If the `@t{(j)}' flag is present, or no `@t{(j)}' flag is present but
+the string is to be split as given by rule @t{11.}, and joining
+did not take place at rule @t{5.}, any words in the value are joined
+together using the given string or the first character of @t{$IFS} if none.
+Note that the `@t{(F)}' flag implicitly supplies a string for joining in this
+manner.
+
+@item @t{11.} @emph{Simple word splitting}
+If one of the `@t{(s)}' or `@t{(f)}' flags are present, or the `@t{=}'
+specifier was present (e.g. @t{$@{=}@var{var}@t{@}}), the word is split on
+occurrences of the specified string, or (for @t{=} with neither of the two
+flags present) any of the characters in @t{$IFS}.
+
+@noindent
+If no `@t{(s)}', `@t{(f)}' or `@t{=}' was given, but the word is not
+quoted and the option @t{SH_WORD_SPLIT} is set, the word is split on
+occurrences of any of the characters in @t{$IFS}. Note this step, too,
+takes place at all levels of a nested substitution.
+
+@item @t{12.} @emph{Case modification}
+Any case modification from one of the flags `@t{(L)}', `@t{(U)}' or `@t{(C)}'
+is applied.
+
+@item @t{13.} @emph{Escape sequence replacement}
+First any replacements from the `@t{(g)}' flag are performed, then any
+prompt-style formatting from the `@t{(%)}' family of flags is applied.
+
+@item @t{14.} @emph{Quote application}
+Any quoting or unquoting using `@t{(q)}' and `@t{(Q)}' and related flags
+is applied.
+
+@item @t{15.} @emph{Directory naming}
+Any directory name substitution using `@t{(D)}' flag is applied.
+
+@item @t{16.} @emph{Visibility enhancement}
+Any modifications to make characters visible using the `@t{(V)}' flag
+are applied.
+
+@item @t{17.} @emph{Lexical word splitting}
+If the '@t{(z)}' flag or one of the forms of the '@t{(Z)}' flag is
+present, the word is split as if it were a shell command line, so that
+quotation marks and other metacharacters are used to decide what
+constitutes a word. Note this form of splitting is entirely distinct
+from that described by rule @t{11.}: it does not use @t{$IFS}, and
+does not cause forced joining.
+
+@item @t{18.} @emph{Uniqueness}
+If the result is an array and the `@t{(u)}' flag was present, duplicate
+elements are removed from the array.
+
+@item @t{19.} @emph{Ordering}
+If the result is still an array and one of the `@t{(o)}' or `@t{(O)}' flags
+was present, the array is reordered.
+
+@item @t{20.} @t{RC_EXPAND_PARAM}
+At this point the decision is made whether any resulting array elements
+are to be combined element by element with surrounding text, as given
+by either the @t{RC_EXPAND_PARAM} option or the `@t{^}' flag.
+
+@item @t{21.} @emph{Re-evaluation}
+Any `@t{(e)}' flag is applied to the value, forcing it to be re-examined
+for new parameter substitutions, but also for command and arithmetic
+substitutions.
+
+@item @t{22.} @emph{Padding}
+Any padding of the value by the `@t{(l.}@var{fill}@t{.)}' or
+`@t{(r.}@var{fill}@t{.)}' flags is applied.
+
+@item @t{23.} @emph{Semantic joining}
+In contexts where expansion semantics requires a single word to
+result, all words are rejoined with the first character of @t{IFS}
+between. So in `@t{$@{(P}@t{)$@{(f}@t{)lines@}@}}'
+the value of @t{$@{lines@}} is split at newlines, but then must be
+joined again before the `@t{(P)}' flag can be applied.
+
+@noindent
+If a single word is not required, this rule is skipped.
+
+@item @t{24.} @emph{Empty argument removal}
+If the substitution does not appear in double quotes, any resulting
+zero-length argument, whether from a scalar or an element of an array,
+is elided from the list of arguments inserted into the command line.
+
+@noindent
+Strictly speaking, the removal happens later as the same happens with
+other forms of substitution; the point to note here is simply that
+it occurs after any of the above parameter operations.
+
+@item @t{25.} @emph{Nested parameter name replacement}
+If the `@t{(P)}' flag is present and rule @t{4.} has not applied, the
+value so far is treated as a parameter name (which may include a subscript
+expression) and replaced with the corresponding value, with internal flags
+(rule @t{2.}) applied to the new value.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Examples
+@noindent
+The flag @t{f} is useful to split a double-quoted substitution line by
+line. For example, @t{$@{(f)"$(<}@var{file}@t{)"@}}
+substitutes the contents of @var{file} divided so that each line is
+an element of the resulting array. Compare this with the effect of
+@t{$}@t{(<}@var{file}@t{)} alone, which divides the file
+up by words, or the same inside double quotes, which makes the entire
+content of the file a single string.
+
+@noindent
+The following illustrates the rules for nested parameter expansions.
+Suppose that @t{$foo} contains the array @t{(bar baz}@t{)}:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{"$@{(@@)$@{foo@}[1]@}"}
+This produces the result @t{b}. First, the inner substitution
+@t{"$@{foo@}"}, which has no array (@t{@@}) flag, produces a single word
+result @t{"bar baz"}. The outer substitution @t{"$@{(@@)...[1]@}"} detects
+that this is a scalar, so that (despite the `@t{(@@)}' flag) the subscript
+picks the first character.
+
+@item @t{"$@{$@{(@@)foo@}[1]@}"}
+This produces the result `@t{bar}'. In this case, the inner substitution
+@t{"$@{(@@)foo@}"} produces the array `@t{(bar baz}@t{)}'. The outer
+substitution @t{"$@{...[1]@}"} detects that this is an array and picks the
+first word. This is similar to the simple case @t{"$@{foo[1]@}"}.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+As an example of the rules for word splitting and joining, suppose @t{$foo}
+contains the array `@t{(ax1 bx1}@t{)}'. Then
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{$@{(s/x/)foo@}}
+produces the words `@t{a}', `@t{1 b}' and `@t{1}'.
+
+@item @t{$@{(j/x/s/x/)foo@}}
+produces `@t{a}', `@t{1}', `@t{b}' and `@t{1}'.
+
+@item @t{$@{(s/x/)foo%%1*@}}
+produces `@t{a}' and `@t{ b}' (note the extra space). As substitution
+occurs before either joining or splitting, the operation first generates
+the modified array @t{(ax bx}@t{)}, which is joined to give
+@t{"ax bx"}, and then split to give `@t{a}', `@t{ b}' and `'. The final
+empty string will then be elided, as it is not in double quotes.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+@node Command Substitution, Arithmetic Expansion, Parameter Expansion, Expansion
+
+@section Command Substitution
+@noindent
+@cindex command substitution
+@cindex substitution, command
+A command enclosed in parentheses preceded by a dollar sign, like
+`@t{$(}...@t{)}', or quoted with grave
+accents, like `@t{`}...@t{`}', is replaced with its standard output, with
+any trailing newlines deleted.
+If the substitution is not enclosed in double quotes, the
+output is broken into words using the @t{IFS} parameter.
+@vindex IFS, use of
+
+@noindent
+The substitution `@t{$(cat} @var{foo}@t{)}' may be replaced
+by the faster `@t{$(<}@var{foo}@t{)}'. In this case @var{foo}
+undergoes single word shell expansions (@emph{parameter expansion},
+@emph{command substitution} and @emph{arithmetic expansion}), but not
+filename generation.
+
+@noindent
+If the option @t{GLOB_SUBST} is set, the result of any unquoted command
+substitution, including the special form just mentioned, is eligible for
+filename generation.
+
+@noindent
+@node Arithmetic Expansion, Brace Expansion, Command Substitution, Expansion
+
+@section Arithmetic Expansion
+@noindent
+@cindex arithmetic expansion
+@cindex expansion, arithmetic
+A string of the form `@t{$[}@var{exp}@t{]}' or
+`@t{$((}@var{exp}@t{))}' is substituted
+with the value of the arithmetic expression @var{exp}. @var{exp} is
+subjected to @emph{parameter expansion}, @emph{command substitution}
+and @emph{arithmetic expansion} before it is evaluated.
+See @ref{Arithmetic Evaluation}.
+@node Brace Expansion, Filename Expansion, Arithmetic Expansion, Expansion
+
+@section Brace Expansion
+@noindent
+@cindex brace expansion
+@cindex expansion, brace
+A string of the form
+`@var{foo}@t{@{}@var{xx}@t{,}@var{yy}@t{,}@var{zz}@t{@}}@var{bar}'
+is expanded to the individual words
+`@var{fooxxbar}', `@var{fooyybar}' and `@var{foozzbar}'.
+Left-to-right order is preserved. This construct
+may be nested. Commas may be quoted in order to
+include them literally in a word.
+
+@noindent
+An expression of the form `@t{@{}@var{n1}@t{..}@var{n2}@t{@}}',
+where @var{n1} and @var{n2} are integers,
+is expanded to every number between
+@var{n1} and @var{n2} inclusive. If either number begins with a
+zero, all the resulting numbers will be padded with leading zeroes to
+that minimum width, but for negative numbers the @t{-} character is also
+included in the width. If the numbers are in decreasing order the
+resulting sequence will also be in decreasing order.
+
+@noindent
+An expression of the form `@t{@{}@var{n1}@t{..}@var{n2}@t{..}@var{n3}@t{@}}',
+where @var{n1}, @var{n2}, and @var{n3} are integers,
+is expanded as above, but only every @var{n3}th number starting from @var{n1}
+is output. If @var{n3} is negative the numbers are output in reverse order,
+this is slightly different from simply swapping @var{n1} and @var{n2} in the case
+that the step @var{n3} doesn't evenly divide the range. Zero padding can be
+specified in any of the three numbers, specifying it in the third can be useful
+to pad for example `@t{@{-99..100..01@}}' which is not possible to specify by putting a
+0 on either of the first two numbers (i.e. pad to two characters).
+
+@noindent
+An expression of the form `@t{@{}@var{c1}@t{..}@var{c2}@t{@}}', where
+@var{c1} and @var{c2} are single characters (which may be multibyte
+characters), is expanded to every character in the range from @var{c1} to
+@var{c2} in whatever character sequence is used internally. For
+characters with code points below 128 this is US ASCII (this is the only
+case most users will need). If any intervening character is not
+printable, appropriate quotation is used to render it printable.
+If the character sequence is reversed, the output is in reverse
+order, e.g. `@t{@{d..a@}}' is substituted as `@t{d c b a}'.
+
+@noindent
+If a brace expression matches none of the above forms, it is left
+unchanged, unless the option @t{BRACE_CCL} (an abbreviation for `brace
+character class') is set.
+@pindex BRACE_CCL, use of
+In that case, it is expanded to a list of the individual
+characters between the braces sorted into the order of the characters
+in the ASCII character set (multibyte characters are not currently
+handled). The syntax is similar to a
+@t{[}...@t{]} expression in filename generation:
+`@t{-}' is treated specially to denote a range of characters, but `@t{^}' or
+`@t{!}' as the first character is treated normally. For example,
+`@t{@{abcdef0-9@}}' expands to 16 words @t{0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 a b c d e f}.
+
+@noindent
+Note that brace expansion is not part of filename generation (globbing); an
+expression such as @t{*/@{foo,bar@}} is split into two separate words
+@t{*/foo} and @t{*/bar} before filename generation takes place. In
+particular, note that this is liable to produce a `no match' error if
+@emph{either} of the two expressions does not match; this is to be contrasted
+with @t{*/(foo|bar)}, which is treated as a single pattern but otherwise
+has similar effects.
+
+@noindent
+To combine brace expansion with array expansion, see the
+@t{$@{^}@var{spec}@t{@}} form described
+in @ref{Parameter Expansion}
+above.
+
+@noindent
+@node Filename Expansion, Filename Generation, Brace Expansion, Expansion
+
+@section Filename Expansion
+@noindent
+@cindex filename expansion
+@cindex expansion, filename
+Each word is checked to see if it begins with an unquoted `@t{~}'.
+If it does, then the word up to a `@t{/}',
+or the end of the word if there is no `@t{/}',
+is checked to see if it can be substituted in one of the ways
+described here. If so, then the `@t{~}' and the checked portion are
+replaced with the appropriate substitute value.
+
+@noindent
+A `@t{~}' by itself is replaced by the value of @t{$HOME}.
+A `@t{~}' followed by a `@t{+}' or a `@t{-}' is replaced by current
+or previous working directory, respectively.
+
+@noindent
+A `@t{~}' followed by a number is replaced by the directory at that
+position in the directory stack.
+`@t{~0}' is equivalent to `@t{~+}',
+and `@t{~1}' is the top of the stack.
+`@t{~+}' followed by a number is replaced by the directory at that
+position in the directory stack.
+`@t{~+0}' is equivalent to `@t{~+}',
+and `@t{~+1}' is the top of the stack.
+`@t{~-}' followed by a number is replaced by the directory that
+many positions from the bottom of the stack.
+`@t{~-0}' is the bottom of the stack.
+@pindex PUSHD_MINUS, use of
+The @t{PUSHD_MINUS}
+option exchanges the effects of `@t{~+}' and `@t{~-}' where they are
+followed by a number.
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Dynamic named directories
+@noindent
+@cindex directories, named, dynamic
+@cindex named directories, dynamic
+@cindex dynamic named directories
+
+@noindent
+If the function @t{zsh_directory_name} exists, or the shell variable
+@t{zsh_directory_name_functions} exists and contains an array of
+function names, then the functions are used to implement dynamic
+directory naming. The functions are tried in order until one returns
+status zero, so it is important that functions test whether they can
+handle the case in question and return an appropriate status.
+
+@noindent
+A `@t{~}' followed by a string @var{namstr} in unquoted square brackets is
+treated specially as a dynamic directory name. Note that the first
+unquoted closing square bracket always terminates @var{namstr}. The shell
+function is passed two arguments: the string @t{n} (for name) and
+@var{namstr}. It should either set the array @t{reply} to a single element
+which is the directory corresponding to the name and return status zero
+(executing an assignment as the last statement is usually sufficient), or
+it should return status non-zero. In the former case the element of reply
+is used as the directory; in the latter case the substitution is deemed to
+have failed. If all functions fail and the option @t{NOMATCH} is set,
+an error results.
+
+@noindent
+The functions defined as above are also used to see if a directory can
+be turned into a name, for example when printing the directory stack or
+when expanding @t{%~} in prompts. In this case each function is passed two
+arguments: the string @t{d} (for directory) and the candidate for dynamic
+naming. The function should either return non-zero status, if the
+directory cannot be named by the function, or it should set the array reply
+to consist of two elements: the first is the dynamic name for the directory
+(as would appear within `@t{~[}@var{...}@t{]}'), and the second is the
+prefix length of the directory to be replaced. For example, if the trial
+directory is @t{/home/myname/src/zsh} and the dynamic name for
+@t{/home/myname/src} (which has 16 characters) is @t{s}, then the function
+sets
+
+@noindent
+@example
+reply=(s 16)
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The directory name so returned is compared with possible static names for
+parts of the directory path, as described below; it is used if the prefix
+length matched (16 in the example) is longer than that matched by any
+static name.
+
+@noindent
+It is not a requirement that a function implements both
+@t{n} and @t{d} calls; for example, it might be appropriate for certain
+dynamic forms of expansion not to be contracted to names. In that case
+any call with the first argument @t{d} should cause a non-zero status to
+be returned.
+
+@noindent
+The completion system calls `@t{zsh_directory_name c}' followed by
+equivalent calls to elements of the array
+@t{zsh_directory_name_functions}, if it exists, in order to
+complete dynamic names for directories. The code for this should be
+as for any other completion function as described in
+@ref{Completion System}.
+
+@noindent
+As a working example, here is a function that expands any dynamic names
+beginning with the string @t{p:} to directories below
+@t{/home/pws/perforce}. In this simple case a static name for the
+directory would be just as effective.
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zsh_directory_name() @{
+ emulate -L zsh
+ setopt extendedglob
+ local -a match mbegin mend
+ if [[ $1 = d ]]; then
+ # turn the directory into a name
+ if [[ $2 = (#b)(/home/pws/perforce/)([^/]##)* ]]; then
+ typeset -ga reply
+ reply=(p:$match[2] $(( $@{#match[1]@} + $@{#match[2]@} )) )
+ else
+ return 1
+ fi
+ elif [[ $1 = n ]]; then
+ # turn the name into a directory
+ [[ $2 != (#b)p:(?*) ]] && return 1
+ typeset -ga reply
+ reply=(/home/pws/perforce/$match[1])
+ elif [[ $1 = c ]]; then
+ # complete names
+ local expl
+ local -a dirs
+ dirs=(/home/pws/perforce/*(/:t))
+ dirs=(p:$@{^dirs@})
+ _wanted dynamic-dirs expl 'dynamic directory' compadd -S\] -a dirs
+ return
+ else
+ return 1
+ fi
+ return 0
+@}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Static named directories
+@noindent
+@cindex directories, named, static
+@cindex named directories, static
+@cindex static named directories
+A `@t{~}' followed by anything not already covered consisting
+of any number of alphanumeric characters or underscore (`@t{_}'),
+hyphen (`@t{-}'), or dot (`@t{.}') is looked up as a
+named directory, and replaced by the value of that named directory if found.
+Named directories are typically home directories for users on the system.
+They may also be defined if the text after the `@t{~}' is the name
+of a string shell parameter whose value begins with a `@t{/}'.
+Note that trailing slashes will be removed from the path to the directory
+(though the original parameter is not modified).
+
+@noindent
+It is also possible to define directory names using the @t{-d} option to the
+@t{hash} builtin.
+
+@noindent
+When the shell prints a path (e.g. when expanding @t{%~} in prompts or when
+printing the directory stack), the path is checked to see if it has a named
+directory as its prefix. If so, then the prefix portion is replaced with a
+`@t{~}' followed by the name of the directory.
+The shorter of the two ways of referring to the directory is used,
+i.e. either the directory name or the full path; the name is used
+if they are the same length.
+The parameters @t{$PWD} and @t{$OLDPWD} are never abbreviated in this fashion.
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection `=' expansion
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+If a word begins with an unquoted `@t{=}'
+and the @t{EQUALS} option is set,
+the remainder of the word is taken as the
+name of a command. If a command
+exists by that name, the word is replaced
+by the full pathname of the command.
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Notes
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+Filename expansion is performed on the right hand side of a parameter
+assignment, including those appearing after commands of the
+@t{typeset} family. In this case, the right hand side will be treated
+as a colon-separated list in the manner of the @t{PATH} parameter,
+so that a `@t{~}' or an `@t{=}' following a `@t{:}' is eligible for expansion.
+All such behaviour can be
+disabled by quoting the `@t{~}', the `@t{=}', or the whole expression (but not
+simply the colon); the @t{EQUALS} option is also respected.
+
+@noindent
+If the option @t{MAGIC_EQUAL_SUBST} is set, any unquoted shell
+argument in the form `@var{identifier}@t{=}@var{expression}' becomes eligible
+for file expansion as described in the previous paragraph. Quoting the
+first `@t{=}' also inhibits this.
+
+@noindent
+@node Filename Generation, , Filename Expansion, Expansion
+
+@section Filename Generation
+@noindent
+@cindex filename generation
+If a word contains an unquoted instance of one of the characters
+`@t{*}', `@t{(}', `@t{|}', `@t{<}', `@t{[}', or `@t{?}', it is regarded
+as a pattern for filename generation, unless the @t{GLOB} option is unset.
+@pindex GLOB, use of
+If the @t{EXTENDED_GLOB} option is set,
+@pindex EXTENDED_GLOB, use of
+the `@t{^}' and `@t{#}' characters also denote a pattern; otherwise
+they are not treated specially by the shell.
+
+@noindent
+The word is replaced with a list of sorted filenames that match
+the pattern. If no matching pattern is found, the shell gives
+an error message, unless the @t{NULL_GLOB} option is set,
+@pindex NULL_GLOB, use of
+in which case the word is deleted; or unless the @t{NOMATCH}
+option is unset, in which case the word is left unchanged.
+@pindex NOMATCH, use of
+
+@noindent
+In filename generation,
+the character `@t{/}' must be matched explicitly;
+also, a `@t{.}' must be matched
+explicitly at the beginning of a pattern or after a `@t{/}', unless the
+@t{GLOB_DOTS} option is set.
+@pindex GLOB_DOTS, use of
+No filename generation pattern
+matches the files `@t{.}' or `@t{..}'. In other instances of pattern
+matching, the `@t{/}' and `@t{.}' are not treated specially.
+
+@subsection Glob Operators
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{*}
+Matches any string, including the null string.
+
+@item @t{?}
+Matches any character.
+
+@item @t{[}...@t{]}
+Matches any of the enclosed characters. Ranges of characters
+can be specified by separating two characters by a `@t{-}'.
+A `@t{-}' or `@t{]}' may be matched by including it as the
+first character in the list.
+@cindex character classes
+There are also several named classes of characters, in the form
+`@t{[:}@var{name}@t{:]}' with the following meanings.
+The first set use the macros provided by
+the operating system to test for the given character combinations,
+including any modifications due to local language settings, see
+man page ctype(3):
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{[:alnum:]}
+The character is alphanumeric
+
+@item @t{[:alpha:]}
+The character is alphabetic
+
+@item @t{[:ascii:]}
+The character is 7-bit, i.e. is a single-byte character without
+the top bit set.
+
+@item @t{[:blank:]}
+The character is a blank character
+
+@item @t{[:cntrl:]}
+The character is a control character
+
+@item @t{[:digit:]}
+The character is a decimal digit
+
+@item @t{[:graph:]}
+The character is a printable character other than whitespace
+
+@item @t{[:lower:]}
+The character is a lowercase letter
+
+@item @t{[:print:]}
+The character is printable
+
+@item @t{[:punct:]}
+The character is printable but neither alphanumeric nor whitespace
+
+@item @t{[:space:]}
+The character is whitespace
+
+@item @t{[:upper:]}
+The character is an uppercase letter
+
+@item @t{[:xdigit:]}
+The character is a hexadecimal digit
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+Another set of named classes is handled internally by the shell and
+is not sensitive to the locale:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{[:IDENT:]}
+The character is allowed to form part of a shell identifier, such
+as a parameter name
+
+@item @t{[:IFS:]}
+The character is used as an input field separator, i.e. is contained in the
+@t{IFS} parameter
+
+@item @t{[:IFSSPACE:]}
+The character is an IFS white space character; see the documentation
+for @t{IFS} in
+@ref{Parameters Used By The Shell}.
+
+@item @t{[:INCOMPLETE:]}
+Matches a byte that starts an incomplete multibyte character.
+Note that there may be a sequence of more than one bytes that
+taken together form the prefix of a multibyte character. To
+test for a potentially incomplete byte sequence, use the pattern
+`@t{[[:INCOMPLETE:]]*}'. This will never match a sequence starting
+with a valid multibyte character.
+
+@item @t{[:INVALID:]}
+Matches a byte that does not start a valid multibyte character.
+Note this may be a continuation byte of an incomplete multibyte
+character as any part of a multibyte string consisting of invalid and
+incomplete multibyte characters is treated as single bytes.
+
+@item @t{[:WORD:]}
+The character is treated as part of a word; this test is sensitive
+to the value of the @t{WORDCHARS} parameter
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+Note that the square brackets are additional
+to those enclosing the whole set of characters, so to test for a
+single alphanumeric character you need `@t{[[:alnum:]]}'. Named
+character sets can be used alongside other types,
+e.g. `@t{[[:alpha:]0-9]}'.
+
+@item @t{[^}...@t{]}
+@itemx @t{[!}...@t{]}
+Like @t{[}...@t{]}, except that it matches any character which is
+not in the given set.
+
+@item @t{<}[@var{x}]@t{-}[@var{y}]@t{>}
+Matches any number in the range @var{x} to @var{y}, inclusive.
+Either of the numbers may be omitted to make the range open-ended;
+hence `@t{<->}' matches any number. To match individual digits, the
+@t{[}...@t{]} form is more efficient.
+
+@noindent
+Be careful when using other wildcards adjacent to patterns of this form;
+for example, @t{<0-9>*} will actually match any number whatsoever at the
+start of the string, since the `@t{<0-9>}' will match the first digit, and
+the `@t{*}' will match any others. This is a trap for the unwary, but is
+in fact an inevitable consequence of the rule that the longest possible
+match always succeeds. Expressions such as `@t{<0-9>[^[:digit:]]*}' can be
+used instead.
+
+@item @t{(}...@t{)}
+Matches the enclosed pattern. This is used for grouping.
+If the @t{KSH_GLOB} option is set, then a
+`@t{@@}', `@t{*}', `@t{+}', `@t{?}' or `@t{!}' immediately preceding
+the `@t{(}' is treated specially, as detailed below. The option
+@t{SH_GLOB} prevents bare parentheses from being used in this way, though
+the @t{KSH_GLOB} option is still available.
+
+@noindent
+Note that grouping cannot extend over multiple directories: it is an error
+to have a `@t{/}' within a group (this only applies for patterns used in
+filename generation). There is one exception: a group of the form
+@t{(}@var{pat}@t{/)#} appearing as a complete path segment can
+match a sequence of directories. For example, @t{foo/(a*/)#bar} matches
+@t{foo/bar}, @t{foo/any/bar}, @t{foo/any/anyother/bar}, and so on.
+
+@item @var{x}@t{|}@var{y}
+Matches either @var{x} or @var{y}.
+This operator has lower precedence than any other.
+The `@t{|}' character
+must be within parentheses, to avoid interpretation as a pipeline.
+The alternatives are tried in order from left to right.
+
+@item @t{^}@var{x}
+(Requires @t{EXTENDED_GLOB} to be set.)
+Matches anything except the pattern @var{x}.
+This has a higher precedence than `@t{/}', so `@t{^foo/bar}'
+will search directories in `@t{.}' except `@t{./foo}'
+for a file named `@t{bar}'.
+
+@item @var{x}@t{~}@var{y}
+(Requires @t{EXTENDED_GLOB} to be set.)
+Match anything that matches the pattern @var{x} but does not match @var{y}.
+This has lower precedence than any operator except `@t{|}', so
+`@t{*/*~foo/bar}' will search for all files in all directories in `@t{.}'
+and then exclude `@t{foo/bar}' if there was such a match.
+Multiple patterns can be excluded by
+`@var{foo}@t{~}@var{bar}@t{~}@var{baz}'.
+In the exclusion pattern (@var{y}), `@t{/}' and `@t{.}' are not treated
+specially the way they usually are in globbing.
+
+@item @var{x}@t{#}
+(Requires @t{EXTENDED_GLOB} to be set.)
+Matches zero or more occurrences of the pattern @var{x}.
+This operator has high precedence; `@t{12#}' is equivalent to `@t{1(2#)}',
+rather than `@t{(12)#}'. It is an error for an unquoted `@t{#}' to follow
+something which cannot be repeated; this includes an empty string, a
+pattern already followed by `@t{##}', or parentheses when part of a
+@t{KSH_GLOB} pattern (for example, `@t{!(}@var{foo}@t{)#}' is
+invalid and must be replaced by
+`@t{*(!(}@var{foo}@t{))}').
+
+@item @var{x}@t{##}
+(Requires @t{EXTENDED_GLOB} to be set.)
+Matches one or more occurrences of the pattern @var{x}.
+This operator has high precedence; `@t{12##}' is equivalent to `@t{1(2##)}',
+rather than `@t{(12)##}'. No more than two active `@t{#}' characters may
+appear together. (Note the potential clash with glob qualifiers in the
+form `@t{1(2##)}' which should therefore be avoided.)
+
+@end table
+
+@subsection ksh-like Glob Operators
+@noindent
+@pindex KSH_GLOB, use of
+If the @t{KSH_GLOB} option is set, the effects of parentheses can be
+modified by a preceding `@t{@@}', `@t{*}', `@t{+}', `@t{?}' or `@t{!}'.
+This character need not be unquoted to have special effects,
+but the `@t{(}' must be.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{@@(}...@t{)}
+Match the pattern in the parentheses. (Like `@t{(}...@t{)}'.)
+
+@item @t{*(}...@t{)}
+Match any number of occurrences. (Like `@t{(}...@t{)#}',
+except that recursive directory searching is not supported.)
+
+@item @t{+(}...@t{)}
+Match at least one occurrence. (Like `@t{(}...@t{)##}',
+except that recursive directory searching is not supported.)
+
+@item @t{?(}...@t{)}
+Match zero or one occurrence. (Like `@t{(|}...@t{)}'.)
+
+@item @t{!(}...@t{)}
+Match anything but the expression in parentheses.
+(Like `@t{(^(}...@t{))}'.)
+
+@end table
+
+@subsection Precedence
+@noindent
+@cindex precedence of glob operators
+The precedence of the operators given above is (highest) `@t{^}', `@t{/}',
+`@t{~}', `@t{|}' (lowest); the
+remaining operators are simply treated from left to right as part of a
+string, with `@t{#}' and `@t{##}' applying to the shortest possible
+preceding unit (i.e. a character, `@t{?}', `@t{[}...@t{]}',
+`@t{<}...@t{>}', or a parenthesised expression). As mentioned
+above, a `@t{/}' used as a directory separator may not appear inside
+parentheses, while a `@t{|}' must do so; in patterns used in other contexts
+than filename generation (for example, in @t{case} statements and tests
+within `@t{[[}...@t{]]}'), a `@t{/}' is not special; and `@t{/}' is also
+not special after a `@t{~}' appearing outside parentheses in a filename
+pattern.
+
+@subsection Globbing Flags
+@noindent
+There are various flags which affect any text to their right up to the
+end of the enclosing group or to the end of the pattern; they require
+the @t{EXTENDED_GLOB} option. All take the form
+@t{(#}@var{X}@t{)} where @var{X} may have one of the following
+forms:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{i}
+Case insensitive: upper or lower case characters in the pattern match
+upper or lower case characters.
+
+@item @t{l}
+Lower case characters in the pattern match upper or lower case
+characters; upper case characters in the pattern still only match
+upper case characters.
+
+@item @t{I}
+Case sensitive: locally negates the effect of @t{i} or @t{l} from
+that point on.
+
+@vindex match
+@vindex mbegin
+@vindex mend
+@item @t{b}
+Activate backreferences for parenthesised groups in the pattern;
+this does not work in filename generation. When a pattern with a set of
+active parentheses is matched, the strings matched by the groups are
+stored in the array @t{$match}, the indices of the beginning of the matched
+parentheses in the array @t{$mbegin}, and the indices of the end in the array
+@t{$mend}, with the first element of each array corresponding to the first
+parenthesised group, and so on. These arrays are not otherwise special to
+the shell. The indices use the same convention as does parameter
+substitution, so that elements of @t{$mend} and @t{$mbegin} may be used in
+subscripts; the @t{KSH_ARRAYS} option is respected. Sets of globbing flags
+are not considered parenthesised groups; only the first nine active
+parentheses can be referenced.
+
+@noindent
+For example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+foo="a_string_with_a_message"
+if [[ $foo = (a|an)_(#b)(*) ]]; then
+ print $@{foo[$mbegin[1],$mend[1]]@}
+fi
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+prints `@t{string_with_a_message}'.
+Note that the first set of parentheses is before the
+@t{(#b)} and does not create a backreference.
+
+@noindent
+Backreferences work with all forms of pattern matching other than filename
+generation, but note that when performing matches on an entire array, such
+as @t{$@{}@var{array}@t{#}@var{pattern}@t{@}}, or a global substitution, such
+as @t{$@{}@var{param}@t{//}@var{pat}@t{/}@var{repl}@t{@}}, only the data for the
+last match remains available. In the case of global replacements this may
+still be useful. See the example for the @t{m} flag below.
+
+@noindent
+The numbering of backreferences strictly follows the order of the opening
+parentheses from left to right in the pattern string, although sets of
+parentheses may be nested. There are special rules for parentheses followed
+by `@t{#}' or `@t{##}'. Only the last match of the parenthesis is
+remembered: for example, in `@t{[[ abab = (#b)([ab])# ]]}', only the final
+`@t{b}' is stored in @t{match[1]}. Thus extra parentheses may be necessary
+to match the complete segment: for example, use
+`@t{X((ab|cd)#)Y}' to match
+a whole string of either `@t{ab}' or `@t{cd}' between `@t{X}' and `@t{Y}',
+using the value of @t{$match[1]} rather than @t{$match[2]}.
+
+@noindent
+If the match fails none of the parameters is altered, so in some cases it
+may be necessary to initialise them beforehand. If some of the
+backreferences fail to match --- which happens if they are in an alternate
+branch which fails to match, or if they are followed by @t{#} and matched
+zero times --- then the matched string is set to the empty string, and the
+start and end indices are set to -1.
+
+@noindent
+Pattern matching with backreferences is slightly slower than without.
+
+@item @t{B}
+Deactivate backreferences, negating the effect of the @t{b} flag from that
+point on.
+
+@item @t{c}@var{N}@t{,}@var{M}
+The flag @t{(#c}@var{N}@t{,}@var{M}@t{)} can be used anywhere
+that the @t{#} or @t{##} operators can be used except in the expressions
+`@t{(*/)#}' and `@t{(*/)##}' in filename generation, where `@t{/}'
+has special meaning; it cannot be combined with other globbing flags and
+a bad pattern error occurs if it is misplaced. It is equivalent to the
+form @t{@{}@var{N}@t{,}@var{M}@t{@}} in regular expressions. The previous
+character or group is required to match between @var{N} and @var{M} times,
+inclusive. The form @t{(#c}@var{N}@t{)} requires exactly @t{N}
+matches; @t{(#c,}@var{M}@t{)} is equivalent to specifying @var{N}
+as 0; @t{(#c}@var{N}@t{,)} specifies that there is no maximum
+limit on the number of matches.
+
+@vindex MATCH
+@vindex MBEGIN
+@vindex MEND
+@item @t{m}
+Set references to the match data for the entire string matched; this is
+similar to backreferencing and does not work in filename generation. The
+flag must be in effect at the end of the pattern, i.e. not local to a
+group. The parameters @t{$MATCH}, @t{$MBEGIN} and @t{$MEND} will be set to
+the string matched and to the indices of the beginning and end of the
+string, respectively. This is most useful in parameter substitutions, as
+otherwise the string matched is obvious.
+
+@noindent
+For example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+arr=(veldt jynx grimps waqf zho buck)
+print $@{arr//(#m)[aeiou]/$@{(U)MATCH@}@}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+forces all the matches (i.e. all vowels) into uppercase, printing
+`@t{vEldt jynx grImps wAqf zhO bUck}'.
+
+@noindent
+Unlike backreferences, there is no speed penalty for using match
+references, other than the extra substitutions required for the
+replacement strings in cases such as the example shown.
+
+@item @t{M}
+Deactivate the @t{m} flag, hence no references to match data will be
+created.
+
+@item @t{a}@var{num}
+Approximate matching: @var{num} errors are allowed in the string matched by
+the pattern. The rules for this are described in the next subsection.
+
+@item @t{s}, @t{e}
+Unlike the other flags, these have only a local effect, and each must
+appear on its own: `@t{(#s)}' and `@t{(#e)}' are the only valid forms.
+The `@t{(#s)}' flag succeeds only at the start of the test string, and the
+`@t{(#e)}' flag succeeds only at the end of the test string; they
+correspond to `@t{^}' and `@t{$}' in standard regular expressions. They
+are useful for matching path segments in patterns other than those in
+filename generation (where path segments are in any case treated
+separately). For example, `@t{*((#s)|/)test((#e)|/)*}' matches
+a path segment `@t{test}' in any of the following strings: @t{test},
+@t{test/at/start}, @t{at/end/test}, @t{in/test/middle}.
+
+@noindent
+Another use is in parameter substitution; for example
+`@t{$@{array/(#s)A*Z(#e)@}}' will remove only elements of an
+array which
+match the complete pattern `@t{A*Z}'. There are other ways of performing
+many operations of this type, however the combination of the substitution
+operations `@t{/}' and `@t{//}' with the `@t{(#s)}' and `@t{(#e)}' flags
+provides a single simple and memorable method.
+
+@noindent
+Note that assertions of the form `@t{(^(#s))}' also work, i.e. match
+anywhere except at the start of the string, although this actually means
+`anything except a zero-length portion at the start of the string'; you
+need to use `@t{(""~(#s))}' to match a zero-length portion of the string
+not at the start.
+
+@item @t{q}
+A `@t{q}' and everything up to the closing parenthesis of the globbing
+flags are ignored by the pattern matching code. This is intended to
+support the use of glob qualifiers, see below. The result is that
+the pattern `@t{(#b)(*).c(#q.)}' can be used both for globbing
+and for
+matching against a string. In the former case, the `@t{(#q.)}' will be
+treated as a glob qualifier and the `@t{(#b)}' will not be useful, while in
+the latter case the `@t{(#b)}' is useful for backreferences and the
+`@t{(#q.)}' will be ignored. Note that colon modifiers in the glob
+qualifiers are also not applied in ordinary pattern matching.
+
+@item @t{u}
+Respect the current locale in determining the presence of multibyte
+characters in a pattern, provided the shell was compiled with
+@t{MULTIBYTE_SUPPORT}. This overrides the @t{MULTIBYTE}
+option; the default behaviour is taken from the option. Compare @t{U}.
+(Mnemonic: typically multibyte characters are from Unicode in the UTF-8
+encoding, although any extension of ASCII supported by the system
+library may be used.)
+
+@item @t{U}
+All characters are considered to be a single byte long. The opposite
+of @t{u}. This overrides the @t{MULTIBYTE} option.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+For example, the test string @t{fooxx} can be matched by the pattern
+@t{(#i}@t{)FOOXX}, but not by @t{(#l}@t{)FOOXX},
+@t{(#i}@t{)FOO}@t{(#I}@t{)XX} or
+@t{((#i}@t{)FOOX}@t{)X}. The string
+@t{(#ia2}@t{)readme} specifies case-insensitive matching of
+@t{readme} with up to two errors.
+
+@noindent
+When using the ksh syntax for grouping both @t{KSH_GLOB} and
+@t{EXTENDED_GLOB} must be set and the left parenthesis should be
+preceded by @t{@@}. Note also that the flags do not affect letters
+inside @t{[}...@t{]} groups, in other words @t{(#i}@t{)[a-z]}
+still matches only lowercase letters. Finally, note that when
+examining whole paths case-insensitively every directory must be
+searched for all files which match, so that a pattern of the form
+@t{(#i}@t{)/foo/bar/...} is potentially slow.
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Approximate Matching
+@noindent
+When matching approximately, the shell keeps a count of the errors found,
+which cannot exceed the number specified in the
+@t{(#a}@var{num}@t{)} flags. Four types of error are recognised:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item 1.
+Different characters, as in @t{fooxbar} and @t{fooybar}.
+
+@item 2.
+Transposition of characters, as in @t{banana} and @t{abnana}.
+
+@item 3.
+A character missing in the target string, as with the pattern @t{road} and
+target string @t{rod}.
+
+@item 4.
+An extra character appearing in the target string, as with @t{stove}
+and @t{strove}.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+Thus, the pattern @t{(#a3}@t{)abcd} matches @t{dcba}, with the
+errors occurring by using the first rule twice and the second once,
+grouping the string as @t{[d][cb][a]} and @t{[a][bc][d]}.
+
+@noindent
+Non-literal parts of the pattern must match exactly, including characters
+in character ranges: hence @t{(#a1}@t{)???} matches strings of
+length four, by applying rule 4 to an empty part of the pattern, but not
+strings of length two, since all the @t{?} must match. Other characters
+which must match exactly are initial dots in filenames (unless the
+@t{GLOB_DOTS} option is set), and all slashes in filenames, so that
+@t{a/bc} is two errors from @t{ab/c} (the slash cannot be transposed with
+another character). Similarly, errors are counted separately for
+non-contiguous strings in the pattern, so that @t{(ab|cd}@t{)ef}
+is two errors from @t{aebf}.
+
+@noindent
+When using exclusion via the @t{~} operator, approximate matching is
+treated entirely separately for the excluded part and must be activated
+separately. Thus, @t{(#a1}@t{)README~READ_ME} matches
+@t{READ.ME} but not @t{READ_ME}, as the trailing @t{READ_ME} is matched
+without approximation. However,
+@t{(#a1}@t{)README~(#a1}@t{)READ_ME}
+does not match any pattern of the form @t{READ}@var{?}@t{ME} as all
+such forms are now excluded.
+
+@noindent
+Apart from exclusions, there is only one overall error count; however, the
+maximum errors allowed may be altered locally, and this can be delimited by
+grouping. For example,
+@t{(#a1}@t{)cat}@t{((#a0}@t{)dog}@t{)fox}
+allows one error in total, which may not occur in the @t{dog} section, and
+the pattern
+@t{(#a1}@t{)cat}@t{(#a0}@t{)dog}@t{(#a1}@t{)fox}
+is equivalent. Note that the point at which an error is first found is the
+crucial one for establishing whether to use approximation; for example,
+@t{(#a1)abc(#a0)xyz} will not match @t{abcdxyz}, because the
+error occurs at the `@t{x}', where approximation is turned off.
+
+@noindent
+Entire path segments may be matched approximately, so that
+`@t{(#a1)/foo/d/is/available/at/the/bar}' allows one error in any path
+segment. This is much less efficient than without the @t{(#a1)}, however,
+since every directory in the path must be scanned for a possible
+approximate match. It is best to place the @t{(#a1)} after any path
+segments which are known to be correct.
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Recursive Globbing
+@noindent
+A pathname component of the form `@t{(}@var{foo}@t{/)#}'
+matches a path consisting of zero or more directories
+matching the pattern @var{foo}.
+
+@noindent
+As a shorthand, `@t{**/}' is equivalent to `@t{(*/)#}'; note that this
+therefore matches files in the current directory as well as
+subdirectories.
+Thus:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+ls -ld -- (*/)#bar
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+or
+
+@noindent
+@example
+ls -ld -- **/bar
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+does a recursive directory search for files named `@t{bar}' (potentially
+including the file `@t{bar}' in the current directory). This form does not
+follow symbolic links; the alternative form `@t{***/}' does, but is
+otherwise identical. Neither of these can be combined with other forms of
+globbing within the same path segment; in that case, the `@t{*}'
+operators revert to their usual effect.
+
+@noindent
+Even shorter forms are available when the option @t{GLOB_STAR_SHORT} is
+set. In that case if no @t{/} immediately follows a @t{**} or @t{***}
+they are treated as if both a @t{/} plus a further @t{*} are present.
+Hence:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+setopt GLOBSTARSHORT
+ls -ld -- **.c
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+is equivalent to
+
+@noindent
+@example
+ls -ld -- **/*.c
+@end example
+
+@subsection Glob Qualifiers
+@noindent
+@cindex globbing, qualifiers
+@cindex qualifiers, globbing
+Patterns used for filename generation may end in a
+list of qualifiers enclosed in parentheses.
+The qualifiers specify which filenames that otherwise match the given pattern
+will be inserted in the argument list.
+
+@noindent
+@pindex BARE_GLOB_QUAL, use of
+If the option @t{BARE_GLOB_QUAL} is set, then a trailing set of parentheses
+containing no `@t{|}' or `@t{(}' characters (or `@t{~}' if it is special)
+is taken as a set of
+glob qualifiers. A glob subexpression that would normally be taken as glob
+qualifiers, for example `@t{(^x)}', can be forced to be treated as part of
+the glob pattern by doubling the parentheses, in this case producing
+`@t{((^x))}'.
+
+@noindent
+If the option @t{EXTENDED_GLOB} is set, a different syntax for glob
+qualifiers is available, namely `@t{(#q}@var{x}@t{)}'
+where @var{x} is any of the same
+glob qualifiers used in the other format. The qualifiers must still appear
+at the end of the pattern. However, with this syntax multiple glob
+qualifiers may be chained together. They are treated as a logical AND of
+the individual sets of flags. Also, as the syntax is unambiguous, the
+expression will be treated as glob qualifiers just as long any parentheses
+contained within it are balanced; appearance of `@t{|}', `@t{(}' or
+`@t{~}' does not negate the effect. Note that qualifiers will be
+recognised in this form even if a bare glob qualifier exists at the end of
+the pattern, for example `@t{*(#q*)(.)}' will recognise executable regular
+files if both options are set; however, mixed syntax should probably be
+avoided for the sake of clarity. Note that within conditions using the
+`@t{[[}' form the presence of a parenthesised expression
+@t{(#q}@var{...}@t{)} at the end of a string indicates that globbing
+should be performed; the expression may include glob qualifiers, but
+it is also valid if it is simply @t{(#q)}. This does
+not apply to the right hand side of pattern match operators as the
+syntax already has special significance.
+
+@noindent
+A qualifier may be any one of the following:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{/}
+directories
+
+@item @t{F}
+`full' (i.e. non-empty) directories. Note that the
+opposite sense @t{(^F}@t{)} expands to empty directories
+and all non-directories. Use @t{(/^F}@t{)} for
+empty directories.
+
+@item @t{.}
+plain files
+
+@item @t{@@}
+symbolic links
+
+@item @t{=}
+sockets
+
+@item @t{p}
+named pipes (FIFOs)
+
+@item @t{*}
+executable plain files (0100 or 0010 or 0001)
+
+@item @t{%}
+device files (character or block special)
+
+@item @t{%b}
+block special files
+
+@item @t{%c}
+character special files
+
+@item @t{r}
+owner-readable files (0400)
+
+@item @t{w}
+owner-writable files (0200)
+
+@item @t{x}
+owner-executable files (0100)
+
+@item @t{A}
+group-readable files (0040)
+
+@item @t{I}
+group-writable files (0020)
+
+@item @t{E}
+group-executable files (0010)
+
+@item @t{R}
+world-readable files (0004)
+
+@item @t{W}
+world-writable files (0002)
+
+@item @t{X}
+world-executable files (0001)
+
+@item @t{s}
+setuid files (04000)
+
+@item @t{S}
+setgid files (02000)
+
+@item @t{t}
+files with the sticky bit (01000)
+
+@item @t{f}@var{spec}
+files with access rights matching @var{spec}. This @var{spec} may be a
+octal number optionally preceded by a `@t{=}', a `@t{+}', or a
+`@t{-}'. If none of these characters is given, the behavior is the
+same as for `@t{=}'. The octal number describes the mode bits to be
+expected, if combined with a `@t{=}', the value given must match the
+file-modes exactly, with a `@t{+}', at least the bits in the
+given number must be set in the file-modes, and with a `@t{-}', the
+bits in the number must not be set. Giving a `@t{?}' instead of a
+octal digit anywhere in the number ensures that the corresponding bits
+in the file-modes are not checked, this is only useful in combination
+with `@t{=}'.
+
+@noindent
+If the qualifier `@t{f}' is followed by any other character anything
+up to the next matching character (`@t{[}', `@t{@{}', and `@t{<}' match
+`@t{]}', `@t{@}}', and `@t{>}' respectively, any other character
+matches itself) is taken as a list of comma-separated
+@var{sub-spec}s. Each @var{sub-spec} may be either an octal number as
+described above or a list of any of the characters `@t{u}', `@t{g}',
+`@t{o}', and `@t{a}', followed by a `@t{=}', a `@t{+}', or a
+`@t{-}', followed by a list of any of the characters `@t{r}', `@t{w}',
+`@t{x}', `@t{s}', and `@t{t}', or an octal digit. The first list of
+characters specify which access rights are to be checked. If a `@t{u}'
+is given, those for the owner of the file are used, if a `@t{g}' is
+given, those of the group are checked, a `@t{o}' means to test those
+of other users, and the `@t{a}' says to test all three groups. The
+`@t{=}', `@t{+}', and `@t{-}' again says how the modes are to be
+checked and have the same meaning as described for the first form
+above. The second list of characters finally says which access rights
+are to be expected: `@t{r}' for read access, `@t{w}' for write access,
+`@t{x}' for the right to execute the file (or to search a directory),
+`@t{s}' for the setuid and setgid bits, and `@t{t}' for the sticky
+bit.
+
+@noindent
+Thus, `@t{*(f70?)}' gives the files for which the owner has read,
+write, and execute permission, and for which other group members have
+no rights, independent of the permissions for other users. The pattern
+`@t{*(f-100)}' gives all files for which the owner does not have
+execute permission, and `@t{*(f:gu+w,o-rx:)}' gives the files for which
+the owner and the other members of the group have at least write
+permission, and for which other users don't have read or execute
+permission.
+
+@item @t{e}@var{string}
+@itemx @t{+}@var{cmd}
+The @var{string} will be executed as shell code. The filename will be
+included in the list if and only if the code returns a zero status (usually
+the status of the last command).
+
+@noindent
+In the first form, the first character after the `@t{e}'
+will be used as a separator and anything up to the next matching separator
+will be taken as the @var{string}; `@t{[}', `@t{@{}', and `@t{<}' match
+`@t{]}', `@t{@}}', and `@t{>}', respectively, while any other character
+matches itself. Note that expansions must be quoted in the @var{string}
+to prevent them from being expanded before globbing is done.
+@var{string} is then executed as shell code. The string @t{globqual}
+is appended to the array @t{zsh_eval_context} the duration of
+execution.
+
+@noindent
+@vindex REPLY, use of
+@vindex reply, use of
+During the execution of @var{string} the filename currently being tested is
+available in the parameter @t{REPLY}; the parameter may be altered to
+a string to be inserted into the list instead of the original
+filename. In addition, the parameter @t{reply} may be set to an array or a
+string, which overrides the value of @t{REPLY}. If set to an array, the
+latter is inserted into the command line word by word.
+
+@noindent
+For example, suppose a directory contains a single file `@t{lonely}'. Then
+the expression `@t{*(e:'reply=($@{REPLY@}@{1,2@})':)}' will cause the words
+`@t{lonely1}' and `@t{lonely2}' to be inserted into the command line. Note
+the quoting of @var{string}.
+
+@noindent
+The form @t{+}@var{cmd} has the same effect, but no delimiters appear
+around @var{cmd}. Instead, @var{cmd} is taken as the longest sequence of
+characters following the @t{+} that are alphanumeric or underscore.
+Typically @var{cmd} will be the name of a shell function that contains the
+appropriate test. For example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+nt() @{ [[ $REPLY -nt $NTREF ]] @}
+NTREF=reffile
+ls -ld -- *(+nt)
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+lists all files in the directory that have been modified more recently than
+@t{reffile}.
+
+@item @t{d}@var{dev}
+files on the device @var{dev}
+
+@item @t{l}[@t{-}|@t{+}]@var{ct}
+files having a link count less than @var{ct} (@t{-}), greater than
+@var{ct} (@t{+}), or equal to @var{ct}
+
+@item @t{U}
+files owned by the effective user ID
+
+@item @t{G}
+files owned by the effective group ID
+
+@item @t{u}@var{id}
+files owned by user ID @var{id} if that is a number. Otherwise,
+@var{id} specifies a user name: the
+character after the `@t{u}' will be taken as a separator and the string
+between it and the next matching separator will be taken as a user name.
+The starting separators `@t{[}', `@t{@{}', and `@t{<}'
+match the final separators `@t{]}', `@t{@}}', and `@t{>}', respectively;
+any other character matches itself. The selected files are those
+owned by this user. For example, `@t{u:foo:}' or `@t{u[foo]}' selects
+files owned by user `@t{foo}'.
+
+@item @t{g}@var{id}
+like @t{u}@var{id} but with group IDs or names
+
+@item @t{a}[@t{Mwhms}][@t{-}|@t{+}]@var{n}
+files accessed exactly @var{n} days ago. Files accessed within the last
+@var{n} days are selected using a negative value for @var{n} (@t{-}@var{n}).
+Files accessed more than @var{n} days ago are selected by a positive @var{n}
+value (@t{+}@var{n}). Optional unit specifiers `@t{M}', `@t{w}',
+`@t{h}', `@t{m}' or `@t{s}' (e.g. `@t{ah5}') cause the check to be
+performed with months (of 30 days), weeks, hours, minutes or seconds
+instead of days, respectively. An explicit `@t{d}' for days is also
+allowed.
+
+@noindent
+Any fractional part of the difference between the access time and the
+current part in the appropriate units is ignored in the comparison. For
+instance, `@t{echo *(ah-5)}' would echo files accessed within the last
+five hours, while `@t{echo *(ah+5)}' would echo files accessed at least
+six hours ago, as times strictly between five and six hours are treated
+as five hours.
+
+@item @t{m}[@t{Mwhms}][@t{-}|@t{+}]@var{n}
+like the file access qualifier, except that it uses the file modification
+time.
+
+@item @t{c}[@t{Mwhms}][@t{-}|@t{+}]@var{n}
+like the file access qualifier, except that it uses the file inode change
+time.
+
+@item @t{L}[@t{+}|@t{-}]@var{n}
+files less than @var{n} bytes (@t{-}), more than @var{n} bytes (@t{+}), or
+exactly @var{n} bytes in length.
+
+@noindent
+If this flag is directly followed by a @emph{size specifier} `@t{k}' (`@t{K}'),
+`@t{m}' (`@t{M}'), or `@t{p}' (`@t{P}') (e.g. `@t{Lk-50}') the check is
+performed with kilobytes, megabytes, or blocks (of 512 bytes) instead.
+(On some systems additional specifiers are available for gigabytes,
+`@t{g}' or `@t{G}', and terabytes, `@t{t}' or `@t{T}'.) If a size specifier
+is used a file is regarded as "exactly" the size if the file size rounded up
+to the next unit is equal to the test size. Hence `@t{*(Lm1)}'
+matches files from 1 byte up to 1 Megabyte inclusive. Note also that
+the set of files "less than" the test size only includes files that would
+not match the equality test; hence `@t{*(Lm-1)}' only matches
+files of zero size.
+
+@item @t{^}
+negates all qualifiers following it
+
+@item @t{-}
+toggles between making the qualifiers work on symbolic links (the
+default) and the files they point to
+
+@item @t{M}
+sets the @t{MARK_DIRS} option for the current pattern
+@pindex MARK_DIRS, setting in pattern
+
+@item @t{T}
+appends a trailing qualifier mark to the filenames, analogous to the
+@t{LIST_TYPES} option, for the current pattern (overrides @t{M})
+
+@item @t{N}
+sets the @t{NULL_GLOB} option for the current pattern
+@pindex NULL_GLOB, setting in pattern
+
+@item @t{D}
+sets the @t{GLOB_DOTS} option for the current pattern
+@pindex GLOB_DOTS, setting in pattern
+
+@item @t{n}
+sets the @t{NUMERIC_GLOB_SORT} option for the current pattern
+@pindex NUMERIC_GLOB_SORT, setting in pattern
+
+@item @t{Y}@var{n}
+enables short-circuit mode: the pattern will expand to at most @var{n}
+filenames. If more than @var{n} matches exist, only the first @var{n}
+matches in directory traversal order will be considered.
+
+@noindent
+Implies @t{oN} when no @t{o}@var{c} qualifier is used.
+
+@item @t{o}@var{c}
+specifies how the names of the files should be sorted. If @var{c} is
+@t{n} they are sorted by name; if it is @t{L} they
+are sorted depending on the size (length) of the files; if @t{l}
+they are sorted by the number of links; if @t{a}, @t{m}, or @t{c}
+they are sorted by the time of the last access, modification, or
+inode change respectively; if @t{d}, files in subdirectories appear before
+those in the current directory at each level of the search --- this is best
+combined with other criteria, for example `@t{odon}' to sort on names for
+files within the same directory; if @t{N}, no sorting is performed.
+Note that @t{a}, @t{m}, and @t{c} compare
+the age against the current time, hence the first name in the list is the
+youngest file. Also note that the modifiers @t{^} and @t{-} are used,
+so `@t{*(^-oL)}' gives a list of all files sorted by file size in descending
+order, following any symbolic links. Unless @t{oN} is used, multiple order
+specifiers may occur to resolve ties.
+
+@noindent
+The default sorting is @t{n} (by name) unless the @t{Y} glob qualifier is used,
+in which case it is @t{N} (unsorted).
+
+@noindent
+@t{oe} and @t{o+} are special cases; they are each followed by shell code,
+delimited as for the @t{e} glob qualifier and the @t{+} glob qualifier
+respectively (see above). The code is executed for each matched file with
+the parameter @t{REPLY} set to the name of the file on entry and
+@t{globsort} appended to @t{zsh_eval_context}. The code
+should modify the parameter @t{REPLY} in some fashion. On return, the
+value of the parameter is used instead of the file name as the string on
+which to sort. Unlike other sort operators, @t{oe} and @t{o+} may be
+repeated, but note that the maximum number of sort operators of any kind
+that may appear in any glob expression is 12.
+
+@item @t{O}@var{c}
+like `@t{o}', but sorts in descending order; i.e. `@t{*(^oc)}' is the
+same as `@t{*(Oc)}' and `@t{*(^Oc)}' is the same as `@t{*(oc)}'; `@t{Od}'
+puts files in the current directory before those in subdirectories at each
+level of the search.
+
+@item @t{[}@var{beg}[@t{,}@var{end}]@t{]}
+specifies which of the matched filenames should be included in the
+returned list. The syntax is the same as for array
+subscripts. @var{beg} and the optional @var{end} may be mathematical
+expressions. As in parameter subscripting they may be negative to make
+them count from the last match backward. E.g.: `@t{*(-OL[1,3])}'
+gives a list of the names of the three largest files.
+
+@item @t{P}@var{string}
+The @var{string} will be prepended to each glob match as a separate
+word. @var{string} is delimited in the same way as arguments to the
+@t{e} glob qualifier described above. The qualifier can be repeated;
+the words are prepended separately so that the resulting command
+line contains the words in the same order they were given in the
+list of glob qualifiers.
+
+@noindent
+A typical use for this is to prepend an option before all occurrences
+of a file name; for example, the pattern `@t{*(P:-f:)}' produces the
+command line arguments `@t{-f} @var{file1} @t{-f} @var{file2} ...'
+
+@noindent
+If the modifier @t{^} is active, then @var{string} will be appended
+instead of prepended. Prepending and appending is done independently
+so both can be used on the same glob expression; for example by writing
+`@t{*(P:foo:^P:bar:^P:baz:)}' which produces the command line arguments
+`@t{foo} @t{baz} @var{file1} @t{bar} ...'
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+More than one of these lists can be combined, separated by commas. The
+whole list matches if at least one of the sublists matches (they are
+`or'ed, the qualifiers in the sublists are `and'ed). Some qualifiers,
+however, affect all matches generated, independent of the sublist in
+which they are given. These are the qualifiers `@t{M}', `@t{T}',
+`@t{N}', `@t{D}', `@t{n}', `@t{o}', `@t{O}' and the subscripts given
+in brackets (`@t{[}@var{...}@t{]}').
+
+@noindent
+If a `@t{:}' appears in a qualifier list, the remainder of the expression in
+parenthesis is interpreted as a modifier (see @ref{Modifiers}
+in @ref{History Expansion}). Each modifier must be introduced by a
+separate `@t{:}'. Note also that the result after modification does not
+have to be an existing file. The name of any existing file can be followed
+by a modifier of the form `@t{(:}@var{...}@t{)}'
+even if no actual filename generation
+is performed, although note that the presence of the parentheses
+causes the entire expression to be subjected to any global pattern matching
+options such as @t{NULL_GLOB}. Thus:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+ls -ld -- *(-/)
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+lists all directories and symbolic links that point to directories,
+and
+
+@noindent
+@example
+ls -ld -- *(-@@)
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+lists all broken symbolic links, and
+
+@noindent
+@example
+ls -ld -- *(%W)
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+lists all world-writable device files in the current directory, and
+
+@noindent
+@example
+ls -ld -- *(W,X)
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+lists all files in the current directory that are
+world-writable or world-executable, and
+
+@noindent
+@example
+print -rC1 /tmp/foo*(u0^@@:t)
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+outputs the basename of all root-owned files beginning with the string
+`@t{foo}' in @t{/tmp}, ignoring symlinks, and
+
+@noindent
+@example
+ls -ld -- *.*~(lex|parse).[ch](^D^l1)
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+lists all files having a link count of one whose names contain a dot
+(but not those starting with a dot, since @t{GLOB_DOTS} is explicitly
+switched off) except for @t{lex.c}, @t{lex.h}, @t{parse.c} and @t{parse.h}.
+
+@noindent
+@example
+print -rC1 b*.pro(#q:s/pro/shmo/)(#q.:s/builtin/shmiltin/)
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+demonstrates how colon modifiers and other qualifiers may be chained
+together. The ordinary qualifier `@t{.}' is applied first, then the colon
+modifiers in order from left to right. So if @t{EXTENDED_GLOB} is set and
+the base pattern matches the regular file @t{builtin.pro}, the shell will
+print `@t{shmiltin.shmo}'.
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/params.yo
+@node Parameters, Options, Expansion, Top
+
+@chapter Parameters
+@noindent
+@cindex parameters
+@cindex variables
+
+@section Description
+@noindent
+A parameter has a name, a value, and a number of attributes.
+A name may be any sequence of alphanumeric
+characters and underscores, or the single characters
+`@t{*}', `@t{@@}', `@t{#}', `@t{?}', `@t{-}', `@t{$}', or `@t{!}'.
+A parameter whose name begins with an alphanumeric or underscore is also
+referred to as a @emph{variable}.
+
+@noindent
+@cindex scalar
+@cindex parameters, scalar
+@cindex parameters, array
+@cindex parameters, associative array
+@cindex hash
+The attributes of a parameter determine the @emph{type} of its value, often
+referred to as the parameter type or variable type, and also control
+other processing that may be applied to the value when it is referenced.
+The value type may be a @emph{scalar} (a string, an integer, or a floating
+point number), an array (indexed numerically), or an @emph{associative}
+array (an unordered set of name-value pairs, indexed by name, also
+referred to as a @emph{hash}).
+
+@noindent
+@cindex export
+@cindex environment
+@cindex environment variables
+@cindex variables, environment
+Named scalar parameters may have the @emph{exported}, @t{-x}, attribute, to
+copy them into the process environment, which is then passed from the
+shell to any new processes that it starts. Exported parameters are called
+@emph{environment variables}. The shell also @emph{imports} environment variables
+at startup time and automatically marks the corresponding parameters as
+exported. Some environment variables are not imported for reasons of
+security or because they would interfere with the correct operation of
+other shell features.
+
+@noindent
+@cindex special parameters
+@cindex parameters, special
+Parameters may also be @emph{special}, that is, they have a predetermined
+meaning to the shell. Special parameters cannot have their type changed
+or their readonly attribute turned off, and if a special parameter is
+unset, then later recreated, the special properties will be retained.
+
+@noindent
+To declare the type of a parameter, or to assign a string or numeric value
+to a scalar parameter, use the @t{typeset} builtin.
+@findex typeset, use of
+
+@noindent
+The value of a scalar parameter may also be assigned by writing:
+@cindex assignment
+
+@quotation
+@var{name}@t{=}@var{value}
+@end quotation
+
+@noindent
+In scalar assignment, @var{value} is expanded as a single string, in
+which the elements of arrays are joined together; filename expansion is
+not performed unless the option @t{GLOB_ASSIGN} is set.
+
+@noindent
+When the integer attribute, @t{-i}, or a floating point attribute, @t{-E}
+or @t{-F}, is set for @var{name}, the @var{value} is subject to arithmetic
+evaluation. Furthermore, by replacing `@t{=}' with `@t{+=}', a parameter
+can be incremented or appended to. See @ref{Array Parameters} and
+@ref{Arithmetic Evaluation}
+for additional forms of assignment.
+
+@noindent
+Note that assignment may implicitly change the attributes of a parameter.
+For example, assigning a number to a variable in arithmetic evaluation may
+change its type to integer or float, and with @t{GLOB_ASSIGN} assigning a
+pattern to a variable may change its type to an array.
+
+@noindent
+To reference the value of a parameter, write `@t{$}@var{name}' or
+`@t{$@{}@var{name}@t{@}}'. See
+@ref{Parameter Expansion}
+for complete details. That section also explains the effect
+of the difference between scalar and array assignment on parameter
+expansion.
+@menu
+* Array Parameters::
+* Positional Parameters::
+* Local Parameters::
+* Parameters Set By The Shell::
+* Parameters Used By The Shell::
+@end menu
+@node Array Parameters, Positional Parameters, , Parameters
+
+@section Array Parameters
+@noindent
+To assign an array value, write one of:
+@findex set, use of
+@cindex array assignment
+
+@quotation
+@t{set -A} @var{name} @var{value} ...
+@end quotation
+@quotation
+@var{name}@t{=(}@var{value} ...@t{)}
+@end quotation
+@quotation
+@var{name}@t{=(}@t{[}@var{key}@t{]=}@var{value} ...@t{)}
+@end quotation
+
+@noindent
+If no parameter @var{name} exists, an ordinary array parameter is created.
+If the parameter @var{name} exists and is a scalar, it is replaced by a new
+array.
+
+@noindent
+In the third form, @var{key} is an expression that will be evaluated in
+arithmetic context (in its simplest form, an integer) that gives the
+index of the element to be assigned with @var{value}. In this form any
+elements not explicitly mentioned that come before the largest index to
+which a value is assigned are assigned an empty string. The indices
+may be in any order. Note that this syntax is strict: @t{[} and @t{]=} must
+not be quoted, and @var{key} may not consist of the unquoted string
+@t{]=}, but is otherwise treated as a simple string. The enhanced forms
+of subscript expression that may be used when directly subscripting a
+variable name, described in the section Array Subscripts below, are not
+available.
+
+@noindent
+The syntaxes with and without the explicit key may be mixed. An implicit
+@var{key} is deduced by incrementing the index from the previously
+assigned element. Note that it is not treated as an error
+if latter assignments in this form overwrite earlier assignments.
+
+@noindent
+For example, assuming the option @t{KSH_ARRAYS} is not set, the following:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+array=(one [3]=three four)
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+causes the array variable @t{array} to contain four elements @t{one},
+an empty string, @t{three} and @t{four}, in that order.
+
+@noindent
+In the forms where only @var{value} is specified, full command
+line expansion is performed.
+
+@noindent
+In the @t{[}@var{key}@t{]=}@var{value} form,
+both @var{key} and @var{value} undergo all forms of expansion
+allowed for single word shell expansions (this does not include filename
+generation); these are as performed by the parameter expansion flag
+@t{(e)} as described in
+@ref{Parameter Expansion}.
+Nested parentheses may surround @var{value} and are included as part of the
+value, which is joined into a plain string; this differs from ksh which
+allows the values themselves to be arrays. A future version of zsh may
+support that. To cause the brackets to be interpreted as a character
+class for filename generation, and therefore to treat the resulting list
+of files as a set of values, quote the equal sign using any form of quoting.
+Example:
+
+@quotation
+@var{name}@t{=(}@t{[a-z]'='*)}
+@end quotation
+
+@noindent
+To append to an array without changing the existing values, use
+one of the following:
+
+@quotation
+@var{name}@t{+=(}@var{value} ...@t{)}
+@end quotation
+@quotation
+@var{name}@t{+=(}@t{[}@var{key}@t{]=}@var{value} ...@t{)}
+@end quotation
+
+@noindent
+In the second form @var{key} may specify an existing index as well as an
+index off the end of the old array; any existing value is overwritten by
+@var{value}. Also, it is possible to use @t{[}@var{key}@t{]+=}@var{value}
+to append to the existing value at that index.
+
+@noindent
+Within the parentheses on the right hand side of either form of the
+assignment, newlines and semicolons are treated the same as white space,
+separating individual @var{value}s. Any consecutive sequence of such
+characters has the same effect.
+
+@noindent
+Ordinary array parameters may also be explicitly declared with:
+@findex typeset, use of
+
+@quotation
+@t{typeset -a} @var{name}
+@end quotation
+
+@noindent
+Associative arrays @emph{must} be declared before assignment, by using:
+
+@quotation
+@t{typeset -A} @var{name}
+@end quotation
+
+@noindent
+When @var{name} refers to an associative array, the list in an assignment
+is interpreted as alternating keys and values:
+
+@quotation
+@t{set -A} @var{name} @var{key} @var{value} ...
+@end quotation
+@quotation
+@var{name}@t{=(}@var{key} @var{value} ...@t{)}
+@end quotation
+@quotation
+@var{name}@t{=(}@t{[}@var{key}@t{]=}@var{value} ...@t{)}
+@end quotation
+
+@noindent
+Note that only one of the two syntaxes above may be used in any
+given assignment; the forms may not be mixed. This is unlike the case
+of numerically indexed arrays.
+
+@noindent
+Every @var{key} must have a @var{value} in this case. Note that this
+assigns to the entire array, deleting any elements that do not appear in
+the list. The append syntax may also be used with an associative array:
+
+@quotation
+@var{name}@t{+=(}@var{key} @var{value} ...@t{)}
+@end quotation
+@quotation
+@var{name}@t{+=(}@t{[}@var{key}@t{]=}@var{value} ...@t{)}
+@end quotation
+
+@noindent
+This adds a new key/value pair if the key is not already present, and
+replaces the value for the existing key if it is. In the second
+form it is also possible to use @t{[}@var{key}@t{]+=}@var{value} to
+append to the existing value at that key. Expansion is performed
+identically to the corresponding forms for normal arrays, as
+described above.
+
+@noindent
+To create an empty array (including associative arrays), use one of:
+
+@quotation
+@t{set -A} @var{name}
+@end quotation
+@quotation
+@var{name}@t{=()}
+@end quotation
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Array Subscripts
+@noindent
+@cindex subscripts
+Individual elements of an array may be selected using a subscript. A
+subscript of the form `@t{[}@var{exp}@t{]}' selects the single element
+@var{exp}, where @var{exp} is an arithmetic expression which will be subject
+to arithmetic expansion as if it were surrounded by
+`@t{$((}...@t{))}'. The elements are numbered
+beginning with 1, unless the @t{KSH_ARRAYS} option is set in which case
+they are numbered from zero.
+@pindex KSH_ARRAYS, use of
+
+@noindent
+Subscripts may be used inside braces used to delimit a parameter name, thus
+`@t{$@{foo[2]@}}' is equivalent to `@t{$foo[2]}'. If the @t{KSH_ARRAYS}
+option is set, the braced form is the only one that works, as bracketed
+expressions otherwise are not treated as subscripts.
+
+@noindent
+If the @t{KSH_ARRAYS} option is not set, then by default accesses to
+an array element with a subscript that evaluates to zero return an
+empty string, while an attempt to write such an element is treated as
+an error. For backward compatibility the @t{KSH_ZERO_SUBSCRIPT}
+option can be set to cause subscript values 0 and 1 to be equivalent; see
+the description of the option in @ref{Description of Options}.
+
+@noindent
+The same subscripting syntax is used for associative arrays, except that
+no arithmetic expansion is applied to @var{exp}. However, the parsing
+rules for arithmetic expressions still apply, which affects the way that
+certain special characters must be protected from interpretation. See
+@emph{Subscript Parsing} below for details.
+
+@noindent
+A subscript of the form `@t{[*]}' or `@t{[@@]}' evaluates to all elements
+of an array; there is no difference between the two except when they
+appear within double quotes.
+`@t{"$foo[*]"}' evaluates to `@t{"$foo[1] $foo[2] }...@t{"}', whereas
+`@t{"$foo[@@]"}' evaluates to `@t{"$foo[1]" "$foo[2]" }...'. For
+associative arrays, `@t{[*]}' or `@t{[@@]}' evaluate to all the values,
+in no particular order. Note that this does not substitute
+the keys; see the documentation for the `@t{k}' flag under
+@ref{Parameter Expansion}
+for complete details.
+When an array parameter is referenced as `@t{$}@var{name}' (with no
+subscript) it evaluates to `@t{$}@var{name}@t{[*]}', unless the @t{KSH_ARRAYS}
+option is set in which case it evaluates to `@t{$@{}@var{name}@t{[0]@}}' (for
+an associative array, this means the value of the key `@t{0}', which may
+not exist even if there are values for other keys).
+
+@noindent
+A subscript of the form `@t{[}@var{exp1}@t{,}@var{exp2}@t{]}'
+selects all elements in the range @var{exp1} to @var{exp2},
+inclusive. (Associative arrays are unordered, and so do not support
+ranges.) If one of the subscripts evaluates to a negative number,
+say @t{-}@var{n}, then the @var{n}th element from the end
+of the array is used. Thus `@t{$foo[-3]}' is the third element
+from the end of the array @t{foo}, and
+`@t{$foo[1,-1]}' is the same as `@t{$foo[*]}'.
+
+@noindent
+Subscripting may also be performed on non-array values, in which
+case the subscripts specify a substring to be extracted.
+For example, if @t{FOO} is set to `@t{foobar}', then
+`@t{echo $FOO[2,5]}' prints `@t{ooba}'. Note that
+some forms of subscripting described below perform pattern matching,
+and in that case the substring extends from the start of the match
+of the first subscript to the end of the match of the second
+subscript. For example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+string="abcdefghijklm"
+print $@{string[(r)d?,(r)h?]@}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+prints `@t{defghi}'. This is an obvious generalisation of the
+rule for single-character matches. For a single subscript,
+only a single character is referenced (not the range of characters
+covered by the match).
+
+@noindent
+Note that in substring operations the second subscript is handled
+differently by the @t{r} and @t{R} subscript flags: the former takes the
+shortest match as the length and the latter the longest match. Hence
+in the former case a @t{*} at the end is redundant while in
+the latter case it matches the whole remainder of the string. This
+does not affect the result of the single subscript case as here the
+length of the match is irrelevant.
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Array Element Assignment
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+A subscript may be used on the left side of an assignment like so:
+
+@quotation
+@var{name}@t{[}@var{exp}@t{]=}@var{value}
+@end quotation
+
+@noindent
+In this form of assignment the element or range specified by @var{exp}
+is replaced by the expression on the right side. An array (but not an
+associative array) may be created by assignment to a range or element.
+Arrays do not nest, so assigning a parenthesized list of values to an
+element or range changes the number of elements in the array, shifting the
+other elements to accommodate the new values. (This is not supported for
+associative arrays.)
+
+@noindent
+This syntax also works as an argument to the @t{typeset} command:
+
+@quotation
+@t{typeset} @t{"}@var{name}@t{[}@var{exp}@t{]"=}@var{value}
+@end quotation
+
+@noindent
+The @var{value} may @emph{not} be a parenthesized list in this case; only
+single-element assignments may be made with @t{typeset}. Note that quotes
+are necessary in this case to prevent the brackets from being interpreted
+as filename generation operators. The @t{noglob} precommand modifier
+could be used instead.
+
+@noindent
+To delete an element of an ordinary array, assign `@t{()}' to
+that element. To delete an element of an associative array, use the
+@t{unset} command:
+
+@quotation
+@t{unset} @t{"}@var{name}@t{[}@var{exp}@t{]"}
+@end quotation
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Subscript Flags
+@noindent
+@cindex subscript flags
+If the opening bracket, or the comma in a range, in any subscript
+expression is directly followed by an opening parenthesis, the string up
+to the matching closing one is considered to be a list of flags, as in
+`@var{name}@t{[(}@var{flags}@t{)}@var{exp}@t{]}'.
+
+@noindent
+The flags @t{s}, @t{n} and @t{b} take an argument; the delimiter
+is shown below as `@t{:}', but any character, or the matching pairs
+`@t{(}...@t{)}', `@t{@{}...@t{@}}', `@t{[}...@t{]}', or
+`@t{<}...@t{>}', may be used, but note that `@t{<}...@t{>}' can only be
+used if the subscript is inside a double quoted expression or a
+parameter substitution enclosed in braces as otherwise the expression is
+interpreted as a redirection.
+
+@noindent
+The flags currently understood are:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{w}
+If the parameter subscripted is a scalar then this flag makes
+subscripting work on words instead of characters. The default word
+separator is whitespace. When combined with the @t{i} or @t{I} flag,
+the effect is to produce the index of the first character of the
+first/last word which matches the given pattern; note that a failed
+match in this case always yields 0.
+
+@item @t{s:}@var{string}@t{:}
+This gives the @var{string} that separates words (for use with the
+@t{w} flag). The delimiter character @t{:} is arbitrary; see above.
+
+@item @t{p}
+Recognize the same escape sequences as the @t{print} builtin in
+the string argument of a subsequent `@t{s}' flag.
+
+@item @t{f}
+If the parameter subscripted is a scalar then this flag makes
+subscripting work on lines instead of characters, i.e. with elements
+separated by newlines. This is a shorthand for `@t{pws:\n:}'.
+
+@item @t{r}
+Reverse subscripting: if this flag is given, the @var{exp} is taken as a
+pattern and the result is the first matching array element, substring or
+word (if the parameter is an array, if it is a scalar, or if it is a
+scalar and the `@t{w}' flag is given, respectively). The subscript used
+is the number of the matching element, so that pairs of subscripts such as
+`@t{$foo[(r)??,3]}' and `@t{$foo[(r)??,(r)f*]}' are
+possible if the parameter is not an associative array. If the
+parameter is an associative array, only the value part of each pair is
+compared to the pattern, and the result is that value.
+
+@noindent
+If a search through an ordinary array failed, the search sets the
+subscript to one past the end of the array, and hence
+@t{$@{array[(r)}@var{pattern}@t{]@}} will substitute the empty string. Thus the
+success of a search can be tested by using the @t{(i)} flag, for
+example (assuming the option @t{KSH_ARRAYS} is not in effect):
+
+@noindent
+@example
+[[ $@{array[(i)pattern]@} -le $@{#array@} ]]
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+If @t{KSH_ARRAYS} is in effect, the @t{-le} should be replaced by @t{-lt}.
+
+@item @t{R}
+Like `@t{r}', but gives the last match. For associative arrays, gives
+all possible matches. May be used for assigning to ordinary array
+elements, but not for assigning to associative arrays. On failure, for
+normal arrays this has the effect of returning the element corresponding to
+subscript 0; this is empty unless one of the options @t{KSH_ARRAYS} or
+@t{KSH_ZERO_SUBSCRIPT} is in effect.
+
+@noindent
+Note that in subscripts with both `@t{r}' and `@t{R}' pattern characters
+are active even if they were substituted for a parameter (regardless of the
+setting of @t{GLOB_SUBST} which controls this feature in normal pattern
+matching). The flag `@t{e}' can be added to inhibit pattern matching. As
+this flag does not inhibit other forms of substitution, care is still
+required; using a parameter to hold the key has the desired effect:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+key2='original key'
+print $@{array[(Re)$key2]@}
+@end example
+
+@item @t{i}
+Like `@t{r}', but gives the index of the match instead; this may not be
+combined with a second argument. On the left side of an assignment,
+behaves like `@t{r}'. For associative arrays, the key part of each pair
+is compared to the pattern, and the first matching key found is the
+result. On failure substitutes the length of the array plus one, as
+discussed under the description of `@t{r}', or the empty string for an
+associative array.
+
+@item @t{I}
+Like `@t{i}', but gives the index of the last match, or all possible
+matching keys in an associative array. On failure substitutes 0, or
+the empty string for an associative array. This flag is best when
+testing for values or keys that do not exist.
+
+@item @t{k}
+If used in a subscript on an associative array, this flag causes the keys
+to be interpreted as patterns, and returns the value for the first key
+found where @var{exp} is matched by the key. Note this could be any
+such key as no ordering of associative arrays is defined.
+This flag does not work on the left side of an assignment to an associative
+array element. If used on another type of parameter, this behaves like `@t{r}'.
+
+@item @t{K}
+On an associative array this is like `@t{k}' but returns all values where
+@var{exp} is matched by the keys. On other types of parameters this has
+the same effect as `@t{R}'.
+
+@item @t{n:}@var{expr}@t{:}
+If combined with `@t{r}', `@t{R}', `@t{i}' or `@t{I}', makes them give
+the @var{n}th or @var{n}th last match (if @var{expr} evaluates to
+@var{n}). This flag is ignored when the array is associative.
+The delimiter character @t{:} is arbitrary; see above.
+
+@item @t{b:}@var{expr}@t{:}
+If combined with `@t{r}', `@t{R}', `@t{i}' or `@t{I}', makes them begin
+at the @var{n}th or @var{n}th last element, word, or character (if @var{expr}
+evaluates to @var{n}). This flag is ignored when the array is associative.
+The delimiter character @t{:} is arbitrary; see above.
+
+@item @t{e}
+This flag causes any pattern matching that would be performed on the
+subscript to use plain string matching instead. Hence
+`@t{$@{array[(re)*]@}}' matches only the array element whose value is @t{*}.
+Note that other forms of substitution such as parameter substitution are
+not inhibited.
+
+@noindent
+This flag can also be used to force @t{*} or @t{@@} to be interpreted as
+a single key rather than as a reference to all values. It may be used
+for either purpose on the left side of an assignment.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+See @emph{Parameter Expansion Flags} (@ref{Parameter Expansion}) for additional ways to manipulate the results of array subscripting.
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Subscript Parsing
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+This discussion applies mainly to associative array key strings and to
+patterns used for reverse subscripting (the `@t{r}', `@t{R}', `@t{i}',
+etc. flags), but it may also affect parameter substitutions that appear
+as part of an arithmetic expression in an ordinary subscript.
+
+@noindent
+To avoid subscript parsing limitations in assignments to associative array
+elements, use the append syntax:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+aa+=('key with "*strange*" characters' 'value string')
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The basic rule to remember when writing a subscript expression is that all
+text between the opening `@t{[}' and the closing `@t{]}' is interpreted
+@emph{as if} it were in double quotes (@ref{Quoting}). However, unlike double quotes which normally cannot nest, subscript
+expressions may appear inside double-quoted strings or inside other
+subscript expressions (or both!), so the rules have two important
+differences.
+
+@noindent
+The first difference is that brackets (`@t{[}' and `@t{]}') must appear as
+balanced pairs in a subscript expression unless they are preceded by a
+backslash (`@t{\}'). Therefore, within a subscript expression (and unlike
+true double-quoting) the sequence `@t{\[}' becomes `@t{[}', and similarly
+`@t{\]}' becomes `@t{]}'. This applies even in cases where a backslash is
+not normally required; for example, the pattern `@t{[^[]}' (to match any
+character other than an open bracket) should be written `@t{[^\[]}' in a
+reverse-subscript pattern. However, note that `@t{\[^\[\]}' and even
+`@t{\[^[]}' mean the @emph{same} thing, because backslashes are always
+stripped when they appear before brackets!
+
+@noindent
+The same rule applies to parentheses (`@t{(}' and `@t{)}') and
+braces (`@t{@{}' and `@t{@}}'): they must appear either in balanced pairs or
+preceded by a backslash, and backslashes that protect parentheses or
+braces are removed during parsing. This is because parameter expansions
+may be surrounded by balanced braces, and subscript flags are introduced by
+balanced parentheses.
+
+@noindent
+The second difference is that a double-quote (`@t{"}') may appear as part
+of a subscript expression without being preceded by a backslash, and
+therefore that the two characters `@t{\"}' remain as two characters in the
+subscript (in true double-quoting, `@t{\"}' becomes `@t{"}'). However,
+because of the standard shell quoting rules, any double-quotes that appear
+must occur in balanced pairs unless preceded by a backslash. This makes
+it more difficult to write a subscript expression that contains an odd
+number of double-quote characters, but the reason for this difference is
+so that when a subscript expression appears inside true double-quotes, one
+can still write `@t{\"}' (rather than `@t{\\\"}') for `@t{"}'.
+
+@noindent
+To use an odd number of double quotes as a key in an assignment, use the
+@t{typeset} builtin and an enclosing pair of double quotes; to refer to
+the value of that key, again use double quotes:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+typeset -A aa
+typeset "aa[one\"two\"three\"quotes]"=QQQ
+print "$aa[one\"two\"three\"quotes]"
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+It is important to note that the quoting rules do not change when a
+parameter expansion with a subscript is nested inside another subscript
+expression. That is, it is not necessary to use additional backslashes
+within the inner subscript expression; they are removed only once, from
+the innermost subscript outwards. Parameters are also expanded from the
+innermost subscript first, as each expansion is encountered left to right
+in the outer expression.
+
+@noindent
+A further complication arises from a way in which subscript parsing is
+@emph{not} different from double quote parsing. As in true double-quoting,
+the sequences `@t{\*}', and `@t{\@@}' remain as two characters when they
+appear in a subscript expression. To use a literal `@t{*}' or `@t{@@}' as
+an associative array key, the `@t{e}' flag must be used:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+typeset -A aa
+aa[(e)*]=star
+print $aa[(e)*]
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+A last detail must be considered when reverse subscripting is performed.
+Parameters appearing in the subscript expression are first expanded and
+then the complete expression is interpreted as a pattern. This has two
+effects: first, parameters behave as if @t{GLOB_SUBST} were on (and it
+cannot be turned off); second, backslashes are interpreted twice, once
+when parsing the array subscript and again when parsing the pattern. In a
+reverse subscript, it's necessary to use @emph{four} backslashes to cause a
+single backslash to match literally in the pattern. For complex patterns,
+it is often easiest to assign the desired pattern to a parameter and then
+refer to that parameter in the subscript, because then the backslashes,
+brackets, parentheses, etc., are seen only when the complete expression is
+converted to a pattern. To match the value of a parameter literally in a
+reverse subscript, rather than as a pattern,
+use `@t{$@{(q}@t{)}@var{name}@t{@}}' (@ref{Parameter Expansion}) to quote the expanded value.
+
+@noindent
+Note that the `@t{k}' and `@t{K}' flags are reverse subscripting for an
+ordinary array, but are @emph{not} reverse subscripting for an associative
+array! (For an associative array, the keys in the array itself are
+interpreted as patterns by those flags; the subscript is a plain string
+in that case.)
+
+@noindent
+One final note, not directly related to subscripting: the numeric names
+of positional parameters (@ref{Positional Parameters}) are parsed specially, so for example `@t{$2foo}' is equivalent to
+`@t{$@{2@}foo}'. Therefore, to use subscript syntax to extract a substring
+from a positional parameter, the expansion must be surrounded by braces;
+for example, `@t{$@{2[3,5]@}}' evaluates to the third through fifth
+characters of the second positional parameter, but `@t{$2[3,5]}' is the
+entire second parameter concatenated with the filename generation pattern
+`@t{[3,5]}'.
+
+@noindent
+@node Positional Parameters, Local Parameters, Array Parameters, Parameters
+
+@section Positional Parameters
+@noindent
+The positional parameters provide access to the command-line arguments
+of a shell function, shell script, or the shell itself; see
+@ref{Invocation}, and also @ref{Functions}.
+The parameter @var{n}, where @var{n} is a number,
+is the @var{n}th positional parameter.
+The parameter `@t{$0}' is a special case, see
+@ref{Parameters Set By The Shell}.
+
+@noindent
+The parameters @t{*}, @t{@@} and @t{argv} are
+arrays containing all the positional parameters;
+thus `@t{$argv[}@var{n}@t{]}', etc., is equivalent to simply `@t{$}@var{n}'.
+Note that the options @t{KSH_ARRAYS} or @t{KSH_ZERO_SUBSCRIPT} apply
+to these arrays as well, so with either of those options set,
+`@t{$@{argv[0]@}}' is equivalent to `@t{$1}' and so on.
+
+@noindent
+Positional parameters may be changed after the shell or function starts by
+using the @t{set} builtin, by assigning to the @t{argv} array, or by direct
+assignment of the form `@var{n}@t{=}@var{value}' where @var{n} is the number of
+the positional parameter to be changed. This also creates (with empty
+values) any of the positions from 1 to @var{n} that do not already have
+values. Note that, because the positional parameters form an array, an
+array assignment of the form `@var{n}@t{=(}@var{value} ...@t{)}' is
+allowed, and has the effect of shifting all the values at positions greater
+than @var{n} by as many positions as necessary to accommodate the new values.
+
+@noindent
+@node Local Parameters, Parameters Set By The Shell, Positional Parameters, Parameters
+
+@section Local Parameters
+@noindent
+Shell function executions delimit scopes for shell parameters.
+(Parameters are dynamically scoped.) The @t{typeset} builtin, and its
+alternative forms @t{declare}, @t{integer}, @t{local} and @t{readonly}
+(but not @t{export}), can be used to declare a parameter as being local
+to the innermost scope.
+
+@noindent
+When a parameter is read or assigned to, the
+innermost existing parameter of that name is used. (That is, the
+local parameter hides any less-local parameter.) However, assigning
+to a non-existent parameter, or declaring a new parameter with @t{export},
+causes it to be created in the @emph{outer}most scope.
+
+@noindent
+Local parameters disappear when their scope ends.
+@t{unset} can be used to delete a parameter while it is still in scope;
+any outer parameter of the same name remains hidden.
+
+@noindent
+Special parameters may also be made local; they retain their special
+attributes unless either the existing or the newly-created parameter
+has the @t{-h} (hide) attribute. This may have unexpected effects:
+there is no default value, so if there is no assignment at the
+point the variable is made local, it will be set to an empty value (or zero
+in the case of integers).
+The following:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+typeset PATH=/new/directory:$PATH
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+is valid for temporarily allowing the shell or programmes called from it to
+find the programs in @t{/new/directory} inside a function.
+
+@noindent
+Note that the restriction in older versions of zsh that local parameters
+were never exported has been removed.
+
+@noindent
+@node Parameters Set By The Shell, Parameters Used By The Shell, Local Parameters, Parameters
+
+@section Parameters Set By The Shell
+@noindent
+In the parameter lists that follow, the mark `<S>' indicates that the
+parameter is special. `<Z>' indicates that the parameter does not exist
+when the shell initializes in @t{sh} or @t{ksh} emulation mode.
+
+@noindent
+The following parameters are automatically set by the shell:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@vindex !
+@item @t{!} <S>
+The process ID of the last command started in the background with @t{&},
+put into the background with the @t{bg} builtin, or spawned with @t{coproc}.
+
+@vindex #
+@item @t{#} <S>
+The number of positional parameters in decimal. Note that some confusion
+may occur with the syntax @t{$#}@var{param} which substitutes the length of
+@var{param}. Use @t{$@{#@}} to resolve ambiguities. In particular, the
+sequence `@t{$#-}@var{...}' in an arithmetic expression is interpreted as
+the length of the parameter @t{-}, q.v.
+
+@vindex ARGC
+@item @t{ARGC} <S> <Z>
+Same as @t{#}.
+
+@vindex $
+@item @t{$} <S>
+The process ID of this shell. Note that this indicates the original
+shell started by invoking @t{zsh}; all processes forked from the shells
+without executing a new program, such as subshells started by
+@t{(}@var{...}@t{)}, substitute the same value.
+
+@vindex -
+@item @t{-} <S>
+Flags supplied to the shell on invocation or by the @t{set}
+or @t{setopt} commands.
+
+@vindex *
+@item @t{*} <S>
+An array containing the positional parameters.
+
+@vindex argv
+@item @t{argv} <S> <Z>
+Same as @t{*}. Assigning to @t{argv} changes the local positional
+parameters, but @t{argv} is @emph{not} itself a local parameter.
+Deleting @t{argv} with @t{unset} in any function deletes it everywhere,
+although only the innermost positional parameter array is deleted (so
+@t{*} and @t{@@} in other scopes are not affected).
+
+@vindex @@
+@item @t{@@} <S>
+Same as @t{argv[@@]}, even when @t{argv} is not set.
+
+@vindex ?
+@item @t{?} <S>
+The exit status returned by the last command.
+
+@vindex 0
+@item @t{0} <S>
+The name used to invoke the current shell, or as set by the @t{-c} command
+line option upon invocation. If the @t{FUNCTION_ARGZERO} option is set,
+@t{$0} is set upon entry to a shell function to the name of the function,
+and upon entry to a sourced script to the name of the script, and reset to
+its previous value when the function or script returns.
+
+@vindex status
+@item @t{status} <S> <Z>
+Same as @t{?}.
+
+@vindex pipestatus
+@item @t{pipestatus} <S> <Z>
+An array containing the exit statuses returned by all commands in the
+last pipeline.
+
+@vindex _
+@item @t{_} <S>
+The last argument of the previous command.
+Also, this parameter is set in the environment of every command
+executed to the full pathname of the command.
+
+@vindex CPUTYPE
+@item @t{CPUTYPE}
+The machine type (microprocessor class or machine model),
+as determined at run time.
+
+@vindex EGID
+@item @t{EGID} <S>
+The effective group ID of the shell process. If you have sufficient
+privileges, you may change the effective group ID of the shell
+process by assigning to this parameter. Also (assuming sufficient
+privileges), you may start a single command with a different
+effective group ID by `@t{(EGID=}@var{gid}@t{; command)}'
+
+@noindent
+If this is made local, it is not implicitly set to 0, but may be
+explicitly set locally.
+
+@vindex EUID
+@item @t{EUID} <S>
+The effective user ID of the shell process. If you have sufficient
+privileges, you may change the effective user ID of the shell process
+by assigning to this parameter. Also (assuming sufficient privileges),
+you may start a single command with a different
+effective user ID by `@t{(EUID=}@var{uid}@t{; command)}'
+
+@noindent
+If this is made local, it is not implicitly set to 0, but may be
+explicitly set locally.
+
+@vindex ERRNO
+@item @t{ERRNO} <S>
+The value of errno (see man page errno(3))
+as set by the most recently failed system call.
+This value is system dependent and is intended for debugging
+purposes. It is also useful with the @t{zsh/system} module which
+allows the number to be turned into a name or message.
+
+@vindex FUNCNEST
+@item @t{FUNCNEST} <S>
+Integer. If greater than or equal to zero, the maximum nesting depth of
+shell functions. When it is exceeded, an error is raised at the point
+where a function is called. The default value is determined when
+the shell is configured, but is typically 500. Increasing
+the value increases the danger of a runaway function recursion
+causing the shell to crash. Setting a negative value turns off
+the check.
+
+@vindex GID
+@item @t{GID} <S>
+The real group ID of the shell process. If you have sufficient privileges,
+you may change the group ID of the shell process by assigning to this
+parameter. Also (assuming sufficient privileges), you may start a single
+command under a different
+group ID by `@t{(GID=}@var{gid}@t{; command)}'
+
+@noindent
+If this is made local, it is not implicitly set to 0, but may be
+explicitly set locally.
+
+@vindex HISTCMD
+@item @t{HISTCMD}
+The current history event number in an interactive shell, in other
+words the event number for the command that caused @t{$HISTCMD}
+to be read. If the current history event modifies the history,
+@t{HISTCMD} changes to the new maximum history event number.
+
+@vindex HOST
+@item @t{HOST}
+The current hostname.
+
+@vindex LINENO
+@item @t{LINENO} <S>
+The line number of the current line within the current script, sourced
+file, or shell function being executed, whichever was started most
+recently. Note that in the case of shell functions the line
+number refers to the function as it appeared in the original definition,
+not necessarily as displayed by the @t{functions} builtin.
+
+@vindex LOGNAME
+@item @t{LOGNAME}
+If the corresponding variable is not set in the environment of the
+shell, it is initialized to the login name corresponding to the
+current login session. This parameter is exported by default but
+this can be disabled using the @t{typeset} builtin. The value
+is set to the string returned by the man page getlogin(3) system call
+if that is available.
+
+@vindex MACHTYPE
+@item @t{MACHTYPE}
+The machine type (microprocessor class or machine model),
+as determined at compile time.
+
+@vindex OLDPWD
+@item @t{OLDPWD}
+The previous working directory. This is set when the shell initializes
+and whenever the directory changes.
+
+@vindex OPTARG
+@item @t{OPTARG} <S>
+The value of the last option argument processed by the @t{getopts}
+command.
+
+@vindex OPTIND
+@item @t{OPTIND} <S>
+The index of the last option argument processed by the @t{getopts}
+command.
+
+@vindex OSTYPE
+@item @t{OSTYPE}
+The operating system, as determined at compile time.
+
+@vindex PPID
+@item @t{PPID} <S>
+The process ID of the parent of the shell. As for @t{$$}, the
+value indicates the parent of the original shell and does not
+change in subshells.
+
+@vindex PWD
+@item @t{PWD}
+The present working directory. This is set when the shell initializes
+and whenever the directory changes.
+
+@vindex RANDOM
+@item @t{RANDOM} <S>
+A pseudo-random integer from 0 to 32767, newly generated each time
+this parameter is referenced. The random number generator
+can be seeded by assigning a numeric value to @t{RANDOM}.
+
+@noindent
+The values of @t{RANDOM} form an intentionally-repeatable pseudo-random
+sequence; subshells that reference @t{RANDOM} will result
+in identical pseudo-random values unless the value of @t{RANDOM} is
+referenced or seeded in the parent shell in between subshell invocations.
+
+@vindex SECONDS
+@item @t{SECONDS} <S>
+The number of seconds since shell invocation. If this parameter
+is assigned a value, then the value returned upon reference
+will be the value that was assigned plus the number of seconds
+since the assignment.
+
+@noindent
+Unlike other special parameters, the type of the @t{SECONDS} parameter can
+be changed using the @t{typeset} command. Only integer and one of the
+floating point types are allowed. For example, `@t{typeset -F SECONDS}'
+causes the value to be reported as a floating point number. The
+value is available to microsecond accuracy, although the shell may
+show more or fewer digits depending on the use of @t{typeset}. See
+the documentation for the builtin @t{typeset} in
+@ref{Shell Builtin Commands} for more details.
+
+@vindex SHLVL
+@item @t{SHLVL} <S>
+Incremented by one each time a new shell is started.
+
+@vindex signals
+@item @t{signals}
+An array containing the names of the signals. Note that with
+the standard zsh numbering of array indices, where the first element
+has index 1, the signals are offset by 1 from the signal number
+used by the operating system. For example, on typical Unix-like systems
+@t{HUP} is signal number 1, but is referred to as @t{$signals[2]}. This
+is because of @t{EXIT} at position 1 in the array, which is used
+internally by zsh but is not known to the operating system.
+
+@vindex TRY_BLOCK_ERROR
+@item @t{TRY_BLOCK_ERROR} <S>
+In an @t{always} block, indicates whether the preceding list of code
+caused an error. The value is 1 to indicate an error, 0 otherwise.
+It may be reset, clearing the error condition. See
+@ref{Complex Commands}
+
+@vindex TRY_BLOCK_INTERRUPT
+@item @t{TRY_BLOCK_INTERRUPT} <S>
+This variable works in a similar way to @t{TRY_BLOCK_ERROR}, but
+represents the status of an interrupt from the signal SIGINT, which
+typically comes from the keyboard when the user types @t{^C}. If set to
+0, any such interrupt will be reset; otherwise, the interrupt is
+propagated after the @t{always} block.
+
+@noindent
+Note that it is possible that an interrupt arrives during the execution
+of the @t{always} block; this interrupt is also propagated.
+
+@vindex TTY
+@item @t{TTY}
+The name of the tty associated with the shell, if any.
+
+@vindex TTYIDLE
+@item @t{TTYIDLE} <S>
+The idle time of the tty associated with the shell in seconds or -1 if there
+is no such tty.
+
+@vindex UID
+@item @t{UID} <S>
+The real user ID of the shell process. If you have sufficient privileges,
+you may change the user ID of the shell by assigning to this parameter.
+Also (assuming sufficient privileges), you may start a single command
+under a different
+user ID by `@t{(UID=}@var{uid}@t{; command)}'
+
+@noindent
+If this is made local, it is not implicitly set to 0, but may be
+explicitly set locally.
+
+@vindex USERNAME
+@item @t{USERNAME} <S>
+The username corresponding to the real user ID of the shell process. If you
+have sufficient privileges, you may change the username (and also the
+user ID and group ID) of the shell by assigning to this parameter.
+Also (assuming sufficient privileges), you may start a single command
+under a different username (and user ID and group ID)
+by `@t{(USERNAME=}@var{username}@t{; command)}'
+
+@vindex VENDOR
+@item @t{VENDOR}
+The vendor, as determined at compile time.
+
+@vindex zsh_eval_context
+@vindex ZSH_EVAL_CONTEXT
+@item @t{zsh_eval_context} <S> <Z> (@t{ZSH_EVAL_CONTEXT} <S>)
+An array (colon-separated list) indicating the context of shell
+code that is being run. Each time a piece of shell code that
+is stored within the shell is executed a string is temporarily appended to
+the array to indicate the type of operation that is being performed.
+Read in order the array gives an indication of the stack of
+operations being performed with the most immediate context last.
+
+@noindent
+Note that the variable does not give information on syntactic context such
+as pipelines or subshells. Use @t{$ZSH_SUBSHELL} to detect subshells.
+
+@noindent
+The context is one of the following:
+@table @asis
+@item @t{cmdarg}
+Code specified by the @t{-c} option to the command line that invoked
+the shell.
+
+@item @t{cmdsubst}
+Command substitution using the @t{`}@var{...}@t{`} or
+@t{$(}@var{...}@t{)} construct.
+
+@item @t{equalsubst}
+File substitution using the @t{=(}@var{...}@t{)} construct.
+
+@item @t{eval}
+Code executed by the @t{eval} builtin.
+
+@item @t{evalautofunc}
+Code executed with the @t{KSH_AUTOLOAD} mechanism in order to define
+an autoloaded function.
+
+@item @t{fc}
+Code from the shell history executed by the @t{-e} option to the @t{fc}
+builtin.
+
+@item @t{file}
+Lines of code being read directly from a file, for example by
+the @t{source} builtin.
+
+@item @t{filecode}
+Lines of code being read from a @t{.zwc} file instead of directly
+from the source file.
+
+@item @t{globqual}
+Code executed by the @t{e} or @t{+} glob qualifier.
+
+@item @t{globsort}
+Code executed to order files by the @t{o} glob qualifier.
+
+@item @t{insubst}
+File substitution using the @t{<(}@var{...}@t{)} construct.
+
+@item @t{loadautofunc}
+Code read directly from a file to define an autoloaded function.
+
+@item @t{outsubst}
+File substitution using the @t{>(}@var{...}@t{)} construct.
+
+@item @t{sched}
+Code executed by the @t{sched} builtin.
+
+@item @t{shfunc}
+A shell function.
+
+@item @t{stty}
+Code passed to @t{stty} by the @t{STTY} environment variable.
+Normally this is passed directly to the system's @t{stty} command,
+so this value is unlikely to be seen in practice.
+
+@item @t{style}
+Code executed as part of a style retrieved by the @t{zstyle} builtin
+from the @t{zsh/zutil} module.
+
+@item @t{toplevel}
+The highest execution level of a script or interactive shell.
+
+@item @t{trap}
+Code executed as a trap defined by the @t{trap} builtin. Traps
+defined as functions have the context @t{shfunc}. As traps are
+asynchronous they may have a different hierarchy from other
+code.
+
+@item @t{zpty}
+Code executed by the @t{zpty} builtin from the @t{zsh/zpty} module.
+
+@item @t{zregexparse-guard}
+Code executed as a guard by the @t{zregexparse} command from the
+@t{zsh/zutil} module.
+
+@item @t{zregexparse-action}
+Code executed as an action by the @t{zregexparse} command from the
+@t{zsh/zutil} module.
+
+@end table
+
+@vindex ZSH_ARGZERO
+@item @t{ZSH_ARGZERO}
+If zsh was invoked to run a script, this is the name of the script.
+Otherwise, it is the name used to invoke the current shell. This is
+the same as the value of @t{$0} when the @t{POSIX_ARGZERO} option is
+set, but is always available.
+
+@vindex ZSH_EXECUTION_STRING
+@item @t{ZSH_EXECUTION_STRING}
+If the shell was started with the option @t{-c}, this contains
+the argument passed to the option. Otherwise it is not set.
+
+@vindex ZSH_NAME
+@item @t{ZSH_NAME}
+Expands to the basename of the command used to invoke this instance
+of zsh.
+
+@vindex ZSH_PATCHLEVEL
+@item @t{ZSH_PATCHLEVEL}
+The output of `@t{git describe --tags --long}' for the zsh repository
+used to build the shell. This is most useful in order to keep
+track of versions of the shell during development between releases;
+hence most users should not use it and should instead rely on
+@t{$ZSH_VERSION}.
+
+@item @t{zsh_scheduled_events}
+See @ref{The zsh/sched Module}.
+
+@vindex ZSH_SCRIPT
+@item @t{ZSH_SCRIPT}
+If zsh was invoked to run a script, this is the name of the script,
+otherwise it is unset.
+
+@vindex ZSH_SUBSHELL <S>
+@item @t{ZSH_SUBSHELL}
+Readonly integer. Initially zero, incremented each time the shell forks
+to create a subshell for executing code. Hence `@t{(print $ZSH_SUBSHELL)}'
+and `@t{print $(print $ZSH_SUBSHELL)}' output 1, while
+`@t{( (print $ZSH_SUBSHELL) )}' outputs 2.
+
+@vindex ZSH_VERSION
+@item @t{ZSH_VERSION}
+The version number of the release of zsh.
+
+@end table
+@node Parameters Used By The Shell, , Parameters Set By The Shell, Parameters
+
+@section Parameters Used By The Shell
+@noindent
+The following parameters are used by the shell. Again, `<S>' indicates
+that the parameter is special and `<Z>' indicates that the parameter does
+not exist when the shell initializes in @t{sh} or @t{ksh} emulation mode.
+
+@noindent
+In cases where there are two parameters with an upper- and lowercase
+form of the same name, such as @t{path} and @t{PATH}, the lowercase form
+is an array and the uppercase form is a scalar with the elements of the
+array joined together by colons. These are similar to tied parameters
+created via `@t{typeset -T}'. The normal use for the colon-separated
+form is for exporting to the environment, while the array form is easier
+to manipulate within the shell. Note that unsetting either of the pair
+will unset the other; they retain their special properties when
+recreated, and recreating one of the pair will recreate the other.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@vindex ARGV0
+@item @t{ARGV0}
+If exported, its value is used as the @t{argv[0]} of external commands.
+Usually used in constructs like `@t{ARGV0=emacs nethack}'.
+
+@cindex editing over slow connection
+@cindex slow connection, editing over
+@vindex BAUD
+@item @t{BAUD}
+The rate in bits per second at which data reaches the terminal.
+The line editor will use this value in order to compensate for a slow
+terminal by delaying updates to the display until necessary. If the
+parameter is unset or the value is zero the compensation mechanism is
+turned off. The parameter is not set by default.
+
+@noindent
+This parameter may be profitably set in some circumstances, e.g.
+for slow modems dialing into a communications server, or on a slow wide
+area network. It should be set to the baud
+rate of the slowest part of the link for best performance.
+
+@vindex cdpath
+@vindex CDPATH
+@item @t{cdpath} <S> <Z> (@t{CDPATH} <S>)
+An array (colon-separated list)
+of directories specifying the search path for the @t{cd} command.
+
+@vindex COLUMNS
+@item @t{COLUMNS} <S>
+The number of columns for this terminal session.
+Used for printing select lists and for the line editor.
+
+@vindex CORRECT_IGNORE
+@item @t{CORRECT_IGNORE}
+If set, is treated as a pattern during spelling correction. Any
+potential correction that matches the pattern is ignored. For example,
+if the value is `@t{_*}' then completion functions (which, by
+convention, have names beginning with `@t{_}') will never be offered
+as spelling corrections. The pattern does not apply to the correction
+of file names, as applied by the @t{CORRECT_ALL} option (so with the
+example just given files beginning with `@t{_}' in the current
+directory would still be completed).
+
+@vindex CORRECT_IGNORE_FILE
+@item @t{CORRECT_IGNORE_FILE}
+If set, is treated as a pattern during spelling correction of file names.
+Any file name that matches the pattern is never offered as a correction.
+For example, if the value is `@t{.*}' then dot file names will never be
+offered as spelling corrections. This is useful with the
+@t{CORRECT_ALL} option.
+
+@vindex DIRSTACKSIZE
+@item @t{DIRSTACKSIZE}
+The maximum size of the directory stack, by default there is no limit. If the
+stack gets larger than this, it will be truncated automatically.
+This is useful with the @t{AUTO_PUSHD} option.
+@pindex AUTO_PUSHD, use of
+
+@vindex ENV
+@item @t{ENV}
+If the @t{ENV} environment variable is set when zsh is invoked as @t{sh}
+or @t{ksh}, @t{$ENV} is sourced after the profile scripts. The value of
+@t{ENV} is subjected to parameter expansion, command substitution, and
+arithmetic expansion before being interpreted as a pathname. Note that
+@t{ENV} is @emph{not} used unless the shell is interactive and zsh is
+emulating @cite{sh} or @cite{ksh}.
+
+@vindex FCEDIT
+@item @t{FCEDIT}
+The default editor for the @t{fc} builtin. If @t{FCEDIT} is not set,
+the parameter @t{EDITOR} is used; if that is not set either, a builtin
+default, usually @t{vi}, is used.
+
+@vindex fignore
+@vindex FIGNORE
+@item @t{fignore} <S> <Z> (@t{FIGNORE} <S>)
+An array (colon separated list)
+containing the suffixes of files to be ignored
+during filename completion. However, if completion only generates files
+with suffixes in this list, then these files are completed anyway.
+
+@vindex fpath
+@vindex FPATH
+@item @t{fpath} <S> <Z> (@t{FPATH} <S>)
+An array (colon separated list)
+of directories specifying the search path for
+function definitions. This path is searched when a function
+with the @t{-u} attribute is referenced. If an executable
+file is found, then it is read and executed in the current environment.
+
+@vindex histchars
+@item @t{histchars} <S>
+Three characters used by the shell's history and lexical analysis
+mechanism. The first character signals the start of a history
+expansion (default `@t{!}'). The second character signals the
+start of a quick history substitution (default `@t{^}'). The third
+character is the comment character (default `@t{#}').
+
+@noindent
+The characters must be in the ASCII character set; any attempt to set
+@t{histchars} to characters with a locale-dependent meaning will be
+rejected with an error message.
+
+@vindex HISTCHARS
+@item @t{HISTCHARS} <S> <Z>
+Same as @t{histchars}. (Deprecated.)
+
+@vindex HISTFILE
+@item @t{HISTFILE}
+The file to save the history in when an interactive shell exits.
+If unset, the history is not saved.
+
+@vindex HISTORY_IGNORE
+@item @t{HISTORY_IGNORE}
+If set, is treated as a pattern at the time history files are written.
+Any potential history entry that matches the pattern is skipped. For
+example, if the value is `@t{fc *}' then commands that invoke the
+interactive history editor are never written to the history file.
+
+@noindent
+Note that @t{HISTORY_IGNORE} defines a single pattern: to
+specify alternatives use the
+`@t{(}@var{first}@t{|}@var{second}@t{|}@var{...}@t{)}' syntax.
+
+@noindent
+Compare the @t{HIST_NO_STORE} option or the @t{zshaddhistory} hook,
+either of which would prevent such commands from being added to the
+interactive history at all. If you wish to use @t{HISTORY_IGNORE} to
+stop history being added in the first place, you can define the
+following hook:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zshaddhistory() @{
+ emulate -L zsh
+ ## uncomment if HISTORY_IGNORE
+ ## should use EXTENDED_GLOB syntax
+ # setopt extendedglob
+ [[ $1 != $@{~HISTORY_IGNORE@} ]]
+@}
+@end example
+
+@vindex HISTSIZE
+@item @t{HISTSIZE} <S>
+The maximum number of events stored in the internal history list.
+If you use the @t{HIST_EXPIRE_DUPS_FIRST} option, setting this value
+larger than the @t{SAVEHIST} size will give you the difference as a
+cushion for saving duplicated history events.
+
+@noindent
+If this is made local, it is not implicitly set to 0, but may be
+explicitly set locally.
+
+@vindex HOME
+@item @t{HOME} <S>
+The default argument for the @t{cd} command. This is not set automatically
+by the shell in @t{sh}, @t{ksh} or @t{csh} emulation, but it is typically
+present in the environment anyway, and if it becomes set it has its usual
+special behaviour.
+
+@vindex IFS
+@item @t{IFS} <S>
+Internal field separators (by default space, tab, newline and NUL), that
+are used to separate words which result from
+command or parameter expansion and words read by
+the @t{read} builtin. Any characters from the set space, tab and
+newline that appear in the IFS are called @emph{IFS white space}.
+One or more IFS white space characters or one non-IFS white space
+character together with any adjacent IFS white space character delimit
+a field. If an IFS white space character appears twice consecutively
+in the IFS, this character is treated as if it were not an IFS white
+space character.
+
+@noindent
+If the parameter is unset, the default is used. Note this has
+a different effect from setting the parameter to an empty string.
+
+@vindex KEYBOARD_HACK
+@item @t{KEYBOARD_HACK}
+This variable defines a character to be removed from the end of the
+command line before interpreting it (interactive shells only). It is
+intended to fix the problem with keys placed annoyingly close to return
+and replaces the @t{SUNKEYBOARDHACK} option which did this for
+backquotes only. Should the chosen character be one of singlequote,
+doublequote or backquote, there must also be an odd number of them
+on the command line for the last one to be removed.
+
+@noindent
+For backward compatibility, if the @t{SUNKEYBOARDHACK} option is
+explicitly set, the value of @t{KEYBOARD_HACK} reverts to backquote.
+If the option is explicitly unset, this variable is set to empty.
+
+@vindex KEYTIMEOUT
+@item @t{KEYTIMEOUT}
+The time the shell waits, in hundredths of seconds, for another key to
+be pressed when reading bound multi-character sequences.
+
+@vindex LANG
+@item @t{LANG} <S>
+This variable determines the locale category for any category not
+specifically selected via a variable starting with `@t{LC_}'.
+
+@vindex LC_ALL
+@item @t{LC_ALL} <S>
+This variable overrides the value of the `@t{LANG}' variable and the value
+of any of the other variables starting with `@t{LC_}'.
+
+@vindex LC_COLLATE
+@item @t{LC_COLLATE} <S>
+This variable determines the locale category for character collation
+information within ranges in glob brackets and for sorting.
+
+@vindex LC_CTYPE
+@item @t{LC_CTYPE} <S>
+This variable determines the locale category for character handling
+functions. If the @t{MULTIBYTE} option is in effect this variable or
+@t{LANG} should contain a value that reflects the character set in
+use, even if it is a single-byte character set, unless only the
+7-bit subset (ASCII) is used. For example, if the character set
+is ISO-8859-1, a suitable value might be @t{en_US.iso88591} (certain
+Linux distributions) or @t{en_US.ISO8859-1} (MacOS).
+
+@vindex LC_MESSAGES
+@item @t{LC_MESSAGES} <S>
+This variable determines the language in which messages should be
+written. Note that zsh does not use message catalogs.
+
+@vindex LC_NUMERIC
+@item @t{LC_NUMERIC} <S>
+This variable affects the decimal point character and thousands
+separator character for the formatted input/output functions
+and string conversion functions. Note that zsh ignores this
+setting when parsing floating point mathematical expressions.
+
+@vindex LC_TIME
+@item @t{LC_TIME} <S>
+This variable determines the locale category for date and time
+formatting in prompt escape sequences.
+
+@vindex LINES
+@item @t{LINES} <S>
+The number of lines for this terminal session.
+Used for printing select lists and for the line editor.
+
+@vindex LISTMAX
+@item @t{LISTMAX}
+In the line editor, the number of matches to list without asking
+first. If the value is negative, the list will be shown if it spans at
+most as many lines as given by the absolute value.
+If set to zero, the shell asks only if the top of the listing would scroll
+off the screen.
+
+@vindex LOGCHECK
+@item @t{LOGCHECK}
+The interval in seconds between checks for login/logout activity
+using the @t{watch} parameter.
+
+@vindex MAIL
+@item @t{MAIL}
+If this parameter is set and @t{mailpath} is not set,
+the shell looks for mail in the specified file.
+
+@vindex MAILCHECK
+@item @t{MAILCHECK}
+The interval in seconds between checks for new mail.
+
+@vindex mailpath
+@vindex MAILPATH
+@item @t{mailpath} <S> <Z> (@t{MAILPATH} <S>)
+An array (colon-separated list) of filenames to check for
+new mail. Each filename can be followed by a `@t{?}' and a
+message that will be printed. The message will undergo
+parameter expansion, command substitution and arithmetic
+expansion with the variable @t{$_} defined as the name
+of the file that has changed. The default message is
+`@t{You have new mail}'. If an element is a directory
+instead of a file the shell will recursively check every
+file in every subdirectory of the element.
+
+@vindex manpath
+@vindex MANPATH
+@item @t{manpath} <S> <Z> (@t{MANPATH} <S> <Z>)
+An array (colon-separated list)
+whose value is not used by the shell. The @t{manpath}
+array can be useful, however, since setting it also sets
+@t{MANPATH}, and vice versa.
+
+@item @t{match}
+@itemx @t{mbegin}
+@itemx @t{mend}
+Arrays set by the shell when the @t{b} globbing flag is used in pattern
+matches. See the subsection @emph{Globbing flags} in
+@ref{Filename Generation}.
+
+@item @t{MATCH}
+@itemx @t{MBEGIN}
+@itemx @t{MEND}
+Set by the shell when the @t{m} globbing flag is used in pattern
+matches. See the subsection @emph{Globbing flags} in
+@ref{Filename Generation}.
+
+@vindex module_path
+@vindex MODULE_PATH
+@item @t{module_path} <S> <Z> (@t{MODULE_PATH} <S>)
+An array (colon-separated list)
+of directories that @t{zmodload}
+searches for dynamically loadable modules.
+This is initialized to a standard pathname,
+usually `@t{/usr/local/lib/zsh/$ZSH_VERSION}'.
+(The `@t{/usr/local/lib}' part varies from installation to installation.)
+For security reasons, any value set in the environment when the shell
+is started will be ignored.
+
+@noindent
+These parameters only exist if the installation supports dynamic
+module loading.
+
+@vindex NULLCMD
+@cindex null command style
+@cindex csh, null command style
+@cindex ksh, null command style
+@item @t{NULLCMD} <S>
+The command name to assume if a redirection is specified
+with no command. Defaults to @t{cat}. For @cite{sh}/@cite{ksh}
+behavior, change this to @t{:}. For @cite{csh}-like
+behavior, unset this parameter; the shell will print an
+error message if null commands are entered.
+
+@vindex path
+@vindex PATH
+@item @t{path} <S> <Z> (@t{PATH} <S>)
+An array (colon-separated list)
+of directories to search for commands.
+When this parameter is set, each directory is scanned
+and all files found are put in a hash table.
+
+@vindex POSTEDIT
+@item @t{POSTEDIT} <S>
+This string is output whenever the line editor exits.
+It usually contains termcap strings to reset the terminal.
+
+@vindex PROMPT
+@item @t{PROMPT} <S> <Z>
+@vindex PROMPT2
+@itemx @t{PROMPT2} <S> <Z>
+@vindex PROMPT3
+@itemx @t{PROMPT3} <S> <Z>
+@vindex PROMPT4
+@itemx @t{PROMPT4} <S> <Z>
+Same as @t{PS1}, @t{PS2}, @t{PS3} and @t{PS4},
+respectively.
+
+@vindex prompt
+@item @t{prompt} <S> <Z>
+Same as @t{PS1}.
+
+@vindex PROMPT_EOL_MARK
+@item @t{PROMPT_EOL_MARK}
+When the @t{PROMPT_CR} and @t{PROMPT_SP} options are set, the
+@t{PROMPT_EOL_MARK} parameter can be used to customize how the end of
+partial lines are shown. This parameter undergoes prompt expansion, with
+the @t{PROMPT_PERCENT} option set. If not set, the default behavior is
+equivalent to the value `@t{%B%S%#%s%b}'.
+
+@vindex PS1
+@item @t{PS1} <S>
+The primary prompt string, printed before a command is read.
+It undergoes a special form of expansion
+before being displayed; see
+@ref{Prompt Expansion}. The default is `@t{%m%# }'.
+
+@vindex PS2
+@item @t{PS2} <S>
+The secondary prompt, printed when the shell needs more information
+to complete a command.
+It is expanded in the same way as @t{PS1}.
+The default is `@t{%_> }', which displays any shell constructs or quotation
+marks which are currently being processed.
+
+@vindex PS3
+@item @t{PS3} <S>
+Selection prompt used within a @t{select} loop.
+It is expanded in the same way as @t{PS1}.
+The default is `@t{?# }'.
+
+@vindex PS4
+@item @t{PS4} <S>
+The execution trace prompt. Default is `@t{+%N:%i> }', which displays
+the name of the current shell structure and the line number within it.
+In sh or ksh emulation, the default is `@t{+ }'.
+
+@vindex psvar
+@vindex PSVAR
+@item @t{psvar} <S> <Z> (@t{PSVAR} <S>)
+An array (colon-separated list) whose elements can be used in
+@t{PROMPT} strings. Setting @t{psvar} also sets @t{PSVAR}, and
+vice versa.
+
+@vindex READNULLCMD
+@item @t{READNULLCMD} <S>
+The command name to assume if a single input redirection
+is specified with no command. Defaults to @t{more}.
+
+@vindex REPORTMEMORY
+@item @t{REPORTMEMORY}
+If nonnegative, commands whose maximum resident set size (roughly
+speaking, main memory usage) in kilobytes is greater than this
+value have timing statistics reported. The format used to output
+statistics is the value of the @t{TIMEFMT} parameter, which is the same
+as for the @t{REPORTTIME} variable and the @t{time} builtin; note that
+by default this does not output memory usage. Appending
+@t{" max RSS %M"} to the value of @t{TIMEFMT} causes it to output the
+value that triggered the report. If @t{REPORTTIME} is also in use,
+at most a single report is printed for both triggers. This feature
+requires the @t{getrusage()} system call, commonly supported by
+modern Unix-like systems.
+
+@vindex REPORTTIME
+@item @t{REPORTTIME}
+If nonnegative, commands whose combined user and system execution times
+(measured in seconds) are greater than this value have timing
+statistics printed for them. Output is suppressed for commands
+executed within the line editor, including completion; commands
+explicitly marked with the @t{time} keyword still cause the summary
+to be printed in this case.
+
+@vindex REPLY
+@item @t{REPLY}
+This parameter is reserved by convention to pass string values between
+shell scripts and shell builtins in situations where a function call or
+redirection are impossible or undesirable. The @t{read} builtin and the
+@t{select} complex command may set @t{REPLY}, and filename generation both
+sets and examines its value when evaluating certain expressions. Some
+modules also employ @t{REPLY} for similar purposes.
+
+@vindex reply
+@item @t{reply}
+As @t{REPLY}, but for array values rather than strings.
+
+@vindex RPROMPT
+@item @t{RPROMPT} <S>
+@vindex RPS1
+@itemx @t{RPS1} <S>
+This prompt is displayed on the right-hand side of the screen
+when the primary prompt is being displayed on the left.
+This does not work if the @t{SINGLE_LINE_ZLE} option is set.
+It is expanded in the same way as @t{PS1}.
+
+@vindex RPROMPT2
+@item @t{RPROMPT2} <S>
+@vindex RPS2
+@itemx @t{RPS2} <S>
+This prompt is displayed on the right-hand side of the screen
+when the secondary prompt is being displayed on the left.
+This does not work if the @t{SINGLE_LINE_ZLE} option is set.
+It is expanded in the same way as @t{PS2}.
+
+@vindex SAVEHIST
+@item @t{SAVEHIST}
+The maximum number of history events to save in the history file.
+
+@noindent
+If this is made local, it is not implicitly set to 0, but may be
+explicitly set locally.
+
+@vindex SPROMPT
+@item @t{SPROMPT} <S>
+The prompt used for spelling correction. The sequence
+`@t{%R}' expands to the string which presumably needs spelling
+correction, and `@t{%r}' expands to the proposed correction.
+All other prompt escapes are also allowed.
+
+@noindent
+The actions available at the prompt are @t{[nyae]}:
+@table @asis
+@item @t{n} (`no') (default)
+Discard the correction and run the command.
+@item @t{y} (`yes')
+Make the correction and run the command.
+@item @t{a} (`abort')
+Discard the entire command line without running it.
+@item @t{e} (`edit')
+Resume editing the command line.
+@end table
+
+@vindex STTY
+@item @t{STTY}
+If this parameter is set in a command's environment, the shell runs the
+@t{stty} command with the value of this parameter as arguments in order to
+set up the terminal before executing the command. The modes apply only to the
+command, and are reset when it finishes or is suspended. If the command is
+suspended and continued later with the @t{fg} or @t{wait} builtins it will
+see the modes specified by @t{STTY}, as if it were not suspended. This
+(intentionally) does not apply if the command is continued via `@t{kill
+-CONT}'. @t{STTY} is ignored if the command is run in the background, or
+if it is in the environment of the shell but not explicitly assigned to in
+the input line. This avoids running stty at every external command by
+accidentally exporting it. Also note that @t{STTY} should not be used for
+window size specifications; these will not be local to the command.
+
+@vindex TERM
+@item @t{TERM} <S>
+The type of terminal in use. This is used when looking up termcap
+sequences. An assignment to @t{TERM} causes zsh to re-initialize the
+terminal, even if the value does not change (e.g., `@t{TERM=$TERM}'). It
+is necessary to make such an assignment upon any change to the terminal
+definition database or terminal type in order for the new settings to
+take effect.
+
+@vindex TERMINFO
+@item @t{TERMINFO} <S>
+A reference to your terminfo database, used by the `terminfo' library when the
+system has it; see man page terminfo(5).
+If set, this causes the shell to reinitialise the terminal, making the
+workaround `@t{TERM=$TERM}' unnecessary.
+
+@vindex TERMINFO_DIRS
+@item @t{TERMINFO_DIRS} <S>
+A colon-seprarated list of terminfo databases, used by the `terminfo' library
+when the system has it; see man page terminfo(5). This variable is only
+used by certain terminal libraries, in particular ncurses; see
+man page terminfo(5) to check support on your system. If set, this
+causes the shell to reinitialise the terminal, making the workaround
+`@t{TERM=$TERM}' unnecessary. Note that unlike other colon-separated
+arrays this is not tied to a zsh array.
+
+@vindex TIMEFMT
+@item @t{TIMEFMT}
+The format of process time reports with the @t{time} keyword.
+The default is `@t{%J %U user %S system %P cpu %*E total}'.
+Recognizes the following escape sequences, although not all
+may be available on all systems, and some that are available
+may not be useful:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{%%}
+A `@t{%}'.
+@item @t{%U}
+CPU seconds spent in user mode.
+@item @t{%S}
+CPU seconds spent in kernel mode.
+@item @t{%E}
+Elapsed time in seconds.
+@item @t{%P}
+The CPU percentage, computed as
+100*(@t{%U}+@t{%S})/@t{%E}.
+@item @t{%W}
+Number of times the process was swapped.
+@item @t{%X}
+The average amount in (shared) text space used in kilobytes.
+@item @t{%D}
+The average amount in (unshared) data/stack space used in
+kilobytes.
+@item @t{%K}
+The total space used (@t{%X}+@t{%D}) in kilobytes.
+@item @t{%M}
+The maximum memory the process had in use at any time in
+kilobytes.
+@item @t{%F}
+The number of major page faults (page needed to be brought
+from disk).
+@item @t{%R}
+The number of minor page faults.
+@item @t{%I}
+The number of input operations.
+@item @t{%O}
+The number of output operations.
+@item @t{%r}
+The number of socket messages received.
+@item @t{%s}
+The number of socket messages sent.
+@item @t{%k}
+The number of signals received.
+@item @t{%w}
+Number of voluntary context switches (waits).
+@item @t{%c}
+Number of involuntary context switches.
+@item @t{%J}
+The name of this job.
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+A star may be inserted between the percent sign and flags printing time
+(e.g., `@t{%*E}'); this causes the time to be printed in
+`@var{hh}@t{:}@var{mm}@t{:}@var{ss}@t{.}@var{ttt}'
+format (hours and minutes are only printed if they are not zero).
+Alternatively, `@t{m}' or `@t{u}' may be used (e.g., `@t{%mE}') to produce
+time output in milliseconds or microseconds, respectively.
+
+@vindex TMOUT
+@item @t{TMOUT}
+If this parameter is nonzero, the shell will receive an @t{ALRM}
+signal if a command is not entered within the specified number of
+seconds after issuing a prompt. If there is a trap on @t{SIGALRM}, it
+will be executed and a new alarm is scheduled using the value of the
+@t{TMOUT} parameter after executing the trap. If no trap is set, and
+the idle time of the terminal is not less than the value of the
+@t{TMOUT} parameter, zsh terminates. Otherwise a new alarm is
+scheduled to @t{TMOUT} seconds after the last keypress.
+
+@vindex TMPPREFIX
+@item @t{TMPPREFIX}
+A pathname prefix which the shell will use for all temporary files.
+Note that this should include an initial part for the file name as
+well as any directory names. The default is `@t{/tmp/zsh}'.
+
+@vindex TMPSUFFIX
+@item @t{TMPSUFFIX}
+A filename suffix which the shell will use for temporary files created
+by process substitutions (e.g., `@t{=(@var{list})}').
+Note that the value should include a leading dot `@t{.}' if intended
+to be interpreted as a file extension. The default is not to append
+any suffix, thus this parameter should be assigned only when needed
+and then unset again.
+
+@vindex watch
+@vindex WATCH
+@item @t{watch} <S> <Z> (@t{WATCH} <S>)
+An array (colon-separated list) of login/logout events to report.
+
+@noindent
+If it contains the single word `@t{all}', then all login/logout events
+are reported. If it contains the single word `@t{notme}', then all
+events are reported as with `@t{all}' except @t{$USERNAME}.
+
+@noindent
+An entry in this list may consist of a username,
+an `@t{@@}' followed by a remote hostname,
+and a `@t{%}' followed by a line (tty). Any of these may
+be a pattern (be sure to quote this during the assignment to
+@t{watch} so that it does not immediately perform file generation);
+the setting of the @t{EXTENDED_GLOB} option is respected.
+Any or all of these components may be present in an entry;
+if a login/logout event matches all of them,
+it is reported.
+
+@noindent
+For example, with the @t{EXTENDED_GLOB} option set, the following:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+watch=('^(pws|barts)')
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+causes reports for activity associated with any user other than @t{pws}
+or @t{barts}.
+
+@vindex WATCHFMT
+@item @t{WATCHFMT}
+The format of login/logout reports if the @t{watch} parameter is set.
+Default is `@t{%n has %a %l from %m}'.
+Recognizes the following escape sequences:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{%n}
+The name of the user that logged in/out.
+
+@item @t{%a}
+The observed action, i.e. "logged on" or "logged off".
+
+@item @t{%l}
+The line (tty) the user is logged in on.
+
+@item @t{%M}
+The full hostname of the remote host.
+
+@item @t{%m}
+The hostname up to the first `@t{.}'. If only the
+IP address is available or the utmp field contains
+the name of an X-windows display, the whole name is printed.
+
+@noindent
+@emph{NOTE:}
+The `@t{%m}' and `@t{%M}' escapes will work only if there is a host name
+field in the utmp on your machine. Otherwise they are
+treated as ordinary strings.
+
+@item @t{%S} (@t{%s})
+Start (stop) standout mode.
+
+@item @t{%U} (@t{%u})
+Start (stop) underline mode.
+
+@item @t{%B} (@t{%b})
+Start (stop) boldface mode.
+
+@item @t{%t}
+@itemx @t{%@@}
+The time, in 12-hour, am/pm format.
+
+@item @t{%T}
+The time, in 24-hour format.
+
+@item @t{%w}
+The date in `@var{day}@t{-}@var{dd}' format.
+
+@item @t{%W}
+The date in `@var{mm}@t{/}@var{dd}@t{/}@var{yy}' format.
+
+@item @t{%D}
+The date in `@var{yy}@t{-}@var{mm}@t{-}@var{dd}' format.
+
+@item @t{%D@{}@var{string}@t{@}}
+The date formatted as @var{string} using the @t{strftime} function, with
+zsh extensions as described by
+@ref{Prompt Expansion}.
+
+@item @t{%(}@var{x}@t{:}@var{true-text}@t{:}@var{false-text}@t{)}
+Specifies a ternary expression.
+The character following the @var{x} is
+arbitrary; the same character is used to separate the text
+for the "true" result from that for the "false" result.
+Both the separator and the right parenthesis may be escaped
+with a backslash.
+Ternary expressions may be nested.
+
+@noindent
+The test character @var{x} may be any one of `@t{l}', `@t{n}', `@t{m}'
+or `@t{M}', which indicate a `true' result if the corresponding
+escape sequence would return a non-empty value; or it may be `@t{a}',
+which indicates a `true' result if the watched user has logged in,
+or `false' if he has logged out.
+Other characters evaluate to neither true nor false; the entire
+expression is omitted in this case.
+
+@noindent
+If the result is `true', then the @var{true-text}
+is formatted according to the rules above and printed,
+and the @var{false-text} is skipped.
+If `false', the @var{true-text} is skipped and the @var{false-text}
+is formatted and printed.
+Either or both of the branches may be empty, but
+both separators must be present in any case.
+
+@end table
+
+@vindex WORDCHARS
+@item @t{WORDCHARS} <S>
+A list of non-alphanumeric characters considered part of a word
+by the line editor.
+
+@vindex ZBEEP
+@item @t{ZBEEP}
+If set, this gives a string of characters, which can use all the same codes
+as the @t{bindkey} command as described in
+@ref{The zsh/zle Module}, that will be output to the terminal
+instead of beeping. This may have a visible instead of an audible effect;
+for example, the string `@t{\e[?5h\e[?5l}' on a vt100 or xterm will have
+the effect of flashing reverse video on and off (if you usually use reverse
+video, you should use the string `@t{\e[?5l\e[?5h}' instead). This takes
+precedence over the @t{NOBEEP} option.
+
+@vindex ZDOTDIR
+@item @t{ZDOTDIR}
+The directory to search for shell startup files (.zshrc, etc),
+if not @t{$HOME}.
+
+@vindex zle_bracketed_paste
+@cindex bracketed paste
+@cindex enabling bracketed paste
+@item @t{zle_bracketed_paste}
+Many terminal emulators have a feature that allows applications to
+identify when text is pasted into the terminal rather than being typed
+normally. For ZLE, this means that special characters such as tabs
+and newlines can be inserted instead of invoking editor commands.
+Furthermore, pasted text forms a single undo event and if the region is
+active, pasted text will replace the region.
+
+@noindent
+This two-element array contains the terminal escape sequences for
+enabling and disabling the feature. These escape sequences are used to
+enable bracketed paste when ZLE is active and disable it at other times.
+Unsetting the parameter has the effect of ensuring that bracketed paste
+remains disabled.
+
+@vindex zle_highlight
+@item @t{zle_highlight}
+An array describing contexts in which ZLE should highlight the input text.
+See @ref{Character Highlighting}.
+
+@vindex ZLE_LINE_ABORTED
+@item @t{ZLE_LINE_ABORTED}
+This parameter is set by the line editor when an error occurs. It
+contains the line that was being edited at the point of the error.
+`@t{print -zr -- $ZLE_LINE_ABORTED}' can be used to recover the line.
+Only the most recent line of this kind is remembered.
+
+@vindex ZLE_REMOVE_SUFFIX_CHARS
+@vindex ZLE_SPACE_SUFFIX_CHARS
+@item @t{ZLE_REMOVE_SUFFIX_CHARS}
+@itemx @t{ZLE_SPACE_SUFFIX_CHARS}
+These parameters are used by the line editor. In certain circumstances
+suffixes (typically space or slash) added by the completion system
+will be removed automatically, either because the next editing command
+was not an insertable character, or because the character was marked
+as requiring the suffix to be removed.
+
+@noindent
+These variables can contain the sets of characters that will cause the
+suffix to be removed. If @t{ZLE_REMOVE_SUFFIX_CHARS} is set, those
+characters will cause the suffix to be removed; if
+@t{ZLE_SPACE_SUFFIX_CHARS} is set, those characters will cause the
+suffix to be removed and replaced by a space.
+
+@noindent
+If @t{ZLE_REMOVE_SUFFIX_CHARS} is not set, the default behaviour is
+equivalent to:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+ZLE_REMOVE_SUFFIX_CHARS=$' \t\n;&|'
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+If @t{ZLE_REMOVE_SUFFIX_CHARS} is set but is empty, no characters have this
+behaviour. @t{ZLE_SPACE_SUFFIX_CHARS} takes precedence, so that the
+following:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+ZLE_SPACE_SUFFIX_CHARS=$'&|'
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+causes the characters `@t{&}' and `@t{|}' to remove the suffix but to
+replace it with a space.
+
+@noindent
+To illustrate the difference, suppose that the option @t{AUTO_REMOVE_SLASH}
+is in effect and the directory @t{DIR} has just been completed, with an
+appended @t{/}, following which the user types `@t{&}'. The default result
+is `@t{DIR&}'. With @t{ZLE_REMOVE_SUFFIX_CHARS} set but without including
+`@t{&}' the result is `@t{DIR/&}'. With @t{ZLE_SPACE_SUFFIX_CHARS} set to
+include `@t{&}' the result is `@t{DIR &}'.
+
+@noindent
+Note that certain completions may provide their own suffix removal
+or replacement behaviour which overrides the values described here.
+See the completion system documentation in
+@ref{Completion System}.
+
+@vindex ZLE_RPROMPT_INDENT
+@item @t{ZLE_RPROMPT_INDENT} <S>
+If set, used to give the indentation between the right hand side of
+the right prompt in the line editor as given by @t{RPS1} or @t{RPROMPT}
+and the right hand side of the screen. If not set, the value 1 is used.
+
+@noindent
+Typically this will be used to set the value to 0 so that the prompt
+appears flush with the right hand side of the screen. This is not the
+default as many terminals do not handle this correctly, in particular
+when the prompt appears at the extreme bottom right of the screen.
+Recent virtual terminals are more likely to handle this case correctly.
+Some experimentation is necessary.
+
+@end table
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/options.yo
+@node Options, Shell Builtin Commands, Parameters, Top
+
+@chapter Options
+@noindent
+@cindex options
+@menu
+* Specifying Options::
+* Description of Options::
+* Option Aliases::
+* Single Letter Options::
+@end menu
+@node Specifying Options, Description of Options, , Options
+
+@section Specifying Options
+@noindent
+@cindex options, specifying
+Options are primarily referred to by name.
+These names are case insensitive and underscores are ignored.
+For example, `@t{allexport}' is equivalent to `@t{A__lleXP_ort}'.
+
+@noindent
+The sense of an option name may be inverted by preceding it with
+`@t{no}', so `@t{setopt No_Beep}' is equivalent to `@t{unsetopt beep}'.
+This inversion can only be done once, so `@t{nonobeep}' is @emph{not}
+a synonym for `@t{beep}'. Similarly, `@t{tify}' is not a synonym for
+`@t{nonotify}' (the inversion of `@t{notify}').
+
+@noindent
+Some options also have one or more single letter names.
+There are two sets of single letter options: one used by default,
+and another used to emulate @cite{sh}/@cite{ksh} (used when the
+@t{SH_OPTION_LETTERS} option is set).
+The single letter options can be used on the shell command line,
+or with the @t{set}, @t{setopt} and @t{unsetopt}
+builtins, as normal Unix options preceded by `@t{-}'.
+
+@noindent
+The sense of the single letter options may be inverted by using
+`@t{+}' instead of `@t{-}'.
+Some of the single letter option names refer to an option being off,
+in which case the inversion of that name refers to the option being on.
+For example, `@t{+n}' is the short name of `@t{exec}', and
+`@t{-n}' is the short name of its inversion, `@t{noexec}'.
+
+@noindent
+In strings of single letter options supplied to the shell at startup,
+trailing whitespace will be ignored; for example the string `@t{-f }'
+will be treated just as `@t{-f}', but the string `@t{-f i}' is an error.
+This is because many systems which implement the `@t{#!}' mechanism for
+calling scripts do not strip trailing whitespace.
+
+@noindent
+@node Description of Options, Option Aliases, Specifying Options, Options
+
+@section Description of Options
+@noindent
+@cindex options, description
+In the following list, options set by default in all emulations are marked
+<D>; those set by default only in csh, ksh, sh, or zsh emulations are marked
+<C>, <K>, <S>, <Z> as appropriate. When listing options (by `@t{setopt}',
+`@t{unsetopt}', `@t{set -o}' or `@t{set +o}'), those turned on by default
+appear in the list prefixed with `@t{no}'. Hence (unless
+@t{KSH_OPTION_PRINT} is set), `@t{setopt}' shows all options whose settings
+are changed from the default.
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Changing Directories
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@pindex AUTO_CD
+@pindex NO_AUTO_CD
+@pindex AUTOCD
+@pindex NOAUTOCD
+@cindex cd, automatic
+@item @t{AUTO_CD} (@t{-J})
+If a command is issued that can't be executed as a normal command,
+and the command is the name of a directory, perform the @t{cd}
+command to that directory.
+This option is only applicable if the option @t{SHIN_STDIN} is set,
+i.e. if commands are being read from standard input. The option
+is designed for interactive use; it is recommended that @t{cd}
+be used explicitly in scripts to avoid ambiguity.
+
+@pindex AUTO_PUSHD
+@pindex NO_AUTO_PUSHD
+@pindex AUTOPUSHD
+@pindex NOAUTOPUSHD
+@cindex cd, behaving like pushd
+@cindex pushd, making cd behave like
+@item @t{AUTO_PUSHD} (@t{-N})
+Make @t{cd} push the old directory onto the directory stack.
+
+@pindex CDABLE_VARS
+@pindex NO_CDABLE_VARS
+@pindex CDABLEVARS
+@pindex NOCDABLEVARS
+@cindex cd, to parameter
+@item @t{CDABLE_VARS} (@t{-T})
+If the argument to a @t{cd} command (or an implied @t{cd} with the
+@t{AUTO_CD} option set) is not a directory, and does not begin with a
+slash, try to expand the expression as if it were preceded by a `@t{~}' (see
+@ref{Filename Expansion}).
+
+@pindex CD_SILENT
+@pindex NO_CD_SILENT
+@pindex CDSILENT
+@pindex NOCDSILENT
+@cindex cd, silencing
+@cindex autocd, silencing
+@item @t{CD_SILENT}
+Never print the working directory after a @t{cd} (whether explicit or
+implied with the @t{AUTO_CD} option set). @t{cd} normally prints the
+working directory when the argument given to it was @t{-}, a stack entry, or
+the name of a directory found under @t{CDPATH}. Note that this is distinct
+from @t{pushd}'s stack-printing behaviour, which is controlled by
+@t{PUSHD_SILENT}. This option overrides the printing-related effects of
+@t{POSIX_CD}.
+
+@pindex CHASE_DOTS
+@pindex NO_CHASE_DOTS
+@pindex CHASEDOTS
+@pindex NOCHASEDOTS
+@cindex cd, with .. in argument
+@item @t{CHASE_DOTS}
+When changing to a directory containing a path segment `@t{..}' which would
+otherwise be treated as canceling the previous segment in the path (in
+other words, `@t{foo/..}' would be removed from the path, or if `@t{..}' is
+the first part of the path, the last part of the current working directory
+would be removed), instead resolve the path to the physical directory.
+This option is overridden by @t{CHASE_LINKS}.
+
+@noindent
+For example, suppose @t{/foo/bar} is a link to the directory @t{/alt/rod}.
+Without this option set, `@t{cd /foo/bar/..}' changes to @t{/foo}; with it
+set, it changes to @t{/alt}. The same applies if the current directory
+is @t{/foo/bar} and `@t{cd ..}' is used. Note that all other symbolic
+links in the path will also be resolved.
+
+@pindex CHASE_LINKS
+@pindex NO_CHASE_LINKS
+@pindex CHASELINKS
+@pindex NOCHASELINKS
+@cindex links, symbolic
+@cindex symbolic links
+@item @t{CHASE_LINKS} (@t{-w})
+Resolve symbolic links to their true values when changing directory.
+This also has the effect of @t{CHASE_DOTS}, i.e. a `@t{..}' path segment
+will be treated as referring to the physical parent, even if the preceding
+path segment is a symbolic link.
+
+@pindex POSIX_CD
+@pindex POSIXCD
+@pindex NO_POSIX_CD
+@pindex NOPOSIXCD
+@cindex CDPATH, order of checking
+@item @t{POSIX_CD} <K> <S>
+Modifies the behaviour of @t{cd}, @t{chdir} and @t{pushd} commands
+to make them more compatible with the POSIX standard. The behaviour with
+the option unset is described in the documentation for the @t{cd}
+builtin in
+@ref{Shell Builtin Commands}.
+If the option is set, the shell does not test for directories beneath
+the local directory (`@t{.}') until after all directories in @t{cdpath}
+have been tested, and the @t{cd} and @t{chdir} commands do not recognise
+arguments of the form `@{@t{+}|@t{-}@}@var{n}' as directory stack entries.
+
+@noindent
+Also, if the option is set, the conditions under which the shell
+prints the new directory after changing to it are modified. It is
+no longer restricted to interactive shells (although printing of
+the directory stack with @t{pushd} is still limited to interactive
+shells); and any use of a component of @t{CDPATH}, including a `@t{.}' but
+excluding an empty component that is otherwise treated as `@t{.}', causes
+the directory to be printed.
+
+@pindex PUSHD_IGNORE_DUPS
+@pindex NO_PUSHD_IGNORE_DUPS
+@pindex PUSHDIGNOREDUPS
+@pindex NOPUSHDIGNOREDUPS
+@cindex directory stack, ignoring duplicates
+@item @t{PUSHD_IGNORE_DUPS}
+Don't push multiple copies of the same directory onto the directory stack.
+
+@pindex PUSHD_MINUS
+@pindex NO_PUSHD_MINUS
+@pindex PUSHDMINUS
+@pindex NOPUSHDMINUS
+@cindex directory stack, controlling syntax
+@item @t{PUSHD_MINUS}
+Exchanges the meanings of `@t{+}' and `@t{-}'
+when used with a number to specify a directory in the stack.
+
+@pindex PUSHD_SILENT
+@pindex NO_PUSHD_SILENT
+@pindex PUSHDSILENT
+@pindex NOPUSHDSILENT
+@cindex directory stack, silencing
+@item @t{PUSHD_SILENT} (@t{-E})
+Do not print the directory stack after @t{pushd} or @t{popd}.
+
+@pindex PUSHD_TO_HOME
+@pindex NO_PUSHD_TO_HOME
+@pindex PUSHDTOHOME
+@pindex NOPUSHDTOHOME
+@cindex pushd, to home
+@item @t{PUSHD_TO_HOME} (@t{-D})
+Have @t{pushd} with no arguments act like `@t{pushd $HOME}'.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Completion
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@pindex ALWAYS_LAST_PROMPT
+@pindex NO_ALWAYS_LAST_PROMPT
+@pindex ALWAYSLASTPROMPT
+@pindex NOALWAYSLASTPROMPT
+@item @t{ALWAYS_LAST_PROMPT} <D>
+If unset, key functions that list completions try to return to the last
+prompt if given a numeric argument. If set these functions try to
+return to the last prompt if given @emph{no} numeric argument.
+
+@pindex ALWAYS_TO_END
+@pindex NO_ALWAYS_TO_END
+@pindex ALWAYSTOEND
+@pindex NOALWAYSTOEND
+@item @t{ALWAYS_TO_END}
+If a completion is performed with the cursor within a word, and a
+full completion is inserted, the cursor is moved to the end of the
+word. That is, the cursor is moved to the end of the word if either
+a single match is inserted or menu completion is performed.
+
+@pindex AUTO_LIST
+@pindex NO_AUTO_LIST
+@pindex AUTOLIST
+@pindex NOAUTOLIST
+@cindex completion, listing choices
+@item @t{AUTO_LIST} (@t{-9}) <D>
+Automatically list choices on an ambiguous completion.
+
+@pindex AUTO_MENU
+@pindex NO_AUTO_MENU
+@pindex AUTOMENU
+@pindex NOAUTOMENU
+@cindex completion, menu
+@item @t{AUTO_MENU} <D>
+Automatically use menu completion after the second consecutive request for
+completion, for example by pressing the tab key repeatedly. This option
+is overridden by @t{MENU_COMPLETE}.
+
+@pindex AUTO_NAME_DIRS
+@pindex NO_AUTO_NAME_DIRS
+@pindex AUTONAMEDIRS
+@pindex NOAUTONAMEDIRS
+@cindex directories, named
+@item @t{AUTO_NAME_DIRS}
+Any parameter that is set to the absolute name of a directory
+immediately becomes a name for that directory, that will be used
+by the `@t{%~}'
+and related prompt sequences, and will be available when completion
+is performed on a word starting with `@t{~}'.
+(Otherwise, the parameter must be used in the form `@t{~}@var{param}' first.)
+
+@pindex AUTO_PARAM_KEYS
+@pindex NO_AUTO_PARAM_KEYS
+@pindex AUTOPARAMKEYS
+@pindex NOAUTOPARAMKEYS
+@item @t{AUTO_PARAM_KEYS} <D>
+If a parameter name was completed and a following character
+(normally a space) automatically
+inserted, and the next character typed is one
+of those that have to come directly after the name (like `@t{@}}', `@t{:}',
+etc.), the automatically added character is deleted, so that the character
+typed comes immediately after the parameter name.
+Completion in a brace expansion is affected similarly: the added character
+is a `@t{,}', which will be removed if `@t{@}}' is typed next.
+
+@pindex AUTO_PARAM_SLASH
+@pindex NO_AUTO_PARAM_SLASH
+@pindex AUTOPARAMSLASH
+@pindex NOAUTOPARAMSLASH
+@item @t{AUTO_PARAM_SLASH} <D>
+If a parameter is completed whose content is the name of a directory,
+then add a trailing slash instead of a space.
+
+@pindex AUTO_REMOVE_SLASH
+@pindex NO_AUTO_REMOVE_SLASH
+@pindex AUTOREMOVESLASH
+@pindex NOAUTOREMOVESLASH
+@cindex slash, removing trailing
+@item @t{AUTO_REMOVE_SLASH} <D>
+When the last character resulting from a completion is a slash and the next
+character typed is a word delimiter, a slash, or a character that ends
+a command (such as a semicolon or an ampersand), remove the slash.
+
+@pindex BASH_AUTO_LIST
+@pindex NO_BASH_AUTO_LIST
+@pindex BASHAUTOLIST
+@pindex NOBASHAUTOLIST
+@cindex completion, listing choices, bash style
+@item @t{BASH_AUTO_LIST}
+On an ambiguous completion, automatically list choices when the
+completion function is called twice in succession. This takes
+precedence over @t{AUTO_LIST}. The setting of @t{LIST_AMBIGUOUS} is
+respected. If @t{AUTO_MENU} is set, the menu behaviour will then start
+with the third press. Note that this will not work with
+@t{MENU_COMPLETE}, since repeated completion calls immediately cycle
+through the list in that case.
+
+@pindex COMPLETE_ALIASES
+@pindex NO_COMPLETE_ALIASES
+@pindex COMPLETEALIASES
+@pindex NOCOMPLETEALIASES
+@cindex aliases, completion of
+@item @t{COMPLETE_ALIASES}
+Prevents aliases on the command line from being internally substituted
+before completion is attempted. The effect is to make the alias a
+distinct command for completion purposes.
+
+@pindex COMPLETE_IN_WORD
+@pindex NO_COMPLETE_IN_WORD
+@pindex COMPLETEINWORD
+@pindex NOCOMPLETEINWORD
+@item @t{COMPLETE_IN_WORD}
+If unset, the cursor is set to the end of the word if completion is
+started. Otherwise it stays there and completion is done from both ends.
+
+@pindex GLOB_COMPLETE
+@pindex NO_GLOB_COMPLETE
+@pindex GLOBCOMPLETE
+@pindex NOGLOBCOMPLETE
+@item @t{GLOB_COMPLETE}
+When the current word has a glob pattern, do not insert all the words
+resulting from the expansion but generate matches as for completion and
+cycle through them like @t{MENU_COMPLETE}. The matches are generated as if
+a `@t{*}' was added to the end of the word, or inserted at the cursor when
+@t{COMPLETE_IN_WORD} is set. This actually uses pattern matching, not
+globbing, so it works not only for files but for any completion, such as
+options, user names, etc.
+
+@noindent
+Note that when the pattern matcher is used, matching control (for example,
+case-insensitive or anchored matching) cannot be used. This limitation
+only applies when the current word contains a pattern; simply turning
+on the @t{GLOB_COMPLETE} option does not have this effect.
+
+@pindex HASH_LIST_ALL
+@pindex NO_HASH_LIST_ALL
+@pindex HASHLISTALL
+@pindex NOHASHLISTALL
+@item @t{HASH_LIST_ALL} <D>
+Whenever a command completion or spelling correction is attempted, make
+sure the entire command path is hashed first. This makes the first
+completion slower but avoids false reports of spelling errors.
+
+@pindex LIST_AMBIGUOUS
+@pindex NO_LIST_AMBIGUOUS
+@pindex LISTAMBIGUOUS
+@pindex NOLISTAMBIGUOUS
+@cindex ambiguous completion
+@cindex completion, ambiguous
+@item @t{LIST_AMBIGUOUS} <D>
+This option works when @t{AUTO_LIST} or @t{BASH_AUTO_LIST} is also
+set. If there is an unambiguous prefix to insert on the command line,
+that is done without a completion list being displayed; in other
+words, auto-listing behaviour only takes place when nothing would be
+inserted. In the case of @t{BASH_AUTO_LIST}, this means that the list
+will be delayed to the third call of the function.
+
+@pindex LIST_BEEP
+@pindex NO_LIST_BEEP
+@pindex LISTBEEP
+@pindex NOLISTBEEP
+@cindex beep, ambiguous completion
+@cindex completion, beep on ambiguous
+@item @t{LIST_BEEP} <D>
+Beep on an ambiguous completion. More accurately, this forces the
+completion widgets to return status 1 on an ambiguous completion, which
+causes the shell to beep if the option @t{BEEP} is also set; this may
+be modified if completion is called from a user-defined widget.
+
+@pindex LIST_PACKED
+@pindex NO_LIST_PACKED
+@pindex LISTPACKED
+@pindex NOLISTPACKED
+@cindex completion, listing
+@item @t{LIST_PACKED}
+Try to make the completion list smaller (occupying less lines) by
+printing the matches in columns with different widths.
+
+@pindex LIST_ROWS_FIRST
+@pindex NO_LIST_ROWS_FIRST
+@pindex LISTROWSFIRST
+@pindex NOLISTROWSFIRST
+@cindex completion, listing order
+@item @t{LIST_ROWS_FIRST}
+Lay out the matches in completion lists sorted horizontally, that is,
+the second match is to the right of the first one, not under it as
+usual.
+
+@pindex LIST_TYPES
+@pindex NO_LIST_TYPES
+@pindex LISTTYPES
+@pindex NOLISTTYPES
+@cindex marking file types
+@cindex files, marking type of
+@item @t{LIST_TYPES} (@t{-X}) <D>
+When listing files that are possible completions, show the
+type of each file with a trailing identifying mark.
+
+@pindex MENU_COMPLETE
+@pindex NO_MENU_COMPLETE
+@pindex MENUCOMPLETE
+@pindex NOMENUCOMPLETE
+@cindex completion, menu
+@item @t{MENU_COMPLETE} (@t{-Y})
+On an ambiguous completion, instead of listing possibilities or beeping,
+insert the first match immediately. Then when completion is requested
+again, remove the first match and insert the second match, etc.
+When there are no more matches, go back to the first one again.
+@t{reverse-menu-complete} may be used to loop through the list
+in the other direction. This option overrides @t{AUTO_MENU}.
+
+@pindex REC_EXACT
+@pindex NO_REC_EXACT
+@pindex RECEXACT
+@pindex NORECEXACT
+@cindex completion, exact matches
+@item @t{REC_EXACT} (@t{-S})
+If the string on the command line exactly matches one of the possible
+completions, it is accepted, even if there is another completion (i.e. that
+string with something else added) that also matches.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Expansion and Globbing
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@pindex BAD_PATTERN
+@pindex NO_BAD_PATTERN
+@pindex BADPATTERN
+@pindex NOBADPATTERN
+@cindex globbing, bad pattern
+@cindex filename generation, bad pattern
+@item @t{BAD_PATTERN} (@t{+2}) <C> <Z>
+If a pattern for filename generation is badly formed, print an error message.
+(If this option is unset, the pattern will be left unchanged.)
+
+@pindex BARE_GLOB_QUAL
+@pindex NO_BARE_GLOB_QUAL
+@pindex BAREGLOBQUAL
+@pindex NOBAREGLOBQUAL
+@cindex globbing qualifiers, enable
+@cindex enable globbing qualifiers
+@item @t{BARE_GLOB_QUAL} <Z>
+In a glob pattern, treat a trailing set of parentheses as a qualifier
+list, if it contains no `@t{|}', `@t{(}' or (if special) `@t{~}'
+characters. See @ref{Filename Generation}.
+
+@pindex BRACE_CCL
+@pindex NO_BRACE_CCL
+@pindex BRACECCL
+@pindex NOBRACECCL
+@cindex brace expansion, extending
+@cindex expansion, brace, extending
+@item @t{BRACE_CCL}
+Expand expressions in braces which would not otherwise undergo brace
+expansion to a lexically ordered list of all the characters. See
+@ref{Brace Expansion}.
+
+@pindex CASE_GLOB
+@pindex NO_CASE_GLOB
+@pindex CASEGLOB
+@pindex NOCASEGLOB
+@cindex case-insensitive globbing, option
+@item @t{CASE_GLOB} <D>
+Make globbing (filename generation) sensitive to case. Note that other
+uses of patterns are always sensitive to case. If the option is unset,
+the presence of any character which is special to filename generation
+will cause case-insensitive matching. For example, @t{cvs(/)}
+can match the directory @t{CVS} owing to the presence of the globbing flag
+(unless the option @t{BARE_GLOB_QUAL} is unset).
+
+@pindex CASE_MATCH
+@pindex NO_CASE_MATCH
+@pindex CASEMATCH
+@pindex NOCASEMATCH
+@cindex case-insensitive regular expression matches, option
+@cindex regular expressions, case-insensitive matching, option
+@item @t{CASE_MATCH} <D>
+Make regular expressions using the @t{zsh/regex} module (including
+matches with @t{=~}) sensitive to case.
+
+@pindex CSH_NULL_GLOB
+@pindex NO_CSH_NULL_GLOB
+@pindex CSHNULLGLOB
+@pindex NOCSHNULLGLOB
+@cindex csh, null globbing style
+@cindex null globbing style, csh
+@cindex globbing, null, style, csh
+@item @t{CSH_NULL_GLOB} <C>
+If a pattern for filename generation has no matches,
+delete the pattern from the argument list;
+do not report an error unless all the patterns
+in a command have no matches.
+Overrides @t{NOMATCH}.
+
+@pindex EQUALS
+@pindex NO_EQUALS
+@pindex NOEQUALS
+@cindex filename expansion, =
+@item @t{EQUALS} <Z>
+Perform @t{=} filename expansion.
+(See @ref{Filename Expansion}.)
+
+@pindex EXTENDED_GLOB
+@pindex NO_EXTENDED_GLOB
+@pindex EXTENDEDGLOB
+@pindex NOEXTENDEDGLOB
+@cindex globbing, extended
+@item @t{EXTENDED_GLOB}
+Treat the `@t{#}', `@t{~}' and `@t{^}' characters as part of patterns
+for filename generation, etc. (An initial unquoted `@t{~}'
+always produces named directory expansion.)
+
+@pindex FORCE_FLOAT
+@pindex NO_FORCE_FLOAT
+@pindex FORCEFLOAT
+@pindex NOFORCEFLOAT
+@cindex floating point, forcing use of
+@cindex forcing use of floating point
+@item @t{FORCE_FLOAT}
+Constants in arithmetic evaluation will be treated as
+floating point even without the use of a decimal point; the
+values of integer variables will be converted to floating point when
+used in arithmetic expressions. Integers in any base will be converted.
+
+@pindex GLOB
+@pindex NO_GLOB
+@pindex NOGLOB
+@cindex globbing, enabling
+@cindex enabling globbing
+@item @t{GLOB} (@t{+F}, ksh: @t{+f}) <D>
+Perform filename generation (globbing).
+(See @ref{Filename Generation}.)
+
+@pindex GLOB_ASSIGN
+@pindex NO_GLOB_ASSIGN
+@pindex GLOBASSIGN
+@pindex NOGLOBASSIGN
+@item @t{GLOB_ASSIGN} <C>
+If this option is set, filename generation (globbing) is
+performed on the right hand side of scalar parameter assignments of
+the form `@var{name}@t{=}@var{pattern} (e.g. `@t{foo=*}').
+If the result has more than one word the parameter will become an array
+with those words as arguments. This option is provided for backwards
+compatibility only: globbing is always performed on the right hand side
+of array assignments of the form `@var{name}@t{=(}@var{value}@t{)}'
+(e.g. `@t{foo=(*)}') and this form is recommended for clarity;
+with this option set, it is not possible to predict whether the result
+will be an array or a scalar.
+
+@pindex GLOB_DOTS
+@pindex NO_GLOB_DOTS
+@pindex GLOBDOTS
+@pindex NOGLOBDOTS
+@cindex globbing, of . files
+@item @t{GLOB_DOTS} (@t{-4})
+Do not require a leading `@t{.}' in a filename to be matched explicitly.
+
+@pindex GLOB_STAR_SHORT
+@pindex NO_GLOB_STAR_SHORT
+@pindex GLOBSTARSHORT
+@pindex NOGLOBSTARSHORT
+@cindex globbing, short forms
+@cindex globbing, ** special
+@item @t{GLOB_STAR_SHORT}
+When this option is set and the default zsh-style globbing is in
+effect, the pattern `@t{**/*}' can be abbreviated to `@t{**}' and the
+pattern `@t{***/*}' can be abbreviated to @t{***}. Hence `@t{**.c}'
+finds a file ending in @t{.c} in any subdirectory, and `@t{***.c}' does
+the same while also following symbolic links. A @t{/} immediately
+after the `@t{**}' or `@t{***}' forces the pattern to be treated as the
+unabbreviated form.
+
+@pindex GLOB_SUBST
+@pindex NO_GLOB_SUBST
+@pindex GLOBSUBST
+@pindex NOGLOBSUBST
+@item @t{GLOB_SUBST} <C> <K> <S>
+Treat any characters resulting from parameter expansion as being
+eligible for filename expansion and filename generation, and any
+characters resulting from command substitution as being eligible for
+filename generation. Braces (and commas in between) do not become eligible
+for expansion.
+
+@pindex HIST_SUBST_PATTERN
+@pindex NO_HIST_SUBST_PATTERN
+@pindex HISTSUBSTPATTERN
+@pindex NOHISTSUBSTPATTERN
+@item @t{HIST_SUBST_PATTERN}
+Substitutions using the @t{:s} and @t{:&} history modifiers are performed
+with pattern matching instead of string matching. This occurs wherever
+history modifiers are valid, including glob qualifiers and parameters.
+See
+@ref{Modifiers}.
+
+@pindex IGNORE_BRACES
+@pindex NO_IGNORE_BRACES
+@pindex IGNOREBRACES
+@pindex NOIGNOREBRACES
+@cindex disabling brace expansion
+@cindex brace expansion, disabling
+@cindex expansion, brace, disabling
+@item @t{IGNORE_BRACES} (@t{-I}) <S>
+Do not perform brace expansion. For historical reasons this
+also includes the effect of the @t{IGNORE_CLOSE_BRACES} option.
+
+@pindex IGNORE_CLOSE_BRACES
+@pindex NO_IGNORE_CLOSE_BRACES
+@pindex IGNORECLOSEBRACES
+@pindex NOIGNORECLOSEBRACES
+@item @t{IGNORE_CLOSE_BRACES}
+When neither this option nor @t{IGNORE_BRACES} is set, a sole
+close brace character `@t{@}}' is syntactically significant at any
+point on a command line. This has the effect that no semicolon
+or newline is necessary before the brace terminating a function
+or current shell construct. When either option is set, a closing brace
+is syntactically significant only in command position. Unlike
+@t{IGNORE_BRACES}, this option does not disable brace expansion.
+
+@noindent
+For example, with both options unset a function may be defined
+in the following fashion:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+args() @{ echo $# @}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+while if either option is set, this does not work and something
+equivalent to the following is required:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+args() @{ echo $#; @}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+
+@pindex KSH_GLOB
+@pindex NO_KSH_GLOB
+@pindex KSHGLOB
+@pindex NOKSHGLOB
+@item @t{KSH_GLOB} <K>
+In pattern matching, the interpretation of parentheses is affected by
+a preceding `@t{@@}', `@t{*}', `@t{+}', `@t{?}' or `@t{!}'.
+See @ref{Filename Generation}.
+
+@pindex MAGIC_EQUAL_SUBST
+@pindex NO_MAGIC_EQUAL_SUBST
+@pindex MAGICEQUALSUBST
+@pindex NOMAGICEQUALSUBST
+@item @t{MAGIC_EQUAL_SUBST}
+All unquoted arguments of the form `@var{anything}@t{=}@var{expression}'
+appearing after the command name have filename expansion (that is,
+where @var{expression} has a leading `@t{~}' or `@t{=}') performed on
+@var{expression} as if it were a parameter assignment. The argument is
+not otherwise treated specially; it is passed to the command as a single
+argument, and not used as an actual parameter assignment. For example, in
+@t{echo foo=~/bar:~/rod}, both occurrences of @t{~} would be replaced.
+Note that this happens anyway with @t{typeset} and similar statements.
+
+@noindent
+This option respects the setting of the @t{KSH_TYPESET} option. In other
+words, if both options are in effect, arguments looking like
+assignments will not undergo word splitting.
+
+@pindex MARK_DIRS
+@pindex NO_MARK_DIRS
+@pindex MARKDIRS
+@pindex NOMARKDIRS
+@cindex directories, marking
+@cindex marking directories
+@item @t{MARK_DIRS} (@t{-8}, ksh: @t{-X})
+Append a trailing `@t{/}' to all directory
+names resulting from filename generation (globbing).
+
+@pindex MULTIBYTE
+@pindex NO_MULTIBYTE
+@pindex NOMULTIBYTE
+@cindex characters, multibyte, in expansion and globbing
+@cindex multibyte characters, in expansion and globbing
+@item @t{MULTIBYTE} <D>
+Respect multibyte characters when found in strings.
+When this option is set, strings are examined using the
+system library to determine how many bytes form a character, depending
+on the current locale. This affects the way characters are counted in
+pattern matching, parameter values and various delimiters.
+
+@noindent
+The option is on by default if the shell was compiled with
+@t{MULTIBYTE_SUPPORT}; otherwise it is off by default and has no effect
+if turned on.
+
+@noindent
+If the option is off a single byte is always treated as a single
+character. This setting is designed purely for examining strings
+known to contain raw bytes or other values that may not be characters
+in the current locale. It is not necessary to unset the option merely
+because the character set for the current locale does not contain multibyte
+characters.
+
+@noindent
+The option does not affect the shell's editor, which always uses the
+locale to determine multibyte characters. This is because
+the character set displayed by the terminal emulator is independent of
+shell settings.
+
+@pindex NOMATCH
+@pindex NO_NOMATCH
+@pindex NONOMATCH
+@cindex globbing, no matches
+@item @t{NOMATCH} (@t{+3}) <C> <Z>
+If a pattern for filename generation has no matches,
+print an error, instead of
+leaving it unchanged in the argument list.
+This also applies to file expansion
+of an initial `@t{~}' or `@t{=}'.
+
+@pindex NULL_GLOB
+@pindex NO_NULL_GLOB
+@pindex NULLGLOB
+@pindex NONULLGLOB
+@cindex globbing, no matches
+@item @t{NULL_GLOB} (@t{-G})
+If a pattern for filename generation has no matches,
+delete the pattern from the argument list instead
+of reporting an error. Overrides @t{NOMATCH}.
+
+@pindex NUMERIC_GLOB_SORT
+@pindex NO_NUMERIC_GLOB_SORT
+@pindex NUMERICGLOBSORT
+@pindex NONUMERICGLOBSORT
+@cindex globbing, sorting numerically
+@item @t{NUMERIC_GLOB_SORT}
+If numeric filenames are matched by a filename generation pattern,
+sort the filenames numerically rather than lexicographically.
+
+@pindex RC_EXPAND_PARAM
+@pindex NO_RC_EXPAND_PARAM
+@pindex RCEXPANDPARAM
+@pindex NORCEXPANDPARAM
+@cindex rc, parameter expansion style
+@cindex parameter expansion style, rc
+@item @t{RC_EXPAND_PARAM} (@t{-P})
+Array expansions of the form
+`@var{foo}@t{$@{}@var{xx}@t{@}}@var{bar}', where the parameter
+@var{xx} is set to @t{(}@var{a b c}@t{)}, are substituted with
+`@var{fooabar foobbar foocbar}' instead of the default
+`@var{fooa b cbar}'. Note that an empty array will therefore cause
+all arguments to be removed.
+
+@pindex REMATCH_PCRE
+@pindex NO_REMATCH_PCRE
+@pindex REMATCHPCRE
+@pindex NOREMATCHPCRE
+@cindex regexp, PCRE
+@cindex PCRE, regexp
+@item @t{REMATCH_PCRE}
+If set, regular expression matching with the @t{=~} operator will use
+Perl-Compatible Regular Expressions from the PCRE library.
+(The @t{zsh/pcre} module must be available.)
+If not set, regular expressions will use the extended regexp syntax
+provided by the system libraries.
+
+@pindex SH_GLOB
+@pindex NO_SH_GLOB
+@pindex SHGLOB
+@pindex NOSHGLOB
+@cindex sh, globbing style
+@cindex globbing style, sh
+@item @t{SH_GLOB} <K> <S>
+Disables the special meaning of `@t{(}', `@t{|}', `@t{)}'
+and '@t{<}' for globbing the result of parameter and command substitutions,
+and in some other places where
+the shell accepts patterns. If @t{SH_GLOB} is set but @t{KSH_GLOB} is
+not, the shell allows the interpretation of
+subshell expressions enclosed in parentheses in some cases where there
+is no space before the opening parenthesis, e.g. @t{!(true)}
+is interpreted as if there were a space after the @t{!}. This option is
+set by default if zsh is invoked as @t{sh} or @t{ksh}.
+
+@pindex UNSET
+@pindex NO_UNSET
+@pindex NOUNSET
+@cindex parameters, substituting unset
+@cindex unset parameters, substituting
+@item @t{UNSET} (@t{+u}, ksh: @t{+u}) <K> <S> <Z>
+Treat unset parameters as if they were empty when substituting, and as if
+they were zero when reading their values in arithmetic expansion and
+arithmetic commands.
+Otherwise they are treated as an error.
+
+@pindex WARN_CREATE_GLOBAL
+@pindex NO_WARN_CREATE_GLOBAL
+@pindex WARNCREATEGLOBAL
+@pindex NOWARNCREATEGLOBAL
+@cindex parameters, warning when created globally
+@item @t{WARN_CREATE_GLOBAL}
+Print a warning message when a global parameter is created in a function
+by an assignment or in math context.
+This often indicates that a parameter has not been
+declared local when it should have been. Parameters explicitly declared
+global from within a function using @t{typeset -g} do not cause a warning.
+Note that there is no warning when a local parameter is assigned to in
+a nested function, which may also indicate an error.
+
+@pindex WARN_NESTED_VAR
+@pindex NO_WARN_NESTED_VAR
+@pindex WARNNESTEDVAR
+@pindex NO_WARNNESTEDVAR
+@cindex parameters, warning when setting in enclosing scope
+@item @t{WARN_NESTED_VAR}
+Print a warning message when an existing parameter from an
+enclosing function scope, or global, is set in a function
+by an assignment or in math context. Assignment to shell
+special parameters does not cause a warning. This is the companion
+to @t{WARN_CREATE_GLOBAL} as in this case the warning is only
+printed when a parameter is @emph{not} created. Where possible,
+use of @t{typeset -g} to set the parameter suppresses the error,
+but note that this needs to be used every time the parameter is set.
+To restrict the effect of this option to a single function scope,
+use `@t{functions -W}'.
+
+@noindent
+For example, the following code produces a warning for the assignment
+inside the function @t{nested} as that overrides the value within
+@t{toplevel}
+
+@noindent
+@example
+toplevel() @{
+ local foo="in fn"
+ nested
+@}
+nested() @{
+ foo="in nested"
+@}
+setopt warn_nested_var
+toplevel
+@end example
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection History
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@pindex APPEND_HISTORY
+@pindex NO_APPEND_HISTORY
+@pindex APPENDHISTORY
+@pindex NOAPPENDHISTORY
+@cindex history, appending to a file
+@item @t{APPEND_HISTORY} <D>
+If this is set, zsh sessions will append their history list to
+the history file, rather than replace it. Thus, multiple parallel
+zsh sessions will all have the new entries from their history lists
+added to the history file, in the order that they exit.
+The file will still be periodically re-written to trim it when the
+number of lines grows 20% beyond the value specified by
+@t{$SAVEHIST} (see also the @t{HIST_SAVE_BY_COPY} option).
+
+@pindex BANG_HIST
+@pindex NO_BANG_HIST
+@pindex BANGHIST
+@pindex NOBANGHIST
+@cindex history, enable substitution
+@cindex enable history substitution
+@item @t{BANG_HIST} (@t{+K}) <C> <Z>
+Perform textual history expansion, @cite{csh}-style,
+treating the character `@t{!}' specially.
+
+@pindex EXTENDED_HISTORY
+@pindex NO_EXTENDED_HISTORY
+@pindex EXTENDEDHISTORY
+@pindex NOEXTENDEDHISTORY
+@cindex history, timestamping
+@item @t{EXTENDED_HISTORY} <C>
+Save each command's beginning timestamp (in seconds since the epoch)
+and the duration (in seconds) to the history file. The format of
+this prefixed data is:
+
+@noindent
+`@t{: }@var{<beginning time>}@t{:}@var{<elapsed seconds>}@t{;}@var{<command>}'.
+
+@pindex HIST_ALLOW_CLOBBER
+@pindex NO_HIST_ALLOW_CLOBBER
+@pindex HISTALLOWCLOBBER
+@pindex NOHISTALLOWCLOBBER
+@item @t{HIST_ALLOW_CLOBBER}
+Add `@t{|}' to output redirections in the history. This allows history
+references to clobber files even when @t{CLOBBER} is unset.
+
+@pindex HIST_BEEP
+@pindex NO_HIST_BEEP
+@pindex HISTBEEP
+@pindex NOHISTBEEP
+@cindex history beeping
+@cindex beep, history
+@item @t{HIST_BEEP} <D>
+Beep in ZLE when a widget attempts to access a history entry which
+isn't there.
+
+@pindex HIST_EXPIRE_DUPS_FIRST
+@pindex NO_HIST_EXPIRE_DUPS_FIRST
+@pindex HISTEXPIREDUPSFIRST
+@pindex NOHISTEXPIREDUPSFIRST
+@cindex history, expiring duplicates
+@item @t{HIST_EXPIRE_DUPS_FIRST}
+If the internal history needs to be trimmed to add the current command line,
+setting this option will cause the oldest history event that has a duplicate
+to be lost before losing a unique event from the list.
+You should be sure to set the value of @t{HISTSIZE} to a larger number
+than @t{SAVEHIST} in order to give you some room for the duplicated
+events, otherwise this option will behave just like
+@t{HIST_IGNORE_ALL_DUPS} once the history fills up with unique events.
+
+@pindex HIST_FCNTL_LOCK
+@pindex NO_HIST_FCNTL_LOCK
+@pindex HISTFCNTLLOCK
+@pindex NOHISTFCNTLLOCK
+@item @t{HIST_FCNTL_LOCK}
+When writing out the history file, by default zsh uses ad-hoc file locking
+to avoid known problems with locking on some operating systems. With this
+option locking is done by means of the system's @t{fcntl} call, where
+this method is available. On recent operating systems this may
+provide better performance, in particular avoiding history corruption when
+files are stored on NFS.
+
+@pindex HIST_FIND_NO_DUPS
+@pindex NO_HIST_FIND_NO_DUPS
+@pindex HISTFINDNODUPS
+@pindex NOHISTFINDNODUPS
+@cindex history, ignoring duplicates in search
+@item @t{HIST_FIND_NO_DUPS}
+When searching for history entries in the line editor, do not display
+duplicates of a line previously found, even if the duplicates are not
+contiguous.
+
+@pindex HIST_IGNORE_ALL_DUPS
+@pindex NO_HIST_IGNORE_ALL_DUPS
+@pindex HISTIGNOREALLDUPS
+@pindex NOHISTIGNOREALLDUPS
+@cindex history, ignoring all duplicates
+@item @t{HIST_IGNORE_ALL_DUPS}
+If a new command line being added to the history list duplicates an
+older one, the older command is removed from the list (even if it is
+not the previous event).
+
+@pindex HIST_IGNORE_DUPS
+@pindex NO_HIST_IGNORE_DUPS
+@pindex HISTIGNOREDUPS
+@pindex NOHISTIGNOREDUPS
+@cindex history, ignoring duplicates
+@item @t{HIST_IGNORE_DUPS} (@t{-h})
+Do not enter command lines into the history list
+if they are duplicates of the previous event.
+
+@pindex HIST_IGNORE_SPACE
+@pindex NO_HIST_IGNORE_SPACE
+@pindex HISTIGNORESPACE
+@pindex NOHISTIGNORESPACE
+@cindex history, ignoring spaces
+@item @t{HIST_IGNORE_SPACE} (@t{-g})
+Remove command lines from the history list when the first character on
+the line is a space, or when one of the expanded aliases contains a
+leading space. Only normal aliases (not global or suffix aliases)
+have this behaviour.
+Note that the command lingers in the internal history until the next
+command is entered before it vanishes, allowing you to briefly reuse
+or edit the line. If you want to make it vanish right away without
+entering another command, type a space and press return.
+
+@pindex HIST_LEX_WORDS
+@pindex NO_HIST_LEX_WORDS
+@pindex HISTLEXWORDS
+@pindex NOHISTLEXWORDS
+@item @t{HIST_LEX_WORDS}
+By default, shell history that is read in from files is split into
+words on all white space. This means that arguments with quoted
+whitespace are not correctly handled, with the consequence that
+references to words in history lines that have been read from a file
+may be inaccurate. When this option is set, words read in from a
+history file are divided up in a similar fashion to normal shell
+command line handling. Although this produces more accurately delimited
+words, if the size of the history file is large this can be slow. Trial
+and error is necessary to decide.
+
+@pindex HIST_NO_FUNCTIONS
+@pindex NO_HIST_NO_FUNCTIONS
+@pindex HISTNOFUNCTIONS
+@pindex NOHISTNOFUNCTIONS
+@item @t{HIST_NO_FUNCTIONS}
+Remove function definitions from the history list.
+Note that the function lingers in the internal history until the next
+command is entered before it vanishes, allowing you to briefly reuse
+or edit the definition.
+
+@pindex HIST_NO_STORE
+@pindex NO_HIST_NO_STORE
+@pindex HISTNOSTORE
+@pindex NOHISTNOSTORE
+@item @t{HIST_NO_STORE}
+Remove the @t{history} (@t{fc -l}) command from the history list
+when invoked.
+Note that the command lingers in the internal history until the next
+command is entered before it vanishes, allowing you to briefly reuse
+or edit the line.
+
+@pindex HIST_REDUCE_BLANKS
+@pindex NO_HIST_REDUCE_BLANKS
+@pindex HISTREDUCEBLANKS
+@pindex NOHISTREDUCEBLANKS
+@item @t{HIST_REDUCE_BLANKS}
+Remove superfluous blanks from each command line
+being added to the history list.
+
+@pindex HIST_SAVE_BY_COPY
+@pindex NO_HIST_SAVE_BY_COPY
+@pindex HISTSAVEBYCOPY
+@pindex NOHISTSAVEBYCOPY
+@item @t{HIST_SAVE_BY_COPY} <D>
+When the history file is re-written, we normally write out a copy of
+the file named @t{$HISTFILE.new} and then rename it over the old one.
+However, if this option is unset, we instead truncate the old
+history file and write out the new version in-place. If one of the
+history-appending options is enabled, this option only has an effect
+when the enlarged history file needs to be re-written to trim it
+down to size. Disable this only if you have special needs, as doing
+so makes it possible to lose history entries if zsh gets interrupted
+during the save.
+
+@noindent
+When writing out a copy of the history file, zsh preserves the old
+file's permissions and group information, but will refuse to write
+out a new file if it would change the history file's owner.
+
+@pindex HIST_SAVE_NO_DUPS
+@pindex NO_HIST_SAVE_NO_DUPS
+@pindex HISTSAVENODUPS
+@pindex NOHISTSAVENODUPS
+@item @t{HIST_SAVE_NO_DUPS}
+When writing out the history file, older commands that duplicate
+newer ones are omitted.
+
+@pindex HIST_VERIFY
+@pindex NO_HIST_VERIFY
+@pindex HISTVERIFY
+@pindex NOHISTVERIFY
+@cindex history, verifying substitution
+@item @t{HIST_VERIFY}
+Whenever the user enters a line with history expansion,
+don't execute the line directly; instead, perform
+history expansion and reload the line into the editing buffer.
+
+@pindex INC_APPEND_HISTORY
+@pindex NO_INC_APPEND_HISTORY
+@pindex INCAPPENDHISTORY
+@pindex NOINCAPPENDHISTORY
+@cindex history, incremental appending to a file
+@item @t{INC_APPEND_HISTORY}
+This option works like @t{APPEND_HISTORY} except that new history lines
+are added to the @t{$HISTFILE} incrementally (as soon as they are
+entered), rather than waiting until the shell exits.
+The file will still be periodically re-written to trim it when the
+number of lines grows 20% beyond the value specified by
+@t{$SAVEHIST} (see also the @t{HIST_SAVE_BY_COPY} option).
+
+@pindex INC_APPEND_HISTORY_TIME
+@pindex NO_INC_APPEND_HISTORY_TIME
+@pindex INCAPPENDHISTORYTIME
+@pindex NOINCAPPENDHISTORYTIME
+@cindex history, incremental appending to a file with time
+@item @t{INC_APPEND_HISTORY_TIME}
+This option is a variant of @t{INC_APPEND_HISTORY} in which, where
+possible, the history entry is written out to the file after the
+command is finished, so that the time taken by the command is recorded
+correctly in the history file in @t{EXTENDED_HISTORY} format. This
+means that the history entry will not be available immediately from
+other instances of the shell that are using the same history file.
+
+@noindent
+This option is only useful if @t{INC_APPEND_HISTORY} and
+@t{SHARE_HISTORY} are turned off. The three options should be
+considered mutually exclusive.
+
+@pindex SHARE_HISTORY
+@pindex NO_SHARE_HISTORY
+@pindex SHAREHISTORY
+@pindex NOSHAREHISTORY
+@cindex share history
+@cindex history, sharing
+@item @t{SHARE_HISTORY} <K>
+
+@noindent
+This option both imports new commands from the history file, and also
+causes your typed commands to be appended to the history file (the
+latter is like specifying @t{INC_APPEND_HISTORY}, which should be turned
+off if this option is in effect). The history lines are also output
+with timestamps ala @t{EXTENDED_HISTORY} (which makes it easier to find
+the spot where we left off reading the file after it gets re-written).
+
+@noindent
+By default, history movement commands visit the imported lines as
+well as the local lines, but you can toggle this on and off with the
+set-local-history zle binding. It is also possible to create a zle
+widget that will make some commands ignore imported commands, and
+some include them.
+
+@noindent
+If you find that you want more control over when commands
+get imported, you may wish to turn @t{SHARE_HISTORY} off,
+@t{INC_APPEND_HISTORY} or @t{INC_APPEND_HISTORY_TIME} (see above) on,
+and then manually import commands whenever you need them using `@t{fc
+-RI}'.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Initialisation
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@pindex ALL_EXPORT
+@pindex NO_ALL_EXPORT
+@pindex ALLEXPORT
+@pindex NOALLEXPORT
+@cindex export, automatic
+@item @t{ALL_EXPORT} (@t{-a}, ksh: @t{-a})
+All parameters subsequently defined are automatically exported.
+
+@pindex GLOBAL_EXPORT
+@pindex NO_GLOBAL_EXPORT
+@pindex GLOBALEXPORT
+@pindex NOGLOBALEXPORT
+@cindex environment, and local parameters
+@item @t{GLOBAL_EXPORT} <Z>
+If this option is set, passing the @t{-x} flag to the builtins @t{declare},
+@t{float}, @t{integer}, @t{readonly} and @t{typeset} (but not @t{local})
+will also set the @t{-g} flag; hence parameters exported to
+the environment will not be made local to the enclosing function, unless
+they were already or the flag @t{+g} is given explicitly. If the option is
+unset, exported parameters will be made local in just the same way as any
+other parameter.
+
+@noindent
+This option is set by default for backward compatibility; it is not
+recommended that its behaviour be relied upon. Note that the builtin
+@t{export} always sets both the @t{-x} and @t{-g} flags, and hence its
+effect extends beyond the scope of the enclosing function; this is the
+most portable way to achieve this behaviour.
+
+@cindex exporting, and local parameters
+@pindex GLOBAL_RCS
+@pindex NO_GLOBAL_RCS
+@pindex GLOBALRCS
+@pindex NOGLOBALRCS
+@cindex startup files, global, inhibiting
+@cindex files, global startup, inhibiting
+@item @t{GLOBAL_RCS} (@t{-d}) <D>
+If this option is unset, the startup files @t{/etc/zprofile},
+@t{/etc/zshrc}, @t{/etc/zlogin} and @t{/etc/zlogout} will not be run. It
+can be disabled and re-enabled at any time, including inside local startup
+files (@t{.zshrc}, etc.).
+
+@pindex RCS
+@pindex NO_RCS
+@pindex NORCS
+@cindex startup files, sourcing
+@item @t{RCS} (@t{+f}) <D>
+After @t{/etc/zshenv} is sourced on startup, source the
+@t{.zshenv}, @t{/etc/zprofile}, @t{.zprofile},
+@t{/etc/zshrc}, @t{.zshrc}, @t{/etc/zlogin}, @t{.zlogin}, and @t{.zlogout}
+files, as described in @ref{Files}.
+If this option is unset, the @t{/etc/zshenv} file is still sourced, but any
+of the others will not be; it can be set at any time to prevent the
+remaining startup files after the currently executing one from
+being sourced.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Input/Output
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@pindex ALIASES
+@pindex NO_ALIASES
+@pindex NOALIASES
+@cindex aliases, expansion
+@item @t{ALIASES} <D>
+Expand aliases.
+
+@pindex CLOBBER
+@pindex NO_CLOBBER
+@pindex NOCLOBBER
+@cindex clobbering, of files
+@cindex file clobbering, allowing
+@item @t{CLOBBER} (@t{+C}, ksh: @t{+C}) <D>
+Allows `@t{>}' redirection to truncate existing files.
+Otherwise `@t{>!}' or `@t{>|}' must be used to truncate a file.
+
+@noindent
+If the option is not set, and the option @t{APPEND_CREATE} is also
+not set, `@t{>>!}' or `@t{>>|}' must be used to create a file.
+If either option is set, `@t{>>}' may be used.
+
+@pindex CORRECT
+@pindex NO_CORRECT
+@pindex NOCORRECT
+@cindex correction, spelling
+@cindex spelling correction
+@item @t{CORRECT} (@t{-0})
+Try to correct the spelling of commands.
+Note that, when the @t{HASH_LIST_ALL} option is not set or when some
+directories in the path are not readable, this may falsely report spelling
+errors the first time some commands are used.
+
+@noindent
+The shell variable @t{CORRECT_IGNORE} may be set to a pattern to
+match words that will never be offered as corrections.
+
+@pindex CORRECT_ALL
+@pindex NO_CORRECT_ALL
+@pindex CORRECTALL
+@pindex NOCORRECTALL
+@item @t{CORRECT_ALL} (@t{-O})
+Try to correct the spelling of all arguments in a line.
+
+@noindent
+The shell variable @t{CORRECT_IGNORE_FILE} may be set to a pattern to
+match file names that will never be offered as corrections.
+
+@pindex DVORAK
+@pindex NO_DVORAK
+@pindex NODVORAK
+@item @t{DVORAK}
+Use the Dvorak keyboard instead of the standard qwerty keyboard as a basis
+for examining spelling mistakes for the @t{CORRECT} and @t{CORRECT_ALL}
+options and the @t{spell-word} editor command.
+
+@pindex FLOW_CONTROL
+@pindex NO_FLOW_CONTROL
+@pindex FLOWCONTROL
+@pindex NOFLOWCONTROL
+@cindex flow control
+@item @t{FLOW_CONTROL} <D>
+If this option is unset,
+output flow control via start/stop characters (usually assigned to
+^S/^Q) is disabled in the shell's editor.
+
+@pindex IGNORE_EOF
+@pindex NO_IGNORE_EOF
+@pindex IGNOREEOF
+@pindex NOIGNOREEOF
+@cindex EOF, ignoring
+@item @t{IGNORE_EOF} (@t{-7})
+Do not exit on end-of-file. Require the use
+of @t{exit} or @t{logout} instead.
+However, ten consecutive EOFs will cause the shell to exit anyway,
+to avoid the shell hanging if its tty goes away.
+
+@noindent
+Also, if this option is set and the Zsh Line Editor is used, widgets
+implemented by shell functions can be bound to EOF (normally
+Control-D) without printing the normal warning message. This works
+only for normal widgets, not for completion widgets.
+
+@pindex INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS
+@pindex NO_INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS
+@pindex INTERACTIVECOMMENTS
+@pindex NOINTERACTIVECOMMENTS
+@cindex comments, in interactive shells
+@item @t{INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS} (@t{-k}) <K> <S>
+Allow comments even in interactive shells.
+
+@pindex HASH_CMDS
+@pindex NO_HASH_CMDS
+@pindex HASHCMDS
+@pindex NOHASHCMDS
+@cindex hashing, of commands
+@cindex command hashing
+@item @t{HASH_CMDS} <D>
+Note the location of each command the first time it is executed.
+Subsequent invocations of the same command will use the
+saved location, avoiding a path search.
+If this option is unset, no path hashing is done at all.
+However, when @t{CORRECT} is set, commands whose names do not appear in
+the functions or aliases hash tables are hashed in order to avoid
+reporting them as spelling errors.
+
+@pindex HASH_DIRS
+@pindex NO_HASH_DIRS
+@pindex HASHDIRS
+@pindex NOHASHDIRS
+@cindex hashing, of directories
+@cindex directories, hashing
+@item @t{HASH_DIRS} <D>
+Whenever a command name is hashed, hash the directory containing it,
+as well as all directories that occur earlier in the path.
+Has no effect if neither @t{HASH_CMDS} nor @t{CORRECT} is set.
+
+@pindex HASH_EXECUTABLES_ONLY
+@pindex NO_HASH_EXECUTABLES_ONLY
+@pindex HASHEXECUTABLESONLY
+@pindex NOHASHEXECUTABLESONLY
+@cindex hashing, of executables
+@cindex executables, hashing
+@item @t{HASH_EXECUTABLES_ONLY}
+When hashing commands because of @t{HASH_CMDS}, check that the
+file to be hashed is actually an executable. This option
+is unset by default as if the path contains a large number of commands,
+or consists of many remote files, the additional tests can take
+a long time. Trial and error is needed to show if this option is
+beneficial.
+
+@pindex MAIL_WARNING
+@pindex NO_MAIL_WARNING
+@pindex MAILWARNING
+@pindex NOMAILWARNING
+@cindex mail, warning of reading
+@item @t{MAIL_WARNING} (@t{-U})
+Print a warning message if a mail file has been
+accessed since the shell last checked.
+
+@pindex PATH_DIRS
+@pindex NO_PATH_DIRS
+@pindex PATHDIRS
+@pindex NOPATHDIRS
+@cindex path search, extended
+@item @t{PATH_DIRS} (@t{-Q})
+Perform a path search even on command names with slashes in them.
+Thus if `@t{/usr/local/bin}' is in the user's path, and he or she types
+`@t{X11/xinit}', the command `@t{/usr/local/bin/X11/xinit}' will be executed
+(assuming it exists).
+Commands explicitly beginning with `@t{/}', `@t{./}' or `@t{../}'
+are not subject to the path search.
+This also applies to the `@t{.}' and @t{source} builtins.
+
+@noindent
+Note that subdirectories of the current directory are always searched for
+executables specified in this form. This takes place before any search
+indicated by this option, and regardless of whether `@t{.}' or the current
+directory appear in the command search path.
+
+@pindex PATH_SCRIPT
+@pindex NO_PATH_SCRIPT
+@pindex PATHSCRIPT
+@pindex NOPATHSCRIPT
+@cindex path search, for script argument to shell
+@item @t{PATH_SCRIPT} <K> <S>
+If this option is not set, a script passed as the first non-option argument
+to the shell must contain the name of the file to open. If this
+option is set, and the script does not specify a directory path,
+the script is looked for first in the current directory, then in the
+command path. See
+@ref{Invocation}.
+
+@pindex PRINT_EIGHT_BIT
+@pindex NO_PRINT_EIGHT_BIT
+@pindex PRINTEIGHTBIT
+@pindex NOPRINTEIGHTBIT
+@cindex eight bit characters, printing
+@item @t{PRINT_EIGHT_BIT}
+Print eight bit characters literally in completion lists, etc.
+This option is not necessary if your system correctly returns the
+printability of eight bit characters (see man page ctype(3)).
+
+@pindex PRINT_EXIT_VALUE
+@pindex NO_PRINT_EXIT_VALUE
+@pindex PRINTEXITVALUE
+@pindex NOPRINTEXITVALUE
+@cindex exit status, printing
+@item @t{PRINT_EXIT_VALUE} (@t{-1})
+Print the exit value of programs with non-zero exit status.
+This is only available at the command line in interactive shells.
+
+@pindex RC_QUOTES
+@pindex NO_RC_QUOTES
+@pindex RCQUOTES
+@pindex NORCQUOTES
+@cindex rc, quoting style
+@cindex quoting style, rc
+@item @t{RC_QUOTES}
+Allow the character sequence `@t{@value{dsq}}' to signify a single quote
+within singly quoted strings. Note this does not apply in quoted strings
+using the format @t{$'}@var{...}@t{'}, where a backslashed single quote can
+be used.
+
+@pindex RM_STAR_SILENT
+@pindex NO_RM_STAR_SILENT
+@pindex RMSTARSILENT
+@pindex NORMSTARSILENT
+@cindex rm *, querying before
+@cindex querying before rm *
+@item @t{RM_STAR_SILENT} (@t{-H}) <K> <S>
+Do not query the user before executing `@t{rm *}' or `@t{rm path/*}'.
+
+@pindex RM_STAR_WAIT
+@pindex NO_RM_STAR_WAIT
+@pindex RMSTARWAIT
+@pindex NORMSTARWAIT
+@cindex rm *, waiting before
+@cindex waiting before rm *
+@item @t{RM_STAR_WAIT}
+If querying the user before executing `@t{rm *}' or `@t{rm path/*}',
+first wait ten seconds and ignore anything typed in that time.
+This avoids the problem of reflexively answering `yes' to the query
+when one didn't really mean it. The wait and query can always be
+avoided by expanding the `@t{*}' in ZLE (with tab).
+
+@pindex SHORT_LOOPS
+@pindex NO_SHORT_LOOPS
+@pindex SHORTLOOPS
+@pindex NOSHORTLOOPS
+@item @t{SHORT_LOOPS} <C> <Z>
+Allow the short forms of @t{for}, @t{repeat}, @t{select},
+@t{if}, and @t{function} constructs.
+
+@pindex SUN_KEYBOARD_HACK
+@pindex NO_SUN_KEYBOARD_HACK
+@pindex SUNKEYBOARDHACK
+@pindex NOSUNKEYBOARDHACK
+@cindex sun keyboard, annoying
+@cindex annoying keyboard, sun
+@item @t{SUN_KEYBOARD_HACK} (@t{-L})
+If a line ends with a backquote, and there are an odd number
+of backquotes on the line, ignore the trailing backquote.
+This is useful on some keyboards where the return key is
+too small, and the backquote key lies annoyingly close to it.
+As an alternative the variable @t{KEYBOARD_HACK} lets you choose the
+character to be removed.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Job Control
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@pindex AUTO_CONTINUE
+@pindex NO_AUTO_CONTINUE
+@pindex AUTOCONTINUE
+@pindex NOAUTOCONTINUE
+@cindex jobs, continuing automatically
+@cindex continuing jobs automatically
+@item @t{AUTO_CONTINUE}
+With this option set, stopped jobs that are removed from the job table
+with the @t{disown} builtin command are automatically sent a @t{CONT}
+signal to make them running.
+
+@pindex AUTO_RESUME
+@pindex NO_AUTO_RESUME
+@pindex AUTORESUME
+@pindex NOAUTORESUME
+@cindex jobs, resuming automatically
+@cindex resuming jobs automatically
+@item @t{AUTO_RESUME} (@t{-W})
+Treat single word simple commands without redirection
+as candidates for resumption of an existing job.
+
+@pindex BG_NICE
+@pindex NO_BG_NICE
+@pindex BGNICE
+@pindex NOBGNICE
+@cindex jobs, background priority
+@cindex background jobs, priority of
+@cindex priority of background jobs
+@item @t{BG_NICE} (@t{-6}) <C> <Z>
+Run all background jobs at a lower priority. This option
+is set by default.
+
+@pindex CHECK_JOBS
+@pindex NO_CHECK_JOBS
+@pindex CHECKJOBS
+@pindex NOCHECKJOBS
+@cindex exiting, checking jobs when
+@cindex logging out, checking jobs when
+@item @t{CHECK_JOBS} <Z>
+Report the status of background and suspended jobs before exiting a shell
+with job control; a second attempt to exit the shell will succeed.
+@t{NO_CHECK_JOBS} is best used only in combination with @t{NO_HUP}, else
+such jobs will be killed automatically.
+
+@noindent
+The check is omitted if the commands run from the previous command line
+included a `@t{jobs}' command, since it is assumed the user is aware that
+there are background or suspended jobs. A `@t{jobs}' command run from one
+of the hook functions defined in
+the section Special Functions in @ref{Functions}
+is not counted for this purpose.
+
+@pindex CHECK_RUNNING_JOBS
+@pindex NO_CHECK_RUNNING_JOBS
+@pindex CHECKRUNNINGJOBS
+@pindex NOCHECKRUNNINGJOBS
+@cindex exiting, checking running jobs when
+@cindex logging out, checking running jobs when
+@item @t{CHECK_RUNNING_JOBS} <Z>
+Check for both running and suspended jobs when @t{CHECK_JOBS} is enabled.
+When this option is disabled, zsh checks only for suspended jobs, which
+matches the default behavior of bash.
+
+@noindent
+This option has no effect unless @t{CHECK_JOBS} is set.
+
+@pindex HUP
+@pindex NO_HUP
+@pindex NOHUP
+@cindex jobs, HUP
+@item @t{HUP} <Z>
+Send the @t{HUP} signal to running jobs when the
+shell exits.
+
+@pindex LONG_LIST_JOBS
+@pindex NO_LONG_LIST_JOBS
+@pindex LONGLISTJOBS
+@pindex NOLONGLISTJOBS
+@cindex jobs, list format
+@item @t{LONG_LIST_JOBS} (@t{-R})
+Print job notifications in the long format by default.
+
+@pindex MONITOR
+@pindex NO_MONITOR
+@pindex NOMONITOR
+@cindex job control, allowing
+@item @t{MONITOR} (@t{-m}, ksh: @t{-m})
+Allow job control. Set by default in interactive shells.
+
+@pindex NOTIFY
+@pindex NO_NOTIFY
+@pindex NONOTIFY
+@cindex background jobs, notification
+@cindex notification of background jobs
+@item @t{NOTIFY} (@t{-5}, ksh: @t{-b}) <Z>
+Report the status of background jobs immediately, rather than
+waiting until just before printing a prompt.
+
+@pindex POSIX_JOBS
+@pindex POSIXJOBS
+@pindex NO_POSIX_JOBS
+@pindex NOPOSIXJOBS
+@cindex bg, output in POSIX format
+@cindex fg, output in POSIX format
+@cindex job control, in subshell
+@cindex jobs, output in subshell
+@item @t{POSIX_JOBS} <K> <S>
+This option makes job control more compliant with the POSIX standard.
+
+@noindent
+When the option is not set, the @t{MONITOR} option is unset on entry to
+subshells, so that job control is no longer active. When the option is
+set, the @t{MONITOR} option and job control remain active in the
+subshell, but note that the subshell has no access to jobs in the parent
+shell.
+
+@noindent
+When the option is not set, jobs put in the background or foreground
+with @t{bg} or @t{fg} are displayed with the same information that would
+be reported by @t{jobs}. When the option is set, only the text is
+printed. The output from @t{jobs} itself is not affected by the option.
+
+@noindent
+When the option is not set, job information from the parent
+shell is saved for output within a subshell (for example, within a
+pipeline). When the option is set, the output of @t{jobs} is empty
+until a job is started within the subshell.
+
+@noindent
+In previous versions of the shell, it was necessary to enable
+@t{POSIX_JOBS} in order for the builtin command @t{wait} to return the
+status of background jobs that had already exited. This is no longer
+the case.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Prompting
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@pindex PROMPT_BANG
+@pindex NO_PROMPT_BANG
+@pindex PROMPTBANG
+@pindex NOPROMPTBANG
+@cindex prompt, ! expansion
+@item @t{PROMPT_BANG} <K>
+If set, `@t{!}' is treated specially in prompt expansion.
+See
+@ref{Prompt Expansion}.
+
+@pindex PROMPT_CR
+@pindex NO_PROMPT_CR
+@pindex PROMPTCR
+@pindex NOPROMPTCR
+@cindex prompt, with CR
+@item @t{PROMPT_CR} (@t{+V}) <D>
+Print a carriage return just before printing
+a prompt in the line editor. This is on by default as multi-line editing
+is only possible if the editor knows where the start of the line appears.
+
+@pindex PROMPT_SP
+@pindex NO_PROMPT_SP
+@pindex PROMPTSP
+@pindex NOPROMPTSP
+@cindex prompt, save partial lines
+@item @t{PROMPT_SP} <D>
+Attempt to preserve a partial line (i.e. a line that did not end with a
+newline) that would otherwise be covered up by the command prompt due to
+the @t{PROMPT_CR} option. This works by outputting some cursor-control
+characters, including a series of spaces, that should make the terminal
+wrap to the next line when a partial line is present (note that this is
+only successful if your terminal has automatic margins, which is typical).
+
+@noindent
+When a partial line is preserved, by default you will see an inverse+bold
+character at the end of the partial line: a `@t{%}' for a normal user or
+a `@t{#}' for root. If set, the shell parameter @t{PROMPT_EOL_MARK} can be
+used to customize how the end of partial lines are shown.
+
+@noindent
+NOTE: if the @t{PROMPT_CR} option is not set, enabling this option will
+have no effect. This option is on by default.
+
+@pindex PROMPT_PERCENT
+@pindex NO_PROMPT_PERCENT
+@pindex PROMPTPERCENT
+@pindex NOPROMPTPERCENT
+@cindex prompt, % expansion
+@item @t{PROMPT_PERCENT} <C> <Z>
+If set, `@t{%}' is treated specially in prompt expansion.
+See
+@ref{Prompt Expansion}.
+
+@pindex PROMPT_SUBST
+@pindex NO_PROMPT_SUBST
+@pindex PROMPTSUBST
+@pindex NOPROMPTSUBST
+@cindex prompt, parameter expansion
+@item @t{PROMPT_SUBST} <K> <S>
+If set, @emph{parameter expansion}, @emph{command substitution} and
+@emph{arithmetic expansion} are performed in prompts. Substitutions
+within prompts do not affect the command status.
+
+@pindex TRANSIENT_RPROMPT
+@pindex NO_TRANSIENT_RPROMPT
+@pindex TRANSIENTRPROMPT
+@pindex NOTRANSIENTRPROMPT
+@item @t{TRANSIENT_RPROMPT}
+Remove any right prompt from display when accepting a command
+line. This may be useful with terminals with other cut/paste methods.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Scripts and Functions
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@pindex ALIAS_FUNC_DEF
+@pindex NO_ALIAS_FUNC_DEF
+@pindex ALIASFUNCDEF
+@pindex NOALIASFUNCDEF
+@cindex functions, defining with expanded aliases
+@cindex aliases, expanding in function definition
+@item @t{ALIAS_FUNC_DEF} <S>
+By default, zsh does not allow the definition of functions using
+the `@var{name} @t{()}' syntax if @var{name} was expanded as an
+alias: this causes an error. This is usually the desired behaviour, as
+otherwise the combination of an alias and a function based on the same
+definition can easily cause problems.
+
+@noindent
+When this option is set, aliases can be used for defining functions.
+
+@noindent
+For example, consider the following definitions as they might
+occur in a startup file.
+
+@noindent
+@example
+alias foo=bar
+foo() @{
+ print This probably does not do what you expect.
+@}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Here, @t{foo} is expanded as an alias to @t{bar} before the
+@t{()} is encountered, so the function defined would be named
+@t{bar}. By default this is instead an error in native mode. Note that
+quoting any part of the function name, or using the keyword
+@t{function}, avoids the problem, so is recommended when the function
+name can also be an alias.
+
+@pindex C_BASES
+@pindex NO_C_BASES
+@pindex CBASES
+@pindex NOCBASES
+@cindex bases, output in C format
+@cindex hexadecimal, output in C format
+@cindex octal, output in C format
+@item @t{C_BASES}
+Output hexadecimal numbers in the standard C format, for example `@t{0xFF}'
+instead of the usual `@t{16#FF}'. If the option @t{OCTAL_ZEROES} is also
+set (it is not by default), octal numbers will be treated similarly and
+hence appear as `@t{077}' instead of `@t{8#77}'. This option has no effect
+on the choice of the output base, nor on the output of bases other than
+hexadecimal and octal. Note that these formats will be understood on input
+irrespective of the setting of @t{C_BASES}.
+
+@pindex C_PRECEDENCES
+@pindex NO_C_PRECEDENCES
+@pindex CPRECEDENCES
+@pindex NOCPRECEDENCES
+@cindex precedence, operator
+@cindex operator precedence
+@item @t{C_PRECEDENCES}
+This alters the precedence of arithmetic operators to be more
+like C and other programming languages;
+@ref{Arithmetic Evaluation}
+has an explicit list.
+
+@pindex DEBUG_BEFORE_CMD
+@pindex NO_DEBUG_BEFORE_CMD
+@pindex DEBUGBEFORECMD
+@pindex NODEBUGBEFORECMD
+@cindex traps, DEBUG, before or after command
+@cindex DEBUG trap, before or after command
+@item @t{DEBUG_BEFORE_CMD} <D>
+Run the @t{DEBUG} trap before each command; otherwise it is run after
+each command. Setting this option mimics the behaviour of ksh 93; with
+the option unset the behaviour is that of ksh 88.
+
+@pindex ERR_EXIT
+@pindex NO_ERR_EXIT
+@pindex ERREXIT
+@pindex NOERREXIT
+@cindex exit status, trapping
+@item @t{ERR_EXIT} (@t{-e}, ksh: @t{-e})
+If a command has a non-zero exit status, execute the @t{ZERR}
+trap, if set, and exit. This is disabled while running initialization
+scripts.
+
+@noindent
+The behaviour is also disabled inside @t{DEBUG} traps. In this
+case the option is handled specially: it is unset on entry to
+the trap. If the option @t{DEBUG_BEFORE_CMD} is set,
+as it is by default, and the option @t{ERR_EXIT} is found to have been set
+on exit, then the command for which the @t{DEBUG} trap is being executed is
+skipped. The option is restored after the trap exits.
+
+@noindent
+Non-zero status in a command list containing @t{&&} or @t{||} is ignored
+for commands not at the end of the list. Hence
+
+@noindent
+@example
+false && true
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+does not trigger exit.
+
+@noindent
+Exiting due to @t{ERR_EXIT} has certain interactions with asynchronous
+jobs noted in
+@ref{Jobs & Signals}.
+
+@pindex ERR_RETURN
+@pindex NO_ERR_RETURN
+@pindex ERRRETURN
+@pindex NOERRRETURN
+@cindex function return, on error
+@cindex return from function, on error
+@item @t{ERR_RETURN}
+If a command has a non-zero exit status, return immediately from the
+enclosing function. The logic is similar to that for @t{ERR_EXIT},
+except that an implicit @t{return} statement is executed instead of an
+@t{exit}. This will trigger an exit at the outermost level of a
+non-interactive script.
+
+@noindent
+Normally this option inherits the behaviour of @t{ERR_EXIT} that
+code followed by `@t{&&}' `@t{||}' does not trigger a return. Hence
+in the following:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+summit || true
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+no return is forced as the combined effect always has a zero return
+status.
+
+@noindent
+Note. however, that if @t{summit} in the above example is itself a
+function, code inside it is considered separately: it may force a return
+from @t{summit} (assuming the option remains set within @t{summit}), but
+not from the enclosing context. This behaviour is different from
+@t{ERR_EXIT} which is unaffected by function scope.
+
+@pindex EVAL_LINENO
+@pindex NO_EVAL_LINENO
+@pindex EVALLINENO
+@pindex NOEVALLINENO
+@cindex line number, in evaluated expression
+@item @t{EVAL_LINENO} <Z>
+If set, line numbers of expressions evaluated using the builtin @t{eval}
+are tracked separately of the enclosing environment. This applies both
+to the parameter @t{LINENO} and the line number output by the prompt
+escape @t{%i}. If the option is set, the prompt escape @t{%N} will output
+the string `@t{(eval)}' instead of the script or function name as an
+indication. (The two prompt escapes are typically used in the parameter
+@t{PS4} to be output when the option @t{XTRACE} is set.) If
+@t{EVAL_LINENO} is unset, the line number of the surrounding script or
+function is retained during the evaluation.
+
+@pindex EXEC
+@pindex NO_EXEC
+@pindex NOEXEC
+@cindex command execution, enabling
+@item @t{EXEC} (@t{+n}, ksh: @t{+n}) <D>
+Do execute commands. Without this option, commands are
+read and checked for syntax errors, but not executed.
+This option cannot be turned off in an interactive shell,
+except when `@t{-n}' is supplied to the shell at startup.
+
+@pindex FUNCTION_ARGZERO
+@pindex NO_FUNCTION_ARGZERO
+@pindex FUNCTIONARGZERO
+@pindex NOFUNCTIONARGZERO
+@cindex $0, setting
+@item @t{FUNCTION_ARGZERO} <C> <Z>
+When executing a shell function or sourcing a script, set @t{$0}
+temporarily to the name of the function/script. Note that toggling
+@t{FUNCTION_ARGZERO} from on to off (or off to on) does not change the
+current value of @t{$0}. Only the state upon entry to the function or
+script has an effect. Compare @t{POSIX_ARGZERO}.
+
+@pindex LOCAL_LOOPS
+@pindex NO_LOCAL_LOOPS
+@pindex LOCALLOOPS
+@pindex NOLOCALLOOPS
+@cindex break, inside function
+@cindex continue, inside function
+@cindex function, scope of break and continue
+@item @t{LOCAL_LOOPS}
+When this option is not set, the effect of @t{break} and @t{continue}
+commands may propagate outside function scope, affecting loops in
+calling functions. When the option is set in a calling function, a
+@t{break} or a @t{continue} that is not caught within a called function
+(regardless of the setting of the option within that function)
+produces a warning and the effect is cancelled.
+
+@pindex LOCAL_OPTIONS
+@pindex NO_LOCAL_OPTIONS
+@pindex LOCALOPTIONS
+@pindex NOLOCALOPTIONS
+@item @t{LOCAL_OPTIONS} <K>
+If this option is set at the point of return from a shell function,
+most options (including this one) which were in force upon entry to
+the function are restored; options that are not restored are
+@t{PRIVILEGED} and @t{RESTRICTED}. Otherwise, only this option,
+and the @t{LOCAL_LOOPS}, @t{XTRACE} and @t{PRINT_EXIT_VALUE} options are
+restored. Hence if this is explicitly unset by a shell function the
+other options in force at the point of return will remain so.
+A shell function can also guarantee itself a known shell configuration
+with a formulation like `@t{emulate -L zsh}'; the @t{-L} activates
+@t{LOCAL_OPTIONS}.
+
+@pindex LOCAL_PATTERNS
+@pindex NO_LOCAL_PATTERNS
+@pindex LOCALPATTERNS
+@pindex NOLOCALPATTERNS
+@item @t{LOCAL_PATTERNS}
+If this option is set at the point of return from a shell function,
+the state of pattern disables, as set with the builtin command
+`@t{disable -p}', is restored to what it was when the function was
+entered. The behaviour of this option is similar to the effect
+of @t{LOCAL_OPTIONS} on options; hence `@t{emulate -L sh}' (or
+indeed any other emulation with the @t{-L} option) activates
+@t{LOCAL_PATTERNS}.
+
+@pindex LOCAL_TRAPS
+@pindex NO_LOCAL_TRAPS
+@pindex LOCALTRAPS
+@pindex NOLOCALTRAPS
+@item @t{LOCAL_TRAPS} <K>
+If this option is set when a signal trap is set inside a function, then the
+previous status of the trap for that signal will be restored when the
+function exits. Note that this option must be set @emph{prior} to altering the
+trap behaviour in a function; unlike @t{LOCAL_OPTIONS}, the value on exit
+from the function is irrelevant. However, it does not need to be set
+before any global trap for that to be correctly restored by a function.
+For example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+unsetopt localtraps
+trap - INT
+fn() @{ setopt localtraps; trap @value{dsq} INT; sleep 3; @}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+will restore normal handling of @t{SIGINT} after the function exits.
+
+@pindex MULTI_FUNC_DEF
+@pindex NO_MULTI_FUNC_DEF
+@pindex MULTIFUNCDEF
+@pindex NOMULTIFUNCDEF
+@item @t{MULTI_FUNC_DEF} <Z>
+Allow definitions of multiple functions at once in the form `@t{fn1
+fn2}@var{...}@t{()}'; if the option is not set, this causes
+a parse error. Definition of multiple functions with the @t{function}
+keyword is always allowed. Multiple function definitions are not often
+used and can cause obscure errors.
+
+@pindex MULTIOS
+@pindex NO_MULTIOS
+@pindex NOMULTIOS
+@item @t{MULTIOS} <Z>
+Perform implicit @cite{tee}s or @cite{cat}s when multiple
+redirections are attempted (see @ref{Redirection}).
+
+@pindex OCTAL_ZEROES
+@pindex NO_OCTAL_ZEROES
+@pindex OCTALZEROES
+@pindex NOOCTALZEROES
+@cindex octal, arithmetic expressions
+@item @t{OCTAL_ZEROES} <S>
+Interpret any integer constant beginning with a 0 as octal, per IEEE Std
+1003.2-1992 (ISO 9945-2:1993). This is not enabled by default as it
+causes problems with parsing of, for example, date and time strings with
+leading zeroes.
+
+@noindent
+Sequences of digits indicating a numeric base such as the `@t{08}'
+component in `@t{08#77}' are always interpreted as decimal, regardless
+of leading zeroes.
+
+@pindex PIPE_FAIL
+@pindex NO_PIPE_FAIL
+@pindex PIPEFAIL
+@pindex NOPIPEFAIL
+@cindex exit status from pipeline
+@cindex status, on exit from pipeline
+@cindex pipeline, exit status from
+@item @t{PIPE_FAIL}
+By default, when a pipeline exits the exit status recorded by the shell
+and returned by the shell variable @t{$?} reflects that of the
+rightmost element of a pipeline. If this option is set, the exit status
+instead reflects the status of the rightmost element of the pipeline
+that was non-zero, or zero if all elements exited with zero status.
+
+@pindex SOURCE_TRACE
+@pindex NO_SOURCE_TRACE
+@pindex SOURCETRACE
+@pindex NOSOURCETRACE
+@item @t{SOURCE_TRACE}
+If set, zsh will print an informational message announcing the name of
+each file it loads. The format of the output is similar to that
+for the @t{XTRACE} option, with the message @t{<sourcetrace>}.
+A file may be loaded by the shell itself when it
+starts up and shuts down (@t{Startup/Shutdown Files}) or by the use of
+the `@t{source}' and `@t{dot}' builtin commands.
+
+@pindex TYPESET_SILENT
+@pindex NO_TYPESET_SILENT
+@pindex TYPESETSILENT
+@pindex NOTYPESETSILENT
+@item @t{TYPESET_SILENT}
+If this is unset, executing any of the `@t{typeset}' family of
+commands with no options and a list of parameters that have no values
+to be assigned but already exist will display the value of the parameter.
+If the option is set, they will only be shown when parameters are selected
+with the `@t{-m}' option. The option `@t{-p}' is available whether or not
+the option is set.
+
+@pindex VERBOSE
+@pindex NO_VERBOSE
+@pindex NOVERBOSE
+@cindex tracing, of input lines
+@cindex input, tracing
+@item @t{VERBOSE} (@t{-v}, ksh: @t{-v})
+Print shell input lines as they are read.
+
+@pindex XTRACE
+@pindex NO_XTRACE
+@pindex NOXTRACE
+@cindex tracing, of commands
+@cindex commands, tracing
+@item @t{XTRACE} (@t{-x}, ksh: @t{-x})
+Print commands and their arguments as they are executed. The
+output is preceded by the value of @t{$PS4}, formatted as described
+in
+@ref{Prompt Expansion}.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Shell Emulation
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@pindex APPEND_CREATE
+@pindex NO_APPEND_CREATE
+@pindex APPENDCREATE
+@pindex NOAPPENDCREATE
+@cindex clobbering, POSIX compatibility
+@cindex file clobbering, POSIX compatibility
+@cindex no clobber, POSIX compatible
+@item @t{APPEND_CREATE} <K> <S>
+This option only applies when @t{NO_CLOBBER} (-@t{C}) is in effect.
+
+@noindent
+If this option is not set, the shell will report an error when a
+append redirection (@t{>>}) is used on a file that does not already
+exists (the traditional zsh behaviour of @t{NO_CLOBBER}). If the option
+is set, no error is reported (POSIX behaviour).
+
+@pindex BASH_REMATCH
+@pindex NO_BASH_REMATCH
+@pindex BASHREMATCH
+@pindex NOBASHREMATCH
+@cindex bash, BASH_REMATCH variable
+@cindex regexp, bash BASH_REMATCH variable
+@item @t{BASH_REMATCH}
+When set, matches performed with the @t{=~} operator will set the
+@t{BASH_REMATCH} array variable, instead of the default @t{MATCH} and
+@t{match} variables. The first element of the @t{BASH_REMATCH} array
+will contain the entire matched text and subsequent elements will contain
+extracted substrings. This option makes more sense when @t{KSH_ARRAYS} is
+also set, so that the entire matched portion is stored at index 0 and the
+first substring is at index 1. Without this option, the @t{MATCH} variable
+contains the entire matched text and the @t{match} array variable contains
+substrings.
+
+@pindex BSD_ECHO
+@pindex NO_BSD_ECHO
+@pindex BSDECHO
+@pindex NOBSDECHO
+@cindex echo, BSD compatible
+@item @t{BSD_ECHO} <S>
+Make the @t{echo} builtin compatible with the BSD man page echo(1) command.
+This disables backslashed escape sequences in echo strings unless the
+@t{-e} option is specified.
+
+@pindex CONTINUE_ON_ERROR
+@pindex NO_CONTINUE_ON_ERROR
+@pindex CONTINUEONERROR
+@pindex NOCONTINUEONERROR
+@cindex error, option to continue script on
+@item @t{CONTINUE_ON_ERROR}
+If a fatal error is encountered (see
+@ref{Errors}), and the code is running
+in a script, the shell will resume execution at the next statement
+in the script at the top level, in other words outside all functions
+or shell constructs such as loops and conditions. This mimics the
+behaviour of interactive shells, where the shell returns to the
+line editor to read a new command; it was the normal behaviour in versions
+of zsh before 5.0.1.
+
+@pindex CSH_JUNKIE_HISTORY
+@pindex NO_CSH_JUNKIE_HISTORY
+@pindex CSHJUNKIEHISTORY
+@pindex NOCSHJUNKIEHISTORY
+@cindex csh, history style
+@cindex history style, csh
+@item @t{CSH_JUNKIE_HISTORY} <C>
+A history reference without an event specifier will always refer to the
+previous command. Without this option, such a history reference refers
+to the same event as the previous history reference on the current
+command line, defaulting to the previous command.
+
+@pindex CSH_JUNKIE_LOOPS
+@pindex NO_CSH_JUNKIE_LOOPS
+@pindex CSHJUNKIELOOPS
+@pindex NOCSHJUNKIELOOPS
+@cindex csh, loop style
+@cindex loop style, csh
+@item @t{CSH_JUNKIE_LOOPS} <C>
+Allow loop bodies to take the form `@var{list}@t{; end}' instead of
+`@t{do }@var{list}@t{; done}'.
+
+@pindex CSH_JUNKIE_QUOTES
+@pindex NO_CSH_JUNKIE_QUOTES
+@pindex CSHJUNKIEQUOTES
+@pindex NOCSHJUNKIEQUOTES
+@cindex csh, quoting style
+@cindex quoting style, csh
+@item @t{CSH_JUNKIE_QUOTES} <C>
+Changes the rules for single- and double-quoted text to match that of
+@cite{csh}. These require that embedded newlines be preceded by a backslash;
+unescaped newlines will cause an error message.
+In double-quoted strings, it is made impossible to escape `@t{$}', `@t{`}'
+or `@t{"}' (and `@t{\}' itself no longer needs escaping).
+Command substitutions are only expanded once, and cannot be nested.
+
+@pindex CSH_NULLCMD
+@pindex NO_CSH_NULLCMD
+@pindex CSHNULLCMD
+@pindex NOCSHNULLCMD
+@vindex NULLCMD, ignoring
+@vindex READNULLCMD, ignoring
+@cindex redirections with no command, csh
+@cindex csh, redirections with no command
+@item @t{CSH_NULLCMD} <C>
+Do not use the values of @t{NULLCMD} and @t{READNULLCMD}
+when running redirections with no command. This make
+such redirections fail (see @ref{Redirection}).
+
+@pindex KSH_ARRAYS
+@pindex NO_KSH_ARRAYS
+@pindex KSHARRAYS
+@pindex NOKSHARRAYS
+@cindex arrays, ksh style
+@cindex array style, ksh
+@cindex ksh, array style
+@item @t{KSH_ARRAYS} <K> <S>
+Emulate @cite{ksh} array handling as closely as possible. If this option
+is set, array elements are numbered from zero, an array parameter
+without subscript refers to the first element instead of the whole array,
+and braces are required to delimit a subscript (`@t{$@{path[2]@}}' rather
+than just `@t{$path[2]}') or to apply modifiers to any parameter
+(`@t{$@{PWD:h@}}' rather than `@t{$PWD:h}').
+
+@pindex KSH_AUTOLOAD
+@pindex NO_KSH_AUTOLOAD
+@pindex KSHAUTOLOAD
+@pindex NOKSHAUTOLOAD
+@item @t{KSH_AUTOLOAD} <K> <S>
+Emulate @cite{ksh} function autoloading. This means that when a function is
+autoloaded, the corresponding file is merely executed, and must define
+the function itself. (By default, the function is defined to the contents
+of the file. However, the most common @cite{ksh}-style case - of the file
+containing only a simple definition of the function - is always handled
+in the @cite{ksh}-compatible manner.)
+
+@pindex KSH_OPTION_PRINT
+@pindex NO_KSH_OPTION_PRINT
+@pindex KSHOPTIONPRINT
+@pindex NOKSHOPTIONPRINT
+@cindex option printing, ksh style
+@cindex option printing style, ksh
+@cindex ksh, option printing style
+@item @t{KSH_OPTION_PRINT} <K>
+Alters the way options settings are printed: instead of separate lists of
+set and unset options, all options are shown, marked `on' if
+they are in the non-default state, `off' otherwise.
+
+@pindex KSH_TYPESET
+@pindex NO_KSH_TYPESET
+@pindex KSHTYPESET
+@pindex NOKSHTYPESET
+@cindex argument splitting, in typeset etc.
+@cindex ksh, argument splitting in typeset
+@item @t{KSH_TYPESET}
+This option is now obsolete: a better appropximation to the behaviour of
+other shells is obtained with the reserved word interface to
+@t{declare}, @t{export}, @t{float}, @t{integer}, @t{local}, @t{readonly}
+and @t{typeset}. Note that the option is only applied when the reserved
+word interface is @emph{not} in use.
+
+@noindent
+Alters the way arguments to the @t{typeset} family of commands, including
+@t{declare}, @t{export}, @t{float}, @t{integer}, @t{local} and
+@t{readonly}, are processed. Without this option, zsh will perform normal
+word splitting after command and parameter expansion in arguments of an
+assignment; with it, word splitting does not take place in those cases.
+
+@pindex KSH_ZERO_SUBSCRIPT
+@pindex NO_KSH_ZERO_SUBSCRIPT
+@pindex KSHZEROSUBSCRIPT
+@pindex NOKSHZEROSUBSCRIPT
+@cindex arrays, behaviour of index zero
+@item @t{KSH_ZERO_SUBSCRIPT}
+Treat use of a subscript of value zero in array or string expressions as a
+reference to the first element, i.e. the element that usually has the
+subscript 1. Ignored if @t{KSH_ARRAYS} is also set.
+
+@noindent
+If neither this option nor @t{KSH_ARRAYS} is set, accesses to an element of
+an array or string with subscript zero return an empty element or string,
+while attempts to set element zero of an array or string are treated as an
+error. However, attempts to set an otherwise valid subscript range that
+includes zero will succeed. For example, if @t{KSH_ZERO_SUBSCRIPT} is not
+set,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+array[0]=(element)
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+is an error, while
+
+@noindent
+@example
+array[0,1]=(element)
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+is not and will replace the first element of the array.
+
+@noindent
+This option is for compatibility with older versions of the shell and
+is not recommended in new code.
+
+@pindex POSIX_ALIASES
+@pindex NO_POSIX_ALIASES
+@pindex POSIXALIASES
+@pindex NOPOSIXALIASES
+@item @t{POSIX_ALIASES} <K> <S>
+When this option is set, reserved words are not candidates for
+alias expansion: it is still possible to declare any of them as an alias,
+but the alias will never be expanded. Reserved words are described in
+@ref{Reserved Words}.
+
+@noindent
+Alias expansion takes place while text is being read; hence when this
+option is set it does not take effect until the end of any function or
+other piece of shell code parsed as one unit. Note this may
+cause differences from other shells even when the option is in
+effect. For example, when running a command with `@t{zsh -c}',
+or even `@t{zsh -o posixaliases -c}', the entire command argument is parsed
+as one unit, so aliases defined within the argument are not available even
+in later lines. If in doubt, avoid use of aliases in non-interactive
+code.
+
+@pindex POSIX_ARGZERO
+@pindex NO_POSIX_ARGZERO
+@pindex POSIXARGZERO
+@pindex NOPOSIXARGZERO
+@cindex $0, using
+@item @t{POSIX_ARGZERO}
+This option may be used to temporarily disable @t{FUNCTION_ARGZERO} and
+thereby restore the value of @t{$0} to the name used to invoke the shell
+(or as set by the @t{-c} command line option). For compatibility with
+previous versions of the shell, emulations use @t{NO_FUNCTION_ARGZERO}
+instead of @t{POSIX_ARGZERO}, which may result in unexpected scoping of
+@t{$0} if the emulation mode is changed inside a function or script.
+To avoid this, explicitly enable @t{POSIX_ARGZERO} in the @t{emulate}
+command:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+emulate sh -o POSIX_ARGZERO
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Note that @t{NO_POSIX_ARGZERO} has no effect unless @t{FUNCTION_ARGZERO}
+was already enabled upon entry to the function or script.
+
+@pindex POSIX_BUILTINS
+@pindex NO_POSIX_BUILTINS
+@pindex POSIXBUILTINS
+@pindex NOPOSIXBUILTINS
+@item @t{POSIX_BUILTINS} <K> <S>
+When this option is set the @t{command} builtin can be used to execute
+shell builtin commands. Parameter assignments specified before shell
+functions and special builtins are kept after the command completes unless
+the special builtin is prefixed with the @t{command} builtin. Special
+builtins are
+@t{.},
+@t{:},
+@t{break},
+@t{continue},
+@t{declare},
+@t{eval},
+@t{exit},
+@t{export},
+@t{integer},
+@t{local},
+@t{readonly},
+@t{return},
+@t{set},
+@t{shift},
+@t{source},
+@t{times},
+@t{trap} and
+@t{unset}.
+
+@noindent
+In addition, various error conditions associated with the above builtins
+or @t{exec} cause a non-interactive shell to exit and an interactive
+shell to return to its top-level processing.
+
+@noindent
+Furthermore, functions and shell builtins are not executed after
+an @t{exec} prefix; the command to be executed must be an external
+command found in the path.
+
+@noindent
+Furthermore, the @t{getopts} builtin behaves in a POSIX-compatible
+fashion in that the associated variable @t{OPTIND} is not made
+local to functions.
+
+@noindent
+Moreover, the warning and special exit code from
+@t{[[ -o }@var{non_existent_option}@t{ ]]} are suppressed.
+
+@pindex POSIX_IDENTIFIERS
+@pindex NO_POSIX_IDENTIFIERS
+@pindex POSIXIDENTIFIERS
+@pindex NOPOSIXIDENTIFIERS
+@cindex identifiers, non-portable characters in
+@cindex parameter names, non-portable characters in
+@item @t{POSIX_IDENTIFIERS} <K> <S>
+When this option is set, only the ASCII characters @t{a} to @t{z}, @t{A} to
+@t{Z}, @t{0} to @t{9} and @t{_} may be used in identifiers (names
+of shell parameters and modules).
+
+@noindent
+In addition, setting this option limits the effect of parameter
+substitution with no braces, so that the expression @t{$#} is treated as
+the parameter @t{$#} even if followed by a valid parameter name.
+When it is unset, zsh allows expressions of the form @t{$#}@var{name}
+to refer to the length of @t{$}@var{name}, even for special variables,
+for example in expressions such as @t{$#-} and @t{$#*}.
+
+@noindent
+Another difference is that with the option set assignment to an
+unset variable in arithmetic context causes the variable to be created
+as a scalar rather than a numeric type. So after `@t{unset t; (( t = 3
+))}'. without @t{POSIX_IDENTIFIERS} set @t{t} has integer type, while with
+it set it has scalar type.
+
+@noindent
+When the option is unset and multibyte character support is enabled (i.e. it
+is compiled in and the option @t{MULTIBYTE} is set), then additionally any
+alphanumeric characters in the local character set may be used in
+identifiers. Note that scripts and functions written with this feature are
+not portable, and also that both options must be set before the script
+or function is parsed; setting them during execution is not sufficient
+as the syntax @var{variable}@t{=}@var{value} has already been parsed as
+a command rather than an assignment.
+
+@noindent
+If multibyte character support is not compiled into the shell this option is
+ignored; all octets with the top bit set may be used in identifiers.
+This is non-standard but is the traditional zsh behaviour.
+
+@pindex POSIX_STRINGS
+@pindex NO_POSIX_STRINGS
+@pindex POSIXSTRINGS
+@pindex NOPOSIXSTRINGS
+@cindex discarding embedded nulls in $'...'
+@cindex embedded nulls, in $'...'
+@cindex nulls, embedded in $'...'
+@item @t{POSIX_STRINGS} <K> <S>
+This option affects processing of quoted strings. Currently it only
+affects the behaviour of null characters, i.e. character 0 in the
+portable character set corresponding to US ASCII.
+
+@noindent
+When this option is not set, null characters embedded within strings
+of the form @t{$'}@var{...}@t{'} are treated as ordinary characters. The
+entire string is maintained within the shell and output to files where
+necessary, although owing to restrictions of the library interface
+the string is truncated at the null character in file names, environment
+variables, or in arguments to external programs.
+
+@noindent
+When this option is set, the @t{$'}@var{...}@t{'} expression is truncated at
+the null character. Note that remaining parts of the same string
+beyond the termination of the quotes are not truncated.
+
+@noindent
+For example, the command line argument @t{a$'b\0c'd} is treated with
+the option off as the characters @t{a}, @t{b}, null, @t{c}, @t{d},
+and with the option on as the characters @t{a}, @t{b}, @t{d}.
+
+@pindex POSIX_TRAPS
+@pindex NO_POSIX_TRAPS
+@pindex POSIXTRAPS
+@pindex NOPOSIXTRAPS
+@cindex traps, on function exit
+@cindex traps, POSIX compatibility
+@item @t{POSIX_TRAPS} <K> <S>
+When this option is set, the usual zsh behaviour of executing
+traps for @t{EXIT} on exit from shell functions is suppressed.
+In that case, manipulating @t{EXIT} traps always alters the global
+trap for exiting the shell; the @t{LOCAL_TRAPS} option is
+ignored for the @t{EXIT} trap. Furthermore, a @t{return} statement
+executed in a trap with no argument passes back from the function the
+value from the surrounding context, not from code executed within the
+trap.
+
+@pindex SH_FILE_EXPANSION
+@pindex NO_SH_FILE_EXPANSION
+@pindex SHFILEEXPANSION
+@pindex NOSHFILEEXPANSION
+@cindex sh, expansion style
+@cindex expansion style, sh
+@item @t{SH_FILE_EXPANSION} <K> <S>
+Perform filename expansion (e.g., @t{~} expansion) @emph{before}
+parameter expansion, command substitution, arithmetic expansion
+and brace expansion.
+If this option is unset, it is performed @emph{after}
+brace expansion, so things like `@t{~$USERNAME}' and
+`@t{~@{pfalstad,rc@}}' will work.
+
+@pindex SH_NULLCMD
+@pindex NO_SH_NULLCMD
+@pindex SHNULLCMD
+@pindex NOSHNULLCMD
+@vindex NULLCMD, ignoring
+@vindex READNULLCMD, ignoring
+@cindex sh, redirections with no command
+@cindex ksh, redirections with no command
+@cindex redirections with no command, sh
+@cindex redirections with no command, ksh
+@item @t{SH_NULLCMD} <K> <S>
+Do not use the values of @t{NULLCMD} and @t{READNULLCMD}
+when doing redirections, use `@t{:}' instead (see @ref{Redirection}).
+
+@pindex SH_OPTION_LETTERS
+@pindex NO_SH_OPTION_LETTERS
+@pindex SHOPTIONLETTERS
+@pindex NOSHOPTIONLETTERS
+@cindex sh, single letter options style
+@cindex ksh, single letter options style
+@cindex single letter options, ksh style
+@cindex options, single letter, ksh style
+@item @t{SH_OPTION_LETTERS} <K> <S>
+If this option is set the shell tries to interpret single letter options
+(which are used with @t{set} and @t{setopt}) like @cite{ksh} does.
+This also affects the value of the @t{-} special parameter.
+
+@pindex SH_WORD_SPLIT
+@pindex NO_SH_WORD_SPLIT
+@pindex SHWORDSPLIT
+@pindex NOSHWORDSPLIT
+@cindex field splitting, sh style
+@cindex sh, field splitting style
+@item @t{SH_WORD_SPLIT} (@t{-y}) <K> <S>
+Causes field splitting to be performed on unquoted parameter expansions.
+Note that this option has nothing to do with word splitting.
+(See
+@ref{Parameter Expansion}.)
+
+@pindex TRAPS_ASYNC
+@pindex NO_TRAPS_ASYNC
+@pindex TRAPSASYNC
+@pindex NOTRAPSASYNC
+@cindex traps, asynchronous
+@item @t{TRAPS_ASYNC}
+While waiting for a program to exit, handle signals and run traps
+immediately. Otherwise the trap is run after a child process has exited.
+Note this does not affect the point at which traps are run for any case
+other than when the shell is waiting for a child process.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Shell State
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@pindex INTERACTIVE
+@pindex NO_INTERACTIVE
+@pindex NOINTERACTIVE
+@item @t{INTERACTIVE} (@t{-i}, ksh: @t{-i})
+This is an interactive shell. This option is set upon initialisation if
+the standard input is a tty and commands are being read from standard input.
+(See the discussion of @t{SHIN_STDIN}.)
+This heuristic may be overridden by specifying a state for this option
+on the command line.
+The value of this option can only be changed via flags supplied at
+invocation of the shell.
+It cannot be changed once zsh is running.
+
+@pindex LOGIN
+@pindex NO_LOGIN
+@pindex NOLOGIN
+@item @t{LOGIN} (@t{-l}, ksh: @t{-l})
+This is a login shell.
+If this option is not explicitly set, the shell becomes a login shell if
+the first character of the @t{argv[0]} passed to the shell is a `@t{-}'.
+
+@pindex PRIVILEGED
+@pindex NO_PRIVILEGED
+@pindex NOPRIVILEGED
+@cindex privileged mode
+@cindex mode, privileged
+@item @t{PRIVILEGED} (@t{-p}, ksh: @t{-p})
+Turn on privileged mode. Typically this is used when script is to be run
+with elevated privileges. This should be done as follows directly with
+the @t{-p} option to zsh so that it takes effect during startup.
+
+@noindent
+@example
+#!/bin/zsh -p
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The option is enabled automatically on startup if the effective user
+(group) ID is not equal to the real user (group) ID. In this case,
+turning the option off causes the effective user and group IDs to be set
+to the real user and group IDs. Be aware that if that fails the shell may
+be running with different IDs than was intended so a script should check
+for failure and act accordingly, for example:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+unsetopt privileged || exit
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The @t{PRIVILEGED} option disables sourcing user startup files.
+If zsh is invoked as `@t{sh}' or `@t{ksh}' with this option set,
+@t{/etc/suid_profile} is sourced (after @t{/etc/profile} on interactive
+shells). Sourcing @t{~/.profile} is disabled and the contents of the
+@t{ENV} variable is ignored. This option cannot be changed using the
+@t{-m} option of @t{setopt} and @t{unsetopt}, and changing it inside a
+function always changes it globally regardless of the @t{LOCAL_OPTIONS}
+option.
+
+@pindex RESTRICTED
+@pindex NO_RESTRICTED
+@pindex NORESTRICTED
+@cindex restricted shell
+@item @t{RESTRICTED} (@t{-r})
+Enables restricted mode. This option cannot be changed using
+@t{unsetopt}, and setting it inside a function always changes it
+globally regardless of the @t{LOCAL_OPTIONS} option. See
+@ref{Restricted Shell}.
+
+@pindex SHIN_STDIN
+@pindex NO_SHIN_STDIN
+@pindex SHINSTDIN
+@pindex NOSHINSTDIN
+@item @t{SHIN_STDIN} (@t{-s}, ksh: @t{-s})
+Commands are being read from the standard input.
+Commands are read from standard input if no command is specified with
+@t{-c} and no file of commands is specified. If @t{SHIN_STDIN}
+is set explicitly on the command line,
+any argument that would otherwise have been
+taken as a file to run will instead be treated as a normal positional
+parameter.
+Note that setting or unsetting this option on the command line does not
+necessarily affect the state the option will have while the shell is
+running - that is purely an indicator of whether or not commands are
+@emph{actually} being read from standard input.
+The value of this option can only be changed via flags supplied at
+invocation of the shell.
+It cannot be changed once zsh is running.
+
+@pindex SINGLE_COMMAND
+@pindex NO_SINGLE_COMMAND
+@pindex SINGLECOMMAND
+@pindex NOSINGLECOMMAND
+@cindex single command
+@pindex INTERACTIVE, use of
+@item @t{SINGLE_COMMAND} (@t{-t}, ksh: @t{-t})
+If the shell is reading from standard input, it exits after a single command
+has been executed. This also makes the shell non-interactive, unless the
+@t{INTERACTIVE} option is explicitly set on the command line.
+The value of this option can only be changed via flags supplied at
+invocation of the shell.
+It cannot be changed once zsh is running.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Zle
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@pindex BEEP
+@pindex NO_BEEP
+@pindex NOBEEP
+@cindex beep, enabling
+@cindex enabling the beep
+@item @t{BEEP} (@t{+B}) <D>
+Beep on error in ZLE.
+
+@pindex COMBINING_CHARS
+@pindex NO_COMBINING_CHARS
+@pindex COMBININGCHARS
+@pindex NOCOMBININGCHARS
+@cindex characters, (Unicode) combining
+@cindex combining characters (Unicode)
+@cindex Unicode combining characters
+@item @t{COMBINING_CHARS}
+Assume that the terminal displays combining characters correctly.
+Specifically, if a base alphanumeric character is followed by one or more
+zero-width punctuation characters, assume that the zero-width characters
+will be displayed as modifications to the base character within the
+same width. Not all terminals handle this. If this option is not
+set, zero-width characters are displayed separately with special
+mark-up.
+
+@noindent
+If this option is set, the pattern test @t{[[:WORD:]]} matches a
+zero-width punctuation character on the assumption that it will be
+used as part of a word in combination with a word character.
+Otherwise the base shell does not handle combining characters specially.
+
+@pindex EMACS
+@pindex NO_EMACS
+@pindex NOEMACS
+@item @t{EMACS}
+If ZLE is loaded, turning on this option has the equivalent effect
+of `@t{bindkey -e}'. In addition, the VI option is unset.
+Turning it off has no effect. The option setting is
+not guaranteed to reflect the current keymap. This option is
+provided for compatibility; @t{bindkey} is the recommended interface.
+
+@pindex OVERSTRIKE
+@pindex NO_OVERSTRIKE
+@pindex NOOVERSTRIKE
+@cindex editor, overstrike mode
+@cindex overstrike mode, of editor
+@item @t{OVERSTRIKE}
+Start up the line editor in overstrike mode.
+
+@pindex SINGLE_LINE_ZLE
+@pindex NO_SINGLE_LINE_ZLE
+@pindex SINGLELINEZLE
+@pindex NOSINGLELINEZLE
+@cindex editor, single line mode
+@item @t{SINGLE_LINE_ZLE} (@t{-M}) <K>
+Use single-line command line editing instead of multi-line.
+
+@noindent
+Note that although this is on by default in ksh emulation it only
+provides superficial compatibility with the ksh line editor and
+reduces the effectiveness of the zsh line editor. As it has no
+effect on shell syntax, many users may wish to disable this option
+when using ksh emulation interactively.
+
+@pindex VI
+@pindex NO_VI
+@pindex NOVI
+@item @t{VI}
+If ZLE is loaded, turning on this option has the equivalent effect
+of `@t{bindkey -v}'. In addition, the EMACS option is unset.
+Turning it off has no effect. The option setting is
+not guaranteed to reflect the current keymap. This option is
+provided for compatibility; @t{bindkey} is the recommended interface.
+
+@pindex ZLE
+@pindex NO_ZLE
+@pindex NOZLE
+@cindex editor, enabling
+@cindex enabling the editor
+@item @t{ZLE} (@t{-Z})
+Use the zsh line editor. Set by default in interactive shells connected to
+a terminal.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+@node Option Aliases, Single Letter Options, Description of Options, Options
+
+@section Option Aliases
+@noindent
+@cindex options, aliases
+Some options have alternative names. These aliases are never used for
+output, but can be used just like normal option names when specifying
+options to the shell.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@pindex BRACE_EXPAND
+@pindex NO_BRACE_EXPAND
+@pindex BRACEEXPAND
+@pindex NOBRACEEXPAND
+@item @t{BRACE_EXPAND}
+@emph{NO_}@t{IGNORE_BRACES}
+(ksh and bash compatibility)
+
+@pindex DOT_GLOB
+@pindex NO_DOT_GLOB
+@pindex DOTGLOB
+@pindex NODOTGLOB
+@item @t{DOT_GLOB}
+@t{GLOB_DOTS}
+(bash compatibility)
+
+@pindex HASH_ALL
+@pindex NO_HASH_ALL
+@pindex HASHALL
+@pindex NOHASHALL
+@item @t{HASH_ALL}
+@t{HASH_CMDS}
+(bash compatibility)
+
+@pindex HIST_APPEND
+@pindex NO_HIST_APPEND
+@pindex HISTAPPEND
+@pindex NOHISTAPPEND
+@item @t{HIST_APPEND}
+@t{APPEND_HISTORY}
+(bash compatibility)
+
+@pindex HIST_EXPAND
+@pindex NO_HIST_EXPAND
+@pindex HISTEXPAND
+@pindex NOHISTEXPAND
+@item @t{HIST_EXPAND}
+@t{BANG_HIST}
+(bash compatibility)
+
+@pindex LOG
+@pindex NO_LOG
+@pindex NOLOG
+@item @t{LOG}
+@emph{NO_}@t{HIST_NO_FUNCTIONS}
+(ksh compatibility)
+
+@pindex MAIL_WARN
+@pindex NO_MAIL_WARN
+@pindex MAILWARN
+@pindex NOMAILWARN
+@item @t{MAIL_WARN}
+@t{MAIL_WARNING}
+(bash compatibility)
+
+@pindex ONE_CMD
+@pindex NO_ONE_CMD
+@pindex ONECMD
+@pindex NOONECMD
+@item @t{ONE_CMD}
+@t{SINGLE_COMMAND}
+(bash compatibility)
+
+@pindex PHYSICAL
+@pindex NO_PHYSICAL
+@pindex NOPHYSICAL
+@item @t{PHYSICAL}
+@t{CHASE_LINKS}
+(ksh and bash compatibility)
+
+@pindex PROMPT_VARS
+@pindex NO_PROMPT_VARS
+@pindex PROMPTVARS
+@pindex NOPROMPTVARS
+@item @t{PROMPT_VARS}
+@t{PROMPT_SUBST}
+(bash compatibility)
+
+@pindex STDIN
+@pindex NO_STDIN
+@pindex NOSTDIN
+@item @t{STDIN}
+@t{SHIN_STDIN}
+(ksh compatibility)
+
+@pindex TRACK_ALL
+@pindex NO_TRACK_ALL
+@pindex TRACKALL
+@pindex NOTRACKALL
+@item @t{TRACK_ALL}
+@t{HASH_CMDS}
+(ksh compatibility)
+
+@end table
+@node Single Letter Options, , Option Aliases, Options
+
+@section Single Letter Options
+@noindent
+@cindex options, single letter
+@cindex single letter options
+
+@subsection Default set
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{-0}
+CORRECT
+@item @t{-1}
+PRINT_EXIT_VALUE
+@item @t{-2}
+@emph{NO_}BAD_PATTERN
+@item @t{-3}
+@emph{NO_}NOMATCH
+@item @t{-4}
+GLOB_DOTS
+@item @t{-5}
+NOTIFY
+@item @t{-6}
+BG_NICE
+@item @t{-7}
+IGNORE_EOF
+@item @t{-8}
+MARK_DIRS
+@item @t{-9}
+AUTO_LIST
+@item @t{-B}
+@emph{NO_}BEEP
+@item @t{-C}
+@emph{NO_}CLOBBER
+@item @t{-D}
+PUSHD_TO_HOME
+@item @t{-E}
+PUSHD_SILENT
+@item @t{-F}
+@emph{NO_}GLOB
+@item @t{-G}
+NULL_GLOB
+@item @t{-H}
+RM_STAR_SILENT
+@item @t{-I}
+IGNORE_BRACES
+@item @t{-J}
+AUTO_CD
+@item @t{-K}
+@emph{NO_}BANG_HIST
+@item @t{-L}
+SUN_KEYBOARD_HACK
+@item @t{-M}
+SINGLE_LINE_ZLE
+@item @t{-N}
+AUTO_PUSHD
+@item @t{-O}
+CORRECT_ALL
+@item @t{-P}
+RC_EXPAND_PARAM
+@item @t{-Q}
+PATH_DIRS
+@item @t{-R}
+LONG_LIST_JOBS
+@item @t{-S}
+REC_EXACT
+@item @t{-T}
+CDABLE_VARS
+@item @t{-U}
+MAIL_WARNING
+@item @t{-V}
+@emph{NO_}PROMPT_CR
+@item @t{-W}
+AUTO_RESUME
+@item @t{-X}
+LIST_TYPES
+@item @t{-Y}
+MENU_COMPLETE
+@item @t{-Z}
+ZLE
+@item @t{-a}
+ALL_EXPORT
+@item @t{-e}
+ERR_EXIT
+@item @t{-f}
+@emph{NO_}RCS
+@item @t{-g}
+HIST_IGNORE_SPACE
+@item @t{-h}
+HIST_IGNORE_DUPS
+@item @t{-i}
+INTERACTIVE
+@item @t{-k}
+INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS
+@item @t{-l}
+LOGIN
+@item @t{-m}
+MONITOR
+@item @t{-n}
+@emph{NO_}EXEC
+@item @t{-p}
+PRIVILEGED
+@item @t{-r}
+RESTRICTED
+@item @t{-s}
+SHIN_STDIN
+@item @t{-t}
+SINGLE_COMMAND
+@item @t{-u}
+@emph{NO_}UNSET
+@item @t{-v}
+VERBOSE
+@item @t{-w}
+CHASE_LINKS
+@item @t{-x}
+XTRACE
+@item @t{-y}
+SH_WORD_SPLIT
+@end table
+
+@subsection sh/ksh emulation set
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{-C}
+@emph{NO_}CLOBBER
+@item @t{-T}
+TRAPS_ASYNC
+@item @t{-X}
+MARK_DIRS
+@item @t{-a}
+ALL_EXPORT
+@item @t{-b}
+NOTIFY
+@item @t{-e}
+ERR_EXIT
+@item @t{-f}
+@emph{NO_}GLOB
+@item @t{-i}
+INTERACTIVE
+@item @t{-l}
+LOGIN
+@item @t{-m}
+MONITOR
+@item @t{-n}
+@emph{NO_}EXEC
+@item @t{-p}
+PRIVILEGED
+@item @t{-r}
+RESTRICTED
+@item @t{-s}
+SHIN_STDIN
+@item @t{-t}
+SINGLE_COMMAND
+@item @t{-u}
+@emph{NO_}UNSET
+@item @t{-v}
+VERBOSE
+@item @t{-x}
+XTRACE
+@end table
+
+@subsection Also note
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{-A}
+Used by @t{set} for setting arrays
+@item @t{-b}
+Used on the command line to specify end of option processing
+@item @t{-c}
+Used on the command line to specify a single command
+@item @t{-m}
+Used by @t{setopt} for pattern-matching option setting
+@item @t{-o}
+Used in all places to allow use of long option names
+@item @t{-s}
+Used by @t{set} to sort positional parameters
+@end table
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/builtins.yo
+@node Shell Builtin Commands, Zsh Line Editor, Options, Top
+
+@chapter Shell Builtin Commands
+@noindent
+
+@cindex builtin commands
+@cindex commands, builtin
+Some shell builtin commands take options as described in individual
+entries; these are often referred to in the list below as `@t{flags}' to
+avoid confusion with shell options, which may also have an effect on the
+behaviour of builtin commands. In this introductory section,
+`@t{option}' always has the meaning of an option to a command that should
+be familiar to most command line users.
+
+@noindent
+Typically, options are single letters preceded by a hyphen (@t{-}).
+Options that take an argument accept it either immediately following the
+option letter or after white space, for example `@t{print -C3 @{1..9@}}' or
+`@t{print -C 3 @{1..9@}}' are equivalent. Arguments to options are not the
+same as arguments to the command; the documentation indicates which is
+which. Options that do not take an argument may be combined in a single
+word, for example `@t{print -rca -- *}' and `@t{print -r -c -a -- *}' are
+equivalent.
+
+@noindent
+Some shell builtin commands also take options that begin with `@t{+}'
+instead of `@t{-}'. The list below makes clear which commands these
+are.
+
+@noindent
+Options (together with their individual arguments, if any) must appear
+in a group before any non-option arguments; once the first non-option
+argument has been found, option processing is terminated.
+
+@noindent
+All builtin commands other than `@t{echo}' and precommand modifiers,
+even those that have no options, can be given the argument `@t{-}@t{-}'
+to terminate option processing. This indicates that the following words
+are non-option arguments, but is otherwise ignored. This is useful in
+cases where arguments to the command may begin with `@t{-}'. For
+historical reasons, most builtin commands (including `@t{echo}') also
+recognize a single `@t{-}' in a separate word for this purpose; note
+that this is less standard and use of `@t{-}@t{-}' is recommended.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{-} @var{simple command}
+See @ref{Precommand Modifiers}.
+
+@findex .
+@item @t{.} @var{file} [ @var{arg} ... ]
+Read commands from @var{file} and execute them in the current shell
+environment.
+
+@noindent
+If @var{file} does not contain a slash, or if @t{PATH_DIRS} is set,
+the shell looks in the components of @t{$path} to find the directory
+containing @var{file}. Files in the current directory are not read
+unless `@t{.}' appears somewhere in @t{$path}. If a file named
+`@var{file}@t{.zwc}' is found, is newer than @var{file}, and is the
+compiled form (created with the @t{zcompile} builtin) of @var{file},
+then commands are read from that file instead of @var{file}.
+
+@noindent
+If any arguments @var{arg} are given,
+they become the positional parameters; the old positional
+parameters are restored when the @var{file} is done executing.
+However, if no arguments are given,
+the positional parameters remain those of the calling context,
+and no restoring is done.
+
+@noindent
+If @var{file} was not found the return status is 127; if @var{file} was found
+but contained a syntax error the return status is 126; else the return
+status is the exit status of the last command executed.
+
+@findex :
+@cindex expanding parameters
+@cindex parameters, expanding
+@cindex doing nothing
+@item @t{:} [ @var{arg} ... ]
+This command does nothing, although normal argument expansions is performed
+which may have effects on shell parameters. A zero exit status is returned.
+
+@findex alias
+@cindex aliases, defining
+@cindex aliases, listing
+@item @t{alias} [ @{@t{+}|@t{-}@}@t{gmrsL} ] [ @var{name}[@t{=}@var{value}] ... ]
+For each @var{name} with a corresponding @var{value}, define an alias
+with that value. A trailing space in @var{value} causes the next word
+to be checked for alias expansion. If the @t{-g} flag is present,
+define a global alias; global aliases are expanded even if they do not
+occur in command position.
+
+@noindent
+If the @t{-s} flag is present, define a suffix alias: if the command
+word on a command line is in the form `@var{text}@t{.}@var{name}', where
+@var{text} is any non-empty string, it is replaced by the text
+`@var{value} @var{text}@t{.}@var{name}'. Note that @var{name} is treated as
+a literal string, not a pattern. A trailing space in @var{value} is not
+special in this case. For example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+alias -s ps='gv --'
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+will cause the command `@t{*.ps}' to be expanded to `@t{gv -- *.ps}'. As
+alias expansion is carried out earlier than globbing, the `@t{*.ps}' will
+then be expanded. Suffix aliases constitute a different name space from
+other aliases (so in the above example it is still possible
+to create an alias for the command @t{ps}) and the two sets are never
+listed together.
+
+@noindent
+For each @var{name} with no @var{value},
+print the value of @var{name}, if any. With no arguments, print all
+currently defined aliases other than suffix aliases. If the @t{-m} flag
+is given the arguments are taken as patterns (they should be quoted to
+preserve them from being interpreted as glob patterns), and the aliases
+matching these patterns are printed. When printing aliases and one of
+the @t{-g}, @t{-r} or @t{-s} flags is present, restrict the printing to
+global, regular or suffix aliases, respectively; a regular alias is one
+which is neither a global nor a suffix alias. Using `@t{+}'
+instead of `@t{-}', or ending the option list with a single
+`@t{+}', prevents the values of the aliases from being printed.
+
+@noindent
+If the @t{-L} flag is present, then print each
+alias in a manner suitable for putting in a startup script. The exit
+status is nonzero if a @var{name} (with no @var{value}) is given for
+which no alias has been defined.
+
+@noindent
+For more on aliases, include common problems, see
+@ref{Aliasing}.
+
+@findex autoload
+@cindex functions, autoloading
+@cindex autoloading functions
+@item @t{autoload} [ @{@t{+}|@t{-}@}@t{RTUXdkmrtWz} ] [ @t{-w} ] [ @var{name} ... ]
+@vindex fpath, searching
+See the section `Autoloading Functions' in @ref{Functions} for full details. The @t{fpath} parameter
+will be searched to find the function definition when the function is
+first referenced.
+
+@noindent
+If @var{name} consists of an absolute path, the function is defined to
+load from the file given (searching as usual for dump files in the given
+location). The name of the function is the basename (non-directory
+part) of the file. It is normally an error if the function is not found
+in the given location; however, if the option @t{-d} is given, searching
+for the function defaults to @t{$fpath}. If a function is loaded by
+absolute path, any functions loaded from it that are marked for
+@t{autoload} without an absolute path have the load path of the parent
+function temporarily prepended to @t{$fpath}.
+
+@noindent
+If the option @t{-r} or @t{-R} is given, the function is searched for
+immediately and the location is recorded internally for use when the
+function is executed; a relative path is expanded using the value of
+@t{$PWD}. This protects against a change to @t{$fpath} after the call
+to @t{autoload}. With @t{-r}, if the function is not found, it is
+silently left unresolved until execution; with @t{-R}, an error message
+is printed and command processing aborted immediately the search fails,
+i.e. at the @t{autoload} command rather than at function execution..
+
+@noindent
+The flag @t{-X} may be used only inside a shell function. It causes the
+calling function to be marked for autoloading and then immediately
+loaded and executed, with the current array of positional parameters as
+arguments. This replaces the previous definition of the function. If
+no function definition is found, an error is printed and the function
+remains undefined and marked for autoloading. If an argument is given,
+it is used as a directory (i.e. it does not include the name of the
+function) in which the function is to be found; this may be combined
+with the @t{-d} option to allow the function search to default to @t{$fpath}
+if it is not in the given location.
+
+@noindent
+The flag @t{+X} attempts to load each @var{name} as an autoloaded function,
+but does @emph{not} execute it. The exit status is zero (success) if the
+function was not previously defined @emph{and} a definition for it was found.
+This does @emph{not} replace any existing definition of the function. The
+exit status is nonzero (failure) if the function was already defined or
+when no definition was found. In the latter case the function remains
+undefined and marked for autoloading. If ksh-style autoloading is
+enabled, the function created will contain the contents of the file
+plus a call to the function itself appended to it, thus giving normal
+ksh autoloading behaviour on the first call to the function.
+If the @t{-m} flag is also given each @var{name} is treated as a
+pattern and all functions already marked for autoload that match the
+pattern are loaded.
+
+@noindent
+With the @t{-t} flag, turn on execution tracing; with @t{-T}, turn on
+execution tracing only for the current function, turning it off on entry
+to any called functions that do not also have tracing enabled.
+
+@noindent
+With the @t{-U} flag, alias expansion is suppressed when the function is
+loaded.
+
+@noindent
+With the @t{-w} flag, the @var{name}s are taken as names of files compiled
+with the @t{zcompile} builtin, and all functions defined in them are
+marked for autoloading.
+
+@noindent
+The flags @t{-z} and @t{-k} mark the function to be autoloaded using the
+zsh or ksh style, as if the option @t{KSH_AUTOLOAD} were unset or were
+set, respectively. The flags override the setting of the option at the
+time the function is loaded.
+
+@noindent
+Note that the @t{autoload} command makes no attempt to ensure the
+shell options set during the loading or execution of the file have
+any particular value. For this, the @t{emulate} command can be used:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+emulate zsh -c 'autoload -Uz @var{func}'
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+arranges that when @var{func} is loaded the shell is in native @t{zsh}
+emulation, and this emulation is also applied when @var{func} is run.
+
+@noindent
+Some of the functions of @t{autoload} are also provided by @t{functions
+-u} or @t{functions -U}, but @t{autoload} is a more comprehensive
+interface.
+
+@findex bg
+@cindex jobs, backgrounding
+@item @t{bg} [ @var{job} ... ]
+@itemx @var{job} ... @t{&}
+Put each specified @var{job} in the background,
+or the current job if none is specified.
+
+@item @t{bindkey}
+See @ref{Zle Builtins}.
+
+@findex break
+@cindex exiting loops
+@cindex loops, exiting
+@item @t{break} [ @var{n} ]
+Exit from an enclosing @t{for}, @t{while},
+@t{until}, @t{select} or @t{repeat} loop. If an arithmetic expression @var{n}
+is specified, then break @var{n} levels instead of just one.
+
+@findex builtin
+@item @t{builtin} @var{name} [ @var{args} ... ]
+Executes the builtin @var{name}, with the given @var{args}.
+
+@findex bye
+@item @t{bye}
+Same as @t{exit}.
+
+@item @t{cap}
+See @ref{The zsh/cap Module}.
+
+@findex cd
+@cindex directories, changing
+@item @t{cd} [ @t{-qsLP} ] [ @var{arg} ]
+@itemx @t{cd} [ @t{-qsLP} ] @var{old} @var{new}
+@itemx @t{cd} [ @t{-qsLP} ] @{@t{+}|@t{-}@}@var{n}
+Change the current directory. In the first form, change the
+current directory to @var{arg}, or to the value of @t{$HOME} if
+@var{arg} is not specified. If @var{arg} is `@t{-}', change to the
+previous directory.
+
+@noindent
+Otherwise, if @var{arg} begins with a slash, attempt to change to the
+directory given by @var{arg}.
+
+@noindent
+If @var{arg} does not begin with a slash, the behaviour depends on whether
+the current directory `@t{.}' occurs in the list of directories contained
+in the shell parameter @t{cdpath}. If it does not, first attempt to change
+to the directory @var{arg} under the current directory, and if that fails
+but @t{cdpath} is set and contains at least one element attempt to change
+to the directory @var{arg} under each component of @t{cdpath} in turn until
+successful. If `@t{.}' occurs in @t{cdpath}, then @t{cdpath} is searched
+strictly in order so that `@t{.}' is only tried at the appropriate point.
+
+@noindent
+The order of testing @t{cdpath} is modified if the option @t{POSIX_CD}
+is set, as described in the documentation for the option.
+
+@noindent
+If no directory is found, the option @t{CDABLE_VARS} is set, and a
+parameter named @var{arg} exists whose value begins with a slash, treat its
+value as the directory. In that case, the parameter is added to the named
+directory hash table.
+
+@noindent
+The second form of @t{cd} substitutes the string @var{new}
+for the string @var{old} in the name of the current directory,
+and tries to change to this new directory.
+
+@noindent
+The third form of @t{cd} extracts an entry from the directory
+stack, and changes to that directory. An argument of the form
+`@t{+}@var{n}' identifies a stack entry by counting from the left
+of the list shown by the @t{dirs} command, starting with zero.
+An argument of the form `@t{-}@var{n}' counts from the right.
+If the @t{PUSHD_MINUS} option is set, the meanings of `@t{+}'
+and `@t{-}' in this context are swapped.
+If the @t{POSIX_CD} option is set, this form of @t{cd} is not recognised
+and will be interpreted as the first form.
+
+@noindent
+If the @t{-q} (quiet) option is specified, the hook function @t{chpwd}
+and the functions in the array @t{chpwd_functions} are not called.
+This is useful for calls to @t{cd} that do not change the environment
+seen by an interactive user.
+
+@noindent
+If the @t{-s} option is specified, @t{cd} refuses to change the current
+directory if the given pathname contains symlinks. If the @t{-P} option
+is given or the @t{CHASE_LINKS} option is set, symbolic links are resolved
+to their true values. If the @t{-L} option is given symbolic links are
+retained in the directory (and not resolved) regardless of the state of
+the @t{CHASE_LINKS} option.
+
+@findex chdir
+@item @t{chdir}
+Same as @t{cd}.
+
+@item @t{clone}
+See @ref{The zsh/clone Module}.
+
+@findex command
+@item @t{command} [ @t{-pvV} ] @var{simple command}
+The simple command argument is taken as an external command instead of
+a function or builtin and is executed. If the @t{POSIX_BUILTINS} option
+is set, builtins will also be executed but certain special properties
+of them are suppressed. The @t{-p} flag causes a default path to be
+searched instead of that in @t{$path}. With the @t{-v} flag, @t{command}
+is similar to @t{whence} and with @t{-V}, it is equivalent to @t{whence
+-v}.
+
+@noindent
+See also @ref{Precommand Modifiers}.
+
+@item @t{comparguments}
+See @ref{The zsh/computil Module}.
+
+@item @t{compcall}
+See @ref{The zsh/compctl Module}.
+
+@item @t{compctl}
+See @ref{The zsh/compctl Module}.
+
+@item @t{compdescribe}
+See @ref{The zsh/computil Module}.
+
+@item @t{compfiles}
+See @ref{The zsh/computil Module}.
+
+@item @t{compgroups}
+See @ref{The zsh/computil Module}.
+
+@item @t{compquote}
+See @ref{The zsh/computil Module}.
+
+@item @t{comptags}
+See @ref{The zsh/computil Module}.
+
+@item @t{comptry}
+See @ref{The zsh/computil Module}.
+
+@item @t{compvalues}
+See @ref{The zsh/computil Module}.
+
+@findex continue
+@cindex loops, continuing
+@cindex continuing loops
+@item @t{continue} [ @var{n} ]
+Resume the next iteration of the enclosing
+@t{for}, @t{while}, @t{until}, @t{select} or
+@t{repeat} loop. If an arithmetic expression @var{n} is specified, break out of
+@var{n}-1 loops and resume at the @var{n}th enclosing loop.
+
+@findex declare
+@item @t{declare}
+Same as @t{typeset}.
+
+@findex dirs
+@cindex directory stack, printing
+@item @t{dirs} [ @t{-c} ] [ @var{arg} ... ]
+@itemx @t{dirs} [ @t{-lpv} ]
+With no arguments, print the contents of the directory stack.
+Directories are added to this stack with the @t{pushd} command,
+and removed with the @t{cd} or @t{popd} commands.
+If arguments are specified, load them onto the directory stack,
+replacing anything that was there, and push the current directory
+onto the stack.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{-c}
+clear the directory stack.
+
+@item @t{-l}
+print directory names in full instead of using of using @t{~} expressions (@ref{Filename Expansion}).
+
+@item @t{-p}
+print directory entries one per line.
+
+@item @t{-v}
+number the directories in the stack when printing.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@findex disable
+@cindex disabling commands
+@cindex commands, disabling
+@item @t{disable} [ @t{-afmprs} ] @var{name} ...
+Temporarily disable the @var{name}d hash table elements or patterns. The default
+is to disable builtin commands. This allows you to use an external
+command with the same name as a builtin command. The @t{-a} option
+causes @t{disable} to act on regular or global aliases. The @t{-s}
+option causes @t{disable} to act on suffix aliases. The @t{-f} option causes
+@t{disable} to act on shell functions. The @t{-r} options causes
+@t{disable} to act on reserved words. Without arguments all disabled
+hash table elements from the corresponding hash table are printed.
+With the @t{-m} flag the arguments are taken as patterns (which should be
+quoted to prevent them from undergoing filename expansion), and all hash
+table elements from the corresponding hash table matching these patterns
+are disabled. Disabled objects can be enabled with the @t{enable}
+command.
+
+@noindent
+With the option @t{-p}, @var{name} ... refer to elements of the
+shell's pattern syntax as described in @ref{Filename Generation}.
+Certain elements can be disabled separately, as given below.
+
+@noindent
+Note that patterns
+not allowed by the current settings for the options @t{EXTENDED_GLOB},
+@t{KSH_GLOB} and @t{SH_GLOB} are never enabled, regardless of the
+setting here. For example, if @t{EXTENDED_GLOB} is not active,
+the pattern @t{^} is ineffective even if `@t{disable -p "^"}' has
+not been issued. The list below indicates any option settings
+that restrict the use of the pattern. It should be noted that
+setting @t{SH_GLOB} has a wider effect than merely disabling patterns
+as certain expressions, in particular those involving parentheses,
+are parsed differently.
+
+@noindent
+The following patterns may be disabled; all
+the strings need quoting on the command line to prevent them from
+being interpreted immediately as patterns and the patterns are
+shown below in single quotes as a reminder.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{'?'}
+The pattern character @t{?} wherever it occurs, including when preceding
+a parenthesis with @t{KSH_GLOB}.
+
+@item @t{'*'}
+The pattern character @t{*} wherever it occurs, including recursive
+globbing and when preceding a parenthesis with @t{KSH_GLOB}.
+
+@item @t{'['}
+Character classes.
+
+@item @t{'<'} (@t{NO_SH_GLOB})
+Numeric ranges.
+
+@item @t{'|'} (@t{NO_SH_GLOB})
+Alternation in grouped patterns, case statements, or KSH_GLOB
+parenthesised expressions.
+
+@item @t{'('} (@t{NO_SH_GLOB})
+Grouping using single parentheses. Disabling this does not disable the
+use of parentheses for @t{KSH_GLOB} where they are introduced by a
+special character, nor for glob qualifiers (use `@t{setopt
+NO_BARE_GLOB_QUAL}' to disable glob qualifiers that use parentheses
+only).
+
+@item @t{'~'} (@t{EXTENDED_GLOB})
+Exclusion in the form @var{A}@t{~}@var{B}.
+
+@item @t{'^'} (@t{EXTENDED_GLOB})
+Exclusion in the form @var{A}@t{^}@var{B}.
+
+@item @t{'#'} (@t{EXTENDED_GLOB})
+The pattern character @t{#} wherever it occurs, both for
+repetition of a previous pattern and for indicating globbing flags.
+
+@item @t{'?('} (@t{KSH_GLOB})
+The grouping form @t{?(}@var{...}@t{)}. Note this is also
+disabled if @t{'?'} is disabled.
+
+@item @t{'*('} (@t{KSH_GLOB})
+The grouping form @t{*(}@var{...}@t{)}. Note this is also
+disabled if @t{'*'} is disabled.
+
+@item @t{'+('} (@t{KSH_GLOB})
+The grouping form @t{+(}@var{...}@t{)}.
+
+@item @t{'!('} (@t{KSH_GLOB})
+The grouping form @t{!(}@var{...}@t{)}.
+
+@item @t{'@@('} (@t{KSH_GLOB})
+The grouping form @t{@@(}@var{...}@t{)}.
+
+@end table
+
+@findex disown
+@cindex jobs, disowning
+@item @t{disown} [ @var{job} ... ]
+@itemx @var{job} ... @t{&|}
+@itemx @var{job} ... @t{&!}
+Remove the specified @var{job}s from the job table; the shell will
+no longer report their status, and will not complain if you
+try to exit an interactive shell with them running or stopped.
+If no @var{job} is specified, disown the current job.
+
+@noindent
+If the @var{job}s are currently stopped and the @t{AUTO_CONTINUE} option
+is not set, a warning is printed containing information about how to
+make them running after they have been disowned. If one of the latter
+two forms is used, the @var{job}s will automatically be made running,
+independent of the setting of the @t{AUTO_CONTINUE} option.
+
+@findex echo
+@item @t{echo} [ @t{-neE} ] [ @var{arg} ... ]
+Write each @var{arg} on the standard output, with a space separating
+each one.
+If the @t{-n} flag is not present, print a newline at the end.
+@t{echo} recognizes the following escape sequences:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{\a}
+bell character
+@item @t{\b}
+backspace
+@item @t{\c}
+suppress subsequent characters and final newline
+@item @t{\e}
+escape
+@item @t{\f}
+form feed
+@item @t{\n}
+linefeed (newline)
+@item @t{\r}
+carriage return
+@item @t{\t}
+horizontal tab
+@item @t{\v}
+vertical tab
+@item @t{\\}
+backslash
+@item @t{\0}@var{NNN}
+character code in octal
+@item @t{\x}@var{NN}
+character code in hexadecimal
+@item @t{\u}@var{NNNN}
+unicode character code in hexadecimal
+@item @t{\U}@var{NNNNNNNN}
+unicode character code in hexadecimal
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+@pindex BSD_ECHO, use of
+The @t{-E} flag, or the @t{BSD_ECHO} option, can be used to disable
+these escape sequences. In the latter case, @t{-e} flag can be used to
+enable them.
+
+@noindent
+Note that for standards compliance a double dash does not terminate
+option processing; instead, it is printed directly. However, a
+single dash does terminate option processing, so the first dash,
+possibly following options, is not printed, but everything following it
+is printed as an argument. The single dash behaviour is different
+from other shells. For a more portable way of printing text, see
+@t{printf}, and for a more controllable way of printing text within zsh,
+see @t{print}.
+
+@item @t{echotc}
+See @ref{The zsh/termcap Module}.
+
+@item @t{echoti}
+See @ref{The zsh/terminfo Module}.
+
+@findex emulate
+@cindex compatibility, sh
+@cindex compatibility, ksh
+@cindex compatibility, csh
+@cindex sh, compatibility
+@cindex ksh, compatibility
+@cindex csh, compatibility
+@item @t{emulate} [ @t{-lLR} ] [ @{@t{zsh}|@t{sh}|@t{ksh}|@t{csh}@} [ @var{flags} ... ] ]
+Without any argument print current emulation mode.
+
+@noindent
+With single argument set up zsh options to emulate the specified shell
+as much as possible.
+@cite{csh} will never be fully emulated.
+If the argument is not one of the shells listed above, @t{zsh}
+will be used as a default; more precisely, the tests performed on the
+argument are the same as those used to determine the emulation at startup
+based on the shell name, see
+@ref{Compatibility}
+. In addition to setting shell options, the command also restores
+the pristine state of pattern enables, as if all patterns had been
+enabled using @t{enable -p}.
+
+@noindent
+If the @t{emulate} command occurs inside a function that has been
+marked for execution tracing with @t{functions -t} then the @t{xtrace}
+option will be turned on regardless of emulation mode or other options.
+Note that code executed inside the function by the @t{.}, @t{source}, or
+@t{eval} commands is not considered to be running directly from the
+function, hence does not provoke this behaviour.
+
+@noindent
+If the @t{-R} switch is given, all settable options
+are reset to their default value corresponding to the specified emulation
+mode, except for certain options describing the interactive
+environment; otherwise, only those options likely to cause portability
+problems in scripts and functions are altered. If the @t{-L} switch is given,
+the options @t{LOCAL_OPTIONS}, @t{LOCAL_PATTERNS} and @t{LOCAL_TRAPS}
+will be set as
+well, causing the effects of the @t{emulate} command and any @t{setopt},
+@t{disable -p} or @t{enable -p}, and @t{trap} commands to be local to
+the immediately surrounding shell
+function, if any; normally these options are turned off in all emulation
+modes except @t{ksh}. The @t{-L} switch is mutually exclusive with the
+use of @t{-c} in @var{flags}.
+
+@noindent
+If there is a single argument and the @t{-l} switch is given, the
+options that would be set or unset (the latter indicated with the prefix
+`@t{no}') are listed. @t{-l} can be combined with @t{-L} or @t{-R} and
+the list will be modified in the appropriate way. Note the list does
+not depend on the current setting of options, i.e. it includes all
+options that may in principle change, not just those that would actually
+change.
+
+@noindent
+The @var{flags} may be any of the invocation-time flags described in
+@ref{Invocation},
+except that `@t{-o EMACS}' and `@t{-o VI}' may not be used. Flags such
+as `@t{+r}'/`@t{+o RESTRICTED}' may be prohibited in some circumstances.
+
+@noindent
+If @t{-c} @var{arg} appears in @var{flags}, @var{arg} is evaluated while the
+requested emulation is temporarily in effect. In this case the emulation
+mode and all options are restored to their previous values before
+@t{emulate} returns. The @t{-R} switch may precede the name of the shell
+to emulate; note this has a meaning distinct from including @t{-R} in
+@var{flags}.
+
+@noindent
+Use of @t{-c} enables `sticky' emulation mode for functions defined
+within the evaluated expression: the emulation mode is associated
+thereafter with the function so that whenever the function is executed
+the emulation (respecting the @t{-R} switch, if present) and all
+options are set (and pattern disables cleared)
+before entry to the function, and the state is restored after exit.
+If the function is called when the sticky emulation is already in
+effect, either within an `@t{emulate} @var{shell} @t{-c}' expression or
+within another function with the same sticky emulation, entry and exit
+from the function do not cause options to be altered (except due to
+standard processing such as the @t{LOCAL_OPTIONS} option). This also
+applies to functions marked for autoload within the sticky emulation;
+the appropriate set of options will be applied at the point the
+function is loaded as well as when it is run.
+
+@noindent
+For example:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+emulate sh -c 'fni() @{ setopt cshnullglob; @}
+fno() @{ fni; @}'
+fno
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The two functions @t{fni} and @t{fno} are defined with sticky @t{sh}
+emulation. @t{fno} is then executed, causing options associated
+with emulations to be set to their values in @t{sh}. @t{fno} then
+calls @t{fni}; because @t{fni} is also marked for sticky @t{sh}
+emulation, no option changes take place on entry to or exit from it.
+Hence the option @t{cshnullglob}, turned off by @t{sh} emulation, will
+be turned on within @t{fni} and remain on return to @t{fno}. On exit
+from @t{fno}, the emulation mode and all options will be restored to the
+state they were in before entry to the temporary emulation.
+
+@noindent
+The documentation above is typically sufficient for the intended
+purpose of executing code designed for other shells in a suitable
+environment. More detailed rules follow.
+@table @asis
+@item 1.
+The sticky emulation environment provided by `@t{emulate}
+@var{shell} @t{-c}' is identical to that provided by entry to
+a function marked for sticky emulation as a consequence of being
+defined in such an environment. Hence, for example, the sticky
+emulation is inherited by subfunctions defined within functions
+with sticky emulation.
+@item 2.
+No change of options takes place on entry to or exit from
+functions that are not marked for sticky emulation, other than those
+that would normally take place, even if those functions are called
+within sticky emulation.
+@item 3.
+No special handling is provided for functions marked for
+@t{autoload} nor for functions present in wordcode created by
+the @t{zcompile} command.
+@item 4.
+The presence or absence of the @t{-R} switch to @t{emulate}
+corresponds to different sticky emulation modes, so for example
+`@t{emulate sh -c}', `@t{emulate -R sh -c}' and `@t{emulate csh -c}'
+are treated as three distinct sticky emulations.
+@item 5.
+Difference in shell options supplied in addition to the
+basic emulation also mean the sticky emulations are different, so for
+example `@t{emulate zsh -c}' and `@t{emulate zsh -o cbases -c}' are
+treated as distinct sticky emulations.
+@end table
+
+@findex enable
+@cindex enabling commands
+@cindex commands, enabling
+@item @t{enable} [ @t{-afmprs} ] @var{name} ...
+Enable the @var{name}d hash table elements, presumably disabled
+earlier with @t{disable}. The default is to enable builtin commands.
+The @t{-a} option causes @t{enable} to act on regular or global aliases.
+The @t{-s} option causes @t{enable} to act on suffix aliases.
+The @t{-f} option causes @t{enable} to act on shell functions. The @t{-r}
+option causes @t{enable} to act on reserved words. Without arguments
+all enabled hash table elements from the corresponding hash table are
+printed. With the @t{-m} flag the arguments are taken as patterns
+(should be quoted) and all hash table elements from the corresponding
+hash table matching these patterns are enabled. Enabled objects can be
+disabled with the @t{disable} builtin command.
+
+@noindent
+@t{enable -p} reenables patterns disabled with @t{disable -p}. Note
+that it does not override globbing options; for example, `@t{enable -p
+"~"}' does not cause the pattern character @t{~} to be active unless
+the @t{EXTENDED_GLOB} option is also set. To enable all possible
+patterns (so that they may be individually disabled with @t{disable -p}),
+use `@t{setopt EXTENDED_GLOB KSH_GLOB NO_SH_GLOB}'.
+
+@findex eval
+@cindex evaluating arguments as commands
+@item @t{eval} [ @var{arg} ... ]
+Read the arguments as input to the shell and execute the resulting
+command(s) in the current shell process. The return status is
+the same as if the commands had been executed directly by the shell;
+if there are no @var{args} or they contain no commands (i.e. are
+an empty string or whitespace) the return status is zero.
+
+@item @t{exec} [ @t{-cl} ] [ @t{-a} @var{argv0} ] [ @var{command} [ @var{arg} ... ] ]
+Replace the current shell with @var{command} rather than forking.
+If @var{command} is a shell builtin command or a shell function,
+the shell executes it, and exits when the command is complete.
+
+@noindent
+With @t{-c} clear the environment; with @t{-l} prepend @t{-} to the
+@t{argv[0]} string of the command executed (to simulate a login shell);
+with @t{-a} @var{argv0} set the @t{argv[0]} string of the command
+executed.
+See @ref{Precommand Modifiers}.
+
+@noindent
+If the option @t{POSIX_BUILTINS} is set, @var{command} is never
+interpreted as a shell builtin command or shell function. This
+means further precommand modifiers such as @t{builtin} and
+@t{noglob} are also not interpreted within the shell. Hence
+@var{command} is always found by searching the command path.
+
+@noindent
+@cindex redirection, current shell's I/O
+If @var{command} is omitted but any redirections are specified,
+then the redirections will take effect in the current shell.
+
+@findex exit
+@item @t{exit} [ @var{n} ]
+Exit the shell with the exit status specified by an arithmetic
+expression @var{n}; if none
+is specified, use the exit status from the last command executed.
+@pindex IGNORE_EOF, use of
+An EOF condition will also cause the shell to exit, unless
+the @t{IGNORE_EOF} option is set.
+
+@noindent
+See notes at the end of
+@ref{Jobs & Signals} for some possibly unexpected interactions
+of the @t{exit} command with jobs.
+
+@findex export
+@item @t{export} [ @var{name}[@t{=}@var{value}] ... ]
+The specified @var{name}s are marked for automatic export
+to the environment of subsequently executed commands.
+Equivalent to @t{typeset -gx}.
+If a parameter specified does not
+already exist, it is created in the global scope.
+
+@findex false
+@cindex doing nothing, unsuccessfully
+@item @t{false} [ @var{arg} ... ]
+Do nothing and return an exit status of 1.
+
+@findex fc
+@cindex history, editing
+@cindex editing history
+
+@item @t{fc} [ @t{-e} @var{ename} ] [ @t{-LI} ] [ @t{-m} @var{match} ] [ @var{old}@t{=}@var{new} ... ] [ @var{first} [ @var{last} ] ]
+@itemx @t{fc -l }[ @t{-LI} ] [ @t{-nrdfEiD} ] [ @t{-t} @var{timefmt} ] [ @t{-m} @var{match} ]
+@itemx @t{@ @ @ @ @ @ }[ @var{old}@t{=}@var{new} ... ] [ @var{first} [ @var{last} ] ]
+@itemx @t{fc -p }[ @t{-a} ] [ @var{filename} [ @var{histsize} [ @var{savehistsize} ] ] ]
+@itemx @t{fc} @t{-P}
+@itemx @t{fc} @t{-ARWI} [ @var{filename} ]
+The @t{fc} command controls the interactive history mechanism. Note
+that reading and writing of history options is only performed if the
+shell is interactive. Usually this is detected automatically, but
+it can be forced by setting the @t{interactive} option when starting the
+shell.
+
+@noindent
+The first two forms of this command select a range of events from
+@var{first} to @var{last} from the history list. The arguments @var{first}
+and @var{last} may be specified as a number or as a string. A negative
+number is used as an offset to the current history event number. A string
+specifies the most recent event beginning with the given string. All
+substitutions @var{old}@t{=}@var{new}, if any, are then performed on the
+text of the events.
+
+@noindent
+In addition to the number range,
+@table @asis
+@item @t{-I}
+restricts to only internal events (not from @t{$HISTFILE})
+@item @t{-L}
+restricts to only local events (not from other shells, see
+@t{SHARE_HISTORY} in @ref{Description of Options} -- note that @t{$HISTFILE} is
+considered local when read at startup)
+@item @t{-m}
+takes the first argument as a pattern (should be quoted) and
+only the history events matching this pattern are considered
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+If @var{first} is not specified, it will be set to -1 (the most recent
+event), or to -16 if the @t{-l} flag is given.
+If @var{last} is not specified, it will be set to @var{first},
+or to -1 if the @t{-l} flag is given.
+However, if the current event has added entries to the history with
+`@t{print -s}' or `@t{fc -R}', then the default @var{last} for @t{-l}
+includes all new history entries since the current event began.
+
+@noindent
+When the @t{-l} flag is given, the resulting events are listed on
+standard output. Otherwise the editor program specified by @t{-e} @var{ename}
+is invoked on a file containing these history events. If @t{-e} is not given, the
+value of the parameter @t{FCEDIT} is used; if that is not set the value of
+the parameter @t{EDITOR} is used; if that is not set a builtin default,
+usually `@t{vi}' is used. If @var{ename} is `@t{-}', no editor is invoked.
+When editing is complete, the edited command is executed.
+
+@noindent
+The flag @t{-r} reverses the order of the events and the
+flag @t{-n} suppresses event numbers when listing.
+
+@noindent
+Also when listing,
+@table @asis
+@item @t{-d}
+prints timestamps for each event
+@item @t{-f}
+prints full time-date stamps in the US
+`@var{MM}@t{/}@var{DD}@t{/}@var{YY} @var{hh}@t{:}@var{mm}' format
+@item @t{-E}
+prints full time-date stamps in the European
+`@var{dd}@t{.}@var{mm}@t{.}@var{yyyy} @var{hh}@t{:}@var{mm}' format
+@item @t{-i}
+prints full time-date stamps in ISO8601
+`@var{yyyy}@t{-}@var{mm}@t{-}@var{dd} @var{hh}@t{:}@var{mm}' format
+@item @t{-t} @var{fmt}
+prints time and date stamps in the given format;
+@var{fmt} is formatted with the strftime function with the zsh extensions
+described for the @t{%D@{}@var{string}@t{@}} prompt format in
+@ref{Prompt Expansion}. The resulting formatted string must be
+no more than 256 characters or will not be printed
+
+@item @t{-D}
+prints elapsed times; may be combined with one of the
+options above
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+@cindex history, stack
+@cindex stack, history
+`@t{fc -p}' pushes the current history list onto a stack and switches to a
+new history list. If the @t{-a} option is also specified, this history list
+will be automatically popped when the current function scope is exited, which
+is a much better solution than creating a trap function to call `@t{fc -P}'
+manually. If no arguments are specified, the history list is left empty,
+@t{$HISTFILE} is unset, and @t{$HISTSIZE} & @t{$SAVEHIST} are set to their
+default values. If one argument is given, @t{$HISTFILE} is set to that
+filename, @t{$HISTSIZE} & @t{$SAVEHIST} are left unchanged, and the history
+file is read in (if it exists) to initialize the new list. If a second
+argument is specified, @t{$HISTSIZE} & @t{$SAVEHIST} are instead set to the
+single specified numeric value. Finally, if a third argument is specified,
+@t{$SAVEHIST} is set to a separate value from @t{$HISTSIZE}. You are free to
+change these environment values for the new history list however you desire
+in order to manipulate the new history list.
+
+@noindent
+`@t{fc -P}' pops the history list back to an older list saved by `@t{fc -p}'.
+The current list is saved to its @t{$HISTFILE} before it is destroyed
+(assuming that @t{$HISTFILE} and @t{$SAVEHIST} are set appropriately, of
+course). The values of @t{$HISTFILE}, @t{$HISTSIZE}, and @t{$SAVEHIST} are
+restored to the values they had when `@t{fc -p}' was called. Note that this
+restoration can conflict with making these variables "local", so your best
+bet is to avoid local declarations for these variables in functions that use
+`@t{fc -p}'. The one other guaranteed-safe combination is declaring these
+variables to be local at the top of your function and using the automatic
+option (@t{-a}) with `@t{fc -p}'. Finally, note that it is legal to manually
+pop a push marked for automatic popping if you need to do so before the
+function exits.
+
+@noindent
+@cindex history, file
+@cindex file, history
+`@t{fc -R}' reads the history from the given file,
+`@t{fc -W}' writes the history out to the given file,
+and `@t{fc -A}' appends the history out to the given file.
+If no filename is specified, the @t{$HISTFILE} is assumed.
+If the @t{-I} option is added to @t{-R}, only those events that are
+not already contained within the internal history list are added.
+If the @t{-I} option is added to @t{-A} or @t{-W}, only those
+events that are new since last incremental append/write to
+the history file are appended/written.
+In any case, the created file will have no more than @t{$SAVEHIST}
+entries.
+
+@findex fg
+@cindex jobs, foregrounding
+@cindex jobs, resuming
+@item @t{fg} [ @var{job} ... ]
+@itemx @var{job} ...
+Bring each specified @var{job} in turn to the foreground.
+If no @var{job} is specified, resume the current job.
+
+@findex float
+@item @t{float} [ @{@t{+}|@t{-}@}@t{Hghlprtux} ] [ @{@t{+}|@t{-}@}@t{EFLRZ} [ @var{n} ] ] [ @var{name}[@t{=}@var{value}] ... ]
+Equivalent to @t{typeset -E}, except that options irrelevant to floating
+point numbers are not permitted.
+
+@findex functions
+@item @t{functions} [ @{@t{+}|@t{-}@}@t{UkmtTuWz} ] [ @t{-x} @var{num} ] [ @var{name} ... ]
+@itemx @t{functions -c} @var{oldfn} @var{newfn}
+@itemx @t{functions -M} [@t{-s}] @var{mathfn} [ @var{min} [ @var{max} [ @var{shellfn} ] ] ]
+@itemx @t{functions -M} [ @t{-m} @var{pattern} ... ]
+@itemx @t{functions +M} [ @t{-m} ] @var{mathfn} ...
+Equivalent to @t{typeset -f}, with the exception of the @t{-c}, @t{-x},
+@t{-M} and @t{-W} options. For @t{functions -u} and @t{functions -U},
+see @t{autoload}, which provides additional options.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{-x} option indicates that any functions output will have
+each leading tab for indentation, added by the shell to show syntactic
+structure, expanded to the given number @var{num} of spaces. @var{num}
+can also be 0 to suppress all indentation.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{-W} option turns on the option @t{WARN_NESTED_VAR} for the named
+function or functions only. The option is turned off at the start of
+nested functions (apart from anonoymous functions) unless the called
+function also has the @t{-W} attribute.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{-c} option causes @var{oldfn} to be copied to @var{newfn}. The
+copy is efficiently handled internally by reference counting. If
+@var{oldfn} was marked for autoload it is first loaded and if this
+fails the copy fails. Either function may subsequently be redefined
+without affecting the other. A typical idiom is that @var{oldfn} is the
+name of a library shell function which is then redefined to call
+@t{newfn}, thereby installing a modified version of the function.
+
+@noindent
+Use of the @t{-M} option may not be combined with any of the options
+handled by @t{typeset -f}.
+
+@noindent
+@t{functions -M} @var{mathfn} defines @var{mathfn} as the name of
+a mathematical function recognised in all forms of arithmetical expressions;
+see
+@ref{Arithmetic Evaluation}. By default @var{mathfn} may take
+any number of comma-separated arguments. If @var{min} is given,
+it must have exactly @var{min} args; if @var{min} and @var{max} are
+both given, it must have at least @var{min} and at most @var{max}
+args. @var{max} may be -1 to indicate that there is no upper limit.
+
+@noindent
+By default the function is implemented by a shell function of the same
+name; if @var{shellfn} is specified it gives the name of the corresponding
+shell function while @var{mathfn} remains the name used in arithmetical
+expressions. The name of the function in @t{$0} is @var{mathfn} (not
+@var{shellfn} as would usually be the case), provided the option
+@t{FUNCTION_ARGZERO} is in effect. The positional parameters in the shell
+function correspond to the arguments of the mathematical function call.
+The result of the last arithmetical expression evaluated
+inside the shell function (even if it is a form that normally only returns
+a status) gives the result of the mathematical function.
+
+@noindent
+If the additional option @t{-s} is given to @t{functions -M}, the
+argument to the function is a single string: anything between the
+opening and matching closing parenthesis is passed to the function as a
+single argument, even if it includes commas or white space. The minimum
+and maximum argument specifiers must therefore be 1 if given. An empty
+argument list is passed as a zero-length string.
+
+@noindent
+@t{functions -M} with no arguments lists all such user-defined functions in
+the same form as a definition. With the additional option @t{-m} and
+a list of arguments, all functions whose @var{mathfn} matches one of
+the pattern arguments are listed.
+
+@noindent
+@t{function +M} removes the list of mathematical functions; with the
+additional option @t{-m} the arguments are treated as patterns and
+all functions whose @var{mathfn} matches the pattern are removed. Note
+that the shell function implementing the behaviour is not removed
+(regardless of whether its name coincides with @var{mathfn}).
+
+@noindent
+For example, the following prints the cube of 3:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zmath_cube() @{ (( $1 * $1 * $1 )) @}
+functions -M cube 1 1 zmath_cube
+print $(( cube(3) ))
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The following string function takes a single argument, including
+the commas, so prints 11:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+stringfn() @{ (( $#1 )) @}
+functions -Ms stringfn
+print $(( stringfn(foo,bar,rod) ))
+@end example
+
+@item @t{getcap}
+See @ref{The zsh/cap Module}.
+
+@findex getln
+@cindex line, reading
+@cindex reading a line
+@item @t{getln} [ @t{-AclneE} ] @var{name} ...
+Read the top value from the buffer stack and put it in
+the shell parameter @var{name}. Equivalent to
+@t{read -zr}.
+
+@findex getopts
+@cindex options, processing
+@item @t{getopts} @var{optstring} @var{name} [ @var{arg} ... ]
+Checks the @var{arg}s for legal options. If the @var{arg}s are omitted,
+use the positional parameters. A valid option argument
+begins with a `@t{+}' or a `@t{-}'. An argument not beginning with
+a `@t{+}' or a `@t{-}', or the argument `@t{-}@t{-}', ends the options.
+Note that a single `@t{-}' is not considered a valid option argument.
+@var{optstring} contains the letters that @t{getopts}
+recognizes. If a letter is followed by a `@t{:}', that option
+requires an argument. The options can be
+separated from the argument by blanks.
+
+@noindent
+Each time it is invoked, @t{getopts} places the option letter it finds
+in the shell parameter @var{name}, prepended with a `@t{+}' when
+@var{arg} begins with a `@t{+}'. The index of the next @var{arg}
+is stored in @t{OPTIND}. The option argument, if any,
+is stored in @t{OPTARG}.
+@vindex OPTIND, use of
+@vindex OPTARG, use of
+
+@noindent
+The first option to be examined may be changed by explicitly assigning
+to @t{OPTIND}. @t{OPTIND} has an initial value of @t{1}, and is
+normally set to @t{1} upon entry to a shell function and restored
+upon exit (this is disabled by the @t{POSIX_BUILTINS} option). @t{OPTARG}
+is not reset and retains its value from the most recent call to
+@t{getopts}. If either of @t{OPTIND} or @t{OPTARG} is explicitly
+unset, it remains unset, and the index or option argument is not
+stored. The option itself is still stored in @var{name} in this case.
+
+@noindent
+A leading `@t{:}' in @var{optstring} causes @t{getopts} to store the
+letter of any invalid option in @t{OPTARG}, and to set @var{name} to
+`@t{?}' for an unknown option and to `@t{:}' when a required argument is
+missing. Otherwise, @t{getopts} sets @var{name} to `@t{?}' and prints
+an error message when an option is invalid. The exit status is
+nonzero when there are no more options.
+
+@findex hash
+@item @t{hash} [ @t{-Ldfmrv} ] [ @var{name}[@t{=}@var{value}] ] ...
+@t{hash} can be used to directly modify the contents of the command
+hash table, and the named directory hash table. Normally one would
+modify these tables by modifying one's @t{PATH}
+(for the command hash table) or by creating appropriate shell parameters
+(for the named directory hash table).
+The choice of hash table to work on is determined by the @t{-d} option;
+without the option the command hash table is used, and with the option the
+named directory hash table is used.
+
+@noindent
+A command @var{name} starting with a @t{/} is never hashed, whether by
+explicit use of the @t{hash} command or otherwise. Such a command
+is always found by direct look up in the file system.
+
+@noindent
+Given no arguments, and neither the @t{-r} or @t{-f} options,
+the selected hash table will be listed in full.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{-r} option causes the selected hash table to be emptied.
+It will be subsequently rebuilt in the normal fashion.
+The @t{-f} option causes the selected hash table to be fully
+rebuilt immediately. For the command hash table this hashes
+all the absolute directories in the @t{PATH},
+and for the named directory hash table this adds all users' home directories.
+These two options cannot be used with any arguments.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{-m} option causes the arguments to be taken as patterns
+(which should be quoted) and the elements of the hash table
+matching those patterns are printed. This is the only way to display
+a limited selection of hash table elements.
+
+@noindent
+For each @var{name} with a corresponding @var{value}, put `@var{name}' in
+the selected hash table, associating it with the pathname `@var{value}'.
+In the command hash table, this means that
+whenever `@var{name}' is used as a command argument, the shell will try
+to execute the file given by `@var{value}'.
+In the named directory hash table, this means
+that `@var{value}' may be referred to as `@t{~}@var{name}'.
+
+@noindent
+For each @var{name} with no
+corresponding @var{value}, attempt to add @var{name} to the hash table,
+checking what the appropriate @t{value} is in the normal manner for
+that hash table. If an appropriate @t{value} can't be found, then
+the hash table will be unchanged.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{-v} option causes hash table entries to be listed as they are
+added by explicit specification. If has no effect if used with @t{-f}.
+
+@noindent
+If the @t{-L} flag is present, then each hash table entry is printed in
+the form of a call to hash.
+
+@findex history
+@item @t{history}
+Same as @t{fc -l}.
+
+@findex integer
+@item @t{integer} [ @{@t{+}|@t{-}@}@t{Hghlprtux} ] [ @{@t{+}|@t{-}@}@t{LRZi} [ @var{n} ] ] [ @var{name}[@t{=}@var{value}] ... ]
+Equivalent to @t{typeset -i}, except that options irrelevant to
+integers are not permitted.
+
+@findex jobs
+@item @t{jobs} [ @t{-dlprs} ] [ @var{job} ... ]
+@itemx @t{jobs -Z} @var{string}
+Lists information about each given job, or all jobs
+if @var{job} is omitted. The @t{-l} flag lists process
+IDs, and the @t{-p} flag lists process groups.
+If the @t{-r} flag is specified only running jobs will be listed
+and if the @t{-s} flag is given only stopped jobs are shown.
+If the @t{-d} flag is given, the directory from which the job was
+started (which may not be the current directory of the job) will also
+be shown.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{-Z} option replaces the shell's argument and environment space with
+the given string, truncated if necessary to fit. This will normally be
+visible in @t{ps} (man page ps(1)) listings. This feature is typically
+used by daemons, to indicate their state.
+
+@findex kill
+@cindex killing jobs
+@cindex jobs, killing
+@item @t{kill} [ @t{-s} @var{signal_name} | @t{-n} @var{signal_number} | @t{-}@var{sig} ] @var{job} ...
+@itemx @t{kill} @t{-l} [ @var{sig} ... ]
+Sends either @t{SIGTERM} or the specified signal to the given
+jobs or processes.
+Signals are given by number or by names, with or without the `@t{SIG}'
+prefix.
+If the signal being sent is not `@t{KILL}' or `@t{CONT}', then the job
+will be sent a `@t{CONT}' signal if it is stopped.
+The argument @var{job} can be the process ID of a job
+not in the job list.
+In the second form, @t{kill -l}, if @var{sig} is not
+specified the signal names are listed. Otherwise, for each
+@var{sig} that is a name, the corresponding signal number is
+listed. For each @var{sig} that is a signal number or a number
+representing the exit status of a process which was terminated or
+stopped by a signal the name of the signal is printed.
+
+@noindent
+On some systems, alternative signal names are allowed for a few signals.
+Typical examples are @t{SIGCHLD} and @t{SIGCLD} or @t{SIGPOLL} and
+@t{SIGIO}, assuming they correspond to the same signal number. @t{kill
+-l} will only list the preferred form, however @t{kill -l} @var{alt} will
+show if the alternative form corresponds to a signal number. For example,
+under Linux @t{kill -l IO} and @t{kill -l POLL} both output 29, hence
+@t{kill -IO} and @t{kill -POLL} have the same effect.
+
+@noindent
+Many systems will allow process IDs to be negative to kill a process
+group or zero to kill the current process group.
+
+@findex let
+@item @t{let} @var{arg} ...
+Evaluate each @var{arg} as an arithmetic expression.
+See
+@ref{Arithmetic Evaluation}
+for a description of arithmetic expressions. The exit status is 0 if the
+value of the last expression is nonzero, 1 if it is zero, and 2 if
+an error occurred.
+
+@findex limit
+@cindex resource limits
+@cindex limits, resource
+@item @t{limit} [ @t{-hs} ] [ @var{resource} [ @var{limit} ] ] ...
+Set or display resource limits. Unless the @t{-s} flag is given,
+the limit applies only the children of the shell. If @t{-s} is
+given without other arguments, the resource limits of the current
+shell is set to the previously set resource limits of the children.
+
+@noindent
+If @var{limit} is not specified, print the current limit placed
+on @var{resource}, otherwise
+set the limit to the specified value. If the @t{-h} flag
+is given, use hard limits instead of soft limits.
+If no @var{resource} is given, print all limits.
+
+@noindent
+When looping over multiple resources, the shell will abort immediately if
+it detects a badly formed argument. However, if it fails to set a limit
+for some other reason it will continue trying to set the remaining limits.
+
+@noindent
+@var{resource} can be one of:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{addressspace}
+Maximum amount of address space used.
+@item @t{aiomemorylocked}
+Maximum amount of memory locked in RAM for AIO operations.
+@item @t{aiooperations}
+Maximum number of AIO operations.
+@item @t{cachedthreads}
+Maximum number of cached threads.
+@item @t{coredumpsize}
+Maximum size of a core dump.
+@item @t{cputime}
+Maximum CPU seconds per process.
+@item @t{datasize}
+Maximum data size (including stack) for each process.
+@item @t{descriptors}
+Maximum value for a file descriptor.
+@item @t{filesize}
+Largest single file allowed.
+@item @t{kqueues}
+Maximum number of kqueues allocated.
+@item @t{maxproc}
+Maximum number of processes.
+@item @t{maxpthreads}
+Maximum number of threads per process.
+@item @t{memorylocked}
+Maximum amount of memory locked in RAM.
+@item @t{memoryuse}
+Maximum resident set size.
+@item @t{msgqueue}
+Maximum number of bytes in POSIX message queues.
+@item @t{posixlocks}
+Maximum number of POSIX locks per user.
+@item @t{pseudoterminals}
+Maximum number of pseudo-terminals.
+@item @t{resident}
+Maximum resident set size.
+@item @t{sigpending}
+Maximum number of pending signals.
+@item @t{sockbufsize}
+Maximum size of all socket buffers.
+@item @t{stacksize}
+Maximum stack size for each process.
+@item @t{swapsize}
+Maximum amount of swap used.
+@item @t{vmemorysize}
+Maximum amount of virtual memory.
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+Which of these resource limits are available depends on the system.
+@var{resource} can be abbreviated to any unambiguous prefix. It
+can also be an integer, which corresponds to the integer defined
+for the resource by the operating system.
+
+@noindent
+If argument corresponds to a number which is out of the range of the
+resources configured into the shell, the shell will try to read or write
+the limit anyway, and will report an error if this fails. As the shell
+does not store such resources internally, an attempt to set the limit will
+fail unless the @t{-s} option is present.
+
+@noindent
+@var{limit} is a number, with an optional scaling factor, as follows:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @var{n}@t{h}
+hours
+@item @var{n}@t{k}
+kilobytes (default)
+@item @var{n}@t{m}
+megabytes or minutes
+@item @var{n}@t{g}
+gigabytes
+@item [@var{mm}@t{:}]@var{ss}
+minutes and seconds
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+The @t{limit} command is not made available by default when the
+shell starts in a mode emulating another shell. It can be made available
+with the command `@t{zmodload -F zsh/rlimits b:limit}'.
+
+@findex local
+@item @t{local} [ @{@t{+}|@t{-}@}@t{AHUahlprtux} ] [ @{@t{+}|@t{-}@}@t{EFLRZi} [ @var{n} ] ] [ @var{name}[@t{=}@var{value}] ... ]
+Same as @t{typeset}, except that the options @t{-g}, and
+@t{-f} are not permitted. In this case the @t{-x} option does not force
+the use of @t{-g}, i.e. exported variables will be local to functions.
+
+@findex log
+@vindex watch, use of
+@cindex watching users
+@cindex users, watching
+@item @t{log}
+List all users currently logged in who are affected by
+the current setting of the @t{watch} parameter.
+
+@findex logout
+@item @t{logout} [ @var{n} ]
+Same as @t{exit}, except that it only works in a login shell.
+
+@item @t{noglob} @var{simple command}
+See @ref{Precommand Modifiers}.
+
+@findex popd
+@item @t{popd} [ @t{-q} ] [ @{@t{+}|@t{-}@}@var{n} ]
+Remove an entry from the directory stack, and perform a @t{cd} to
+the new top directory. With no argument, the current top entry is
+removed. An argument of the form `@t{+}@var{n}' identifies a stack
+entry by counting from the left of the list shown by the @t{dirs} command,
+starting with zero. An argument of the form @t{-}@var{n} counts from the right.
+@pindex PUSHD_MINUS, use of
+If the @t{PUSHD_MINUS} option is set, the meanings of `@t{+}' and
+`@t{-}' in this context are swapped.
+
+@noindent
+If the @t{-q} (quiet) option is specified, the hook function @t{chpwd}
+and the functions in the array @t{$chpwd_functions} are not called,
+and the new directory stack is not printed. This is useful for calls to
+@t{popd} that do not change the environment seen by an interactive user.
+
+@findex print
+@item @t{print }[ @t{-abcDilmnNoOpPrsSz} ] [ @t{-u} @var{n} ] [ @t{-f} @var{format} ] [ @t{-C} @var{cols} ]
+@itemx @t{@ @ @ @ @ @ }[ @t{-v} @var{name} ] [ @t{-xX} @var{tabstop} ] [ @t{-R} [ @t{-en} ]] [ @var{arg} ... ]
+With the `@t{-f}' option the arguments are printed as described by @t{printf}.
+With no flags or with the flag `@t{-}', the arguments are printed on
+the standard output as described by @t{echo}, with the following differences:
+the escape sequence `@t{\M-}@var{x}' (or `@t{\M}@var{x}') metafies the character
+@var{x} (sets the highest bit),
+`@t{\C-}@var{x}' (or `@t{\C}@var{x}') produces a control character
+(`@t{\C-@@}' and `@t{\C-?}' give the characters NULL and delete),
+a character code in octal is represented by `@t{\}@var{NNN}'
+(instead of `@t{\0}@var{NNN}'),
+and `@t{\E}' is a synonym for `@t{\e}'.
+Finally, if not in an escape
+sequence, `@t{\}' escapes the following character and is not printed.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{-a}
+Print arguments with the column incrementing first. Only useful with the
+@t{-c} and @t{-C} options.
+
+@item @t{-b}
+Recognize all the escape sequences defined for the @t{bindkey} command,
+see
+@ref{Zle Builtins}.
+
+@item @t{-c}
+Print the arguments in columns. Unless @t{-a} is also given, arguments are
+printed with the row incrementing first.
+
+@item @t{-C} @var{cols}
+Print the arguments in @var{cols} columns. Unless @t{-a} is also given,
+arguments are printed with the row incrementing first.
+
+@item @t{-D}
+Treat the arguments as paths, replacing directory prefixes with @t{~}
+expressions corresponding to directory names, as appropriate.
+
+@item @t{-i}
+If given together with @t{-o} or @t{-O}, sorting is performed
+case-independently.
+
+@item @t{-l}
+Print the arguments separated by newlines instead of spaces. Note: if
+the list of arguments is empty, @t{print -l} will still output one empty
+line. To print a possibly-empty list of arguments one per line, use
+@t{print -C1}, as in `@t{print -rC1 -- "$list[@@]"}'.
+
+@item @t{-m}
+Take the first argument as a pattern (should be quoted), and remove
+it from the argument list together with subsequent arguments that
+do not match this pattern.
+
+@item @t{-n}
+Do not add a newline to the output.
+
+@item @t{-N}
+Print the arguments separated and terminated by nulls. Again,
+@t{print -rNC1 -- "$list[@@]"} is a canonical way to print an
+arbitrary list as null-delimited records.
+
+@item @t{-o}
+Print the arguments sorted in ascending order.
+
+@item @t{-O}
+Print the arguments sorted in descending order.
+
+@item @t{-p}
+Print the arguments to the input of the coprocess.
+
+@item @t{-P}
+Perform prompt expansion (see
+@ref{Prompt Expansion}).
+In combination with `@t{-f}',
+prompt escape sequences are parsed only within interpolated arguments,
+not within the format string.
+
+@item @t{-r}
+Ignore the escape conventions of @t{echo}.
+
+@item @t{-R}
+Emulate the BSD @t{echo} command, which does not process escape sequences
+unless the @t{-e} flag is given. The @t{-n} flag suppresses the trailing
+newline. Only the @t{-e} and @t{-n} flags are recognized after
+@t{-R}; all other arguments and options are printed.
+
+@item @t{-s}
+Place the results in the history list instead of on the standard output.
+Each argument to the @t{print} command is treated as a single word in the
+history, regardless of its content.
+
+@item @t{-S}
+Place the results in the history list instead of on the standard output.
+In this case only a single argument is allowed; it will be split into
+words as if it were a full shell command line. The effect is
+similar to reading the line from a history file with the
+@t{HIST_LEX_WORDS} option active.
+
+@item @t{-u} @var{n}
+Print the arguments to file descriptor @var{n}.
+
+@item @t{-v} @var{name}
+Store the printed arguments as the value of the parameter @var{name}.
+
+@item @t{-x} @var{tab-stop}
+Expand leading tabs on each line of output in the printed string
+assuming a tab stop every @var{tab-stop} characters. This is appropriate
+for formatting code that may be indented with tabs. Note that leading
+tabs of any argument to print, not just the first, are expanded, even if
+@t{print} is using spaces to separate arguments (the column count
+is maintained across arguments but may be incorrect on output
+owing to previous unexpanded tabs).
+
+@noindent
+The start of the output of each print command is assumed to be aligned
+with a tab stop. Widths of multibyte characters are handled if the
+option @t{MULTIBYTE} is in effect. This option is ignored if other
+formatting options are in effect, namely column alignment or
+@t{printf} style, or if output is to a special location such as shell
+history or the command line editor.
+
+@item @t{-X} @var{tab-stop}
+This is similar to @t{-x}, except that all tabs in the printed string
+are expanded. This is appropriate if tabs in the arguments are
+being used to produce a table format.
+
+@item @t{-z}
+Push the arguments onto the editing buffer stack, separated by spaces.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+If any of `@t{-m}', `@t{-o}' or `@t{-O}' are used in combination with
+`@t{-f}' and there are no arguments (after the removal process in the
+case of `@t{-m}') then nothing is printed.
+
+@findex printf
+@item @t{printf} [ @t{-v} @var{name} ] @var{format} [ @var{arg} ... ]
+Print the arguments according to the format specification. Formatting
+rules are the same as used in C. The same escape sequences as for @t{echo}
+are recognised in the format. All C conversion specifications ending in
+one of @t{csdiouxXeEfgGn} are handled. In addition to this, `@t{%b}' can be
+used instead of `@t{%s}' to cause escape sequences in the argument to be
+recognised and `@t{%q}' can be used to quote the argument in such a way
+that allows it to be reused as shell input. With the numeric format
+specifiers, if the corresponding argument starts with a quote character,
+the numeric value of the following character is used as the number to
+print; otherwise the argument is evaluated as an arithmetic expression. See
+@ref{Arithmetic Evaluation}
+for a description of arithmetic
+expressions. With `@t{%n}', the corresponding argument is taken as an
+identifier which is created as an integer parameter.
+
+@noindent
+Normally, conversion specifications are applied to each argument in order
+but they can explicitly specify the @var{n}th argument is to be used by
+replacing `@t{%}' by `@t{%}@var{n}@t{$}' and `@t{*}' by `@t{*}@var{n}@t{$}'.
+It is recommended that you do not mix references of this explicit style
+with the normal style and the handling of such mixed styles may be subject
+to future change.
+
+@noindent
+If arguments remain unused after formatting, the format string is reused
+until all arguments have been consumed. With the @t{print} builtin, this
+can be suppressed by using the @t{-r} option. If more arguments are
+required by the format than have been specified, the behaviour is as if
+zero or an empty string had been specified as the argument.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{-v} option causes the output to be stored as the value of the
+parameter @var{name}, instead of printed. If @var{name} is an array and
+the format string is reused when consuming arguments then one
+array element will be used for each use of the format string.
+
+@findex pushd
+@pindex PUSHD_TO_HOME, use of
+@pindex PUSHD_MINUS, use of
+@pindex CDABLE_VARS, use of
+@pindex PUSHD_SILENT, use of
+@item @t{pushd} [ @t{-qsLP} ] [ @var{arg} ]
+@itemx @t{pushd} [ @t{-qsLP} ] @var{old} @var{new}
+@itemx @t{pushd} [ @t{-qsLP} ] @{@t{+}|@t{-}@}@var{n}
+Change the current directory, and push the old current directory
+onto the directory stack. In the first form, change the
+current directory to @var{arg}.
+If @var{arg} is not specified, change to the second directory
+on the stack (that is, exchange the top two entries), or
+change to @t{$HOME} if the @t{PUSHD_TO_HOME}
+option is set or if there is only one entry on the stack.
+Otherwise, @var{arg} is interpreted as it would be by @t{cd}.
+The meaning of @var{old} and @var{new} in the second form is also
+the same as for @t{cd}.
+
+@noindent
+The third form of @t{pushd} changes directory by rotating the
+directory list. An argument of the form `@t{+}@var{n}' identifies a stack
+entry by counting from the left of the list shown by the @t{dirs}
+command, starting with zero. An argument of the form `@t{-}@var{n}' counts
+from the right. If the @t{PUSHD_MINUS} option is set, the meanings
+of `@t{+}' and `@t{-}' in this context are swapped.
+
+@noindent
+If the @t{-q} (quiet) option is specified, the hook function @t{chpwd}
+and the functions in the array @t{$chpwd_functions} are not called,
+and the new directory stack is not printed. This is useful for calls to
+@t{pushd} that do not change the environment seen by an interactive user.
+
+@noindent
+If the option @t{-q} is not specified and the shell option @t{PUSHD_SILENT}
+is not set, the directory stack will be printed after a @t{pushd} is
+performed.
+
+@noindent
+The options @t{-s}, @t{-L} and @t{-P} have the same meanings as for the
+@t{cd} builtin.
+
+@findex pushln
+@item @t{pushln} [ @var{arg} ... ]
+Equivalent to @t{print -nz}.
+
+@findex pwd
+@pindex CHASE_LINKS, use of
+@item @t{pwd} [ @t{-rLP} ]
+Print the absolute pathname of the current working directory.
+If the @t{-r} or the @t{-P} flag is specified, or the @t{CHASE_LINKS}
+option is set and the @t{-L} flag is not given, the printed path will not
+contain symbolic links.
+
+@findex r
+@item @t{r}
+Same as @t{fc -e -}.
+
+@findex read
+@vindex IFS, use of
+
+@item @t{read }[ @t{-rszpqAclneE} ] [ @t{-t} [ @var{num} ] ] [ @t{-k} [ @var{num} ] ] [ @t{-d} @var{delim} ]
+@itemx @t{@ @ @ @ @ }[ @t{-u} @var{n} ] [ @var{name}[@t{?}@var{prompt}] ] [ @var{name} ... ]
+@vindex REPLY, use of
+@vindex reply, use of
+Read one line and break it into fields using the characters
+in @t{$IFS} as separators, except as noted below.
+The first field is assigned to the first @var{name}, the second field
+to the second @var{name}, etc., with leftover
+fields assigned to the last @var{name}.
+If @var{name} is omitted then
+@t{REPLY} is used for scalars and @t{reply} for arrays.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{-r}
+Raw mode: a `@t{\}' at the end of a line does not signify line
+continuation and backslashes in the line don't quote the following
+character and are not removed.
+
+@item @t{-s}
+Don't echo back characters if reading from the terminal.
+
+@item @t{-q}
+Read only one character from the terminal and set @var{name} to
+`@t{y}' if this character was `@t{y}' or `@t{Y}' and to `@t{n}' otherwise.
+With this flag set the return status is zero only if the character was
+`@t{y}' or `@t{Y}'. This option may be used with a timeout (see @t{-t}); if
+the read times out, or encounters end of file, status 2 is returned. Input is
+read from the terminal unless one of @t{-u} or @t{-p} is present. This option
+may also be used within zle widgets.
+
+@item @t{-k} [ @var{num} ]
+Read only one (or @var{num}) characters. All are assigned to the first
+@var{name}, without word splitting. This flag is ignored when @t{-q} is
+present. Input is read from the terminal unless one of @t{-u} or @t{-p}
+is present. This option may also be used within zle widgets.
+
+@noindent
+Note that despite the mnemonic `key' this option does read full
+characters, which may consist of multiple bytes if the option
+@t{MULTIBYTE} is set.
+
+@item @t{-z}
+Read one entry from the editor buffer stack and assign it to the first
+@var{name}, without word splitting. Text is pushed onto the stack with
+`@t{print -z}' or with @t{push-line} from the line editor (see
+@ref{Zsh Line Editor}). This flag is ignored when the @t{-k} or @t{-q} flags are present.
+
+@item @t{-e}
+@itemx @t{-E}
+The input read is printed (echoed) to the standard output. If the @t{-e}
+flag is used, no input is assigned to the parameters.
+
+@item @t{-A}
+The first @var{name} is taken as the name of an array and all words are
+assigned to it.
+
+@item @t{-c}
+@itemx @t{-l}
+These flags are allowed only if called inside a
+function used for completion (specified with the @t{-K} flag to
+@t{compctl}). If the @t{-c} flag is given, the words of the
+current command are read. If the @t{-l} flag is given, the whole
+line is assigned as a scalar. If both flags are present, @t{-l}
+is used and @t{-c} is ignored.
+
+@item @t{-n}
+Together with @t{-c}, the number of the word the cursor is on is
+read. With @t{-l}, the index of the character the cursor is on is
+read. Note that the command name is word number 1, not word 0,
+and that when the cursor is at the end of the line, its character
+index is the length of the line plus one.
+
+@item @t{-u} @var{n}
+Input is read from file descriptor @var{n}.
+
+@item @t{-p}
+Input is read from the coprocess.
+
+@item @t{-d} @var{delim}
+Input is terminated by the first character of @var{delim} instead of
+by newline.
+
+@item @t{-t} [ @var{num} ]
+Test if input is available before attempting to read. If @var{num}
+is present, it must begin with a digit and will be evaluated
+to give a number of seconds, which may be a floating point number;
+in this case the read times out if input is not available within this
+time. If @var{num} is not present, it is taken to be zero, so that
+@t{read} returns immediately if no input is available.
+If no input is available, return status 1 and do not set any variables.
+
+This option is not available when reading from the editor buffer with
+@t{-z}, when called from within completion with @t{-c} or @t{-l}, with
+@t{-q} which clears the input queue before reading, or within zle where
+other mechanisms should be used to test for input.
+
+Note that read does not attempt to alter the input processing mode. The
+default mode is canonical input, in which an entire line is read at a time,
+so usually `@t{read -t}' will not read anything until an entire line has
+been typed. However, when reading from the terminal with @t{-k}
+input is processed one key at a time; in this case, only availability of
+the first character is tested, so that e.g. `@t{read -t -k 2}' can still
+block on the second character. Use two instances of `@t{read -t -k}' if
+this is not what is wanted.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+If the first argument contains a `@t{?}', the remainder of this
+word is used as a @var{prompt} on standard error when the shell
+is interactive.
+
+@noindent
+The value (exit status) of @t{read} is 1 when an end-of-file is
+encountered, or when @t{-c} or @t{-l} is present and the command is
+not called from a @t{compctl} function, or as described for @t{-q}.
+Otherwise the value is 0.
+
+@noindent
+The behavior of some combinations of the @t{-k}, @t{-p}, @t{-q}, @t{-u}
+and @t{-z} flags is undefined. Presently @t{-q} cancels all the others,
+@t{-p} cancels @t{-u}, @t{-k} cancels @t{-z}, and otherwise @t{-z}
+cancels both @t{-p} and @t{-u}.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{-c} or @t{-l} flags cancel any and all of @t{-kpquz}.
+
+@cindex parameters, marking readonly
+@item @t{readonly}
+Same as @t{typeset -r}. With the @t{POSIX_BUILTINS} option set, same
+as @t{typeset -gr}.
+
+@findex rehash
+@item @t{rehash}
+Same as @t{hash -r}.
+
+@findex return
+@cindex functions, returning from
+@item @t{return} [ @var{n} ]
+Causes a shell function or `@t{.}' script to return to
+the invoking script with the return status specified by
+an arithmetic expression @var{n}. If @var{n}
+is omitted, the return status is that of the last command
+executed.
+
+@noindent
+If @t{return} was executed from a trap in a @t{TRAP}@var{NAL} function,
+the effect is different for zero and non-zero return status. With zero
+status (or after an implicit return at the end of the trap), the shell
+will return to whatever it was previously processing; with a non-zero
+status, the shell will behave as interrupted except that the return
+status of the trap is retained. Note that the numeric value of the signal
+which caused the trap is passed as the first argument, so the statement
+`@t{return $((128+$1))}' will return the same status as if the signal
+had not been trapped.
+
+@item @t{sched}
+See @ref{The zsh/sched Module}.
+
+@findex set
+@cindex parameters, listing
+@cindex parameters, positional
+@cindex parameters, setting array
+@cindex array parameters, setting
+@pindex KSH_ARRAYS, use of
+
+@item @t{set }[ @{@t{+}|@t{-}@}@var{options} | @{@t{+}|@t{-}@}@t{o} [ @var{option_name} ] ] ... [ @{@t{+}|@t{-}@}@t{A} [ @var{name} ] ]
+@itemx @t{@ @ @ @ }[ @var{arg} ... ]
+Set the options for the shell and/or set the positional parameters, or
+declare and set an array. If the @t{-s} option is given, it causes the
+specified arguments to be sorted before assigning them to the positional
+parameters (or to the array @var{name} if @t{-A} is used). With @t{+s}
+sort arguments in descending order. For the meaning of the other flags, see
+@ref{Options}. Flags may be specified by name using the @t{-o} option. If no option
+name is supplied with @t{-o}, the current option states are printed: see
+the description of @t{setopt} below for more information on the format.
+With @t{+o} they are printed in a form that can be used as input
+to the shell.
+
+@noindent
+If the @t{-A} flag is specified, @var{name} is set to an array containing
+the given @var{arg}s; if no @var{name} is specified, all arrays are printed
+together with their values.
+
+@noindent
+If @t{+A} is used and @var{name} is an array, the
+given arguments will replace the initial elements of that array; if no
+@var{name} is specified, all arrays are printed without their values.
+
+@noindent
+The behaviour of arguments after @t{-A} @var{name} or @t{+A} @var{name}
+depends on whether the option @t{KSH_ARRAYS} is set. If it is not set, all
+arguments following @var{name} are treated as values for the array,
+regardless of their form. If the option is set, normal option processing
+continues at that point; only regular arguments are treated as values for
+the array. This means that
+
+@noindent
+@example
+set -A array -x -- foo
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+sets @t{array} to `@t{-x -}@t{- foo}' if @t{KSH_ARRAYS} is not set, but sets
+the array to @t{foo} and turns on the option `@t{-x}' if it is set.
+
+@noindent
+If the @t{-A} flag is not present, but there are arguments beyond the
+options, the positional parameters are set. If the option list (if any)
+is terminated by `@t{-}@t{-}', and there are no further arguments, the
+positional parameters will be unset.
+
+@noindent
+If no arguments and no `@t{-}@t{-}' are given, then the names and values of
+all parameters are printed on the standard output. If the only argument is
+`@t{+}', the names of all parameters are printed.
+
+@noindent
+For historical reasons, `@t{set -}' is treated as `@t{set +xv}'
+and `@t{set -} @var{args}' as `@t{set +xv --} @var{args}' when in
+any other emulation mode than zsh's native mode.
+
+@item @t{setcap}
+See @ref{The zsh/cap Module}.
+
+@findex setopt
+@cindex options, setting
+@item @t{setopt} [ @{@t{+}|@t{-}@}@var{options} | @{@t{+}|@t{-}@}@t{o} @var{option_name} ] [ @t{-m} ] [ @var{name} ... ]
+Set the options for the shell. All options specified either
+with flags or by name are set.
+
+@noindent
+If no arguments are supplied, the names of all options currently set are
+printed. The form is chosen so as to minimize the differences from the
+default options for the current emulation (the default emulation being
+native @t{zsh}, shown as @t{<Z>} in
+@ref{Description of Options}).
+Options that are on by default for the emulation are
+shown with the prefix @t{no} only if they are off, while other options are
+shown without the prefix @t{no} and only if they are on. In addition to
+options changed from the default state by the user, any options activated
+automatically by the shell (for example, @t{SHIN_STDIN} or @t{INTERACTIVE})
+will be shown in the list. The format is further modified by the option
+@t{KSH_OPTION_PRINT}, however the rationale for choosing options with
+or without the @t{no} prefix remains the same in this case.
+
+@noindent
+If the @t{-m} flag is given the arguments are taken as patterns
+(which should be quoted to protect them from filename expansion), and all
+options with names matching these patterns are set.
+
+@noindent
+Note that a bad option name does not cause execution of subsequent shell
+code to be aborted; this is behaviour is different from that of `@t{set
+-o}'. This is because @t{set} is regarded as a special builtin by the
+POSIX standard, but @t{setopt} is not.
+
+@findex shift
+@cindex parameters, positional
+@item @t{shift} [ @t{-p} ] [ @var{n} ] [ @var{name} ... ]
+The positional parameters @t{$@{}@var{n}+1@t{@}} ... are renamed
+to @t{$1} ..., where @var{n} is an arithmetic expression that
+defaults to 1.
+If any @var{name}s are given then the arrays with these names are
+shifted instead of the positional parameters.
+
+@noindent
+If the option @t{-p} is given arguments are instead removed (popped)
+from the end rather than the start of the array.
+
+@findex source
+@item @t{source} @var{file} [ @var{arg} ... ]
+Same as `@t{.}', except that the current directory is always searched and
+is always searched first, before directories in @t{$path}.
+
+@item @t{stat}
+See @ref{The zsh/stat Module}.
+
+@findex suspend
+@cindex shell, suspending
+@cindex suspending the shell
+@item @t{suspend} [ @t{-f} ]
+Suspend the execution of the shell (send it a @t{SIGTSTP})
+until it receives a @t{SIGCONT}.
+Unless the @t{-f} option is given, this will refuse to suspend a login shell.
+
+@findex test
+@item @t{test} [ @var{arg} ... ]
+@itemx @t{[} [ @var{arg} ... ] @t{]}
+Like the system version of @t{test}. Added for compatibility;
+use conditional expressions instead (see @ref{Conditional Expressions}).
+The main differences between the conditional expression syntax and the
+@t{test} and @t{[} builtins are: these commands are not handled
+syntactically, so for example an empty variable expansion may cause an
+argument to be omitted; syntax errors cause status 2 to be returned instead
+of a shell error; and arithmetic operators expect integer arguments rather
+than arithmetic expressions.
+
+@noindent
+The command attempts to implement POSIX and its extensions where these
+are specified. Unfortunately there are intrinsic ambiguities in
+the syntax; in particular there is no distinction between test operators
+and strings that resemble them. The standard attempts to resolve these
+for small numbers of arguments (up to four); for five or more arguments
+compatibility cannot be relied on. Users are urged wherever possible to
+use the `@t{[[}' test syntax which does not have these ambiguities.
+
+@findex times
+@cindex shell, timing
+@cindex timing the shell
+@item @t{times}
+Print the accumulated user and system times for the shell
+and for processes run from the shell.
+
+@findex trap
+@cindex signals, trapping
+@cindex trapping signals
+@item @t{trap} [ @var{arg} ] [ @var{sig} ... ]
+@var{arg} is a series of commands (usually quoted to protect it from
+immediate evaluation by the shell) to be read and executed when the shell
+receives any of the signals specified by one or more @var{sig} args.
+Each @var{sig} can be given as a number,
+or as the name of a signal either with or without the string @t{SIG}
+in front (e.g. 1, HUP, and SIGHUP are all the same signal).
+
+@noindent
+If @var{arg} is `@t{-}', then the specified signals are reset to their
+defaults, or, if no @var{sig} args are present, all traps are reset.
+
+@noindent
+If @var{arg} is an empty string, then the specified signals
+are ignored by the shell (and by the commands it invokes).
+
+@noindent
+If @var{arg} is omitted but one or more @var{sig} args are provided (i.e.
+the first argument is a valid signal number or name), the effect is the
+same as if @var{arg} had been specified as `@t{-}'.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{trap} command with no arguments prints a list of commands
+associated with each signal.
+
+@noindent
+If @var{sig} is @t{ZERR} then @var{arg} will be executed
+after each command with a nonzero exit status. @t{ERR} is an alias
+for @t{ZERR} on systems that have no @t{SIGERR} signal (this is the
+usual case).
+
+@noindent
+If @var{sig} is @t{DEBUG} then @var{arg} will be executed
+before each command if the option @t{DEBUG_BEFORE_CMD} is set
+(as it is by default), else after each command. Here, a `command' is
+what is described as a `sublist' in the shell grammar, see
+@ref{Simple Commands & Pipelines}.
+If @t{DEBUG_BEFORE_CMD} is set various additional features are available.
+First, it is possible to skip the next command by setting the option
+@t{ERR_EXIT}; see the description of the @t{ERR_EXIT} option in
+@ref{Description of Options}. Also, the shell parameter
+@t{ZSH_DEBUG_CMD} is set to the string corresponding to the command
+to be executed following the trap. Note that this string is reconstructed
+from the internal format and may not be formatted the same way as the
+original text. The parameter is unset after the trap is executed.
+
+@noindent
+If @var{sig} is @t{0} or @t{EXIT}
+and the @t{trap} statement is executed inside the body of a function,
+then the command @var{arg} is executed after the function completes.
+The value of @t{$?} at the start of execution is the exit status of the
+shell or the return status of the function exiting.
+If @var{sig} is @t{0} or @t{EXIT}
+and the @t{trap} statement is not executed inside the body of a function,
+then the command @var{arg} is executed when the shell terminates; the
+trap runs before any @t{zshexit} hook functions.
+
+@noindent
+@t{ZERR}, @t{DEBUG}, and @t{EXIT} traps are not executed inside other
+traps. @t{ZERR} and @t{DEBUG} traps are kept within subshells, while
+other traps are reset.
+
+@noindent
+Note that traps defined with the @t{trap} builtin are slightly different
+from those defined as `@t{TRAP}@var{NAL} () @{ ... @}', as the latter have
+their own function environment (line numbers, local variables, etc.) while
+the former use the environment of the command in which they were called.
+For example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+trap 'print $LINENO' DEBUG
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+will print the line number of a command executed after it has run, while
+
+@noindent
+@example
+TRAPDEBUG() @{ print $LINENO; @}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+will always print the number zero.
+
+@noindent
+Alternative signal names are allowed as described under @t{kill} above.
+Defining a trap under either name causes any trap under an alternative
+name to be removed. However, it is recommended that for consistency
+users stick exclusively to one name or another.
+
+@findex true
+@cindex doing nothing, successfully
+@item @t{true} [ @var{arg} ... ]
+Do nothing and return an exit status of 0.
+
+@findex ttyctl
+@cindex tty, freezing
+@item @t{ttyctl} [ @t{-fu} ]
+The @t{-f} option freezes the tty (i.e. terminal or terminal emulator), and
+@t{-u} unfreezes it.
+When the tty is frozen, no changes made to the tty settings by
+external programs will be honored by the shell, except for changes in the
+size of the screen; the shell will
+simply reset the settings to their previous values as soon as each
+command exits or is suspended. Thus, @t{stty} and similar programs have
+no effect when the tty is frozen. Freezing the tty does not cause
+the current state to be remembered: instead, it causes future changes
+to the state to be blocked.
+
+@noindent
+Without options it reports whether the terminal is frozen or not.
+
+@noindent
+Note that, regardless of whether the tty is frozen or not, the
+shell needs to change the settings when the line editor starts, so
+unfreezing the tty does not guarantee settings made on the
+command line are preserved. Strings of commands run between
+editing the command line will see a consistent tty state.
+See also the shell variable @t{STTY} for a means of initialising
+the tty before running external commands.
+
+@findex type
+@item @t{type} [ @t{-wfpamsS} ] @var{name} ...
+Equivalent to @t{whence -v}.
+
+@findex typeset
+@cindex parameters, setting
+@cindex parameters, declaring
+
+@item @t{typeset }[ @{@t{+}|@t{-}@}@t{AHUaghlmrtux} ] [ @{@t{+}|@t{-}@}@t{EFLRZip} [ @var{n} ] ]
+@itemx @t{@ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ }[ @t{+} ] [ @var{name}[@t{=}@var{value}] ... ]
+@itemx @t{typeset }@t{-T} [ @{@t{+}|@t{-}@}@t{Uglrux} ] [ @{@t{+}|@t{-}@}@t{LRZp} [ @var{n} ] ]
+@itemx @t{@ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ }[ @t{+} | @var{SCALAR}[@t{=}@var{value}] @var{array}[@t{=(}@var{value} ...@t{)}] [ @var{sep} ] ]
+@itemx @t{typeset} @t{-f} [ @{@t{+}|@t{-}@}@t{TUkmtuz} ] [ @t{+} ] [ @var{name} ... ]
+Set or display attributes and values for shell parameters.
+
+@noindent
+Except as noted below for control flags that change the behavior,
+a parameter is created for each @var{name} that does not already refer
+to one. When inside a function, a new parameter is created for every
+@var{name} (even those that already exist), and is unset again when the
+function completes. See
+@ref{Local Parameters}. The same rules apply to special shell parameters, which
+retain their special attributes when made local.
+
+@noindent
+For each @var{name}@t{=}@var{value} assignment, the parameter
+@var{name} is set to @var{value}.
+
+@noindent
+If the shell option @t{TYPESET_SILENT} is not set, for each remaining
+@var{name} that refers to a parameter that is already set, the name and
+value of the parameter are printed in the form of an assignment.
+Nothing is printed for newly-created parameters, or when any attribute
+flags listed below are given along with the @var{name}. Using
+`@t{+}' instead of minus to introduce an attribute turns it off.
+
+@noindent
+If no @var{name} is present, the names and values of all parameters are
+printed. In this case the attribute flags restrict the display to only
+those parameters that have the specified attributes, and using `@t{+}'
+rather than `@t{-}' to introduce the flag suppresses printing of the values
+of parameters when there is no parameter name.
+
+@noindent
+All forms of the command handle scalar assignment. Array assignment is
+possible if any of the reserved words @t{declare}, @t{export}, @t{float},
+@t{integer}, @t{local}, @t{readonly} or @t{typeset} is matched when the
+line is parsed (N.B. not when it is executed). In this case the arguments
+are parsed as assignments, except that the `@t{+=}' syntax and the
+@t{GLOB_ASSIGN} option are not supported, and scalar values after @t{=}
+are @emph{not} split further into words, even if expanded (regardless of the
+setting of the @t{KSH_TYPESET} option; this option is obsolete).
+
+@noindent
+Examples of the differences between command and reserved word parsing:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+# Reserved word parsing
+typeset svar=$(echo one word) avar=(several words)
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The above creates a scalar parameter @t{svar} and an array
+parameter @t{avar} as if the assignments had been
+
+@noindent
+@example
+svar="one word"
+avar=(several words)
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+On the other hand:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+# Normal builtin interface
+builtin typeset svar=$(echo two words)
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The @t{builtin} keyword causes the above to use the standard builtin
+interface to @t{typeset} in which argument parsing is performed in the same
+way as for other commands. This example creates a scalar @t{svar}
+containing the value @t{two} and another scalar parameter @t{words} with
+no value. An array value in this case would either cause an error or be
+treated as an obscure set of glob qualifiers.
+
+@noindent
+Arbitrary arguments are allowed if they take the form of assignments
+after command line expansion; however, these only perform scalar
+assignment:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+var='svar=val'
+typeset $var
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The above sets the scalar parameter @t{svar} to the value @t{val}.
+Parentheses around the value within @t{var} would not cause array
+assignment as they will be treated as ordinary characters when @t{$var}
+is substituted. Any non-trivial expansion in the name part of the
+assignment causes the argument to be treated in this fashion:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+typeset @{var1,var2,var3@}=name
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The above syntax is valid, and has the expected effect of setting the
+three parameters to the same value, but the command line is parsed as
+a set of three normal command line arguments to @t{typeset} after
+expansion. Hence it is not possible to assign to multiple arrays by
+this means.
+
+@noindent
+Note that each interface to any of the commands my be disabled
+separately. For example, `@t{disable -r typeset}' disables the reserved
+word interface to @t{typeset}, exposing the builtin interface, while
+`@t{disable typeset}' disables the builtin. Note that disabling the
+reserved word interface for @t{typeset} may cause problems with the
+output of `@t{typeset -p}', which assumes the reserved word interface is
+available in order to restore array and associative array values.
+
+@noindent
+Unlike parameter assignment statements, @t{typeset}'s exit status on an
+assignment that involves a command substitution does not reflect the exit
+status of the command substitution. Therefore, to test for an error in
+a command substitution, separate the declaration of the parameter from its
+initialization:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+# WRONG
+typeset var1=$(exit 1) || echo "Trouble with var1"
+
+# RIGHT
+typeset var1 && var1=$(exit 1) || echo "Trouble with var1"
+
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+To initialize a parameter @var{param} to a command output and mark it readonly,
+use @t{typeset -r }@var{param} or @t{readonly }@var{param} after the parameter
+assignment statement.
+
+@noindent
+If no attribute flags are given, and either no @var{name} arguments are
+present or the flag @t{+m} is used, then each parameter name printed is
+preceded by a list of the attributes of that parameter (@t{array},
+@t{association}, @t{exported}, @t{float}, @t{integer}, @t{readonly},
+or @t{undefined} for autoloaded parameters not yet loaded). If @t{+m} is
+used with attribute flags, and all those flags are introduced with
+@t{+}, the matching parameter names are printed but their values
+are not.
+
+@noindent
+The following control flags change the behavior of @t{typeset}:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{+}
+If `@t{+}' appears by itself in a separate word as the last option,
+then the names of all parameters (functions with @t{-f}) are printed, but
+the values (function bodies) are not. No @var{name} arguments may appear,
+and it is an error for any other options to follow `@t{+}'. The
+effect of `@t{+}' is as if all attribute flags which precede it were
+given with a `@t{+}' prefix. For example, `@t{typeset -U +}' is
+equivalent to `@t{typeset +U}' and displays the names of all arrays having
+the uniqueness attribute, whereas `@t{typeset -f -U +}' displays the
+names of all autoloadable functions. If @t{+} is the only option,
+then type information (array, readonly, etc.) is also printed for each
+parameter, in the same manner as `@t{typeset +m "*"}'.
+
+@item @t{-g}
+The @t{-g} (global) means that any resulting parameter will not be
+restricted to local scope. Note that this does not necessarily mean that
+the parameter will be global, as the flag will apply to any existing
+parameter (even if unset) from an enclosing function. This flag does not
+affect the parameter after creation, hence it has no effect when listing
+existing parameters, nor does the flag @t{+g} have any effect except in
+combination with @t{-m} (see below).
+
+@item @t{-m}
+If the @t{-m} flag is given the @var{name} arguments are taken as patterns
+(use quoting to prevent these from being interpreted as file patterns).
+With no attribute flags, all parameters (or functions with the @t{-f}
+flag) with matching names are printed (the shell option @t{TYPESET_SILENT}
+is not used in this case).
+
+@noindent
+If the @t{+g} flag is combined with @t{-m}, a new local parameter is
+created for every matching parameter that is not already local. Otherwise
+@t{-m} applies all other flags or assignments to the existing parameters.
+
+@noindent
+Except when assignments are made with @var{name}@t{=}@var{value}, using
+@t{+m} forces the matching parameters and their attributes to be printed,
+even inside a function. Note that @t{-m} is ignored if no patterns are
+given, so `@t{typeset -m}' displays attributes but `@t{typeset -a +m}'
+does not.
+
+@item @t{-p} [ @var{n} ]
+If the @t{-p} option is given, parameters and values are printed in the
+form of a typeset command with an assignment, regardless of other flags
+and options. Note that the @t{-H} flag on parameters is respected; no
+value will be shown for these parameters.
+
+@noindent
+@t{-p} may be followed by an optional integer argument. Currently
+only the value @t{1} is supported. In this case arrays and associative
+arrays are printed with newlines between indented elements for
+readability.
+
+@item @t{-T} [ @var{scalar}[@t{=}@var{value}] @var{array}[@t{=(}@var{value} ...@t{)}] [ @var{sep} ] ]
+This flag has a different meaning when used with @t{-f}; see below.
+Otherwise the @t{-T} option requires zero, two, or three arguments to be
+present. With no arguments, the list of parameters created in this
+fashion is shown. With two or three arguments, the first two are the name
+of a scalar and of an array parameter (in that order) that will be tied
+together in the manner of @t{$PATH} and @t{$path}. The optional third
+argument is a single-character separator which will be used to join the
+elements of the array to form the scalar; if absent, a colon is used, as
+with @t{$PATH}. Only the first character of the separator is significant;
+any remaining characters are ignored. Multibyte characters are not
+yet supported.
+
+@noindent
+Only one of the scalar and array parameters may be assigned an initial
+value (the restrictions on assignment forms described above also apply).
+
+@noindent
+Both the scalar and the array may be manipulated as normal. If one is
+unset, the other will automatically be unset too. There is no way of
+untying the variables without unsetting them, nor of converting the type
+of one of them with another @t{typeset} command; @t{+T} does not work,
+assigning an array to @var{scalar} is an error, and assigning a scalar to
+@var{array} sets it to be a single-element array.
+
+@noindent
+Note that both `@t{typeset -xT ...}' and `@t{export -T ...}' work, but
+only the scalar will be marked for export. Setting the value using the
+scalar version causes a split on all separators (which cannot be quoted).
+It is possible to apply @t{-T} to two previously tied variables but with a
+different separator character, in which case the variables remain joined
+as before but the separator is changed.
+
+@noindent
+When an existing scalar is tied to a new array, the value of the scalar
+is preserved but no attribute other than export will be preserved.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+Attribute flags that transform the final value (@t{-L}, @t{-R}, @t{-Z},
+@t{-l}, @t{-u}) are only applied to the expanded value at the point
+of a parameter expansion expression using `@t{$}'. They are not applied
+when a parameter is retrieved internally by the shell for any purpose.
+
+@noindent
+The following attribute flags may be specified:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{-A}
+The names refer to associative array parameters; see
+@ref{Array Parameters}.
+
+@item @t{-L} [ @var{n} ]
+Left justify and remove leading blanks from the value when the parameter
+is expanded.
+If @var{n} is nonzero, it defines the width of the field.
+If @var{n} is zero, the width is determined by the width of the value of
+the first assignment. In the case of numeric parameters, the length of the
+complete value assigned to the parameter is used to determine the width,
+not the value that would be output.
+
+@noindent
+The width is the count of characters, which may be multibyte characters
+if the @t{MULTIBYTE} option is in effect. Note that the screen
+width of the character is not taken into account; if this is required,
+use padding with parameter expansion flags
+@t{$@{(ml}@var{...}@t{)}@var{...}@t{@}} as described in
+`Parameter Expansion Flags' in
+@ref{Parameter Expansion}.
+
+@noindent
+When the parameter is expanded, it is filled on the right with
+blanks or truncated if necessary to fit the field.
+Note truncation can lead to unexpected results with numeric parameters.
+Leading zeros are removed if the @t{-Z} flag is also set.
+
+@item @t{-R} [ @var{n} ]
+Similar to @t{-L}, except that right justification is used;
+when the parameter is expanded, the field is left filled with
+blanks or truncated from the end. May not be combined with the @t{-Z}
+flag.
+
+@item @t{-U}
+For arrays (but not for associative arrays), keep only the first
+occurrence of each duplicated value. This may also be set for tied
+parameters (see @t{-T}) or colon-separated special parameters like
+@t{PATH} or @t{FIGNORE}, etc. Note the flag takes effect on assignment,
+and the type of the variable being assigned to is determinative; for
+variables with shared values it is therefore recommended to set the flag
+for all interfaces, e.g. `@t{typeset -U PATH path}'.
+
+@noindent
+This flag has a different meaning when used with @t{-f}; see below.
+
+@item @t{-Z} [ @var{n} ]
+Specially handled if set along with the @t{-L} flag.
+Otherwise, similar to @t{-R}, except that leading zeros are used for
+padding instead of blanks if the first non-blank character is a digit.
+Numeric parameters are specially handled: they are always eligible
+for padding with zeroes, and the zeroes are inserted at an appropriate
+place in the output.
+
+@item @t{-a}
+The names refer to array parameters. An array parameter may be
+created this way, but it may be assigned to in the @t{typeset}
+statement only if the reserved word form of @t{typeset} is enabled
+(as it is by default). When displaying, both normal and associative
+arrays are shown.
+
+@item @t{-f}
+The names refer to functions rather than parameters. No assignments
+can be made, and the only other valid flags are @t{-t}, @t{-T}, @t{-k},
+@t{-u}, @t{-U} and @t{-z}. The flag @t{-t} turns on execution tracing
+for this function; the flag @t{-T} does the same, but turns off tracing
+for any named (not anonymous) function called from the present one,
+unless that function also
+has the @t{-t} or @t{-T} flag. The @t{-u} and @t{-U} flags cause the
+function to be marked for autoloading; @t{-U} also causes alias
+expansion to be suppressed when the function is loaded. See the
+description of the `@t{autoload}' builtin for details.
+
+@noindent
+Note that the builtin @t{functions} provides the same basic capabilities
+as @t{typeset -f} but gives access to a few extra options; @t{autoload}
+gives further additional options for the case @t{typeset -fu} and
+@t{typeset -fU}.
+
+@item @t{-h}
+Hide: only useful for special parameters (those marked `<S>' in the table in
+@ref{Parameters Set By The Shell}), and for local parameters with the same name as a special parameter,
+though harmless for others. A special parameter with this attribute will
+not retain its special effect when made local. Thus after `@t{typeset -h
+PATH}', a function containing `@t{typeset PATH}' will create an ordinary
+local parameter without the usual behaviour of @t{PATH}. Alternatively,
+the local parameter may itself be given this attribute; hence inside a
+function `@t{typeset -h PATH}' creates an ordinary local parameter and the
+special @t{PATH} parameter is not altered in any way. It is also possible
+to create a local parameter using `@t{typeset +h }@var{special}', where the
+local copy of @var{special} will retain its special properties regardless of
+having the @t{-h} attribute. Global special parameters loaded from shell
+modules (currently those in @t{zsh/mapfile} and @t{zsh/parameter}) are
+automatically given the @t{-h} attribute to avoid name clashes.
+
+@item @t{-H}
+Hide value: specifies that @t{typeset} will not display the value of the
+parameter when listing parameters; the display for such parameters is
+always as if the `@t{+}' flag had been given. Use of the parameter is
+in other respects normal, and the option does not apply if the parameter is
+specified by name, or by pattern with the @t{-m} option. This is on by
+default for the parameters in the @t{zsh/parameter} and @t{zsh/mapfile}
+modules. Note, however, that unlike the @t{-h} flag this is also useful
+for non-special parameters.
+
+@item @t{-i} [ @var{n} ]
+Use an internal integer representation. If @var{n} is nonzero it
+defines the output arithmetic base, otherwise it is determined by the
+first assignment. Bases from 2 to 36 inclusive are allowed.
+
+@item @t{-E} [ @var{n} ]
+Use an internal double-precision floating point representation. On output
+the variable will be converted to scientific notation. If @var{n} is
+nonzero it defines the number of significant figures to display; the
+default is ten.
+
+@item @t{-F} [ @var{n} ]
+Use an internal double-precision floating point representation. On output
+the variable will be converted to fixed-point decimal notation. If @var{n}
+is nonzero it defines the number of digits to display after the decimal
+point; the default is ten.
+
+@item @t{-l}
+Convert the result to lower case whenever the parameter is expanded.
+The value is @emph{not} converted when assigned.
+
+@item @t{-r}
+The given @var{name}s are marked readonly. Note that if @var{name} is a
+special parameter, the readonly attribute can be turned on, but cannot then
+be turned off.
+
+@noindent
+If the @t{POSIX_BUILTINS} option is set, the readonly attribute is
+more restrictive: unset variables can be marked readonly and cannot then
+be set; furthermore, the readonly attribute cannot be removed from any
+variable.
+
+@noindent
+It is still possible to change other attributes of the variable though,
+some of which like @t{-U} or @t{-Z} would affect the value. More generally,
+the readonly attribute should not be relied on as a security mechanism.
+
+@noindent
+Note that in zsh (like in pdksh but unlike most other shells) it is
+still possible to create a local variable of the same name as this is
+considered a different variable (though this variable, too, can be marked
+readonly). Special variables that have been made readonly retain their value
+and readonly attribute when made local.
+
+@item @t{-t}
+Tags the named parameters. Tags have no special meaning to the shell.
+This flag has a different meaning when used with @t{-f}; see above.
+
+@item @t{-u}
+Convert the result to upper case whenever the parameter is expanded.
+The value is @emph{not} converted when assigned.
+This flag has a different meaning when used with @t{-f}; see above.
+
+@item @t{-x}
+Mark for automatic export to the environment of subsequently
+executed commands. If the option @t{GLOBAL_EXPORT} is set, this implies
+the option @t{-g}, unless @t{+g} is also explicitly given; in other words
+the parameter is not made local to the enclosing function. This is for
+compatibility with previous versions of zsh.
+
+@end table
+
+@findex ulimit
+@cindex resource limits
+@cindex limits, resource
+@item @t{ulimit} [ @t{-HSa} ] [ @{ @t{-bcdfiklmnpqrsTtvwx} | @t{-N} @var{resource} @} [ @var{limit} ] ... ]
+Set or display resource limits of the shell and the processes started by
+the shell. The value of @var{limit} can be a number in the unit specified
+below or one of the values `@t{unlimited}', which removes the limit on the
+resource, or `@t{hard}', which uses the current value of the hard limit on
+the resource.
+
+@noindent
+By default, only soft limits are manipulated. If the @t{-H} flag
+is given use hard limits instead of soft limits. If the @t{-S} flag is given
+together with the @t{-H} flag set both hard and soft limits.
+
+@noindent
+If no options are used, the file size limit (@t{-f}) is assumed.
+
+@noindent
+If @var{limit} is omitted the current value of the specified resources are
+printed. When more than one resource value is printed, the limit name and
+unit is printed before each value.
+
+@noindent
+When looping over multiple resources, the shell will abort immediately if
+it detects a badly formed argument. However, if it fails to set a limit
+for some other reason it will continue trying to set the remaining limits.
+
+@noindent
+Not all the following resources are supported on all systems. Running
+@t{ulimit -a} will show which are supported.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{-a}
+Lists all of the current resource limits.
+@item @t{-b}
+Socket buffer size in bytes (N.B. not kilobytes)
+@item @t{-c}
+512-byte blocks on the size of core dumps.
+@item @t{-d}
+Kilobytes on the size of the data segment.
+@item @t{-f}
+512-byte blocks on the size of files written.
+@item @t{-i}
+The number of pending signals.
+@item @t{-k}
+The number of kqueues allocated.
+@item @t{-l}
+Kilobytes on the size of locked-in memory.
+@item @t{-m}
+Kilobytes on the size of physical memory.
+@item @t{-n}
+open file descriptors.
+@item @t{-p}
+The number of pseudo-terminals.
+@item @t{-q}
+Bytes in POSIX message queues.
+@item @t{-r}
+Maximum real time priority. On some systems where this
+is not available, such as NetBSD, this has the same effect as @t{-T}
+for compatibility with @t{sh}.
+@item @t{-s}
+Kilobytes on the size of the stack.
+@item @t{-T}
+The number of simultaneous threads available to the user.
+@item @t{-t}
+CPU seconds to be used.
+@item @t{-u}
+The number of processes available to the user.
+@item @t{-v}
+Kilobytes on the size of virtual memory. On some systems this
+refers to the limit called `address space'.
+@item @t{-w}
+Kilobytes on the size of swapped out memory.
+@item @t{-x}
+The number of locks on files.
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+A resource may also be specified by integer in the form `@t{-N}
+@var{resource}', where @var{resource} corresponds to the integer defined for
+the resource by the operating system. This may be used to set the limits
+for resources known to the shell which do not correspond to option letters.
+Such limits will be shown by number in the output of `@t{ulimit -a}'.
+
+@noindent
+The number may alternatively be out of the range of limits compiled into
+the shell. The shell will try to read or write the limit anyway, and
+will report an error if this fails.
+
+@findex umask
+@cindex umask
+@item @t{umask} [ @t{-S} ] [ @var{mask} ]
+The umask is set to @var{mask}. @var{mask} can be either
+an octal number or a symbolic value as described in man page chmod(1).
+If @var{mask} is omitted, the current value is printed. The @t{-S}
+option causes the mask to be printed as a symbolic value. Otherwise,
+the mask is printed as an octal number. Note that in
+the symbolic form the permissions you specify are those which are to be
+allowed (not denied) to the users specified.
+
+@cindex aliases, removing
+@item @t{unalias} [ @t{-ams} ] @var{name} ...
+Removes aliases. This command works the same as @t{unhash -a}, except that
+the @t{-a} option removes all regular or global aliases, or with @t{-s}
+all suffix aliases: in this case no @var{name} arguments may appear. The
+options @t{-m} (remove by pattern) and @t{-s} without @t{-a} (remove
+listed suffix aliases) behave as for @t{unhash -a}. Note that
+the meaning of @t{-a} is different between @t{unalias} and @t{unhash}.
+
+@cindex functions, removing
+@findex unfunction
+@item @t{unfunction}
+Same as @t{unhash -f}.
+
+@findex unhash
+@item @t{unhash} [ @t{-adfms} ] @var{name} ...
+Remove the element named @var{name} from an internal hash table. The
+default is remove elements from the command hash table. The @t{-a}
+option causes @t{unhash} to remove regular or global aliases; note
+when removing a global aliases that the argument must be quoted to prevent
+it from being expanded before being passed to the command.
+The @t{-s} option causes @t{unhash} to remove suffix aliases.
+The @t{-f} option causes
+@t{unhash} to remove shell functions. The @t{-d} options causes
+@t{unhash} to remove named directories. If the @t{-m} flag is given
+the arguments are taken as patterns (should be quoted) and all elements
+of the corresponding hash table with matching names will be removed.
+
+@findex unlimit
+@cindex resource limits
+@cindex limits, resource
+@item @t{unlimit} [ @t{-hs} ] @var{resource} ...
+The resource limit for each @var{resource} is set to the hard limit.
+If the @t{-h} flag is given and the shell has appropriate privileges,
+the hard resource limit for each @var{resource} is removed.
+The resources of the shell process are only changed if the @t{-s}
+flag is given.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{unlimit} command is not made available by default when the
+shell starts in a mode emulating another shell. It can be made available
+with the command `@t{zmodload -F zsh/rlimits b:unlimit}'.
+
+@findex unset
+@cindex parameters, unsetting
+@item @t{unset} [ @t{-fmv} ] @var{name} ...
+Each named parameter is unset.
+Local parameters remain local even if unset; they appear unset within scope,
+but the previous value will still reappear when the scope ends.
+
+@noindent
+Individual elements of associative array parameters may be unset by using
+subscript syntax on @var{name}, which should be quoted (or the entire command
+prefixed with @t{noglob}) to protect the subscript from filename generation.
+
+@noindent
+If the @t{-m} flag is specified the arguments are taken as patterns (should
+be quoted) and all parameters with matching names are unset. Note that this
+cannot be used when unsetting associative array elements, as the subscript
+will be treated as part of the pattern.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{-v} flag specifies that @var{name} refers to parameters. This is the
+default behaviour.
+
+@noindent
+@t{unset -f} is equivalent to @t{unfunction}.
+
+@findex unsetopt
+@cindex options, unsetting
+@item @t{unsetopt} [ @{@t{+}|@t{-}@}@var{options} | @{@t{+}|@t{-}@}@t{o} @var{option_name} ] [ @var{name} ... ]
+Unset the options for the shell. All options specified either
+with flags or by name are unset. If no arguments are supplied,
+the names of all options currently unset are printed.
+If the @t{-m} flag is given the arguments are taken as patterns
+(which should be quoted to preserve them from being interpreted as glob
+patterns), and all options with names matching these patterns are unset.
+
+@item @t{vared}
+See @ref{Zle Builtins}.
+
+@findex wait
+@cindex waiting for jobs
+@cindex jobs, waiting for
+@item @t{wait} [ @var{job} ... ]
+Wait for the specified jobs or processes. If @var{job} is not given
+then all currently active child processes are waited for.
+Each @var{job} can be either a job specification or the process ID
+of a job in the job table.
+The exit status from this command is that of the job waited for.
+If @var{job} represents an unknown job or process ID, a warning is printed
+(unless the @t{POSIX_BUILTINS} option is set) and the exit status is 127.
+
+@noindent
+It is possible to wait for recent processes (specified by process ID,
+not by job) that were running in the background even if the process has
+exited. Typically the process ID will be recorded by capturing the
+value of the variable @t{$!} immediately after the process has been
+started. There is a limit on the number of process IDs remembered by
+the shell; this is given by the value of the system configuration
+parameter @t{CHILD_MAX}. When this limit is reached, older process IDs
+are discarded, least recently started processes first.
+
+@noindent
+Note there is no protection against the process ID wrapping, i.e. if the
+wait is not executed soon enough there is a chance the process waited
+for is the wrong one. A conflict implies both process IDs have been
+generated by the shell, as other processes are not recorded, and that
+the user is potentially interested in both, so this problem is intrinsic
+to process IDs.
+
+@findex whence
+@item @t{whence} [ @t{-vcwfpamsS} ] [ @t{-x} @var{num} ] @var{name} ...
+For each @var{name}, indicate how it would be interpreted if used as a
+command name.
+
+@noindent
+If @var{name} is not an alias, built-in command, external command, shell
+function, hashed command, or a reserved word, the exit status shall be
+non-zero, and --- if @t{-v}, @t{-c}, or @t{-w} was passed --- a message
+will be written to standard output. (This is different from other shells that
+write that message to standard error.)
+
+@noindent
+@t{whence} is most useful when @var{name} is only the last path component
+of a command, i.e. does not include a `@t{/}'; in particular, pattern
+matching only succeeds if just the non-directory component of the command is
+passed.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{-v}
+Produce a more verbose report.
+
+@item @t{-c}
+Print the results in a @cite{csh}-like format.
+This takes precedence over @t{-v}.
+
+@item @t{-w}
+For each @var{name}, print `@var{name}@t{:} @var{word}' where @var{word}
+is one of @t{alias}, @t{builtin}, @t{command}, @t{function},
+@t{hashed}, @t{reserved} or @t{none}, according as @var{name}
+corresponds to an alias, a built-in command, an external command, a
+shell function, a command defined with the @t{hash} builtin, a
+reserved word, or is not recognised. This takes precedence over
+@t{-v} and @t{-c}.
+
+@item @t{-f}
+Causes the contents of a shell function to be
+displayed, which would otherwise not happen unless the @t{-c}
+flag were used.
+
+@item @t{-p}
+Do a path search for @var{name}
+even if it is an alias, reserved word, shell function or builtin.
+
+@item @t{-a}
+Do a search for all occurrences of @var{name}
+throughout the command path.
+Normally only the first occurrence is printed.
+
+@item @t{-m}
+The arguments are taken as patterns (pattern characters should be
+quoted), and the information is displayed for each command matching one
+of these patterns.
+
+@item @t{-s}
+If a pathname contains symlinks, print the symlink-free pathname as well.
+
+@item @t{-S}
+As @t{-s}, but if the pathname had to be resolved by following
+multiple symlinks, the intermediate steps are printed, too. The
+symlink resolved at each step might be anywhere in the path.
+
+@item @t{-x} @var{num}
+Expand tabs when outputting shell functions using the @t{-c} option.
+This has the same effect as the @t{-x} option to the @t{functions}
+builtin.
+
+@end table
+
+@findex where
+@item @t{where} [ @t{-wpmsS} ] [ @t{-x} @var{num} ] @var{name} ...
+Equivalent to @t{whence -ca}.
+
+@findex which
+@item @t{which} [ @t{-wpamsS} ] [ @t{-x} @var{num} ] @var{name} ...
+Equivalent to @t{whence -c}.
+
+@findex zcompile
+@cindex .zwc files, creation
+@cindex compilation
+@item @t{zcompile} [ @t{-U} ] [ @t{-z} | @t{-k} ] [ @t{-R} | @t{-M} ] @var{file} [ @var{name} ... ]
+@itemx @t{zcompile} @t{-ca} [ @t{-m} ] [ @t{-R} | @t{-M} ] @var{file} [ @var{name} ... ]
+@itemx @t{zcompile -t} @var{file} [ @var{name} ... ]
+This builtin command can be used to compile functions or scripts,
+storing the compiled form in a file, and to examine files containing
+the compiled form. This allows faster autoloading of functions and
+sourcing of scripts by avoiding parsing of the text when the files
+are read.
+
+@noindent
+The first form (without the @t{-c}, @t{-a} or @t{-t} options) creates a
+compiled file. If only the @var{file} argument is given, the
+output file has the name `@var{file}@t{.zwc}' and will be placed in
+the same directory as the @var{file}. The shell will load the compiled
+file instead of the normal function file when the function
+is autoloaded; see
+@ref{Functions}
+for a description of how autoloaded functions are searched. The
+extension @t{.zwc} stands for `zsh word code'.
+
+@noindent
+@vindex fpath, with zcompile
+If there is at least one @var{name} argument, all the named files
+are compiled into the output @var{file} given as the first argument. If
+@var{file} does not end in @t{.zwc}, this extension is automatically
+appended. Files containing multiple compiled functions are called `digest'
+files, and are intended to be used as elements of the @t{FPATH}/@t{fpath}
+special array.
+
+@noindent
+The second form, with the @t{-c} or @t{-a} options, writes the compiled
+definitions for all the named functions into @var{file}. For @t{-c}, the
+names must be functions currently defined in the shell, not those marked
+for autoloading. Undefined functions that are marked for autoloading
+may be written by using the @t{-a} option, in which case the @t{fpath}
+is searched and the contents of the definition files for those
+functions, if found, are compiled into @var{file}. If both @t{-c} and
+@t{-a} are given, names of both defined functions and functions marked
+for autoloading may be given. In either case, the functions in files
+written with the @t{-c} or @t{-a} option will be autoloaded as if the
+@t{KSH_AUTOLOAD} option were unset.
+
+@noindent
+The reason for handling loaded and not-yet-loaded functions with
+different options is that some definition files for autoloading define
+multiple functions, including the function with the same name as the
+file, and, at the end, call that function. In such cases the output of
+`@t{zcompile -c}' does not include the additional functions defined in
+the file, and any other initialization code in the file is lost. Using
+`@t{zcompile -a}' captures all this extra information.
+
+@noindent
+If the @t{-m} option is combined with @t{-c} or @t{-a},
+the @var{name}s are used as patterns and all functions whose names
+match one of these patterns will be written. If no @var{name} is given,
+the definitions of all functions currently defined or marked as
+autoloaded will be written.
+
+@noindent
+Note the second form cannot be used for compiling functions that
+include redirections as part of the definition rather than within
+the body of the function; for example
+
+@noindent
+@example
+fn1() @{ @{ ... @} >~/logfile @}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+can be compiled but
+
+@noindent
+@example
+fn1() @{ ... @} >~/logfile
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+cannot. It is possible to use the first form of @t{zcompile} to compile
+autoloadable functions that include the full function definition instead
+of just the body of the function.
+
+@noindent
+The third form, with the @t{-t} option, examines an existing
+compiled file. Without further arguments, the names of the original
+files compiled into it are listed. The first line of output shows
+the version of the shell which compiled the file and how the file
+will be used (i.e. by reading it directly or by mapping it into memory).
+With arguments, nothing is output and the return status is set to zero if
+definitions for @emph{all} @var{name}s were found in the compiled
+file, and non-zero if the definition for at least one @var{name} was not
+found.
+
+@noindent
+Other options:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{-U}
+Aliases are not expanded when compiling the @var{name}d files.
+
+@item @t{-R}
+When the compiled file is read, its contents are copied into the
+shell's memory, rather than memory-mapped (see @t{-M}). This
+happens automatically on systems that do not support memory mapping.
+
+@noindent
+When compiling scripts instead of autoloadable functions, it is
+often desirable to use this option; otherwise the whole file, including the
+code to define functions which have already been defined, will
+remain mapped, consequently wasting memory.
+
+@item @t{-M}
+The compiled file is mapped into the shell's memory when read. This
+is done in such a way that multiple instances of the shell running
+on the same host will share this mapped file. If neither @t{-R} nor
+@t{-M} is given, the @t{zcompile} builtin decides what to do based
+on the size of the compiled file.
+
+@item @t{-k}
+@itemx @t{-z}
+These options are used when the compiled file contains functions which
+are to be autoloaded. If @t{-z} is given, the
+function will be autoloaded as if the @t{KSH_AUTOLOAD} option is
+@emph{not} set, even if it is set at the time the compiled file is
+read, while if the @t{-k} is given, the function will be loaded as if
+@t{KSH_AUTOLOAD} @emph{is} set. These options also take precedence over
+any @t{-k} or @t{-z} options specified to the @t{autoload} builtin. If
+neither of these options is given, the function will be loaded as
+determined by the setting of the @t{KSH_AUTOLOAD} option at the time
+the compiled file is read.
+
+These options may also appear as many times as necessary between the listed
+@var{name}s to specify the loading style of all following functions, up to
+the next @t{-k} or @t{-z}.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+The created file always contains two versions of the compiled
+format, one for big-endian machines and one for small-endian
+machines. The upshot of this is that the compiled file is machine
+independent and if it is read or mapped, only one half of the file
+is actually used (and mapped).
+
+
+@item @t{zformat}
+See @ref{The zsh/zutil Module}.
+
+@item @t{zftp}
+See @ref{The zsh/zftp Module}.
+
+@item @t{zle}
+See @ref{Zle Builtins}.
+
+@findex zmodload
+@cindex modules, loading
+@cindex loading modules
+@item @t{zmodload} [ @t{-dL} ] [ @t{-s} ] [ ... ]
+@itemx @t{zmodload -F} [ @t{-alLme} @t{-P} @var{param} ] @var{module} [ [@t{+-}]@var{feature} ... ]
+@itemx @t{zmodload -e} [ @t{-A} ] [ ... ]
+@itemx @t{zmodload} [ @t{-a} [ @t{-bcpf} [ @t{-I} ] ] ] [ @t{-iL} ] ...
+@itemx @t{zmodload} @t{-u} [ @t{-abcdpf} [ @t{-I} ] ] [ @t{-iL} ] ...
+@itemx @t{zmodload} @t{-A} [ @t{-L} ] [ @var{modalias}[@t{=}@var{module}] ... ]
+@itemx @t{zmodload} @t{-R} @var{modalias} ...
+Performs operations relating to zsh's loadable modules.
+Loading of modules while the shell is running (`dynamical loading') is not
+available on all operating systems, or on all installations on a particular
+operating system, although the @t{zmodload} command itself is always
+available and can be used to manipulate modules built into versions of the
+shell executable without dynamical loading.
+
+@noindent
+Without arguments the names of all currently loaded binary modules are
+printed. The @t{-L} option causes this list to be in the form of a
+series of @t{zmodload} commands. Forms with arguments are:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{zmodload} [ @t{-is} ] @var{name} ...
+@itemx @t{zmodload} @t{-u} [ @t{-i} ] @var{name} ...
+In the simplest case, @t{zmodload} loads a binary module. The module must
+be in a file with a name consisting of the specified @var{name} followed by
+a standard suffix, usually `@t{.so}' (`@t{.sl}' on HPUX).
+If the module to be loaded is already loaded the duplicate module is
+ignored. If @t{zmodload} detects an inconsistency, such as an
+invalid module name or circular dependency list, the current code block is
+aborted. If it is available, the module is loaded if necessary, while if it
+is not available, non-zero status is silently returned. The option
+@t{-i} is accepted for compatibility but has no effect.
+
+@noindent
+The @var{name}d module is searched for in the same way a command is, using
+@t{$module_path} instead of @t{$path}. However, the path search is
+performed even when the module name contains a `@t{/}', which it usually does.
+There is no way to prevent the path search.
+
+@noindent
+If the module supports features (see below), @t{zmodload} tries to
+enable all features when loading a module. If the module was successfully
+loaded but not all features could be enabled, @t{zmodload} returns status 2.
+
+@noindent
+If the option @t{-s} is given, no error is printed if the module was not
+available (though other errors indicating a problem with the module are
+printed). The return status indicates if the module was loaded. This
+is appropriate if the caller considers the module optional.
+
+@noindent
+With @t{-u}, @t{zmodload} unloads modules. The same @var{name}
+must be given that was given when the module was loaded, but it is not
+necessary for the module to exist in the file system.
+The @t{-i} option suppresses the error if the module is already
+unloaded (or was never loaded).
+
+@noindent
+Each module has a boot and a cleanup function. The module
+will not be loaded if its boot function fails. Similarly a module
+can only be unloaded if its cleanup function runs successfully.
+
+@item @t{zmodload -F} [ @t{-almLe} @t{-P} @var{param} ] @var{module} [ [@t{+-}]@var{feature} ... ]
+@t{zmodload -F} allows more selective control over the features provided
+by modules. With no options apart from @t{-F}, the module named
+@var{module} is loaded, if it was not already loaded, and the list of
+@var{feature}s is set to the required state. If no
+@var{feature}s are specified, the module is loaded, if it was not already
+loaded, but the state of features is unchanged. Each feature
+may be preceded by a @t{+} to turn the feature on, or @t{-} to turn it
+off; the @t{+} is assumed if neither character is present.
+Any feature not explicitly mentioned is left in its current state;
+if the module was not previously loaded this means any such features will
+remain disabled. The return status is zero if all features were
+set, 1 if the module failed to load, and 2 if some features could
+not be set (for example, a parameter couldn't be added because there
+was a different parameter of the same name) but the module was loaded.
+
+@noindent
+The standard features are builtins, conditions, parameters and math
+functions; these are indicated by the prefix `@t{b:}', `@t{c:}'
+(`@t{C:}' for an infix condition), `@t{p:}' and `@t{f:}', respectively,
+followed by the name that the corresponding feature would have in the
+shell. For example, `@t{b:strftime}' indicates a builtin named
+@t{strftime} and @t{p:EPOCHSECONDS} indicates a parameter named
+@t{EPOCHSECONDS}. The module may provide other (`abstract') features of
+its own as indicated by its documentation; these have no prefix.
+
+@noindent
+With @t{-l} or @t{-L}, features provided by the module are listed. With
+@t{-l} alone, a list of features together with their states is shown, one
+feature per line. With @t{-L} alone, a @t{zmodload -F} command that would
+cause enabled features of the module to be turned on is shown. With
+@t{-lL}, a @t{zmodload -F} command that would cause all the features to be
+set to their current state is shown. If one of these combinations is given
+with the option @t{-P} @var{param} then the parameter @var{param} is set to an
+array of features, either features together with their state or (if
+@t{-L} alone is given) enabled features.
+
+@noindent
+With the option @t{-L} the module name may be omitted; then a list
+of all enabled features for all modules providing features is printed
+in the form of @t{zmodload -F} commands. If @t{-l} is also given,
+the state of both enabled and disabled features is output in that form.
+
+@noindent
+A set of features may be provided together with @t{-l} or @t{-L} and a
+module name; in that case only the state of those features is
+considered. Each feature may be preceded by @t{+} or @t{-} but the
+character has no effect. If no set of features is provided, all
+features are considered.
+
+@noindent
+With @t{-e}, the command first tests that the module is loaded;
+if it is not, status 1 is returned. If the module is loaded,
+the list of features given as an argument is examined. Any feature
+given with no prefix is simply tested to see if the module provides it;
+any feature given with a prefix @t{+} or @t{-} is tested to
+see if is provided and in the given state. If the tests on all features
+in the list succeed, status 0 is returned, else status 1.
+
+@noindent
+With @t{-m}, each entry in the given list of features is taken
+as a pattern to be matched against the list of features provided
+by the module. An initial @t{+} or @t{-} must be given explicitly.
+This may not be combined with the @t{-a} option as autoloads must
+be specified explicitly.
+
+@noindent
+With @t{-a}, the given list of features is marked for autoload from
+the specified module, which may not yet be loaded. An optional @t{+}
+may appear before the feature name. If the feature is prefixed with
+@t{-}, any existing autoload is removed. The options @t{-l} and @t{-L}
+may be used to list autoloads. Autoloading is specific to individual
+features; when the module is loaded only the requested feature is
+enabled. Autoload requests are preserved if the module is
+subsequently unloaded until an explicit `@t{zmodload -Fa} @var{module}
+@t{-}@var{feature}' is issued. It is not an error to request an autoload
+for a feature of a module that is already loaded.
+
+@noindent
+When the module is loaded each autoload is checked against the features
+actually provided by the module; if the feature is not provided the
+autoload request is deleted. A warning message is output; if the
+module is being loaded to provide a different feature, and that autoload
+is successful, there is no effect on the status of the current command.
+If the module is already loaded at the time when @t{zmodload -Fa} is
+run, an error message is printed and status 1 returned.
+
+@noindent
+@t{zmodload -Fa} can be used with the @t{-l}, @t{-L}, @t{-e} and
+@t{-P} options for listing and testing the existence of autoloadable
+features. In this case @t{-l} is ignored if @t{-L} is specified.
+@t{zmodload -FaL} with no module name lists autoloads for all modules.
+
+@noindent
+Note that only standard features as described above can be autoloaded;
+other features require the module to be loaded before enabling.
+
+@item @t{zmodload} @t{-d} [ @t{-L} ] [ @var{name} ]
+@itemx @t{zmodload} @t{-d} @var{name} @var{dep} ...
+@itemx @t{zmodload} @t{-ud} @var{name} [ @var{dep} ... ]
+The @t{-d} option can be used to specify module dependencies. The modules
+named in the second and subsequent arguments will be loaded before the
+module named in the first argument.
+
+@noindent
+With @t{-d} and one argument, all dependencies for that module are listed.
+With @t{-d} and no arguments, all module dependencies are listed. This
+listing is by default in a Makefile-like format. The @t{-L} option
+changes this format to a list of @t{zmodload -d} commands.
+
+@noindent
+If @t{-d} and @t{-u} are both used, dependencies are removed. If only one
+argument is given, all dependencies for that module are removed.
+
+@item @t{zmodload} @t{-ab} [ @t{-L} ]
+@itemx @t{zmodload} @t{-ab} [ @t{-i} ] @var{name} [ @var{builtin} ... ]
+@itemx @t{zmodload} @t{-ub} [ @t{-i} ] @var{builtin} ...
+The @t{-ab} option defines autoloaded builtins. It defines the specified
+@var{builtin}s. When any of those builtins is called, the module specified
+in the first argument is loaded and all its features are enabled (for
+selective control of features use `@t{zmodload -F -a}' as described
+above). If only the @var{name} is given, one builtin is defined, with
+the same name as the module. @t{-i} suppresses the error if the builtin
+is already defined or autoloaded, but not if another builtin of the
+same name is already defined.
+
+@noindent
+With @t{-ab} and no arguments, all autoloaded builtins are listed, with the
+module name (if different) shown in parentheses after the builtin name.
+The @t{-L} option changes this format to a list of @t{zmodload -a}
+commands.
+
+@noindent
+If @t{-b} is used together with the @t{-u} option, it removes builtins
+previously defined with @t{-ab}. This is only possible if the builtin is
+not yet loaded. @t{-i} suppresses the error if the builtin is already
+removed (or never existed).
+
+@noindent
+Autoload requests are retained if the module is subsequently unloaded
+until an explicit `@t{zmodload -ub} @var{builtin}' is issued.
+
+@item @t{zmodload} @t{-ac} [ @t{-IL} ]
+@itemx @t{zmodload} @t{-ac} [ @t{-iI} ] @var{name} [ @var{cond} ... ]
+@itemx @t{zmodload} @t{-uc} [ @t{-iI} ] @var{cond} ...
+The @t{-ac} option is used to define autoloaded condition codes. The
+@var{cond} strings give the names of the conditions defined by the
+module. The optional @t{-I} option is used to define infix condition
+names. Without this option prefix condition names are defined.
+
+@noindent
+If given no condition names, all defined names are listed (as a series of
+@t{zmodload} commands if the @t{-L} option is given).
+
+@noindent
+The @t{-uc} option removes definitions for autoloaded conditions.
+
+@item @t{zmodload} @t{-ap} [ @t{-L} ]
+@itemx @t{zmodload} @t{-ap} [ @t{-i} ] @var{name} [ @var{parameter} ... ]
+@itemx @t{zmodload} @t{-up} [ @t{-i} ] @var{parameter} ...
+The @t{-p} option is like the @t{-b} and @t{-c} options, but makes
+@t{zmodload} work on autoloaded parameters instead.
+
+@item @t{zmodload} @t{-af} [ @t{-L} ]
+@itemx @t{zmodload} @t{-af} [ @t{-i} ] @var{name} [ @var{function} ... ]
+@itemx @t{zmodload} @t{-uf} [ @t{-i} ] @var{function} ...
+The @t{-f} option is like the @t{-b}, @t{-p}, and @t{-c} options, but
+makes @t{zmodload} work on autoloaded math functions instead.
+
+@item @t{zmodload} @t{-a} [ @t{-L} ]
+@itemx @t{zmodload} @t{-a} [ @t{-i} ] @var{name} [ @var{builtin} ... ]
+@itemx @t{zmodload} @t{-ua} [ @t{-i} ] @var{builtin} ...
+Equivalent to @t{-ab} and @t{-ub}.
+
+@item @t{zmodload -e} [ @t{-A} ] [ @var{string} ... ]
+The @t{-e} option without arguments lists all loaded modules; if the @t{-A}
+option is also given, module aliases corresponding to loaded modules are
+also shown. If arguments are provided, nothing is printed;
+the return status is set to zero if all @var{string}s given as arguments
+are names of loaded modules and to one if at least on @var{string} is not
+the name of a loaded module. This can be used to test for the
+availability of things implemented by modules. In this case, any
+aliases are automatically resolved and the @t{-A} flag is not used.
+
+@item @t{zmodload} @t{-A} [ @t{-L} ] [ @var{modalias}[@t{=}@var{module}] ... ]
+For each argument, if both @var{modalias} and @var{module} are given,
+define @var{modalias} to be an alias for the module @var{module}.
+If the module @var{modalias} is ever subsequently requested, either via a
+call to @t{zmodload} or implicitly, the shell will attempt to load
+@var{module} instead. If @var{module} is not given, show the definition of
+@var{modalias}. If no arguments are given, list all defined module aliases.
+When listing, if the @t{-L} flag was also given, list the definition as a
+@t{zmodload} command to recreate the alias.
+
+@noindent
+The existence of aliases for modules is completely independent of whether
+the name resolved is actually loaded as a module: while the alias exists,
+loading and unloading the module under any alias has exactly the same
+effect as using the resolved name, and does not affect the connection
+between the alias and the resolved name which can be removed either by
+@t{zmodload -R} or by redefining the alias. Chains of aliases (i.e. where
+the first resolved name is itself an alias) are valid so long as these are
+not circular. As the aliases take the same format as module names, they
+may include path separators: in this case, there is no requirement for any
+part of the path named to exist as the alias will be resolved first. For
+example, `@t{any/old/alias}' is always a valid alias.
+
+@noindent
+Dependencies added to aliased modules are actually added to the resolved
+module; these remain if the alias is removed. It is valid to create an
+alias whose name is one of the standard shell modules and which resolves to
+a different module. However, if a module has dependencies, it
+will not be possible to use the module name as an alias as the module will
+already be marked as a loadable module in its own right.
+
+@noindent
+Apart from the above, aliases can be used in the @t{zmodload} command
+anywhere module names are required. However, aliases will not be
+shown in lists of loaded modules with a bare `@t{zmodload}'.
+
+@item @t{zmodload} @t{-R} @var{modalias} ...
+For each @var{modalias} argument that was previously defined as a module
+alias via @t{zmodload -A}, delete the alias. If any was not defined, an
+error is caused and the remainder of the line is ignored.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+Note that @t{zsh} makes no distinction between modules that were linked
+into the shell and modules that are loaded dynamically. In both cases
+this builtin command has to be used to make available the builtins and
+other things defined by modules (unless the module is autoloaded on
+these definitions). This is true even for systems that don't support
+dynamic loading of modules.
+
+@item @t{zparseopts}
+See @ref{The zsh/zutil Module}.
+
+@item @t{zprof}
+See @ref{The zsh/zprof Module}.
+
+@item @t{zpty}
+See @ref{The zsh/zpty Module}.
+
+@item @t{zregexparse}
+See @ref{The zsh/zutil Module}.
+
+@item @t{zsocket}
+See @ref{The zsh/net/socket Module}.
+
+@item @t{zstyle}
+See @ref{The zsh/zutil Module}.
+
+@item @t{ztcp}
+See @ref{The zsh/net/tcp Module}.
+
+@end table
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/zle.yo
+@node Zsh Line Editor, Completion Widgets, Shell Builtin Commands, Top
+
+@chapter Zsh Line Editor
+@noindent
+@cindex line editor
+@cindex editor, line
+@cindex ZLE
+
+@section Description
+@noindent
+@pindex ZLE, use of
+If the @t{ZLE} option is set (which it is by default in interactive shells)
+and the shell input is attached to the terminal, the user
+is able to edit command lines.
+
+@noindent
+There are two display modes. The first, multiline mode, is the
+default. It only works if the @t{TERM} parameter is set to a valid
+terminal type that can move the cursor up. The second, single line
+mode, is used if @t{TERM} is invalid or incapable of moving the
+cursor up, or if the @t{SINGLE_LINE_ZLE} option is set.
+@pindex SINGLE_LINE_ZLE, use of
+@cindex ksh, editor mode
+@cindex editor ksh style
+This mode
+is similar to @cite{ksh}, and uses no termcap sequences. If @t{TERM} is
+"emacs", the @t{ZLE} option will be unset by default.
+
+@noindent
+@vindex BAUD, use of
+@vindex COLUMNS, use of
+@vindex LINES, use of
+The parameters @t{BAUD}, @t{COLUMNS}, and @t{LINES} are also used by the
+line editor. See
+@ref{Parameters Used By The Shell}.
+
+@noindent
+@vindex zle_highlight, use of
+The parameter @t{zle_highlight} is also used by the line editor; see
+@ref{Character Highlighting}. Highlighting
+of special characters and the region between the cursor and the
+mark (as set with @t{set-mark-command} in Emacs mode, or by @t{visual-mode}
+in Vi mode) is enabled
+by default; consult this reference for more information. Irascible
+conservatives will wish to know that all highlighting may be disabled by
+the following setting:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zle_highlight=(none)
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+In many places, references are made to the @t{numeric argument}. This can
+by default be entered in emacs mode by holding the alt key and typing
+a number, or pressing escape before each digit, and in vi command mode
+by typing the number before entering a command. Generally the numeric
+argument causes the next command entered to be repeated the specified
+number of times, unless otherwise noted below; this is implemented
+by the @t{digit-argument} widget. See also
+@ref{Arguments} for some other ways the numeric argument can be modified.
+
+@noindent
+@menu
+* Keymaps::
+* Zle Builtins::
+* Zle Widgets::
+* Character Highlighting::
+@end menu
+
+@noindent
+@node Keymaps, Zle Builtins, , Zsh Line Editor
+
+@section Keymaps
+@noindent
+@cindex keymaps
+@cindex key bindings
+@cindex bindings, key
+A keymap in ZLE contains a set of bindings between key sequences
+and ZLE commands. The empty key sequence cannot be bound.
+
+@noindent
+There can be any number of keymaps at any time, and each keymap has one
+or more names. If all of a keymap's names are deleted, it disappears.
+@findex bindkey, use of
+@t{bindkey} can be used to manipulate keymap names.
+
+@noindent
+Initially, there are eight keymaps:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{emacs}
+EMACS emulation
+@item @t{viins}
+vi emulation - insert mode
+@item @t{vicmd}
+vi emulation - command mode
+@item @t{viopp}
+vi emulation - operator pending
+@item @t{visual}
+vi emulation - selection active
+@item @t{isearch}
+incremental search mode
+@item @t{command}
+read a command name
+@item @t{.safe}
+fallback keymap
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+The `@t{.safe}' keymap is special. It can never be altered, and the name
+can never be removed. However, it can be linked to other names, which can
+be removed. In the future other special keymaps may be added; users should
+avoid using names beginning with `@t{.}' for their own keymaps.
+
+@noindent
+@vindex VISUAL
+@vindex EDITOR
+In addition to these names, either `@t{emacs}' or `@t{viins}' is
+also linked to the name `@t{main}'. If one of the @t{VISUAL} or
+@t{EDITOR} environment variables contain the string `@t{vi}' when the shell
+starts up then it will be `@t{viins}', otherwise it will be `@t{emacs}'.
+@t{bindkey}'s @t{-e} and @t{-v}
+options provide a convenient way to override this default choice.
+
+@noindent
+When the editor starts up, it will select the `@t{main}' keymap.
+If that keymap doesn't exist, it will use `@t{.safe}' instead.
+
+@noindent
+In the `@t{.safe}' keymap, each single key is bound to @t{self-insert},
+except for ^J (line feed) and ^M (return) which are bound to @t{accept-line}.
+This is deliberately not pleasant to use; if you are using it, it
+means you deleted the main keymap, and you should put it back.
+
+@subsection Reading Commands
+@noindent
+When ZLE is reading a command from the terminal, it may read a sequence
+that is bound to some command and is also a prefix of a longer bound string.
+In this case ZLE will wait a certain time to see if more characters
+are typed, and if not (or they don't match any longer string) it will
+execute the binding. This timeout is defined by the @t{KEYTIMEOUT} parameter;
+its default is 0.4 sec. There is no timeout if the prefix string is not
+itself bound to a command.
+
+@noindent
+The key timeout is also applied when ZLE is reading the bytes from a
+multibyte character string when it is in the appropriate mode. (This
+requires that the shell was compiled with multibyte mode enabled; typically
+also the locale has characters with the UTF-8 encoding, although any
+multibyte encoding known to the operating system is supported.) If the
+second or a subsequent byte is not read within the timeout period, the
+shell acts as if @t{?} were typed and resets the input state.
+
+@noindent
+As well as ZLE commands, key sequences can be bound to other strings, by using
+`@t{bindkey -s}'.
+When such a sequence is read, the replacement string is pushed back as input,
+and the command reading process starts again using these fake keystrokes.
+This input can itself invoke further replacement strings, but in order to
+detect loops the process will be stopped if there are twenty such replacements
+without a real command being read.
+
+@noindent
+A key sequence typed by the user can be turned into a command name for use
+in user-defined widgets with the @t{read-command} widget, described in
+@ref{Miscellaneous} below.
+
+@subsection Local Keymaps
+@noindent
+@cindex local keymaps
+While for normal editing a single keymap is used exclusively, in many
+modes a local keymap allows for some keys to be customised. For example,
+in an incremental search mode, a binding in the @t{isearch} keymap will
+override a binding in the @t{main} keymap but all keys that are not
+overridden can still be used.
+
+@noindent
+If a key sequence is defined in a local keymap, it will hide a key
+sequence in the global keymap that is a prefix of that sequence. An
+example of this occurs with the binding of @t{iw} in @t{viopp} as this
+hides the binding of @t{i} in @t{vicmd}. However, a longer sequence in
+the global keymap that shares the same prefix can still apply so for
+example the binding of @t{^Xa} in the global keymap will be unaffected
+by the binding of @t{^Xb} in the local keymap.
+
+@noindent
+@node Zle Builtins, Zle Widgets, Keymaps, Zsh Line Editor
+
+@section Zle Builtins
+@noindent
+@cindex zle, builtin commands
+The ZLE module contains three related builtin commands. The @t{bindkey}
+command manipulates keymaps and key bindings; the @t{vared} command invokes
+ZLE on the value of a shell parameter; and the @t{zle} command manipulates
+editing widgets and allows command line access to ZLE commands from within
+shell functions.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex bindkey
+@cindex keys, rebinding
+@cindex rebinding keys
+@cindex keys, binding
+@cindex binding keys
+@cindex keymaps
+@item @t{bindkey} [ @var{options} ] @t{-l} [ @t{-L} ] [ @var{keymap} ... ]
+@itemx @t{bindkey} [ @var{options} ] @t{-d}
+@itemx @t{bindkey} [ @var{options} ] @t{-D} @var{keymap} ...
+@itemx @t{bindkey} [ @var{options} ] @t{-A} @var{old-keymap new-keymap}
+@itemx @t{bindkey} [ @var{options} ] @t{-N} @var{new-keymap} [ @var{old-keymap} ]
+@itemx @t{bindkey} [ @var{options} ] @t{-m}
+@itemx @t{bindkey} [ @var{options} ] @t{-r} @var{in-string} ...
+@itemx @t{bindkey} [ @var{options} ] @t{-s} @var{in-string out-string} ...
+@itemx @t{bindkey} [ @var{options} ] @var{in-string command} ...
+@itemx @t{bindkey} [ @var{options} ] [ @var{in-string} ]
+@t{bindkey}'s options can be divided into three categories: keymap
+selection for the current command, operation selection, and others. The
+keymap selection options are:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{-e}
+Selects keymap `@t{emacs}' for any operations by the current command,
+and also links `@t{emacs}' to `@t{main}' so that it is selected by
+default the next time the editor starts.
+
+@item @t{-v}
+Selects keymap `@t{viins}' for any operations by the current command,
+and also links `@t{viins}' to `@t{main}' so that it is selected by default
+the next time the editor starts.
+
+@item @t{-a}
+Selects keymap `@t{vicmd}' for any operations by the current command.
+
+@item @t{-M} @var{keymap}
+The @var{keymap} specifies a keymap name that is selected for any
+operations by the current command.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+If a keymap selection is required and none of the options above are used, the
+`@t{main}' keymap is used. Some operations do not permit a keymap to be
+selected, namely:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{-l}
+List all existing keymap names; if any arguments are given, list just
+those keymaps.
+
+@noindent
+If the @t{-L} option is also used, list in the form of @t{bindkey}
+commands to create or link the keymaps. `@t{bindkey -lL
+main}' shows which keymap is linked to `@t{main}', if any, and hence if
+the standard emacs or vi emulation is in effect. This option does
+not show the @t{.safe} keymap because it cannot be created in that
+fashion; however, neither is `@t{bindkey -lL .safe}' reported as an
+error, it simply outputs nothing.
+
+@item @t{-d}
+Delete all existing keymaps and reset to the default state.
+
+@item @t{-D} @var{keymap} ...
+Delete the named @var{keymap}s.
+
+@item @t{-A} @var{old-keymap new-keymap}
+Make the @var{new-keymap} name an alias for @var{old-keymap}, so that
+both names refer to the same keymap. The names have equal standing;
+if either is deleted, the other remains. If there is already a keymap
+with the @var{new-keymap} name, it is deleted.
+
+@item @t{-N} @var{new-keymap} [ @var{old-keymap} ]
+Create a new keymap, named @var{new-keymap}. If a keymap already has that
+name, it is deleted. If an @var{old-keymap} name is given, the new keymap
+is initialized to be a duplicate of it, otherwise the new keymap will
+be empty.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+To use a newly created keymap, it should be linked to @t{main}. Hence
+the sequence of commands to create and use a new keymap `@t{mymap}'
+initialized from the @t{emacs} keymap (which remains unchanged) is:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+bindkey -N mymap emacs
+bindkey -A mymap main
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Note that while `@t{bindkey -A} @var{newmap} @t{main}' will work when
+@var{newmap} is @t{emacs} or @t{viins}, it will not work for @t{vicmd}, as
+switching from vi insert to command mode becomes impossible.
+
+@noindent
+The following operations act on the `@t{main}' keymap if no keymap
+selection option was given:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{-m}
+Add the built-in set of meta-key bindings to the selected keymap.
+Only keys that are unbound or bound to @t{self-insert} are affected.
+
+@item @t{-r} @var{in-string} ...
+Unbind the specified @var{in-string}s in the selected keymap.
+This is exactly equivalent to binding the strings to @t{undefined-key}.
+
+@noindent
+When @t{-R} is also used, interpret the @var{in-string}s as ranges.
+
+@noindent
+When @t{-p} is also used, the @var{in-string}s specify prefixes. Any
+binding that has the given @var{in-string} as a prefix, not including the
+binding for the @var{in-string} itself, if any, will be removed. For
+example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+bindkey -rpM viins '^['
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+will remove all bindings in the vi-insert keymap beginning with an escape
+character (probably cursor keys), but leave the binding for the escape
+character itself (probably @t{vi-cmd-mode}). This is incompatible with the
+option @t{-R}.
+
+@item @t{-s} @var{in-string out-string} ...
+Bind each @var{in-string} to each @var{out-string}.
+When @var{in-string} is typed, @var{out-string} will be
+pushed back and treated as input to the line editor.
+When @t{-R} is also used, interpret the @var{in-string}s as ranges.
+
+@noindent
+Note that both @var{in-string} and @var{out-string} are subject to the same
+form of interpretation, as described below.
+
+@item @var{in-string command} ...
+Bind each @var{in-string} to each @var{command}.
+When @t{-R} is used, interpret the @var{in-string}s as ranges.
+
+@item [ @var{in-string} ]
+List key bindings. If an @var{in-string} is specified, the binding of
+that string in the selected keymap is displayed. Otherwise, all key
+bindings in the selected keymap are displayed. (As a special case,
+if the @t{-e} or @t{-v} option is used alone, the keymap is @emph{not}
+displayed - the implicit linking of keymaps is the only thing that
+happens.)
+
+@noindent
+When the option @t{-p} is used, the @var{in-string} must be present.
+The listing shows all bindings which have the given key sequence as a
+prefix, not including any bindings for the key sequence itself.
+
+@noindent
+When the @t{-L} option is used, the list is in the form of @t{bindkey}
+commands to create the key bindings.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+When the @t{-R} option is used as noted above, a valid range consists of
+two characters, with an optional `@t{-}' between them. All characters
+between the two specified, inclusive, are bound as specified.
+
+@noindent
+For either @var{in-string} or @var{out-string}, the following
+escape sequences are recognised:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{\a}
+bell character
+@item @t{\b}
+backspace
+@item @t{\e}, @t{\E}
+escape
+@item @t{\f}
+form feed
+@item @t{\n}
+linefeed (newline)
+@item @t{\r}
+carriage return
+@item @t{\t}
+horizontal tab
+@item @t{\v}
+vertical tab
+@item @t{\}@var{NNN}
+character code in octal
+@item @t{\x}@var{NN}
+character code in hexadecimal
+@item @t{\u}@var{NNNN}
+unicode character code in hexadecimal
+@item @t{\U}@var{NNNNNNNN}
+unicode character code in hexadecimal
+@item @t{\M}[@t{-}]@var{X}
+character with meta bit set
+@item @t{\C}[@t{-}]@var{X}
+control character
+@item @t{^}@var{X}
+control character
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+In all other cases, `@t{\}' escapes the following character. Delete is
+written as `@t{^?}'. Note that `@t{\M^?}' and `@t{^\M?}' are not the same,
+and that (unlike emacs), the bindings `@t{\M-}@var{X}' and `@t{\e}@var{X}'
+are entirely distinct, although they are initialized to the same bindings
+by `@t{bindkey -m}'.
+
+@findex vared
+@cindex parameters, editing
+@cindex editing parameters
+
+@item @t{vared }[ @t{-Aacghe} ] [ @t{-p} @var{prompt} ] [ @t{-r} @var{rprompt} ]
+@itemx @t{@ @ @ @ @ @ }[ @t{-M} @var{main-keymap} ] [ @t{-m} @var{vicmd-keymap} ]
+@itemx @t{@ @ @ @ @ @ }[ @t{-i} @var{init-widget} ] [ @t{-f} @var{finish-widget} ]
+@itemx @t{@ @ @ @ @ @ }[ @t{-t} @var{tty} ] @var{name}
+The value of the parameter @var{name} is loaded into the edit
+buffer, and the line editor is invoked. When the editor exits,
+@var{name} is set to the string value returned by the editor.
+When the @t{-c} flag is given, the parameter is created if it doesn't
+already exist. The @t{-a} flag may be given with @t{-c} to create
+an array parameter, or the @t{-A} flag to create an associative array.
+If the type of an existing parameter does not match the type to be
+created, the parameter is unset and recreated. The @t{-g} flag may
+be given to suppress warnings from the @t{WARN_CREATE_GLOBAL}
+and @t{WARN_NESTED_VAR} options.
+
+@noindent
+If an array or array slice is being edited, separator characters as defined
+in @t{$IFS} will be shown quoted with a backslash, as will backslashes
+themselves. Conversely, when the edited text is split into an array, a
+backslash quotes an immediately following separator character or backslash;
+no other special handling of backslashes, or any handling of quotes, is
+performed.
+
+@noindent
+Individual elements of existing array or associative array parameters
+may be edited by using subscript syntax on @var{name}. New elements are
+created automatically, even without @t{-c}.
+
+@noindent
+If the @t{-p} flag is given, the following string will be taken as
+the prompt to display at the left. If the @t{-r} flag is given,
+the following string gives the prompt to display at the right. If the
+@t{-h} flag is specified, the history can be accessed from ZLE. If the
+@t{-e} flag is given, typing @t{^D} (Control-D) on an empty line
+causes @t{vared} to exit immediately with a non-zero return value.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{-M} option gives a keymap to link to the @t{main} keymap during
+editing, and the @t{-m} option gives a keymap to link to the @t{vicmd}
+keymap during editing. For vi-style editing, this allows a pair of keymaps
+to override @t{viins} and @t{vicmd}. For emacs-style editing, only @t{-M}
+is normally needed but the @t{-m} option may still be used. On exit, the
+previous keymaps will be restored.
+
+@noindent
+@t{Vared} calls the usual `@t{zle-line-init}' and `@t{zle-line-finish}'
+hooks before and after it takes control. Using the @t{-i} and @t{-f}
+options, it is possible to replace these with other custom widgets.
+
+@noindent
+If `@t{-t} @var{tty}' is given, @var{tty} is the name of a terminal device
+to be used instead of the default @t{/dev/tty}. If @var{tty} does not
+refer to a terminal an error is reported.
+
+@findex zle
+@cindex widgets, rebinding
+@cindex rebinding widgets
+@cindex widgets, binding
+@cindex binding widgets
+@cindex widgets, invoking
+@cindex invoking widgets
+@cindex widgets, calling
+@cindex calling widgets
+@cindex widgets, defining
+@cindex defining widgets
+@item @t{zle}
+@itemx @t{zle} @t{-l} [ @t{-L} | @t{-a} ] [ @var{string} ... ]
+@itemx @t{zle} @t{-D} @var{widget} ...
+@itemx @t{zle} @t{-A} @var{old-widget} @var{new-widget}
+@itemx @t{zle} @t{-N} @var{widget} [ @var{function} ]
+@itemx @t{zle} @t{-f} @var{flag} [ @var{flag}... ]
+@itemx @t{zle} @t{-C} @var{widget} @var{completion-widget} @var{function}
+@itemx @t{zle} @t{-R} [ @t{-c} ] [ @var{display-string} ] [ @var{string} ... ]
+@itemx @t{zle} @t{-M} @var{string}
+@itemx @t{zle} @t{-U} @var{string}
+@itemx @t{zle} @t{-K} @var{keymap}
+@itemx @t{zle} @t{-F} [ @t{-L} | @t{-w} ] [ @var{fd} [ @var{handler} ] ]
+@itemx @t{zle} @t{-I}
+@itemx @t{zle} @t{-T} [ @t{tc} @var{function} | @t{-r} @t{tc} | @t{-L} ]
+@itemx @t{zle} @var{widget} [ @t{-n} @var{num} ] [ @t{-Nw} ] [ @t{-K} @var{keymap} ] @var{args} ...
+The @t{zle} builtin performs a number of different actions concerning
+ZLE.
+
+@noindent
+With no options and no arguments, only the return status will be
+set. It is zero if ZLE is currently active and widgets could be
+invoked using this builtin command and non-zero otherwise.
+Note that even if non-zero status is returned, zle may still be active as
+part of the completion system; this does not allow direct calls to ZLE
+widgets.
+
+@noindent
+Otherwise, which operation it performs depends on its options:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{-l} [ @t{-L} | @t{-a} ] [ @var{string} ]
+List all existing user-defined widgets. If the @t{-L}
+option is used, list in the form of @t{zle}
+commands to create the widgets.
+
+@noindent
+When combined with the @t{-a} option, all widget names are listed,
+including the builtin ones. In this case the @t{-L} option is ignored.
+
+@noindent
+If at least one @var{string} is given, and @t{-a} is present or @t{-L} is
+not used, nothing will be printed. The return status will be zero if
+all @var{string}s are names of existing widgets and non-zero if at least one
+@var{string} is not a name of a defined widget. If @t{-a} is also
+present, all widget names are used for the comparison including builtin
+widgets, else only user-defined widgets are used.
+
+@noindent
+If at least one @var{string} is present and the @t{-L} option is used,
+user-defined widgets matching any @var{string} are listed in the form of
+@t{zle} commands to create the widgets.
+
+@item @t{-D} @var{widget} ...
+Delete the named @var{widget}s.
+
+@item @t{-A} @var{old-widget} @var{new-widget}
+Make the @var{new-widget} name an alias for @var{old-widget}, so that
+both names refer to the same widget. The names have equal standing;
+if either is deleted, the other remains. If there is already a widget
+with the @var{new-widget} name, it is deleted.
+
+@item @t{-N} @var{widget} [ @var{function} ]
+Create a user-defined widget. If there is already a widget with the
+specified name, it is overwritten. When the new
+widget is invoked from within the editor, the specified shell @var{function}
+is called. If no function name is specified, it defaults to
+the same name as the widget. For further information, see
+@ref{Zle Widgets}.
+
+@item @t{-f} @var{flag} [ @var{flag}... ]
+Set various flags on the running widget. Possible values for @var{flag} are:
+
+@noindent
+@t{yank} for indicating that the widget has yanked text into the buffer.
+If the widget is wrapping an existing internal widget, no further
+action is necessary, but if it has inserted the text manually, then it
+should also take care to set @t{YANK_START} and @t{YANK_END} correctly.
+@t{yankbefore} does the same but is used when the yanked text appears
+after the cursor.
+
+@noindent
+@t{kill} for indicating that text has been killed into the cutbuffer.
+When repeatedly invoking a kill widget, text is appended to the cutbuffer
+instead of replacing it, but when wrapping such widgets, it is necessary
+to call `@t{zle -f kill}' to retain this effect.
+
+@noindent
+@t{vichange} for indicating that the widget represents a vi change that
+can be repeated as a whole with `@t{vi-repeat-change}'. The flag should be set
+early in the function before inspecting the value of @t{NUMERIC} or invoking
+other widgets. This has no effect for a widget invoked from insert mode. If
+insert mode is active when the widget finishes, the change extends until next
+returning to command mode.
+
+@cindex completion widgets, creating
+@item @t{-C} @var{widget} @var{completion-widget} @var{function}
+Create a user-defined completion widget named @var{widget}. The
+completion widget will behave like the built-in completion-widget
+whose name is given as @var{completion-widget}. To generate the
+completions, the shell function @var{function} will be called.
+For further information, see
+@ref{Completion Widgets}.
+
+@item @t{-R} [ @t{-c} ] [ @var{display-string} ] [ @var{string} ... ]
+Redisplay the command line; this is to be called from within a user-defined
+widget to allow changes to become visible. If a @var{display-string} is
+given and not empty, this is shown in the status line (immediately
+below the line being edited).
+
+@noindent
+If the optional @var{string}s are given they are listed below the
+prompt in the same way as completion lists are printed. If no
+@var{string}s are given but the @t{-c} option is used such a list is
+cleared.
+
+@noindent
+Note that this option is only useful for widgets that do not exit
+immediately after using it because the strings displayed will be erased
+immediately after return from the widget.
+
+@noindent
+This command can safely be called outside user defined widgets; if zle is
+active, the display will be refreshed, while if zle is not active, the
+command has no effect. In this case there will usually be no other
+arguments.
+
+@noindent
+The status is zero if zle was active, else one.
+
+@item @t{-M} @var{string}
+As with the @t{-R} option, the @var{string} will be displayed below the
+command line; unlike the @t{-R} option, the string will not be put into
+the status line but will instead be printed normally below the
+prompt. This means that the @var{string} will still be displayed after
+the widget returns (until it is overwritten by subsequent commands).
+
+@item @t{-U} @var{string}
+This pushes the characters in the @var{string} onto the input stack of
+ZLE. After the widget currently executed finishes ZLE will behave as
+if the characters in the @var{string} were typed by the user.
+
+@noindent
+As ZLE uses a stack, if this option is used repeatedly
+the last string pushed onto the stack will be processed first. However,
+the characters in each @var{string} will be processed in the order in which
+they appear in the string.
+
+@item @t{-K} @var{keymap}
+Selects the keymap named @var{keymap}. An error message will be displayed if
+there is no such keymap.
+
+@noindent
+This keymap selection affects the interpretation of following keystrokes
+within this invocation of ZLE. Any following invocation (e.g., the next
+command line) will start as usual with the `@t{main}' keymap selected.
+
+@item @t{-F} [ @t{-L} | @t{-w} ] [ @var{fd} [ @var{handler} ] ]
+Only available if your system supports one of the `poll' or `select' system
+calls; most modern systems do.
+
+@noindent
+Installs @var{handler} (the name of a shell function) to handle input from
+file descriptor @var{fd}. Installing a handler for an @var{fd} which is
+already handled causes the existing handler to be replaced. Any number of
+handlers for any number of readable file descriptors may be installed.
+Note that zle makes no attempt to check whether this @var{fd} is actually
+readable when installing the handler. The user must make their own
+arrangements for handling the file descriptor when zle is not active.
+
+@noindent
+When zle is attempting to read data, it will examine both the terminal and
+the list of handled @var{fd}'s. If data becomes available on a handled
+@var{fd}, zle calls @var{handler} with the fd which is ready for reading
+as the first argument. Under normal circumstances this is the only
+argument, but if an error was detected, a second argument provides
+details: `@t{hup}' for a disconnect, `@t{nval}' for a closed or otherwise
+invalid descriptor, or `@t{err}' for any other condition. Systems that
+support only the `select' system call always use `@t{err}'.
+
+@noindent
+If the option @t{-w} is also given, the @var{handler} is instead a line
+editor widget, typically a shell function made into a widget using
+`@t{zle -N}'. In that case @var{handler} can use all the facilities of zle
+to update the current editing line. Note, however, that as handling @var{fd}
+takes place at a low level changes to the display will not automatically
+appear; the widget should call `@t{zle -R}' to force redisplay. As of this
+writing, widget handlers only support a single argument and thus are never
+passed a string for error state, so widgets must be prepared to test the
+descriptor themselves.
+
+@noindent
+If either type of handler produces output to the terminal, it should call
+`@t{zle -I}' before doing so (see below). Handlers should not attempt to
+read from the terminal.
+
+@noindent
+If no @var{handler} is given, but an @var{fd} is present, any handler for
+that @var{fd} is removed. If there is none, an error message is printed
+and status 1 is returned.
+
+@noindent
+If no arguments are given, or the @t{-L} option is supplied, a list of
+handlers is printed in a form which can be stored for later execution.
+
+@noindent
+An @var{fd} (but not a @var{handler}) may optionally be given with the @t{-L}
+option; in this case, the function will list the handler if any, else
+silently return status 1.
+
+@noindent
+Note that this feature should be used with care. Activity on one of the
+@var{fd}'s which is not properly handled can cause the terminal to become
+unusable. Removing an @var{fd} handler from within a signal trap may cause
+unpredictable behavior.
+
+@noindent
+Here is a simple example of using this feature. A connection to a remote
+TCP port is created using the ztcp command; see
+@ref{The zsh/net/tcp Module}. Then a handler is installed
+which simply prints out any data which arrives on this connection. Note
+that `select' will indicate that the file descriptor needs handling
+if the remote side has closed the connection; we handle that by testing
+for a failed read.
+
+@noindent
+@example
+if ztcp pwspc 2811; then
+ tcpfd=$REPLY
+ handler() @{
+ zle -I
+ local line
+ if ! read -r line <&$1; then
+ # select marks this fd if we reach EOF,
+ # so handle this specially.
+ print "[Read on fd $1 failed, removing.]" >&2
+ zle -F $1
+ return 1
+ fi
+ print -r - $line
+ @}
+ zle -F $tcpfd handler
+fi
+@end example
+
+@item @t{-I}
+Unusually, this option is most useful outside ordinary widget functions,
+though it may be used within if normal output to the terminal is required.
+It invalidates the current zle display in preparation for output; typically
+this will be from a trap function. It has no effect if zle is not
+active. When a trap exits, the shell checks to see if the display needs
+restoring, hence the following will print output in such a way as not to
+disturb the line being edited:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+TRAPUSR1() @{
+ # Invalidate zle display
+ [[ -o zle ]] && zle -I
+ # Show output
+ print Hello
+@}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+In general, the trap function may need to test whether zle is active before
+using this method (as shown in the example), since the @t{zsh/zle} module
+may not even be loaded; if it is not, the command can be skipped.
+
+@noindent
+It is possible to call `@t{zle -I}' several times before control is
+returned to the editor; the display will only be invalidated the first time
+to minimise disruption.
+
+@noindent
+Note that there are normally better ways of manipulating the display from
+within zle widgets; see, for example, `@t{zle -R}' above.
+
+@noindent
+The returned status is zero if zle was invalidated, even though
+this may have been by a previous call to `@t{zle -I}' or by a system
+notification. To test if a zle widget may be called at this point, execute
+@t{zle} with no arguments and examine the return status.
+
+@item @t{-T}
+This is used to add, list or remove internal transformations on the
+processing performed by the line editor. It is typically used only for
+debugging or testing and is therefore of little interest to the general
+user.
+
+@noindent
+`@t{zle -T} @var{transformation} @var{func}' specifies that the
+given @var{transformation} (see below) is effected by shell function
+@var{func}.
+
+@noindent
+`@t{zle -Tr} @var{transformation}' removes the given @var{transformation}
+if it was present (it is not an error if none was).
+
+@noindent
+`@t{zle -TL}' can be used to list all transformations currently in
+operation.
+
+@noindent
+Currently the only transformation is @t{tc}. This is used instead
+of outputting termcap codes to the terminal. When the transformation is
+in operation the shell function is passed the termcap code that would be
+output as its first argument; if the operation required a numeric
+argument, that is passed as a second argument. The function should set
+the shell variable @t{REPLY} to the transformed termcap code. Typically
+this is used to produce some simply formatted version of the code and
+optional argument for debugging or testing. Note that this
+transformation is not applied to other non-printing characters such as
+carriage returns and newlines.
+
+@item @var{widget} [ @t{-n} @var{num} ] [ @t{-Nw} ] [ @t{-K} @var{keymap} ] @var{args} ...
+Invoke the specified @var{widget}. This can only be done when ZLE is
+active; normally this will be within a user-defined widget.
+
+@noindent
+With the options @t{-n} and @t{-N}, the current numeric argument will be
+saved and then restored after the call to @var{widget}; `@t{-n} @var{num}'
+sets the numeric argument temporarily to @var{num}, while `@t{-N}' sets it
+to the default, i.e. as if there were none.
+
+@noindent
+With the option @t{-K}, @var{keymap} will be used as the current keymap
+during the execution of the widget. The previous keymap will be
+restored when the widget exits.
+
+@noindent
+Normally, calling a widget in this way does not set the special
+parameter @t{WIDGET} and related parameters, so that the environment
+appears as if the top-level widget called by the user were still
+active. With the option @t{-w}, @t{WIDGET} and related parameters are set
+to reflect the widget being executed by the @t{zle} call.
+
+@noindent
+Any further arguments will be passed to the widget; note that as
+standard argument handling is performed, any general argument list
+should be preceded by @t{-}@t{-}. If it is a shell
+function, these are passed down as positional parameters; for builtin
+widgets it is up to the widget in question what it does with them.
+Currently arguments are only handled by the incremental-search commands,
+the @t{history-search-forward} and @t{-backward} and the corresponding
+functions prefixed by @t{vi-}, and by @t{universal-argument}. No error is
+flagged if the command does not use the arguments, or only uses some of
+them.
+
+@noindent
+The return status reflects the success or failure of the operation carried
+out by the widget, or if it is a user-defined widget the return status of
+the shell function.
+
+@noindent
+A non-zero return status causes the shell to beep when the widget exits,
+unless the @t{BEEP} options was unset or the widget was called via the
+@t{zle} command. Thus if a user defined widget requires an immediate beep,
+it should call the @t{beep} widget directly.
+
+@end table
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+@node Zle Widgets, Character Highlighting, Zle Builtins, Zsh Line Editor
+
+@section Widgets
+@noindent
+@cindex widgets
+All actions in the editor are performed by `widgets'. A widget's job is
+simply to perform some small action. The ZLE commands that key sequences
+in keymaps are bound to are in fact widgets. Widgets can be user-defined
+or built in.
+
+@noindent
+The standard widgets built into ZLE are listed in Standard Widgets below.
+Other built-in widgets can be defined by other modules (see
+@ref{Zsh Modules}). Each built-in widget has two names: its normal canonical name, and the
+same name preceded by a `@t{.}'. The `@t{.}' name is special: it can't be
+rebound to a different widget. This makes the widget available even when
+its usual name has been redefined.
+
+@noindent
+User-defined widgets are defined using `@t{zle -N}', and implemented
+as shell functions. When the widget is executed, the corresponding
+shell function is executed, and can perform editing (or other) actions.
+It is recommended that user-defined widgets should not have names
+starting with `@t{.}'.
+
+@section User-Defined Widgets
+@noindent
+@cindex widgets, user-defined
+User-defined widgets, being implemented as shell functions,
+can execute any normal shell command. They can also run other widgets
+(whether built-in or user-defined) using the @t{zle} builtin command. The
+standard input of the function is redirected from /dev/null to prevent
+external commands from unintentionally blocking ZLE by reading from the
+terminal, but @t{read -k} or @t{read -q} can be used to read characters.
+Finally, they can examine and edit the ZLE buffer being edited by reading
+and setting the special parameters described below.
+
+@noindent
+@cindex parameters, editor
+@cindex parameters, zle
+These special parameters are always available in widget functions, but
+are not in any way special outside ZLE. If they have some normal value
+outside ZLE, that value is temporarily inaccessible, but will return
+when the widget function exits. These special parameters in fact have
+local scope, like parameters created in a function using @t{local}.
+
+@noindent
+Inside completion widgets and traps called while ZLE is active, these
+parameters are available read-only.
+
+@noindent
+Note that the parameters appear as local to any ZLE widget in
+which they appear. Hence if it is desired to override them this needs
+to be done within a nested function:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+widget-function() @{
+ # $WIDGET here refers to the special variable
+ # that is local inside widget-function
+ () @{
+ # This anonymous nested function allows WIDGET
+ # to be used as a local variable. The -h
+ # removes the special status of the variable.
+ local -h WIDGET
+ @}
+@}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@vindex BUFFER
+@item @t{BUFFER} (scalar)
+The entire contents of the edit buffer. If it is written to, the
+cursor remains at the same offset, unless that would put it outside the
+buffer.
+
+@vindex BUFFERLINES
+@item @t{BUFFERLINES} (integer)
+The number of screen lines needed for the edit buffer currently
+displayed on screen (i.e. without any changes to the preceding
+parameters done after the last redisplay); read-only.
+
+@vindex CONTEXT
+@item @t{CONTEXT} (scalar)
+The context in which zle was called to read a line; read-only. One of
+the values:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{start}
+The start of a command line (at prompt @t{PS1}).
+
+@item @t{cont}
+A continuation to a command line (at prompt @t{PS2}).
+
+@item @t{select}
+In a @t{select} loop (at prompt @t{PS3}).
+
+@item @t{vared}
+Editing a variable in @t{vared}.
+
+@end table
+
+@vindex CURSOR
+@item @t{CURSOR} (integer)
+The offset of the cursor, within the edit buffer. This is in the range
+0 to @t{$#BUFFER}, and is by definition equal to @t{$#LBUFFER}.
+Attempts to move the cursor outside the buffer will result in the
+cursor being moved to the appropriate end of the buffer.
+
+@vindex CUTBUFFER
+@item @t{CUTBUFFER} (scalar)
+The last item cut using one of the `@t{kill-}' commands; the string
+which the next yank would insert in the line. Later entries in
+the kill ring are in the array @t{killring}. Note that the
+command `@t{zle copy-region-as-kill} @var{string}' can be used to
+set the text of the cut buffer from a shell function and cycle the kill
+ring in the same way as interactively killing text.
+
+@vindex HISTNO
+@item @t{HISTNO} (integer)
+The current history number. Setting this has the same effect as
+moving up or down in the history to the corresponding history line.
+An attempt to set it is ignored if the line is not stored in the
+history. Note this is not the same as the parameter @t{HISTCMD},
+which always gives the number of the history line being added to the main
+shell's history. @t{HISTNO} refers to the line being retrieved within
+zle.
+
+@vindex ISEARCHMATCH_ACTIVE
+@vindex ISEARCHMATCH_START
+@vindex ISEARCHMATCH_END
+@item @t{ISEARCHMATCH_ACTIVE} (integer)
+@itemx @t{ISEARCHMATCH_START} (integer)
+@itemx @t{ISEARCHMATCH_END} (integer)
+@t{ISEARCHMATCH_ACTIVE} indicates whether a part of the @t{BUFFER} is
+currently matched by an incremental search pattern. @t{ISEARCHMATCH_START}
+and @t{ISEARCHMATCH_END} give the location of the matched part and are
+in the same units as @t{CURSOR}. They are only valid for reading
+when @t{ISEARCHMATCH_ACTIVE} is non-zero.
+
+@noindent
+All parameters are read-only.
+
+@vindex KEYMAP
+@item @t{KEYMAP} (scalar)
+The name of the currently selected keymap; read-only.
+
+@vindex KEYS
+@item @t{KEYS} (scalar)
+The keys typed to invoke this widget, as a literal string; read-only.
+
+@vindex KEYS_QUEUED_COUNT
+@item @t{KEYS_QUEUED_COUNT} (integer)
+The number of bytes pushed back to the input queue and therefore
+available for reading immediately before any I/O is done; read-only.
+See also @t{PENDING}; the two values are distinct.
+
+@vindex killring
+@item @t{killring} (array)
+The array of previously killed items, with the most recently killed first.
+This gives the items that would be retrieved by a @t{yank-pop} in the
+same order. Note, however, that the most recently killed item is in
+@t{$CUTBUFFER}; @t{$killring} shows the array of previous entries.
+
+@noindent
+The default size for the kill ring is eight, however the length may be
+changed by normal array operations. Any empty string in the kill ring is
+ignored by the @t{yank-pop} command, hence the size of the array
+effectively sets the maximum length of the kill ring, while the number of
+non-zero strings gives the current length, both as seen by the user at the
+command line.
+
+@vindex LASTABORTEDSEARCH
+@item @t{LASTABORTEDSEARCH} (scalar)
+The last search string used by an interactive search that was
+aborted by the user (status 3 returned by the search widget).
+
+@vindex LASTSEARCH
+@item @t{LASTSEARCH} (scalar)
+The last search string used by an interactive search; read-only.
+This is set even if the search failed (status 0, 1 or 2 returned
+by the search widget), but not if it was aborted by the user.
+
+@vindex LASTWIDGET
+@item @t{LASTWIDGET} (scalar)
+The name of the last widget that was executed; read-only.
+
+@vindex LBUFFER
+@item @t{LBUFFER} (scalar)
+The part of the buffer that lies to the left of the cursor position.
+If it is assigned to, only that part of the buffer is replaced, and the
+cursor remains between the new @t{$LBUFFER} and the old @t{$RBUFFER}.
+
+@vindex MARK
+@item @t{MARK} (integer)
+Like @t{CURSOR}, but for the mark. With vi-mode operators that wait for
+a movement command to select a region of text, setting @t{MARK} allows
+the selection to extend in both directions from the initial cursor
+position.
+
+@vindex NUMERIC
+@item @t{NUMERIC} (integer)
+The numeric argument. If no numeric argument was given, this parameter
+is unset. When this is set inside a widget function, builtin widgets
+called with the @t{zle} builtin command will use the value
+assigned. If it is unset inside a widget function, builtin widgets
+called behave as if no numeric argument was given.
+
+@vindex PENDING
+@item @t{PENDING} (integer)
+The number of bytes pending for input, i.e. the number of bytes which have
+already been typed and can immediately be read. On systems where the shell
+is not able to get this information, this parameter will always have a
+value of zero. Read-only. See also @t{KEYS_QUEUED_COUNT}; the two
+values are distinct.
+
+@vindex PREBUFFER
+@item @t{PREBUFFER} (scalar)
+In a multi-line input at the secondary prompt, this read-only parameter
+contains the contents of the lines before the one the cursor is
+currently in.
+
+@vindex PREDISPLAY
+@item @t{PREDISPLAY} (scalar)
+Text to be displayed before the start of the editable text buffer. This
+does not have to be a complete line; to display a complete line, a newline
+must be appended explicitly. The text is reset on each new invocation
+(but not recursive invocation) of zle.
+
+@vindex POSTDISPLAY
+@item @t{POSTDISPLAY} (scalar)
+Text to be displayed after the end of the editable text buffer. This
+does not have to be a complete line; to display a complete line, a newline
+must be prepended explicitly. The text is reset on each new invocation
+(but not recursive invocation) of zle.
+
+@vindex RBUFFER
+@item @t{RBUFFER} (scalar)
+The part of the buffer that lies to the right of the cursor position.
+If it is assigned to, only that part of the buffer is replaced, and the
+cursor remains between the old @t{$LBUFFER} and the new @t{$RBUFFER}.
+
+@vindex REGION_ACTIVE
+@item @t{REGION_ACTIVE} (integer)
+Indicates if the region is currently active. It can be assigned 0 or 1
+to deactivate and activate the region respectively. A value of 2
+activates the region in line-wise mode with the highlighted text
+extending for whole lines only; see
+@ref{Character Highlighting}.
+
+@vindex region_highlight
+@item @t{region_highlight} (array)
+Each element of this array may be set to a string that describes
+highlighting for an arbitrary region of the command line that will
+take effect the next time the command line is redisplayed. Highlighting
+of the non-editable parts of the command line in @t{PREDISPLAY}
+and @t{POSTDISPLAY} are possible, but note that the @t{P} flag
+is needed for character indexing to include @t{PREDISPLAY}.
+
+@noindent
+Each string consists of the following parts:
+
+@noindent
+@itemize @bullet
+
+@item
+Optionally, a `@t{P}' to signify that the start and end offset that
+follow include any string set by the @t{PREDISPLAY} special parameter;
+this is needed if the predisplay string itself is to be highlighted.
+Whitespace may follow the `@t{P}'.
+@item
+A start offset in the same units as @t{CURSOR}, terminated by
+whitespace.
+@item
+An end offset in the same units as @t{CURSOR}, terminated by
+whitespace.
+@item
+A highlight specification in the same format as
+used for contexts in the parameter @t{zle_highlight}, see
+@ref{Character Highlighting};
+for example, @t{standout} or @t{fg=red,bold}.
+@end itemize
+
+@noindent
+For example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+region_highlight=("P0 20 bold")
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+specifies that the first twenty characters of the text including
+any predisplay string should be highlighted in bold.
+
+@noindent
+Note that the effect of @t{region_highlight} is not saved and disappears
+as soon as the line is accepted.
+
+@noindent
+The final highlighting on the command line depends on both @t{region_highlight}
+and @t{zle_highlight}; see
+@ref{Character Highlighting} for details.
+
+@vindex registers
+@item @t{registers} (associative array)
+The contents of each of the vi register buffers. These are
+typically set using @t{vi-set-buffer} followed by a delete, change or
+yank command.
+
+@vindex SUFFIX_ACTIVE
+@vindex SUFFIX_START
+@vindex SUFFIX_END
+@item @t{SUFFIX_ACTIVE} (integer)
+@itemx @t{SUFFIX_START} (integer)
+@itemx @t{SUFFIX_END} (integer)
+@t{SUFFIX_ACTIVE} indicates whether an auto-removable completion suffix
+is currently active. @t{SUFFIX_START} and @t{SUFFIX_END} give the
+location of the suffix and are in the same units as @t{CURSOR}. They are
+only valid for reading when @t{SUFFIX_ACTIVE} is non-zero.
+
+@noindent
+All parameters are read-only.
+
+@vindex UNDO_CHANGE_NO
+@item @t{UNDO_CHANGE_NO} (integer)
+A number representing the state of the undo history. The only use
+of this is passing as an argument to the @t{undo} widget in order to
+undo back to the recorded point. Read-only.
+
+@vindex UNDO_LIMIT_NO
+@item @t{UNDO_LIMIT_NO} (integer)
+A number corresponding to an existing change in the undo history;
+compare @t{UNDO_CHANGE_NO}. If this is set to a value greater
+than zero, the @t{undo} command will not allow the line to
+be undone beyond the given change number. It is still possible
+to use `@t{zle undo} @var{change}' in a widget to undo beyond
+that point; in that case, it will not be possible to undo at
+all until @t{UNDO_LIMIT_NO} is reduced. Set to 0 to disable the limit.
+
+@noindent
+A typical use of this variable in a widget function is as follows (note
+the additional function scope is required):
+
+@noindent
+@example
+() @{
+ local UNDO_LIMIT_NO=$UNDO_CHANGE_NO
+ # Perform some form of recursive edit.
+@}
+@end example
+
+@vindex WIDGET
+@item @t{WIDGET} (scalar)
+The name of the widget currently being executed; read-only.
+
+@vindex WIDGETFUNC
+@item @t{WIDGETFUNC} (scalar)
+The name of the shell function that implements a widget defined with
+either @t{zle -N} or @t{zle -C}. In the former case, this is the second
+argument to the @t{zle -N} command that defined the widget, or
+the first argument if there was no second argument. In the latter case
+this is the third argument to the @t{zle -C} command that defined the
+widget. Read-only.
+
+@vindex WIDGETSTYLE
+@item @t{WIDGETSTYLE} (scalar)
+Describes the implementation behind the completion widget currently being
+executed; the second argument that followed @t{zle -C} when the widget was
+defined. This is the name of a builtin completion widget. For widgets
+defined with @t{zle -N} this is set to the empty string. Read-only.
+
+@vindex YANK_ACTIVE
+@vindex YANK_START
+@vindex YANK_END
+@item @t{YANK_ACTIVE} (integer)
+@itemx @t{YANK_START} (integer)
+@itemx @t{YANK_END} (integer)
+@t{YANK_ACTIVE} indicates whether text has just been yanked (pasted)
+into the buffer. @t{YANK_START} and @t{YANK_END} give the location of
+the pasted text and are in the same units as @t{CURSOR}. They are only
+valid for reading when @t{YANK_ACTIVE} is non-zero. They can also be
+assigned by widgets that insert text in a yank-like fashion, for example
+wrappers of @t{bracketed-paste}. See also @t{zle -f}.
+
+@noindent
+@t{YANK_ACTIVE} is read-only.
+
+@vindex ZLE_RECURSIVE
+@item @t{ZLE_RECURSIVE} (integer)
+Usually zero, but incremented inside any instance of
+@t{recursive-edit}. Hence indicates the current recursion level.
+
+@noindent
+@t{ZLE_RECURSIVE} is read-only.
+
+@vindex ZLE_STATE
+@item @t{ZLE_STATE} (scalar)
+Contains a set of space-separated words that describe the current @t{zle}
+state.
+
+@noindent
+Currently, the states shown are the insert mode as set by the
+@t{overwrite-mode} or @t{vi-replace} widgets and whether history commands
+will visit imported entries as controlled by the set-local-history widget.
+The string contains `@t{insert}' if characters to be inserted on the
+command line move existing characters to the right or `@t{overwrite}'
+if characters to be inserted overwrite existing characters. It contains
+`@t{localhistory}' if only local history commands will be visited or
+`@t{globalhistory}' if imported history commands will also be visited.
+
+@noindent
+The substrings are sorted in alphabetical order so that if you want to
+test for two specific substrings in a future-proof way, you can do match
+by doing:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+if [[ $ZLE_STATE == *globalhistory*insert* ]]; then ...; fi
+@end example
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Special Widgets
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+There are a few user-defined widgets which are special to the shell.
+If they do not exist, no special action is taken. The environment
+provided is identical to that for any other editing widget.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@tindex zle-isearch-exit
+@item @t{zle-isearch-exit}
+Executed at the end of incremental search at the point where the isearch
+prompt is removed from the display. See @t{zle-isearch-update} for
+an example.
+
+@tindex zle-isearch-update
+@item @t{zle-isearch-update}
+Executed within incremental search when the display is about to be
+redrawn. Additional output below the incremental search prompt can be
+generated by using `@t{zle -M}' within the widget. For example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zle-isearch-update() @{ zle -M "Line $HISTNO"; @}
+zle -N zle-isearch-update
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Note the line output by `@t{zle -M}' is not deleted on exit from
+incremental search. This can be done from a @t{zle-isearch-exit}
+widget:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zle-isearch-exit() @{ zle -M ""; @}
+zle -N zle-isearch-exit
+@end example
+
+@tindex zle-line-pre-redraw
+@item @t{zle-line-pre-redraw}
+Executed whenever the input line is about to be redrawn, providing an
+opportunity to update the region_highlight array.
+
+@tindex zle-line-init
+@item @t{zle-line-init}
+Executed every time the line editor is started to read a new line
+of input. The following example puts the line editor into vi command
+mode when it starts up.
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zle-line-init() @{ zle -K vicmd; @}
+zle -N zle-line-init
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+(The command inside the function sets the keymap directly; it is
+equivalent to @t{zle vi-cmd-mode}.)
+
+@tindex zle-line-finish
+@item @t{zle-line-finish}
+This is similar to @t{zle-line-init} but is executed every time the
+line editor has finished reading a line of input.
+
+@tindex zle-history-line-set
+@item @t{zle-history-line-set}
+Executed when the history line changes.
+
+@tindex zle-keymap-select
+@item @t{zle-keymap-select}
+Executed every time the keymap changes, i.e. the special parameter
+@t{KEYMAP} is set to a different value, while the line editor is active.
+Initialising the keymap when the line editor starts does not cause the
+widget to be called.
+
+@noindent
+The value @t{$KEYMAP} within the function reflects the new keymap. The
+old keymap is passed as the sole argument.
+
+@noindent
+This can be used for detecting switches between the vi command
+(@t{vicmd}) and insert (usually @t{main}) keymaps.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@section Standard Widgets
+@noindent
+@cindex widgets, standard
+The following is a list of all the standard widgets,
+and their default bindings in emacs mode,
+vi command mode and vi insert mode
+(the `@t{emacs}', `@t{vicmd}' and `@t{viins}' keymaps, respectively).
+
+@noindent
+Note that cursor keys are bound to movement keys in all three keymaps;
+the shell assumes that the cursor keys send the key sequences reported
+by the terminal-handling library (termcap or terminfo). The key sequences
+shown in the list are those based on the VT100, common on many modern
+terminals, but in fact these are not necessarily bound. In the case of the
+@t{viins} keymap, the initial escape character of the sequences serves also
+to return to the @t{vicmd} keymap: whether this happens is determined by
+the @t{KEYTIMEOUT} parameter, see @ref{Parameters}.
+@menu
+* Movement::
+* History Control::
+* Modifying Text::
+* Arguments::
+* Completion::
+* Miscellaneous::
+* Text Objects::
+@end menu
+@node Movement, History Control, , Zle Widgets
+
+@subsection Movement
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@tindex vi-backward-blank-word
+@item @t{vi-backward-blank-word} (unbound) (@t{B}) (unbound)
+Move backward one word, where a word is defined as a series of
+non-blank characters.
+
+@tindex vi-backward-blank-word-end
+@item @t{vi-backward-blank-word-end} (unbound) (@t{gE}) (unbound)
+Move to the end of the previous word, where a word is defined as a
+series of non-blank characters.
+
+@tindex backward-char
+@item @t{backward-char} (@t{^B ESC-[D}) (unbound) (unbound)
+Move backward one character.
+
+@tindex vi-backward-char
+@item @t{vi-backward-char} (unbound) (@t{^H h ^?}) (@t{ESC-[D})
+Move backward one character, without changing lines.
+
+@tindex backward-word
+@item @t{backward-word} (@t{ESC-B ESC-b}) (unbound) (unbound)
+Move to the beginning of the previous word.
+
+@tindex emacs-backward-word
+@item @t{emacs-backward-word}
+Move to the beginning of the previous word.
+
+@tindex vi-backward-word
+@item @t{vi-backward-word} (unbound) (@t{b}) (unbound)
+Move to the beginning of the previous word, vi-style.
+
+@tindex vi-backward-word-end
+@item @t{vi-backward-word-end} (unbound) (@t{ge}) (unbound)
+Move to the end of the previous word, vi-style.
+
+@tindex beginning-of-line
+@item @t{beginning-of-line} (@t{^A}) (unbound) (unbound)
+Move to the beginning of the line. If already at the beginning
+of the line, move to the beginning of the previous line, if any.
+
+@tindex vi-beginning-of-line
+@item @t{vi-beginning-of-line}
+Move to the beginning of the line, without changing lines.
+
+@tindex down-line
+@item @t{down-line} (unbound) (unbound) (unbound)
+Move down a line in the buffer.
+
+@tindex end-of-line
+@item @t{end-of-line} (@t{^E}) (unbound) (unbound)
+Move to the end of the line. If already at the end
+of the line, move to the end of the next line, if any.
+
+@tindex vi-end-of-line
+@item @t{vi-end-of-line} (unbound) (@t{$}) (unbound)
+Move to the end of the line.
+If an argument is given to this command, the cursor will be moved to
+the end of the line (argument - 1) lines down.
+
+@tindex vi-forward-blank-word
+@item @t{vi-forward-blank-word} (unbound) (@t{W}) (unbound)
+Move forward one word, where a word is defined as a series of
+non-blank characters.
+
+@tindex vi-forward-blank-word-end
+@item @t{vi-forward-blank-word-end} (unbound) (@t{E}) (unbound)
+Move to the end of the current word, or, if at the end of the current word,
+to the end of the next word,
+where a word is defined as a series of non-blank characters.
+
+@tindex forward-char
+@item @t{forward-char} (@t{^F ESC-[C}) (unbound) (unbound)
+Move forward one character.
+
+@tindex vi-forward-char
+@item @t{vi-forward-char} (unbound) (@t{space l}) (@t{ESC-[C})
+Move forward one character.
+
+@tindex vi-find-next-char
+@item @t{vi-find-next-char} (@t{^X^F}) (@t{f}) (unbound)
+Read a character from the keyboard, and move to
+the next occurrence of it in the line.
+
+@tindex vi-find-next-char-skip
+@item @t{vi-find-next-char-skip} (unbound) (@t{t}) (unbound)
+Read a character from the keyboard, and move to
+the position just before the next occurrence of it in the line.
+
+@tindex vi-find-prev-char
+@item @t{vi-find-prev-char} (unbound) (@t{F}) (unbound)
+Read a character from the keyboard, and move to
+the previous occurrence of it in the line.
+
+@tindex vi-find-prev-char-skip
+@item @t{vi-find-prev-char-skip} (unbound) (@t{T}) (unbound)
+Read a character from the keyboard, and move to
+the position just after the previous occurrence of it in the line.
+
+@tindex vi-first-non-blank
+@item @t{vi-first-non-blank} (unbound) (@t{^}) (unbound)
+Move to the first non-blank character in the line.
+
+@tindex vi-forward-word
+@item @t{vi-forward-word} (unbound) (@t{w}) (unbound)
+Move forward one word, vi-style.
+
+@tindex forward-word
+@item @t{forward-word} (@t{ESC-F ESC-f}) (unbound) (unbound)
+Move to the beginning of the next word.
+The editor's idea of a word is specified with the @t{WORDCHARS}
+parameter.
+
+@tindex emacs-forward-word
+@item @t{emacs-forward-word}
+Move to the end of the next word.
+
+@tindex vi-forward-word-end
+@item @t{vi-forward-word-end} (unbound) (@t{e}) (unbound)
+Move to the end of the next word.
+
+@tindex vi-goto-column
+@item @t{vi-goto-column} (@t{ESC-|}) (@t{|}) (unbound)
+Move to the column specified by the numeric argument.
+
+@tindex vi-goto-mark
+@item @t{vi-goto-mark} (unbound) (@t{`}) (unbound)
+Move to the specified mark.
+
+@tindex vi-goto-mark-line
+@item @t{vi-goto-mark-line} (unbound) (@t{'}) (unbound)
+Move to beginning of the line containing the specified mark.
+
+@tindex vi-repeat-find
+@item @t{vi-repeat-find} (unbound) (@t{;}) (unbound)
+Repeat the last @t{vi-find} command.
+
+@tindex vi-rev-repeat-find
+@item @t{vi-rev-repeat-find} (unbound) (@t{,}) (unbound)
+Repeat the last @t{vi-find} command in the opposite direction.
+
+@tindex up-line
+@item @t{up-line} (unbound) (unbound) (unbound)
+Move up a line in the buffer.
+
+@end table
+@node History Control, Modifying Text, Movement, Zle Widgets
+
+@subsection History Control
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@tindex beginning-of-buffer-or-history
+@item @t{beginning-of-buffer-or-history} (@t{ESC-<}) (@t{gg}) (unbound)
+Move to the beginning of the buffer, or if already there,
+move to the first event in the history list.
+
+@tindex beginning-of-line-hist
+@item @t{beginning-of-line-hist}
+Move to the beginning of the line. If already at the
+beginning of the buffer, move to the previous history line.
+
+@tindex beginning-of-history
+@item @t{beginning-of-history}
+Move to the first event in the history list.
+
+@tindex down-line-or-history
+@item @t{down-line-or-history} (@t{^N ESC-[B}) (@t{j}) (@t{ESC-[B})
+Move down a line in the buffer, or if already at the bottom line,
+move to the next event in the history list.
+
+@tindex vi-down-line-or-history
+@item @t{vi-down-line-or-history} (unbound) (@t{+}) (unbound)
+Move down a line in the buffer, or if already at the bottom line,
+move to the next event in the history list.
+Then move to the first non-blank character on the line.
+
+@tindex down-line-or-search
+@item @t{down-line-or-search}
+Move down a line in the buffer, or if already at the bottom line,
+search forward in the history for a line beginning with the first
+word in the buffer.
+
+@noindent
+If called from a function by the @t{zle} command with arguments, the first
+argument is taken as the string for which to search, rather than the
+first word in the buffer.
+
+@tindex down-history
+@item @t{down-history} (unbound) (@t{^N}) (unbound)
+Move to the next event in the history list.
+
+@tindex history-beginning-search-backward
+@item @t{history-beginning-search-backward}
+Search backward in the history for a line beginning with the current
+line up to the cursor.
+This leaves the cursor in its original position.
+
+@tindex end-of-buffer-or-history
+@item @t{end-of-buffer-or-history} (@t{ESC->}) (unbound) (unbound)
+Move to the end of the buffer, or if already there,
+move to the last event in the history list.
+
+@tindex end-of-line-hist
+@item @t{end-of-line-hist}
+Move to the end of the line. If already at the end of
+the buffer, move to the next history line.
+
+@tindex end-of-history
+@item @t{end-of-history}
+Move to the last event in the history list.
+
+@tindex vi-fetch-history
+@item @t{vi-fetch-history} (unbound) (@t{G}) (unbound)
+Fetch the history line specified by the numeric argument.
+This defaults to the current history line
+(i.e. the one that isn't history yet).
+
+@tindex history-incremental-search-backward
+@item @t{history-incremental-search-backward} (@t{^R ^Xr}) (unbound) (unbound)
+Search backward incrementally for a specified string. The search is
+case-insensitive if the search string does not have uppercase letters and no
+numeric argument was given. The string may begin with `@t{^}' to anchor the
+search to the beginning of the line. When called from a user-defined
+function returns the following statuses: 0, if the search succeeded;
+1, if the search failed; 2, if the search term was a bad pattern;
+3, if the search was aborted by the @t{send-break} command.
+
+@noindent
+A restricted set of editing functions
+is available in the mini-buffer. Keys are looked up in the special
+@t{isearch} keymap, and if not found there in the main keymap (note
+that by default the @t{isearch} keymap is empty).
+An interrupt signal, as defined by the stty
+setting, will stop the search and go back to the original line. An undefined
+key will have the same effect. Note that the following always
+perform the same task within incremental searches and cannot be
+replaced by user defined widgets, nor can the set of functions
+be extended. The supported functions are:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{accept-and-hold}
+@itemx @t{accept-and-infer-next-history}
+@itemx @t{accept-line}
+@itemx @t{accept-line-and-down-history}
+Perform the usual function after exiting incremental search.
+The command line displayed is executed.
+
+@item @t{backward-delete-char}
+@itemx @t{vi-backward-delete-char}
+Back up one place in the search history. If the search has been
+repeated this does not immediately erase a character in the
+minibuffer.
+
+@item @t{accept-search}
+Exit incremental search, retaining the command line but performing no
+further action. Note that this function is not bound by default
+and has no effect outside incremental search.
+
+@item @t{backward-delete-word}
+@itemx @t{backward-kill-word}
+@itemx @t{vi-backward-kill-word}
+Back up one character in the minibuffer; if multiple searches
+have been performed since the character was inserted the search
+history is rewound to the point just before the character was
+entered. Hence this has the effect of repeating
+@t{backward-delete-char}.
+
+@item @t{clear-screen}
+Clear the screen, remaining in incremental search mode.
+
+@item @t{history-incremental-search-backward}
+Find the next occurrence of the contents of the mini-buffer. If the
+mini-buffer is empty, the most recent previously used search string is
+reinstated.
+
+@item @t{history-incremental-search-forward}
+Invert the sense of the search.
+
+@item @t{magic-space}
+Inserts a non-magical space.
+
+@item @t{quoted-insert}
+@itemx @t{vi-quoted-insert}
+Quote the character to insert into the minibuffer.
+
+@item @t{redisplay}
+Redisplay the command line, remaining in incremental search mode.
+
+@item @t{vi-cmd-mode}
+Select the `@t{vicmd}' keymap;
+the `@t{main}' keymap (insert mode) will be selected initially.
+
+@noindent
+In addition, the modifications that were made while in vi insert mode are
+merged to form a single undo event.
+
+@item @t{vi-repeat-search}
+@itemx @t{vi-rev-repeat-search}
+Repeat the search. The direction of the search is indicated in the
+mini-buffer.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+Any character that is not bound to one of the above functions, or
+@t{self-insert} or @t{self-insert-unmeta}, will cause the mode to be
+exited. The character is then looked up and executed in the keymap in
+effect at that point.
+
+@noindent
+When called from a widget function by the @t{zle} command, the incremental
+search commands can take a string argument. This will be treated as a
+string of keys, as for arguments to the @t{bindkey} command, and used as
+initial input for the command. Any characters in the string which are
+unused by the incremental search will be silently ignored. For example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zle history-incremental-search-backward forceps
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+will search backwards for @t{forceps}, leaving the minibuffer containing
+the string `@t{forceps}'.
+
+@tindex history-incremental-search-forward
+@item @t{history-incremental-search-forward} (@t{^S ^Xs}) (unbound) (unbound)
+Search forward incrementally for a specified string. The search is
+case-insensitive if the search string does not have uppercase letters and no
+numeric argument was given. The string may begin with `@t{^}' to anchor the
+search to the beginning of the line. The functions available in the
+mini-buffer are the same as for @t{history-incremental-search-backward}.
+
+@tindex history-incremental-pattern-search-backward
+@tindex history-incremental-pattern-search-forward
+@item @t{history-incremental-pattern-search-backward}
+@itemx @t{history-incremental-pattern-search-forward}
+These widgets behave similarly to the corresponding widgets with
+no @t{-pattern}, but the search string typed by the user is treated
+as a pattern, respecting the current settings of the various options
+affecting pattern matching. See
+@ref{Filename Generation} for a description of patterns.
+If no numeric argument was given lowercase letters in the search
+string may match uppercase letters in the history. The string may begin
+with `@t{^}' to anchor the search to the beginning of the line.
+
+@noindent
+The prompt changes to indicate an invalid pattern; this may simply
+indicate the pattern is not yet complete.
+
+@noindent
+Note that only non-overlapping matches are reported, so an expression
+with wildcards may return fewer matches on a line than are visible
+by inspection.
+
+@tindex history-search-backward
+@item @t{history-search-backward} (@t{ESC-P ESC-p}) (unbound) (unbound)
+Search backward in the history for a line beginning with the first
+word in the buffer.
+
+@noindent
+If called from a function by the @t{zle} command with arguments, the first
+argument is taken as the string for which to search, rather than the
+first word in the buffer.
+
+@tindex vi-history-search-backward
+@item @t{vi-history-search-backward} (unbound) (@t{/}) (unbound)
+Search backward in the history for a specified string.
+The string may begin with `@t{^}' to anchor the search to the
+beginning of the line.
+
+@noindent
+A restricted set of editing functions is available in
+the mini-buffer. An interrupt signal, as defined by the stty setting, will
+stop the search.
+The functions available in the mini-buffer are:
+@t{accept-line},
+@t{backward-delete-char},
+@t{vi-backward-delete-char},
+@t{backward-kill-word},
+@t{vi-backward-kill-word},
+@t{clear-screen},
+@t{redisplay},
+@t{quoted-insert}
+and
+@t{vi-quoted-insert}.
+
+@noindent
+@t{vi-cmd-mode} is treated the same as accept-line, and
+@t{magic-space} is treated as a space.
+Any other character that is not bound to self-insert or
+self-insert-unmeta will beep and be ignored. If the function is called from vi
+command mode, the bindings of the current insert mode will be used.
+
+@noindent
+If called from a function by the @t{zle} command with arguments, the first
+argument is taken as the string for which to search, rather than the
+first word in the buffer.
+
+@tindex history-search-forward
+@item @t{history-search-forward} (@t{ESC-N ESC-n}) (unbound) (unbound)
+Search forward in the history for a line beginning with the first
+word in the buffer.
+
+@noindent
+If called from a function by the @t{zle} command with arguments, the first
+argument is taken as the string for which to search, rather than the
+first word in the buffer.
+
+@tindex vi-history-search-forward
+@item @t{vi-history-search-forward} (unbound) (@t{?}) (unbound)
+Search forward in the history for a specified string.
+The string may begin with `@t{^}' to anchor the search to the
+beginning of the line. The functions available in the mini-buffer are the same
+as for @t{vi-history-search-backward}. Argument handling is also the same
+as for that command.
+
+@tindex infer-next-history
+@item @t{infer-next-history} (@t{^X^N}) (unbound) (unbound)
+Search in the history list for a line matching the current one and
+fetch the event following it.
+
+@tindex insert-last-word
+@item @t{insert-last-word} (@t{ESC-_ ESC-.}) (unbound) (unbound)
+Insert the last word from the previous history event at the
+cursor position. If a positive numeric argument is given,
+insert that word from the end of the previous history event.
+If the argument is zero or negative insert that word from the
+left (zero inserts the previous command word). Repeating this command
+replaces the word just inserted with the last word from the
+history event prior to the one just used; numeric arguments can be used in
+the same way to pick a word from that event.
+
+@noindent
+When called from a shell function invoked from a user-defined widget, the
+command can take one to three arguments. The first argument specifies a
+history offset which applies to successive calls to this widget: if it is -1,
+the default behaviour is used, while if it is 1, successive calls will move
+forwards through the history. The value 0 can be used to indicate that the
+history line examined by the previous execution of the command will be
+reexamined. Note that negative numbers should be preceded by a
+`@t{-}@t{-}' argument to avoid confusing them with options.
+
+@noindent
+If two arguments are given, the second specifies the word on the command
+line in normal array index notation (as a more natural alternative to the
+numeric argument). Hence 1 is the first word, and -1 (the default) is the
+last word.
+
+@noindent
+If a third argument is given, its value is ignored, but it is used to
+signify that the history offset is relative to the current history line,
+rather than the one remembered after the previous invocations of
+@t{insert-last-word}.
+
+@noindent
+For example, the default behaviour of the command corresponds to
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zle insert-last-word -- -1 -1
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+while the command
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zle insert-last-word -- -1 1 -
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+always copies the first word of the line in the history immediately before
+the line being edited. This has the side effect that later invocations of
+the widget will be relative to that line.
+
+@tindex vi-repeat-search
+@item @t{vi-repeat-search} (unbound) (@t{n}) (unbound)
+Repeat the last vi history search.
+
+@tindex vi-rev-repeat-search
+@item @t{vi-rev-repeat-search} (unbound) (@t{N}) (unbound)
+Repeat the last vi history search, but in reverse.
+
+@tindex up-line-or-history
+@item @t{up-line-or-history} (@t{^P ESC-[A}) (@t{k}) (@t{ESC-[A})
+Move up a line in the buffer, or if already at the top line,
+move to the previous event in the history list.
+
+@tindex vi-up-line-or-history
+@item @t{vi-up-line-or-history} (unbound) (@t{-}) (unbound)
+Move up a line in the buffer, or if already at the top line,
+move to the previous event in the history list.
+Then move to the first non-blank character on the line.
+
+@tindex up-line-or-search
+@item @t{up-line-or-search}
+Move up a line in the buffer, or if already at the top line,
+search backward in the history for a line beginning with the
+first word in the buffer.
+
+@noindent
+If called from a function by the @t{zle} command with arguments, the first
+argument is taken as the string for which to search, rather than the
+first word in the buffer.
+
+@tindex up-history
+@item @t{up-history} (unbound) (@t{^P}) (unbound)
+Move to the previous event in the history list.
+
+@tindex history-beginning-search-forward
+@item @t{history-beginning-search-forward}
+Search forward in the history for a line beginning with the current
+line up to the cursor.
+This leaves the cursor in its original position.
+
+@tindex set-local-history
+@item @t{set-local-history}
+By default, history movement commands visit the imported lines as well as
+the local lines. This widget lets you toggle this on and off, or set it with
+the numeric argument. Zero for both local and imported lines and nonzero for
+only local lines.
+
+@end table
+@node Modifying Text, Arguments, History Control, Zle Widgets
+
+@subsection Modifying Text
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@tindex vi-add-eol
+@item @t{vi-add-eol} (unbound) (@t{A}) (unbound)
+Move to the end of the line and enter insert mode.
+
+@tindex vi-add-next
+@item @t{vi-add-next} (unbound) (@t{a}) (unbound)
+Enter insert mode after the current cursor position, without changing lines.
+
+@tindex backward-delete-char
+@item @t{backward-delete-char} (@t{^H ^?}) (unbound) (unbound)
+Delete the character behind the cursor.
+
+@tindex vi-backward-delete-char
+@item @t{vi-backward-delete-char} (unbound) (@t{X}) (@t{^H})
+Delete the character behind the cursor, without changing lines.
+If in insert mode, this won't delete past the point where insert mode was
+last entered.
+
+@tindex backward-delete-word
+@item @t{backward-delete-word}
+Delete the word behind the cursor.
+
+@tindex backward-kill-line
+@item @t{backward-kill-line}
+Kill from the beginning of the line to the cursor position.
+
+@tindex backward-kill-word
+@item @t{backward-kill-word} (@t{^W ESC-^H ESC-^?}) (unbound) (unbound)
+Kill the word behind the cursor.
+
+@tindex vi-backward-kill-word
+@item @t{vi-backward-kill-word} (unbound) (unbound) (@t{^W})
+Kill the word behind the cursor, without going past the point where insert
+mode was last entered.
+
+@tindex capitalize-word
+@item @t{capitalize-word} (@t{ESC-C ESC-c}) (unbound) (unbound)
+Capitalize the current word and move past it.
+
+@tindex vi-change
+@item @t{vi-change} (unbound) (@t{c}) (unbound)
+Read a movement command from the keyboard, and kill
+from the cursor position to the endpoint of the movement.
+Then enter insert mode.
+If the command is @t{vi-change}, change the current line.
+
+@noindent
+For compatibility with vi, if the command is @t{vi-forward-word}
+or @t{vi-forward-blank-word}, the whitespace after the word is not
+included. If you prefer the more consistent behaviour with the
+whitespace included use the following key binding:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+bindkey -a -s cw dwi
+@end example
+
+@tindex vi-change-eol
+@item @t{vi-change-eol} (unbound) (@t{C}) (unbound)
+Kill to the end of the line and enter insert mode.
+
+@tindex vi-change-whole-line
+@item @t{vi-change-whole-line} (unbound) (@t{S}) (unbound)
+Kill the current line and enter insert mode.
+
+@tindex copy-region-as-kill
+@item @t{copy-region-as-kill} (@t{ESC-W ESC-w}) (unbound) (unbound)
+Copy the area from the cursor to the mark to the kill buffer.
+
+@noindent
+If called from a ZLE widget function in the form `@t{zle
+copy-region-as-kill} @var{string}' then @var{string} will be taken as the
+text to copy to the kill buffer. The cursor, the mark and the text on the
+command line are not used in this case.
+
+@tindex copy-prev-word
+@item @t{copy-prev-word} (@t{ESC-^_}) (unbound) (unbound)
+Duplicate the word to the left of the cursor.
+
+@tindex copy-prev-shell-word
+@item @t{copy-prev-shell-word}
+Like @t{copy-prev-word}, but the word is found by using shell parsing,
+whereas @t{copy-prev-word} looks for blanks. This makes a difference
+when the word is quoted and contains spaces.
+
+@tindex vi-delete
+@item @t{vi-delete} (unbound) (@t{d}) (unbound)
+Read a movement command from the keyboard, and kill
+from the cursor position to the endpoint of the movement.
+If the command is @t{vi-delete}, kill the current line.
+
+@tindex delete-char
+@item @t{delete-char}
+Delete the character under the cursor.
+
+@tindex vi-delete-char
+@item @t{vi-delete-char} (unbound) (@t{x}) (unbound)
+Delete the character under the cursor,
+without going past the end of the line.
+
+@tindex delete-word
+@item @t{delete-word}
+Delete the current word.
+
+@tindex down-case-word
+@item @t{down-case-word} (@t{ESC-L ESC-l}) (unbound) (unbound)
+Convert the current word to all lowercase and move past it.
+
+@tindex vi-down-case
+@item @t{vi-down-case} (unbound) (@t{gu}) (unbound)
+Read a movement command from the keyboard, and convert all characters
+from the cursor position to the endpoint of the movement to lowercase.
+If the movement command is @t{vi-down-case}, swap the case of all
+characters on the current line.
+
+@tindex kill-word
+@item @t{kill-word} (@t{ESC-D ESC-d}) (unbound) (unbound)
+Kill the current word.
+
+@tindex gosmacs-transpose-chars
+@item @t{gosmacs-transpose-chars}
+Exchange the two characters behind the cursor.
+
+@tindex vi-indent
+@item @t{vi-indent} (unbound) (@t{>}) (unbound)
+Indent a number of lines.
+
+@tindex vi-insert
+@item @t{vi-insert} (unbound) (@t{i}) (unbound)
+Enter insert mode.
+
+@tindex vi-insert-bol
+@item @t{vi-insert-bol} (unbound) (@t{I}) (unbound)
+Move to the first non-blank character on the line and enter insert mode.
+
+@tindex vi-join
+@item @t{vi-join} (@t{^X^J}) (@t{J}) (unbound)
+Join the current line with the next one.
+
+@tindex kill-line
+@item @t{kill-line} (@t{^K}) (unbound) (unbound)
+Kill from the cursor to the end of the line.
+If already on the end of the line, kill the newline character.
+
+@tindex vi-kill-line
+@item @t{vi-kill-line} (unbound) (unbound) (@t{^U})
+Kill from the cursor back to wherever insert mode was last entered.
+
+@tindex vi-kill-eol
+@item @t{vi-kill-eol} (unbound) (@t{D}) (unbound)
+Kill from the cursor to the end of the line.
+
+@tindex kill-region
+@item @t{kill-region}
+Kill from the cursor to the mark.
+
+@tindex kill-buffer
+@item @t{kill-buffer} (@t{^X^K}) (unbound) (unbound)
+Kill the entire buffer.
+
+@tindex kill-whole-line
+@item @t{kill-whole-line} (@t{^U}) (unbound) (unbound)
+Kill the current line.
+
+@tindex vi-match-bracket
+@item @t{vi-match-bracket} (@t{^X^B}) (@t{%}) (unbound)
+Move to the bracket character (one of @t{@{@}}, @t{()} or @t{[]}) that
+matches the one under the cursor.
+If the cursor is not on a bracket character, move forward without going
+past the end of the line to find one, and then go to the matching bracket.
+
+@tindex vi-open-line-above
+@item @t{vi-open-line-above} (unbound) (@t{O}) (unbound)
+Open a line above the cursor and enter insert mode.
+
+@tindex vi-open-line-below
+@item @t{vi-open-line-below} (unbound) (@t{o}) (unbound)
+Open a line below the cursor and enter insert mode.
+
+@tindex vi-oper-swap-case
+@item @t{vi-oper-swap-case} (unbound) (@t{g~}) (unbound)
+Read a movement command from the keyboard, and swap
+the case of all characters
+from the cursor position to the endpoint of the movement.
+If the movement command is @t{vi-oper-swap-case},
+swap the case of all characters on the current line.
+
+@tindex overwrite-mode
+@item @t{overwrite-mode} (@t{^X^O}) (unbound) (unbound)
+Toggle between overwrite mode and insert mode.
+
+@tindex vi-put-before
+@item @t{vi-put-before} (unbound) (@t{P}) (unbound)
+Insert the contents of the kill buffer before the cursor.
+If the kill buffer contains a sequence of lines (as opposed to characters),
+paste it above the current line.
+
+@tindex vi-put-after
+@item @t{vi-put-after} (unbound) (@t{p}) (unbound)
+Insert the contents of the kill buffer after the cursor.
+If the kill buffer contains a sequence of lines (as opposed to characters),
+paste it below the current line.
+
+@tindex put-replace-selection
+@item @t{put-replace-selection} (unbound) (unbound) (unbound)
+Replace the contents of the current region or selection with the
+contents of the kill buffer. If the kill buffer contains a sequence of
+lines (as opposed to characters), the current line will be split by the
+pasted lines.
+
+@tindex quoted-insert
+@item @t{quoted-insert} (@t{^V}) (unbound) (unbound)
+Insert the next character typed into the buffer literally.
+An interrupt character will not be inserted.
+
+@tindex vi-quoted-insert
+@item @t{vi-quoted-insert} (unbound) (unbound) (@t{^Q ^V})
+Display a `@t{^}' at the cursor position, and
+insert the next character typed into the buffer literally.
+An interrupt character will not be inserted.
+
+@tindex quote-line
+@item @t{quote-line} (@t{ESC-'}) (unbound) (unbound)
+Quote the current line; that is, put a `@t{'}' character at the
+beginning and the end, and convert all `@t{'}' characters
+to `@t{'\@value{dsq}}'.
+
+@tindex quote-region
+@item @t{quote-region} (@t{ESC-"}) (unbound) (unbound)
+Quote the region from the cursor to the mark.
+
+@tindex vi-replace
+@item @t{vi-replace} (unbound) (@t{R}) (unbound)
+Enter overwrite mode.
+
+@tindex vi-repeat-change
+@item @t{vi-repeat-change} (unbound) (@t{.}) (unbound)
+Repeat the last vi mode text modification.
+If a count was used with the modification, it is remembered.
+If a count is given to this command, it overrides the remembered count,
+and is remembered for future uses of this command.
+The cut buffer specification is similarly remembered.
+
+@tindex vi-replace-chars
+@item @t{vi-replace-chars} (unbound) (@t{r}) (unbound)
+Replace the character under the cursor with a character
+read from the keyboard.
+
+@tindex self-insert
+@item @t{self-insert} (printable characters) (unbound) (printable characters and some control characters)
+Insert a character into the buffer at the cursor position.
+
+@tindex self-insert-unmeta
+@item @t{self-insert-unmeta} (@t{ESC-^I ESC-^J ESC-^M}) (unbound) (unbound)
+Insert a character into the buffer after stripping the meta bit
+and converting ^M to ^J.
+
+@tindex vi-substitute
+@item @t{vi-substitute} (unbound) (@t{s}) (unbound)
+Substitute the next character(s).
+
+@tindex vi-swap-case
+@item @t{vi-swap-case} (unbound) (@t{~}) (unbound)
+Swap the case of the character under the cursor and move past it.
+
+@tindex transpose-chars
+@item @t{transpose-chars} (@t{^T}) (unbound) (unbound)
+Exchange the two characters to the left of the
+cursor if at end of line, else exchange the
+character under the cursor with the character
+to the left.
+
+@tindex transpose-words
+@item @t{transpose-words} (@t{ESC-T ESC-t}) (unbound) (unbound)
+Exchange the current word with the one before it.
+
+@noindent
+With a positive numeric argument @emph{N}, the word around the cursor, or
+following it if the cursor is between words, is transposed with the
+preceding @emph{N} words. The cursor is put at the end of the resulting
+group of words.
+
+@noindent
+With a negative numeric argument @emph{-N}, the effect is the same as using
+a positive argument @emph{N} except that the original cursor position is
+retained, regardless of how the words are rearranged.
+
+@tindex vi-unindent
+@item @t{vi-unindent} (unbound) (@t{<}) (unbound)
+Unindent a number of lines.
+
+@tindex vi-up-case
+@item @t{vi-up-case} (unbound) (@t{gU}) (unbound)
+Read a movement command from the keyboard, and convert all characters
+from the cursor position to the endpoint of the movement to lowercase.
+If the movement command is @t{vi-up-case}, swap the case of all
+characters on the current line.
+
+@tindex up-case-word
+@item @t{up-case-word} (@t{ESC-U ESC-u}) (unbound) (unbound)
+Convert the current word to all caps and move past it.
+
+@tindex yank
+@item @t{yank} (@t{^Y}) (unbound) (unbound)
+Insert the contents of the kill buffer at the cursor position.
+
+@tindex yank-pop
+@item @t{yank-pop} (@t{ESC-y}) (unbound) (unbound)
+Remove the text just yanked, rotate the kill-ring (the history of
+previously killed text) and yank the new top. Only works following
+@t{yank}, @t{vi-put-before}, @t{vi-put-after} or @t{yank-pop}.
+
+@tindex vi-yank
+@item @t{vi-yank} (unbound) (@t{y}) (unbound)
+Read a movement command from the keyboard, and copy the region
+from the cursor position to the endpoint of the movement
+into the kill buffer.
+If the command is @t{vi-yank}, copy the current line.
+
+@tindex vi-yank-whole-line
+@item @t{vi-yank-whole-line} (unbound) (@t{Y}) (unbound)
+Copy the current line into the kill buffer.
+
+@tindex vi-yank-eol
+@item @t{vi-yank-eol}
+Copy the region from the cursor position to the end of the line
+into the kill buffer.
+Arguably, this is what Y should do in vi, but it isn't what it actually does.
+
+@end table
+@node Arguments, Completion, Modifying Text, Zle Widgets
+
+@subsection Arguments
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@tindex digit-argument
+@item @t{digit-argument} (@t{ESC-0}..@t{ESC-9}) (@t{1}-@t{9}) (unbound)
+Start a new numeric argument, or add to the current one.
+See also @t{vi-digit-or-beginning-of-line}. This only works if bound to a
+key sequence ending in a decimal digit.
+
+@noindent
+Inside a widget function, a call to this function treats the last key of
+the key sequence which called the widget as the digit.
+
+@tindex neg-argument
+@item @t{neg-argument} (@t{ESC-}@t{-}) (unbound) (unbound)
+Changes the sign of the following argument.
+
+@tindex universal-argument
+@item @t{universal-argument}
+Multiply the argument of the next command by 4. Alternatively, if
+this command is followed by an integer (positive or negative), use
+that as the argument for the next command. Thus digits cannot be
+repeated using this command. For example, if this command occurs
+twice, followed immediately by @t{forward-char}, move forward sixteen
+spaces; if instead it is followed by @t{-2}, then @t{forward-char},
+move backward two spaces.
+
+@noindent
+Inside a widget function, if passed an argument, i.e. `@t{zle
+universal-argument} @var{num}', the numeric argument will be set to
+@var{num}; this is equivalent to `@t{NUMERIC=}@var{num}'.
+
+@tindex argument-base
+@item @t{argument-base}
+Use the existing numeric argument as a numeric base, which must be in the
+range 2 to 36 inclusive. Subsequent use of @t{digit-argument} and
+@t{universal-argument} will input a new numeric argument in the given base.
+The usual hexadecimal convention is used: the letter @t{a} or @t{A}
+corresponds to 10, and so on. Arguments in bases requiring digits from 10
+upwards are more conveniently input with @t{universal-argument}, since
+@t{ESC-a} etc. are not usually bound to @t{digit-argument}.
+
+@noindent
+The function can be used with a command argument inside a user-defined
+widget. The following code sets the base to 16 and lets the user input a
+hexadecimal argument until a key out of the digit range is typed:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zle argument-base 16
+zle universal-argument
+@end example
+
+@end table
+@node Completion, Miscellaneous, Arguments, Zle Widgets
+
+@subsection Completion
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@tindex accept-and-menu-complete
+@item @t{accept-and-menu-complete}
+In a menu completion, insert the current completion into the buffer,
+and advance to the next possible completion.
+
+@tindex complete-word
+@item @t{complete-word}
+Attempt completion on the current word.
+
+@tindex delete-char-or-list
+@item @t{delete-char-or-list} (@t{^D}) (unbound) (unbound)
+Delete the character under the cursor. If the cursor
+is at the end of the line, list possible completions for the
+current word.
+
+@tindex expand-cmd-path
+@item @t{expand-cmd-path}
+Expand the current command to its full pathname.
+
+@tindex expand-or-complete
+@item @t{expand-or-complete} (@t{TAB}) (unbound) (@t{TAB})
+Attempt shell expansion on the current word.
+If that fails,
+attempt completion.
+
+@tindex expand-or-complete-prefix
+@item @t{expand-or-complete-prefix}
+Attempt shell expansion on the current word up to cursor.
+
+@tindex expand-history
+@item @t{expand-history} (@t{ESC-space ESC-!}) (unbound) (unbound)
+Perform history expansion on the edit buffer.
+
+@tindex expand-word
+@item @t{expand-word} (@t{^X*}) (unbound) (unbound)
+Attempt shell expansion on the current word.
+
+@tindex list-choices
+@item @t{list-choices} (@t{ESC-^D}) (@t{^D =}) (@t{^D})
+List possible completions for the current word.
+
+@tindex list-expand
+@item @t{list-expand} (@t{^Xg ^XG}) (@t{^G}) (@t{^G})
+List the expansion of the current word.
+
+@tindex magic-space
+@item @t{magic-space}
+Perform history expansion and insert a space into the
+buffer. This is intended to be bound to space.
+
+@tindex menu-complete
+@pindex MENU_COMPLETE, use of
+@item @t{menu-complete}
+Like @t{complete-word}, except that menu completion is used.
+See the @t{MENU_COMPLETE} option.
+
+@tindex menu-expand-or-complete
+@item @t{menu-expand-or-complete}
+Like @t{expand-or-complete}, except that menu completion is used.
+
+@tindex reverse-menu-complete
+@item @t{reverse-menu-complete}
+Perform menu completion, like @t{menu-complete}, except that if
+a menu completion is already in progress, move to the @emph{previous}
+completion rather than the next.
+
+@tindex end-of-list
+@item @t{end-of-list}
+When a previous completion displayed a list below the prompt, this
+widget can be used to move the prompt below the list.
+
+@end table
+@node Miscellaneous, Text Objects, Completion, Zle Widgets
+
+@subsection Miscellaneous
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@tindex accept-and-hold
+@item @t{accept-and-hold} (@t{ESC-A ESC-a}) (unbound) (unbound)
+Push the contents of the buffer on the buffer stack
+and execute it.
+
+@tindex accept-and-infer-next-history
+@item @t{accept-and-infer-next-history}
+Execute the contents of the buffer.
+Then search the history list for a line matching the current one
+and push the event following onto the buffer stack.
+
+@tindex accept-line
+@item @t{accept-line} (@t{^J ^M}) (@t{^J ^M}) (@t{^J ^M})
+Finish editing the buffer. Normally this causes the buffer to be
+executed as a shell command.
+
+@tindex accept-line-and-down-history
+@item @t{accept-line-and-down-history} (@t{^O}) (unbound) (unbound)
+Execute the current line, and push the next history
+event on the buffer stack.
+
+@tindex auto-suffix-remove
+@item @t{auto-suffix-remove}
+If the previous action added a suffix (space, slash, etc.) to the word on
+the command line, remove it. Otherwise do nothing. Removing the suffix
+ends any active menu completion or menu selection.
+
+@noindent
+This widget is intended to be called from user-defined widgets to enforce
+a desired suffix-removal behavior.
+
+@tindex auto-suffix-retain
+@item @t{auto-suffix-retain}
+If the previous action added a suffix (space, slash, etc.) to the word on
+the command line, force it to be preserved. Otherwise do nothing.
+Retaining the suffix ends any active menu completion or menu selection.
+
+@noindent
+This widget is intended to be called from user-defined widgets to enforce
+a desired suffix-preservation behavior.
+
+@tindex beep
+@item @t{beep}
+Beep, unless the @t{BEEP} option is unset.
+
+@tindex bracketed-paste
+@item @t{bracketed-paste}
+This widget is invoked when text is pasted to the terminal emulator. It
+is not intended to be bound to actual keys but instead to the special
+sequence generated by the terminal emulator when text is pasted.
+
+@noindent
+When invoked interactively, the pasted text is inserted to the buffer
+and placed in the cutbuffer.
+If a numeric argument is given, shell quoting will be applied to the
+pasted text before it is inserted.
+
+@noindent
+When a named buffer is specified with @t{vi-set-buffer} (@t{"x}),
+the pasted text is stored in that named buffer but not inserted.
+
+@noindent
+When called from a widget function as `@t{bracketed-paste} @var{name}`, the
+pasted text is assigned to the variable @var{name} and no other processing is
+done.
+
+@noindent
+See also the @t{zle_bracketed_paste} parameter.
+
+@tindex vi-cmd-mode
+@item @t{vi-cmd-mode} (@t{^X^V}) (unbound) (@t{^[})
+Enter command mode; that is, select the `@t{vicmd}' keymap.
+Yes, this is bound by default in emacs mode.
+
+@tindex vi-caps-lock-panic
+@item @t{vi-caps-lock-panic}
+Hang until any lowercase key is pressed.
+This is for vi users without the mental capacity to keep
+track of their caps lock key (like the author).
+
+@tindex clear-screen
+@item @t{clear-screen} (@t{^L ESC-^L}) (@t{^L}) (@t{^L})
+Clear the screen and redraw the prompt.
+
+@tindex deactivate-region
+@item @t{deactivate-region}
+Make the current region inactive. This disables vim-style visual
+selection mode if it is active.
+
+@tindex describe-key-briefly
+@item @t{describe-key-briefly}
+Reads a key sequence, then prints the function bound to that sequence.
+
+@tindex exchange-point-and-mark
+@item @t{exchange-point-and-mark} (@t{^X^X}) (unbound) (unbound)
+Exchange the cursor position (point) with the position of the mark.
+Unless a negative numeric argument is given, the region between
+point and mark is activated so that it can be highlighted.
+If a zero numeric argument is given, the region is activated but
+point and mark are not swapped.
+
+@tindex execute-named-cmd
+@item @t{execute-named-cmd} (@t{ESC-x}) (@t{:}) (unbound)
+Read the name of an editor command and execute it. Aliasing this
+widget with `@t{zle -A}' or replacing it with `@t{zle -N}' has no
+effect when interpreting key bindings, but `@t{zle execute-named-cmd}'
+will invoke such an alias or replacement.
+
+@noindent
+A restricted set of editing functions is available in the
+mini-buffer. Keys are looked up in the special
+@t{command} keymap, and if not found there in the main keymap.
+An interrupt signal, as defined by the stty setting, will
+abort the function. Note that the following always
+perform the same task within the @t{executed-named-cmd} environment and
+cannot be replaced by user defined widgets, nor can the set of functions
+be extended. The allowed functions are:
+@t{backward-delete-char},
+@t{vi-backward-delete-char},
+@t{clear-screen},
+@t{redisplay},
+@t{quoted-insert},
+@t{vi-quoted-insert},
+@t{backward-kill-word},
+@t{vi-backward-kill-word},
+@t{kill-whole-line},
+@t{vi-kill-line},
+@t{backward-kill-line},
+@t{list-choices},
+@t{delete-char-or-list},
+@t{complete-word},
+@t{accept-line},
+@t{expand-or-complete} and
+@t{expand-or-complete-prefix}.
+
+@noindent
+@t{kill-region} kills the last word,
+and vi-cmd-mode is treated the same as accept-line.
+The space and tab characters, if not bound to one of
+these functions, will complete the name and then list the
+possibilities if the @t{AUTO_LIST} option is set.
+Any other character that is not bound to @t{self-insert} or
+@t{self-insert-unmeta} will beep and be ignored.
+The bindings of the current insert mode will be used.
+
+@noindent
+Currently this command may not be redefined or called by name.
+
+@tindex execute-last-named-cmd
+@item @t{execute-last-named-cmd} (@t{ESC-z}) (unbound) (unbound)
+Redo the last function executed with @t{execute-named-cmd}.
+
+@noindent
+Like @t{execute-named-cmd}, this command may not be redefined,
+but it may be called by name.
+
+@tindex get-line
+@item @t{get-line} (@t{ESC-G ESC-g}) (unbound) (unbound)
+Pop the top line off the buffer stack and insert it at the
+cursor position.
+
+@tindex pound-insert
+@item @t{pound-insert} (unbound) (@t{#}) (unbound)
+If there is no # character at the beginning of the buffer,
+add one to the beginning of each line.
+If there is one, remove a # from each line that has one.
+In either case, accept the current line.
+The @t{INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS} option must be set
+for this to have any usefulness.
+
+@tindex vi-pound-insert
+@item @t{vi-pound-insert}
+If there is no # character at the beginning of the current line,
+add one. If there is one, remove it.
+The @t{INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS} option must be set
+for this to have any usefulness.
+
+@tindex push-input
+@item @t{push-input}
+Push the entire current multiline construct onto the buffer stack and
+return to the top-level (@t{PS1}) prompt.
+If the current parser construct is only a single line, this is exactly
+like @t{push-line}.
+Next time the editor starts up or is popped with @t{get-line}, the
+construct will be popped off the top of the buffer stack and loaded
+into the editing buffer.
+
+@tindex push-line
+@item @t{push-line} (@t{^Q ESC-Q ESC-q}) (unbound) (unbound)
+Push the current buffer onto the buffer stack and clear
+the buffer.
+Next time the editor starts up, the buffer will be popped
+off the top of the buffer stack and loaded into the editing
+buffer.
+
+@tindex push-line-or-edit
+@item @t{push-line-or-edit}
+At the top-level (@t{PS1}) prompt, equivalent to @t{push-line}.
+At a secondary (@t{PS2}) prompt, move the entire current multiline
+construct into the editor buffer.
+The latter is equivalent to @t{push-input} followed by @t{get-line}.
+
+@tindex read-command
+@item @t{read-command}
+Only useful from a user-defined widget. A keystroke is read just as in
+normal operation, but instead of the command being executed the name
+of the command that would be executed is stored in the shell parameter
+@t{REPLY}. This can be used as the argument of a future @t{zle}
+command. If the key sequence is not bound, status 1 is returned;
+typically, however, @t{REPLY} is set to @t{undefined-key} to indicate
+a useless key sequence.
+
+@tindex recursive-edit
+@item @t{recursive-edit}
+Only useful from a user-defined widget. At this point in the function,
+the editor regains control until one of the standard widgets which would
+normally cause zle to exit (typically an @t{accept-line} caused by
+hitting the return key) is executed. Instead, control returns to the
+user-defined widget. The status returned is non-zero if the return was
+caused by an error, but the function still continues executing and hence
+may tidy up. This makes it safe for the user-defined widget to alter
+the command line or key bindings temporarily.
+
+@noindent
+The following widget, @t{caps-lock}, serves as an example.
+
+@noindent
+@example
+self-insert-ucase() @{
+ LBUFFER+=$@{(U)KEYS[-1]@}
+@}
+
+integer stat
+
+zle -N self-insert self-insert-ucase
+zle -A caps-lock save-caps-lock
+zle -A accept-line caps-lock
+
+zle recursive-edit
+stat=$?
+
+zle -A .self-insert self-insert
+zle -A save-caps-lock caps-lock
+zle -D save-caps-lock
+
+(( stat )) && zle send-break
+
+return $stat
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+This causes typed letters to be inserted capitalised until either
+@t{accept-line} (i.e. typically the return key) is typed or the
+@t{caps-lock} widget is invoked again; the later is handled by saving
+the old definition of @t{caps-lock} as @t{save-caps-lock} and then
+rebinding it to invoke @t{accept-line}. Note that an error from the
+recursive edit is detected as a non-zero return status and propagated by
+using the @t{send-break} widget.
+
+@tindex redisplay
+@item @t{redisplay} (unbound) (@t{^R}) (@t{^R})
+Redisplays the edit buffer.
+
+@tindex reset-prompt
+@item @t{reset-prompt} (unbound) (unbound) (unbound)
+Force the prompts on both the left and right of the screen to be
+re-expanded, then redisplay the edit buffer. This
+reflects changes both to the prompt variables themselves and changes
+in the expansion of the values (for example, changes in time or
+directory, or changes to the value of variables referred to by the
+prompt).
+
+@noindent
+Otherwise, the prompt is only expanded each time zle starts, and
+when the display has been interrupted by output from another part of the
+shell (such as a job notification) which causes the command line to be
+reprinted.
+
+@noindent
+@t{reset-prompt} doesn't alter the special parameter @t{LASTWIDGET}.
+
+@noindent
+
+@tindex send-break
+@item @t{send-break} (@t{^G ESC-^G}) (unbound) (unbound)
+Abort the current editor function, e.g. @t{execute-named-command}, or the
+editor itself, e.g. if you are in @t{vared}. Otherwise abort the parsing of
+the current line; in this case the aborted line is available in the shell
+variable @t{ZLE_LINE_ABORTED}. If the editor is aborted from within
+@t{vared}, the variable @t{ZLE_VARED_ABORTED} is set.
+
+@tindex run-help
+@item @t{run-help} (@t{ESC-H ESC-h}) (unbound) (unbound)
+Push the buffer onto the buffer stack, and execute the
+command `@t{run-help} @var{cmd}', where @var{cmd} is the current
+command. @t{run-help} is normally aliased to @t{man}.
+
+@tindex vi-set-buffer
+@item @t{vi-set-buffer} (unbound) (@t{"}) (unbound)
+Specify a buffer to be used in the following command.
+There are 37 buffers that can be specified:
+the 26 `named' buffers @t{"a} to @t{"z}, the `yank' buffer @t{"0},
+the nine `queued' buffers @t{"1} to @t{"9} and the `black hole' buffer
+@t{"_}. The named buffers can also be specified as @t{"A} to @t{"Z}.
+
+@noindent
+When a buffer is specified for a cut, change or yank command, the text
+concerned replaces the previous contents of the specified buffer. If
+a named buffer is specified using a capital, the newly cut text is
+appended to the buffer instead of overwriting it. When using the @t{"_}
+buffer, nothing happens. This can be useful for deleting text without
+affecting any buffers.
+
+@noindent
+If no buffer is specified for a cut or change command, @t{"1} is used, and
+the contents of @t{"1} to @t{"8} are each shifted along one buffer;
+the contents of @t{"9} is lost. If no buffer is specified for a yank
+command, @t{"0} is used. Finally, a paste command without a specified
+buffer will paste the text from the most recent command regardless of any
+buffer that might have been used with that command.
+
+@noindent
+When called from a widget function by the @t{zle} command, the buffer
+can optionally be specified with an argument. For example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zle vi-set-buffer A
+@end example
+
+@tindex vi-set-mark
+@item @t{vi-set-mark} (unbound) (@t{m}) (unbound)
+Set the specified mark at the cursor position.
+
+@tindex set-mark-command
+@item @t{set-mark-command} (@t{^@@}) (unbound) (unbound)
+Set the mark at the cursor position. If called with a negative
+numeric argument, do not set the mark but deactivate the region so that
+it is no longer highlighted (it is still usable for other purposes).
+Otherwise the region is marked as active.
+
+@tindex spell-word
+@item @t{spell-word} (@t{ESC-$ ESC-S ESC-s}) (unbound) (unbound)
+Attempt spelling correction on the current word.
+
+@tindex split-undo
+@item @t{split-undo}
+Breaks the undo sequence at the current change. This is useful in vi mode as
+changes made in insert mode are coalesced on entering command mode. Similarly,
+@t{undo} will normally revert as one all the changes made by a user-defined
+widget.
+
+@tindex undefined-key
+@item @t{undefined-key}
+This command is executed when a key sequence that is not bound to any
+command is typed. By default it beeps.
+
+@tindex undo
+@item @t{undo} (@t{^_ ^Xu ^X^U}) (@t{u}) (unbound)
+Incrementally undo the last text modification. When called from a
+user-defined widget, takes an optional argument indicating a previous state
+of the undo history as returned by the @t{UNDO_CHANGE_NO} variable;
+modifications are undone until that state is reached, subject to
+any limit imposed by the @t{UNDO_LIMIT_NO} variable.
+
+@noindent
+Note that when invoked from vi command mode, the full prior change made in
+insert mode is reverted, the changes having been merged when command mode was
+selected.
+
+@tindex redo
+@item @t{redo} (unbound) (@t{^R}) (unbound)
+Incrementally redo undone text modifications.
+
+@tindex vi-undo-change
+@item @t{vi-undo-change} (unbound) (unbound) (unbound)
+Undo the last text modification.
+If repeated, redo the modification.
+
+@tindex visual-mode
+@item @t{visual-mode} (unbound) (@t{v}) (unbound)
+Toggle vim-style visual selection mode. If line-wise visual mode is
+currently enabled then it is changed to being character-wise. If used
+following an operator, it forces the subsequent movement command to be
+treated as a character-wise movement.
+
+@tindex visual-line-mode
+@item @t{visual-line-mode} (unbound) (@t{V}) (unbound)
+Toggle vim-style line-wise visual selection mode. If character-wise
+visual mode is currently enabled then it is changed to being line-wise. If used
+following an operator, it forces the subsequent movement command to be
+treated as a line-wise movement.
+
+@tindex what-cursor-position
+@item @t{what-cursor-position} (@t{^X=}) (@t{ga}) (unbound)
+Print the character under the cursor, its code as an octal, decimal and
+hexadecimal number, the current cursor position within the buffer and the
+column of the cursor in the current line.
+
+@tindex where-is
+@item @t{where-is}
+Read the name of an editor command and print the listing of key
+sequences that invoke the specified command.
+A restricted set of editing functions is available in the
+mini-buffer. Keys are looked up in the special
+@t{command} keymap, and if not found there in the main keymap.
+
+@tindex which-command
+@item @t{which-command} (@t{ESC-?}) (unbound) (unbound)
+Push the buffer onto the buffer stack, and execute the
+command `@t{which-command} @var{cmd}'. where @var{cmd} is the current
+command. @t{which-command} is normally aliased to @t{whence}.
+
+@tindex vi-digit-or-beginning-of-line
+@item @t{vi-digit-or-beginning-of-line} (unbound) (@t{0}) (unbound)
+If the last command executed was a digit as part of an argument,
+continue the argument. Otherwise, execute vi-beginning-of-line.
+
+@end table
+@node Text Objects, , Miscellaneous, Zle Widgets
+
+@subsection Text Objects
+@noindent
+@cindex text objects
+Text objects are commands that can be used to select a block of text
+according to some criteria. They are a feature of the vim text editor
+and so are primarily intended for use with vi operators or from visual
+selection mode. However, they can also be used from vi-insert or emacs
+mode. Key bindings listed below apply to the @t{viopp} and @t{visual}
+keymaps.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@tindex select-a-blank-word
+@item @t{select-a-blank-word} (@t{aW})
+Select a word including adjacent blanks, where a word is defined as a
+series of non-blank characters. With a numeric argument, multiple words
+will be selected.
+
+@tindex select-a-shell-word
+@item @t{select-a-shell-word} (@t{aa})
+Select the current command argument applying the normal rules for
+quoting.
+
+@tindex select-a-word
+@item @t{select-a-word} (@t{aw})
+Select a word including adjacent blanks, using the normal vi-style word
+definition. With a numeric argument, multiple words will be selected.
+
+@tindex select-in-blank-word
+@item @t{select-in-blank-word} (@t{iW})
+Select a word, where a word is defined as a series of non-blank
+characters. With a numeric argument, multiple words will be selected.
+
+@tindex select-in-shell-word
+@item @t{select-in-shell-word} (@t{ia})
+Select the current command argument applying the normal rules for
+quoting. If the argument begins and ends with matching quote characters,
+these are not included in the selection.
+
+@tindex select-in-word
+@item @t{select-in-word} (@t{iw})
+Select a word, using the normal vi-style word definition. With a numeric
+argument, multiple words will be selected.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+@node Character Highlighting, , Zle Widgets, Zsh Line Editor
+
+@section Character Highlighting
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+@vindex zle_highlight, setting
+The line editor has the ability to highlight characters or regions
+of the line that have a particular significance. This is controlled
+by the array parameter @t{zle_highlight}, if it has been set by the user.
+
+@noindent
+If the parameter contains the single entry @t{none} all highlighting
+is turned off. Note the parameter is still expected to be an array.
+
+@noindent
+Otherwise each entry of the array should consist of a word indicating a
+context for highlighting, then a colon, then a comma-separated list of
+the types of highlighting to apply in that context.
+
+@noindent
+The contexts available for highlighting are the following:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@cindex region, highlighting
+@cindex highlighting, region
+@item @t{default}
+Any text within the command line not affected by any other highlighting.
+Text outside the editable area of the command line is not affected.
+
+@item @t{isearch}
+When one of the incremental history search widgets is active, the
+area of the command line matched by the search string or pattern.
+
+@item @t{region}
+The currently selected text. In emacs terminology, this is referred to as
+the region and is bounded by the cursor (point) and the mark. The region
+is only highlighted if it is active, which is the case after the mark
+is modified with @t{set-mark-command} or @t{exchange-point-and-mark}.
+Note that whether or not the region is active has no effect on its
+use within emacs style widgets, it simply determines whether it is
+highlighted. In vi mode, the region corresponds to selected text in
+visual mode.
+
+@cindex special characters, highlighting
+@cindex highlighting, special characters
+@item @t{special}
+Individual characters that have no direct printable
+representation but are shown in a special manner by the line editor.
+These characters are described below.
+
+@cindex completion removable suffix, highlighting
+@cindex suffix, highlighting removable, in completion
+@cindex removable suffix, highlighting in completion
+@item @t{suffix}
+This context is used in completion for characters that are
+marked as suffixes that will be removed if the completion ends
+at that point, the most obvious example being a slash (@t{/}) after
+a directory name. Note that suffix removal is configurable; the
+circumstances under which the suffix will be removed may differ
+for different completions.
+
+@item @t{paste}
+Following a command to paste text, the characters that were inserted.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+When @t{region_highlight} is set, the contexts that describe a region ---
+@t{isearch}, @t{region}, @t{suffix}, and @t{paste} ---
+are applied first, then @t{region_highlight} is applied, then the remaining
+@t{zle_highlight} contexts are applied. If a particular character is
+affected by multiple specifications, the last specification wins.
+
+@noindent
+@t{zle_highlight} may contain additional fields for controlling how
+terminal sequences to change colours are output. Each of the following is
+followed by a colon and a string in the same form as for key bindings.
+This will not be necessary for the vast majority of terminals as the
+defaults shown in parentheses are widely used.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@cindex escape sequences, terminal, for highlighting
+@cindex terminal escape sequences for highlighting
+@item @t{fg_start_code} (@t{\e[3})
+The start of the escape sequence for the foreground colour.
+This is followed by one to three ASCII digits representing the colour.
+Only used for palette colors, i.e. not 24-bit colors specified via a
+color triplet.
+
+@item @t{fg_default_code} (@t{9})
+The number to use instead of the colour to reset the default foreground
+colour.
+
+@item @t{fg_end_code} (@t{m})
+The end of the escape sequence for the foreground colour.
+
+@item @t{bg_start_code} (@t{\e[4})
+The start of the escape sequence for the background colour.
+See @t{fg_start_code} above.
+
+@item @t{bg_default_code} (@t{9})
+The number to use instead of the colour to reset the default
+background colour.
+
+@item @t{bg_end_code} (@t{m})
+The end of the escape sequence for the background colour.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+The available types of highlighting are the following. Note that
+not all types of highlighting are available on all terminals:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{none}
+No highlighting is applied to the given context. It is not useful for
+this to appear with other types of highlighting; it is used to override
+a default.
+
+@item @t{fg=}@var{colour}
+The foreground colour should be set to @var{colour}, a decimal integer,
+the name of one of the eight most widely-supported colours or as a
+`@t{#}' followed by an RGB triplet in hexadecimal format.
+
+@noindent
+Not all terminals support this and, of those that do, not all provide
+facilities to test the support, hence the user should decide based on the
+terminal type. Most terminals support the colours @t{black}, @t{red},
+@t{green}, @t{yellow}, @t{blue}, @t{magenta}, @t{cyan} and @t{white},
+which can be set by name. In addition. @t{default} may be used to
+set the terminal's default foreground colour. Abbreviations are allowed;
+@t{b} or @t{bl} selects black. Some terminals may generate additional
+colours if the @t{bold} attribute is also present.
+
+@noindent
+On recent terminals and on systems with an up-to-date terminal database the
+number of colours supported may be tested by the command `@t{echotc
+Co}'; if this succeeds, it indicates a limit on the number of colours which
+will be enforced by the line editor. The number of colours is in any case
+limited to 256 (i.e. the range 0 to 255).
+
+@noindent
+Some modern terminal emulators have support for 24-bit true colour (16
+million colours). In this case, the hex triplet format can be used. This
+consists of a `@t{#}' followed by either a three or six digit hexadecimal
+number describing the red, green and blue components of the colour. Hex
+triplets can also be used with 88 and 256 colour terminals via the
+@t{zsh/nearcolor} module (see @ref{The zsh/nearcolor Module}).
+
+@noindent
+Colour is also known as color.
+
+@item @t{bg=}@var{colour}
+The background colour should be set to @var{colour}.
+This works similarly to the foreground colour, except the background is
+not usually affected by the bold attribute.
+
+@item @t{bold}
+The characters in the given context are shown in a bold font.
+Not all terminals distinguish bold fonts.
+
+@item @t{standout}
+The characters in the given context are shown in the terminal's standout
+mode. The actual effect is specific to the terminal; on many terminals it
+is inverse video. On some such terminals, where the cursor does not blink
+it appears with standout mode negated, making it less than clear where
+the cursor actually is. On such terminals one of the other effects
+may be preferable for highlighting the region and matched search string.
+
+@item @t{underline}
+The characters in the given context are shown underlined. Some
+terminals show the foreground in a different colour instead; in this
+case whitespace will not be highlighted.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+The characters described above as `special' are as follows. The
+formatting described here is used irrespective of whether the characters
+are highlighted:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item ASCII control characters
+Control characters in the ASCII range are shown as
+`@t{^}' followed by the base character.
+
+@item Unprintable multibyte characters
+This item applies to control characters not in the ASCII range,
+plus other characters as follows. If the @t{MULTIBYTE} option is in
+effect, multibyte characters not in the ASCII character set that are
+reported as having zero width are treated as combining characters when the
+option @t{COMBINING_CHARS} is on. If the option is off, or if a character
+appears where a combining character is not valid, the character
+is treated as unprintable.
+
+@noindent
+Unprintable multibyte characters are shown as a hexadecimal number between
+angle brackets. The number is the code point of the character in the wide
+character set; this may or may not be Unicode, depending on the operating
+system.
+
+@item Invalid multibyte characters
+If the @t{MULTIBYTE} option is in effect, any sequence of one or more
+bytes that does not form a valid character in the current character
+set is treated as a series of bytes each shown as a special character.
+This case can be distinguished from other unprintable characters
+as the bytes are represented as two hexadecimal digits between angle
+brackets, as distinct from the four or eight digits that are used for
+unprintable characters that are nonetheless valid in the current
+character set.
+
+@noindent
+Not all systems support this: for it to work, the system's representation of
+wide characters must be code values from the Universal Character Set,
+as defined by IS0 10646 (also known as Unicode).
+
+@item Wrapped double-width characters
+When a double-width character appears in the final column of a line, it
+is instead shown on the next line. The empty space left in the original
+position is highlighted as a special character.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+If @t{zle_highlight} is not set or no value applies to a particular
+context, the defaults applied are equivalent to
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zle_highlight=(region:standout special:standout
+suffix:bold isearch:underline paste:standout)
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+i.e. both the region and special characters are shown in standout mode.
+
+@noindent
+Within widgets, arbitrary regions may be highlighted by setting the
+special array parameter @t{region_highlight}; see
+@ref{Zle Widgets}.
+
+@noindent
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/compwid.yo
+@node Completion Widgets, Completion System, Zsh Line Editor, Top
+
+@chapter Completion Widgets
+@noindent
+@cindex completion, widgets
+@cindex completion, programmable
+@cindex completion, controlling
+
+@section Description
+@noindent
+The shell's programmable completion mechanism can be manipulated in two
+ways; here the low-level features supporting the newer, function-based
+mechanism are defined. A complete set of shell functions based on these
+features is described in
+the next chapter, @ref{Completion System},
+and users with no interest in adding to that system (or, potentially,
+writing their own --- see dictionary entry for `hubris') should skip
+the current section. The older system based on the @t{compctl} builtin
+command is described in
+@ref{Completion Using compctl}.
+
+@noindent
+Completion widgets are defined by the @t{-C} option to the @t{zle}
+builtin command provided by the @t{zsh/zle} module (see
+@ref{The zsh/zle Module}). For example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zle -C complete expand-or-complete completer
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+defines a widget named `@t{complete}'. The second argument is the name
+of any of the builtin widgets that handle completions:
+@t{complete-word}, @t{expand-or-complete},
+@t{expand-or-complete-prefix}, @t{menu-complete},
+@t{menu-expand-or-complete}, @t{reverse-menu-complete},
+@t{list-choices}, or @t{delete-char-or-list}. Note that this will still
+work even if the widget in question has been re-bound.
+
+@noindent
+When this newly defined widget is bound to a key
+using the @t{bindkey} builtin command defined in the @t{zsh/zle} module
+(@ref{Zsh Line Editor}), typing that key will call the shell function `@t{completer}'. This
+function is responsible for generating the possible matches using the
+builtins described below. As with other ZLE widgets, the function is
+called with its standard input closed.
+
+@noindent
+Once the function returns, the completion code takes over control again
+and treats the matches in the same manner as the specified builtin
+widget, in this case @t{expand-or-complete}.
+
+@noindent
+@menu
+* Completion Special Parameters::
+* Completion Builtin Commands::
+* Completion Condition Codes::
+* Completion Matching Control::
+* Completion Widget Example::
+@end menu
+
+@noindent
+@node Completion Special Parameters, Completion Builtin Commands, , Completion Widgets
+
+@section Completion Special Parameters
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+The parameters @t{ZLE_REMOVE_SUFFIX_CHARS} and @t{ZLE_SPACE_SUFFIX_CHARS}
+are used by the completion mechanism, but are not special. See
+@ref{Parameters Used By The Shell}.
+
+@noindent
+Inside completion widgets, and any functions called from them, some
+parameters have special meaning; outside these functions they are not
+special to the shell in any way. These parameters are used to pass
+information between the completion code and the completion widget. Some of
+the builtin commands and the condition codes use or change the current
+values of these parameters. Any existing values will be hidden during
+execution of completion widgets; except for @t{compstate}, the parameters
+are reset on each function exit (including nested function calls from
+within the completion widget) to the values they had when the function was
+entered.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@vindex CURRENT
+@item @t{CURRENT}
+This is the number of the current word, i.e. the word the cursor is
+currently on in the @t{words} array. Note that this value is only
+correct if the @t{ksharrays} option is not set.
+
+@vindex IPREFIX
+@item @t{IPREFIX}
+Initially this will be set to the empty string. This parameter functions
+like @t{PREFIX}; it contains a string which precedes the one in @t{PREFIX}
+and is not considered part of the list of matches. Typically, a string is
+transferred from the beginning of @t{PREFIX} to the end of @t{IPREFIX}, for
+example:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+IPREFIX=$@{PREFIX%%\=*@}=
+PREFIX=$@{PREFIX#*=@}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+causes the part of the prefix up to and including the first equal sign not
+to be treated as part of a matched string. This can be done automatically
+by the @t{compset} builtin, see below.
+
+@vindex ISUFFIX
+@item @t{ISUFFIX}
+As @t{IPREFIX}, but for a suffix that should not be considered part
+of the matches; note that the @t{ISUFFIX} string follows the @t{SUFFIX}
+string.
+
+@vindex PREFIX
+@item @t{PREFIX}
+Initially this will be set to the part of the current word from the
+beginning of the word up to the position of the cursor; it may be altered
+to give a common prefix for all matches.
+
+@vindex QIPREFIX
+@item @t{QIPREFIX}
+This parameter is read-only and contains the quoted string up to the
+word being completed. E.g. when completing `@t{"foo}', this parameter
+contains the double quote. If the @t{-q} option of @t{compset} is used
+(see below), and the original string was `@t{"foo bar}' with the
+cursor on the `@t{bar}', this parameter contains `@t{"foo }'.
+
+@vindex QISUFFIX
+@item @t{QISUFFIX}
+Like @t{QIPREFIX}, but containing the suffix.
+
+@vindex SUFFIX
+@item @t{SUFFIX}
+Initially this will be set to the part of the current word from the
+cursor position to the end; it may be altered to give a common suffix for
+all matches. It is most useful when the option @t{COMPLETE_IN_WORD} is
+set, as otherwise the whole word on the command line is treated as a
+prefix.
+
+@vindex compstate
+@cindex completion widgets, examining and setting state in
+@item @t{compstate}
+This is an associative array with various keys and values that the
+completion code uses to exchange information with the completion widget.
+The keys are:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@vindex all_quotes, compstate
+@item @t{all_quotes}
+The @t{-q} option of the @t{compset} builtin command (see below)
+allows a quoted string to be broken into separate words; if the cursor is
+on one of those words, that word will be completed, possibly invoking
+`@t{compset -q}' recursively. With this key it is possible to test the
+types of quoted strings which are currently broken into parts in this
+fashion. Its value contains one character for each quoting level. The
+characters are a single quote or a double quote for strings quoted with
+these characters, a dollars sign for strings quoted with
+@t{$'}@var{...}@t{'} and a backslash for strings not starting with a
+quote character. The first character in the value always corresponds to the
+innermost quoting level.
+
+@vindex context, compstate
+@item @t{context}
+This will be set by the completion code to the overall context
+in which completion is attempted. Possible values are:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{array_value}
+when completing inside the value of an array parameter assignment; in
+this case the @t{words} array contains the words inside the parentheses.
+
+@item @t{brace_parameter}
+when completing the name of a parameter in a parameter expansion beginning
+with @t{$@{}. This context will also be set when completing parameter
+flags following @t{$@{(}; the full command line argument is presented
+and the handler must test the value to be completed to ascertain that
+this is the case.
+
+@item @t{assign_parameter}
+when completing the name of a parameter in a parameter assignment.
+
+@item @t{command}
+when completing for a normal command (either in command position or for
+an argument of the command).
+
+@item @t{condition}
+when completing inside a `@t{[[}...@t{]]}' conditional expression; in
+this case the @t{words} array contains only the words inside the
+conditional expression.
+
+@item @t{math}
+when completing in a mathematical environment such as a
+`@t{((}...@t{))}' construct.
+
+@item @t{parameter}
+when completing the name of a parameter in a parameter expansion beginning
+with @t{$} but not @t{$@{}.
+
+@item @t{redirect}
+when completing after a redirection operator.
+
+@item @t{subscript}
+when completing inside a parameter subscript.
+
+@item @t{value}
+when completing the value of a parameter assignment.
+
+@end table
+
+@vindex exact, compstate
+@item @t{exact}
+Controls the behaviour when the @t{REC_EXACT} option is set. It will be
+set to @t{accept} if an exact match would be accepted, and will be unset
+otherwise.
+
+@noindent
+If it was set when at least one match equal to the string on the line
+was generated, the match is accepted.
+
+@vindex exact_string, compstate
+@item @t{exact_string}
+The string of an exact match if one was found, otherwise unset.
+
+@vindex ignored, compstate
+@item @t{ignored}
+The number of words that were ignored because they matched one of the
+patterns given with the @t{-F} option to the @t{compadd} builtin
+command.
+
+@vindex insert, compstate
+@item @t{insert}
+This controls the manner in which a match is inserted into the command
+line. On entry to the widget function, if it is unset the command line is
+not to be changed; if set to @t{unambiguous}, any prefix common to all
+matches is to be inserted; if set to @t{automenu-unambiguous}, the
+common prefix is to be inserted and the next invocation of the
+completion code may start menu completion (due to the @t{AUTO_MENU}
+option being set); if set to @t{menu} or @t{automenu} menu completion
+will be started for the matches currently generated (in the
+latter case this will happen because the @t{AUTO_MENU} is set). The
+value may also contain the string `@t{tab}' when the completion code
+would normally not really do completion, but only insert the TAB
+character.
+
+@noindent
+On exit it may be set to any of the values above (where setting it to
+the empty string is the same as unsetting it), or to a number, in which
+case the match whose number is given will be inserted into the command line.
+Negative numbers count backward from the last match (with `@t{-1}'
+selecting the last match) and out-of-range values are wrapped
+around, so that a value of zero selects the last match and a value
+one more than the maximum selects the first. Unless the value of this
+key ends in a space, the match is inserted as in a menu completion,
+i.e. without automatically appending a space.
+
+@noindent
+Both @t{menu} and @t{automenu} may also specify the number of the
+match to insert, given after a colon. For example, `@t{menu:2}' says
+to start menu completion, beginning with the second match.
+
+@noindent
+Note that a value containing the substring `@t{tab}' makes the
+matches generated be ignored and only the TAB be inserted.
+
+@noindent
+Finally, it may also be set to @t{all}, which makes all matches
+generated be inserted into the line.
+
+@vindex insert_positions, compstate
+@item @t{insert_positions}
+When the completion system inserts an unambiguous string into the
+line, there may be multiple places where characters are missing or
+where the character inserted differs from at least one match. The
+value of this key contains a colon separated list of all these
+positions, as indexes into the command line.
+
+@vindex last_prompt, compstate
+@item @t{last_prompt}
+If this is set to a non-empty string for every match added, the
+completion code will move the cursor back to the previous prompt after
+the list of completions has been displayed. Initially this is set or
+unset according to the @t{ALWAYS_LAST_PROMPT} option.
+
+@vindex list, compstate
+@item @t{list}
+This controls whether or how the list of matches will be displayed. If it
+is unset or empty they will never be listed; if its value begins with
+@t{list}, they will always be listed; if it begins with @t{autolist}
+or @t{ambiguous}, they will be listed when the @t{AUTO_LIST} or
+@t{LIST_AMBIGUOUS} options respectively would normally cause them to
+be.
+
+@noindent
+If the substring @t{force} appears in the value, this makes the
+list be shown even if there is only one match. Normally, the list
+would be shown only if there are at least two matches.
+
+@noindent
+The value contains the substring @t{packed} if the @t{LIST_PACKED}
+option is set. If this substring is given for all matches added to a
+group, this group will show the @t{LIST_PACKED} behavior. The same is
+done for the @t{LIST_ROWS_FIRST} option with the substring @t{rows}.
+
+@noindent
+Finally, if the value contains the string @t{explanations}, only the
+explanation strings, if any, will be listed and if it contains
+@t{messages}, only the messages (added with the @t{-x} option of
+@t{compadd}) will be listed. If it contains both @t{explanations} and
+@t{messages} both kinds of explanation strings will be listed. It
+will be set appropriately on entry to a completion widget and may be
+changed there.
+
+@vindex list_lines, compstate
+@item @t{list_lines}
+This gives the number of lines that are needed to display the full
+list of completions. Note that to calculate the total number of lines
+to display you need to add the number of lines needed for the command
+line to this value, this is available as the value of the @t{BUFFERLINES}
+special parameter.
+
+@vindex list_max, compstate
+@item @t{list_max}
+Initially this is set to the value of the @t{LISTMAX} parameter.
+It may be set to any other value; when the widget exits this value
+will be used in the same way as the value of @t{LISTMAX}.
+
+@vindex nmatches, compstate
+@item @t{nmatches}
+The number of matches generated and accepted by the completion code so
+far.
+
+@vindex old_insert, compstate
+@item @t{old_insert}
+On entry to the widget this will be set to the number of the match of
+an old list of completions that is currently inserted into the command
+line. If no match has been inserted, this is unset.
+
+@noindent
+As with @t{old_list}, the value of this key will only be used if it is the
+string @t{keep}. If it was set to this value by the widget and there was an
+old match inserted into the command line, this match will be kept and if
+the value of the @t{insert} key specifies that another match should be
+inserted, this will be inserted after the old one.
+
+@vindex old_list, compstate
+@item @t{old_list}
+This is set to @t{yes} if there is still a valid list of completions
+from a previous completion at the time the widget is invoked. This will
+usually be the case if and only if the previous editing operation was a
+completion widget or one of the builtin completion functions. If there is a
+valid list and it is also currently shown on the screen, the value of this
+key is @t{shown}.
+
+@noindent
+After the widget has exited the value of this key is only used if it
+was set to @t{keep}. In this case the completion code will continue
+to use this old list. If the widget generated new matches, they will
+not be used.
+
+@vindex parameter, compstate
+@item @t{parameter}
+The name of the parameter when completing in a subscript or in the
+value of a parameter assignment.
+
+@vindex pattern_insert, compstate
+@item @t{pattern_insert}
+Normally this is set to @t{menu}, which specifies that menu completion will
+be used whenever a set of matches was generated using pattern matching. If
+it is set to any other non-empty string by the user and menu completion is
+not selected by other option settings, the code will instead insert any
+common prefix for the generated matches as with normal completion.
+
+@vindex pattern_match, compstate
+@item @t{pattern_match}
+Locally controls the behaviour given by the @t{GLOB_COMPLETE} option.
+Initially it is set to `@t{*}' if and only if the option is set.
+The completion widget may set it to this value, to an empty string
+(which has the same effect as unsetting it), or to any
+other non-empty string. If it is non-empty, unquoted metacharacters on the
+command line will be treated as patterns; if it is `@t{*}', then
+additionally a wildcard `@t{*}' is assumed at the cursor position; if
+it is empty or unset, metacharacters will be treated literally.
+
+@noindent
+Note that the matcher specifications given to the @t{compadd} builtin
+command are not used if this is set to a non-empty string.
+
+@vindex quote, compstate
+@item @t{quote}
+When completing inside quotes, this contains the quotation character
+(i.e. either a single quote, a double quote, or a backtick). Otherwise it
+is unset.
+
+@vindex quoting, compstate
+@item @t{quoting}
+When completing inside single quotes, this is set to the string
+@t{single}; inside double quotes, the string
+@t{double}; inside backticks, the string @t{backtick}.
+Otherwise it is unset.
+
+@vindex redirect, compstate
+@item @t{redirect}
+The redirection operator when completing in a redirection position,
+i.e. one of @t{<}, @t{>}, etc.
+
+@vindex restore, compstate
+@item @t{restore}
+This is set to @t{auto} before a function is entered, which forces the
+special parameters mentioned above (@t{words}, @t{CURRENT}, @t{PREFIX},
+@t{IPREFIX}, @t{SUFFIX}, and @t{ISUFFIX}) to be restored to their
+previous values when the function exits. If a function unsets it or
+sets it to any other string, they will not be restored.
+
+@vindex to_end, compstate
+@item @t{to_end}
+Specifies the occasions on which the cursor is moved to the end of a string
+when a match is inserted. On entry to a widget function, it may be
+@t{single} if this will happen when a single unambiguous match was inserted
+or @t{match} if it will happen any time a match is inserted (for example,
+by menu completion; this is likely to be the effect of the @t{ALWAYS_TO_END}
+option).
+
+@noindent
+On exit, it may be set to @t{single} as above. It may also be set to
+@t{always}, or to the empty string or unset; in those cases the cursor will
+be moved to the end of the string always or never respectively. Any
+other string is treated as @t{match}.
+
+@vindex unambiguous, compstate
+@item @t{unambiguous}
+This key is read-only and will always be set to the common (unambiguous)
+prefix the completion code has generated for all matches added so far.
+
+@vindex unambiguous_cursor, compstate
+@item @t{unambiguous_cursor}
+This gives the position the cursor would be placed at if the
+common prefix in the @t{unambiguous} key were inserted, relative to
+the value of that key. The cursor would be placed before the character
+whose index is given by this key.
+
+@vindex unambiguous_positions, compstate
+@item @t{unambiguous_positions}
+This contains all positions where characters in the unambiguous string
+are missing or where the character inserted differs from at least one
+of the matches. The positions are given as indexes into the string
+given by the value of the @t{unambiguous} key.
+
+@vindex vared, compstate
+@item @t{vared}
+If completion is called while editing a line using the @t{vared}
+builtin, the value of this key is set to the name of the parameter
+given as an argument to @t{vared}. This key is only set while a @t{vared}
+command is active.
+
+@end table
+
+@vindex words
+@item @t{words}
+This array contains the words present on the command line currently being
+edited.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+@node Completion Builtin Commands, Completion Condition Codes, Completion Special Parameters, Completion Widgets
+
+@section Completion Builtin Commands
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex compadd
+@cindex completion widgets, adding specified matches
+
+@item @t{compadd }[ @t{-akqQfenUl12C} ] [ @t{-F} @var{array} ]
+@itemx @t{@ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ }[@t{-P} @var{prefix} ] [ @t{-S} @var{suffix} ]
+@itemx @t{@ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ }[@t{-p} @var{hidden-prefix} ] [ @t{-s} @var{hidden-suffix} ]
+@itemx @t{@ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ }[@t{-i} @var{ignored-prefix} ] [ @t{-I} @var{ignored-suffix} ]
+@itemx @t{@ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ }[@t{-W} @var{file-prefix} ] [ @t{-d} @var{array} ]
+@itemx @t{@ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ }[@t{-J} @var{group-name} ] [ @t{-X} @var{explanation} ] [ @t{-x} @var{message} ]
+@itemx @t{@ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ }[@t{-V} @var{group-name} ] [ @t{-o} [ @var{order} ] ]
+@itemx @t{@ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ }[@t{-r} @var{remove-chars} ] [ @t{-R} @var{remove-func} ]
+@itemx @t{@ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ }[@t{-D} @var{array} ] [ @t{-O} @var{array} ] [ @t{-A} @var{array} ]
+@itemx @t{@ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ }[@t{-E} @var{number} ]
+@itemx @t{@ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ }[@t{-M} @var{match-spec} ] [ @t{-}@t{-} ] [ @var{words} ... ]
+
+@noindent
+This builtin command can be used to add matches directly and control
+all the information the completion code stores with each possible
+match. The return status is zero if at least one match was added and
+non-zero if no matches were added.
+
+@noindent
+The completion code breaks the string to complete into seven fields in
+the order:
+
+@noindent
+@quotation
+@var{<ipre><apre><hpre><word><hsuf><asuf><isuf>}
+@end quotation
+
+@noindent
+The first field
+is an ignored prefix taken from the command line, the contents of the
+@t{IPREFIX} parameter plus the string given with the @t{-i}
+option. With the @t{-U} option, only the string from the @t{-i}
+option is used. The field @var{<apre>} is an optional prefix string
+given with the @t{-P} option. The @var{<hpre>} field is a string
+that is considered part of the match but that should not be shown when
+listing completions, given with the @t{-p} option; for example,
+functions that do filename generation might specify
+a common path prefix this way. @var{<word>} is the part of the match that
+should appear in the list of completions, i.e. one of the @var{words} given
+at the end of the @t{compadd} command line. The suffixes @var{<hsuf>},
+@var{<asuf>} and @var{<isuf>} correspond to the prefixes @var{<hpre>},
+@var{<apre>} and @var{<ipre>} and are given by the options @t{-s}, @t{-S} and
+@t{-I}, respectively.
+
+@noindent
+The supported flags are:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{-P} @var{prefix}
+This gives a string to be inserted before the given @var{words}. The
+string given is not considered as part of the match and any shell
+metacharacters in it will not be quoted when the string is inserted.
+
+@item @t{-S} @var{suffix}
+Like @t{-P}, but gives a string to be inserted after the match.
+
+@item @t{-p} @var{hidden-prefix}
+This gives a string that should be inserted into the command line before the
+match but that should not appear in the list of matches. Unless the
+@t{-U} option is given, this string must be matched as part of the string
+on the command line.
+
+@item @t{-s} @var{hidden-suffix}
+Like `@t{-p}', but gives a string to insert after the match.
+
+@item @t{-i} @var{ignored-prefix}
+This gives a string to insert into the command line just before any
+string given with the `@t{-P}' option. Without `@t{-P}' the string is
+inserted before the string given with `@t{-p}' or directly before the
+match.
+
+@item @t{-I} @var{ignored-suffix}
+Like @t{-i}, but gives an ignored suffix.
+
+@item @t{-a}
+With this flag the @var{words} are taken as names of arrays and the
+possible matches are their values. If only some elements of the
+arrays are needed, the @var{words} may also contain subscripts, as in
+`@t{foo[2,-1]}'.
+
+@item @t{-k}
+With this flag the @var{words} are taken as names of associative arrays
+and the possible matches are their keys. As for @t{-a}, the
+@var{words} may also contain subscripts, as in `@t{foo[(R)*bar*]}'.
+
+@item @t{-d} @var{array}
+This adds per-match display strings. The @var{array} should contain one
+element per @var{word} given. The completion code will then display the
+first element instead of the first @var{word}, and so on. The
+@var{array} may be given as the name of an array parameter or directly
+as a space-separated list of words in parentheses.
+
+@noindent
+If there are fewer display strings than @var{words}, the leftover
+@var{words} will be displayed unchanged and if there are more display
+strings than @var{words}, the leftover display strings will be silently
+ignored.
+
+@item @t{-l}
+This option only has an effect if used together with the @t{-d}
+option. If it is given, the display strings are listed one per line,
+not arrayed in columns.
+
+@item @t{-o} [ @var{order} ]
+This controls the order in which matches are sorted. @var{order} is a
+comma-separated list comprising the following possible values. These values
+can be abbreviated to their initial two or three characters. Note that the
+order forms part of the group name space so matches with different orderings
+will not be in the same group.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{match}
+If given, the order of the output is determined by the match strings;
+otherwise it is determined by the display strings (i.e. the strings given
+by the @t{-d} option). This is the default if `@t{-o}' is specified but
+the @var{order} argument is omitted.
+
+@item @t{nosort}
+This specifies that the matches are pre-sorted and their order should be
+preserved. This value only makes sense alone and cannot be combined with any
+others.
+
+@item @t{numeric}
+If the matches include numbers, sort them numerically rather than
+lexicographically.
+
+@item @t{reverse}
+Arrange the matches backwards by reversing the sort ordering.
+
+@end table
+
+@item @t{-J} @var{group-name}
+Gives the name of the group of matches the words should be stored in.
+
+@item @t{-V} @var{group-name}
+Like @t{-J} but naming an unsorted group. This option is identical to
+the combination of @t{-J} and @t{-o nosort}.
+
+@item @t{-1}
+If given together with the @t{-V} option, makes
+only consecutive duplicates in the group be removed. If combined with
+the @t{-J} option, this has no visible effect. Note that groups
+with and without this flag are in different name spaces.
+
+@item @t{-2}
+If given together with the @t{-J} or @t{-V} option, makes all
+duplicates be kept. Again, groups with and without this flag are in
+different name spaces.
+
+@item @t{-X} @var{explanation}
+The @var{explanation} string will be printed with the list of matches,
+above the group currently selected.
+
+@noindent
+Within the @var{explanation}, the following sequences may be used to
+specify output attributes
+(see @ref{Prompt Expansion}):
+`@t{%B}', `@t{%S}', `@t{%U}', `@t{%F}', `@t{%K}' and their lower case
+counterparts, as well as `@t{%@{}...@t{%@}}'. `@t{%F}', `@t{%K}' and
+`@t{%@{}...@t{%@}}' take arguments in the same form as prompt
+expansion. (Note that the sequence `@t{%G}' is not available; an
+argument to `@t{%@{}' should be used instead.) The sequence `@t{%%}'
+produces a literal `@t{%}'.
+
+@noindent
+These sequences are most often employed by users when customising the
+@t{format} style
+(see
+@ref{Completion System}),
+but they must also be taken into account when writing completion
+functions, as passing descriptions with unescaped `@t{%}' characters
+to utility functions such as @t{_arguments} and @t{_message} may
+produce unexpected results. If arbitrary text is to be passed in a
+description, it can be escaped using e.g. @t{$@{my_str//\%/%%@}}.
+
+@item @t{-x} @var{message}
+Like @t{-X}, but the @var{message} will be printed even if there are no
+matches in the group.
+
+@item @t{-q}
+The suffix given with @t{-S} will be automatically removed if
+the next character typed is a blank or does not insert anything, or if
+the suffix consists of only one character and the next character typed
+is the same character.
+
+@item @t{-r} @var{remove-chars}
+This is a more versatile form of the @t{-q} option.
+The suffix given with @t{-S} or the slash automatically added after
+completing directories will be automatically removed if
+the next character typed inserts one of the characters given in the
+@var{remove-chars}. This string is parsed as a characters class and
+understands the backslash sequences used by the @t{print} command. For
+example, `@t{-r "a-z\t"}' removes the suffix if the next character typed
+inserts a lower case character or a TAB, and `@t{-r "^0-9"}' removes the
+suffix if the next character typed inserts anything but a digit. One extra
+backslash sequence is understood in this string: `@t{\-}' stands for
+all characters that insert nothing. Thus `@t{-S "=" -q}' is the same
+as `@t{-S "=" -r "= \t\n\-"}'.
+
+@noindent
+This option may also be used without the @t{-S} option; then any
+automatically added space will be removed when one of the characters in the
+list is typed.
+
+@item @t{-R} @var{remove-func}
+This is another form of the @t{-r} option. When a suffix
+has been inserted and the completion accepted, the function
+@var{remove-func} will be called after the next character typed. It is
+passed the length of the suffix as an argument and can use the special
+parameters available in ordinary (non-completion) zle widgets (see
+@ref{Zsh Line Editor}) to analyse and modify the command line.
+
+@item @t{-f}
+If this flag is given, all of the matches built from @var{words} are
+marked as being the names of files. They are not required to be actual
+filenames, but if they are, and the option @t{LIST_TYPES} is set, the
+characters describing the types of the files in the completion lists will
+be shown. This also forces a slash to be added when the name of a
+directory is completed.
+
+@item @t{-e}
+This flag can be used to tell the completion code that the matches
+added are parameter names for a parameter expansion. This will make
+the @t{AUTO_PARAM_SLASH} and @t{AUTO_PARAM_KEYS} options be used for
+the matches.
+
+@item @t{-W} @var{file-prefix}
+This string is a pathname that will be
+prepended to each of the matches formed by the given @var{words} together
+with any prefix specified by the @t{-p} option to form a complete filename
+for testing. Hence it is only useful if combined with the @t{-f} flag, as
+the tests will not otherwise be performed.
+
+@item @t{-F} @var{array}
+Specifies an array containing patterns. Words matching one of these
+patterns are ignored, i.e. not considered to be possible matches.
+
+@noindent
+The @var{array} may be the name of an array parameter or a list of
+literal patterns enclosed in parentheses and quoted, as in `@t{-F "(*?.o
+*?.h)"}'. If the name of an array is given, the elements of the array are
+taken as the patterns.
+
+@item @t{-Q}
+This flag instructs the completion
+code not to quote any metacharacters in the words when inserting them
+into the command line.
+
+@item @t{-M} @var{match-spec}
+This gives local match specifications as described below in
+@ref{Completion Matching Control}. This option may be given more than once.
+In this case all @var{match-spec}s given are concatenated with spaces
+between them to form the specification string to use.
+Note that they will only be used if the @t{-U} option is not given.
+
+@item @t{-n}
+Specifies that the words added are to be used as possible
+matches, but are not to appear in the completion listing.
+
+@item @t{-U}
+If this flag is given, all words given will be accepted and no matching
+will be done by the completion code. Normally this is used in
+functions that do the matching themselves.
+
+@item @t{-O} @var{array}
+If this option is given, the @var{words} are @emph{not} added to the set of
+possible completions. Instead, matching is done as usual and all of the
+@var{words} given as arguments that match the string on the command line
+will be stored in the array parameter whose name is given as @var{array}.
+
+@item @t{-A} @var{array}
+As the @t{-O} option, except that instead of those of the @var{words} which
+match being stored in @var{array}, the strings generated internally by the
+completion code are stored. For example,
+with a matching specification of `@t{-M "L:|no="}', the string `@t{nof}'
+on the command line and the string `@t{foo}' as one of the @var{words}, this
+option stores the string `@t{nofoo}' in the array, whereas the @t{-O}
+option stores the `@t{foo}' originally given.
+
+@item @t{-D} @var{array}
+As with @t{-O}, the @var{words} are not added to the set of possible
+completions. Instead, the completion code tests whether each @var{word}
+in turn matches what is on the line. If the @var{n}th @var{word} does not
+match, the @var{n}th element of the @var{array} is removed. Elements
+for which the corresponding @var{word} is matched are retained.
+
+@item @t{-C}
+This option adds a special match which expands to all other matches
+when inserted into the line, even those that are added after this
+option is used. Together with the @t{-d} option it is possible to
+specify a string that should be displayed in the list for this special
+match. If no string is given, it will be shown as a string containing
+the strings that would be inserted for the other matches, truncated to
+the width of the screen.
+
+@item @t{-E} @var{number}
+This option adds @var{number} empty matches after the @var{words} have
+been added. An empty match takes up space in completion listings but
+will never be inserted in the line and can't be selected with menu
+completion or menu selection. This makes empty matches only useful to
+format completion lists and to make explanatory string be shown in
+completion lists (since empty matches can be given display strings
+with the @t{-d} option). And because all but one empty string would
+otherwise be removed, this option implies the @t{-V} and @t{-2}
+options (even if an explicit @t{-J} option is given). This can be
+important to note as it affects the name space into which matches are
+added.
+
+@item @t{-}
+@itemx @t{-}@t{-}
+This flag ends the list of flags and options. All arguments after it
+will be taken as the words to use as matches even if they begin with
+hyphens.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+Except for the @t{-M} flag, if any of these flags is given more than
+once, the first one (and its argument) will be used.
+
+@findex compset
+@cindex completion widgets, modifying special parameters
+@item @t{compset -p} @var{number}
+@itemx @t{compset -P} [ @var{number} ] @var{pattern}
+@itemx @t{compset -s} @var{number}
+@itemx @t{compset -S} [ @var{number} ] @var{pattern}
+@itemx @t{compset -n} @var{begin} [ @var{end} ]
+@itemx @t{compset -N} @var{beg-pat} [ @var{end-pat} ]
+@itemx @t{compset -q}
+This command simplifies modification of the special parameters,
+while its return status allows tests on them to be carried out.
+
+@noindent
+The options are:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{-p} @var{number}
+If the value of the @t{PREFIX} parameter is at least @var{number}
+characters long, the first @var{number} characters are removed from it and
+appended to the contents of the @t{IPREFIX} parameter.
+
+@item @t{-P} [ @var{number} ] @var{pattern}
+If the value of the @t{PREFIX} parameter begins with anything that
+matches the @var{pattern}, the matched portion is removed from
+@t{PREFIX} and appended to @t{IPREFIX}.
+
+@noindent
+Without the optional @var{number}, the longest match is taken, but
+if @var{number} is given, anything up to the @var{number}th match is
+moved. If the @var{number} is negative, the @var{number}th longest
+match is moved. For example, if @t{PREFIX} contains the string
+`@t{a=b=c}', then @t{compset -P '*\='} will move the string `@t{a=b=}'
+into the @t{IPREFIX} parameter, but @t{compset -P 1 '*\='} will move only
+the string `@t{a=}'.
+
+@item @t{-s} @var{number}
+As @t{-p}, but transfer the last @var{number} characters from the
+value of @t{SUFFIX} to the front of the value of @t{ISUFFIX}.
+
+@item @t{-S} [ @var{number} ] @var{pattern}
+As @t{-P}, but match the last portion of @t{SUFFIX} and transfer the
+matched portion to the front of the value of @t{ISUFFIX}.
+
+@item @t{-n} @var{begin} [ @var{end} ]
+If the current word position as specified by the parameter @t{CURRENT}
+is greater than or equal to @var{begin}, anything up to the
+@var{begin}th word is removed from the @t{words} array and the value
+of the parameter @t{CURRENT} is decremented by @var{begin}.
+
+@noindent
+If the optional @var{end} is given, the modification is done only if
+the current word position is also less than or equal to @var{end}. In
+this case, the words from position @var{end} onwards are also removed from
+the @t{words} array.
+
+@noindent
+Both @var{begin} and @var{end} may be negative to count backwards
+from the last element of the @t{words} array.
+
+@item @t{-N} @var{beg-pat} [ @var{end-pat} ]
+If one of the elements of the @t{words} array before the one at the
+index given by the value of the parameter @t{CURRENT} matches the
+pattern @var{beg-pat}, all elements up to and including the matching one are
+removed from the @t{words} array and the value of @t{CURRENT} is changed to
+point to the same word in the changed array.
+
+@noindent
+If the optional pattern @var{end-pat} is also given, and there is an
+element in the @t{words} array matching this pattern, the parameters
+are modified only if the index of this word is higher than the one
+given by the @t{CURRENT} parameter (so that the matching word has
+to be after the cursor). In this case, the words starting with the one
+matching @t{end-pat} are also removed from the @t{words}
+array. If @t{words} contains no word matching @var{end-pat}, the
+testing and modification is performed as if it were not given.
+
+@item @t{-q}
+The word
+currently being completed is split on spaces into separate words,
+respecting the usual shell quoting conventions. The
+resulting words are stored in the @t{words} array, and @t{CURRENT},
+@t{PREFIX}, @t{SUFFIX}, @t{QIPREFIX}, and @t{QISUFFIX} are modified to
+reflect the word part that is completed.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+In all the above cases the return status is zero if the test succeeded
+and the parameters were modified and non-zero otherwise. This allows
+one to use this builtin in tests such as:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+if compset -P '*\='; then ...
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+This forces anything up to and including the last equal sign to be
+ignored by the completion code.
+
+@item @t{compcall} [ @t{-TD} ]
+This allows the use of completions defined with the @t{compctl} builtin
+from within completion widgets. The list of matches will be generated as
+if one of the non-widget completion functions (@t{complete-word}, etc.)
+had been called, except that only @t{compctl}s given for specific commands
+are used. To force the code to try completions defined with the @t{-T}
+option of @t{compctl} and/or the default completion (whether defined by
+@t{compctl -D} or the builtin default) in the appropriate places, the
+@t{-T} and/or @t{-D} flags can be passed to @t{compcall}.
+
+@noindent
+The return status can be used to test if a matching @t{compctl}
+definition was found. It is non-zero if a @t{compctl} was found and
+zero otherwise.
+
+@noindent
+Note that this builtin is defined by the @t{zsh/compctl} module.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+@node Completion Condition Codes, Completion Matching Control, Completion Builtin Commands, Completion Widgets
+
+@section Completion Condition Codes
+@noindent
+@cindex completion widgets, condition codes
+
+@noindent
+The following additional condition codes for use within the @t{[[} @var{...} @t{]]}
+construct are available in completion widgets. These work on the special
+parameters. All of these tests can also be performed by the @t{compset}
+builtin, but in the case of the condition codes the contents of the special
+parameters are not modified.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{-prefix} [ @var{number} ] @var{pattern}
+true if the test for the @t{-P} option of @t{compset} would succeed.
+
+@item @t{-suffix} [ @var{number} ] @var{pattern}
+true if the test for the @t{-S} option of @t{compset} would succeed.
+
+@item @t{-after} @var{beg-pat}
+true if the test of the @t{-N} option with only the @var{beg-pat} given
+would succeed.
+
+@item @t{-between} @var{beg-pat end-pat}
+true if the test for the @t{-N} option with both patterns would succeed.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+@node Completion Matching Control, Completion Widget Example, Completion Condition Codes, Completion Widgets
+
+@section Completion Matching Control
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+It is possible by use of the
+@t{-M} option of the @t{compadd} builtin command to specify how the
+characters in the string to be completed (referred to here as the
+command line) map onto the characters in the list of matches produced by
+the completion code (referred to here as the trial completions). Note
+that this is not used if the command line contains a glob pattern and
+the @t{GLOB_COMPLETE} option is set or the @t{pattern_match} of the
+@t{compstate} special association is set to a non-empty string.
+
+@noindent
+The @var{match-spec} given as the argument to the @t{-M} option (see
+@ref{Completion Builtin Commands}) consists of one or more matching descriptions separated by
+whitespace. Each description consists of a letter followed by a colon
+and then the patterns describing which character sequences on the line match
+which character sequences in the trial completion. Any sequence of
+characters not handled in this fashion must match exactly, as usual.
+
+@noindent
+The forms of @var{match-spec} understood are as follows. In each case, the
+form with an upper case initial character retains the string already
+typed on the command line as the final result of completion, while with
+a lower case initial character the string on the command line is changed
+into the corresponding part of the trial completion.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{m:}@var{lpat}@t{=}@var{tpat}
+@itemx @t{M:}@var{lpat}@t{=}@var{tpat}
+Here, @var{lpat} is a pattern that matches on the command line,
+corresponding to @var{tpat} which matches in the trial completion.
+
+@item @t{l:}@var{lanchor}@t{|}@var{lpat}@t{=}@var{tpat}
+@itemx @t{L:}@var{lanchor}@t{|}@var{lpat}@t{=}@var{tpat}
+@itemx @t{l:}@var{lanchor}@t{||}@var{ranchor}@t{=}@var{tpat}
+@itemx @t{L:}@var{lanchor}@t{||}@var{ranchor}@t{=}@var{tpat}
+@itemx @t{b:}@var{lpat}@t{=}@var{tpat}
+@itemx @t{B:}@var{lpat}@t{=}@var{tpat}
+These letters are for patterns that are anchored by another pattern on
+the left side. Matching for @var{lpat} and @var{tpat} is as for @t{m} and
+@t{M}, but the pattern @var{lpat} matched on the command line must be
+preceded by the pattern @var{lanchor}. The @var{lanchor} can be blank to
+anchor the match to the start of the command line string; otherwise the
+anchor can occur anywhere, but must match in both the command line and
+trial completion strings.
+
+@noindent
+If no @var{lpat} is given but a @var{ranchor} is, this matches the gap
+between substrings matched by @var{lanchor} and @var{ranchor}. Unlike
+@var{lanchor}, the @var{ranchor} only needs to match the trial
+completion string.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{b} and @t{B} forms are similar to @t{l} and @t{L} with an empty
+anchor, but need to match only the beginning of the word on the command line
+or trial completion, respectively.
+
+@item @t{r:}@var{lpat}@t{|}@var{ranchor}@t{=}@var{tpat}
+@itemx @t{R:}@var{lpat}@t{|}@var{ranchor}@t{=}@var{tpat}
+@itemx @t{r:}@var{lanchor}@t{||}@var{ranchor}@t{=}@var{tpat}
+@itemx @t{R:}@var{lanchor}@t{||}@var{ranchor}@t{=}@var{tpat}
+@itemx @t{e:}@var{lpat}@t{=}@var{tpat}
+@itemx @t{E:}@var{lpat}@t{=}@var{tpat}
+As @t{l}, @t{L}, @t{b} and @t{B}, with the difference that the command
+line and trial completion patterns are anchored on the right side.
+Here an empty @var{ranchor} and the @t{e} and @t{E} forms force the
+match to the end of the command line or trial completion string.
+
+@item @t{x:}
+This form is used to mark the end of matching specifications:
+subsequent specifications are ignored. In a single standalone list
+of specifications this has no use but where matching specifications
+are accumulated, such as from nested function calls, it can allow one
+function to override another.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+Each @var{lpat}, @var{tpat} or @var{anchor} is either an empty string or
+consists of a sequence of literal characters (which may be quoted with a
+backslash), question marks, character classes, and correspondence
+classes; ordinary shell patterns are not used. Literal characters match
+only themselves, question marks match any character, and character
+classes are formed as for globbing and match any character in the given
+set.
+
+@noindent
+Correspondence classes are defined like character classes, but with two
+differences: they are delimited by a pair of braces, and negated classes
+are not allowed, so the characters @t{!} and @t{^} have no special
+meaning directly after the opening brace. They indicate that a range of
+characters on the line match a range of characters in the trial
+completion, but (unlike ordinary character classes) paired according to
+the corresponding position in the sequence. For example, to make any
+ASCII lower case letter on the line match the corresponding upper case
+letter in the trial completion, you can use `@t{m:@{a-z@}=@{A-Z@}}'
+(however, see below for the recommended form for this). More
+than one pair of classes can occur, in which case the first class before
+the @t{=} corresponds to the first after it, and so on. If one side has
+more such classes than the other side, the superfluous classes behave
+like normal character classes. In anchor patterns correspondence classes
+also behave like normal character classes.
+
+@noindent
+The standard `@t{[:}@var{name}@t{:]}' forms described for standard shell
+patterns (see
+@ref{Filename Generation})
+may appear in correspondence classes as well as normal character
+classes. The only special behaviour in correspondence classes is if
+the form on the left and the form on the right are each one of
+@t{[:upper:]}, @t{[:lower:]}. In these cases the
+character in the word and the character on the line must be the same up
+to a difference in case. Hence to make any lower case character on the
+line match the corresponding upper case character in the trial
+completion you can use `@t{m:@{[:lower:]@}=@{[:upper:]@}}'. Although the
+matching system does not yet handle multibyte characters, this is likely
+to be a future extension, at which point this syntax will handle
+arbitrary alphabets; hence this form, rather than the use of explicit
+ranges, is the recommended form. In other cases
+`@t{[:}@var{name}@t{:]}' forms are allowed. If the two forms on the left
+and right are the same, the characters must match exactly. In remaining
+cases, the corresponding tests are applied to both characters, but they
+are not otherwise constrained; any matching character in one set goes
+with any matching character in the other set: this is equivalent to the
+behaviour of ordinary character classes.
+
+@noindent
+The pattern @var{tpat} may also be one or two stars, `@t{*}' or
+`@t{**}'. This means that the pattern on the command line can match
+any number of characters in the trial completion. In this case the
+pattern must be anchored (on either side); in the case of a single
+star, the @var{anchor} then determines how much of the trial completion
+is to be included --- only the characters up to the next appearance of
+the anchor will be matched. With two stars, substrings matched by the
+anchor can be matched, too.
+
+@noindent
+Examples:
+
+@noindent
+The keys of the @t{options} association defined by the @t{parameter}
+module are the option names in all-lower-case form, without
+underscores, and without the optional @t{no} at the beginning even
+though the builtins @t{setopt} and @t{unsetopt} understand option names
+with upper case letters, underscores, and the optional @t{no}. The
+following alters the matching rules so that the prefix @t{no} and any
+underscore are ignored when trying to match the trial completions
+generated and upper case letters on the line match the corresponding
+lower case letters in the words:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+compadd -M 'L:|[nN][oO]= M:_= M:@{[:upper:]@}=@{[:lower:]@}' - \
+ $@{(k)options@}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The first part says that the pattern `@t{[nN][oO]}' at the beginning
+(the empty anchor before the pipe symbol) of the string on the
+line matches the empty string in the list of words generated by
+completion, so it will be ignored if present. The second part does the
+same for an underscore anywhere in the command line string, and the
+third part uses correspondence classes so that any
+upper case letter on the line matches the corresponding lower case
+letter in the word. The use of the upper case forms of the
+specification characters (@t{L} and @t{M}) guarantees that what has
+already been typed on the command line (in particular the prefix
+@t{no}) will not be deleted.
+
+@noindent
+Note that the use of @t{L} in the first part means that it matches
+only when at the beginning of both the command line string and the
+trial completion. I.e., the string `@t{_NO_f}' would not be
+completed to `@t{_NO_foo}', nor would `@t{NONO_f}' be completed to
+`@t{NONO_foo}' because of the leading underscore or the second
+`@t{NO}' on the line which makes the pattern fail even though they are
+otherwise ignored. To fix this, one would use `@t{B:[nN][oO]=}'
+instead of the first part. As described above, this matches at the
+beginning of the trial completion, independent of other characters or
+substrings at the beginning of the command line word which are ignored
+by the same or other @var{match-spec}s.
+
+@noindent
+The second example makes completion case insensitive. This is just
+the same as in the option example, except here we wish to retain the
+characters in the list of completions:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+compadd -M 'm:@{[:lower:]@}=@{[:upper:]@}' ...
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+This makes lower case letters match their upper case counterparts.
+To make upper case letters match the lower case forms as well:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+compadd -M 'm:@{[:lower:][:upper:]@}=@{[:upper:][:lower:]@}' ...
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+A nice example for the use of @t{*} patterns is partial word
+completion. Sometimes you would like to make strings like `@t{c.s.u}'
+complete to strings like `@t{comp.source.unix}', i.e. the word on the
+command line consists of multiple parts, separated by a dot in this
+example, where each part should be completed separately --- note,
+however, that the case where each part of the word, i.e. `@t{comp}',
+`@t{source}' and `@t{unix}' in this example, is to be completed from
+separate sets of matches
+is a different problem to be solved by the implementation of the
+completion widget. The example can be handled by:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+compadd -M 'r:|.=* r:|=*' \
+ - comp.sources.unix comp.sources.misc ...
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The first specification says that @var{lpat} is the empty string, while
+@var{anchor} is a dot; @var{tpat} is @t{*}, so this can match anything
+except for the `@t{.}' from the anchor in
+the trial completion word. So in `@t{c.s.u}', the matcher sees `@t{c}',
+followed by the empty string, followed by the anchor `@t{.}', and
+likewise for the second dot, and replaces the empty strings before the
+anchors, giving `@t{c}[@t{omp}]@t{.s}[@t{ources}]@t{.u}[@t{nix}]', where
+the last part of the completion is just as normal.
+
+@noindent
+With the pattern shown above, the string `@t{c.u}' could not be
+completed to `@t{comp.sources.unix}' because the single star means
+that no dot (matched by the anchor) can be skipped. By using two stars
+as in `@t{r:|.=**}', however, `@t{c.u}' could be completed to
+`@t{comp.sources.unix}'. This also shows that in some cases,
+especially if the anchor is a real pattern, like a character class,
+the form with two stars may result in more matches than one would like.
+
+@noindent
+The second specification is needed to make this work when the cursor is
+in the middle of the string on the command line and the option
+@t{COMPLETE_IN_WORD} is set. In this case the completion code would
+normally try to match trial completions that end with the string as
+typed so far, i.e. it will only insert new characters at the cursor
+position rather than at the end. However in our example we would like
+the code to recognise matches which contain extra characters after the
+string on the line (the `@t{nix}' in the example). Hence we say that the
+empty string at the end of the string on the line matches any characters
+at the end of the trial completion.
+
+@noindent
+More generally, the specification
+
+@noindent
+@example
+compadd -M 'r:|[.,_-]=* r:|=*' ...
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+allows one to complete words with abbreviations before any of the
+characters in the square brackets. For example, to
+complete @t{veryverylongfile.c} rather than @t{veryverylongheader.h}
+with the above in effect, you can just type @t{very.c} before attempting
+completion.
+
+@noindent
+The specifications with both a left and a right anchor are useful to
+complete partial words whose parts are not separated by some
+special character. For example, in some places strings have to be
+completed that are formed `@t{LikeThis}' (i.e. the separate parts are
+determined by a leading upper case letter) or maybe one has to
+complete strings with trailing numbers. Here one could use the simple
+form with only one anchor as in:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+compadd -M 'r:|[[:upper:]0-9]=* r:|=*' LikeTHIS FooHoo 5foo123 5bar234
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+But with this, the string `@t{H}' would neither complete to `@t{FooHoo}'
+nor to `@t{LikeTHIS}' because in each case there is an upper case
+letter before the `@t{H}' and that is matched by the anchor. Likewise,
+a `@t{2}' would not be completed. In both cases this could be changed
+by using `@t{r:|[[:upper:]0-9]=**}', but then `@t{H}' completes to both
+`@t{LikeTHIS}' and `@t{FooHoo}' and a `@t{2}' matches the other
+strings because characters can be inserted before every upper case
+letter and digit. To avoid this one would use:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+compadd -M 'r:[^[:upper:]0-9]||[[:upper:]0-9]=** r:|=*' \
+ LikeTHIS FooHoo foo123 bar234
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+By using these two anchors, a `@t{H}' matches only upper case `@t{H}'s that
+are immediately preceded by something matching the left anchor
+`@t{[^[:upper:]0-9]}'. The effect is, of course, that `@t{H}' matches only
+the string `@t{FooHoo}', a `@t{2}' matches only `@t{bar234}' and so on.
+
+@noindent
+When using the completion system (see
+@ref{Completion System}), users can define match specifications that are to be used for
+specific contexts by using the @t{matcher} and @t{matcher-list}
+styles. The values for the latter will be used everywhere.
+
+@noindent
+@node Completion Widget Example, , Completion Matching Control, Completion Widgets
+
+@section Completion Widget Example
+@noindent
+@cindex completion widgets, example
+
+@noindent
+The first step is to define the widget:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zle -C complete complete-word complete-files
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Then the widget can be bound to a key using the @t{bindkey} builtin
+command:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+bindkey '^X\t' complete
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+After that the shell function @t{complete-files} will be invoked
+after typing control-X and TAB. The function should then generate the
+matches, e.g.:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+complete-files () @{ compadd - * @}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+This function will complete files in the current directory matching the
+current word.
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/compsys.yo
+@node Completion System, Completion Using compctl, Completion Widgets, Top
+
+@chapter Completion System
+@noindent
+@cindex completion system
+@cindex completion, programmable
+@cindex completion, controlling
+
+@section Description
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+This describes the shell code for the `new' completion system, referred
+to as @t{compsys}. It is written in shell functions based on the
+features described in
+the previous chapter, @ref{Completion Widgets}.
+
+@noindent
+The features are contextual, sensitive to the point at which completion is
+started. Many completions are already provided.
+For this reason, a user can perform a great many tasks without
+knowing any details beyond how to initialize the system, which is
+described
+in @ref{Initialization}.
+
+@noindent
+The context that decides what completion is to be performed may be
+@itemize @bullet
+
+@item
+an argument or option position: these describe the position on the
+command line at which completion is requested. For example `first argument
+to rmdir, the word being completed names a directory';
+
+@item
+a special context, denoting an element in the shell's syntax. For example
+`a word in command position' or `an array subscript'.
+
+@end itemize
+
+@noindent
+A full context specification contains other elements, as we shall describe.
+
+@noindent
+Besides commands names and contexts, the system employs two more
+concepts, @emph{styles} and @emph{tags}. These provide ways for the user
+to configure the system's behaviour.
+
+@noindent
+Tags play a dual role. They serve as a classification system for
+the matches, typically indicating a class of object that the user
+may need to distinguish. For example, when completing arguments of the
+@t{ls} command the user may prefer to try @t{files} before @t{directories},
+so both of these are tags. They also appear as the rightmost
+element in a context specification.
+
+@noindent
+Styles modify various operations of the completion system, such as
+output formatting, but also what kinds of completers are used (and in
+what order), or which tags are examined. Styles may accept arguments
+and are manipulated using the @t{zstyle} command described in
+@ref{The zsh/zutil Module}.
+
+@noindent
+In summary, tags describe @emph{what} the completion objects are, and style
+@t{how} they are to be completed. At various points of execution, the
+completion system checks what styles and/or tags are defined for the
+current context, and uses that to modify its behavior. The full
+description of context handling, which determines how tags and other
+elements of the context influence the behaviour of styles, is described
+in @ref{Completion System Configuration}.
+
+@noindent
+When a completion is requested, a dispatcher function is called;
+see the description of @t{_main_complete} in the list of control functions
+below. This dispatcher decides which function should
+be called to produce the completions, and calls it. The result is
+passed to one or more @emph{completers}, functions that implement
+individual completion strategies: simple completion, error correction,
+completion with error correction, menu selection, etc.
+
+@noindent
+More generally, the shell functions contained in the completion system are
+of two types:
+@itemize @bullet
+
+@item
+those beginning `@t{comp}' are to be called directly; there are only
+a few of these;
+
+@item
+those beginning `@t{_}' are called by the
+completion code. The shell functions of this set, which implement
+completion behaviour and may be bound to keystrokes, are referred to
+as `widgets'. These proliferate as new completions are required.
+
+@end itemize
+
+@noindent
+@menu
+* Initialization::
+* Completion System Configuration::
+* Control Functions::
+* Bindable Commands::
+* Completion Functions::
+* Completion Directories::
+* Completion System Variables::
+@end menu
+
+@noindent
+@node Initialization, Completion System Configuration, , Completion System
+
+@section Initialization
+@noindent
+@findex compinstall
+@cindex completion system, installing
+
+@noindent
+If the system was installed completely, it should be enough to
+call the shell function @t{compinit} from your initialization file; see the
+next section. However, the function @t{compinstall} can be run by a user
+to configure various aspects of the completion system.
+
+@noindent
+Usually, @t{compinstall} will insert code into @t{.zshrc}, although if
+that is not writable it will save it in another file and tell you that
+file's location. Note that it is up to you to make sure that the lines
+added to @t{.zshrc} are actually run; you may, for example, need to move
+them to an earlier place in the file if @t{.zshrc} usually returns early.
+So long as you keep them all together (including the comment lines at the
+start and finish), you can rerun @t{compinstall} and it will correctly
+locate and modify these lines. Note, however, that any code you add to
+this section by hand is likely to be lost if you rerun @t{compinstall},
+although lines using the command `@t{zstyle}' should be gracefully handled.
+
+@noindent
+The new code will take effect next time you start the shell, or run
+@t{.zshrc} by hand; there is also an option to make them take effect
+immediately. However, if @t{compinstall} has removed definitions, you will
+need to restart the shell to see the changes.
+
+@noindent
+To run @t{compinstall} you will need to make sure it is in a directory
+mentioned in your @t{fpath} parameter, which should already be the case if
+zsh was properly configured as long as your startup files do not remove the
+appropriate directories from @t{fpath}. Then it must be autoloaded
+(`@t{autoload -U compinstall}' is recommended). You can abort the
+installation any time you are being prompted for information, and your
+@t{.zshrc} will not be altered at all; changes only take place right at the
+end, where you are specifically asked for confirmation.
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Use of compinit
+@noindent
+@findex compinit
+@cindex completion system, initializing
+
+@noindent
+This section describes the use of @t{compinit} to initialize completion for
+the current session when called directly; if you have run
+@t{compinstall} it will be called automatically from your @t{.zshrc}.
+
+@noindent
+To initialize the system, the function @t{compinit} should be in a
+directory mentioned in the @t{fpath} parameter, and should be autoloaded
+(`@t{autoload -U compinit}' is recommended), and then run simply as
+`@t{compinit}'. This will define a
+few utility functions, arrange for all the necessary shell functions to be
+autoloaded, and will then re-define all widgets that do completion to use the
+new system. If you use the @t{menu-select} widget, which is part of the
+@t{zsh/complist} module, you should make sure that that module is loaded
+before the call to @t{compinit} so that that widget is also
+re-defined. If completion styles (see below) are set up to perform
+expansion as well as completion by default, and the TAB key is bound to
+@t{expand-or-complete}, @t{compinit} will rebind it to @t{complete-word};
+this is necessary to use the correct form of expansion.
+
+@noindent
+Should you need to use the original completion commands, you can still
+bind keys to the old widgets by putting a `@t{.}' in front of the
+widget name, e.g. `@t{.expand-or-complete}'.
+
+@noindent
+To speed up the running of @t{compinit}, it can be made to produce a dumped
+configuration that will be read in on future invocations; this is the
+default, but can be turned off by calling @t{compinit} with the
+option @t{-D}. The dumped file is @t{.zcompdump} in the same
+directory as the startup files (i.e. @t{$ZDOTDIR} or @t{$HOME});
+alternatively, an explicit file name can be given by `@t{compinit -d}
+@var{dumpfile}'. The next invocation of @t{compinit} will read the dumped
+file instead of performing a full initialization.
+
+@noindent
+If the number of completion files changes, @t{compinit} will recognise this
+and produce a new dump file. However, if the name of a function or the
+arguments in the first line of a @t{#compdef} function (as described below)
+change, it is easiest to delete the dump file by hand so that
+@t{compinit} will re-create it the next time it is run. The check
+performed to see if there are new functions can be omitted by giving
+the option @t{-C}. In this case the dump file will only be created if
+there isn't one already.
+
+@noindent
+The dumping is actually done by another function, @t{compdump}, but you
+will only need to run this yourself if you change the configuration
+(e.g. using @t{compdef}) and then want to dump the new one. The name of
+the old dumped file will be remembered for this purpose.
+
+@noindent
+If the parameter @t{_compdir} is set, @t{compinit} uses it as a directory
+where completion functions can be found; this is only necessary if they are
+not already in the function search path.
+
+@noindent
+For security reasons @t{compinit} also checks if the completion system
+would use files not owned by root or by the current user, or files in
+directories that are world- or group-writable or that are not owned by
+root or by the current user. If such files or directories are found,
+@t{compinit} will ask if the completion system should really be used. To
+avoid these tests and make all files found be used without asking, use the
+option @t{-u}, and to make @t{compinit} silently ignore all insecure files
+and directories use the option @t{-i}. This security check is skipped
+entirely when the @t{-C} option is given.
+
+@noindent
+@findex compaudit
+The security check can be retried at any time by running the function
+@t{compaudit}. This is the same check used by @t{compinit}, but when it
+is executed directly any changes to @t{fpath} are made local to the
+function so they do not persist. The directories to be checked may be
+passed as arguments; if none are given, @t{compaudit} uses @t{fpath} and
+@t{_compdir} to find completion system directories, adding missing ones
+to @t{fpath} as necessary. To force a check of exactly the directories
+currently named in @t{fpath}, set @t{_compdir} to an empty string before
+calling @t{compaudit} or @t{compinit}.
+
+@noindent
+@findex bashcompinit
+The function @t{bashcompinit} provides compatibility with bash's programmable
+completion system. When run it will define the functions, @t{compgen} and
+@t{complete} which correspond to the bash builtins with the same names.
+It will then be possible to use completion specifications and functions
+written for bash.
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Autoloaded files
+@noindent
+@cindex completion system, autoloaded functions
+
+@noindent
+The convention for autoloaded functions used in completion is that they
+start with an underscore; as already mentioned, the @t{fpath/FPATH}
+parameter must contain the directory in which they are stored. If @t{zsh}
+was properly installed on your system, then @t{fpath/FPATH} automatically
+contains the required directories for the standard functions.
+
+@noindent
+For incomplete installations, if @t{compinit} does not find enough files
+beginning with an underscore (fewer than twenty) in the search path, it
+will try to find more by adding the directory @t{_compdir} to the search
+path. If that directory has a subdirectory named @t{Base}, all
+subdirectories will be added to the path. Furthermore, if the subdirectory
+@t{Base} has a subdirectory named @t{Core}, @t{compinit} will add all
+subdirectories of the subdirectories to the path: this allows
+the functions to be in the same format as in the @t{zsh} source
+distribution.
+
+@noindent
+@cindex compdef, use of by compinit
+When @t{compinit} is run, it searches all such files accessible via
+@t{fpath/FPATH} and reads the first line of each of them. This line should
+contain one of the tags described below. Files whose first line does not
+start with one of these tags are not considered to be part of the
+completion system and will not be treated specially.
+
+@noindent
+The tags are:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{#compdef} @var{name} ... [ @t{-}@{@t{p}|@t{P}@} @var{pattern} ... [ @t{-N} @var{name} ... ] ]
+The file will be made autoloadable and the function defined
+in it will be called when completing @var{name}s, each of which is
+either the name of a command whose arguments are to be completed or one of
+a number of special contexts in the form @t{-}@var{context}@t{-} described
+below.
+
+@noindent
+Each @var{name} may also be of the form `@var{cmd}@t{=}@var{service}'.
+When completing the command @var{cmd}, the function typically behaves as
+if the command (or special context) @var{service} was being completed
+instead. This provides a way of altering the behaviour of functions
+that can perform many different completions. It is implemented
+by setting the parameter @t{$service} when calling the function;
+the function may choose to interpret this how it wishes, and simpler
+functions will probably ignore it.
+
+@noindent
+If the @t{#compdef} line contains one of the options @t{-p} or @t{-P},
+the words following are taken to be patterns. The function will be
+called when completion is attempted for a command or context that matches
+one of the patterns. The options @t{-p} and @t{-P} are used to specify
+patterns to be tried before or after other completions respectively.
+Hence @t{-P} may be used to specify default actions.
+
+@noindent
+The option @t{-N} is used after a list following @t{-p} or @t{-P}; it
+specifies that remaining words no longer define patterns. It is
+possible to toggle between the three options as many times as necessary.
+
+@item @t{#compdef -k} @var{style key-sequence} ...
+This option creates a widget behaving like the
+builtin widget @var{style} and binds it to the given @var{key-sequence}s,
+if any. The @var{style} must be one of the builtin widgets that perform
+completion, namely @t{complete-word}, @t{delete-char-or-list},
+@t{expand-or-complete}, @t{expand-or-complete-prefix}, @t{list-choices},
+@t{menu-complete}, @t{menu-expand-or-complete}, or
+@t{reverse-menu-complete}. If the @t{zsh/complist} module is loaded (see
+@ref{The zsh/complist Module}) the widget @t{menu-select} is also available.
+
+@noindent
+When one of the @var{key-sequence}s is typed, the function in the file will
+be invoked to generate the matches. Note that a key will not be re-bound
+if it already was (that is, was bound to something other than
+@t{undefined-key}). The widget created has the same name as the file and
+can be bound to any other keys using @t{bindkey} as usual.
+
+@item @t{#compdef -K} @var{widget-name} @var{style} @var{key-sequence} [ @var{name} @var{style} @var{seq} ... ]
+This is similar to @t{-k} except that only one @var{key-sequence}
+argument may be given for each @var{widget-name} @var{style} pair.
+However, the entire set of three arguments may be repeated with a
+different set of arguments. Note in particular that the
+@var{widget-name} must be distinct in each set. If it does not begin with
+`@t{_}' this will be added. The @var{widget-name} should not clash with
+the name of any existing widget: names based on the name of the function
+are most useful. For example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+#compdef -K _foo_complete complete-word "^X^C" \
+ _foo_list list-choices "^X^D"
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+(all on one line) defines a widget @t{_foo_complete} for completion, bound
+to `@t{^X^C}', and a widget @t{_foo_list} for listing, bound to `@t{^X^D}'.
+
+@item @t{#autoload} [ @var{options} ]
+Functions with the @t{#autoload} tag are marked for autoloading but
+are not otherwise treated specially. Typically they are to be called
+from within one of the completion functions. Any @var{options} supplied
+will be passed to the @t{autoload} builtin; a typical use is @t{+X} to
+force the function to be loaded immediately. Note that the @t{-U} and
+@t{-z} flags are always added implicitly.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+The @t{#} is part of the tag name and no white space is allowed after it.
+The @t{#compdef} tags use the @t{compdef} function described below; the
+main difference is that the name of the function is supplied implicitly.
+
+@noindent
+The special contexts for which completion functions can be defined are:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@kindex -array-value-, completion context
+@item @t{-array-value-}
+The right hand side of an array-assignment
+(`@var{name}@t{=(}@var{...}@t{)}')
+
+@kindex -brace-parameter-, completion context
+@item @t{-brace-parameter-}
+The name of a parameter expansion within braces (`@t{$@{}@var{...}@t{@}}')
+
+@kindex -assign-parameter-, completion context
+@item @t{-assign-parameter-}
+The name of a parameter in an assignment, i.e. on the left hand side of
+an `@t{=}'
+
+@kindex -command-, completion context
+@item @t{-command-}
+A word in command position
+
+@kindex -condition-, completion context
+@item @t{-condition-}
+A word inside a condition (`@t{[[}@var{...}@t{]]}')
+
+@kindex -default-, completion context
+@item @t{-default-}
+Any word for which no other completion is defined
+
+@kindex -equal-, completion context
+@item @t{-equal-}
+A word beginning with an equals sign
+
+@kindex -first-, completion context
+@item @t{-first-}
+This is tried before any other completion function. The function called
+may set the @t{_compskip} parameter to one of various values:
+@t{all}: no further completion is attempted; a string
+containing the substring @t{patterns}: no pattern completion functions
+will be called; a string containing @t{default}: the
+function for the `@t{-default-}' context will not be called, but
+functions defined for commands will be.
+
+@kindex -math-, completion context
+@item @t{-math-}
+Inside mathematical contexts, such as
+`@t{((}@var{...}@t{))}'
+
+@kindex -parameter-, completion context
+@item @t{-parameter-}
+The name of a parameter expansion (`@t{$}@var{...}')
+
+@kindex -redirect-, completion context
+@item @t{-redirect-}
+The word after a redirection operator.
+
+@kindex -subscript-, completion context
+@item @t{-subscript-}
+The contents of a parameter subscript.
+
+@kindex -tilde-, completion context
+@item @t{-tilde-}
+After an initial tilde (`@t{~}'), but before the first slash
+in the word.
+
+@kindex -value-, completion context
+@item @t{-value-}
+On the right hand side of an assignment.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+Default implementations are supplied for each of these
+contexts. In most cases the context @t{-}@var{context}@t{-} is
+implemented by a corresponding function @t{_}@var{context}, for example
+the context `@t{-tilde-}' and the function `@t{_tilde}').
+
+@noindent
+The contexts @t{-redirect-} and @t{-value-} allow extra context-specific
+information. (Internally, this is handled by the functions for each
+context calling the function @t{_dispatch}.) The extra
+information is added separated by commas.
+
+@noindent
+For the @t{-redirect-} context, the extra information is in the form
+`@t{-redirect-,}@var{op}@t{,}@var{command}', where @var{op} is the
+redirection operator and @var{command} is the name of the command on
+the line. If there is no command on the line yet, the @var{command}
+field will be empty.
+
+@noindent
+For the @t{-value-} context, the form is
+`@t{-value-,}@var{name}@t{,}@var{command}', where @var{name} is the name of
+the parameter on the left hand side of the assignment.
+In the case of elements of an associative array, for
+example `@t{assoc=(key <TAB>}', @var{name} is expanded to
+`@var{name}@t{-}@var{key}'. In certain special contexts, such as
+completing after `@t{make CFLAGS=}', the @var{command} part gives the
+name of the command, here @t{make}; otherwise it is empty.
+
+@noindent
+It is not necessary to define fully specific completions as the
+functions provided will try to generate completions by progressively
+replacing the elements with `@t{-default-}'. For example, when
+completing after `@t{foo=<TAB>}', @t{_value} will try the names
+`@t{-value-,foo,}' (note the empty @var{command} part),
+`@t{-value-,foo,-default-}' and`@t{-value-,-default-,-default-}', in
+that order, until it finds a function to handle the context.
+
+@noindent
+As an example:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+compdef '_files -g "*.log"' '-redirect-,2>,-default-'
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+completes files matching `@t{*.log}' after `@t{2> <TAB>}' for any
+command with no more specific handler defined.
+
+@noindent
+Also:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+compdef _foo -value-,-default-,-default-
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+specifies that @t{_foo} provides completions for the values of
+parameters for which no special function has been defined. This is
+usually handled by the function @t{_value} itself.
+
+@noindent
+The same lookup rules are used when looking up styles (as described
+below); for example
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle ':completion:*:*:-redirect-,2>,*:*' file-patterns '*.log'
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+is another way to make completion after `@t{2> <TAB>}' complete files
+matching `@t{*.log}'.
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Functions
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+The following function is defined by @t{compinit} and may be called
+directly.
+
+@noindent
+@findex compdef
+@cindex completion system, adding definitions
+@table @asis
+
+@item @t{compdef} [ @t{-ane} ] @var{function name} ... [ @t{-}@{@t{p}|@t{P}@} @var{pattern} ... [ @t{-N} @var{name} ...]]
+@itemx @t{compdef -d} @var{name} ...
+@itemx @t{compdef -k} [ @t{-an} ] @var{function style key-sequence} [ @var{key-sequence} ... ]
+@itemx @t{compdef -K} [ @t{-an} ] @var{function name style key-seq} [ @var{name style seq} ... ]
+The first form defines the @var{function} to call for completion in the
+given contexts as described for the @t{#compdef} tag above.
+
+@noindent
+Alternatively, all the arguments may have the form
+`@var{cmd}@t{=}@var{service}'. Here @var{service} should already have been
+defined by `@var{cmd1}@t{=}@var{service}' lines in @t{#compdef} files, as
+described above. The argument for @var{cmd} will be completed in the
+same way as @var{service}.
+
+@noindent
+The @var{function} argument may alternatively be a string containing
+almost any shell code. If the string contains an equal sign, the above
+will take precedence. The option @t{-e} may be used to specify the first
+argument is to be evaluated as shell code even if it contains an equal
+sign. The string will be executed using the @t{eval} builtin command to
+generate completions. This provides a way of avoiding having to define
+a new completion function. For example, to complete files ending in
+`@t{.h}' as arguments to the command @t{foo}:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+compdef '_files -g "*.h"' foo
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The option @t{-n} prevents any completions already defined for the
+command or context from being overwritten.
+
+@noindent
+The option @t{-d} deletes any completion defined for the command or
+contexts listed.
+
+@noindent
+The @var{name}s may also contain @t{-p}, @t{-P} and @t{-N} options as
+described for the @t{#compdef} tag. The effect on the argument list is
+identical, switching between definitions of patterns tried initially,
+patterns tried finally, and normal commands and contexts.
+
+@noindent
+The parameter @t{$_compskip} may be set by any function defined for a
+pattern context. If it is set to a value containing the substring
+`@t{patterns}' none of the pattern-functions will be called; if it is
+set to a value containing the substring `@t{all}', no other function
+will be called. Setting @t{$_compskip} in this manner is of particular
+utility when using the @t{-p} option, as otherwise the dispatcher will
+move on to additional functions (likely the default one) after calling
+the pattern-context one, which can mangle the display of completion
+possibilities if not handled properly.
+
+@noindent
+The form with @t{-k} defines a widget with the same name as the @var{function}
+that will be called for each of the @var{key-sequence}s; this is like the
+@t{#compdef -k} tag. The function should generate the completions needed
+and will otherwise behave like the builtin widget whose name is given as
+the @var{style} argument. The widgets usable for this are:
+@t{complete-word}, @t{delete-char-or-list}, @t{expand-or-complete},
+@t{expand-or-complete-prefix}, @t{list-choices}, @t{menu-complete},
+@t{menu-expand-or-complete}, and @t{reverse-menu-complete}, as well as
+@t{menu-select} if the @t{zsh/complist} module is loaded. The option @t{-n}
+prevents the key being bound if it is already to bound to something other
+than @t{undefined-key}.
+
+@noindent
+The form with @t{-K} is similar and defines multiple widgets based on the
+same @var{function}, each of which requires the set of three arguments
+@var{name}, @var{style} and @var{key-seq}uence, where the latter two are as
+for @t{-k} and the first must be a unique widget name beginning with an
+underscore.
+
+@noindent
+Wherever applicable, the @t{-a} option makes the @var{function}
+autoloadable, equivalent to @t{autoload -U }@var{function}.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+The function @t{compdef} can be used to associate existing completion
+functions with new commands. For example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+compdef _pids foo
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+uses the function @t{_pids} to complete process IDs for the command @t{foo}.
+
+@noindent
+Note also the @t{_gnu_generic} function described below, which can be
+used to complete options for commands that understand the
+`@t{-}@t{-help}' option.
+
+@noindent
+@node Completion System Configuration, Control Functions, Initialization, Completion System
+
+@section Completion System Configuration
+@noindent
+@cindex completion system, configuration
+
+@noindent
+This section gives a short overview of how the completion system works,
+and then more detail on how users can configure how and when matches are
+generated.
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Overview
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+When completion is attempted somewhere on the command line the
+completion system begins building the context. The context represents
+everything that the shell knows about the meaning of the command line
+and the significance of the cursor position. This takes account of a
+number of things including the command word (such as `@t{grep}' or
+`@t{zsh}') and options to which the current word may be an argument
+(such as the `@t{-o}' option to @t{zsh} which takes a shell option as an
+argument).
+
+@noindent
+The context starts out very generic ("we are beginning a completion")
+and becomes more specific as more is learned ("the current word is in a
+position that is usually a command name" or "the current word might be a
+variable name" and so on). Therefore the context will vary during the
+same call to the completion system.
+
+@noindent
+This context information is condensed into a string consisting of multiple
+fields separated by colons, referred to simply as `the context' in the
+remainder of the documentation. Note that a user of the completion system
+rarely needs to compose a context string, unless for example a new
+function is being written to perform completion for a new command. What a
+user may need to do is compose a @emph{style} pattern, which is matched
+against a context when needed to look up context-sensitive options that
+configure the completion system.
+
+@noindent
+The next few paragraphs explain how a context is composed within the
+completion function suite. Following that is discussion of how @emph{styles}
+are defined. Styles determine such things as how the matches are
+generated, similarly to shell options but with much more control. They
+are defined with the @t{zstyle} builtin command (@ref{The zsh/zutil Module}).
+
+@noindent
+The context string always consists of a fixed set of fields, separated
+by colons and with a leading colon before the first. Fields which are
+not yet known are left empty, but the surrounding colons appear anyway.
+The fields are always in the order
+@t{:completion:}@var{function}@t{:}@var{completer}@t{:}@var{command}@t{:}@var{argument}@t{:}@var{tag}. These have the following meaning:
+
+@noindent
+@itemize @bullet
+
+@item
+The literal string @t{completion}, saying that this style is used by
+the completion system. This distinguishes the context from those used
+by, for example, zle widgets and ZFTP functions.
+
+@item
+The @var{function}, if completion is called from a named widget rather
+than through the normal completion system. Typically this is blank, but
+it is set by special widgets such as @t{predict-on} and the various
+functions in the @t{Widget} directory of the distribution to the name of
+that function, often in an abbreviated form.
+
+@item
+The @var{completer} currently active, the name of the function without the
+leading underscore and with other underscores converted to hyphens. A
+`completer' is in overall control of how completion is to be performed;
+`@t{complete}' is the simplest, but other completers exist to perform
+related tasks such as correction, or to modify the behaviour of a later
+completer. See
+@ref{Control Functions}
+for more information.
+
+@item
+The @var{command} or a special @t{-}@var{context}@t{-}, just at it appears
+following the @t{#compdef} tag or the @t{compdef} function. Completion
+functions for commands that have sub-commands usually modify this field
+to contain the name of the command followed by a minus sign and the
+sub-command. For example, the completion function for the @t{cvs}
+command sets this field to @t{cvs-add} when completing arguments to
+the @t{add} subcommand.
+
+@item
+The @var{argument}; this indicates which command line or option argument
+we are completing. For command arguments this generally takes the form
+@t{argument-}@var{n}, where @var{n} is the number of the argument,
+and for arguments to options the form @t{option-}@var{opt}@t{-}@var{n}
+where @var{n} is the number of the argument to option @var{opt}. However,
+this is only the case if the command line is parsed with standard
+UNIX-style options and arguments, so many completions do not set this.
+
+@item
+The @var{tag}. As described previously, tags are used to discriminate between
+the types of matches a completion function can generate in a certain context.
+Any completion function may use any tag name it likes, but a list of the
+more common ones is given below.
+
+@end itemize
+
+@noindent
+The context is gradually put together as the functions are executed, starting
+with the main entry point, which adds @t{:completion:} and the @var{function}
+element if necessary. The completer then adds the @var{completer} element.
+The contextual completion adds the @var{command} and @var{argument} options.
+Finally, the @var{tag} is added when the types of completion are known.
+For example, the context name
+
+@noindent
+@example
+@t{:completion::complete:dvips:option-o-1:files}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+says that normal completion was attempted as the first argument to the
+option @t{-o} of the command @t{dvips}:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+@t{dvips -o ...}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+and the completion function will generate filenames.
+
+@noindent
+Usually completion will be tried for all possible tags in an order given
+by the completion function. However, this can be altered by using the
+@t{tag-order} style. Completion is then restricted to the list of given
+tags in the given order.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{_complete_help} bindable command shows all the contexts and tags
+available for completion at a particular point. This provides an easy
+way of finding information for @t{tag-order} and other styles. It is
+described in
+@ref{Bindable Commands}.
+
+@noindent
+When looking up styles the completion system uses full context names,
+including the tag. Looking up the value of a style therefore consists of
+two things: the context, which is matched to the most specific (best
+fitting) style pattern, and the name of the style itself, which must be
+matched exactly. The following examples demonstrate that style patterns
+may be loosely defined for styles that apply broadly, or as tightly
+defined as desired for styles that apply in narrower circumstances.
+
+@noindent
+For example, many completion functions can generate matches in a
+simple and a verbose form and use the @t{verbose} style to decide
+which form should be used. To make all such functions use the verbose form,
+put
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle ':completion:*' verbose yes
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+in a startup file (probably @t{.zshrc}).
+This gives the @t{verbose} style the value @t{yes} in every
+context inside the completion system, unless that context has a more
+specific definition. It is best to avoid giving the context as `@t{*}'
+in case the style has some meaning outside the completion system.
+
+@noindent
+Many such general purpose styles can be configured simply by using the
+@t{compinstall} function.
+
+@noindent
+A more specific example of the use of the @t{verbose} style is by the
+completion for the @t{kill} builtin. If the style is set, the builtin
+lists full job texts and process command lines; otherwise it shows the
+bare job numbers and PIDs. To turn the style off for this use only:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle ':completion:*:*:kill:*:*' verbose no
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+For even more control, the style can use one of the tags `@t{jobs}' or
+`@t{processes}'. To turn off verbose display only for jobs:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle ':completion:*:*:kill:*:jobs' verbose no
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The @t{-e} option to @t{zstyle} even allows completion function code to
+appear as the argument to a style; this requires some understanding of
+the internals of completion functions (see
+@ref{Completion Widgets})). For example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+@t{zstyle -e ':completion:*' hosts 'reply=($myhosts)'}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+This forces the value of the @t{hosts} style to be read from the
+variable @t{myhosts} each time a host name is needed; this is useful
+if the value of @t{myhosts} can change dynamically.
+For another useful example, see the example in the description of the
+@t{file-list} style below. This form can be
+slow and should be avoided for commonly examined styles such
+as @t{menu} and @t{list-rows-first}.
+
+@noindent
+Note that the order in which styles are @emph{defined} does not matter; the
+style mechanism uses the most specific possible match for a particular
+style to determine the set of values. More precisely, strings are
+preferred over patterns (for example, `@t{:completion::complete:::foo}' is
+more specific than `@t{:completion::complete:::*'}), and longer patterns are
+preferred over shorter patterns.
+
+@noindent
+A good rule of thumb is that any completion style pattern that needs to
+include more than one wildcard (@t{*}) and that does not end in a tag
+name, should include all six colons (@t{:}), possibly surrounding
+additional wildcards.
+
+@noindent
+Style names like those of tags are arbitrary and depend on the completion
+function. However, the following two sections list some of the most
+common tags and styles.
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Standard Tags
+@noindent
+@cindex completion system, tags
+
+@noindent
+Some of the following are only used when looking up particular styles
+and do not refer to a type of match.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@kindex accounts, completion tag
+@item @t{accounts}
+used to look up the @t{users-hosts} style
+
+@kindex all-expansions, completion tag
+@item @t{all-expansions}
+used by the @t{_expand} completer when adding the single string containing
+all possible expansions
+
+@kindex all-files, completion tag
+@item @t{all-files}
+for the names of all files (as distinct from a particular subset, see the
+@t{globbed-files} tag).
+
+@kindex arguments, completion tag
+@item @t{arguments}
+for arguments to a command
+
+@kindex arrays, completion tag
+@item @t{arrays}
+for names of array parameters
+
+@kindex association-keys, completion tag
+@item @t{association-keys}
+for keys of associative arrays; used when completing inside a
+subscript to a parameter of this type
+
+@kindex bookmarks, completion tag
+@item @t{bookmarks}
+when completing bookmarks (e.g. for URLs and the @t{zftp} function suite)
+
+@kindex builtins, completion tag
+@item @t{builtins}
+for names of builtin commands
+
+@kindex characters, completion tag
+@item @t{characters}
+for single characters in arguments of commands such as @t{stty}. Also used
+when completing character classes after an opening bracket
+
+@kindex colormapids, completion tag
+@item @t{colormapids}
+for X colormap ids
+
+@kindex colors, completion tag
+@item @t{colors}
+for color names
+
+@kindex commands, completion tag
+@item @t{commands}
+for names of external commands. Also used by complex commands such as
+@t{cvs} when completing names subcommands.
+
+@kindex contexts, completion tag
+@item @t{contexts}
+for contexts in arguments to the @t{zstyle} builtin command
+
+@kindex corrections, completion tag
+@item @t{corrections}
+used by the @t{_approximate} and @t{_correct} completers for possible
+corrections
+
+@kindex cursors, completion tag
+@item @t{cursors}
+for cursor names used by X programs
+
+@kindex default, completion tag
+@item @t{default}
+used in some contexts to provide a way of supplying a default when more
+specific tags are also valid. Note that this tag is
+used when only the @var{function} field of the context name is set
+
+@kindex descriptions, completion tag
+@item @t{descriptions}
+used when looking up the value of the @t{format} style to generate
+descriptions for types of matches
+
+@kindex devices, completion tag
+@item @t{devices}
+for names of device special files
+
+@kindex directories, completion tag
+@item @t{directories}
+for names of directories --- @t{local-directories} is used instead
+when completing arguments of @t{cd} and related builtin commands when
+the @t{cdpath} array is set
+
+@kindex directory-stack, completion tag
+@item @t{directory-stack}
+for entries in the directory stack
+
+@kindex displays, completion tag
+@item @t{displays}
+for X display names
+
+@kindex domains, completion tag
+@item @t{domains}
+for network domains
+
+@kindex email-*, completion tag
+@item @t{email-}@var{plugin}
+for email addresses from the `@t{_email-}@var{plugin}' backend of @t{_email_addresses}
+
+@kindex expansions, completion tag
+@item @t{expansions}
+used by the @t{_expand} completer for individual words (as opposed to
+the complete set of expansions) resulting from the expansion of a word
+on the command line
+
+@kindex extensions, completion tag
+@item @t{extensions}
+for X server extensions
+
+@kindex file-descriptors, completion tag
+@item @t{file-descriptors}
+for numbers of open file descriptors
+
+@kindex files, completion tag
+@item @t{files}
+the generic file-matching tag used by functions completing filenames
+
+@kindex fonts, completion tag
+@item @t{fonts}
+for X font names
+
+@kindex fstypes, completion tag
+@item @t{fstypes}
+for file system types (e.g. for the @t{mount} command)
+
+@kindex functions, completion tag
+@item @t{functions}
+names of functions --- normally shell functions, although certain
+commands may understand other kinds of function
+
+@kindex globbed-files, completion tag
+@item @t{globbed-files}
+for filenames when the name has been generated by pattern matching
+
+@kindex groups, completion tag
+@item @t{groups}
+for names of user groups
+
+@kindex history-words, completion tag
+@item @t{history-words}
+for words from the history
+
+@kindex hosts, completion tag
+@item @t{hosts}
+for hostnames
+
+@kindex indexes, completion tag
+@item @t{indexes}
+for array indexes
+
+@kindex jobs, completion tag
+@item @t{jobs}
+for jobs (as listed by the `@t{jobs}' builtin)
+
+@kindex interfaces, completion tag
+@item @t{interfaces}
+for network interfaces
+
+@kindex keymaps, completion tag
+@item @t{keymaps}
+for names of zsh keymaps
+
+@kindex keysyms, completion tag
+@item @t{keysyms}
+for names of X keysyms
+
+@kindex libraries, completion tag
+@item @t{libraries}
+for names of system libraries
+
+@kindex limits, completion tag
+@item @t{limits}
+for system limits
+
+@kindex local-directories, completion tag
+@item @t{local-directories}
+for names of directories that are subdirectories of the current working
+directory when completing arguments of @t{cd} and related builtin
+commands (compare @t{path-directories}) --- when the @t{cdpath}
+array is unset, @t{directories} is used instead
+
+@kindex manuals, completion tag
+@item @t{manuals}
+for names of manual pages
+
+@kindex mailboxes, completion tag
+@item @t{mailboxes}
+for e-mail folders
+
+@kindex maps, completion tag
+@item @t{maps}
+for map names (e.g. NIS maps)
+
+@kindex messages, completion tag
+@item @t{messages}
+used to look up the @t{format} style for messages
+
+@kindex modifiers, completion tag
+@item @t{modifiers}
+for names of X modifiers
+
+@kindex modules, completion tag
+@item @t{modules}
+for modules (e.g. @t{zsh} modules)
+
+@kindex my-accounts, completion tag
+@item @t{my-accounts}
+used to look up the @t{users-hosts} style
+
+@kindex named-directories, completion tag
+@item @t{named-directories}
+for named directories (you wouldn't have guessed that, would you?)
+
+@kindex names, completion tag
+@item @t{names}
+for all kinds of names
+
+@kindex newsgroups, completion tag
+@item @t{newsgroups}
+for USENET groups
+
+@kindex nicknames, completion tag
+@item @t{nicknames}
+for nicknames of NIS maps
+
+@kindex options, completion tag
+@item @t{options}
+for command options
+
+@kindex original, completion tag
+@item @t{original}
+used by the @t{_approximate}, @t{_correct} and @t{_expand} completers when
+offering the original string as a match
+
+@kindex other-accounts, completion tag
+@item @t{other-accounts}
+used to look up the @t{users-hosts} style
+
+@kindex other-files, completion tag
+@item @t{other-files}
+for the names of any non-directory files. This is used instead
+of @t{all-files} when the @t{list-dirs-first} style is in effect.
+
+@kindex packages, completion tag
+@item @t{packages}
+for packages (e.g. @t{rpm} or installed @t{Debian} packages)
+
+@kindex parameters, completion tag
+@item @t{parameters}
+for names of parameters
+
+@kindex path-directories, completion tag
+@item @t{path-directories}
+for names of directories found by searching the @t{cdpath} array when
+completing arguments of @t{cd} and related builtin commands (compare
+@t{local-directories})
+
+@kindex paths, completion tag
+@item @t{paths}
+used to look up the values of the @t{expand}, @t{ambiguous} and
+@t{special-dirs} styles
+
+@kindex pods, completion tag
+@item @t{pods}
+for perl pods (documentation files)
+
+@kindex ports, completion tag
+@item @t{ports}
+for communication ports
+
+@kindex prefixes, completion tag
+@item @t{prefixes}
+for prefixes (like those of a URL)
+
+@kindex printers, completion tag
+@item @t{printers}
+for print queue names
+
+@kindex processes, completion tag
+@item @t{processes}
+for process identifiers
+
+@kindex processes-names, completion tag
+@item @t{processes-names}
+used to look up the @t{command} style when generating the names of
+processes for @t{killall}
+
+@kindex sequences, completion tag
+@item @t{sequences}
+for sequences (e.g. @t{mh} sequences)
+
+@kindex sessions, completion tag
+@item @t{sessions}
+for sessions in the @t{zftp} function suite
+
+@kindex signals, completion tag
+@item @t{signals}
+for signal names
+
+@kindex strings, completion tag
+@item @t{strings}
+for strings (e.g. the replacement strings for the @t{cd} builtin
+command)
+
+@kindex styles, completion tag
+@item @t{styles}
+for styles used by the zstyle builtin command
+
+@kindex suffixes, completion tag
+@item @t{suffixes}
+for filename extensions
+
+@kindex tags, completion tag
+@item @t{tags}
+for tags (e.g. @t{rpm} tags)
+
+@kindex targets, completion tag
+@item @t{targets}
+for makefile targets
+
+@kindex time-zones, completion tag
+@item @t{time-zones}
+for time zones (e.g. when setting the @t{TZ} parameter)
+
+@kindex types, completion tag
+@item @t{types}
+for types of whatever (e.g. address types for the @t{xhost} command)
+
+@kindex urls, completion tag
+@item @t{urls}
+used to look up the @t{urls} and @t{local} styles when completing URLs
+
+@kindex users, completion tag
+@item @t{users}
+for usernames
+
+@kindex values, completion tag
+@item @t{values}
+for one of a set of values in certain lists
+
+@kindex variant, completion tag
+@item @t{variant}
+used by @t{_pick_variant} to look up the command to run when determining
+what program is installed for a particular command name.
+
+@kindex visuals, completion tag
+@item @t{visuals}
+for X visuals
+
+@kindex warnings, completion tag
+@item @t{warnings}
+used to look up the @t{format} style for warnings
+
+@kindex widgets, completion tag
+@item @t{widgets}
+for zsh widget names
+
+@kindex windows, completion tag
+@item @t{windows}
+for IDs of X windows
+
+@kindex zsh-options, completion tag
+@item @t{zsh-options}
+for shell options
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Standard Styles
+@noindent
+@cindex completion system, styles
+
+@noindent
+Note that the values of several of these styles represent boolean
+values. Any of the strings `@t{true}', `@t{on}',
+`@t{yes}', and `@t{1}' can be used for the value `true' and
+any of the strings `@t{false}', `@t{off}', `@t{no}', and `@t{0}' for
+the value `false'. The behavior for any other value is undefined
+except where explicitly mentioned. The default value may
+be either `true' or `false' if the style is not set.
+
+@noindent
+Some of these styles are tested first for every possible tag
+corresponding to a type of match, and if no style was found, for the
+@t{default} tag. The most notable styles of this type are @t{menu},
+@t{list-colors} and styles controlling completion listing such as
+@t{list-packed} and @t{last-prompt}. When tested for the @t{default}
+tag, only the @var{function} field of the context will be set so that
+a style using the @t{default} tag will normally be defined along the lines of:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle ':completion:*:default' menu ...
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@kindex accept-exact, completion style
+@item @t{accept-exact}
+This is tested for the @t{default} tag in addition to the tags valid for
+the current context. If it is set to `true' and any of the trial
+matches is the same as the string on the command line, this match will
+immediately be accepted (even if it would otherwise be considered
+ambiguous).
+
+@noindent
+When completing pathnames (where the tag used is `@t{paths}')
+this style accepts any number of patterns as the value in addition to
+the boolean values. Pathnames matching one of these
+patterns will be accepted immediately even if the command line contains
+some more partially typed pathname components and these match no file
+under the directory accepted.
+
+@noindent
+This style is also used by the @t{_expand} completer to decide if
+words beginning with a tilde or parameter expansion should be
+expanded. For example, if there are parameters
+@t{foo} and @t{foobar}, the string `@t{$foo}' will only be expanded if
+@t{accept-exact} is set to `true'; otherwise the completion system will
+be allowed to complete @t{$foo} to @t{$foobar}. If the style is set to
+`@t{continue}', @t{_expand} will add the expansion as a match and the completion
+system will also be allowed to continue.
+
+@kindex accept-exact-dirs, completion style
+@item @t{accept-exact-dirs}
+This is used by filename completion. Unlike @t{accept-exact} it is
+a boolean. By default, filename completion examines all components
+of a path to see if there are completions of that component, even if
+the component matches an existing directory. For example, when
+completion after @t{/usr/bin/}, the function examines possible
+completions to @t{/usr}.
+
+@noindent
+When this style is `true', any prefix of a path that matches an existing
+directory is accepted without any attempt to complete it further.
+Hence, in the given example, the path @t{/usr/bin/} is accepted
+immediately and completion tried in that directory.
+
+@noindent
+This style is also useful when completing after directories that
+magically appear when referenced, such as ZFS @t{.zfs} directories
+or NetApp @t{.snapshot} directories. When the style is set the
+shell does not check for the existence of the directory within the
+parent directory.
+
+@noindent
+If you wish to inhibit this behaviour entirely, set the @t{path-completion}
+style (see below) to `false'.
+
+@kindex add-space, completion style
+@item @t{add-space}
+This style is used by the @t{_expand} completer. If it is `true' (the
+default), a space will be inserted after all words resulting from the
+expansion, or a slash in the case of directory names. If the value
+is `@t{file}', the completer will only add a space
+to names of existing files. Either a boolean `true' or the value
+`@t{file}' may be combined with `@t{subst}', in which case the completer
+will not add a space to words generated from the expansion of a
+substitution of the form `@t{$(}@var{...}@t{)}' or `@t{$@{}@var{...}@t{@}}'.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{_prefix} completer uses this style as a simple boolean value
+to decide if a space should be inserted before the suffix.
+
+@kindex ambiguous, completion style
+@item @t{ambiguous}
+This applies when completing non-final components of filename paths, in
+other words those with a trailing slash. If it is set, the cursor is
+left after the first ambiguous component, even if menu completion is in
+use. The style is always tested with the @t{paths} tag.
+
+@kindex assign-list, completion style
+@item @t{assign-list}
+When completing after an equals sign that is being treated as an
+assignment, the completion system normally completes only one filename.
+In some cases the value may be a list of filenames separated by colons,
+as with @t{PATH} and similar parameters. This style can be set to a
+list of patterns matching the names of such parameters.
+
+@noindent
+The default is to complete lists when the word on the line already
+contains a colon.
+
+@kindex auto-description, completion style
+@item @t{auto-description}
+If set, this style's value will be used as the description for options that
+are not described by the completion functions, but that have exactly
+one argument. The sequence `@t{%d}' in the value will be replaced by
+the description for this argument. Depending on personal preferences,
+it may be useful to set this style to something like `@t{specify: %d}'.
+Note that this may not work for some commands.
+
+@kindex avoid-completer, completion style
+@item @t{avoid-completer}
+This is used by the @t{_all_matches} completer to decide if the string
+consisting of all matches should be added to the list currently being
+generated. Its value is a list of names of completers. If any of
+these is the name of the completer that generated the matches in this
+completion, the string will not be added.
+
+@noindent
+The default value for this style is `@t{_expand _old_list _correct
+_approximate}', i.e. it contains the completers for which a string
+with all matches will almost never be wanted.
+
+@kindex cache-path, completion style
+@item @t{cache-path}
+This style defines the path where any cache files containing dumped
+completion data are stored. It defaults to `@t{$ZDOTDIR/.zcompcache}', or
+`@t{$HOME/.zcompcache}' if @t{$ZDOTDIR} is not defined. The completion
+cache will not be used unless the @t{use-cache} style is set.
+
+@kindex cache-policy, completion style
+@item @t{cache-policy}
+This style defines the function that will be used to determine whether
+a cache needs rebuilding. See the section on the @t{_cache_invalid}
+function below.
+
+@kindex call-command, completion style
+@item @t{call-command}
+This style is used in the function for commands such as @t{make} and
+@t{ant} where calling the command directly to generate matches suffers
+problems such as being slow or, as in the case of @t{make} can
+potentially cause actions in the makefile to be executed. If it is set
+to `true' the command is called to generate matches. The default value
+of this style is `false'.
+
+@kindex command, completion style
+@item @t{command}
+In many places, completion functions need to call external commands to
+generate the list of completions. This style can be used to override the
+command that is called in some such cases. The elements of the value are
+joined with spaces to form a command line to execute. The value can also
+start with a hyphen, in which case the usual command will be added to the
+end; this is most useful for putting `@t{builtin}' or `@t{command}' in
+front to make sure the appropriate version of a command is called, for
+example to avoid calling a shell function with the same name as an external
+command.
+
+@noindent
+As an example, the completion function for process IDs uses this
+style with the @t{processes} tag to generate the IDs to complete and
+the list of processes to display (if the @t{verbose} style is `true').
+The list produced by the command should look like the output of the
+@t{ps} command. The first line is not displayed, but is searched for
+the string `@t{PID}' (or `@t{pid}') to find the position of the
+process IDs in the following lines. If the line does not contain
+`@t{PID}', the first numbers in each of the other lines are taken as the
+process IDs to complete.
+
+@noindent
+Note that the completion function generally has to call the specified
+command for each attempt to generate the completion list. Hence
+care should be taken to specify only commands that take a short
+time to run, and in particular to avoid any that may never terminate.
+
+@kindex command-path, completion style
+@item @t{command-path}
+This is a list of directories to search for commands to complete. The
+default for this style is the value of the special parameter @t{path}.
+
+@kindex commands, completion style
+@item @t{commands}
+This is used by the function completing sub-commands for the system
+initialisation scripts (residing in @t{/etc/init.d} or somewhere not
+too far away from that). Its values give the default commands to
+complete for those commands for which the completion function isn't
+able to find them out automatically. The default for this style are
+the two strings `@t{start}' and `@t{stop}'.
+
+@kindex complete, completion style
+@item @t{complete}
+This is used by the @t{_expand_alias} function when invoked as a
+bindable command. If set to `true' and the word on the command
+line is not the name of an alias, matching alias names will be
+completed.
+
+@kindex complete-options, completion style
+@item @t{complete-options}
+This is used by the completer for @t{cd}, @t{chdir} and @t{pushd}.
+For these commands a @t{-} is used to introduce a directory stack entry
+and completion of these is far more common than completing options.
+Hence unless the value of this style is `true' options will not be
+completed, even after an initial @t{-}. If it is `true', options will
+be completed after an initial @t{-} unless there is a preceding
+@t{-}@t{-} on the command line.
+
+@kindex completer, completion style
+@item @t{completer}
+The strings given as the value of this style provide the names of the
+completer functions to use. The available completer functions are
+described in
+@ref{Control Functions}.
+
+@noindent
+Each string may be either the name of a completer function or a string
+of the form `@var{function}@t{:}@var{name}'. In the first case the
+@var{completer} field of the context will contain the name of the
+completer without the leading underscore and with all other
+underscores replaced by hyphens. In the second case the
+@var{function} is the name of the completer to call, but the context
+will contain the user-defined @var{name} in the @var{completer} field of
+the context. If the @var{name} starts with a hyphen, the string for the
+context will be build from the name of the completer function as in
+the first case with the @var{name} appended to it. For example:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle ':completion:*' completer _complete _complete:-foo
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Here, completion will call the @t{_complete} completer twice, once
+using `@t{complete}' and once using `@t{complete-foo}' in the
+@var{completer} field of the context. Normally, using the same
+completer more than once only makes sense when used with the
+`@var{functions}@t{:}@var{name}' form, because otherwise the context
+name will be the same in all calls to the completer; possible
+exceptions to this rule are the @t{_ignored} and @t{_prefix}
+completers.
+
+@noindent
+The default value for this style is `@t{_complete _ignored}':
+only completion will be done, first using the @t{ignored-patterns} style
+and the @t{$fignore} array and then without ignoring matches.
+
+@kindex condition, completion style
+@item @t{condition}
+This style is used by the @t{_list} completer function to decide if
+insertion of matches should be delayed unconditionally. The default is
+`true'.
+
+@kindex delimiters, completion style
+@item @t{delimiters}
+This style is used when adding a delimiter for use with history
+modifiers or glob qualifiers that have delimited arguments. It is
+an array of preferred delimiters to add. Non-special characters are
+preferred as the completion system may otherwise become confused.
+The default list is @t{:}, @t{+}, @t{/}, @t{-}, @t{%}. The list
+may be empty to force a delimiter to be typed.
+
+@kindex disabled, completion style
+@item @t{disabled}
+If this is set to `true', the @t{_expand_alias} completer and bindable
+command will try to expand disabled aliases, too. The default is
+`false'.
+
+@kindex domains, completion style
+@item @t{domains}
+A list of names of network domains for completion.
+If this is not set, domain names will be taken from
+the file @t{/etc/resolv.conf}.
+
+@kindex environ, completion style
+@item @t{environ}
+The environ style is used when completing for `@t{sudo}'. It is set to an
+array of `@var{VAR}@t{=}@var{value}' assignments to be exported into the
+local environment before the completion for the target command is invoked.
+@example
+zstyle ':completion:*:sudo::' environ \
+ PATH="/sbin:/usr/sbin:$PATH" HOME="/root"
+@end example
+
+@kindex expand, completion style
+@item @t{expand}
+This style is used when completing strings consisting of multiple
+parts, such as path names.
+
+@noindent
+If one of its values is the string `@t{prefix}', the partially typed
+word from the line will be expanded as far as possible even if trailing
+parts cannot be completed.
+
+@noindent
+If one of its values is the string `@t{suffix}', matching names for
+components after the first ambiguous one will also be added. This means
+that the resulting string is the longest unambiguous string possible.
+However, menu completion can be used to cycle through all matches.
+
+@kindex fake, completion style
+@item @t{fake}
+This style may be set for any completion context. It
+specifies additional strings that will always be completed in that
+context. The form of each string is `@var{value}@t{:}@var{description}';
+the colon and description may be omitted, but any literal colons in
+@var{value} must be quoted with a backslash. Any @var{description}
+provided is shown alongside the value in completion listings.
+
+@noindent
+It is important to use a sufficiently restrictive context when specifying
+fake strings. Note that the styles @t{fake-files} and @t{fake-parameters}
+provide additional features when completing files or parameters.
+
+@kindex fake-always, completion style
+@item @t{fake-always}
+This works identically to the @t{fake} style except that
+the @t{ignored-patterns} style is not applied to it. This makes it
+possible to override a set of matches completely by setting the
+ignored patterns to `@t{*}'.
+
+@noindent
+The following shows a way of supplementing any tag with arbitrary data, but
+having it behave for display purposes like a separate tag. In this example
+we use the features of the @t{tag-order} style to divide the
+@t{named-directories} tag into two when performing completion with
+the standard completer @t{complete} for arguments of @t{cd}. The tag
+@t{named-directories-normal} behaves as normal, but the tag
+@t{named-directories-mine} contains a fixed set of directories.
+This has the effect of adding the match group `@t{extra directories}' with
+the given completions.
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle ':completion::complete:cd:*' tag-order \
+ 'named-directories:-mine:extra\ directories
+ named-directories:-normal:named\ directories *'
+zstyle ':completion::complete:cd:*:named-directories-mine' \
+ fake-always mydir1 mydir2
+zstyle ':completion::complete:cd:*:named-directories-mine' \
+ ignored-patterns '*'
+@end example
+
+@kindex fake-files, completion style
+@item @t{fake-files}
+This style is used when completing files and looked up
+without a tag. Its values are of the form
+`@var{dir}@t{:}@var{names...}'. This will add the @var{names} (strings
+separated by spaces) as
+possible matches when completing in the directory @var{dir}, even if no
+such files really exist. The dir may be a pattern; pattern characters
+or colons in @var{dir} should be quoted with a backslash to be treated
+literally.
+
+@noindent
+This can be useful on systems that support special file systems whose
+top-level pathnames can not be listed or generated with glob patterns
+(but see @t{accept-exact-dirs} for a more general way of dealing
+with this problem). It can also be used for directories for which one
+does not have read permission.
+
+@noindent
+The pattern form can be used to add a certain `magic' entry
+to all directories on a particular file system.
+
+@kindex fake-parameters, completion style
+@item @t{fake-parameters}
+This is used by the completion function for parameter names.
+Its values are names of parameters that might not yet be
+set but should be completed nonetheless. Each name may also be
+followed by a colon and a string specifying the type of the parameter
+(like `@t{scalar}', `@t{array}' or `@t{integer}'). If the type is
+given, the name will only be completed if parameters of that type are
+required in the particular context. Names for which no type is
+specified will always be completed.
+
+@kindex file-list, completion style
+@item @t{file-list}
+This style controls whether files completed using the standard builtin
+mechanism are to be listed with a long list similar to @t{ls -l}.
+Note that this feature uses the shell module
+@t{zsh/stat} for file information; this loads the builtin @t{stat}
+which will replace any external @t{stat} executable. To avoid
+this the following code can be included in an initialization file:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zmodload -i zsh/stat
+disable stat
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The style may either be set to a `true' value (or `@t{all}'), or
+one of the values `@t{insert}' or `@t{list}', indicating that files
+are to be listed in long format in all circumstances, or when
+attempting to insert a file name, or when listing file names
+without attempting to insert one.
+
+@noindent
+More generally, the value may be an array of any of the above values,
+optionally followed by @t{=}@var{num}. If @var{num} is present it
+gives the maximum number of matches for which long listing style
+will be used. For example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle ':completion:*' file-list list=20 insert=10
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+specifies that long format will be used when listing up to 20 files
+or inserting a file with up to 10 matches (assuming a listing
+is to be shown at all, for example on an ambiguous completion), else short
+format will be used.
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle -e ':completion:*' file-list \
+ '(( $@{+NUMERIC@} )) && reply=(true)'
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+specifies that long format will be used any time a numeric argument is
+supplied, else short format.
+
+@kindex file-patterns, completion style
+@item @t{file-patterns}
+This is used by the standard function for completing filenames,
+@t{_files}. If the style is unset up to three tags are offered,
+`@t{globbed-files}',`@t{directories}' and `@t{all-files}', depending on
+the types of files expected by the caller of @t{_files}. The first two
+(`@t{globbed-files}' and `@t{directories}') are normally offered
+together to make it easier to complete files in sub-directories.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{file-patterns} style provides alternatives to the default tags,
+which are not used. Its value consists of elements of the form
+`@var{pattern}@t{:}@var{tag}'; each string may contain any number of
+such specifications separated by spaces.
+
+@noindent
+The @var{pattern} is a pattern that is to be used to generate filenames.
+Any occurrence of the sequence `@t{%p}' is replaced by any
+pattern(s)
+passed by the function calling @t{_files}. Colons in the pattern must
+be preceded by a backslash to make them distinguishable from the colon
+before the @var{tag}. If more than one pattern is needed, the patterns
+can be given inside braces, separated by commas.
+
+@noindent
+The @var{tag}s of all strings in the value will be offered by @t{_files}
+and used when looking up other styles. Any @var{tag}s in the same
+word will be offered at the same time and before later words.
+If no `@t{:}@var{tag}' is given the `@t{files}' tag will be used.
+
+@noindent
+The @var{tag} may also be followed by an optional second colon and a
+description, which will be used for the `@t{%d}' in the value of
+the @t{format} style (if that is set) instead of the default
+description supplied by the completion function. If the description
+given here contains itself a `@t{%d}', that is replaced with the
+description supplied by the completion function.
+
+@noindent
+For example, to make the @t{rm} command first complete only names of
+object files and then the names of all files if there is no matching
+object file:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle ':completion:*:*:rm:*:*' file-patterns \
+ '*.o:object-files' '%p:all-files'
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+To alter the default behaviour of file completion --- offer files
+matching a pattern and directories on the first attempt, then all files
+--- to offer only matching files on the first attempt, then directories,
+and finally all files:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle ':completion:*' file-patterns \
+ '%p:globbed-files' '*(-/):directories' '*:all-files'
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+This works even where there is no special pattern: @t{_files} matches
+all files using the pattern `@t{*}' at the first step and stops when it
+sees this pattern. Note also it will never try a pattern more than once
+for a single completion attempt.
+
+@noindent
+During the execution of completion functions, the @t{EXTENDED_GLOB}
+option is in effect, so the characters `@t{#}', `@t{~}' and `@t{^}' have
+special meanings in the patterns.
+
+@kindex file-sort, completion style
+@item @t{file-sort}
+The standard filename completion function uses this style without a tag
+to determine in which order the names should be listed; menu completion
+will cycle through them in the same order. The possible
+values are: `@t{size}' to sort by the size of the file;
+`@t{links}' to sort by the number of links to the file;
+`@t{modification}' (or `@t{time}' or `@t{date}') to sort by the last
+modification time; `@t{access}' to sort by the last access time; and
+`@t{inode}' (or `@t{change}') to sort by the last inode change
+time. If the style is set to any other value, or is unset, files will be
+sorted alphabetically by name. If the value contains the string
+`@t{reverse}', sorting is done in the opposite order. If the value
+contains the string `@t{follow}', timestamps are associated with the
+targets of symbolic links; the default is to use the timestamps
+of the links themselves.
+
+@kindex file-split-chars, completion style
+@item @t{file-split-chars}
+A set of characters that will cause @emph{all} file completions for
+the given context to be split at the point where any of the characters
+occurs. A typical use is to set the style to @t{:}; then everything
+up to and including the last @t{:} in the string so far is ignored when
+completing files. As this is quite heavy-handed, it is usually
+preferable to update completion functions for contexts where this
+behaviour is useful.
+
+@kindex filter, completion style
+@item @t{filter}
+The @t{ldap} plugin of email address completion (see @t{_email_addresses}) uses
+this style to specify
+the attributes to match against when filtering entries. So for example, if
+the style is set to `@t{sn}', matching is done against surnames. Standard
+LDAP filtering is used so normal completion matching is bypassed. If this
+style is not set, the LDAP plugin is skipped. You may also need to set the
+@t{command} style to specify how to connect to your LDAP server.
+
+@kindex force-list, completion style
+@item @t{force-list}
+This forces a list of completions to be shown at any point where listing is
+done, even in cases where the list would usually be suppressed.
+For example, normally the list is only shown if
+there are at least two different matches. By setting this style to
+`@t{always}', the list will always be shown, even if there is only a
+single match that will immediately be accepted. The style may also
+be set to a number. In this case the list will be shown if there are
+at least that many matches, even if they would all insert the same
+string.
+
+@noindent
+This style is tested for the default tag as well as for each tag valid
+for the current completion. Hence the listing can be forced only for
+certain types of match.
+
+@kindex format, completion style
+@item @t{format}
+If this is set for the @t{descriptions} tag, its value is used as a
+string to display above matches in completion lists. The sequence
+`@t{%d}' in this string will be replaced with a short description of
+what these matches are. This string may also contain the output
+attribute sequences understood by @t{compadd -X}
+(see
+@ref{Completion Widgets}).
+
+@noindent
+The style is tested with each tag valid for the current completion
+before it is tested for the @t{descriptions} tag. Hence different format
+strings can be defined for different types of match.
+
+@noindent
+Note also that some completer functions define additional
+`@t{%}'-sequences. These are described for the completer functions that
+make use of them.
+
+@noindent
+Some completion functions display messages that may be customised by
+setting this style for the @t{messages} tag. Here, the `@t{%d}' is
+replaced with a message given by the completion function.
+
+@noindent
+Finally, the format string is looked up with the @t{warnings} tag,
+for use when no matches could be generated at all. In this case the
+`@t{%d}' is replaced with the descriptions for the matches that were
+expected separated by spaces. The sequence `@t{%D}' is replaced with
+the same descriptions separated by newlines.
+
+@noindent
+It is possible to use printf-style field width specifiers with `@t{%d}'
+and similar escape sequences. This is handled by the @t{zformat}
+builtin command from the @t{zsh/zutil} module, see
+@ref{The zsh/zutil Module}.
+
+@kindex glob, completion style
+@item @t{glob}
+This is used by the @t{_expand} completer. If
+it is set to `true' (the default), globbing will be attempted on the
+words resulting from a previous substitution (see the @t{substitute}
+style) or else the original string from the line.
+
+@kindex global, completion style
+@item @t{global}
+If this is set to `true' (the default), the @t{_expand_alias}
+completer and bindable command will try to expand global aliases.
+
+@kindex group-name, completion style
+@item @t{group-name}
+The completion system can group different types of matches, which appear
+in separate lists. This style can be used to give the names of groups
+for particular tags. For example, in command position the completion
+system generates names of builtin and external commands, names of
+aliases, shell functions and parameters and reserved words as possible
+completions. To have the external commands and shell functions listed
+separately:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle ':completion:*:*:-command-:*:commands' \
+ group-name commands
+zstyle ':completion:*:*:-command-:*:functions' \
+ group-name functions
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+As a consequence, any match with the same tag will be displayed in the
+same group.
+
+@noindent
+If the name given is the empty string the name of the tag for
+the matches will be used as the name of the group. So, to have all
+different types of matches displayed separately, one can just set:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle ':completion:*' group-name @value{dsq}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+All matches for which no group name is defined will be put in a group
+named @t{-default-}.
+
+@kindex group-order, completion style
+@item @t{group-order}
+This style is additional to the @t{group-name} style to specify the
+order for display of the groups defined by that style (compare @t{tag-order},
+which determines which completions appear at all). The groups named
+are shown in the given order; any other groups
+are shown in the order defined by the completion function.
+
+@noindent
+For example, to have names of builtin commands, shell functions and
+external commands appear in that order when completing in command
+position:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle ':completion:*:*:-command-:*:*' group-order \
+ builtins functions commands
+@end example
+
+@kindex groups, completion style
+@item @t{groups}
+A list of names of UNIX groups. If this is not set,
+group names are taken from the YP database or the file `@t{/etc/group}'.
+
+@kindex hidden, completion style
+@item @t{hidden}
+If this is set to `true', matches for the given context
+will not be listed, although
+any description for the matches set with the @t{format} style will be
+shown. If it is set to `@t{all}', not even the description will be
+displayed.
+
+@noindent
+Note that the matches will still be completed; they are just not shown
+in the list. To avoid having matches considered as possible
+completions at all, the @t{tag-order} style can be modified as described
+below.
+
+@kindex hosts, completion style
+@item @t{hosts}
+A list of names of hosts that should be completed. If this is not set,
+hostnames are taken from the file `@t{/etc/hosts}'.
+
+@kindex hosts-ports, completion style
+@item @t{hosts-ports}
+This style is used by commands that need or accept hostnames and
+network ports. The strings in the value should be of the form
+`@var{host}@t{:}@var{port}'. Valid ports are determined by the presence
+of hostnames; multiple ports for the same host may appear.
+
+@kindex ignore-line, completion style
+@item @t{ignore-line}
+This is tested for each tag valid for the current completion. If
+it is set to `true', none of the words that are already on the line
+will be considered as possible completions. If it is set to
+`@t{current}', the word the cursor is on will not be considered as a
+possible completion. The value `@t{current-shown}' is similar but only
+applies if the list of completions is currently shown on the screen.
+Finally, if the style is set to `@t{other}', all words on the line except
+for the current one will be excluded from the possible completions.
+
+@noindent
+The values `@t{current}' and `@t{current-shown}' are a bit like the
+opposite of the @t{accept-exact} style: only strings with
+missing characters will be completed.
+
+@noindent
+Note that you almost certainly don't want to set this to `true' or
+`@t{other}' for a general
+context such as `@t{:completion:*}'. This is because it would disallow
+completion of, for example, options multiple times even if the command
+in question accepts the option more than once.
+
+@kindex ignore-parents, completion style
+@item @t{ignore-parents}
+The style is tested without a tag by the function completing pathnames
+in order to determine whether to ignore
+the names of directories already mentioned in the current word, or the
+name of the current working directory. The value must include one or both
+of the following strings:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{parent}
+The name of any directory whose path is already contained in the word on
+the line is ignored. For example, when completing after @t{foo/../}, the
+directory @t{foo} will not be considered a valid completion.
+
+@item @t{pwd}
+The name of the current working directory will not be completed; hence,
+for example, completion after @t{../} will not use the name of the current
+directory.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+In addition, the value may include one or both of:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{..}
+Ignore the specified directories only when the word on the line contains
+the substring `@t{../}'.
+
+@item @t{directory}
+Ignore the specified directories only when names of directories are
+completed, not when completing names of files.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+Excluded values act in a similar fashion to values of the
+@t{ignored-patterns} style, so they can be restored to consideration by
+the @t{_ignored} completer.
+
+@kindex extra-verbose, completion style
+@item @t{extra-verbose}
+If set, the completion listing is more verbose at the cost of
+a probable decrease in completion speed. Completion performance
+will suffer if this style is set to `true'.
+
+@kindex ignored-patterns, completion style
+@item @t{ignored-patterns}
+A list of patterns; any trial completion matching one of the patterns
+will be excluded from consideration. The
+@t{_ignored} completer can appear in the list of completers to
+restore the ignored matches. This is a more configurable
+version of the shell parameter @t{$fignore}.
+
+@noindent
+Note that the
+@t{EXTENDED_GLOB} option is set during the execution of completion
+functions, so the characters `@t{#}', `@t{~}' and `@t{^}' have special
+meanings in the patterns.
+
+@kindex insert, completion style
+@item @t{insert}
+This style is used by the @t{_all_matches} completer to decide whether to
+insert the list of all matches unconditionally instead of adding the
+list as another match.
+
+@kindex insert-ids, completion style
+@item @t{insert-ids}
+When completing process IDs, for example as arguments to the @t{kill} and
+@t{wait} builtins the name of a
+command may be converted to the appropriate process ID. A problem
+arises when the process name typed is not unique. By default (or if this
+style is set explicitly to `@t{menu}') the name will be converted
+immediately to a set of possible IDs, and menu completion will be started
+to cycle through them.
+
+@noindent
+If the value of the style is `@t{single}',
+the shell will wait until the user has typed enough to make the command
+unique before converting the name to an ID; attempts at completion will
+be unsuccessful until that point. If the value is any other
+string, menu completion will be started when the string typed by the
+user is longer than the common prefix to the corresponding IDs.
+
+@kindex insert-tab, completion style
+@item @t{insert-tab}
+If this is set to `true', the completion system will
+insert a TAB character (assuming that was used to start completion) instead
+of performing completion when there is no non-blank character to the left
+of the cursor. If it is set to `false', completion will be done even there.
+
+@noindent
+The value may also contain the substrings `@t{pending}' or
+`@t{pending=}@var{val}'. In this case, the typed character will be
+inserted instead of starting completion when there is unprocessed input
+pending. If a @var{val} is given, completion will not be done if there
+are at least that many characters of unprocessed input. This is often
+useful when pasting characters into a terminal. Note
+however, that it relies on the @t{$PENDING} special parameter from the
+@t{zsh/zle} module being set properly which is not guaranteed on all
+platforms.
+
+@noindent
+The default value of this style is `true' except for completion within
+@t{vared} builtin command where it is `false'.
+
+@kindex insert-unambiguous, completion style
+@item @t{insert-unambiguous}
+This is used by the @t{_match} and @t{_approximate} completers.
+These completers are often used with menu completion since the word typed
+may bear little resemblance to the final completion.
+However, if this style is `true', the completer will start menu
+completion only if it could find no unambiguous initial string at
+least as long as the original string typed by the user.
+
+@noindent
+In the case of the @t{_approximate} completer, the completer
+field in the context will already have been set to one of
+@t{correct-}@var{num} or @t{approximate-}@var{num}, where @var{num} is the
+number of errors that were accepted.
+
+@noindent
+In the case of the @t{_match} completer, the style may also be set to
+the string `@t{pattern}'. Then the pattern on the line is left
+unchanged if it does not match unambiguously.
+
+@kindex gain-privileges, completion style
+@item @t{gain-privileges}
+If set to @t{true}, this style enables the use of commands like @t{sudo}
+or @t{doas} to gain extra privileges when retrieving information for
+completion. This is only done when a command such as @t{sudo} appears on
+the command-line. To force the use of, e.g. @t{sudo} or to override any
+prefix that might be added due to @t{gain-privileges}, the @t{command}
+style can be used with a value that begins with a hyphen.
+
+@kindex keep-prefix, completion style
+@item @t{keep-prefix}
+This style is used by the @t{_expand} completer. If it is `true', the
+completer will try to keep a prefix containing a tilde or parameter
+expansion. Hence, for example, the string `@t{~/f*}' would be expanded to
+`@t{~/foo}' instead of `@t{/home/user/foo}'. If the style is set to
+`@t{changed}' (the default), the prefix will only be left unchanged if
+there were other changes between the expanded words and the original
+word from the command line. Any other value forces the prefix to be
+expanded unconditionally.
+
+@noindent
+The behaviour of @t{_expand} when this style is `true' is to cause @t{_expand}
+to give up when a single expansion with the restored prefix is the same
+as the original; hence any remaining completers may be called.
+
+@kindex last-prompt, completion style
+@item @t{last-prompt}
+This is a more flexible form of the @t{ALWAYS_LAST_PROMPT} option.
+If it is `true', the completion system will try to return the cursor to
+the previous command line after displaying a completion list. It is
+tested for all tags valid for the current completion, then the
+@t{default} tag. The cursor will be moved back to the
+previous line if this style is `true' for all types of match. Note
+that unlike the @t{ALWAYS_LAST_PROMPT} option this is independent of the
+numeric argument.
+
+@kindex known-hosts-files
+@item @t{known-hosts-files}
+This style should contain a list of files to search for host names and
+(if the @t{use-ip} style is set) IP addresses in a format compatible with
+ssh @t{known_hosts} files. If it is not set, the files
+@t{/etc/ssh/ssh_known_hosts} and @t{~/.ssh/known_hosts} are used.
+
+@kindex list, completion style
+@item @t{list}
+This style is used by the @t{_history_complete_word} bindable command.
+If it is set to `true' it has no effect. If it is set to `false'
+matches will not be listed. This overrides the setting of the options
+controlling listing behaviour, in particular @t{AUTO_LIST}. The context
+always starts with `@t{:completion:history-words}'.
+
+@kindex list-colors, completion style
+@item @t{list-colors}
+If the @t{zsh/complist} module is loaded, this style can be used to set
+color specifications. This mechanism replaces the use of the
+@t{ZLS_COLORS} and @t{ZLS_COLOURS} parameters described in
+@ref{The zsh/complist Module}, but the syntax is the same.
+
+@noindent
+If this style is set for the @t{default} tag, the strings in the value
+are taken as specifications that are to be used everywhere. If it is
+set for other tags, the specifications are used only for matches of
+the type described by the tag. For this to work best, the @t{group-name}
+style must be set to an empty string.
+
+@noindent
+In addition to setting styles for specific tags, it is also possible to
+use group names specified explicitly by the @t{group-name} tag together
+with the `@t{(group)}' syntax allowed by the @t{ZLS_COLORS} and
+@t{ZLS_COLOURS} parameters and simply using the @t{default} tag.
+
+@noindent
+It is possible to use any color specifications already set up for the GNU
+version of the @t{ls} command:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle ':completion:*:default' list-colors \
+ $@{(s.:.)LS_COLORS@}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The default colors are the same as for the GNU @t{ls} command and can be
+obtained by setting the style to an empty string (i.e. @t{@value{dsq}}).
+
+@kindex list-dirs-first, completion style
+@item @t{list-dirs-first}
+This is used by file completion. If set, directories to be completed
+are listed separately from and before completion for other files,
+regardless of tag ordering. In addition, the tag @t{other-files}
+is used in place of @t{all-files} for the remaining files, to indicate
+that no directories are presented with that tag.
+
+@kindex list-grouped, completion style
+@item @t{list-grouped}
+If this style is `true' (the default), the completion system will try to
+make certain completion listings more compact by grouping matches.
+For example, options for commands that have the same description (shown
+when the @t{verbose} style is set to `true') will appear as a single
+entry. However, menu selection can be used to cycle through all the
+matches.
+
+@kindex list-packed, completion style
+@item @t{list-packed}
+This is tested for each tag valid in the current context as well as the
+@t{default} tag. If it is set to `true', the corresponding matches
+appear in listings as if the @t{LIST_PACKED} option were set. If it is
+set to `false', they are listed normally.
+
+@kindex list-prompt, completion style
+@item @t{list-prompt}
+If this style is set for the @t{default} tag,
+completion lists that don't fit on the screen can be scrolled (see
+@ref{The zsh/complist Module}). The value, if not the empty string, will be displayed after every
+screenful and the shell will prompt for a key press; if the style is
+set to the empty string,
+a default prompt will be used.
+
+@noindent
+The value may contain the escape sequences:
+`@t{%l}' or `@t{%L}', which will be replaced by the number of the last line
+displayed and the total number of lines; `@t{%m}' or `@t{%M}',
+the number of the last match shown and the total number of
+matches; and `@t{%p}' and `@t{%P}', `@t{Top}'
+when at the beginning of the list, `@t{Bottom}' when at the end and the
+position shown as a percentage of the total length otherwise. In each
+case the form with the uppercase letter will be replaced by a string of fixed
+width, padded to the right with spaces, while the lowercase form will
+be replaced by a variable width string. As in other prompt strings, the
+escape sequences `@t{%S}', `@t{%s}', `@t{%B}', `@t{%b}', `@t{%U}',
+`@t{%u}' for entering and leaving the display modes
+standout, bold and underline, and `@t{%F}', `@t{%f}', `@t{%K}', `@t{%k}' for
+changing the foreground background colour, are also available, as is the form
+`@t{%@{}...@t{%@}}' for enclosing escape sequences which display with zero
+(or, with a numeric argument, some other) width.
+
+@noindent
+After deleting this prompt the variable @t{LISTPROMPT} should be unset for
+the removal to take effect.
+
+@kindex list-rows-first, completion style
+@item @t{list-rows-first}
+This style is tested in the same way as the @t{list-packed} style and
+determines whether matches are to be listed in a rows-first fashion as
+if the @t{LIST_ROWS_FIRST} option were set.
+
+@kindex list-suffixes, completion style
+@item @t{list-suffixes}
+This style is used by the function that completes filenames. If it is
+`true', and completion is attempted on a string containing multiple partially
+typed pathname components, all ambiguous components will be shown.
+Otherwise, completion stops at the first ambiguous component.
+
+@kindex list-separator, completion style
+@item @t{list-separator}
+The value of this style is used in completion listing to separate the
+string to complete from a description when possible (e.g. when
+completing options). It defaults to `@t{-}@t{-}' (two hyphens).
+
+@kindex local, completion style
+@item @t{local}
+This is for use with functions that complete URLs for which the
+corresponding files are available directly from the file system.
+Its value should consist of three strings: a
+hostname, the path to the default web pages for the server, and the
+directory name used by a user placing web pages within their home
+area.
+
+@noindent
+For example:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle ':completion:*' local toast \
+ /var/http/public/toast public_html
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Completion after `@t{http://toast/stuff/}' will look for files in the
+directory @t{/var/http/public/toast/stuff}, while completion after
+`@t{http://toast/~yousir/}' will look for files in the directory
+@t{~yousir/public_html}.
+
+@kindex mail-directory, completion style
+@item @t{mail-directory}
+If set, zsh will assume that mailbox files can be found in
+the directory specified. It defaults to `@t{~/Mail}'.
+
+@kindex match-original, completion style
+@item @t{match-original}
+This is used by the @t{_match} completer. If it is set to
+@t{only}, @t{_match} will try to generate matches without inserting a
+`@t{*}' at the cursor position. If set to any other non-empty value,
+it will first try to generate matches without inserting the `@t{*}'
+and if that yields no matches, it will try again with the `@t{*}'
+inserted. If it is unset or set to the empty string, matching will
+only be performed with the `@t{*}' inserted.
+
+@kindex matcher, completion style
+@item @t{matcher}
+This style is tested separately for each tag valid in the current
+context. Its value is placed before any match specifications given by the
+@t{matcher-list} style so can override them via the use of an @t{x:}
+specification. The value should be in the form described in
+@ref{Completion Matching Control}. For examples of this, see the description of the @t{tag-order} style.
+
+@noindent
+For notes comparing the use of this and the @t{matcher-list} style, see
+under the description of the @t{tag-order} style.
+
+@kindex matcher-list, completion style
+@item @t{matcher-list}
+This style can be set to a list of match specifications that are to
+be applied everywhere. Match specifications are described in
+@ref{Completion Matching Control}.
+The completion system will try them one after another for each completer
+selected. For example, to try first simple completion and, if that
+generates no matches, case-insensitive completion:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle ':completion:*' matcher-list @value{dsq} 'm:@{a-zA-Z@}=@{A-Za-z@}'
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+By default each specification replaces the previous one; however, if a
+specification is prefixed with @t{+}, it is added to the existing list.
+Hence it is possible to create increasingly general specifications
+without repetition:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle ':completion:*' matcher-list \
+ @value{dsq} '+m:@{a-z@}=@{A-Z@}' '+m:@{A-Z@}=@{a-z@}'
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+It is possible to create match specifications valid for particular
+completers by using the third field of the context. This applies only
+to completers that override the global matcher-list, which as of this
+writing includes only @t{_prefix} and @t{_ignored}. For example, to
+use the completers @t{_complete} and @t{_prefix} but allow
+case-insensitive completion only with @t{_complete}:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle ':completion:*' completer _complete _prefix
+zstyle ':completion:*:complete:*:*:*' matcher-list \
+ @value{dsq} 'm:@{a-zA-Z@}=@{A-Za-z@}'
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+User-defined names, as explained for the @t{completer} style, are
+available. This makes it possible to try the same completer more than
+once with different match specifications each time. For example, to try
+normal completion without a match specification, then normal completion
+with case-insensitive matching, then correction, and finally
+partial-word completion:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle ':completion:*' completer \
+ _complete _correct _complete:foo
+zstyle ':completion:*:complete:*:*:*' matcher-list \
+ @value{dsq} 'm:@{a-zA-Z@}=@{A-Za-z@}'
+zstyle ':completion:*:foo:*:*:*' matcher-list \
+ 'm:@{a-zA-Z@}=@{A-Za-z@} r:|[-_./]=* r:|=*'
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+If the style is unset in any context no match specification is applied.
+Note also that some completers such as @t{_correct} and @t{_approximate}
+do not use the match specifications at all, though these completers will
+only ever be called once even if the @t{matcher-list} contains more than
+one element.
+
+@noindent
+Where multiple specifications are useful, note that the @emph{entire}
+completion is done for each element of @t{matcher-list}, which can
+quickly reduce the shell's performance. As a rough rule of thumb,
+one to three strings will give acceptable performance. On the other
+hand, putting multiple space-separated values into the same string does
+not have an appreciable impact on performance.
+
+@noindent
+If there is no current matcher or it is empty, and the option
+@t{NO_CASE_GLOB} is in effect, the matching for files is performed
+case-insensitively in any case. However, any matcher must
+explicitly specify case-insensitive matching if that is required.
+
+@noindent
+For notes comparing the use of this and the @t{matcher} style, see
+under the description of the @t{tag-order} style.
+
+@kindex max-errors, completion style
+@item @t{max-errors}
+This is used by the @t{_approximate} and @t{_correct} completer functions
+to determine the maximum number of errors to allow. The completer will try
+to generate completions by first allowing one error, then two errors, and
+so on, until either a match or matches were found or the maximum number of
+errors given by this style has been reached.
+
+@noindent
+If the value for this style contains the string `@t{numeric}', the
+completer function will take any numeric argument as the
+maximum number of errors allowed. For example, with
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle ':completion:*:approximate:::' max-errors 2 numeric
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+two errors are allowed if no numeric argument is given, but with
+a numeric argument of six (as in `@t{ESC-6 TAB}'), up to six
+errors are accepted. Hence with a value of `@t{0 numeric}', no correcting
+completion will be attempted unless a numeric argument is given.
+
+@noindent
+If the value contains the string `@t{not-numeric}', the completer
+will @emph{not} try to generate corrected
+completions when given a numeric argument, so in this case the number given
+should be greater than zero. For example, `@t{2 not-numeric}' specifies that
+correcting completion with two errors will usually be performed, but if a
+numeric argument is given, correcting completion will not be
+performed.
+
+@noindent
+The default value for this style is `@t{2 numeric}'.
+
+@kindex max-matches-width, completion style
+@item @t{max-matches-width}
+This style is used to determine the trade off between the width of the
+display used for matches and the width used for their descriptions when
+the @t{verbose} style is in effect. The value gives the number of
+display columns to reserve for the matches. The default is half the
+width of the screen.
+
+@noindent
+This has the most impact when several matches have the
+same description and so will be grouped together. Increasing the style
+will allow more matches to be grouped together; decreasing it will allow
+more of the description to be visible.
+
+@kindex menu, completion style
+@item @t{menu}
+If this is `true' in the context of any of the tags defined
+for the current completion menu completion will be used. The value for
+a specific tag will take precedence over that for the `@t{default}' tag.
+
+@noindent
+If none of the values found in this way is `true' but at least
+one is set to `@t{auto}', the shell behaves as if the @t{AUTO_MENU}
+option is set.
+
+@noindent
+If one of the values is explicitly set to `false', menu
+completion will be explicitly turned off, overriding the
+@t{MENU_COMPLETE} option and other settings.
+
+@noindent
+In the form `@t{yes=}@var{num}', where `@t{yes}' may be any of the
+`true' values (`@t{yes}', `@t{true}', `@t{on}' and `@t{1}'),
+menu completion will be turned on if there are at least @var{num} matches.
+In the form `@t{yes=long}', menu completion will be turned on
+if the list does not fit on the screen. This does not activate menu
+completion if the widget normally only lists completions, but menu
+completion can be activated in that case with the value `@t{yes=long-list}'
+(Typically, the value `@t{select=long-list}' described later is more
+useful as it provides control over scrolling.)
+
+@noindent
+Similarly, with any of the `false' values (as in `@t{no=10}'), menu
+completion will @emph{not} be used if there are @var{num} or more matches.
+
+@noindent
+The value of this widget also controls menu selection, as implemented by
+the @t{zsh/complist} module. The following values may appear either
+alongside or instead of the values above.
+
+@noindent
+If the value contains the string `@t{select}', menu selection
+will be started unconditionally.
+
+@noindent
+In the form `@t{select=}@var{num}', menu selection will only be started if
+there are at least @var{num} matches. If the values for more than one
+tag provide a number, the smallest number is taken.
+
+@noindent
+Menu selection can be turned off explicitly by defining a value
+containing the string`@t{no-select}'.
+
+@noindent
+It is also possible to start menu selection only if the list of
+matches does not fit on the screen by using the value
+`@t{select=long}'. To start menu selection even if the current widget
+only performs listing, use the value `@t{select=long-list}'.
+
+@noindent
+To turn on menu completion or menu selection when there are a certain
+number of matches @emph{or} the list of matches does not fit on the
+screen, both of `@t{yes=}' and `@t{select=}' may be given twice, once
+with a number and once with `@t{long}' or `@t{long-list}'.
+
+@noindent
+Finally, it is possible to activate two special modes of menu selection.
+The word `@t{interactive}' in the value causes interactive mode
+to be entered immediately when menu selection is started; see
+@ref{The zsh/complist Module}
+for a description of interactive mode. Including the string
+`@t{search}' does the same for incremental search mode. To select backward
+incremental search, include the string `@t{search-backward}'.
+
+@kindex muttrc, completion style
+@item @t{muttrc}
+If set, gives the location of the mutt configuration file. It defaults
+to `@t{~/.muttrc}'.
+
+@kindex numbers, completion style
+@item @t{numbers}
+This is used with the @t{jobs} tag. If it is `true', the shell will
+complete job numbers instead of the shortest unambiguous prefix
+of the job command text. If the value is a number, job numbers will
+only be used if that many words from the job descriptions are required to
+resolve ambiguities. For example, if the value is `@t{1}', strings will
+only be used if all jobs differ in the first word on their command lines.
+
+@kindex old-list, completion style
+@item @t{old-list}
+This is used by the @t{_oldlist} completer. If it is set to `@t{always}',
+then standard widgets which perform listing will retain the current list of
+matches, however they were generated; this can be turned off explicitly
+with the value `@t{never}', giving the behaviour without the @t{_oldlist}
+completer. If the style is unset, or any other value, then the existing
+list of completions is displayed if it is not already; otherwise, the
+standard completion list is generated; this is the default behaviour of
+@t{_oldlist}. However, if there is an old list and this style contains
+the name of the completer function that generated the list, then the
+old list will be used even if it was generated by a widget which does
+not do listing.
+
+@noindent
+For example, suppose you type @t{^Xc} to use the @t{_correct_word}
+widget, which generates a list of corrections for the word under the
+cursor. Usually, typing @t{^D} would generate a standard list of
+completions for the word on the command line, and show that. With
+@t{_oldlist}, it will instead show the list of corrections already
+generated.
+
+@noindent
+As another example consider the @t{_match} completer: with the
+@t{insert-unambiguous} style set to `true' it inserts only a common prefix
+string, if there is any. However, this may remove parts of the original
+pattern, so that further completion could produce more matches than on the
+first attempt. By using the @t{_oldlist} completer and setting this style
+to @t{_match}, the list of matches generated on the first attempt will be
+used again.
+
+@kindex old-matches, completion style
+@item @t{old-matches}
+This is used by the @t{_all_matches} completer to decide if an old
+list of matches should be used if one exists. This is selected by one of
+the `true' values or by the string `@t{only}'. If
+the value is `@t{only}', @t{_all_matches} will only use an old list
+and won't have any effect on the list of matches currently being
+generated.
+
+@noindent
+If this style is set it is generally unwise to call the @t{_all_matches}
+completer unconditionally. One possible use is for either this style or
+the @t{completer} style to be defined with the @t{-e} option to
+@t{zstyle} to make the style conditional.
+
+@kindex old-menu, completion style
+@item @t{old-menu}
+This is used by the @t{_oldlist} completer. It controls how menu
+completion behaves when a completion has already been inserted and the
+user types a standard completion key such as @t{TAB}. The default
+behaviour of @t{_oldlist} is that menu completion always continues
+with the existing list of completions. If this style is set to
+`false', however, a new completion is started if the old list was
+generated by a different completion command; this is the behaviour without
+the @t{_oldlist} completer.
+
+@noindent
+For example, suppose you type @t{^Xc} to generate a list of corrections,
+and menu completion is started in one of the usual ways. Usually, or with
+this style set to `false', typing @t{TAB} at this point would start
+trying to complete the line as it now appears. With @t{_oldlist}, it
+instead continues to cycle through the list of corrections.
+
+@kindex original, completion style
+@item @t{original}
+This is used by the @t{_approximate} and @t{_correct}
+completers to decide if the original string should be added as
+a possible completion. Normally, this is done only if there are
+at least two possible corrections, but if this style is set to `true', it
+is always added. Note that the style will be examined with the
+completer field in the context name set to @t{correct-}@var{num} or
+@t{approximate-}@var{num}, where @var{num} is the number of errors that
+were accepted.
+
+@kindex packageset, completion style
+@item @t{packageset}
+This style is used when completing arguments of the Debian `@t{dpkg}'
+program. It contains an override for the default package set
+for a given context. For example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle ':completion:*:complete:dpkg:option--status-1:*' \
+ packageset avail
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+causes available packages, rather than only installed packages,
+to be completed for `@t{dpkg -}@t{-status}'.
+
+@kindex path, completion style
+@item @t{path}
+The function that completes color names uses this style with the
+@t{colors} tag. The value should be the pathname of a file
+containing color names in the format of an X11 @t{rgb.txt} file. If
+the style is not set but this file is found in one of various standard
+locations it will be used as the default.
+
+@kindex path-completion, completion style
+@item @t{path-completion}
+This is used by filename completion. By default, filename completion
+examines all components of a path to see if there are completions of
+that component. For example, @t{/u/b/z} can be completed to
+@t{/usr/bin/zsh}. Explicitly setting this style to `false' inhibits this
+behaviour for path components up to the @t{/} before the cursor; this
+overrides the setting of @t{accept-exact-dirs}.
+
+@noindent
+Even with the style set to `false', it is still possible to complete
+multiple paths by setting the option @t{COMPLETE_IN_WORD} and moving the
+cursor back to the first component in the path to be completed. For
+example, @t{/u/b/z} can be completed to @t{/usr/bin/zsh} if the cursor is
+after the @t{/u}.
+
+@kindex pine-directory, completion style
+@item @t{pine-directory}
+If set, specifies the directory containing PINE mailbox files. There
+is no default, since recursively searching this directory is inconvenient
+for anyone who doesn't use PINE.
+
+@kindex ports, completion style
+@item @t{ports}
+A list of Internet service names (network ports) to complete. If this is
+not set, service names are taken from the file `@t{/etc/services}'.
+
+@kindex prefix-hidden, completion style
+@item @t{prefix-hidden}
+This is used for certain completions which share a common prefix, for
+example command options beginning with dashes. If it is `true', the
+prefix will not be shown in the list of matches.
+
+@noindent
+The default value for this style is `false'.
+
+@kindex prefix-needed, completion style
+@item @t{prefix-needed}
+This style is also relevant for matches with a common prefix. If it is
+set to `true' this common prefix must be typed by the user to generate
+the matches.
+
+@noindent
+The style is applicable to the @t{options}, @t{signals}, @t{jobs},
+@t{functions}, and @t{parameters} completion tags.
+
+@noindent
+For command options, this means that the initial `@t{-}', `@t{+}', or
+`@t{-}@t{-}' must be typed explicitly before option names will be
+completed.
+
+@noindent
+For signals, an initial `@t{-}' is required before signal names will
+be completed.
+
+@noindent
+For jobs, an initial `@t{%}' is required before job names will be
+completed.
+
+@noindent
+For function and parameter names, an initial `@t{_}' or `@t{.}' is
+required before function or parameter names starting with those
+characters will be completed.
+
+@noindent
+The default value for this style is `false' for @t{function} and
+@t{parameter} completions, and `true' otherwise.
+
+@kindex preserve-prefix, completion style
+@item @t{preserve-prefix}
+This style is used when completing path names. Its value should be a
+pattern matching an initial prefix of the word to complete that should
+be left unchanged under all circumstances. For example, on some Unices
+an initial `@t{//}' (double slash) has a special meaning; setting
+this style to the string `@t{//}' will preserve it. As another example,
+setting this style to `@t{?:/}' under Cygwin would allow completion
+after `@t{a:/...}' and so on.
+
+@kindex range, completion style
+@item @t{range}
+This is used by the @t{_history} completer and the
+@t{_history_complete_word} bindable command to decide which words
+should be completed.
+
+@noindent
+If it is a single number, only the last @var{N} words from the history
+will be completed.
+
+@noindent
+If it is a range of the form `@var{max}@t{:}@var{slice}',
+the last @var{slice} words will be completed; then if that
+yields no matches, the @var{slice} words before those will be tried and
+so on. This process stops either when at least one match has been
+found, or @var{max} words have been tried.
+
+@noindent
+The default is to complete all words from the history at once.
+
+@kindex recursive-files, completion style
+@item @t{recursive-files}
+If this style is set, its value is an array of patterns to be
+tested against `@t{$PWD/}': note the trailing slash, which allows
+directories in the pattern to be delimited unambiguously by including
+slashes on both sides. If an ordinary file completion fails
+and the word on the command line does not yet have a directory part to its
+name, the style is retrieved using the same tag as for the completion
+just attempted, then the elements tested against @t{$PWD/} in turn.
+If one matches, then the shell reattempts completion by prepending the word
+on the command line with each directory in the expansion of @t{**/*(/)}
+in turn. Typically the elements of the style will be set to restrict
+the number of directories beneath the current one to a manageable
+number, for example `@t{*/.git/*}'.
+
+@noindent
+For example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle ':completion:*' recursive-files '*/zsh/*'
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+If the current directory is @t{/home/pws/zsh/Src}, then
+@t{zle_tr}@emph{TAB} can be completed to @t{Zle/zle_tricky.c}.
+
+@kindex regular, completion style
+@item @t{regular}
+This style is used by the @t{_expand_alias} completer and bindable
+command. If set to `true' (the default), regular aliases will be
+expanded but only in command position. If it is set to `false',
+regular aliases will never be expanded. If it is set to `@t{always}',
+regular aliases will be expanded even if not in command position.
+
+@kindex rehash, completion style
+@item @t{rehash}
+If this is set when completing external commands, the internal
+list (hash) of commands will be updated for each search by issuing
+the @t{rehash} command. There is a speed penalty for this which
+is only likely to be noticeable when directories in the path have
+slow file access.
+
+@kindex remote-access, completion style
+@item @t{remote-access}
+If set to `false', certain commands will be prevented from making
+Internet connections to retrieve remote information. This includes the
+completion for the @t{CVS} command.
+
+@noindent
+It is not always possible to know if connections are in fact to a remote
+site, so some may be prevented unnecessarily.
+
+@kindex remove-all-dups, completion style
+@item @t{remove-all-dups}
+The @t{_history_complete_word} bindable command and the @t{_history}
+completer use this to decide if all duplicate matches should be
+removed, rather than just consecutive duplicates.
+
+@kindex select-prompt, completion style
+@item @t{select-prompt}
+If this is set for the @t{default} tag, its
+value will be displayed during menu selection (see the @t{menu} style
+above) when the completion list does not fit on the screen as a
+whole. The same escapes as for the @t{list-prompt} style are
+understood, except that the numbers refer to the match or line the mark is
+on. A default prompt is used when the value is the empty string.
+
+@kindex select-scroll, completion style
+@item @t{select-scroll}
+This style is tested for the @t{default} tag and determines how a
+completion list is scrolled during a menu selection (see the @t{menu}
+style above) when the completion list does not fit on the screen as a
+whole. If the value is `@t{0}' (zero), the list is scrolled by
+half-screenfuls; if it is a positive integer, the list is scrolled by the
+given number of lines; if it is a negative number, the list is scrolled by a
+screenful minus the absolute value of the given number of lines.
+The default is to scroll by single lines.
+
+@kindex separate-sections, completion style
+@item @t{separate-sections}
+This style is used with the @t{manuals} tag when completing names of
+manual pages. If it is `true', entries for different sections are
+added separately using tag names of the form `@t{manual.}@var{X}',
+where @var{X} is the section number. When the @t{group-name} style is
+also in effect, pages from different sections will appear separately.
+This style is also used similarly with the @t{words} style when
+completing words for the dict command. It allows words from different
+dictionary databases to be added separately.
+The default for this style is `false'.
+
+@kindex show-ambiguity, completion style
+@item @t{show-ambiguity}
+If the @t{zsh/complist} module is loaded, this style can be used to
+highlight the first ambiguous character in completion lists. The
+value is either a color indication such as those supported by the
+@t{list-colors} style or, with a value of `true', a default of
+underlining is selected. The highlighting is only applied if the
+completion display strings correspond to the actual matches.
+
+@kindex show-completer, completion style
+@item @t{show-completer}
+Tested whenever a new completer is tried. If it is `true', the completion
+system outputs a progress message in the listing area showing what
+completer is being tried. The message will be overwritten by any output
+when completions are found and is removed after completion is finished.
+
+@kindex single-ignored, completion style
+@item @t{single-ignored}
+This is used by the @t{_ignored} completer when there is only one match.
+If its value is `@t{show}', the single match will be
+displayed but not inserted. If the value is `@t{menu}', then the single
+match and the original string are both added as matches and menu completion
+is started, making it easy to select either of them.
+
+@kindex sort, completion style
+@item @t{sort}
+This allows the standard ordering of matches to be overridden.
+
+@noindent
+If its value is `@t{true}' or `@t{false}', sorting is enabled or disabled.
+Additionally the values associated with the `@t{-o}' option to @t{compadd} can
+also be listed: @t{match}, @t{nosort}, @t{numeric}, @t{reverse}. If it is not
+set for the context, the standard behaviour of the calling widget is used.
+
+@noindent
+The style is tested first against the full context including the tag, and
+if that fails to produce a value against the context without the tag.
+
+@noindent
+In many cases where a calling widget explicitly selects a particular ordering
+in lieu of the default, a value of `@t{true}' is not honoured. An example of
+where this is not the case is for command history where the default of sorting
+matches chronologically may be overridden by setting the style to `true'.
+
+@noindent
+In the @t{_expand} completer, if it is set to
+`true', the expansions generated will always be sorted. If it is set
+to `@t{menu}', then the expansions are only sorted when they are offered
+as single strings but not in the string containing all possible
+expansions.
+
+@kindex special-dirs, completion style
+@item @t{special-dirs}
+Normally, the completion code will not produce the directory names
+`@t{.}' and `@t{..}' as possible completions. If this style is set to
+`true', it will add both `@t{.}' and `@t{..}' as possible completions;
+if it is set to `@t{..}', only `@t{..}' will be added.
+
+@noindent
+The following example sets @t{special-dirs} to `@t{..}' when the
+current prefix is empty, is a single `@t{.}', or consists only of a path
+beginning with `@t{../}'. Otherwise the value is `false'.
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle -e ':completion:*' special-dirs \
+ '[[ $PREFIX = (../)#(|.|..) ]] && reply=(..)'
+@end example
+
+@kindex squeeze-slashes, completion style
+@item @t{squeeze-slashes}
+If set to `true', sequences of slashes in filename paths (for example in
+`@t{foo//bar}') will be treated as a single slash. This is the usual
+behaviour of UNIX paths. However, by default the file completion
+function behaves as if there were a `@t{*}' between the slashes.
+
+@kindex stop, completion style
+@item @t{stop}
+If set to `true', the @t{_history_complete_word} bindable
+command will stop once when reaching the beginning or end of the
+history. Invoking @t{_history_complete_word} will then wrap around to
+the opposite end of the history. If this style is set to `false' (the
+default), @t{_history_complete_word} will loop immediately as in a
+menu completion.
+
+@kindex strip-comments, completion style
+@item @t{strip-comments}
+If set to `true', this style causes non-essential comment text to be
+removed from completion matches. Currently it is only used when
+completing e-mail addresses where it removes any display name from the
+addresses, cutting them down to plain @var{user@@host} form.
+
+@kindex subst-globs-only, completion style
+@item @t{subst-globs-only}
+This is used by the @t{_expand} completer. If it is set to `true',
+the expansion will only be used if it resulted from globbing; hence,
+if expansions resulted from the use of the @t{substitute} style
+described below, but these were not further changed by globbing, the
+expansions will be rejected.
+
+@noindent
+The default for this style is `false'.
+
+@kindex substitute, completion style
+@item @t{substitute}
+This boolean style controls whether the @t{_expand} completer will
+first try to expand all substitutions in the string (such as
+`@t{$(}@var{...}@t{)}' and `@t{$@{}@var{...}@t{@}}').
+
+@noindent
+The default is `true'.
+
+@kindex suffix, completion style
+@item @t{suffix}
+This is used by the @t{_expand} completer if the word starts with a
+tilde or contains a parameter expansion. If it is set to `true', the
+word will only be expanded if it doesn't have a suffix, i.e. if it is
+something like `@t{~foo}' or `@t{$foo}' rather than `@t{~foo/}' or
+`@t{$foo/bar}', unless that suffix itself contains characters eligible
+for expansion. The default for this style is `true'.
+
+@kindex tag-order, completion style
+@item @t{tag-order}
+This provides a mechanism for sorting how the tags available in a
+particular context will be used.
+
+@noindent
+The values for the style are sets of space-separated lists of tags.
+The tags in each value will be tried at the same time; if no match is
+found, the next value is used. (See the @t{file-patterns} style for
+an exception to this behavior.)
+
+@noindent
+For example:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle ':completion:*:complete:-command-:*:*' tag-order \
+ 'commands functions'
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+specifies that completion in command position first offers
+external commands and shell functions. Remaining tags will be tried if
+no completions are found.
+
+@noindent
+In addition to tag names, each string in the value may take one of the
+following forms:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{-}
+If any value consists of only a hyphen,
+then @emph{only} the tags specified in the other values are
+generated. Normally all tags not explicitly selected are tried last
+if the specified tags fail to generate any matches. This means
+that a single value consisting only of a single hyphen
+turns off completion.
+
+@item @t{!} @var{tags}...
+A string starting with an exclamation mark
+specifies names of tags that are @emph{not} to be used. The effect is
+the same as if all other possible tags for the context had been
+listed.
+
+@item @var{tag}@t{:}@var{label} ...
+Here, @var{tag} is one of the standard tags and @var{label} is an
+arbitrary name. Matches are generated as normal but the name @var{label}
+is used in contexts instead of @var{tag}. This is not useful in words
+starting with @t{!}.
+
+@noindent
+If the @var{label} starts with a hyphen, the @var{tag} is prepended to the
+@var{label} to form the name used for lookup. This can be
+used to make the completion system try a certain tag more than once,
+supplying different style settings for each attempt; see below for an
+example.
+
+@item @var{tag}@t{:}@var{label}@t{:}@var{description}
+As before, but @t{description} will replace the `@t{%d}' in
+the value of the @t{format} style instead of the default description
+supplied by the completion function. Spaces in the description must
+be quoted with a backslash. A `@t{%d}' appearing
+in @var{description} is replaced with the description given by the
+completion function.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+In any of the forms above the tag may be a pattern or several
+patterns in the form `@t{@{}@var{pat1}@t{,}@var{pat2...}@t{@}}'. In this
+case all matching tags will be used except
+for any given explicitly in the same string.
+
+@noindent
+One use of these features is to try
+one tag more than once, setting other styles differently on
+each attempt, but still to use all the other tags without having to
+repeat them all. For example, to make completion of function names in
+command position ignore all the completion functions starting with an
+underscore the first time completion is tried:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle ':completion:*:*:-command-:*:*' tag-order \
+ 'functions:-non-comp *' functions
+zstyle ':completion:*:functions-non-comp' \
+ ignored-patterns '_*'
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+On the first attempt, all tags will be offered but the @t{functions} tag
+will be replaced by @t{functions-non-comp}. The @t{ignored-patterns} style
+is set for this tag to exclude functions starting with an underscore.
+If there are no matches, the second value of the
+@t{tag-order} style is used which completes functions using the default
+tag, this time presumably including all function names.
+
+@noindent
+The matches for one tag can be split into different groups. For example:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle ':completion:*' tag-order \
+ 'options:-long:long\ options
+ options:-short:short\ options
+ options:-single-letter:single\ letter\ options'
+zstyle ':completion:*:options-long' \
+ ignored-patterns '[-+](|-|[^-]*)'
+zstyle ':completion:*:options-short' \
+ ignored-patterns '--*' '[-+]?'
+zstyle ':completion:*:options-single-letter' \
+ ignored-patterns '???*'
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+With the @t{group-names} style set, options beginning with
+`@t{-}@t{-}', options beginning with a single `@t{-}' or `@t{+}' but
+containing multiple characters, and single-letter options will be
+displayed in separate groups with different descriptions.
+
+@noindent
+Another use of patterns is to
+try multiple match specifications one after another. The
+@t{matcher-list} style offers something similar, but it is tested very
+early in the completion system and hence can't be set for single
+commands nor for more specific contexts. Here is how to
+try normal completion without any match specification and, if that
+generates no matches, try again with case-insensitive matching, restricting
+the effect to arguments of the command @t{foo}:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle ':completion:*:*:foo:*:*' tag-order '*' '*:-case'
+zstyle ':completion:*-case' matcher 'm:@{a-z@}=@{A-Z@}'
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+First, all the tags offered when completing after @t{foo} are tried using
+the normal tag name. If that generates no matches, the second value of
+@t{tag-order} is used, which tries all tags again except that this time
+each has @t{-case} appended to its name for lookup of styles. Hence this
+time the value for the @t{matcher} style from the second call to @t{zstyle}
+in the example is used to make completion case-insensitive.
+
+@noindent
+It is possible to use the @t{-e} option of the @t{zstyle} builtin
+command to specify conditions for the use of particular tags. For
+example:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle -e '*:-command-:*' tag-order '
+ if [[ -n $PREFIX$SUFFIX ]]; then
+ reply=( )
+ else
+ reply=( - )
+ fi'
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Completion in command position will be attempted only if the string
+typed so far is not empty. This is tested using the @t{PREFIX}
+special parameter; see
+@ref{Completion Widgets}
+for a description of parameters which are special inside completion widgets.
+Setting @t{reply} to an empty array provides the default
+behaviour of trying all tags at once; setting it to an
+array containing only a hyphen disables the use of all tags and hence of
+all completions.
+
+@noindent
+If no @t{tag-order} style has been defined for a context, the strings
+`@t{(|*-)argument-* (|*-)option-* values}' and `@t{options}' plus all
+tags offered by the completion function will be used to provide a
+sensible default behavior that causes arguments (whether normal command
+arguments or arguments of options) to be completed before option names for
+most commands.
+
+@kindex urls, completion style
+@item @t{urls}
+This is used together with the @t{urls} tag by
+functions completing URLs.
+
+@noindent
+If the value consists of more than one string, or if the only string
+does not name a file or directory, the strings are used as the URLs to
+complete.
+
+@noindent
+If the value contains only one string which is the name of a normal
+file the URLs are taken from that file (where the URLs may be
+separated by white space or newlines).
+
+@noindent
+Finally, if the only string in the value names a directory, the
+directory hierarchy rooted at this directory gives the completions. The
+top level directory should be the file access method, such as
+`@t{http}', `@t{ftp}', `@t{bookmark}' and so on. In many cases the next
+level of directories will be a filename. The directory hierarchy can
+descend as deep as necessary.
+
+@noindent
+For example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle ':completion:*' urls ~/.urls
+mkdir -p ~/.urls/ftp/ftp.zsh.org/pub
+
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+allows completion of all the components of the URL
+@t{ftp://ftp.zsh.org/pub} after suitable commands such as
+`@t{netscape}' or `@t{lynx}'. Note, however, that access methods and
+files are completed separately, so if the @t{hosts} style is set hosts
+can be completed without reference to the @t{urls} style.
+
+@noindent
+See the description in the function @t{_urls} itself
+for more information (e.g. `@t{more $^fpath/_urls(N)}').
+
+@kindex use-cache, completion style
+@item @t{use-cache}
+If this is set, the completion caching layer is activated for any completions
+which use it (via the @t{_store_cache}, @t{_retrieve_cache}, and
+@t{_cache_invalid} functions). The directory containing the cache
+files can be changed with the @t{cache-path} style.
+
+@kindex use-compctl, completion style
+@item @t{use-compctl}
+If this style is set to a string @emph{not} equal to @t{false}, @t{0},
+@t{no}, and @t{off}, the completion system may use any completion
+specifications defined with the @t{compctl} builtin command. If the
+style is unset, this is done only if the @t{zsh/compctl} module
+is loaded. The string may also contain the substring `@t{first}' to
+use completions defined with `@t{compctl -T}', and the substring
+`@t{default}' to use the completion defined with `@t{compctl -D}'.
+
+@noindent
+Note that this is only intended to smooth the transition from
+@t{compctl} to the new completion system and may disappear in the
+future.
+
+@noindent
+Note also that the definitions from @t{compctl} will only be used if
+there is no specific completion function for the command in question. For
+example, if there is a function @t{_foo} to complete arguments to the
+command @t{foo}, @t{compctl} will never be invoked for @t{foo}.
+However, the @t{compctl} version will be tried if @t{foo} only uses
+default completion.
+
+@kindex use-ip, completion style
+@item @t{use-ip}
+By default, the function @t{_hosts} that completes host names strips
+IP addresses from entries read from host databases such as NIS and
+ssh files. If this style is `true', the corresponding IP addresses
+can be completed as well. This style is not use in any context
+where the @t{hosts} style is set; note also it must be set before
+the cache of host names is generated (typically the first completion
+attempt).
+
+@kindex users, completion style
+@item @t{users}
+This may be set to a list of usernames to be completed.
+If it is not set all usernames will be completed.
+Note that if it is set only that list of users will be completed;
+this is because on some systems querying all users can take
+a prohibitive amount of time.
+
+@kindex users-hosts, completion style
+@item @t{users-hosts}
+The values of this style should be of the form
+`@var{user}@t{@@}@var{host}' or `@var{user}@t{:}@var{host}'. It is used for
+commands that need pairs of
+user- and hostnames. These commands will complete usernames from this
+style (only), and will restrict subsequent hostname completion to hosts
+paired with that user in one of the values of the style.
+
+@noindent
+It is possible to group values for sets of commands which allow a remote
+login, such as @t{rlogin} and @t{ssh}, by using the @t{my-accounts} tag.
+Similarly, values for sets of commands which usually refer to the
+accounts of other people, such as @t{talk} and @t{finger}, can be
+grouped by using the @t{other-accounts} tag. More ambivalent commands
+may use the @t{accounts} tag.
+
+@kindex users-hosts-ports, completion style
+@item @t{users-hosts-ports}
+Like @t{users-hosts} but used for commands like @t{telnet} and
+containing strings of the form `@var{user}@t{@@}@var{host}@t{:}@var{port}'.
+
+@kindex verbose, completion style
+@item @t{verbose}
+If set, as it is by default, the completion listing is more verbose.
+In particular many commands show descriptions for options if this
+style is `true'.
+
+@kindex word, completion style
+@item @t{word}
+This is used by the @t{_list} completer, which prevents the insertion of
+completions until a second completion attempt when the line has not
+changed. The normal way of finding out if the line has changed is to
+compare its entire contents between the two occasions. If this style is
+`true', the comparison is instead performed only on the current word.
+Hence if completion is performed on another word with the same contents,
+completion will not be delayed.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+@node Control Functions, Bindable Commands, Completion System Configuration, Completion System
+
+@section Control Functions
+@noindent
+@cindex completion system, choosing completers
+
+@noindent
+The initialization script @t{compinit} redefines all the widgets
+which perform completion to call the supplied widget function
+@t{_main_complete}. This function acts as a wrapper calling the
+so-called `completer' functions that generate matches. If
+@t{_main_complete} is called with arguments, these are taken as the
+names of completer functions to be called in the order given. If no
+arguments are given, the set of functions to try is taken from the
+@t{completer} style. For example, to use normal completion and
+correction if that doesn't generate any matches:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle ':completion:*' completer _complete _correct
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+after calling @t{compinit}. The default value for this style is
+`@t{_complete _ignored}', i.e. normally only ordinary completion is tried,
+first with the effect of the @t{ignored-patterns} style and then without
+it. The @t{_main_complete} function uses the return status of the completer
+functions to decide if other completers should be called. If the return
+status is zero, no other completers are tried and the @t{_main_complete}
+function returns.
+
+@noindent
+If the first argument to @t{_main_complete} is a single hyphen, the
+arguments will not be taken as names of completers. Instead, the
+second argument gives a name to use in the @var{completer} field of the
+context and the other arguments give a command name and arguments to
+call to generate the matches.
+
+@noindent
+The following completer functions are contained in the distribution,
+although users may write their own. Note that in contexts the leading
+underscore is stripped, for example basic completion is performed in the
+context `@t{:completion::complete:}@var{...}'.
+
+@noindent
+@cindex completion system, completers
+@table @asis
+@findex _all_matches
+@item @t{_all_matches}
+This completer can be used to add a string consisting of all other
+matches. As it influences later completers it must appear as the first
+completer in the list. The list of all matches is affected by the
+@t{avoid-completer} and @t{old-matches} styles described above.
+
+@noindent
+It may be useful to use the @t{_generic} function described below
+to bind @t{_all_matches} to its own keystroke, for example:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zle -C all-matches complete-word _generic
+bindkey '^Xa' all-matches
+zstyle ':completion:all-matches:*' old-matches only
+zstyle ':completion:all-matches::::' completer _all_matches
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Note that this does not generate completions by itself: first use
+any of the standard ways of generating a list of completions,
+then use @t{^Xa} to show all matches. It is possible instead to
+add a standard completer to the list and request that the
+list of all matches should be directly inserted:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle ':completion:all-matches::::' completer \
+ _all_matches _complete
+zstyle ':completion:all-matches:*' insert true
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+In this case the @t{old-matches} style should not be set.
+
+@findex _approximate
+@item @t{_approximate}
+This is similar to the basic @t{_complete} completer but allows the
+completions to undergo corrections. The maximum number of errors can be
+specified by the @t{max-errors} style; see the description of
+approximate matching in
+@ref{Filename Generation}
+for how errors are counted. Normally this completer will only be tried
+after the normal @t{_complete} completer:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle ':completion:*' completer _complete _approximate
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+This will give correcting completion if and only if
+normal completion yields no possible completions. When
+corrected completions are found, the completer will normally start
+menu completion allowing you to cycle through these strings.
+
+@noindent
+This completer uses the tags @t{corrections} and @t{original} when
+generating the possible corrections and the original string. The
+@t{format} style for the former may contain the additional sequences
+`@t{%e}' and `@t{%o}' which will be replaced by the number of errors
+accepted to generate the corrections and the original string,
+respectively.
+
+@noindent
+The completer progressively increases the number of errors allowed up to
+the limit by the @t{max-errors} style, hence if a completion is found
+with one error, no completions with two errors will be shown, and so on.
+It modifies the completer name in the context to indicate the number of
+errors being tried: on the first try the completer field contains
+`@t{approximate-1}', on the second try `@t{approximate-2}', and so on.
+
+@noindent
+When @t{_approximate} is called from another function, the number of
+errors to accept may be passed with the @t{-a} option. The argument
+is in the same format as the @t{max-errors} style, all in one string.
+
+@noindent
+Note that this completer (and the @t{_correct} completer mentioned
+below) can be quite expensive to call, especially when a large number
+of errors are allowed. One way to avoid this is to set up the
+@t{completer} style using the @t{-e} option to zstyle so that some
+completers are only used when completion is attempted a second time on
+the same string, e.g.:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle -e ':completion:*' completer '
+ if [[ $_last_try != "$HISTNO$BUFFER$CURSOR" ]]; then
+ _last_try="$HISTNO$BUFFER$CURSOR"
+ reply=(_complete _match _prefix)
+ else
+ reply=(_ignored _correct _approximate)
+ fi'
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+This uses the @t{HISTNO} parameter and the @t{BUFFER} and @t{CURSOR}
+special parameters that are available inside zle and completion
+widgets to find out if the command line hasn't changed since the last
+time completion was tried. Only then are the @t{_ignored},
+@t{_correct} and @t{_approximate} completers called.
+
+@findex _canonical_paths
+@item @t{_canonical_paths} [ @t{-A} @var{var} ] [ @t{-N} ] [ @t{-MJV12nfX} ] @var{tag} @var{descr} [ @var{paths} ... ]
+This completion function completes all paths given to it, and also tries to
+offer completions which point to the same file as one of the paths given
+(relative path when an absolute path is given, and vice versa; when @t{..}'s
+are present in the word to be completed; and some paths got from symlinks).
+
+@noindent
+@t{-A}, if specified, takes the paths from the array variable specified. Paths can
+also be specified on the command line as shown above. @t{-N}, if specified,
+prevents canonicalizing the paths given before using them for completion, in
+case they are already so. The options @t{-M}, @t{-J}, @t{-V}, @t{-1}, @t{-2},
+@t{-n}, @t{-F}, @t{-X} are passed to @t{compadd}.
+
+@noindent
+See @t{_description} for a description of @var{tag} and @var{descr}.
+
+@findex _cmdambivalent
+@item @t{_cmdambivalent}
+Completes the remaining positional arguments as an external command.
+The external command and its arguments are completed as separate arguments
+(in a manner appropriate for completing @t{/usr/bin/env})
+if there are two or more remaining positional arguments on the command line,
+and as a quoted command string (in the manner of @t{system(...)}) otherwise.
+See also @t{_cmdstring} and @t{_precommand}.
+
+@noindent
+This function takes no arguments.
+
+@findex _cmdstring
+@item @t{_cmdstring}
+Completes an external command as a single argument, as for
+@t{system(...)}.
+
+@findex _complete
+@item @t{_complete}
+This completer generates all possible completions in a context-sensitive
+manner, i.e. using the settings defined with the @t{compdef} function
+explained above and the current settings of all special parameters.
+This gives the normal completion behaviour.
+
+@noindent
+To complete arguments of commands, @t{_complete} uses the utility function
+@t{_normal}, which is in turn responsible for finding the particular
+function; it is described below. Various contexts of the form
+@t{-}@var{context}@t{-} are handled specifically. These are all
+mentioned above as possible arguments to the @t{#compdef} tag.
+
+@noindent
+Before trying to find a function for a specific context, @t{_complete}
+checks if the parameter `@t{compcontext}' is set. Setting
+`@t{compcontext}' allows the usual completion dispatching to be
+overridden which is useful in places such as a function that uses
+@t{vared} for input. If it is set to an array, the elements are taken
+to be the possible matches which will be completed using the tag
+`@t{values}' and the description `@t{value}'. If it is set to an
+associative array, the keys are used as the possible completions and
+the values (if non-empty) are used as descriptions for the matches. If
+`@t{compcontext}' is set to a string containing colons, it should be of
+the form `@var{tag}@t{:}@var{descr}@t{:}@var{action}'. In this case the
+@var{tag} and @var{descr} give the tag and description to use and the
+@var{action} indicates what should be completed in one of the forms
+accepted by the @t{_arguments} utility function described below.
+
+@noindent
+Finally, if `@t{compcontext}' is set to a string without colons, the
+value is taken as the name of the context to use and the function
+defined for that context will be called. For this purpose, there is a
+special context named @t{-command-line-} that completes whole command
+lines (commands and their arguments). This is not used by the completion
+system itself but is nonetheless handled when explicitly called.
+
+@findex _correct
+@item @t{_correct}
+Generate corrections, but not completions, for the current word; this is
+similar to @t{_approximate} but will not allow any number of extra
+characters at the cursor as that completer does. The effect is
+similar to spell-checking. It is based on @t{_approximate}, but the
+completer field in the context name is @t{correct}.
+
+@noindent
+For example, with:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle ':completion:::::' completer \
+ _complete _correct _approximate
+zstyle ':completion:*:correct:::' max-errors 2 not-numeric
+zstyle ':completion:*:approximate:::' max-errors 3 numeric
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+correction will accept up to two errors. If a numeric argument is
+given, correction will not be performed, but correcting completion
+will be, and will accept as many errors as given by the numeric
+argument. Without a numeric argument, first correction and then
+correcting completion will be tried, with the first one accepting two
+errors and the second one accepting three errors.
+
+@noindent
+When @t{_correct} is called as a function, the number of errors to accept
+may be given following the @t{-a} option. The argument is in the same
+form a values to the @t{accept} style, all in one string.
+
+@noindent
+This completer function is intended to be used without the
+@t{_approximate} completer or, as in the example, just before
+it. Using it after the @t{_approximate} completer is useless since
+@t{_approximate} will at least generate the corrected strings
+generated by the @t{_correct} completer --- and probably more.
+
+@findex _expand
+@item @t{_expand}
+This completer function does not really perform completion, but instead
+checks if the word on the command line is eligible for expansion and,
+if it is, gives detailed control over how this expansion is done. For
+this to happen, the completion system needs to be invoked with
+@t{complete-word}, not @t{expand-or-complete} (the default binding for
+@t{TAB}), as otherwise the string will be expanded by the shell's
+internal mechanism before the completion system is started.
+Note also this completer should be called before the @t{_complete}
+completer function.
+
+@noindent
+The tags used when generating expansions are @t{all-expansions} for the
+string containing all possible expansions, @t{expansions} when adding
+the possible expansions as single matches and @t{original} when adding
+the original string from the line. The order in which these strings are
+generated, if at all, can be controlled by the @t{group-order} and
+@t{tag-order} styles, as usual.
+
+@noindent
+The format string for @t{all-expansions} and for @t{expansions} may
+contain the sequence `@t{%o}' which will be replaced by the original
+string from the line.
+
+@noindent
+The kind of expansion to be tried is controlled by the @t{substitute},
+@t{glob} and @t{subst-globs-only} styles.
+
+@noindent
+It is also possible to call @t{_expand} as a function, in which case the
+different modes may be selected with options: @t{-s} for
+@t{substitute}, @t{-g} for @t{glob} and @t{-o} for @t{subst-globs-only}.
+
+@findex _expand_alias
+@item @t{_expand_alias}
+If the word the cursor is on is an alias, it is expanded and no other
+completers are called. The types of aliases which are to be expanded can
+be controlled with the styles @t{regular}, @t{global} and @t{disabled}.
+
+@noindent
+This function is also a bindable command, see
+@ref{Bindable Commands}.
+
+@findex _extensions
+@item @t{_extensions}
+If the cursor follows the string `@t{*.}', filename extensions are
+completed. The extensions are taken from files in current directory or a
+directory specified at the beginning of the current word. For exact matches,
+completion continues to allow other completers such as @t{_expand} to
+expand the pattern. The standard @t{add-space} and @t{prefix-hidden}
+styles are observed.
+
+@findex _external_pwds
+@item @t{_external_pwds}
+Completes current directories of other zsh processes belonging to the
+current user.
+
+@noindent
+This is intended to be used via @t{_generic}, bound to a custom key
+combination. Note that pattern matching is enabled so matching is
+performed similar to how it works with the @t{_match} completer.
+
+@findex _history
+@item @t{_history}
+Complete words from the shell's command history. This completer
+can be controlled by the @t{remove-all-dups}, and @t{sort} styles as for the
+@t{_history_complete_word} bindable command, see
+@ref{Bindable Commands}
+and
+@ref{Completion System Configuration}.
+
+@findex _ignored
+@item @t{_ignored}
+The @t{ignored-patterns} style can be set to a list of patterns which are
+compared against possible completions; matching ones are removed.
+With this completer those matches can be reinstated, as
+if no @t{ignored-patterns} style were set. The completer actually
+generates its own list of matches; which completers are invoked
+is determined in the same way as for the @t{_prefix} completer.
+The @t{single-ignored} style is also available as described above.
+
+@findex _list
+@item @t{_list}
+This completer allows the insertion of matches to be delayed until
+completion is attempted a second time without the word on the line
+being changed. On the first attempt, only the list of matches will be
+shown. It is affected by the styles @t{condition} and @t{word}, see
+@ref{Completion System Configuration}.
+
+@findex _match
+@item @t{_match}
+This completer is intended to be used after the @t{_complete}
+completer. It behaves similarly but the string on the command line may
+be a pattern to match against trial completions. This gives the effect
+of the @t{GLOB_COMPLETE} option.
+
+@noindent
+Normally completion will be performed by taking the pattern from the line,
+inserting a `@t{*}' at the cursor position and comparing the resulting
+pattern with the possible completions generated. This can be modified
+with the @t{match-original} style described above.
+
+@noindent
+The generated matches will be offered in a menu completion unless the
+@t{insert-unambiguous} style is set to `true'; see the description above
+for other options for this style.
+
+@noindent
+Note that matcher specifications defined globally or used by the
+completion functions (the styles @t{matcher-list} and @t{matcher}) will
+not be used.
+
+@findex _menu
+@item @t{_menu}
+This completer was written as simple example function to show how menu
+completion can be enabled in shell code. However, it has the notable
+effect of disabling menu selection which can be useful with
+@t{_generic} based widgets. It should be used as the first completer in
+the list. Note that this is independent of the setting of the
+@t{MENU_COMPLETE} option and does not work with the other menu
+completion widgets such as @t{reverse-menu-complete}, or
+@t{accept-and-menu-complete}.
+
+@findex _oldlist
+@item @t{_oldlist}
+This completer controls how the standard completion widgets behave
+when there is an existing list of completions which may have been
+generated by a special completion (i.e. a separately-bound completion
+command). It allows the ordinary completion keys to continue to use the
+list of completions thus generated, instead of producing a new list of
+ordinary contextual completions.
+It should appear in the list of completers before any of
+the widgets which generate matches. It uses two styles: @t{old-list} and
+@t{old-menu}, see
+@ref{Completion System Configuration}.
+
+@findex _precommand
+@item @t{_precommand}
+Complete an external command in word-separated arguments, as for
+@t{exec} and @t{/usr/bin/env}.
+
+@findex _prefix
+@item @t{_prefix}
+This completer can be used to try completion with the suffix (everything
+after the cursor) ignored. In other words, the suffix will not be
+considered to be part of the word to complete. The effect is similar
+to the @t{expand-or-complete-prefix} command.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{completer} style is used to decide which other completers are to
+be called to generate matches. If this style is unset, the list of
+completers set for the current context is used --- except, of course, the
+@t{_prefix} completer itself. Furthermore, if this completer appears
+more than once in the list of completers only those completers not
+already tried by the last invocation of @t{_prefix} will be called.
+
+@noindent
+For example, consider this global @t{completer} style:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle ':completion:*' completer \
+ _complete _prefix _correct _prefix:foo
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Here, the @t{_prefix} completer tries normal completion but ignoring the
+suffix. If that doesn't generate any matches, and neither does
+the call to the @t{_correct} completer after it, @t{_prefix} will
+be called a second time and, now only trying correction with the
+suffix ignored. On the second invocation the completer part of the
+context appears as `@t{foo}'.
+
+@noindent
+To use @t{_prefix} as the last resort and try only normal completion
+when it is invoked:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle ':completion:*' completer _complete ... _prefix
+zstyle ':completion::prefix:*' completer _complete
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The @t{add-space} style is also respected. If it is set to `true' then
+@t{_prefix} will insert a space between the matches generated (if any)
+and the suffix.
+
+@noindent
+Note that this completer is only useful if the
+@t{COMPLETE_IN_WORD} option is set; otherwise, the cursor will
+be moved to the end of the current word before the completion code is
+called and hence there will be no suffix.
+
+@findex _user_expand
+@item @t{_user_expand}
+This completer behaves similarly to the @t{_expand} completer but
+instead performs expansions defined by users. The styles @t{add-space} and
+@t{sort} styles specific to the @t{_expand} completer are usable with
+@t{_user_expand} in addition to other styles handled more generally by
+the completion system. The tag @t{all-expansions} is also available.
+
+@noindent
+The expansion depends on the array style @t{user-expand} being defined
+for the current context; remember that the context for completers is less
+specific than that for contextual completion as the full context has not
+yet been determined. Elements of the array may have one of the following
+forms:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{$}@var{hash}
+
+@var{hash} is the name of an associative array. Note this is not a full
+parameter expression, merely a @t{$}, suitably quoted to prevent immediate
+expansion, followed by the name of an associative array. If the trial
+expansion word matches a key in @var{hash}, the resulting expansion is the
+corresponding value.
+
+@item @var{_func}
+
+@var{_func} is the name of a shell function whose name must begin with
+@t{_} but is not otherwise special to the completion system. The function
+is called with the trial word as an argument. If the word is to be
+expanded, the function should set the array @t{reply} to a list of
+expansions. Optionally, it can set @t{REPLY} to a word that will
+be used as a description for the set of expansions.
+The return status of the function is irrelevant.
+
+@end table
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+@node Bindable Commands, Completion Functions, Control Functions, Completion System
+
+@section Bindable Commands
+@noindent
+@cindex completion system, bindable commands
+
+@noindent
+In addition to the context-dependent completions provided, which are
+expected to work in an intuitively obvious way, there are a few widgets
+implementing special behaviour which can be bound separately to keys. The
+following is a list of these and their default bindings.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex _bash_completions
+@item @t{_bash_completions}
+This function is used by two widgets, @t{_bash_complete-word} and
+@t{_bash_list-choices}. It exists to provide compatibility with
+completion bindings in bash. The last character of the binding determines
+what is completed: `@t{!}', command names; `@t{$}', environment variables;
+`@t{@@}', host names; `@t{/}', file names; `@t{~}' user names. In bash, the
+binding preceded by `@t{\e}' gives completion, and preceded by `@t{^X}'
+lists options. As some of these bindings clash with standard zsh
+bindings, only `@t{\e~}' and `@t{^X~}' are bound by default. To add the
+rest, the following should be added to @t{.zshrc} after @t{compinit} has
+been run:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+for key in '!' '$' '@@' '/' '~'; do
+ bindkey "\e$key" _bash_complete-word
+ bindkey "^X$key" _bash_list-choices
+done
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+This includes the bindings for `@t{~}' in case they were already bound to
+something else; the completion code does not override user bindings.
+
+@findex _correct_filename (^XC)
+@item @t{_correct_filename} (@t{^XC})
+Correct the filename path at the cursor position. Allows up to six errors
+in the name. Can also be called with an argument to correct
+a filename path, independently of zle; the correction is printed on
+standard output.
+
+@findex _correct_word (^Xc)
+@item @t{_correct_word} (@t{^Xc})
+Performs correction of the current argument using the usual contextual
+completions as possible choices. This stores the string
+`@t{correct-word}' in the @var{function} field of the context name and
+then calls the @t{_correct} completer.
+
+@findex _expand_alias (^Xa)
+@item @t{_expand_alias} (@t{^Xa})
+This function can be used as a completer and as a bindable command.
+It expands the word the cursor is on if it is an alias. The types of
+alias expanded can be controlled with the styles @t{regular}, @t{global}
+and @t{disabled}.
+
+@noindent
+When used as a bindable command there is one additional feature that
+can be selected by setting the @t{complete} style to `true'. In this
+case, if the word is not the name of an alias, @t{_expand_alias} tries
+to complete the word to a full alias name without expanding it. It
+leaves the cursor directly after the completed word so that invoking
+@t{_expand_alias} once more will expand the now-complete alias name.
+
+@findex _expand_word (^Xe)
+@item @t{_expand_word} (@t{^Xe})
+Performs expansion on the current word: equivalent to the standard
+@t{expand-word} command, but using the @t{_expand} completer. Before
+calling it, the @var{function} field of the context is set to
+`@t{expand-word}'.
+
+@findex _generic
+@item @t{_generic}
+This function is not defined as a widget and not bound by
+default. However, it can be used to define a widget and will then
+store the name of the widget in the @var{function} field of the context
+and call the completion system. This allows custom completion widgets
+with their own set of style settings to be defined easily. For example,
+to define a widget that performs normal completion and starts
+menu selection:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zle -C foo complete-word _generic
+bindkey '...' foo
+zstyle ':completion:foo:*' menu yes select=1
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Note in particular that the @t{completer} style may be set for the context
+in order to change the set of functions used to generate possible matches.
+If @t{_generic} is called with arguments, those are passed through to
+@t{_main_complete} as the list of completers in place of those defined by
+the @t{completer} style.
+
+@findex _history_complete_word (\e/)
+@item @t{_history_complete_word} (@t{\e/})
+Complete words from the shell's command history. This uses the
+@t{list}, @t{remove-all-dups}, @t{sort}, and @t{stop} styles.
+
+@findex _most_recent_file (^Xm)
+@item @t{_most_recent_file} (@t{^Xm})
+Complete the name of the most recently modified file matching the pattern
+on the command line (which may be blank). If given a numeric argument
+@var{N}, complete the @var{N}th most recently modified file. Note the
+completion, if any, is always unique.
+
+@findex _next_tags (^Xn)
+@item @t{_next_tags} (@t{^Xn})
+This command alters the set of matches used to that for the next tag, or
+set of tags, either as given by the @t{tag-order} style or as set by
+default; these matches would otherwise not be available.
+Successive invocations of the command cycle through all possible sets of
+tags.
+
+@findex _read_comp (^X^R)
+@item @t{_read_comp} (@t{^X^R})
+Prompt the user for a string, and use that to perform completion on the
+current word. There are two possibilities for the string. First, it can
+be a set of words beginning `@t{_}', for example `@t{_files -/}', in which
+case the function with any arguments will be called to generate the
+completions. Unambiguous parts of the function name will be completed
+automatically (normal completion is not available at this point) until a
+space is typed.
+
+@noindent
+Second, any other string will be passed as a set of arguments to
+@t{compadd} and should hence be an expression specifying what should
+be completed.
+
+@noindent
+A very restricted set of editing commands is available when reading the
+string: `@t{DEL}' and `@t{^H}' delete the last character; `@t{^U}' deletes
+the line, and `@t{^C}' and `@t{^G}' abort the function, while `@t{RET}'
+accepts the completion. Note the string is used verbatim as a command
+line, so arguments must be quoted in accordance with standard shell rules.
+
+@noindent
+Once a string has been read, the next call to @t{_read_comp} will use the
+existing string instead of reading a new one. To force a new string to be
+read, call @t{_read_comp} with a numeric argument.
+
+@findex _complete_debug (^X?)
+@item @t{_complete_debug} (@t{^X?})
+This widget performs ordinary completion, but captures in a temporary file
+a trace of the shell commands executed by the completion system. Each
+completion attempt gets its own file. A command to view each of these
+files is pushed onto the editor buffer stack.
+
+@findex _complete_help (^Xh)
+@item @t{_complete_help} (@t{^Xh})
+This widget displays information about the context names,
+the tags, and the completion functions used
+when completing at the current cursor position. If given a numeric
+argument other than @t{1} (as in `@t{ESC-2 ^Xh}'), then the styles
+used and the contexts for which they are used will be shown, too.
+
+@noindent
+Note that the information about styles may be incomplete; it depends on the
+information available from the completion functions called, which in turn
+is determined by the user's own styles and other settings.
+
+@findex _complete_help_generic
+@item @t{_complete_help_generic}
+Unlike other commands listed here, this must be created as a normal ZLE
+widget rather than a completion widget (i.e. with @t{zle -N}). It
+is used for generating help with a widget bound to the @t{_generic}
+widget that is described above.
+
+@noindent
+If this widget is created using the name of the function, as it is by
+default, then when executed it will read a key sequence. This is expected
+to be bound to a call to a completion function that uses the @t{_generic}
+widget. That widget will be executed, and information provided in
+the same format that the @t{_complete_help} widget displays for
+contextual completion.
+
+@noindent
+If the widget's name contains @t{debug}, for example if it is created
+as `@t{zle -N _complete_debug_generic _complete_help_generic}', it
+will read and execute the keystring for a generic widget as before,
+but then generate debugging information as done by @t{_complete_debug}
+for contextual completion.
+
+@noindent
+If the widget's name contains @t{noread}, it will not read a keystring
+but instead arrange that the next use of a generic widget run in
+the same shell will have the effect as described above.
+
+@noindent
+The widget works by setting the shell parameter
+@t{ZSH_TRACE_GENERIC_WIDGET} which is read by @t{_generic}. Unsetting
+the parameter cancels any pending effect of the @t{noread} form.
+
+@noindent
+For example, after executing the following:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zle -N _complete_debug_generic _complete_help_generic
+bindkey '^x:' _complete_debug_generic
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+typing `@t{C-x :}' followed by the key sequence for a generic widget
+will cause trace output for that widget to be saved to a file.
+
+@findex _complete_tag (^Xt)
+@item @t{_complete_tag} (@t{^Xt})
+This widget completes symbol tags created by the @t{etags} or @t{ctags}
+programmes (note there is no connection with the completion system's tags)
+stored in a file @t{TAGS}, in the format used by @t{etags}, or @t{tags}, in the
+format created by @t{ctags}. It will look back up the path hierarchy for
+the first occurrence of either file; if both exist, the file @t{TAGS} is
+preferred. You can specify the full path to a @t{TAGS} or @t{tags} file by
+setting the parameter @t{$TAGSFILE} or @t{$tagsfile} respectively.
+The corresponding completion tags used are @t{etags} and @t{vtags}, after
+emacs and vi respectively.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+@node Completion Functions, Completion System Variables, Bindable Commands, Completion System
+
+@section Utility Functions
+@noindent
+@cindex completion system, utility functions
+
+@noindent
+Descriptions follow for utility functions that may be
+useful when writing completion functions. If functions are installed in
+subdirectories, most of these reside in the
+@t{Base} subdirectory. Like the example
+functions for commands in the distribution, the utility functions
+generating matches all follow the convention of returning status zero if they
+generated completions and non-zero if no matching completions could be
+added.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex _absolute_command_paths
+@item @t{_absolute_command_paths}
+This function completes external commands as absolute paths (unlike
+@t{_command_names -e} which completes their basenames). It takes no
+arguments.
+
+@findex _all_labels
+@item @t{_all_labels} [ @t{-x} ] [ @t{-12VJ} ] @var{tag} @var{name} @var{descr} [ @var{command} @var{arg} ... ]
+This is a convenient interface to the @t{_next_label} function below,
+implementing the loop shown in the @t{_next_label} example. The
+@var{command} and its arguments are called to generate the matches. The
+options stored in the parameter @var{name} will automatically be inserted
+into the @var{arg}s passed to the @var{command}. Normally, they are put
+directly after the @var{command}, but if one of the @var{arg}s is a single
+hyphen, they are inserted directly before that. If the hyphen is the last
+argument, it will be removed from the argument list before the
+@var{command} is called. This allows @t{_all_labels} to be used in almost all
+cases where the matches can be generated by a single call to the
+@t{compadd} builtin command or by a call to one of the utility functions.
+
+@noindent
+For example:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+local expl
+...
+if _requested foo; then
+ ...
+ _all_labels foo expl '...' compadd ... - $matches
+fi
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Will complete the strings from the @t{matches} parameter, using
+@t{compadd} with additional options which will take precedence over
+those generated by @t{_all_labels}.
+
+@findex _alternative
+@item @t{_alternative} [ @t{-O} @var{name} ] [ @t{-C} @var{name} ] @var{spec} ...
+This function is useful in simple cases where multiple tags are available.
+Essentially it implements a loop like the one described for the @t{_tags}
+function below.
+
+@noindent
+The tags to use and the action to perform if a tag is requested are
+described using the @var{spec}s which are of the form:
+`@var{tag}@t{:}@var{descr}@t{:}@var{action}'. The @var{tag}s are offered using
+@t{_tags} and if the tag is requested, the @var{action} is executed with the
+given description @var{descr}. The @var{action}s are those accepted
+by the @t{_arguments} function (described below), excluding the
+`@t{->}@var{state}' and `@t{=}@var{...}' forms.
+
+@noindent
+For example, the @var{action} may be a simple function call:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+_alternative \
+ 'users:user:_users' \
+ 'hosts:host:_hosts'
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+offers usernames and hostnames as possible matches,
+generated by the @t{_users} and @t{_hosts} functions respectively.
+
+@noindent
+Like @t{_arguments}, this function uses @t{_all_labels} to execute
+the actions, which will loop over all sets of tags. Special handling is
+only required if there is an additional valid tag, for example inside a
+function called from @t{_alternative}.
+
+@noindent
+The option `@t{-O} @var{name}' is used in the same way as by the
+@t{_arguments} function. In other words, the elements of the @var{name}
+array will be passed to @t{compadd} when executing an action.
+
+@noindent
+Like @t{_tags} this function supports the @t{-C} option to give a
+different name for the argument context field.
+
+@findex _arguments
+
+@item @t{_arguments }[ @t{-nswWCRS} ] [ @t{-A} @var{pat} ] [ @t{-O} @var{name} ] [ @t{-M} @var{matchspec} ]
+@itemx @t{@ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ }[ @t{:} ] @var{spec} ...
+@itemx @t{_arguments }[ @var{opt} ... ] @t{-}@t{-} [ @t{-l} ] [ @t{-i} @var{pats} ] [ @t{-s} @var{pair} ]
+@itemx @t{@ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ }[ @var{helpspec} ...]
+This function can be used to give a complete specification for completion
+for a command whose arguments follow standard UNIX option and argument
+conventions.
+
+@noindent
+@emph{Options Overview}
+
+@noindent
+Options to @t{_arguments} itself must be in separate words, i.e. @t{-s -w},
+not @t{-sw}. The options are followed by @var{spec}s that describe options and
+arguments of the analyzed command. To avoid ambiguity, all
+options to @t{_arguments} itself may be separated from the @var{spec} forms
+by a single colon.
+
+@noindent
+The `@t{-}@t{-}'
+form is used to intuit @var{spec} forms from the help output of the command
+being analyzed, and is described in detail below. The @var{opts} for the
+`@t{-}@t{-}' form are otherwise the same options as the first form. Note
+that `@t{-s}' following `@t{-}@t{-}' has a distinct meaning from `@t{-s}'
+preceding `@t{-}@t{-}', and both may appear.
+
+@noindent
+The option switches @t{-s}, @t{-S}, @t{-A}, @t{-w}, and @t{-W} affect how
+@t{_arguments} parses the analyzed command line's options. These switches are
+useful for commands with standard argument parsing.
+
+@noindent
+The options of @t{_arguments} have the following meanings:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{-n}
+With this option, @t{_arguments} sets the parameter @t{NORMARG}
+to the position of the first normal argument in the @t{$words} array,
+i.e. the position after the end of the options. If that argument
+has not been reached, @t{NORMARG} is set to @t{-1}. The caller
+should declare `@t{integer NORMARG}' if the @t{-n} option is passed;
+otherwise the parameter is not used.
+
+@item @t{-s}
+Enable @emph{option stacking} for single-letter options, whereby multiple
+single-letter options may be combined into a single word. For example,
+the two options `@t{-x}' and `@t{-y}' may be combined into
+a single word `@t{-xy}'. By default, every word corresponds to a single
+option name (`@t{-xy}' is a single option named `@t{xy}').
+
+@noindent
+Options beginning with a single hyphen or plus sign are eligible for stacking;
+words beginning with two hyphens are not.
+
+@noindent
+Note that @t{-s} after @t{-}@t{-} has a different meaning, which is documented
+in the segment entitled `Deriving @var{spec} forms from the help output'.
+
+@item @t{-w}
+In combination with @t{-s}, allow option stacking
+even if one or more of the options take
+arguments. For example, if @t{-x} takes an argument, with no
+@t{-s}, `@t{-xy}' is considered as a single (unhandled) option; with
+@t{-s}, @t{-xy} is an option with the argument `@t{y}'; with both @t{-s}
+and @t{-w}, @t{-xy} is the option @t{-x} and the option @t{-y} with
+arguments to @t{-x} (and to @t{-y}, if it takes arguments) still to come
+in subsequent words.
+
+@item @t{-W}
+This option takes @t{-w} a stage further: it is possible to
+complete single-letter options even after an argument that occurs in the
+same word. However, it depends on the action performed whether options
+will really be completed at this point. For more control, use a
+utility function like @t{_guard} as part of the action.
+
+@item @t{-C}
+Modify the @t{curcontext} parameter for an action of the form `@t{->}@var{state}'.
+This is discussed in detail below.
+
+@item @t{-R}
+Return status 300 instead of zero when a @t{$state} is to
+be handled, in the `@t{->}@var{string}' syntax.
+
+@item @t{-S}
+Do not complete options after a `@t{-}@t{-}' appearing on the line,
+and ignore the `@t{-}@t{-}'. For example, with @t{-S}, in the line
+
+@noindent
+@example
+foobar -x -- -y
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+the `@t{-x}' is considered an option, the `@t{-y}' is considered an
+argument, and the `@t{-}@t{-}' is considered to be neither.
+
+@item @t{-A} @var{pat}
+Do not complete options after the first non-option
+argument on the line. @var{pat} is a pattern matching
+all strings which are not to be taken as arguments. For example, to make
+@t{_arguments} stop completing options after the first normal argument, but
+ignoring all strings starting with a hyphen even if they are not described
+by one of the @var{optspec}s, the form is `@t{-A "-*"}'.
+
+@item @t{-O} @var{name}
+Pass the elements of the array @var{name} as arguments to functions called to
+execute @var{action}s.
+This is discussed in detail below.
+
+@item @t{-M} @var{matchspec}
+Use the match specification @var{matchspec} for completing option names and values.
+The default @var{matchspec} allows partial word completion after `@t{_}' and
+`@t{-}', such as completing `@t{-f-b}' to `@t{-foo-bar}'. The default
+@var{matchspec} is:
+@example
+@t{r:|[_-]=* r:|=*}
+@end example
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+@emph{@var{spec}s: overview}
+
+@noindent
+Each of the following forms is a @var{spec} describing individual sets of
+options or arguments on the command line being analyzed.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @var{n}@t{:}@var{message}@t{:}@var{action}
+@itemx @var{n}@t{::}@var{message}@t{:}@var{action}
+This describes the @var{n}'th normal argument. The @var{message} will be
+printed above the matches generated and the @var{action} indicates what can
+be completed in this position (see below). If there are two colons
+before the @var{message} the argument is optional. If the
+@var{message} contains only white space, nothing will be printed above
+the matches unless the action adds an explanation string itself.
+
+@item @t{:}@var{message}@t{:}@var{action}
+@itemx @t{::}@var{message}@t{:}@var{action}
+Similar, but describes the @emph{next} argument, whatever number that
+happens to be. If all arguments are specified in this form in the
+correct order the numbers are unnecessary.
+
+@item @t{*:}@var{message}@t{:}@var{action}
+@itemx @t{*::}@var{message}@t{:}@var{action}
+@itemx @t{*:::}@var{message}@t{:}@var{action}
+This describes how arguments (usually non-option arguments, those not
+beginning with @t{-} or @t{+}) are to be completed when neither
+of the first two forms was provided. Any number of arguments can
+be completed in this fashion.
+
+@noindent
+With two colons before the @var{message}, the @t{words} special array and
+the @t{CURRENT} special parameter are modified to refer only to the
+normal arguments when the @var{action} is executed or evaluated. With
+three colons before the @var{message} they are modified to refer only to
+the normal arguments covered by this description.
+
+@item @var{optspec}
+@itemx @var{optspec}@t{:}@var{...}
+This describes an option. The colon indicates handling for one or more
+arguments to the option; if it is not present, the option is assumed to
+take no arguments.
+
+@noindent
+The following forms are available for the initial @var{optspec}, whether
+or not the option has arguments.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{*}@var{optspec}
+Here @var{optspec} is one of the remaining forms below. This indicates
+the following @var{optspec} may be repeated. Otherwise if the
+corresponding option is already present on the command line to the left
+of the cursor it will not be offered again.
+
+@item @t{-}@var{optname}
+@itemx @t{+}@var{optname}
+In the simplest form the @var{optspec} is just the option name beginning
+with a minus or a plus sign, such as `@t{-foo}'. The first argument for
+the option (if any) must follow as a @emph{separate} word directly after the
+option.
+
+@noindent
+Either of `@t{-+}@var{optname}' and `@t{+-}@var{optname}' can be used to
+specify that @t{-}@var{optname} and @t{+}@var{optname} are both valid.
+
+@noindent
+In all the remaining forms, the leading `@t{-}' may be replaced by or
+paired with `@t{+}' in this way.
+
+@item @t{-}@var{optname}@t{-}
+The first argument of the option must come directly after the option name
+@emph{in the same word}. For example, `@t{-foo-:}@var{...}' specifies that
+the completed option and argument will look like `@t{-foo}@var{arg}'.
+
+@item @t{-}@var{optname}@t{+}
+The first argument may appear immediately after @var{optname} in the same
+word, or may appear as a separate word after the option. For example,
+`@t{-foo+:}@var{...}' specifies that the completed option and argument
+will look like either `@t{-foo}@var{arg}' or `@t{-foo} @var{arg}'.
+
+@item @t{-}@var{optname}@t{=}
+The argument may appear as the next word, or in same word as the option
+name provided that it is separated from it by an equals sign, for
+example `@t{-foo=}@var{arg}' or `@t{-foo} @var{arg}'.
+
+@item @t{-}@var{optname}@t{=-}
+The argument to the option must appear after an equals sign in the same
+word, and may not be given in the next argument.
+
+@item @var{optspec}@t{[}@var{explanation}@t{]}
+An explanation string may be appended to any of the preceding forms of
+@var{optspec} by enclosing it in brackets, as in `@t{-q[query operation]}'.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{verbose} style is used to decide whether the explanation strings
+are displayed with the option in a completion listing.
+
+@noindent
+If no bracketed explanation string is given but the @t{auto-description}
+style is set and only one argument is described for this @var{optspec}, the
+value of the style is displayed, with any appearance of the sequence
+`@t{%d}' in it replaced by the @var{message} of the first @var{optarg}
+that follows the @var{optspec}; see below.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+It is possible for options with a literal `@t{+}' or `@t{=}' to
+appear, but that character must be quoted, for example `@t{-\+}'.
+
+@noindent
+Each @var{optarg} following an @var{optspec} must take one of the
+following forms:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{:}@var{message}@t{:}@var{action}
+@itemx @t{::}@var{message}@t{:}@var{action}
+An argument to the option; @var{message} and @var{action} are treated as
+for ordinary arguments. In the first form, the argument is mandatory,
+and in the second form it is optional.
+
+@noindent
+This group may be repeated for options which take multiple arguments.
+In other words,
+@t{:}@var{message1}@t{:}@var{action1}@t{:}@var{message2}@t{:}@var{action2}
+specifies that the option takes two arguments.
+
+@item @t{:*}@var{pattern}@t{:}@var{message}@t{:}@var{action}
+@itemx @t{:*}@var{pattern}@t{::}@var{message}@t{:}@var{action}
+@itemx @t{:*}@var{pattern}@t{:::}@var{message}@t{:}@var{action}
+This describes multiple arguments. Only the last @var{optarg} for
+an option taking multiple arguments may be
+given in this form. If the @var{pattern} is empty (i.e. @t{:*:}), all
+the remaining words on the line are to be completed as described by the
+@var{action}; otherwise, all the words up to and including a word matching
+the @var{pattern} are to be completed using the @var{action}.
+
+@noindent
+Multiple colons are treated as for the `@t{*:}@var{...}' forms for
+ordinary arguments: when the @var{message} is preceded by two colons,
+the @t{words} special array and the @t{CURRENT} special parameter are
+modified during the execution or evaluation of the @var{action} to refer
+only to the words after the option. When preceded by three colons, they
+are modified to refer only to the words covered by this description.
+
+@end table
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+Any literal colon in an @var{optname}, @var{message}, or @var{action}
+must be preceded by a backslash, `@t{\:}'.
+
+@noindent
+Each of the forms above may be preceded by a list in parentheses
+of option names and argument numbers. If the given option is on
+the command line, the options and arguments indicated in parentheses
+will not be offered. For example,
+`@t{(-two -three 1)-one:}@var{...}' completes the option `@t{-one}'; if this
+appears on the command line, the options @t{-two} and @t{-three} and the
+first ordinary argument will not be completed after it.
+`@t{(-foo):}@var{...}' specifies an ordinary argument completion;
+@t{-foo} will not be completed if that argument is already present.
+
+@noindent
+Other items may appear in the list of excluded options to indicate
+various other items that should not be applied when the current
+specification is matched: a single star (@t{*}) for the rest arguments
+(i.e. a specification of the form `@t{*:}@var{...}'); a colon (@t{:})
+for all normal (non-option-) arguments; and a hyphen (@t{-}) for all
+options. For example, if `@t{(*)}' appears before an option and the
+option appears on the command line, the list of remaining arguments
+(those shown in the above table beginning with `@t{*:}') will not be
+completed.
+
+@noindent
+To aid in reuse of specifications, it is possible to precede any of the
+forms above with `@t{!}'; then the form will no longer be completed,
+although if the option or argument appears on the command line they will
+be skipped as normal. The main use for this is when the arguments are
+given by an array, and @t{_arguments} is called repeatedly for more
+specific contexts: on the first call `@t{_arguments $global_options}' is
+used, and on subsequent calls `@t{_arguments !$^global_options}'.
+
+@noindent
+@emph{@var{spec}s: actions}
+
+@noindent
+In each of the forms above the @var{action} determines how
+completions should be generated. Except for the `@t{->}@var{string}'
+form below, the @var{action} will be executed by calling the
+@t{_all_labels} function to process all tag labels. No special handling
+of tags is needed unless a function call introduces a new one.
+
+@noindent
+The functions called to execute @var{action}s will be called with the
+elements of the array named by the `@t{-O} @var{name}' option as arguments.
+This can be used, for example, to pass the same set of options for the
+@t{compadd} builtin to all @var{action}s.
+
+@noindent
+The forms for @var{action} are as follows.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{@ }(single unquoted space)
+This is useful where an argument is required but it is not possible or
+desirable to generate matches for it. The
+@var{message} will be displayed but no completions listed. Note
+that even in this case the colon at the end of the @var{message} is
+needed; it may only be omitted when neither a @var{message}
+nor an @var{action} is given.
+
+@item @t{(}@var{item1} @var{item2} @var{...}@t{)}
+One of a list of possible matches, for example:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+@t{:foo:(foo bar baz}@t{)}
+@end example
+
+@item @t{((@var{item1}\:@var{desc1} @var{...}))}
+Similar to the above, but with descriptions for each possible match.
+Note the backslash before the colon. For example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+@t{:foo:((a\:bar b\:baz}@t{))}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The matches will be listed together with their descriptions if the
+@t{description} style is set with the @t{values} tag in the context.
+
+@item @t{->}@var{string}
+@vindex context, use of
+@vindex line, use of
+@vindex opt_args, use of
+In this form, @t{_arguments} processes the arguments and options and then
+returns control to the calling function with parameters set to indicate the
+state of processing; the calling function then makes its own arrangements
+for generating completions. For example, functions that implement a state
+machine can use this type of action.
+
+@noindent
+Where @t{_arguments} encounters @var{action} in the `@t{->}@var{string}'
+format, it will strip all leading and trailing whitespace from @var{string}
+and set the array @t{state} to the set of all @var{string}s for which an
+action is to be performed. The elements of the array @t{state_descr} are
+assigned the corresponding @var{message} field from each @var{optarg}
+containing such an @var{action}.
+
+@noindent
+By default and in common with all other well behaved completion
+functions, _arguments returns status zero if it was able to add matches and
+non-zero otherwise. However, if the @t{-R} option is given,
+@t{_arguments} will instead return a status of 300 to indicate that
+@t{$state} is to be handled.
+
+@noindent
+In addition to @t{$state} and @t{$state_descr}, @t{_arguments} also
+sets the global
+parameters `@t{context}', `@t{line}' and `@t{opt_args}' as described
+below, and does not reset any changes made to the special parameters
+such as @t{PREFIX} and @t{words}. This gives the calling function the
+choice of resetting these parameters or propagating changes in them.
+
+@noindent
+A function calling @t{_arguments} with at least
+one action containing a `@t{->}@var{string}' must therefore declare
+appropriate local parameters:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+local context state state_descr line
+typeset -A opt_args
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+to prevent @t{_arguments} from altering the global environment.
+
+@item @t{@{}@var{eval-string}@t{@}}
+@vindex expl, use of
+A string in braces is evaluated as shell code to generate matches. If the
+@var{eval-string} itself does not begin with an opening parenthesis or
+brace it is split into separate words before execution.
+
+@item @t{= }@var{action}
+If the @var{action} starts with `@t{= }' (an equals sign followed by a
+space), @t{_arguments} will insert the contents of the @var{argument}
+field of the current context as the new first element in the @t{words}
+special array and increment the value of the @t{CURRENT} special
+parameter. This has the effect of inserting a dummy word onto the
+completion command line while not changing the point at which completion is
+taking place.
+
+@noindent
+This is most useful with one of the specifiers that restrict the words on
+the command line on which the @var{action} is to operate (the two- and
+three-colon forms above). One particular use is when an @var{action} itself
+causes @t{_arguments} on a restricted range; it is necessary to use this
+trick to insert an appropriate command name into the range for the second
+call to @t{_arguments} to be able to parse the line.
+
+@item @var{@t{@ }word...}
+@itemx @var{word...}
+This covers all forms other than those above. If the @var{action}
+starts with a space, the remaining list of words will be invoked unchanged.
+
+@noindent
+Otherwise it will be invoked with some extra strings placed after the
+first word; these are to be passed down as options to the @t{compadd}
+builtin. They ensure that the state specified by @t{_arguments}, in
+particular the descriptions of options and arguments, is correctly passed
+to the completion command. These additional arguments
+are taken from the array parameter `@t{expl}'; this will be set up
+before executing the @var{action} and hence may be referred to inside it,
+typically in an expansion of the form `@t{$expl[@@]}' which preserves empty
+elements of the array.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+During the performance of the action the array `@t{line}' will be set to
+the normal arguments from the command line, i.e. the words from the
+command line after the command name excluding all options and their
+arguments. Options are stored in the associative array
+`@t{opt_args}' with option names as keys and their arguments as
+the values. For options that have more than one argument these are
+given as one string, separated by colons. All colons and backslashes
+in the original arguments are preceded with backslashes.
+
+@noindent
+The parameter `@t{context}' is set when returning to the calling function
+to perform an action of the form `@t{->}@var{string}'. It is set to an
+array of elements corresponding to the elements of @t{$state}. Each
+element is a suitable name for the argument field of the context: either a
+string of the form `@t{option}@var{-opt}@t{-}@var{n}' for the @var{n}'th
+argument of the option @var{-opt}, or a string of the form
+`@t{argument-}@var{n}' for the @var{n}'th argument. For `rest' arguments,
+that is those in the list at the end not handled by position, @var{n} is the
+string `@t{rest}'. For example, when completing the argument of the @t{-o}
+option, the name is `@t{option-o-1}', while for the second normal
+(non-option-) argument it is `@t{argument-2}'.
+
+@noindent
+Furthermore, during the evaluation of the @var{action} the context name in
+the @t{curcontext} parameter is altered to append the same string that is
+stored in the @t{context} parameter.
+
+@noindent
+The option @t{-C} tells @t{_arguments} to modify the @t{curcontext}
+parameter for an action of the form `@t{->}@var{state}'. This is the
+standard parameter used to keep track of the current context. Here it
+(and not the @t{context} array) should be made local to the calling
+function to avoid passing back the modified value and should be
+initialised to the current value at the start of the function:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+local curcontext="$curcontext"
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+This is useful where it is not possible for multiple states to be valid
+together.
+
+@noindent
+@emph{Grouping Options}
+
+@noindent
+Options can be grouped to simplify exclusion lists. A group is
+introduced with `@t{+}' followed by a name for the group in the
+subsequent word. Whole groups can then be referenced in an exclusion
+list or a group name can be used to disambiguate between two forms of
+the same option. For example:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+_arguments \
+ '(group2--x)-a' \
+ + group1 \
+ -m \
+ '(group2)-n' \
+ + group2 \
+ -x -y
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+If the name of a group is specified in the form
+`@t{(}@var{name}@t{)}' then only one value from that group
+will ever be completed; more formally, all specifications are mutually
+exclusive to all other specifications in that group. This is useful for
+defining options that are aliases for each other. For example:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+_arguments \
+ -a -b \
+ + '(operation)' \
+ @{-c,--compress@}'[compress]' \
+ @{-d,--decompress@}'[decompress]' \
+ @{-l,--list@}'[list]'
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+If an option in a group appears on the command line, it is stored in the
+associative array `@t{opt_args}' with '@var{group}@t{-}@var{option}'
+as a key. In the example above, a key `@t{operation--c}' is used if the option
+`@t{-c}' is present on the command line.
+
+@noindent
+@emph{Specifying Multiple Sets of Arguments}
+
+@noindent
+It is possible to specify multiple sets of options and arguments with
+the sets separated by single hyphens. This differs from groups in that
+sets are considered to be mutually exclusive of each other.
+
+@noindent
+Specifications before the first set and from any group are common to
+all sets. For example:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+_arguments \
+ -a \
+ - set1 \
+ -c \
+ - set2 \
+ -d \
+ ':arg:(x2 y2)'
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+This defines two sets. When the command line contains the option
+`@t{-c}', the `@t{-d}' option and the argument will not be considered
+possible completions. When it contains `@t{-d}' or an argument, the
+option `@t{-c}' will not be considered. However, after `@t{-a}'
+both sets will still be considered valid.
+
+@noindent
+As for groups, the name of a set may appear in exclusion lists, either
+alone or preceding a normal option or argument specification.
+
+@noindent
+The completion code has to parse the command line separately for each
+set. This can be slow so sets should only be used when necessary.
+A useful alternative is often an option specification with rest-arguments
+(as in `@t{-foo:*:...}'); here the option @t{-foo} swallows up all
+remaining arguments as described by the @var{optarg} definitions.
+
+@noindent
+@emph{Deriving @var{spec} forms from the help output}
+
+@noindent
+The option `@t{-}@t{-}' allows @t{_arguments} to work out the names of long
+options that support the `@t{-}@t{-help}' option which is standard in many
+GNU commands. The command word is called with the argument
+`@t{-}@t{-help}' and the output examined for option names. Clearly, it can
+be dangerous to pass this to commands which may not support this option as
+the behaviour of the command is unspecified.
+
+@noindent
+In addition to options, `@t{_arguments -}@t{-}' will try to deduce the
+types of arguments available for options when the form
+`@t{-}@t{-}@var{opt}@t{=}@var{val}' is valid. It is also possible to provide
+hints by examining the help text of the command and adding @var{helpspec} of
+the form `@var{pattern}@t{:}@var{message}@t{:}@var{action}'; note that other
+@t{_arguments} @var{spec} forms are not used. The @var{pattern} is matched
+against the help text for an option, and if it matches the @var{message} and
+@var{action} are used as for other argument specifiers. The special case
+of `@t{*:}' means both @var{message} and @var{action} are empty, which has
+the effect of causing options having no description in the help output to
+be ordered in listings ahead of options that have a description.
+
+@noindent
+For example:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+_arguments -- '*\*:toggle:(yes no)' \
+ '*=FILE*:file:_files' \
+ '*=DIR*:directory:_files -/' \
+ '*=PATH*:directory:_files -/'
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Here, `@t{yes}' and `@t{no}' will be completed as the argument of
+options whose description ends in a star; file names will be completed for
+options that contain the substring `@t{=FILE}' in the description; and
+directories will be completed for options whose description contains
+`@t{=DIR}' or `@t{=PATH}'. The last three are in fact the default and so
+need not be given explicitly, although it is possible to override the use
+of these patterns. A typical help text which uses this feature is:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+ -C, --directory=DIR change to directory DIR
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+so that the above specifications will cause directories to be completed
+after `@t{-}@t{-directory}', though not after `@t{-C}'.
+
+@noindent
+Note also that @t{_arguments} tries to find out automatically if the
+argument for an option is optional. This can be specified explicitly by
+doubling the colon before the @var{message}.
+
+@noindent
+If the @var{pattern} ends in `@t{(-)}', this will be removed from the
+pattern and the @var{action} will be used only directly after the
+`@t{=}', not in the next word. This is the behaviour of a normal
+specification defined with the form `@t{=-}'.
+
+@noindent
+By default, the command (with the option `@t{--help}') is run after
+resetting all the locale categories (except for @t{LC_CTYPE}) to `@t{C}'.
+If the localized help output is known to work, the option `@t{-l}' can
+be specified after the `@t{_arguments -}@t{-}' so that the command is
+run in the current locale.
+
+@noindent
+The `@t{_arguments -}@t{-}' can be followed by the option `@t{-i}
+@var{patterns}' to give patterns for options which are not to be
+completed. The patterns can be given as the name of an array parameter
+or as a literal list in parentheses. For example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+_arguments -- -i \
+ "(--(en|dis)able-FEATURE*)"
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+will cause completion to ignore the options
+`@t{-}@t{-enable-FEATURE}' and `@t{-}@t{-disable-FEATURE}' (this example is
+useful with GNU @t{configure}).
+
+@noindent
+The `@t{_arguments -}@t{-}' form can also be followed by the option `@t{-s}
+@var{pair}' to describe option aliases. The @var{pair} consists of a list
+of alternating patterns and corresponding replacements, enclosed in parens
+and quoted so that it forms a single argument word in the @t{_arguments}
+call.
+
+@noindent
+For example, some @t{configure}-script help output describes options only
+as `@t{-}@t{-enable-foo}', but the script also accepts the negated form
+`@t{-}@t{-disable-foo}'. To allow completion of the second form:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+_arguments -- -s "((#s)--enable- --disable-)"
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+@emph{Miscellaneous notes}
+
+@noindent
+Finally, note that @t{_arguments} generally expects to be the primary
+function handling any completion for which it is used. It may have side
+effects which change the treatment of any matches added by other functions
+called after it. To combine @t{_arguments} with other functions, those
+functions should be called either before @t{_arguments}, as an @var{action}
+within a @var{spec}, or in handlers for `@t{->}@var{state}' actions.
+
+@noindent
+Here is a more general example of the use of @t{_arguments}:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+_arguments '-l+:left border:' \
+ '-format:paper size:(letter A4)' \
+ '*-copy:output file:_files::resolution:(300 600)' \
+ ':postscript file:_files -g \*.\(ps\|eps\)' \
+ '*:page number:'
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+This describes three options: `@t{-l}', `@t{-format}', and
+`@t{-copy}'. The first takes one argument described as `@var{left
+border}' for which no completion will be offered because of the empty
+action. Its argument may come directly after the `@t{-l}' or it may be
+given as the next word on the line.
+
+@noindent
+The `@t{-format}' option takes one
+argument in the next word, described as `@var{paper size}' for which
+only the strings `@t{letter}' and `@t{A4}' will be completed.
+
+@noindent
+The `@t{-copy}' option may appear more than once on the command line and
+takes two arguments. The first is mandatory and will be completed as a
+filename. The second is optional (because of the second colon before
+the description `@var{resolution}') and will be completed from the strings
+`@t{300}' and `@t{600}'.
+
+@noindent
+The last two descriptions say what should be completed as
+arguments. The first describes the first argument as a
+`@var{postscript file}' and makes files ending in `@t{ps}' or `@t{eps}'
+be completed. The last description gives all other arguments the
+description `@var{page numbers}' but does not offer completions.
+
+@findex _cache_invalid
+@item @t{_cache_invalid} @var{cache_identifier}
+This function returns status zero if the completions cache corresponding to
+the given cache identifier needs rebuilding. It determines this by
+looking up the @t{cache-policy} style for the current context.
+This should provide a function name which is run with the full path to the
+relevant cache file as the only argument.
+
+@noindent
+Example:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+_example_caching_policy () @{
+ # rebuild if cache is more than a week old
+ local -a oldp
+ oldp=( "$1"(Nm+7) )
+ (( $#oldp ))
+@}
+@end example
+
+@findex _call_function
+@item @t{_call_function} @var{return} @var{name} [ @var{arg} ... ]
+If a function @var{name} exists, it is called with the arguments
+@var{arg}s. The @var{return} argument gives the name of a parameter in which
+the return status from the function @var{name} should be stored; if @var{return}
+is empty or a single hyphen it is ignored.
+
+@noindent
+The return status of @t{_call_function} itself is zero if the function
+@var{name} exists and was called and non-zero otherwise.
+
+@findex _call_program
+@item @t{_call_program} [ @t{-l} ] [ @t{-p} ] @var{tag} @var{string} ...
+This function provides a mechanism for the user to override the use of an
+external command. It looks up the @t{command} style with the supplied
+@var{tag}. If the style is set, its value is used as the command to
+execute. The @var{string}s from the call to @t{_call_program}, or from the
+style if set, are concatenated with spaces between them and the resulting
+string is evaluated. The return status is the return status of the command
+called.
+
+@noindent
+By default, the command is run in an environment where all the locale
+categories (except for @t{LC_CTYPE}) are reset to `@t{C}' by calling the
+utility function @t{_comp_locale} (see below). If the option `@t{-l}' is
+given, the command is run with the current locale.
+
+@noindent
+If the option `@t{-p}' is supplied it indicates that the command
+output is influenced by the permissions it is run with. If the
+@t{gain-privileges} style is set to true, @t{_call_program} will make
+use of commands such as @t{sudo}, if present on the command-line, to
+match the permissions to whatever the final command is likely to run
+under. When looking up the @t{gain-privileges} and @t{command} styles,
+the command component of the zstyle context will end with a slash
+(`@t{/}') followed by the command that would be used to gain privileges.
+
+@findex _combination
+@item @t{_combination} [ @t{-s} @var{pattern} ] @var{tag} @var{style} @var{spec} ... @var{field} @var{opts} ...
+This function is used to complete combinations of values, for example
+pairs of hostnames and usernames. The @var{style} argument gives the style
+which defines the pairs; it is looked up in a context with the @var{tag}
+specified.
+
+@noindent
+The style name consists of field names separated by hyphens, for example
+`@t{users-hosts-ports}'. For each field for a value is already known, a
+@var{spec} of the form `@var{field}@t{=}@var{pattern}' is given. For example,
+if the command line so far specifies a user `@t{pws}', the argument
+`@t{users=pws}' should appear.
+
+@noindent
+The next argument with no equals sign is taken as the name of the field
+for which completions should be generated (presumably not one of the
+@var{field}s for which the value is known).
+
+@noindent
+The matches generated will be taken from the value of the style. These
+should contain the possible values for the combinations in the appropriate
+order (users, hosts, ports in the example above).
+The values for the different fields are separated by colons. This
+can be altered with the option @t{-s} to @t{_combination} which specifies a
+pattern. Typically this is a character class, as for example
+`@t{-s "[:@@]"}' in the case of the @t{users-hosts} style. Each
+`@var{field}@t{=}@var{pattern}' specification restricts the
+completions which apply to elements of the style with appropriately
+matching fields.
+
+@noindent
+If no style with the given name is defined for the given tag,
+or if none of the strings in style's value match, but a
+function name of the required field preceded by an
+underscore is defined, that function will be called to generate the
+matches. For example, if there is no `@t{users-hosts-ports}' or no
+matching hostname when a host is required, the function `@t{_hosts}' will
+automatically be called.
+
+@noindent
+If the same name is used for more than one field, in both the
+`@var{field}@t{=}@var{pattern}' and the argument that gives the name of the
+field to be completed, the number of the field (starting with one) may
+be given after the fieldname, separated from it by a colon.
+
+@noindent
+All arguments after the required field name are passed to
+@t{compadd} when generating matches from the style value, or to
+the functions for the fields if they are called.
+
+@findex _command_names
+@item @t{_command_names} [ @t{-e} | @t{-} ]
+This function completes words that are valid at command position: names of
+aliases, builtins, hashed commands, functions, and so on. With the @t{-e}
+flag, only hashed commands are completed. The @t{-} flag is ignored.
+
+@findex _comp_locale
+@item @t{_comp_locale}
+This function resets all the locale categories other than @t{LC_CTYPE} to
+`@t{C}' so that the output from external commands can be easily analyzed by
+the completion system. @t{LC_CTYPE} retains the current value (taking
+@t{LC_ALL} and @t{LANG} into account), ensuring that non-ASCII characters
+in file names are still handled properly.
+
+@noindent
+This function should normally be run only in a subshell, because the new
+locale is exported to the environment. Typical usage would be
+`@t{$(_comp_locale; }@var{command} ...@t{)}'.
+
+@findex _completers
+@item @t{_completers} [ @t{-p} ]
+This function completes names of completers.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{-p}
+Include the leading underscore (`@t{_}') in the matches.
+
+@end table
+
+@findex _describe
+
+@item @t{_describe }[@t{-12JVx}] [ @t{-oO} | @t{-t} @var{tag} ] @var{descr} @var{name1} [ @var{name2} ] [ @var{opt} ... ]
+@itemx @t{@ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ }[ @t{-}@t{-} @var{name1} [ @var{name2} ] [ @var{opt} ... ] ... ]
+This function associates completions with descriptions.
+Multiple groups separated by @t{-}@t{-} can be supplied, potentially with
+different completion options @var{opt}s.
+
+@noindent
+The @var{descr} is taken as a string to display above the matches if the
+@t{format} style for the @t{descriptions} tag is set. This is followed by
+one or two names of arrays followed by options to pass to @t{compadd}. The
+array @var{name1} contains the possible completions with their descriptions in
+the form `@var{completion}@t{:}@var{description}'. Any literal colons in
+@var{completion} must be quoted with a backslash. If a @var{name2} is
+given, it should have the same number of elements as @var{name1}; in this
+case the corresponding elements are added as possible completions instead
+of the @var{completion} strings from @var{name1}. The completion list
+will retain the descriptions from @var{name1}. Finally, a set of
+completion options can appear.
+
+@noindent
+If the option `@t{-o}' appears before the first argument, the matches added
+will be treated as names of command options (N.B. not shell options),
+typically following a `@t{-}', `@t{-}@t{-}' or `@t{+}' on the command
+line. In this case @t{_describe} uses the @t{prefix-hidden},
+@t{prefix-needed} and @t{verbose} styles to find out if the strings should
+be added as completions and if the descriptions should be shown. Without
+the `@t{-o}' option, only the @t{verbose} style is used to decide how
+descriptions are shown. If `@t{-O}' is used instead of `@t{-o}', command
+options are completed as above but @t{_describe} will not handle the
+@t{prefix-needed} style.
+
+@noindent
+With the @t{-t} option a @var{tag} can be specified. The default is
+`@t{values}' or, if the @t{-o} option is given, `@t{options}'.
+
+@noindent
+The options @t{-1}, @t{-2}, @t{-J}, @t{-V}, @t{-x} are passed to
+@t{_next_label}.
+
+@noindent
+If selected by the @t{list-grouped} style, strings with the same
+description will appear together in the list.
+
+@noindent
+@t{_describe} uses the @t{_all_labels} function to generate the matches, so
+it does not need to appear inside a loop over tag labels.
+
+@findex _description
+@item @t{_description} [ @t{-x} ] [ @t{-12VJ} ] @var{tag} @var{name} @var{descr} [ @var{spec} ... ]
+This function is not to be confused with the previous one; it is used as
+a helper function for creating options to @t{compadd}. It is buried
+inside many of the higher level completion functions and so often does
+not need to be called directly.
+
+@noindent
+The styles listed below are tested in the current context using the
+given @var{tag}. The resulting options for @t{compadd} are put into the
+array named @var{name} (this is traditionally `@t{expl}', but this
+convention is not enforced). The description for the corresponding set
+of matches is passed to the function in @var{descr}.
+
+@noindent
+The styles tested are: @t{format}, @t{hidden}, @t{matcher},
+@t{ignore-line}, @t{ignored-patterns}, @t{group-name} and @t{sort}.
+The @t{format} style is first tested for the given @var{tag} and then for
+the @t{descriptions} tag if no value was found, while the remainder are
+only tested for the tag given as the first argument. The function also
+calls @t{_setup} which tests some more styles.
+
+@noindent
+The string returned by the @t{format} style (if any) will be modified so
+that the sequence `@t{%d}' is replaced by the @var{descr} given as the third
+argument without any leading or trailing white space. If, after
+removing the white space, the @var{descr} is the empty string, the format
+style will not be used and the options put into the @var{name} array will
+not contain an explanation string to be displayed above the matches.
+
+@noindent
+If @t{_description} is called with more than three arguments,
+the additional @var{spec}s should be of the form `@var{char}@t{:}@var{str}'.
+These supply escape sequence replacements for the @t{format} style:
+every appearance of `@t{%}@var{char}' will be
+replaced by @var{string}.
+
+@noindent
+If the @t{-x} option is given, the description will be passed to
+@t{compadd} using the @t{-x} option instead of the default @t{-X}. This
+means that the description will be displayed even if there are no
+corresponding matches.
+
+@noindent
+The options placed in the array @var{name} take account of the
+@t{group-name} style, so matches are placed in a separate group where
+necessary. The group normally has its elements sorted (by passing the
+option @t{-J} to @t{compadd}), but if an option starting with `@t{-V}',
+`@t{-J}', `@t{-1}', or `@t{-2}' is passed to @t{_description}, that
+option will be included in the array. Hence it is possible for the
+completion group to be unsorted by giving the option `@t{-V}',
+`@t{-1V}', or `@t{-2V}'.
+
+@noindent
+In most cases, the function will be used like this:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+local expl
+_description files expl file
+compadd "$expl[@@]" - "$files[@@]"
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Note the use of the parameter @t{expl}, the hyphen, and the list of
+matches. Almost all calls to @t{compadd} within the completion system use
+a similar format; this ensures that user-specified styles are correctly
+passed down to the builtins which implement the internals of completion.
+
+@findex _dir_list
+@item @t{_dir_list} [ @t{-s} @var{sep} ] [ @t{-S} ]
+Complete a list of directory names separated by colons
+(the same format as @t{$PATH}).
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{-s} @var{sep}
+Use @var{sep} as separator between items.
+@var{sep} defaults to a colon (`@t{:}').
+
+@item @t{-S}
+Add @var{sep} instead of slash (`@t{/}') as an autoremoveable suffix.
+
+@end table
+
+@findex _dispatch
+@item @t{_dispatch} @var{context string} ...
+This sets the current context to @var{context} and looks for completion
+functions to handle this context by hunting through the list of command
+names or special contexts (as described above for @t{compdef})
+given as @var{string}s. The first completion function to be defined
+for one of the contexts in the list is used to generate matches.
+Typically, the last @var{string} is @t{-default-} to cause the function
+for default completion to be used as a fallback.
+
+@noindent
+The function sets the parameter
+@t{$service} to the @var{string} being tried, and sets
+the @var{context/command} field (the fourth) of the @t{$curcontext}
+parameter to the @var{context} given as the first argument.
+
+@findex _email_addresses
+@item @t{_email_addresses} [ @t{-c} ] [ @t{-n} @var{plugin} ]
+Complete email addresses. Addresses are provided by plugins.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{-c}
+Complete bare @t{localhost@@domain.tld} addresses, without a name part or
+a comment.
+Without this option, RFC822 `@var{Firstname Lastname} @t{<}@var{address}@t{>}'
+strings are completed.
+
+@item @t{-n} @var{plugin}
+Complete aliases from @var{plugin}.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+The following plugins are available by default:
+@t{_email-ldap} (see the @t{filter} style),
+@t{_email-local} (completes @var{user}@t{@@}@var{hostname} Unix addresses),
+@t{_email-mail} (completes aliases from @t{~/.mailrc}),
+@t{_email-mush},
+@t{_email-mutt},
+and
+@t{_email-pine}.
+
+@noindent
+Addresses from the @t{_email-}@var{foo} plugin are added under the
+tag `@t{email-}@var{foo}'.
+
+@noindent
+@emph{Writing plugins}
+
+@noindent
+Plugins are written as separate functions with names starting with `@t{_email-}'.
+They are invoked with the @t{-c} option and @t{compadd} options.
+They should either do their own completion or
+set the @t{$reply} array to a list of `@var{alias}@t{:}@var{address}' elements and return @t{300}.
+New plugins will be picked up and run automatically.
+
+@findex _files
+@item @t{_files}
+The function @t{_files} is a wrapper around @t{_path_files}. It supports
+all of the same functionality, with some enhancements --- notably, it
+respects the @t{list-dirs-first} style, and it allows users to override
+the behaviour of the @t{-g} and @t{-/} options with the @t{file-patterns}
+style. @t{_files} should therefore be preferred over @t{_path_files} in
+most cases.
+
+@noindent
+This function accepts the full set of options allowed by
+@t{_path_files}, described below.
+
+@findex _gnu_generic
+@item @t{_gnu_generic}
+This function is a simple wrapper around the @t{_arguments} function
+described above. It can be used to determine automatically the long
+options understood by commands that produce a list when passed the
+option `@t{-}@t{-help}'. It is intended to be used as a top-level
+completion function in its own right. For example, to enable option
+completion for the commands @t{foo} and @t{bar}, use
+
+@noindent
+@example
+compdef _gnu_generic foo bar
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+after the call to @t{compinit}.
+
+@noindent
+The completion system as supplied is conservative in its use of this
+function, since it is important to be sure the command understands the
+option `@t{-}@t{-help}'.
+
+@findex _guard
+@item @t{_guard} [ @var{options} ] @var{pattern descr}
+This function displays @var{descr} if @var{pattern} matches the string to
+be completed. It is intended to be used in the @var{action} for the
+specifications passed to @t{_arguments} and similar functions.
+
+@noindent
+The return status is zero if the message was displayed and the word to
+complete is not empty, and non-zero otherwise.
+
+@noindent
+The @var{pattern} may be preceded by any of the options understood by
+@t{compadd} that are passed down from @t{_description}, namely @t{-M},
+@t{-J}, @t{-V}, @t{-1}, @t{-2}, @t{-n}, @t{-F} and @t{-X}. All of these
+options will be ignored. This fits in conveniently with the
+argument-passing conventions of actions for @t{_arguments}.
+
+@noindent
+As an example, consider a command taking the options @t{-n} and
+@t{-none}, where @t{-n} must be followed by a numeric value in the
+same word. By using:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+_arguments '-n-: :_guard "[0-9]#" "numeric value"' '-none'
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+@t{_arguments} can be made to both display the message `@t{numeric
+value}' and complete options after `@t{-n<TAB>}'. If the `@t{-n}' is
+already followed by one or more digits (the pattern passed to
+@t{_guard}) only the message will be displayed; if the `@t{-n}' is
+followed by another character, only options are completed.
+
+@findex _message
+@item @t{_message} [ @t{-r12} ] [ @t{-VJ} @var{group} ] @var{descr}
+@itemx @t{_message -e} [ @var{tag} ] @var{descr}
+The @var{descr} is used in the same way as the third
+argument to the @t{_description} function, except that the resulting
+string will always be shown whether or not matches were
+generated. This is useful for displaying a help message in places where
+no completions can be generated.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{format} style is examined with the @t{messages} tag to find a
+message; the usual tag, @t{descriptions}, is used only if the style is
+not set with the former.
+
+@noindent
+If the @t{-r} option is given, no style is used; the @var{descr} is
+taken literally as the string to display. This is most useful
+when the @var{descr} comes from a pre-processed argument list
+which already contains an expanded description. Note that this
+option does not disable the `@t{%}'-sequence parsing done by
+@t{compadd}.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{-12VJ} options and the @var{group} are passed to @t{compadd} and
+hence determine the group the message string is added to.
+
+@noindent
+The second @t{-e} form gives a description for completions with the tag
+@var{tag} to be shown even if there are no matches for that tag. This form
+is called by @t{_arguments} in the event that there is no action for an
+option specification. The tag can be omitted and if so the tag is taken
+from the parameter @t{$curtag}; this is maintained by the completion
+system and so is usually correct. Note that if there are no matches at
+the time this function is called, @t{compstate[insert]} is cleared, so
+additional matches generated later are not inserted on the command line.
+
+@findex _multi_parts
+@item @t{_multi_parts} [ @t{-i} ] @var{sep} @var{array}
+The argument @var{sep} is a separator character.
+The @var{array} may be either the
+name of an array parameter or a literal array in the form
+`@t{(foo bar}@t{)}', a parenthesised list of words separated
+by whitespace. The possible completions are the
+strings from the array. However, each chunk delimited by @var{sep} will be
+completed separately. For example, the @t{_tar} function uses
+`@t{_multi_parts} @t{/} @var{patharray}' to complete partial file paths
+from the given array of complete file paths.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{-i} option causes @t{_multi_parts} to insert a unique match even
+if that requires multiple separators to be inserted. This is not usually
+the expected behaviour with filenames, but certain other types of
+completion, for example those with a fixed set of possibilities, may be
+more suited to this form.
+
+@noindent
+Like other utility functions, this function accepts the `@t{-V}',
+`@t{-J}', `@t{-1}', `@t{-2}', `@t{-n}', `@t{-f}', `@t{-X}', `@t{-M}',
+`@t{-P}', `@t{-S}', `@t{-r}', `@t{-R}', and `@t{-q}' options and passes
+them to the @t{compadd} builtin.
+
+@findex _next_label
+@item @t{_next_label} [ @t{-x} ] [ @t{-12VJ} ] @var{tag} @var{name} @var{descr} [ @var{option} ... ]
+This function is used to implement the loop over different tag
+labels for a particular tag as described above for the @t{tag-order}
+style. On each call it checks to see if there are any more tag labels; if
+there is it returns status zero, otherwise non-zero.
+As this function requires a current tag to be set, it must always follow
+a call to @t{_tags} or @t{_requested}.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{-x12VJ} options and the first three arguments are passed to the
+@t{_description} function. Where appropriate the @var{tag} will be
+replaced by a tag label in this call. Any description given in
+the @t{tag-order} style is preferred to the @var{descr} passed to
+@t{_next_label}.
+
+@noindent
+The @var{option}s given after the @var{descr}
+are set in the parameter given by @var{name}, and hence are to be passed
+to @t{compadd} or whatever function is called to add the matches.
+
+@noindent
+Here is a typical use of this function for the tag @t{foo}. The call to
+@t{_requested} determines if tag @t{foo} is required at all; the loop
+over @t{_next_label} handles any labels defined for the tag in the
+@t{tag-order} style.
+
+@noindent
+@example
+local expl ret=1
+...
+if _requested foo; then
+ ...
+ while _next_label foo expl '...'; do
+ compadd "$expl[@@]" ... && ret=0
+ done
+ ...
+fi
+return ret
+@end example
+
+@findex _normal
+@item @t{_normal} [ @t{-P} | @t{-p} @var{precommand} ]
+This is the standard function called to handle completion outside
+any special @t{-}@var{context}@t{-}. It is called both to complete the command
+word and also the arguments for a command. In the second case,
+@t{_normal} looks for a special completion for that command, and if
+there is none it uses the completion for the @t{-default-} context.
+
+@noindent
+A second use is to reexamine the command line specified by the @t{$words}
+array and the @t{$CURRENT} parameter after those have been modified.
+For example, the function @t{_precommand}, which
+completes after precommand specifiers such as @t{nohup}, removes the
+first word from the @t{words} array, decrements the @t{CURRENT} parameter,
+then calls `@t{_normal -p $service}'. The effect is that
+`@t{nohup} @var{cmd ...}' is treated in the same way as `@var{cmd ...}'.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{-P}
+Reset the list of precommands. This option should be used if completing
+a command line which allows internal commands (e.g. builtins and
+functions) regardless of prior precommands (e.g. `@t{zsh -c}').
+
+@item @t{-p} @var{precommand}
+Append @var{precommand} to the list of precommands. This option should be
+used in nearly all cases in which @t{-P} is not applicable.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+If the command name matches one of the patterns given by one of the
+options @t{-p} or @t{-P} to @t{compdef}, the corresponding completion
+function is called and then the parameter @t{_compskip} is
+checked. If it is set completion is terminated at that point even if
+no matches have been found. This is the same effect as in the
+@t{-first-} context.
+
+@findex _options
+@item @t{_options}
+This can be used to complete the names of shell options. It provides a
+matcher specification that ignores a leading `@t{no}', ignores
+underscores and allows upper-case letters to
+match their lower-case counterparts (for example, `@t{glob}',
+`@t{noglob}', `@t{NO_GLOB}' are all completed). Any arguments
+are propagated to the @t{compadd} builtin.
+
+@findex _options_set
+@findex _options_unset
+@item @t{_options_set} and @t{_options_unset}
+These functions complete only set or unset options, with the same
+matching specification used in the @t{_options} function.
+
+@noindent
+Note that you need to uncomment a few lines in the @t{_main_complete}
+function for these functions to work properly. The lines in question
+are used to store the option settings in effect before the completion
+widget locally sets the options it needs. Hence these functions are not
+generally used by the completion system.
+
+@findex _parameters
+@item @t{_parameters}
+This is used to complete the names of shell parameters.
+
+@noindent
+The option `@t{-g} @var{pattern}' limits the completion to parameters
+whose type matches the @var{pattern}. The type of a parameter is that
+shown by `@t{print $@{(t)}@var{param}@t{@}}', hence judicious use of
+`@t{*}' in @var{pattern} is probably necessary.
+
+@noindent
+All other arguments are passed to the @t{compadd} builtin.
+
+@findex _path_files
+@item @t{_path_files}
+This function is used throughout the completion system
+to complete filenames. It allows completion of partial paths. For
+example, the string `@t{/u/i/s/sig}' may be completed to
+`@t{/usr/include/sys/signal.h}'.
+
+@noindent
+The options accepted by both @t{_path_files} and @t{_files} are:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{-f}
+Complete all filenames. This is the default.
+
+@item @t{-/}
+Specifies that only directories should be completed.
+
+@item @t{-g} @var{pattern}
+Specifies that only files matching the @var{pattern} should be completed.
+
+@item @t{-W} @var{paths}
+Specifies path prefixes that are to be prepended to the string from the
+command line to generate the filenames but that should not be inserted
+as completions nor shown in completion listings. Here, @var{paths} may be
+the name of an array parameter, a literal list of paths enclosed in
+parentheses or an absolute pathname.
+
+@item @t{-F} @var{ignored-files}
+This behaves as for the corresponding option to the @t{compadd} builtin.
+It gives direct control over which
+filenames should be ignored. If the option is not present, the
+@t{ignored-patterns} style is used.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+Both @t{_path_files} and @t{_files} also accept the following options
+which are passed to @t{compadd}: `@t{-J}', `@t{-V}',
+`@t{-1}', `@t{-2}', `@t{-n}', `@t{-X}', `@t{-M}', `@t{-P}', `@t{-S}',
+`@t{-q}', `@t{-r}', and `@t{-R}'.
+
+@noindent
+Finally, the @t{_path_files} function uses the styles @t{expand},
+@t{ambiguous}, @t{special-dirs}, @t{list-suffixes} and @t{file-sort}
+described above.
+
+@findex _pick_variant
+
+@item @t{_pick_variant }[ @t{-b} @var{builtin-label} ] [ @t{-c} @var{command} ] [ @t{-r} @var{name} ]
+@itemx @t{@ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ }@var{label}@t{=}@var{pattern} ... @var{label} [ @var{arg} ... ]
+This function is used to resolve situations where a single command name
+requires more than one type of handling, either because it
+has more than one variant or because there is a name clash between two
+different commands.
+
+@noindent
+The command to run is taken from the first element of the array
+@t{words} unless this is overridden by the option @t{-c}. This command
+is run and its output is compared with a series of patterns. Arguments
+to be passed to the command can be specified at the end after all the
+other arguments. The patterns to try in order are given by the arguments
+@var{label}@t{=}@var{pattern}; if the output of `@var{command} @var{arg}
+...' contains @var{pattern}, then @var{label} is selected as the label
+for the command variant. If none of the patterns match, the final
+command label is selected and status 1 is returned.
+
+@noindent
+If the `@t{-b} @var{builtin-label}' is given, the command is tested to
+see if it is provided as a shell builtin, possibly autoloaded; if so,
+the label @var{builtin-label} is selected as the label for the variant.
+
+@noindent
+If the `@t{-r} @var{name}' is given, the @var{label} picked is stored in
+the parameter named @var{name}.
+
+@noindent
+The results are also cached in the @t{_cmd_variant} associative array
+indexed by the name of the command run.
+
+@findex _regex_arguments
+@item @t{_regex_arguments} @var{name} @var{spec} ...
+This function generates a completion function @var{name} which matches
+the specifications @var{spec}s, a set of regular expressions as
+described below. After running @t{_regex_arguments}, the function
+@var{name} should be called as a normal completion function.
+The pattern to be matched is given by the contents of
+the @t{words} array up to the current cursor position joined together
+with null characters; no quotation is applied.
+
+@noindent
+The arguments are grouped as sets of alternatives separated by `@t{|}',
+which are tried one after the other until one matches. Each alternative
+consists of a one or more specifications which are tried left to right,
+with each pattern matched being stripped in turn from the command line
+being tested, until all of the group succeeds or until one fails; in the
+latter case, the next alternative is tried. This structure can be
+repeated to arbitrary depth by using parentheses; matching proceeds from
+inside to outside.
+
+@noindent
+A special procedure is applied if no test succeeds but the remaining
+command line string contains no null character (implying the remaining
+word is the one for which completions are to be generated). The
+completion target is restricted to the remaining word and any
+@var{action}s for the corresponding patterns are executed. In this case,
+nothing is stripped from the command line string. The order of
+evaluation of the @var{action}s can be determined by the @t{tag-order}
+style; the various formats supported by @t{_alternative} can be used
+in @var{action}. The @var{descr} is used for setting up the array
+parameter @t{expl}.
+
+@noindent
+Specification arguments take one of following forms, in which
+metacharacters such as `@t{(}', `@t{)}', `@t{#}' and `@t{|}'
+should be quoted.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{/}@var{pattern}@t{/} [@t{%}@var{lookahead}@t{%}] [@t{-}@var{guard}] [@t{:}@var{tag}@t{:}@var{descr}@t{:}@var{action}]
+This is a single primitive component.
+The function tests whether the combined pattern
+`@t{(#b)((#B)}@var{pattern}@t{)}@var{lookahead}@t{*}' matches
+the command line string. If so, `@var{guard}' is evaluated and
+its return status is examined to determine if the test has succeeded.
+The @var{pattern} string `@t{[]}' is guaranteed never to match.
+The @var{lookahead} is not stripped from the command line before the next
+pattern is examined.
+
+@noindent
+The argument starting with @t{:} is used in the same manner as an argument to
+@t{_alternative}.
+
+@noindent
+A component is used as follows: @var{pattern} is tested to
+see if the component already exists on the command line. If
+it does, any following specifications are examined to find something to
+complete. If a component is reached but no such pattern exists yet on the
+command line, the string containing the @var{action} is used to generate
+matches to insert at that point.
+
+@item @t{/}@var{pattern}@t{/+} [@t{%}@var{lookahead}@t{%}] [@t{-}@var{guard}] [@t{:}@var{tag}@t{:}@var{descr}@t{:}@var{action}]
+This is similar to `@t{/}@var{pattern}@t{/} ...' but the left part of the
+command line string (i.e. the part already matched by previous patterns)
+is also considered part of the completion target.
+
+@item @t{/}@var{pattern}@t{/-} [@t{%}@var{lookahead}@t{%}] [@t{-}@var{guard}] [@t{:}@var{tag}@t{:}@var{descr}@t{:}@var{action}]
+This is similar to `@t{/}@var{pattern}@t{/} ...' but the @var{action}s of the
+current and previously matched patterns are ignored even if the
+following `@var{pattern}' matches the empty string.
+
+@item @t{(} @var{spec} @t{)}
+Parentheses may be used to groups @var{spec}s; note each parenthesis
+is a single argument to @t{_regex_arguments}.
+
+@item @var{spec} @t{#}
+This allows any number of repetitions of @var{spec}.
+
+@item @var{spec} @var{spec}
+The two @var{spec}s are to be matched one after the other as described
+above.
+
+@item @var{spec} @t{|} @var{spec}
+Either of the two @var{spec}s can be matched.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+The function @t{_regex_words} can be used as a helper function to
+generate matches for a set of alternative words possibly with
+their own arguments as a command line argument.
+
+@noindent
+Examples:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+_regex_arguments _tst /$'[^\0]#\0'/ \
+ /$'[^\0]#\0'/ :'compadd aaa'
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+This generates a function @t{_tst} that completes @t{aaa} as its only
+argument. The @var{tag} and @var{description} for the action have been
+omitted for brevity (this works but is not recommended in normal use).
+The first component matches the command word, which is arbitrary; the
+second matches any argument. As the argument is also arbitrary, any
+following component would not depend on @t{aaa} being present.
+
+@noindent
+@example
+_regex_arguments _tst /$'[^\0]#\0'/ \
+ /$'aaa\0'/ :'compadd aaa'
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+This is a more typical use; it is similar, but any following patterns
+would only match if @t{aaa} was present as the first argument.
+
+@noindent
+@example
+_regex_arguments _tst /$'[^\0]#\0'/ \( \
+ /$'aaa\0'/ :'compadd aaa' \
+ /$'bbb\0'/ :'compadd bbb' \) \#
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+In this example, an indefinite number of command arguments may be
+completed. Odd arguments are completed as @t{aaa} and even arguments
+as @t{bbb}. Completion fails unless the set of @t{aaa} and @t{bbb}
+arguments before the current one is matched correctly.
+
+@noindent
+@example
+_regex_arguments _tst /$'[^\0]#\0'/ \
+ \( /$'aaa\0'/ :'compadd aaa' \| \
+ /$'bbb\0'/ :'compadd bbb' \) \#
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+This is similar, but either @t{aaa} or @t{bbb} may be completed for
+any argument. In this case @t{_regex_words} could be used to generate
+a suitable expression for the arguments.
+
+@noindent
+
+@findex _regex_words [ @t{-t} @var{term} ]
+@item @t{_regex_words} @var{tag} @var{description} @var{spec} ...
+This function can be used to generate arguments for the
+@t{_regex_arguments} command which may be inserted at any point where
+a set of rules is expected. The @var{tag} and @var{description} give a
+standard tag and description pertaining to the current context. Each
+@var{spec} contains two or three arguments separated by a colon: note
+that there is no leading colon in this case.
+
+@noindent
+Each @var{spec} gives one of a set of words that may be completed at
+this point, together with arguments. It is thus roughly equivalent to
+the @t{_arguments} function when used in normal (non-regex) completion.
+
+@noindent
+The part of the @var{spec} before the first colon is the word to be
+completed. This may contain a @t{*}; the entire word, before and after
+the @t{*} is completed, but only the text before the @t{*} is required
+for the context to be matched, so that further arguments may be
+completed after the abbreviated form.
+
+@noindent
+The second part of @var{spec} is a description for the word being
+completed.
+
+@noindent
+The optional third part of the @var{spec} describes how words following
+the one being completed are themselves to be completed. It will be
+evaluated in order to avoid problems with quoting. This means that
+typically it contains a reference to an array containing previously
+generated regex arguments.
+
+@noindent
+The option @t{-t} @var{term} specifies a terminator for the word
+instead of the usual space. This is handled as an auto-removable suffix
+in the manner of the option @t{-s} @var{sep} to @t{_values}.
+
+@noindent
+The result of the processing by @t{_regex_words} is placed in the array
+@t{reply}, which should be made local to the calling function.
+If the set of words and arguments may be matched repeatedly, a @t{#}
+should be appended to the generated array at that point.
+
+@noindent
+For example:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+local -a reply
+_regex_words mydb-commands 'mydb commands' \
+ 'add:add an entry to mydb:$mydb_add_cmds' \
+ 'show:show entries in mydb'
+_regex_arguments _mydb "$reply[@@]"
+_mydb "$@@"
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+This shows a completion function for a command @t{mydb} which takes
+two command arguments, @t{add} and @t{show}. @t{show} takes no arguments,
+while the arguments for @t{add} have already been prepared in an
+array @t{mydb_add_cmds}, quite possibly by a previous call to
+@t{_regex_words}.
+
+@findex _requested
+@item @t{_requested} [ @t{-x} ] [ @t{-12VJ} ] @var{tag} [ @var{name} @var{descr} [ @var{command} [ @var{arg} ... ] ]
+This function is called to decide whether a tag already registered by a
+call to @t{_tags} (see below) has been requested by the user and hence
+completion should be performed for it. It returns status zero if the
+tag is requested and non-zero otherwise. The function is typically used
+as part of a loop over different tags as follows:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+_tags foo bar baz
+while _tags; do
+ if _requested foo; then
+ ... # perform completion for foo
+ fi
+ ... # test the tags bar and baz in the same way
+ ... # exit loop if matches were generated
+done
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Note that the test for whether matches were generated is not performed
+until the end of the @t{_tags} loop. This is so that the user can set
+the @t{tag-order} style to specify a set of tags to be completed at the
+same time.
+
+@noindent
+If @var{name} and @var{descr} are given, @t{_requested} calls the
+@t{_description} function with these arguments together with the options
+passed to @t{_requested}.
+
+@noindent
+If @var{command} is given, the @t{_all_labels} function will be called
+immediately with the same arguments. In simple cases this makes it
+possible to perform the test for the tag and the matching in one go.
+For example:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+local expl ret=1
+_tags foo bar baz
+while _tags; do
+ _requested foo expl 'description' \
+ compadd foobar foobaz && ret=0
+ ...
+ (( ret )) || break
+done
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+If the @var{command} is not @t{compadd}, it must nevertheless be prepared
+to handle the same options.
+
+@findex _retrieve_cache
+@item @t{_retrieve_cache} @var{cache_identifier}
+This function retrieves completion information from the file given by
+@var{cache_identifier}, stored in a directory specified by the
+@t{cache-path} style which defaults to @t{~/.zcompcache}. The return status
+is zero if retrieval was successful. It will only attempt retrieval
+if the @t{use-cache} style is set, so you can call this function
+without worrying about whether the user wanted to use the caching
+layer.
+
+@noindent
+See @t{_store_cache} below for more details.
+
+@findex _sep_parts
+@item @t{_sep_parts}
+This function is passed alternating arrays and separators as arguments.
+The arrays specify completions for parts of strings to be separated by the
+separators. The arrays may be the names of array parameters or
+a quoted list of words in parentheses. For example, with the array
+`@t{hosts=(ftp news)}' the call `@t{_sep_parts '(foo bar)' @@ hosts}' will
+complete the string `@t{f}' to `@t{foo}' and the string `@t{b@@n}' to
+`@t{bar@@news}'.
+
+@noindent
+This function accepts the @t{compadd} options `@t{-V}', `@t{-J}',
+`@t{-1}', `@t{-2}', `@t{-n}', `@t{-X}', `@t{-M}', `@t{-P}', `@t{-S}',
+`@t{-r}', `@t{-R}', and `@t{-q}' and passes them on to the @t{compadd}
+builtin used to add the matches.
+
+@findex _sequence
+@item @t{_sequence} [ @t{-s} @var{sep} ] [ @t{-n} @var{max} ] [ @t{-d} ] @var{function} [ @t{-} ] ...
+This function is a wrapper to other functions for completing items in a
+separated list. The same function is used to complete each item in the
+list. The separator is specified with the @t{-s} option. If @t{-s} is
+omitted it will use `@t{,}'. Duplicate values are not matched unless
+@t{-d} is specified. If there is a fixed or maximum number of items in
+the list, this can be specified with the @t{-n} option.
+
+@noindent
+Common @t{compadd} options are passed on to the function. It is possible
+to use @t{compadd} directly with @t{_sequence}, though @t{_values} may
+be more appropriate in this situation.
+
+@findex _setup
+@item @t{_setup} @var{tag} [ @var{group} ]
+This function sets up the special
+parameters used by the completion system appropriately for the @var{tag}
+given as the first argument. It uses the styles @t{list-colors},
+@t{list-packed}, @t{list-rows-first}, @t{last-prompt}, @t{accept-exact},
+@t{menu} and @t{force-list}.
+
+@noindent
+The optional @var{group} supplies the name of the group in which the
+matches will be placed. If it is not given, the @var{tag} is used as
+the group name.
+
+@noindent
+This function is called automatically from @t{_description}
+and hence is not normally called explicitly.
+
+@findex _store_cache
+@item @t{_store_cache} @var{cache_identifier} @var{param} ...
+This function, together with @t{_retrieve_cache} and
+@t{_cache_invalid}, implements a caching layer which can be used
+in any completion function. Data obtained by
+costly operations are stored in parameters;
+this function then dumps the values of those parameters to a file. The
+data can then be retrieved quickly from that file via @t{_retrieve_cache},
+even in different instances of the shell.
+
+@noindent
+The @var{cache_identifier} specifies the file which the data should be
+dumped to. The file is stored in a directory specified by the
+@t{cache-path} style which defaults to @t{~/.zcompcache}. The remaining
+@var{param}s arguments are the parameters to dump to the file.
+
+@noindent
+The return status is zero if storage was successful. The function will
+only attempt storage if the @t{use-cache} style is set, so you can
+call this function without worrying about whether the user wanted to
+use the caching layer.
+
+@noindent
+The completion function may avoid calling @t{_retrieve_cache} when it
+already has the completion data available as parameters.
+However, in that case it should
+call @t{_cache_invalid} to check whether the data in the parameters and
+in the cache are still valid.
+
+@noindent
+See the _perl_modules completion function for a simple example of
+the usage of the caching layer.
+
+@findex _tags
+@item @t{_tags} [ [ @t{-C} @var{name} ] @var{tag} ... ]
+If called with arguments, these are taken to be the names of tags
+valid for completions in the current context. These tags are stored
+internally and sorted by using the @t{tag-order} style.
+
+@noindent
+Next, @t{_tags} is called repeatedly without arguments from the same
+completion function. This successively selects the first, second,
+etc. set of tags requested by the user. The return status is zero if at
+least one of the tags is requested and non-zero otherwise. To test if a
+particular tag is to be tried, the @t{_requested} function should be
+called (see above).
+
+@noindent
+If `@t{-C} @var{name}' is given, @var{name} is temporarily stored in the
+@var{argument} field (the fifth) of the context in the @t{curcontext} parameter
+during the call to @t{_tags}; the field is restored on exit. This
+allows @t{_tags} to use a more
+specific context without having to change and reset the
+@t{curcontext} parameter (which has the same effect).
+
+@findex _tilde_files
+@item @t{_tilde_files}
+Like @t{_files}, but resolve leading tildes according to the rules of
+filename expansion, so the suggested completions don't start with
+a `@t{~}' even if the filename on the command-line does.
+
+@findex _values
+@item @t{_values} [ @t{-O} @var{name} ] [ @t{-s} @var{sep} ] [ @t{-S} @var{sep} ] [ @t{-wC} ] @var{desc} @var{spec} ...
+This is used to complete arbitrary keywords (values) and their arguments,
+or lists of such combinations.
+
+@noindent
+If the first argument is the option `@t{-O} @var{name}', it will be used
+in the same way as by the @t{_arguments} function. In other words, the
+elements of the @var{name} array will be passed to @t{compadd}
+when executing an action.
+
+@noindent
+If the first argument (or the first argument after `@t{-O} @var{name}')
+is `@t{-s}', the next argument is used as the character that separates
+multiple values. This character is automatically added after each value
+in an auto-removable fashion (see below); all values completed by
+`@t{_values -s}' appear in the same word on the command line, unlike
+completion using @t{_arguments}. If this option is not present, only a
+single value will be completed per word.
+
+@noindent
+Normally, @t{_values} will only use the current word to determine
+which values are already present on the command line and hence are not
+to be completed again. If the @t{-w} option is given, other arguments
+are examined as well.
+
+@noindent
+The first non-option argument, @var{desc}, is used as a string to print as a
+description before listing the values.
+
+@noindent
+All other arguments describe the possible values and their
+arguments in the same format used for the description of options by
+the @t{_arguments} function (see above). The only differences are that
+no minus or plus sign is required at the beginning,
+values can have only one argument, and the forms of action
+beginning with an equal sign are not supported.
+
+@noindent
+The character separating a value from its argument can be set using the
+option @t{-S} (like @t{-s}, followed by the character to use as the
+separator in the next argument). By default the equals
+sign will be used as the separator between values and arguments.
+
+@noindent
+Example:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+_values -s , 'description' \
+ '*foo[bar]' \
+ '(two)*one[number]:first count:' \
+ 'two[another number]::second count:(1 2 3)'
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+This describes three possible values: `@t{foo}', `@t{one}', and
+`@t{two}'. The first is described as `@t{bar}', takes no argument
+and may appear more than once. The second is described as
+`@t{number}', may appear more than once, and takes one mandatory
+argument described as `@t{first count}'; no action is
+specified, so it will not be completed. The
+`@t{(two)}' at the beginning says that if the value `@t{one}' is on
+the line, the value `@t{two}' will no longer be considered a possible
+completion. Finally, the last value (`@t{two}') is described
+as `@t{another number}' and takes an optional argument described as
+`@t{second count}' for which the completions (to appear after an
+`@t{=}') are `@t{1}', `@t{2}', and `@t{3}'. The @t{_values} function
+will complete lists of these values separated by commas.
+
+@noindent
+Like @t{_arguments}, this function temporarily adds another context name
+component to the arguments element (the fifth) of the current context
+while executing the @var{action}. Here this name is just the name of the
+value for which the argument is completed.
+
+@noindent
+The style @t{verbose} is used to decide if the descriptions for the
+values (but not those for the arguments) should be printed.
+
+@noindent
+The associative array @t{val_args} is used to report values and their
+arguments; this works similarly to the @t{opt_args} associative array
+used by @t{_arguments}. Hence the function calling @t{_values} should
+declare the local parameters @t{state}, @t{state_descr}, @t{line},
+@t{context} and @t{val_args}:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+local context state state_descr line
+typeset -A val_args
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+when using an action of the form `@t{->}@var{string}'. With this
+function the @t{context} parameter will be set to the name of the
+value whose argument is to be completed. Note that for @t{_values},
+the @t{state} and @t{state_descr} are scalars rather than arrays.
+Only a single matching state is returned.
+
+@noindent
+Note also that @t{_values} normally adds the character used as the
+separator between values as an auto-removable suffix (similar to a
+`@t{/}' after a directory). However, this is not possible for a
+`@t{->}@var{string}' action as the matches for the argument are
+generated by the calling function. To get the usual behaviour,
+the calling function can add the separator @var{x} as a suffix by
+passing the options `@t{-qS} @var{x}' either directly or indirectly to
+@t{compadd}.
+
+@noindent
+The option @t{-C} is treated in the same way as it is by @t{_arguments}.
+In that case the parameter @t{curcontext} should be made local instead
+of @t{context} (as described above).
+
+@findex _wanted
+@item @t{_wanted} [ @t{-x} ] [ @t{-C} @var{name} ] [ @t{-12VJ} ] @var{tag} @var{name} @var{descr} @var{command} [ @var{arg} ...]
+In many contexts, completion can only generate one particular set of
+matches, usually corresponding to a single tag. However, it is
+still necessary to decide whether the user requires matches of this type.
+This function is useful in such a case.
+
+@noindent
+The arguments to @t{_wanted} are the same as those to @t{_requested},
+i.e. arguments to be passed to @t{_description}. However, in this case
+the @var{command} is not optional; all the processing of tags, including
+the loop over both tags and tag labels and the generation of matches,
+is carried out automatically by @t{_wanted}.
+
+@noindent
+Hence to offer only one tag and immediately add the corresponding
+matches with the given description:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+local expl
+_wanted tag expl 'description' \
+ compadd matches...
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Note that, as for @t{_requested}, the @var{command} must be able to
+accept options to be passed down to @t{compadd}.
+
+@noindent
+Like @t{_tags} this function supports the @t{-C} option to give a
+different name for the argument context field. The @t{-x} option has
+the same meaning as for @t{_description}.
+
+@findex _widgets
+@item @t{_widgets} [ @t{-g} @var{pattern} ]
+This function completes names of zle widgets (see
+@ref{Zle Widgets}). The @var{pattern}, if present, is matched against values of the @t{$widgets}
+special parameter, documented in
+@ref{The zsh/zleparameter Module}.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+@node Completion System Variables, Completion Directories, Completion Functions, Completion System
+
+@section Completion System Variables
+@noindent
+@cindex completion system, variables
+
+@noindent
+There are some standard variables, initialised by the @t{_main_complete}
+function and then used from other functions.
+
+@noindent
+The standard variables are:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{_comp_caller_options}
+The completion system uses @t{setopt} to set a number of options. This
+allows functions to be written without concern for compatibility with
+every possible combination of user options. However, sometimes completion
+needs to know what the user's option preferences are. These are saved
+in the @t{_comp_caller_options} associative array. Option names, spelled
+in lowercase without underscores, are mapped to one or other of the
+strings `@t{on}' and `@t{off}'.
+
+
+@noindent
+@item @t{_comp_priv_prefix}
+Completion functions such as @t{_sudo} can set the @t{_comp_priv_prefix}
+array to a command prefix that may then be used by @t{_call_program} to
+match the privileges when calling programs to generate matches.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+Two more features are offered by the @t{_main_complete} function. The
+arrays @t{compprefuncs} and @t{comppostfuncs} may contain
+names of functions that are to be called immediately before or after
+completion has been tried. A function will only be called once unless
+it explicitly reinserts itself into the array.
+
+@noindent
+@node Completion Directories, , Completion System Variables, Completion System
+
+@section Completion Directories
+@noindent
+@cindex completion system, directory structure
+
+@noindent
+In the source distribution, the files are contained in various
+subdirectories of the @t{Completion} directory. They may have been
+installed in the same structure, or into one single function directory.
+The following is a description of the files found in the original directory
+structure. If you wish to alter an installed file, you will need to copy
+it to some directory which appears earlier in your @t{fpath} than the
+standard directory where it appears.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{Base}
+The core functions and special completion widgets automatically bound
+to keys. You will certainly need most of these, though will
+probably not need to alter them. Many of these are documented above.
+
+@item @t{Zsh}
+Functions for completing arguments of shell builtin commands and
+utility functions for this. Some of these are also used by functions from
+the @t{Unix} directory.
+
+@item @t{Unix}
+Functions for completing arguments of external commands and suites of
+commands. They may need modifying for your system, although in many cases
+some attempt is made to decide which version of a command is present. For
+example, completion for the @t{mount} command tries to determine the system
+it is running on, while completion for many other utilities try to decide
+whether the GNU version of the command is in use, and hence whether the
+@t{-}@t{-help} option is supported.
+
+@item @t{X}, @t{AIX}, @t{BSD}, ...
+Completion and utility function for commands available only on some systems.
+These are not arranged hierarchically, so, for example, both the
+@t{Linux} and @t{Debian} directories, as well as the @t{X} directory,
+may be useful on your system.
+
+@end table
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/compctl.yo
+@node Completion Using compctl, Zsh Modules, Completion System, Top
+
+@chapter Completion Using compctl
+@noindent
+@cindex completion, programmable
+@cindex completion, controlling
+
+@section Types of completion
+@noindent
+This version of zsh has two ways of performing completion of words on the
+command line. New users of the shell may prefer to use the newer
+and more powerful system based on shell functions; this is described
+in @ref{Completion System}, and the basic shell mechanisms which support
+it are described in @ref{Completion Widgets}. This chapter describes
+the older @t{compctl} command.
+
+@section Description
+@noindent
+@findex compctl
+
+@table @asis
+@item @t{compctl} [ @t{-CDT} ] @var{options} [ @var{command} ... ]
+@item @t{compctl }[ @t{-CDT} ] @var{options} [ @t{-x} @var{pattern} @var{options} @t{-} ... @t{-}@t{-} ]
+@item @t{@ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ }[ @t{+} @var{options} [ @t{-x} ... @t{-}@t{-} ] ... [@t{+}] ] [ @var{command} ... ]
+@item @t{compctl} @t{-M} @var{match-specs} ...
+@item @t{compctl} @t{-L} [ @t{-CDTM} ] [ @var{command} ... ]
+@item @t{compctl} @t{+} @var{command} ...
+@end table
+@sp 1
+
+@noindent
+Control the editor's completion behavior according to the supplied set
+of @var{options}. Various editing commands, notably
+@t{expand-or-complete-word}, usually bound to tab, will
+attempt to complete a word typed by the user, while others, notably
+@t{delete-char-or-list}, usually bound to ^D in EMACS editing
+mode, list the possibilities; @t{compctl} controls what those
+possibilities are. They may for example be filenames (the most common
+case, and hence the default), shell variables, or words from a
+user-specified list.
+@menu
+* Command Flags::
+* Option Flags::
+* Alternative Completion::
+* Extended Completion::
+* Example::
+@end menu
+
+@noindent
+@node Command Flags, Option Flags, , Completion Using compctl
+
+@section Command Flags
+@noindent
+Completion of the arguments of a command may be different for each
+command or may use the default. The behavior when completing the
+command word itself may also be separately specified. These
+correspond to the following flags and arguments, all of which (except
+for @t{-L}) may be combined with any combination of the
+@var{options} described subsequently in @ref{Option Flags}:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @var{command} ...
+controls completion for the named commands, which must be listed last
+on the command line. If completion is attempted for a command with a
+pathname containing slashes and no completion definition is found, the
+search is retried with the last pathname component. If the command starts
+with a @t{=}, completion is tried with the pathname of the command.
+
+@noindent
+Any of the @var{command} strings may be patterns of the form normally
+used for filename generation. These should be quoted to protect them
+from immediate expansion; for example the command string @t{'foo*'}
+arranges for completion of the words of any command beginning with
+@t{foo}. When completion is attempted, all pattern completions are
+tried in the reverse order of their definition until one matches. By
+default, completion then proceeds as normal, i.e. the shell will try to
+generate more matches for the specific command on the command line; this
+can be overridden by including @t{-tn} in the flags for the pattern
+completion.
+
+@noindent
+Note that aliases
+are expanded before the command name is determined unless the
+@t{COMPLETE_ALIASES} option is set. Commands may not be combined
+with the @t{-C}, @t{-D} or @t{-T} flags.
+
+@item @t{-C}
+controls completion when the command word itself is being completed.
+If no @t{compctl -C} command has been issued, the names of any
+executable command (whether in the path or specific to the shell, such
+as aliases or functions) are completed.
+
+@item @t{-D}
+controls default completion behavior for the arguments of commands not
+assigned any special behavior. If no @t{compctl -D} command has
+been issued, filenames are completed.
+
+@item @t{-T}
+supplies completion flags to be used before any other processing is
+done, even before processing for @t{compctl}s defined for specific
+commands. This is especially useful when combined with extended
+completion (the @t{-x} flag, see @ref{Extended Completion} below).
+Using this flag you can define default behavior
+which will apply to all commands without exception, or you can alter
+the standard behavior for all commands. For example, if your access
+to the user database is too slow and/or it contains too many users (so
+that completion after `@t{~}' is too slow to be usable), you can use
+
+@noindent
+@example
+compctl -T -x 's[~] C[0,[^/]#]' -k friends -S/ -tn
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+to complete the strings in the array @t{friends} after a `@t{~}'.
+The @t{C[}@var{...}@t{]} argument is necessary so that this form of
+@t{~}-completion is
+not tried after the directory name is finished.
+
+@item @t{-L}
+lists the existing completion behavior in a manner suitable for
+putting into a start-up script; the existing behavior is not changed.
+Any combination of the above forms, or the @t{-M} flag (which must
+follow the @t{-L} flag), may be specified, otherwise all defined
+completions are listed. Any other flags supplied are ignored.
+
+@item @emph{no argument}
+If no argument is given, @t{compctl} lists all defined completions
+in an abbreviated form; with a list of @var{options}, all completions
+with those flags set (not counting extended completion) are listed.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+If the @t{+} flag is alone and followed immediately by the @var{command}
+list, the completion behavior for all the commands in the list is reset to
+the default. In other words, completion will subsequently use the
+options specified by the @t{-D} flag.
+
+@noindent
+The form with @t{-M} as the first and only option defines global
+matching specifications (see
+@ref{Completion Matching Control}). The match specifications given will be used for every completion
+attempt (only when using @t{compctl}, not with the new completion
+system) and are tried in the order in which they are defined until one
+generates at least one match. E.g.:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+compctl -M @value{dsq} 'm:@{a-zA-Z@}=@{A-Za-z@}'
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+This will first try completion without any global match specifications
+(the empty string) and, if that generates no matches, will try case
+insensitive completion.
+
+@noindent
+@node Option Flags, Alternative Completion, Command Flags, Completion Using compctl
+
+@section Option Flags
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item [ @t{-fcFBdeaRGovNAIOPZEnbjrzu/12} ]
+@item [ @t{-k} @var{array} ] [ @t{-g} @var{globstring} ] [ @t{-s} @var{subststring} ]
+@item [ @t{-K} @var{function} ]
+@item [ @t{-Q} ] [ @t{-P} @var{prefix} ] [ @t{-S} @var{suffix} ]
+@item [ @t{-W} @var{file-prefix} ] [ @t{-H} @var{num pattern} ]
+@item [ @t{-q} ] [ @t{-X} @var{explanation} ] [ @t{-Y} @var{explanation} ]
+@item [ @t{-y} @var{func-or-var} ] [ @t{-l} @var{cmd} ] [ @t{-h} @var{cmd} ] [ @t{-U} ]
+@item [ @t{-t} @var{continue} ] [ @t{-J} @var{name} ] [ @t{-V} @var{name} ]
+@item [ @t{-M} @var{match-spec} ]
+@end table
+@sp 1
+
+@noindent
+The remaining @var{options} specify the type of command arguments
+to look for during completion. Any combination of these flags may be
+specified; the result is a sorted list of all the possibilities. The
+options are as follows.
+@menu
+* Simple Flags::
+* Flags with Arguments::
+* Control Flags::
+@end menu
+
+@noindent
+@node Simple Flags, Flags with Arguments, , Option Flags
+
+@subsection Simple Flags
+@noindent
+These produce completion lists made up by the shell itself:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{-f}
+Filenames and file system paths.
+
+@item @t{-/}
+Just file system paths.
+
+@item @t{-c}
+Command names, including aliases, shell functions, builtins
+and reserved words.
+
+@item @t{-F}
+Function names.
+
+@item @t{-B}
+Names of builtin commands.
+
+@item @t{-m}
+Names of external commands.
+
+@item @t{-w}
+Reserved words.
+
+@item @t{-a}
+Alias names.
+
+@item @t{-R}
+Names of regular (non-global) aliases.
+
+@item @t{-G}
+Names of global aliases.
+
+@item @t{-d}
+This can be combined with @t{-F}, @t{-B}, @t{-w},
+@t{-a}, @t{-R} and @t{-G} to get names of disabled
+functions, builtins, reserved words or aliases.
+
+@item @t{-e}
+This option (to show enabled commands) is in effect by default, but
+may be combined with @t{-d}; @t{-de} in combination with
+@t{-F}, @t{-B}, @t{-w}, @t{-a}, @t{-R} and @t{-G}
+will complete names of functions, builtins, reserved words or aliases
+whether or not they are disabled.
+
+@item @t{-o}
+Names of shell options (see
+@ref{Options}).
+
+@item @t{-v}
+Names of any variable defined in the shell.
+
+@item @t{-N}
+Names of scalar (non-array) parameters.
+
+@item @t{-A}
+Array names.
+
+@item @t{-I}
+Names of integer variables.
+
+@item @t{-O}
+Names of read-only variables.
+
+@item @t{-p}
+Names of parameters used by the shell (including special parameters).
+
+@item @t{-Z}
+Names of shell special parameters.
+
+@item @t{-E}
+Names of environment variables.
+
+@item @t{-n}
+Named directories.
+
+@item @t{-b}
+Key binding names.
+
+@item @t{-j}
+Job names: the first word of the job leader's command line. This is useful
+with the @t{kill} builtin.
+
+@item @t{-r}
+Names of running jobs.
+
+@item @t{-z}
+Names of suspended jobs.
+
+@item @t{-u}
+User names.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+@node Flags with Arguments, Control Flags, Simple Flags, Option Flags
+
+@subsection Flags with Arguments
+@noindent
+These have user supplied arguments to determine how the list of
+completions is to be made up:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{-k} @var{array}
+Names taken from the elements of @t{$}@var{array} (note that the `@t{$}'
+does not appear on the command line).
+Alternatively, the argument @var{array} itself may be a set
+of space- or comma-separated values in parentheses, in which any
+delimiter may be escaped with a backslash; in this case the argument
+should be quoted. For example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+compctl -k "(cputime filesize datasize stacksize
+ coredumpsize resident descriptors)" limit
+@end example
+
+@item @t{-g} @var{globstring}
+The @var{globstring} is expanded using filename globbing; it should be
+quoted to protect it from immediate expansion. The resulting
+filenames are taken as the possible completions. Use `@t{*(/)}' instead of
+`@t{*/}' for directories. The @t{fignore} special parameter is not
+applied to the resulting files. More than one pattern may be given
+separated by blanks. (Note that brace expansion is @emph{not} part of
+globbing. Use the syntax `@t{(either|or)}' to match alternatives.)
+
+@item @t{-s} @var{subststring}
+The @var{subststring} is split into words and these words are than
+expanded using all shell expansion mechanisms (see
+@ref{Expansion}). The resulting words are taken as possible
+completions. The @t{fignore} special parameter is not applied to the
+resulting files. Note that @t{-g} is faster for filenames.
+
+@item @t{-K} @var{function}
+@vindex reply, use of
+Call the given function to get the completions. Unless the name
+starts with an underscore, the function is
+passed two arguments: the prefix and the suffix of the word on which
+completion is to be attempted, in other words those characters before
+the cursor position, and those from the cursor position onwards. The
+whole command line can be accessed with the @t{-c} and @t{-l} flags
+of the @t{read} builtin. The
+function should set the variable @t{reply} to an array containing
+the completions (one completion per element); note that @t{reply}
+should not be made local to the function. From such a function the
+command line can be accessed with the @t{-c} and @t{-l} flags to
+the @t{read} builtin. For example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+function whoson @{ reply=(`users`); @}
+compctl -K whoson talk
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+completes only logged-on users after `@t{talk}'. Note that `@t{whoson}' must
+return an array, so `@t{reply=`users`}' would be incorrect.
+
+@item @t{-H} @var{num pattern}
+The possible completions are taken from the last @var{num} history
+lines. Only words matching @var{pattern} are taken. If @var{num} is
+zero or negative the whole history is searched and if @var{pattern} is
+the empty string all words are taken (as with `@t{*}'). A typical
+use is
+
+@noindent
+@example
+compctl -D -f + -H 0 @value{dsq}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+which forces completion to look back in the history list for a word if
+no filename matches.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+@node Control Flags, , Flags with Arguments, Option Flags
+
+@subsection Control Flags
+@noindent
+These do not directly specify types of name to be completed, but
+manipulate the options that do:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{-Q}
+This instructs the shell not to quote any metacharacters in the possible
+completions. Normally the results of a completion are inserted into
+the command line with any metacharacters quoted so that they are
+interpreted as normal characters. This is appropriate for filenames
+and ordinary strings. However, for special effects, such as inserting
+a backquoted expression from a completion array (@t{-k}) so that
+the expression will not be evaluated until the complete line is
+executed, this option must be used.
+
+@item @t{-P} @var{prefix}
+The @var{prefix} is inserted just before the completed string; any
+initial part already typed will be completed and the whole @var{prefix}
+ignored for completion purposes. For example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+compctl -j -P "%" kill
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+inserts a `%' after the kill command and then completes job names.
+
+@item @t{-S} @var{suffix}
+When a completion is found the @var{suffix} is inserted after
+the completed string. In the case of menu completion the suffix is
+inserted immediately, but it is still possible to cycle through the
+list of completions by repeatedly hitting the same key.
+
+@item @t{-W} @var{file-prefix}
+With directory @var{file-prefix}: for command, file, directory and
+globbing completion (options @t{-c}, @t{-f}, @t{-/}, @t{-g}), the file
+prefix is implicitly added in front of the completion. For example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+compctl -/ -W ~/Mail maildirs
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+completes any subdirectories to any depth beneath the directory
+@t{~/Mail}, although that prefix does not appear on the command line.
+The @var{file-prefix} may also be of the form accepted by the @t{-k}
+flag, i.e. the name of an array or a literal list in parenthesis. In
+this case all the directories in the list will be searched for
+possible completions.
+
+@item @t{-q}
+If used with a suffix as specified by the @t{-S} option, this
+causes the suffix to be removed if the next character typed is a blank
+or does not insert anything or if the suffix consists of only one character
+and the next character typed is the same character; this the same rule used
+for the @t{AUTO_REMOVE_SLASH} option. The option is most useful for list
+separators (comma, colon, etc.).
+
+@item @t{-l} @var{cmd}
+This option restricts the range
+of command line words that are considered to be arguments. If
+combined with one of the extended completion patterns `@t{p[}...@t{]}',
+`@t{r[}...@t{]}', or `@t{R[}...@t{]}' (see @ref{Extended Completion}
+below) the range is restricted to the range of arguments
+specified in the brackets. Completion is then performed as if these
+had been given as arguments to the @var{cmd} supplied with the
+option. If the @var{cmd} string is empty the first word in the range
+is instead taken as the command name, and command name completion
+performed on the first word in the range. For example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+compctl -x 'r[-exec,;]' -l @value{dsq} -- find
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+completes arguments between `@t{-exec}' and the following `@t{;}' (or the end
+of the command line if there is no such string) as if they were
+a separate command line.
+
+@item @t{-h} @var{cmd}
+Normally zsh completes quoted strings as a whole. With this option,
+completion can be done separately on different parts of such
+strings. It works like the @t{-l} option but makes the completion code
+work on the parts of the current word that are separated by
+spaces. These parts are completed as if they were arguments to the
+given @var{cmd}. If @var{cmd} is the empty string, the first part is
+completed as a command name, as with @t{-l}.
+
+@item @t{-U}
+Use the whole list of possible completions, whether or not they
+actually match the word on the command line. The word typed so far
+will be deleted. This is most useful with a function (given by the
+@t{-K} option) which can examine the word components passed to it
+(or via the @t{read} builtin's @t{-c} and @t{-l} flags) and
+use its own criteria to decide what matches. If there is no
+completion, the original word is retained. Since the produced
+possible completions seldom have interesting common prefixes
+and suffixes, menu completion is started immediately if @t{AUTO_MENU} is
+set and this flag is used.
+
+@item @t{-y} @var{func-or-var}
+@vindex reply, use of
+The list provided by @var{func-or-var} is displayed instead of the list
+of completions whenever a listing is required; the actual completions
+to be inserted are not affected. It can be provided in two
+ways. Firstly, if @var{func-or-var} begins with a @t{$} it defines a
+variable, or if it begins with a left parenthesis a literal
+array, which contains the list. A variable may have been set by a
+call to a function using the @t{-K} option. Otherwise it contains the
+name of a function which will be executed to create the list. The
+function will be passed as an argument list all matching completions,
+including prefixes and suffixes expanded in full, and should set the
+array @t{reply} to the result. In both cases, the display list will
+only be retrieved after a complete list of matches has been created.
+
+@noindent
+Note that the returned list does not have to correspond, even in
+length, to the original set of matches, and may be passed as a scalar
+instead of an array. No special formatting of characters is
+performed on the output in this case; in particular, newlines are
+printed literally and if they appear output in columns is suppressed.
+
+@item @t{-X} @var{explanation}
+Print @var{explanation} when trying completion on the current set of
+options. A `@t{%n}' in this string is replaced by the number of
+matches that were added for this explanation string.
+The explanation only appears if completion was tried and there was
+no unique match, or when listing completions. Explanation strings
+will be listed together with the matches of the group specified
+together with the @t{-X} option (using the @t{-J} or @t{-V}
+option). If the same explanation string is given to multiple @t{-X}
+options, the string appears only once (for each group) and the number
+of matches shown for the `@t{%n}' is the total number of all matches
+for each of these uses. In any case, the explanation string will only
+be shown if there was at least one match added for the explanation
+string.
+
+@noindent
+The sequences @t{%B}, @t{%b}, @t{%S}, @t{%s}, @t{%U}, and @t{%u} specify
+output attributes (bold, standout, and underline), @t{%F}, @t{%f}, @t{%K},
+@t{%k} specify foreground and background colours, and @t{%@{}@var{...}@t{%@}} can
+be used to include literal escape sequences as in prompts.
+
+@item @t{-Y} @var{explanation}
+Identical to @t{-X}, except that the @var{explanation} first undergoes
+expansion following the usual rules for strings in double quotes.
+The expansion will be carried out after any functions are called for
+the @t{-K} or @t{-y} options, allowing them to set variables.
+
+@item @t{-t} @var{continue}
+The @var{continue}-string contains a character that specifies which set
+of completion flags should be used next. It is useful:
+
+@noindent
+(i) With @t{-T}, or when trying a list of pattern completions, when
+@t{compctl} would usually continue with ordinary processing after
+finding matches; this can be suppressed with `@t{-tn}'.
+
+@noindent
+(ii) With a list of alternatives separated by @t{+}, when @t{compctl}
+would normally stop when one of the alternatives generates matches. It
+can be forced to consider the next set of completions by adding `@t{-t+}'
+to the flags of the alternative before the `@t{+}'.
+
+@noindent
+(iii) In an extended completion list (see below), when @t{compctl} would
+normally continue until a set of conditions succeeded, then use only
+the immediately following flags. With `@t{-t-}', @t{compctl} will
+continue trying extended completions after the next `@t{-}'; with
+`@t{-tx}' it will attempt completion with the default flags, in other
+words those before the `@t{-x}'.
+
+@item @t{-J} @var{name}
+This gives the name of the group the matches should be placed in. Groups
+are listed and sorted separately; likewise, menu completion will offer
+the matches in the groups in the order in which the groups were
+defined. If no group name is explicitly given, the matches are stored in
+a group named @t{default}. The first time a group name is encountered,
+a group with that name is created. After that all matches with the same
+group name are stored in that group.
+
+@noindent
+This can be useful with non-exclusive alternative completions. For
+example, in
+
+@noindent
+@example
+compctl -f -J files -t+ + -v -J variables foo
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+both files and variables are possible completions, as the @t{-t+} forces
+both sets of alternatives before and after the @t{+} to be considered at
+once. Because of the @t{-J} options, however, all files are listed
+before all variables.
+
+@item @t{-V} @var{name}
+Like @t{-J}, but matches within the group will not be sorted in listings
+nor in menu completion. These unsorted groups are in a different name
+space from the sorted ones, so groups defined as @t{-J files} and @t{-V
+files} are distinct.
+
+@item @t{-1}
+If given together with the @t{-V} option, makes
+only consecutive duplicates in the group be removed. Note that groups
+with and without this flag are in different name spaces.
+
+@item @t{-2}
+If given together with the @t{-J} or @t{-V} option, makes all
+duplicates be kept. Again, groups with and without this flag are in
+different name spaces.
+
+@item @t{-M} @var{match-spec}
+This defines additional matching control specifications that should be used
+only when testing words for the list of flags this flag appears in. The format
+of the @var{match-spec} string is described in
+@ref{Completion Matching Control}.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+@node Alternative Completion, Extended Completion, Option Flags, Completion Using compctl
+
+@section Alternative Completion
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{compctl} [ @t{-CDT} ] @var{options} @t{+} @var{options} [ @t{+} ... ] [ @t{+} ] @var{command} ...
+@end table
+@sp 1
+
+@noindent
+The form with `@t{+}' specifies alternative options. Completion is
+tried with the options before the first `@t{+}'. If this produces no
+matches completion is tried with the flags after the `@t{+}' and so on. If
+there are no flags after the last `@t{+}' and a match has not been found
+up to that point, default completion is tried.
+If the list of flags contains a @t{-t} with a @t{+} character, the next
+list of flags is used even if the current list produced matches.
+
+@noindent
+@node Extended Completion, Example, Alternative Completion, Completion Using compctl
+
+@noindent
+Additional options are available that restrict completion to some part
+of the command line; this is referred to as `extended completion'.
+
+@noindent
+
+@section Extended Completion
+@noindent
+
+@table @asis
+@item @t{compctl }[ @t{-CDT} ] @var{options} @t{-x} @var{pattern} @var{options} @t{-} ... @t{-}@t{-}
+@item @t{@ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ }[ @var{command} ... ]
+@item @t{compctl }[ @t{-CDT} ] @var{options} [ @t{-x} @var{pattern} @var{options} @t{-} ... @t{-}@t{-} ]
+@item @t{@ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ }[ @t{+} @var{options} [ @t{-x} ... @t{-}@t{-} ] ... [@t{+}] ] [ @var{command} ... ]
+@end table
+@sp 1
+
+@noindent
+The form with `@t{-x}' specifies extended completion for the
+commands given; as shown, it may be combined with alternative
+completion using `@t{+}'. Each @var{pattern} is examined in turn; when a
+match is found, the corresponding @var{options}, as described in
+@ref{Option Flags} above, are used to generate possible
+completions. If no @var{pattern} matches, the @var{options} given
+before the @t{-x} are used.
+
+@noindent
+Note that each pattern should be supplied as a single argument and
+should be quoted to prevent expansion of metacharacters by the
+shell.
+
+@noindent
+A @var{pattern} is built of sub-patterns separated by commas; it
+matches if at least one of these sub-patterns matches (they are
+`or'ed). These sub-patterns are in turn composed of other
+sub-patterns separated by white spaces which match if all of the
+sub-patterns match (they are `and'ed). An element of the
+sub-patterns is of the form `@var{c}@t{[}...@t{][}...@t{]}', where the pairs of
+brackets may be repeated as often as necessary, and matches if any of
+the sets of brackets match (an `or'). The example below makes this
+clearer.
+
+@noindent
+The elements may be any of the following:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{s[}@var{string}@t{]}...
+Matches if the current word on the command line starts with
+one of the strings given in brackets. The @var{string} is not removed
+and is not part of the completion.
+
+@item @t{S[}@var{string}@t{]}...
+Like @t{s[}@var{string}@t{]} except that the @var{string} is part of the
+completion.
+
+@item @t{p[}@var{from}@t{,}@var{to}@t{]}...
+Matches if the number of the current word is between one of
+the @var{from} and @var{to} pairs inclusive. The comma and @var{to}
+are optional; @var{to} defaults to the same value as @var{from}. The
+numbers may be negative: @t{-}@var{n} refers to the @var{n}'th last word
+on the line.
+
+@item @t{c[}@var{offset}@t{,}@var{string}@t{]}...
+Matches if the @var{string} matches the word offset by
+@var{offset} from the current word position. Usually @var{offset}
+will be negative.
+
+@item @t{C[}@var{offset}@t{,}@var{pattern}@t{]}...
+Like @t{c} but using pattern matching instead.
+
+@item @t{w[}@var{index}@t{,}@var{string}@t{]}...
+Matches if the word in position @var{index} is equal
+to the corresponding @var{string}. Note that the word count is made
+after any alias expansion.
+
+@item @t{W[}@var{index}@t{,}@var{pattern}@t{]}...
+Like @t{w} but using pattern matching instead.
+
+@item @t{n[}@var{index}@t{,}@var{string}@t{]}...
+Matches if the current word contains @var{string}. Anything up to and
+including the @var{index}th occurrence of this string will not be
+considered part of the completion, but the rest will. @var{index} may
+be negative to count from the end: in most cases, @var{index} will be
+1 or -1. For example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+compctl -s '`users`' -x 'n[1,@@]' -k hosts -- talk
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+will usually complete usernames, but if you insert an @t{@@} after the
+name, names from the array @var{hosts} (assumed to contain hostnames,
+though you must make the array yourself) will be completed. Other
+commands such as @t{rcp} can be handled similarly.
+
+@item @t{N[}@var{index}@t{,}@var{string}@t{]}...
+Like @t{n} except that the string will be
+taken as a character class. Anything up to and including the
+@var{index}th occurrence of any of the characters in @var{string}
+will not be considered part of the completion.
+
+@item @t{m[}@var{min}@t{,}@var{max}@t{]}...
+Matches if the total number of words lies between @var{min} and
+@var{max} inclusive.
+
+@item @t{r[}@var{str1}@t{,}@var{str2}@t{]}...
+Matches if the cursor is after a word with prefix @var{str1}. If there
+is also a word with prefix @var{str2} on the command line after the one
+matched by @var{str1} it matches
+only if the cursor is before this word. If the comma and @var{str2} are
+omitted, it matches if the cursor is after a word with prefix @var{str1}.
+
+@item @t{R[}@var{str1}@t{,}@var{str2}@t{]}...
+Like @t{r} but using pattern matching instead.
+
+@item @t{q[}@var{str}@t{]}...
+Matches the word currently being completed is in single quotes and the
+@var{str} begins with the letter `s', or if completion is done in
+double quotes and @var{str} starts with the letter `d', or if
+completion is done in backticks and @var{str} starts with a `b'.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+@node Example, , Extended Completion, Completion Using compctl
+
+@section Example
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+@example
+compctl -u -x 's[+] c[-1,-f],s[-f+]' \
+ -g '~/Mail/*(:t)' - 's[-f],c[-1,-f]' -f -- mail
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+This is to be interpreted as follows:
+
+@noindent
+If the current command is @t{mail}, then
+
+@noindent
+@quotation
+
+if ((the current word begins with @t{+} and the previous word is @t{-f})
+or (the current word begins with @t{-f+})), then complete the
+non-directory part (the `@t{:t}' glob modifier) of files in the directory
+@t{~/Mail}; else
+
+@noindent
+if the current word begins with @t{-f} or the previous word was @t{-f}, then
+complete any file; else
+
+@noindent
+complete user names.
+
+@end quotation
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/modules.yo
+@node Zsh Modules, Calendar Function System, Completion Using compctl, Top
+
+@chapter Zsh Modules
+@noindent
+@cindex modules
+
+@section Description
+@noindent
+Some optional parts of zsh are in modules, separate from the core
+of the shell. Each of these modules may be linked in to the
+shell at build time,
+or can be dynamically linked while the shell is running
+if the installation supports this feature.
+Modules are linked at runtime with the @t{zmodload} command,
+see @ref{Shell Builtin Commands}.
+
+@noindent
+The modules that are bundled with the zsh distribution are:
+
+@noindent
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/modlist.yo
+@table @asis
+@item @t{zsh/attr}
+Builtins for manipulating extended attributes (xattr).
+
+@item @t{zsh/cap}
+Builtins for manipulating POSIX.1e (POSIX.6) capability (privilege) sets.
+
+@item @t{zsh/clone}
+A builtin that can clone a running shell onto another terminal.
+
+@item @t{zsh/compctl}
+The @t{compctl} builtin for controlling completion.
+
+@item @t{zsh/complete}
+The basic completion code.
+
+@item @t{zsh/complist}
+Completion listing extensions.
+
+@item @t{zsh/computil}
+A module with utility builtins needed for the shell function based
+completion system.
+
+@item @t{zsh/curses}
+curses windowing commands
+
+@item @t{zsh/datetime}
+Some date/time commands and parameters.
+
+@item @t{zsh/db/gdbm}
+Builtins for managing associative array parameters tied to GDBM databases.
+
+@item @t{zsh/deltochar}
+A ZLE function duplicating EMACS' @t{zap-to-char}.
+
+@item @t{zsh/example}
+An example of how to write a module.
+
+@item @t{zsh/files}
+Some basic file manipulation commands as builtins.
+
+@item @t{zsh/langinfo}
+Interface to locale information.
+
+@item @t{zsh/mapfile}
+Access to external files via a special associative array.
+
+@item @t{zsh/mathfunc}
+Standard scientific functions for use in mathematical evaluations.
+
+@item @t{zsh/nearcolor}
+Map colours to the nearest colour in the available palette.
+
+@item @t{zsh/newuser}
+Arrange for files for new users to be installed.
+
+@item @t{zsh/parameter}
+Access to internal hash tables via special associative arrays.
+
+@item @t{zsh/pcre}
+Interface to the PCRE library.
+
+@item @t{zsh/param/private}
+Builtins for managing private-scoped parameters in function context.
+
+@item @t{zsh/regex}
+Interface to the POSIX regex library.
+
+@item @t{zsh/sched}
+A builtin that provides a timed execution facility within the shell.
+
+@item @t{zsh/net/socket}
+Manipulation of Unix domain sockets
+
+@item @t{zsh/stat}
+A builtin command interface to the @t{stat} system call.
+
+@item @t{zsh/system}
+A builtin interface to various low-level system features.
+
+@item @t{zsh/net/tcp}
+Manipulation of TCP sockets
+
+@item @t{zsh/termcap}
+Interface to the termcap database.
+
+@item @t{zsh/terminfo}
+Interface to the terminfo database.
+
+@item @t{zsh/zftp}
+A builtin FTP client.
+
+@item @t{zsh/zle}
+The Zsh Line Editor, including the @t{bindkey} and @t{vared} builtins.
+
+@item @t{zsh/zleparameter}
+Access to internals of the Zsh Line Editor via parameters.
+
+@item @t{zsh/zprof}
+A module allowing profiling for shell functions.
+
+@item @t{zsh/zpty}
+A builtin for starting a command in a pseudo-terminal.
+
+@item @t{zsh/zselect}
+Block and return when file descriptors are ready.
+
+@item @t{zsh/zutil}
+Some utility builtins, e.g. the one for supporting configuration via
+styles.
+
+@end table
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/modmenu.yo
+@menu
+* The zsh/attr Module::
+* The zsh/cap Module::
+* The zsh/clone Module::
+* The zsh/compctl Module::
+* The zsh/complete Module::
+* The zsh/complist Module::
+* The zsh/computil Module::
+* The zsh/curses Module::
+* The zsh/datetime Module::
+* The zsh/db/gdbm Module::
+* The zsh/deltochar Module::
+* The zsh/example Module::
+* The zsh/files Module::
+* The zsh/langinfo Module::
+* The zsh/mapfile Module::
+* The zsh/mathfunc Module::
+* The zsh/nearcolor Module::
+* The zsh/newuser Module::
+* The zsh/parameter Module::
+* The zsh/pcre Module::
+* The zsh/param/private Module::
+* The zsh/regex Module::
+* The zsh/sched Module::
+* The zsh/net/socket Module::
+* The zsh/stat Module::
+* The zsh/system Module::
+* The zsh/net/tcp Module::
+* The zsh/termcap Module::
+* The zsh/terminfo Module::
+* The zsh/zftp Module::
+* The zsh/zle Module::
+* The zsh/zleparameter Module::
+* The zsh/zprof Module::
+* The zsh/zpty Module::
+* The zsh/zselect Module::
+* The zsh/zutil Module::
+@end menu
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@node The zsh/attr Module, The zsh/cap Module, , Zsh Modules
+
+@section The zsh/attr Module
+@noindent
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/mod_attr.yo
+
+The @t{zsh/attr} module is used for manipulating extended attributes.
+The @t{-h} option causes all commands to operate on symbolic links instead
+of their targets.
+The builtins in this module are:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex zgetattr
+@cindex extended attributes, xattr, getting from files
+@item @t{zgetattr} [ @t{-h} ] @var{filename} @var{attribute} [ @var{parameter} ]
+Get the extended attribute @var{attribute} from the specified
+@var{filename}. If the optional argument @var{parameter} is given, the
+attribute is set on that parameter instead of being printed to stdout.
+
+@findex zsetattr
+@cindex extended attributes, xattr, setting on files
+@item @t{zsetattr} [ @t{-h} ] @var{filename} @var{attribute} @var{value}
+Set the extended attribute @var{attribute} on the specified
+@var{filename} to @var{value}.
+
+@findex zdelattr
+@cindex extended attributes, xattr, removing, deleting
+@item @t{zdelattr} [ @t{-h} ] @var{filename} @var{attribute}
+Remove the extended attribute @var{attribute} from the specified
+@var{filename}.
+
+@findex zlistattr
+@cindex extended attributes, xattr, listing
+@item @t{zlistattr} [ @t{-h} ] @var{filename} [ @var{parameter} ]
+List the extended attributes currently set on the specified
+@var{filename}. If the optional argument @var{parameter} is given, the
+list of attributes is set on that parameter instead of being printed to stdout.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+@t{zgetattr} and @t{zlistattr} allocate memory dynamically. If the
+attribute or list of attributes grows between the allocation and the call
+to get them, they return 2. On all other errors, 1 is returned. This
+allows the calling function to check for this case and retry.
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@node The zsh/cap Module, The zsh/clone Module, The zsh/attr Module, Zsh Modules
+
+@section The zsh/cap Module
+@noindent
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/mod_cap.yo
+
+The @t{zsh/cap} module is used for manipulating POSIX.1e (POSIX.6) capability
+sets. If the operating system does not support this interface, the
+builtins defined by this module will do nothing.
+The builtins in this module are:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex cap
+@cindex capabilities, setting
+@item @t{cap} [ @var{capabilities} ]
+Change the shell's process capability sets to the specified @var{capabilities},
+otherwise display the shell's current capabilities.
+
+@findex getcap
+@cindex capabilities, getting from files
+@item @t{getcap} @var{filename} ...
+This is a built-in implementation of the POSIX standard utility. It displays
+the capability sets on each specified @var{filename}.
+
+@findex setcap
+@cindex capabilities, setting on files
+@item @t{setcap} @var{capabilities} @var{filename} ...
+This is a built-in implementation of the POSIX standard utility. It sets
+the capability sets on each specified @var{filename} to the specified
+@var{capabilities}.
+
+@end table
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@node The zsh/clone Module, The zsh/compctl Module, The zsh/cap Module, Zsh Modules
+
+@section The zsh/clone Module
+@noindent
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/mod_clone.yo
+
+The @t{zsh/clone} module makes available one builtin command:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex clone
+@cindex shell, cloning
+@cindex cloning the shell
+@cindex terminal
+@item @t{clone} @var{tty}
+Creates a forked instance of the current shell, attached to the specified
+@var{tty}. In the new shell, the @t{PID}, @t{PPID} and @t{TTY} special
+parameters are changed appropriately. @t{$!} is set to zero in the new
+shell, and to the new shell's PID in the original shell.
+
+@noindent
+The return status of the builtin is zero in both shells if successful,
+and non-zero on error.
+
+@noindent
+The target of @t{clone} should be an unused terminal, such as an unused virtual
+console or a virtual terminal created by
+
+@noindent
+@example
+xterm -e sh -c 'trap : INT QUIT TSTP; tty;
+ while :; do sleep 100000000; done'
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Some words of explanation are warranted about this long xterm command
+line: when doing clone on a pseudo-terminal, some other session
+("session" meant as a unix session group, or SID) is already owning
+the terminal. Hence the cloned zsh cannot acquire the pseudo-terminal
+as a controlling tty. That means two things:
+
+@noindent
+@itemize @bullet
+
+@item
+the job control signals will go to the sh-started-by-xterm process
+group (that's why we disable INT QUIT and TSTP with trap; otherwise
+the while loop could get suspended or killed)
+@item
+the cloned shell will have job control disabled, and the job
+control keys (control-C, control-\ and control-Z) will not work.
+@end itemize
+
+@noindent
+This does not apply when cloning to an @emph{unused} vc.
+
+@noindent
+Cloning to a used (and unprepared) terminal will result in two
+processes reading simultaneously from the same terminal, with
+input bytes going randomly to either process.
+
+@noindent
+@t{clone} is mostly useful as a shell built-in replacement for
+openvt.
+
+@end table
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@node The zsh/compctl Module, The zsh/complete Module, The zsh/clone Module, Zsh Modules
+
+@section The zsh/compctl Module
+@noindent
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/mod_compctl.yo
+
+The @t{zsh/compctl} module makes available two builtin commands. @t{compctl},
+is the old, deprecated way to control completions for ZLE. See
+@ref{Completion Using compctl}.
+The other builtin command, @t{compcall} can be used in user-defined
+completion widgets, see
+@ref{Completion Widgets}.
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@node The zsh/complete Module, The zsh/complist Module, The zsh/compctl Module, Zsh Modules
+
+@section The zsh/complete Module
+@noindent
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/mod_complete.yo
+
+The @t{zsh/complete} module makes available several builtin commands which
+can be used in user-defined completion widgets, see
+@ref{Completion Widgets}.
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@node The zsh/complist Module, The zsh/computil Module, The zsh/complete Module, Zsh Modules
+
+@section The zsh/complist Module
+@noindent
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/mod_complist.yo
+
+@cindex completion, listing
+@cindex completion, coloured listings
+@cindex completion, scroll listings
+The @t{zsh/complist} module offers three extensions to completion listings:
+the ability to highlight matches in such a list, the ability to
+scroll through long lists and a different style of menu completion.
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Colored completion listings
+@noindent
+Whenever one of the parameters @t{ZLS_COLORS} or @t{ZLS_COLOURS} is set
+and the @t{zsh/complist} module is loaded or linked into the shell,
+completion lists will be colored. Note, however, that @t{complist} will
+not automatically be loaded if it is not linked in: on systems with
+dynamic loading, `@t{zmodload zsh/complist}' is required.
+
+@noindent
+@vindex ZLS_COLORS
+@vindex ZLS_COLOURS
+The parameters @t{ZLS_COLORS} and @t{ZLS_COLOURS} describe how matches
+are highlighted. To turn on highlighting an empty value suffices, in
+which case all the default values given below will be used. The format of
+the value of these parameters is the same as used by the GNU version of the
+@t{ls} command: a colon-separated list of specifications of the form
+`@var{name}@t{=}@var{value}'. The @var{name} may be one of the following strings,
+most of which specify file types for which the @var{value} will be used.
+The strings and their default values are:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{no 0}
+for normal text (i.e. when displaying something other than a matched file)
+
+@item @t{fi 0}
+for regular files
+
+@item @t{di 32}
+for directories
+
+@item @t{ln 36}
+for symbolic links. If this has the special value @t{target},
+symbolic links are dereferenced and the target file used to
+determine the display format.
+
+@item @t{pi 31}
+for named pipes (FIFOs)
+
+@item @t{so 33}
+for sockets
+
+@item @t{bd 44;37}
+for block devices
+
+@item @t{cd 44;37}
+for character devices
+
+@item @t{or} @var{none}
+for a symlink to nonexistent file (default is the value defined for @t{ln})
+
+@item @t{mi} @var{none}
+for a non-existent file (default is the value defined for @t{fi}); this code
+is currently not used
+
+@item @t{su 37;41}
+for files with setuid bit set
+
+@item @t{sg 30;43}
+for files with setgid bit set
+
+@item @t{tw 30;42}
+for world writable directories with sticky bit set
+
+@item @t{ow 34;43}
+for world writable directories without sticky bit set
+
+@item @t{sa} @var{none}
+for files with an associated suffix alias; this is only tested
+after specific suffixes, as described below
+
+@item @t{st 37;44}
+for directories with sticky bit set but not world writable
+
+@item @t{ex 35}
+for executable files
+
+@item @t{lc \e[}
+for the left code (see below)
+
+@item @t{rc m}
+for the right code
+
+@item @t{tc 0}
+for the character indicating the file type printed after filenames if
+the @t{LIST_TYPES} option is set
+
+@item @t{sp 0}
+for the spaces printed after matches to align the next column
+
+@item @t{ec} @var{none}
+for the end code
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+Apart from these strings, the @var{name} may also be an asterisk
+(`@t{*}') followed by any string. The @var{value} given for such a
+string will be used for all files whose name ends with the string.
+The @var{name} may also be an equals sign (`@t{=}') followed by a
+pattern; the @t{EXTENDED_GLOB} option will be turned on for evaluation
+of the pattern. The @var{value} given for this pattern will be used for all
+matches (not just filenames) whose display string are matched by
+the pattern. Definitions for the form with the leading equal sign take
+precedence over the values defined for file types, which in turn take
+precedence over the form with the leading asterisk (file extensions).
+
+@noindent
+The leading-equals form also allows different parts of the displayed
+strings to be colored differently. For this, the pattern has to use the
+`@t{(#b)}' globbing flag and pairs of parentheses surrounding the
+parts of the strings that are to be colored differently. In this case
+the @var{value} may consist of more than one color code separated by
+equal signs. The first code will be used for all parts for which no
+explicit code is specified and the following codes will be used for
+the parts matched by the sub-patterns in parentheses. For example,
+the specification `@t{=(#b)(?)*(?)=0=3=7}' will be used for all
+matches which are at least two characters long and will use
+the code `@t{3}' for the first character, `@t{7}' for the last
+character and `@t{0}' for the rest.
+
+@noindent
+All three forms of @var{name} may be preceded by a pattern in
+parentheses. If this is given, the @var{value} will be used
+only for matches in groups whose names are matched by the pattern
+given in the parentheses. For example, `@t{(g*)m*=43}' highlights all
+matches beginning with `@t{m}' in groups whose names begin with
+`@t{g}' using the color code `@t{43}'. In case of the `@t{lc}',
+`@t{rc}', and `@t{ec}' codes, the group pattern is ignored.
+
+@noindent
+Note also that all patterns are tried in the order in which they
+appear in the parameter value until the first one matches which is
+then used. Patterns may be matched against completions, descriptions
+(possibly with spaces appended for padding), or lines consisting of a
+completion followed by a description. For consistent coloring it may be
+necessary to use more than one pattern or a pattern with backreferences.
+
+@noindent
+When printing a match, the code prints the value of @t{lc}, the value
+for the file-type or the last matching specification with a `@t{*}',
+the value of @t{rc}, the string to display for the match itself, and
+then the value of @t{ec} if that is defined or the values of @t{lc},
+@t{no}, and @t{rc} if @t{ec} is not defined.
+
+@noindent
+The default values are ISO 6429 (ANSI) compliant and can be used on
+vt100 compatible terminals such as @t{xterm}s. On monochrome terminals
+the default values will have no visible effect. The @t{colors}
+function from the contribution can be used to get associative arrays
+containing the codes for ANSI terminals (see
+@ref{Other Functions}). For example, after loading @t{colors}, one could use
+`@t{$color[red]}' to get the code for foreground color red and
+`@t{$color[bg-green]}' for the code for background color green.
+
+@noindent
+If the completion system invoked by compinit is used, these
+parameters should not be set directly because the system controls them
+itself. Instead, the @t{list-colors} style should be used (see
+@ref{Completion System Configuration}).
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Scrolling in completion listings
+@noindent
+To enable scrolling through a completion list, the @t{LISTPROMPT}
+parameter must be set. Its value will be used as the prompt; if it
+is the empty string, a default prompt will be used. The value may
+contain escapes of the form `@t{%x}'. It supports the escapes
+`@t{%B}', `@t{%b}', `@t{%S}', `@t{%s}', `@t{%U}', `@t{%u}', `@t{%F}',
+`@t{%f}', `@t{%K}', `@t{%k}' and
+`@t{%@{}@var{...}@t{%@}}' used also in shell prompts as well as three pairs of
+additional sequences: a `@t{%l}' or `@t{%L}' is replaced by the number
+of the last line shown and the total number of lines in the form
+`@var{number}@t{/}@var{total}'; a `@t{%m}' or `@t{%M}' is replaced with
+the number of the last match shown and the total number of matches; and
+`@t{%p}' or `@t{%P}' is replaced with `@t{Top}', `@t{Bottom}' or the
+position of the first line shown in percent of the total number of
+lines, respectively. In each of these cases the form with the uppercase
+letter will be replaced with a string of fixed width, padded to the
+right with spaces, while the lowercase form will not be padded.
+
+@noindent
+If the parameter @t{LISTPROMPT} is set, the completion code will not ask if
+the list should be shown. Instead it immediately starts displaying the
+list, stopping after the first screenful, showing the prompt at the bottom,
+waiting for a keypress after temporarily switching to the @t{listscroll}
+keymap. Some of the zle functions have a special meaning while scrolling
+lists:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{send-break}
+stops listing discarding the key pressed
+
+@item @t{accept-line}, @t{down-history}, @t{down-line-or-history}
+@itemx @t{down-line-or-search}, @t{vi-down-line-or-history}
+scrolls forward one line
+
+@item @t{complete-word}, @t{menu-complete}, @t{expand-or-complete}
+@itemx @t{expand-or-complete-prefix}, @t{menu-complete-or-expand}
+scrolls forward one screenful
+
+@item @t{accept-search}
+stop listing but take no other action
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+Every other character stops listing and immediately processes the key
+as usual. Any key that is not bound in the @t{listscroll} keymap or
+that is bound to @t{undefined-key} is looked up in the keymap
+currently selected.
+
+@noindent
+As for the @t{ZLS_COLORS} and @t{ZLS_COLOURS} parameters,
+@t{LISTPROMPT} should not be set directly when using the shell
+function based completion system. Instead, the @t{list-prompt} style
+should be used.
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Menu selection
+@noindent
+@cindex completion, selecting by cursor
+@vindex MENUSELECT
+@tindex menu-select
+The @t{zsh/complist} module also offers an alternative style of selecting
+matches from a list, called menu selection, which can be used if the
+shell is set up to return to the last prompt after showing a
+completion list (see the @t{ALWAYS_LAST_PROMPT} option in
+@ref{Options}).
+
+@noindent
+Menu selection can be invoked directly by
+the widget @t{menu-select} defined by this module. This is a standard
+ZLE widget that can be bound to a key in the usual way as described
+in @ref{Zsh Line Editor}.
+
+@noindent
+Alternatively,
+the parameter @t{MENUSELECT} can be set to an integer, which gives the
+minimum number of matches that must be present before menu selection is
+automatically turned on. This second method requires that menu completion
+be started, either directly from a widget such as @t{menu-complete}, or due
+to one of the options @t{MENU_COMPLETE} or @t{AUTO_MENU} being set. If
+@t{MENUSELECT} is set, but is 0, 1 or empty, menu selection will always be
+started during an ambiguous menu completion.
+
+@noindent
+When using the completion system based on shell functions, the
+@t{MENUSELECT} parameter should not be used (like the @t{ZLS_COLORS}
+and @t{ZLS_COLOURS} parameters described above). Instead, the @t{menu}
+style should be used with the @t{select=}@var{...} keyword.
+
+@noindent
+After menu selection is started, the matches will be listed. If there
+are more matches than fit on the screen, only the first screenful is
+shown. The
+matches to insert into the command line can be selected from this
+list. In the list one match is highlighted using the value for @t{ma}
+from the @t{ZLS_COLORS} or @t{ZLS_COLOURS} parameter. The default
+value for this is `@t{7}' which forces the selected match to be
+highlighted using standout mode on a vt100-compatible terminal. If
+neither @t{ZLS_COLORS} nor @t{ZLS_COLOURS} is set, the same terminal
+control sequence as for the `@t{%S}' escape in prompts is used.
+
+@noindent
+If there are more matches than fit on the screen and the parameter
+@t{MENUPROMPT} is set, its value will be shown below the matches. It
+supports the same escape sequences as @t{LISTPROMPT}, but the number
+of the match or line shown will be that of the one where the mark is
+placed. If its value is the empty string, a default prompt will be
+used.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{MENUSCROLL} parameter can be used to specify how the list is
+scrolled. If the parameter is unset, this is done line by line, if it
+is set to `@t{0}' (zero), the list will scroll half the number of
+lines of the screen. If the value is positive, it gives the number of
+lines to scroll and if it is negative, the list will be scrolled
+the number of lines of the screen minus the (absolute) value.
+
+@noindent
+As for the @t{ZLS_COLORS}, @t{ZLS_COLOURS} and @t{LISTPROMPT}
+parameters, neither @t{MENUPROMPT} nor @t{MENUSCROLL} should be
+set directly when using the shell function based completion
+system. Instead, the @t{select-prompt} and @t{select-scroll} styles
+should be used.
+
+@noindent
+The completion code sometimes decides not to show all of the matches
+in the list. These hidden matches are either matches for which the
+completion function which added them explicitly requested that they
+not appear in the list (using the @t{-n} option of the @t{compadd}
+builtin command) or they are matches which duplicate a string already
+in the list (because they differ only in things like prefixes or
+suffixes that are not displayed). In the list used for menu selection,
+however, even these matches are shown so that it is possible to select
+them. To highlight such matches the @t{hi} and @t{du} capabilities in
+the @t{ZLS_COLORS} and @t{ZLS_COLOURS} parameters are supported for
+hidden matches of the first and second kind, respectively.
+
+@noindent
+Selecting matches is done by moving the mark around using the zle movement
+functions. When not all matches can be shown on the screen at the same
+time, the list will scroll up and down when crossing the top or
+bottom line. The following zle functions have special meaning during
+menu selection. Note that the following always
+perform the same task within the menu selection map and cannot be
+replaced by user defined widgets, nor can the set of functions
+be extended:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{accept-line}, @t{accept-search}
+accept the current match and leave menu selection (but do
+not cause the command line to be accepted)
+
+@item @t{send-break}
+leaves menu selection and restores the previous contents of the
+command line
+
+@item @t{redisplay}, @t{clear-screen}
+execute their normal function without leaving menu selection
+
+@item @t{accept-and-hold}, @t{accept-and-menu-complete}
+accept the currently inserted match and continue selection allowing to
+select the next match to insert into the line
+
+@item @t{accept-and-infer-next-history}
+accepts the current match and then tries completion with
+menu selection again; in the case of files this allows one to select
+a directory and immediately attempt to complete files in it; if there
+are no matches, a message is shown and one can use @t{undo} to go back
+to completion on the previous level, every other key leaves menu
+selection (including the other zle functions which are otherwise
+special during menu selection)
+
+@item @t{undo}
+removes matches inserted during the menu selection by one of the three
+functions before
+
+@item @t{down-history}, @t{down-line-or-history}
+@itemx @t{vi-down-line-or-history}, @t{down-line-or-search}
+moves the mark one line down
+
+@item @t{up-history}, @t{up-line-or-history}
+@itemx @t{vi-up-line-or-history}, @t{up-line-or-search}
+moves the mark one line up
+
+@item @t{forward-char}, @t{vi-forward-char}
+moves the mark one column right
+
+@item @t{backward-char}, @t{vi-backward-char}
+moves the mark one column left
+
+@item @t{forward-word}, @t{vi-forward-word}
+@itemx @t{vi-forward-word-end}, @t{emacs-forward-word}
+moves the mark one screenful down
+
+@item @t{backward-word}, @t{vi-backward-word}, @t{emacs-backward-word}
+moves the mark one screenful up
+
+@item @t{vi-forward-blank-word}, @t{vi-forward-blank-word-end}
+moves the mark to the first line of the next group of matches
+
+@item @t{vi-backward-blank-word}
+moves the mark to the last line of the previous group of matches
+
+@item @t{beginning-of-history}
+moves the mark to the first line
+
+@item @t{end-of-history}
+moves the mark to the last line
+
+@item @t{beginning-of-buffer-or-history}, @t{beginning-of-line}
+@itemx @t{beginning-of-line-hist}, @t{vi-beginning-of-line}
+moves the mark to the leftmost column
+
+@item @t{end-of-buffer-or-history}, @t{end-of-line}
+@itemx @t{end-of-line-hist}, @t{vi-end-of-line}
+moves the mark to the rightmost column
+
+@item @t{complete-word}, @t{menu-complete}, @t{expand-or-complete}
+@itemx @t{expand-or-complete-prefix}, @t{menu-expand-or-complete}
+moves the mark to the next match
+
+@item @t{reverse-menu-complete}
+moves the mark to the previous match
+
+@item @t{vi-insert}
+this toggles between normal and interactive mode; in interactive mode
+the keys bound to @t{self-insert} and @t{self-insert-unmeta} insert
+into the command line as in normal editing mode but without leaving
+menu selection; after each character completion is tried again and the
+list changes to contain only the new matches; the completion widgets
+make the longest unambiguous string be inserted in the command line
+and @t{undo} and @t{backward-delete-char} go back to the previous set
+of matches
+
+@item @t{history-incremental-search-forward}
+@itemx @t{history-incremental-search-backward}
+this starts incremental searches in the list of completions displayed;
+in this mode, @t{accept-line} only leaves incremental search, going
+back to the normal menu selection mode
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+All movement functions wrap around at the edges; any other zle function not
+listed leaves menu selection and executes that function. It is possible to
+make widgets in the above list do the same by using the form of the widget
+with a `@t{.}' in front. For example, the widget `@t{.accept-line}' has
+the effect of leaving menu selection and accepting the entire command line.
+
+@noindent
+During this selection the widget uses the keymap @t{menuselect}. Any
+key that is not defined in this keymap or that is bound to
+@t{undefined-key} is looked up in the keymap currently selected. This
+is used to ensure that the most important keys used during selection
+(namely the cursor keys, return, and TAB) have sensible defaults. However,
+keys in the @t{menuselect} keymap can be modified directly using the
+@t{bindkey} builtin command (see
+@ref{The zsh/zle Module}). For example, to make the return key leave menu selection without
+accepting the match currently selected one could call
+
+@noindent
+@example
+bindkey -M menuselect '^M' send-break
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+after loading the @t{zsh/complist} module.
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@node The zsh/computil Module, The zsh/curses Module, The zsh/complist Module, Zsh Modules
+
+@section The zsh/computil Module
+@noindent
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/mod_computil.yo
+
+@cindex completion, utility
+The @t{zsh/computil} module adds several builtin commands that are used by
+some of the completion functions in the completion system based on shell
+functions (see
+@ref{Completion System}
+). Except for @t{compquote} these builtin commands are very
+specialised and thus not very interesting when writing your own
+completion functions. In summary, these builtin commands are:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex comparguments
+@item @t{comparguments}
+This is used by the @t{_arguments} function to do the argument and
+command line parsing. Like @t{compdescribe} it has an option @t{-i} to
+do the parsing and initialize some internal state and various options
+to access the state information to decide what should be completed.
+
+@findex compdescribe
+@item @t{compdescribe}
+This is used by the @t{_describe} function to build the displays for
+the matches and to get the strings to add as matches with their
+options. On the first call one of the options @t{-i} or @t{-I} should be
+supplied as the first argument. In the first case, display strings without
+the descriptions will be generated, in the second case, the string used to
+separate the matches from their descriptions must be given as the
+second argument and the descriptions (if any) will be shown. All other
+arguments are like the definition arguments to @t{_describe} itself.
+
+@noindent
+Once @t{compdescribe} has been called with either the @t{-i} or the
+@t{-I} option, it can be repeatedly called with the @t{-g} option and
+the names of four parameters as its arguments. This will step through
+the different sets of matches and store the value of @t{compstate[list]}
+in the first scalar, the options for @t{compadd} in the second array,
+the matches in the third array, and the strings to be displayed in the
+completion listing in the fourth array. The arrays may then be directly
+given to @t{compadd} to register the matches with the completion code.
+
+@findex compfiles
+@item @t{compfiles}
+Used by the @t{_path_files} function to optimize complex recursive
+filename generation (globbing). It does three things. With the
+@t{-p} and @t{-P} options it builds the glob patterns to use,
+including the paths already handled and trying to optimize the
+patterns with respect to the prefix and suffix from the line and the
+match specification currently used. The @t{-i} option does the
+directory tests for the @t{ignore-parents} style and the @t{-r} option
+tests if a component for some of the matches are equal to the string
+on the line and removes all other matches if that is true.
+
+@findex compgroups
+@item @t{compgroups}
+Used by the @t{_tags} function to implement the internals of the
+@t{group-order} style. This only takes its arguments as names of
+completion groups and creates the groups for it (all six types: sorted
+and unsorted, both without removing duplicates, with removing all
+duplicates and with removing consecutive duplicates).
+
+@findex compquote
+@item @t{compquote} [ @t{-p} ] @var{names} ...
+There may be reasons to write completion functions that have to add
+the matches using the @t{-Q} option to @t{compadd} and perform quoting
+themselves. Instead of interpreting the first character of the
+@t{all_quotes} key of the @t{compstate} special association and using
+the @t{q} flag for parameter expansions, one can use this builtin
+command. The arguments are the names of scalar or array parameters
+and the values of these parameters are quoted as needed for the
+innermost quoting level. If the @t{-p} option is given, quoting is
+done as if there is some prefix before the values of the parameters,
+so that a leading equal sign will not be quoted.
+
+@noindent
+The return status is non-zero in case of an error and zero otherwise.
+
+@findex comptags
+@findex comptry
+@item @t{comptags}
+@itemx @t{comptry}
+These implement the internals of the tags mechanism.
+
+@findex compvalues
+@item @t{compvalues}
+Like @t{comparguments}, but for the @t{_values} function.
+
+@end table
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@node The zsh/curses Module, The zsh/datetime Module, The zsh/computil Module, Zsh Modules
+
+@section The zsh/curses Module
+@noindent
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/mod_curses.yo
+
+The @t{zsh/curses} module makes available one builtin command and
+various parameters.
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Builtin
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex zcurses
+@cindex windows, curses
+@item @t{zcurses} @t{init}
+@itemx @t{zcurses} @t{end}
+@itemx @t{zcurses} @t{addwin} @var{targetwin} @var{nlines} @var{ncols} @var{begin_y} @var{begin_x} [ @var{parentwin} ]
+@itemx @t{zcurses} @t{delwin} @var{targetwin}
+@itemx @t{zcurses} @t{refresh} [ @var{targetwin} ... ]
+@itemx @t{zcurses} @t{touch} @var{targetwin} ...
+@itemx @t{zcurses} @t{move} @var{targetwin} @var{new_y} @var{new_x}
+@itemx @t{zcurses} @t{clear} @var{targetwin} [ @t{redraw} | @t{eol} | @t{bot} ]
+@itemx @t{zcurses} @t{position} @var{targetwin} @var{array}
+@itemx @t{zcurses} @t{char} @var{targetwin} @var{character}
+@itemx @t{zcurses} @t{string} @var{targetwin} @var{string}
+@itemx @t{zcurses} @t{border} @var{targetwin} @var{border}
+@itemx @t{zcurses} @t{attr} @var{targetwin} [ [@t{+}|@t{-}]@var{attribute} | @var{fg_col}@t{/}@var{bg_col} ] [...]
+@itemx @t{zcurses} @t{bg} @var{targetwin} [ [@t{+}|@t{-}]@var{attribute} | @var{fg_col}@t{/}@var{bg_col} | @t{@@}@var{char} ] [...]
+@itemx @t{zcurses} @t{scroll} @var{targetwin} [ @t{on} | @t{off} | [@t{+}|@t{-}]@var{lines} ]
+@itemx @t{zcurses} @t{input} @var{targetwin} [ @var{param} [ @var{kparam} [ @var{mparam} ] ] ]
+@itemx @t{zcurses} @t{mouse} [ @t{delay} @var{num} | [@t{+}|@t{-}]@t{motion} ]
+@itemx @t{zcurses} @t{timeout} @var{targetwin} @var{intval}
+@itemx @t{zcurses} @t{querychar} @var{targetwin} [ @var{param} ]
+@itemx @t{zcurses} @t{resize} @var{height} @var{width} [ @t{endwin} | @t{nosave} | @t{endwin_nosave} ]
+Manipulate curses windows. All uses of this command should be
+bracketed by `@t{zcurses init}' to initialise use of curses, and
+`@t{zcurses end}' to end it; omitting `@t{zcurses end}' can cause
+the terminal to be in an unwanted state.
+
+@noindent
+The subcommand @t{addwin} creates a window with @var{nlines} lines and
+@var{ncols} columns. Its upper left corner will be placed at row
+@var{begin_y} and column
+@var{begin_x} of the screen. @var{targetwin} is a string and refers
+to the name of a window that is not currently assigned. Note
+in particular the curses convention that vertical values appear
+before horizontal values.
+
+@noindent
+If @t{addwin} is given an existing window as the final argument, the new
+window is created as a subwindow of @var{parentwin}. This differs from an
+ordinary new window in that the memory of the window contents is shared
+with the parent's memory. Subwindows must be deleted before their parent.
+Note that the coordinates of subwindows are relative to the screen, not
+the parent, as with other windows.
+
+@noindent
+Use the subcommand @t{delwin} to delete a window created with
+@t{addwin}. Note that @t{end} does @emph{not} implicitly delete windows,
+and that @t{delwin} does not erase the screen image of the window.
+
+@noindent
+The window corresponding to the full visible screen is called
+@t{stdscr}; it always exists after `@t{zcurses init}' and cannot
+be delete with @t{delwin}.
+
+@noindent
+The subcommand @t{refresh} will refresh window @var{targetwin}; this is
+necessary to make any pending changes (such as characters you have
+prepared for output with @t{char}) visible on the screen. @t{refresh}
+without an argument causes the screen to be cleared and redrawn.
+If multiple windows are given, the screen is updated once at the end.
+
+@noindent
+The subcommand @t{touch} marks the @var{targetwin}s listed as changed.
+This is necessary before @t{refresh}ing windows if a window that
+was in front of another window (which may be @t{stdscr}) is deleted.
+
+@noindent
+The subcommand @t{move} moves the cursor position in @var{targetwin} to
+new coordinates @var{new_y} and @var{new_x}. Note that the
+subcommand @t{string} (but not the subcommand @t{char}) advances the
+cursor position over the characters added.
+
+@noindent
+The subcommand @t{clear} erases the contents of @var{targetwin}. One
+(and no more than one) of three options may be specified. With the
+option @t{redraw}, in addition the next @t{refresh} of @var{targetwin}
+will cause the screen to be cleared and repainted. With the option
+@t{eol}, @var{targetwin} is only cleared to the end of the current cursor
+line. With the option
+@t{bot}, @var{targetwin} is cleared to the end of the window, i.e
+everything to the right and below the cursor is cleared.
+
+@noindent
+The subcommand @t{position} writes various positions associated with
+@var{targetwin} into the array named @var{array}.
+These are, in order:
+@table @asis
+@item -
+The y and x coordinates of the cursor relative to the top left
+of @var{targetwin}
+@item -
+The y and x coordinates of the top left of @var{targetwin} on the
+screen
+@item -
+The size of @var{targetwin} in y and x dimensions.
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+Outputting characters and strings are achieved by @t{char} and @t{string}
+respectively.
+
+@noindent
+To draw a border around window @var{targetwin}, use @t{border}. Note
+that the border is not subsequently handled specially: in other words,
+the border is simply a set of characters output at the edge of the
+window. Hence it can be overwritten, can scroll off the window, etc.
+
+@noindent
+The subcommand @t{attr} will set @var{targetwin}'s attributes or
+foreground/background color pair for any successive character output.
+Each @var{attribute} given on the line may be prepended by a @t{+} to set
+or a @t{-} to unset that attribute; @t{+} is assumed if absent. The
+attributes supported are @t{blink}, @t{bold}, @t{dim}, @t{reverse},
+@t{standout}, and @t{underline}.
+
+@noindent
+Each @var{fg_col}@t{/}@var{bg_col} attribute (to be read as
+`@var{fg_col} on @var{bg_col}') sets the foreground and background color
+for character output. The color @t{default} is sometimes available
+(in particular if the library is ncurses), specifying the foreground
+or background color with which the terminal started. The color pair
+@t{default/default} is always available. To use more than the 8 named
+colors (red, green, etc.) construct the @var{fg_col}@t{/}@var{bg_col}
+pairs where @var{fg_col} and @var{bg_col} are decimal integers, e.g
+@t{128/200}. The maximum color value is 254 if the terminal supports
+256 colors.
+
+@noindent
+@t{bg} overrides the color and other attributes of all characters in the
+window. Its usual use is to set the background initially, but it will
+overwrite the attributes of any characters at the time when it is called.
+In addition to the arguments allowed with @t{attr}, an argument @t{@@}@var{char}
+specifies a character to be shown in otherwise blank areas of the window.
+Owing to limitations of curses this cannot be a multibyte character
+(use of ASCII characters only is recommended). As the specified set
+of attributes override the existing background, turning attributes
+off in the arguments is not useful, though this does not cause an error.
+
+@noindent
+The subcommand @t{scroll} can be used with @t{on} or @t{off} to enabled
+or disable scrolling of a window when the cursor would otherwise move
+below the window due to typing or output. It can also be used with a
+positive or negative integer to scroll the window up or down the given
+number of lines without changing the current cursor position (which
+therefore appears to move in the opposite direction relative to the
+window). In the second case, if scrolling is @t{off} it is temporarily
+turned @t{on} to allow the window to be scrolled.
+
+@noindent
+The subcommand @t{input} reads a single character from the window
+without echoing it back. If @var{param} is supplied the character is
+assigned to the parameter @var{param}, else it is assigned to the
+parameter @t{REPLY}.
+
+@noindent
+If both @var{param} and @var{kparam} are supplied, the key is read in
+`keypad' mode. In this mode special keys such as function keys and
+arrow keys return the name of the key in the parameter @var{kparam}. The
+key names are the macros defined in the @t{curses.h} or @t{ncurses.h}
+with the prefix `@t{KEY_}' removed; see also the description of the
+parameter @t{zcurses_keycodes} below. Other keys cause a value to be
+set in @var{param} as before. On a successful return only one of
+@var{param} or @var{kparam} contains a non-empty string; the other is set
+to an empty string.
+
+@noindent
+If @var{mparam} is also supplied, @t{input} attempts to handle mouse
+input. This is only available with the ncurses library; mouse handling
+can be detected by checking for the exit status of `@t{zcurses mouse}' with
+no arguments. If a mouse
+button is clicked (or double- or triple-clicked, or pressed or released with
+a configurable delay from being clicked) then @t{kparam} is set to the string
+@t{MOUSE}, and @var{mparam} is set to an array consisting of the
+following elements:
+@table @asis
+@item -
+An identifier to discriminate different input devices; this
+is only rarely useful.
+@item -
+The x, y and z coordinates of the mouse click relative to
+the full screen, as three elements in that order (i.e. the y coordinate
+is, unusually, after the x coordinate). The z coordinate is only
+available for a few unusual input devices and is otherwise set to zero.
+@item -
+Any events that occurred as separate items; usually
+there will be just one. An event consists of @t{PRESSED}, @t{RELEASED},
+@t{CLICKED}, @t{DOUBLE_CLICKED} or @t{TRIPLE_CLICKED} followed
+immediately (in the same element) by the number of the button.
+@item -
+If the shift key was pressed, the string @t{SHIFT}.
+@item -
+If the control key was pressed, the string @t{CTRL}.
+@item -
+If the alt key was pressed, the string @t{ALT}.
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+Not all mouse events may be passed through to the terminal window;
+most terminal emulators handle some mouse events themselves. Note
+that the ncurses manual implies that using input both with and
+without mouse handling may cause the mouse cursor to appear and
+disappear.
+
+@noindent
+The subcommand @t{mouse} can be used to configure the use of the mouse.
+There is no window argument; mouse options are global.
+`@t{zcurses mouse}' with no arguments returns status 0 if mouse handling
+is possible, else status 1. Otherwise, the possible arguments (which
+may be combined on the same command line) are as follows.
+@t{delay} @var{num} sets the maximum delay in milliseconds between press and
+release events to be considered as a click; the value 0 disables click
+resolution, and the default is one sixth of a second. @t{motion} proceeded
+by an optional `@t{+}' (the default) or @t{-} turns on or off
+reporting of mouse motion in addition to clicks, presses and releases,
+which are always reported. However, it appears reports for mouse
+motion are not currently implemented.
+
+@noindent
+The subcommand @t{timeout} specifies a timeout value for input from
+@var{targetwin}. If @var{intval} is negative, `@t{zcurses input}' waits
+indefinitely for a character to be typed; this is the default. If
+@var{intval} is zero, `@t{zcurses input}' returns immediately; if there
+is typeahead it is returned, else no input is done and status 1 is
+returned. If @var{intval} is positive, `@t{zcurses input}' waits
+@var{intval} milliseconds for input and if there is none at the end of
+that period returns status 1.
+
+@noindent
+The subcommand @t{querychar} queries the character at the current cursor
+position. The return values are stored in the array named @var{param} if
+supplied, else in the array @t{reply}. The first value is the character
+(which may be a multibyte character if the system supports them); the
+second is the color pair in the usual @var{fg_col}@t{/}@var{bg_col}
+notation, or @t{0} if color is not supported. Any attributes other than
+color that apply to the character, as set with the subcommand @t{attr},
+appear as additional elements.
+
+@noindent
+The subcommand @t{resize} resizes @t{stdscr} and all windows to given
+dimensions (windows that stick out from the new dimensions are resized
+down). The underlying curses extension (@t{resize_term call}) can be
+unavailable. To verify, zeroes can be used for @var{height} and
+@var{width}. If the result of the subcommand is @t{0}, resize_term is
+available (@t{2} otherwise). Tests show that resizing can be normally
+accomplished by calling @t{zcurses end} and @t{zcurses refresh}. The
+@t{resize} subcommand is provided for versatility. Multiple system
+configurations have been checked and @t{zcurses end} and @t{zcurses
+refresh} are still needed for correct terminal state after resize. To
+invoke them with @t{resize}, use @var{endwin} argument. Using
+@var{nosave} argument will cause new terminal state to not be saved
+internally by @t{zcurses}. This is also provided for versatility and
+should normally be not needed.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Parameters
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@vindex ZCURSES_COLORS
+@item @t{ZCURSES_COLORS}
+Readonly integer. The maximum number of colors the terminal
+supports. This value is initialised by the curses library and is not
+available until the first time @t{zcurses init} is run.
+
+@vindex ZCURSES_COLOR_PAIRS
+@item @t{ZCURSES_COLOR_PAIRS}
+Readonly integer. The maximum number of color pairs
+@var{fg_col}@t{/}@var{bg_col} that may be defined in `@t{zcurses attr}'
+commands; note this limit applies to all color pairs that have been
+used whether or not they are currently active. This value is initialised
+by the curses library and is not available until the first time @t{zcurses
+init} is run.
+
+@vindex zcurses_attrs
+@item @t{zcurses_attrs}
+Readonly array. The attributes supported by @t{zsh/curses}; available
+as soon as the module is loaded.
+
+@vindex zcurses_colors
+@item @t{zcurses_colors}
+Readonly array. The colors supported by @t{zsh/curses}; available
+as soon as the module is loaded.
+
+@vindex zcurses_keycodes
+@item @t{zcurses_keycodes}
+Readonly array. The values that may be returned in the second
+parameter supplied to `@t{zcurses input}' in the order in which they
+are defined internally by curses. Not all function keys
+are listed, only @t{F0}; curses reserves space for @t{F0} up to @t{F63}.
+
+@vindex zcurses_windows
+@item @t{zcurses_windows}
+Readonly array. The current list of windows, i.e. all windows that
+have been created with `@t{zcurses addwin}' and not removed with
+`@t{zcurses delwin}'.
+
+@end table
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@node The zsh/datetime Module, The zsh/db/gdbm Module, The zsh/curses Module, Zsh Modules
+
+@section The zsh/datetime Module
+@noindent
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/mod_datetime.yo
+
+The @t{zsh/datetime} module makes available one builtin command:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex strftime
+@cindex date string, printing
+@item @t{strftime} [ @t{-s} @var{scalar} ] @var{format} [ @var{epochtime} [ @var{nanoseconds} ] ]
+@itemx @t{strftime} @t{-r} [ @t{-q} ] [ @t{-s} @var{scalar} ] @var{format} @var{timestring}
+Output the date in the @var{format} specified. With no @var{epochtime}, the
+current system date/time is used; optionally, @var{epochtime} may be used to
+specify the number of seconds since the epoch, and @var{nanoseconds} may
+additionally be used to specify the number of nanoseconds past the second
+(otherwise that number is assumed to be 0).
+See man page strftime(3) for details. The zsh extensions described in
+@ref{Prompt Expansion} are also available.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{-q}
+Run quietly; suppress printing of all error messages described below.
+Errors for invalid @var{epochtime} values are always printed.
+
+@item @t{-r}
+With the option @t{-r} (reverse), use @var{format} to parse the input
+string @var{timestring} and output the number of seconds since the epoch at
+which the time occurred. The parsing is implemented by the system
+function @t{strptime}; see man page strptime(3). This means that zsh
+format extensions are not available, but for reverse lookup they are not
+required.
+
+@noindent
+In most implementations of @t{strftime} any timezone in the
+@var{timestring} is ignored and the local timezone declared by the @t{TZ}
+environment variable is used; other parameters are set to zero if not
+present.
+
+@noindent
+If @var{timestring} does not match @var{format} the command returns status 1
+and prints an error message. If @var{timestring} matches @var{format} but
+not all characters in @var{timestring} were used, the conversion succeeds
+but also prints an error message.
+
+@noindent
+If either of the system functions @t{strptime} or @t{mktime} is not
+available, status 2 is returned and an error message is printed.
+
+@item @t{-s} @var{scalar}
+Assign the date string (or epoch time in seconds if @t{-r} is given) to
+@var{scalar} instead of printing it.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+Note that depending on the system's declared integral time type,
+@t{strftime} may produce incorrect results for epoch times greater than
+2147483647 which corresponds to 2038-01-19 03:14:07 +0000.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+The @t{zsh/datetime} module makes available several parameters;
+all are readonly:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@vindex EPOCHREALTIME
+@item @t{EPOCHREALTIME}
+A floating point value representing the number of seconds since
+the epoch. The notional accuracy is to nanoseconds if the
+@t{clock_gettime} call is available and to microseconds otherwise,
+but in practice the range of double precision floating point and
+shell scheduling latencies may be significant effects.
+
+@vindex EPOCHSECONDS
+@item @t{EPOCHSECONDS}
+An integer value representing the number of seconds since the
+epoch.
+
+@vindex epochtime
+@item @t{epochtime}
+An array value containing the number of seconds since the epoch
+in the first element and the remainder of the time since the epoch
+in nanoseconds in the second element. To ensure the two elements
+are consistent the array should be copied or otherwise referenced
+as a single substitution before the values are used. The following
+idiom may be used:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+for secs nsecs in $epochtime; do
+ ...
+done
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+
+@end table
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@node The zsh/db/gdbm Module, The zsh/deltochar Module, The zsh/datetime Module, Zsh Modules
+
+@section The zsh/db/gdbm Module
+@noindent
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/mod_db_gdbm.yo
+
+The @t{zsh/db/gdbm} module is used to create "tied" associative arrays
+that interface to database files. If the GDBM interface is not available,
+the builtins defined by this module will report an error. This module is
+also intended as a prototype for creating additional database interfaces,
+so the @t{ztie} builtin may move to a more generic module in the future.
+
+@noindent
+The builtins in this module are:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex ztie
+@cindex database tied array, creating
+@item @t{ztie -d db/gdbm -f} @var{filename} [ @t{-r} ] @var{arrayname}
+Open the GDBM database identified by @var{filename} and, if successful,
+create the associative array @var{arrayname} linked to the file. To create
+a local tied array, the parameter must first be declared, so commands
+similar to the following would be executed inside a function scope:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+local -A sampledb
+ztie -d db/gdbm -f sample.gdbm sampledb
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The @t{-r} option opens the database file for reading only, creating a
+parameter with the readonly attribute. Without this option, using
+`@t{ztie}' on a file for which the user does not have write permission is
+an error. If writable, the database is opened synchronously so fields
+changed in @var{arrayname} are immediately written to @var{filename}.
+
+@noindent
+Changes to the file modes @var{filename} after it has been opened do not
+alter the state of @var{arrayname}, but `@t{typeset -r} @var{arrayname}'
+works as expected.
+
+@findex zuntie
+@cindex database tied array, destroying
+@item @t{zuntie} [ @t{-u} ] @var{arrayname} ...
+Close the GDBM database associated with each @var{arrayname} and then
+unset the parameter. The @t{-u} option forces an unset of parameters
+made readonly with `@t{ztie -r}'.
+
+@noindent
+This happens automatically if the parameter is explicitly unset or its
+local scope (function) ends. Note that a readonly parameter may not be
+explicitly unset, so the only way to unset a global parameter created with
+`@t{ztie -r}' is to use `@t{zuntie -u}'.
+
+@findex zgdbmpath
+@cindex database file path, reading
+@item @t{zgdbmpath} @var{parametername}
+Put path to database file assigned to @var{parametername} into @t{REPLY}
+scalar.
+
+@findex zgdbm_tied
+@cindex database tied arrays, enumerating
+@item @t{zgdbm_tied}
+Array holding names of all tied parameters.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+The fields of an associative array tied to GDBM are neither cached nor
+otherwise stored in memory, they are read from or written to the database
+on each reference. Thus, for example, the values in a readonly array may
+be changed by a second writer of the same database file.
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@node The zsh/deltochar Module, The zsh/example Module, The zsh/db/gdbm Module, Zsh Modules
+
+@section The zsh/deltochar Module
+@noindent
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/mod_deltochar.yo
+
+The @t{zsh/deltochar} module makes available two ZLE functions:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@tindex delete-to-char
+@item @t{delete-to-char}
+Read a character from the keyboard, and
+delete from the cursor position up to and including the next
+(or, with repeat count @var{n}, the @var{n}th) instance of that character.
+Negative repeat counts mean delete backwards.
+
+@tindex zap-to-char
+@item @t{zap-to-char}
+This behaves like @t{delete-to-char}, except that the final occurrence of
+the character itself is not deleted.
+
+@end table
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@node The zsh/example Module, The zsh/files Module, The zsh/deltochar Module, Zsh Modules
+
+@section The zsh/example Module
+@noindent
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/mod_example.yo
+
+The @t{zsh/example} module makes available one builtin command:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex example
+@cindex modules, example
+@cindex modules, writing
+@cindex writing modules
+@item @t{example} [ @t{-flags} ] [ @var{args} ... ]
+Displays the flags and arguments it is invoked with.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+The purpose of the module is to serve as an example of how to write a
+module.
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@node The zsh/files Module, The zsh/langinfo Module, The zsh/example Module, Zsh Modules
+
+@section The zsh/files Module
+@noindent
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/mod_files.yo
+
+@cindex files, manipulating
+The @t{zsh/files} module makes available some common commands for file
+manipulation as builtins; these commands are probably not needed for
+many normal situations but can be useful in emergency recovery
+situations with constrained resources. The commands do not implement
+all features now required by relevant standards committees.
+
+@noindent
+For all commands, a variant beginning @t{zf_} is also available and loaded
+automatically. Using the features capability of zmodload will let you load
+only those names you want. Note that it's possible to load only the
+builtins with zsh-specific names using the following command:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zmodload -m -F zsh/files b:zf_\*
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The commands loaded by default are:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex chgrp
+@item @t{chgrp} [ @t{-hRs} ] @var{group} @var{filename} ...
+Changes group of files specified. This is equivalent to @t{chown} with
+a @var{user-spec} argument of `@t{:}@var{group}'.
+
+@findex chmod
+@item @t{chmod} [ @t{-Rs} ] @var{mode} @var{filename} ...
+Changes mode of files specified.
+
+@noindent
+The specified @var{mode} must be in octal.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{-R} option causes @t{chmod} to recursively descend into directories,
+changing the mode of all files in the directory after
+changing the mode of the directory itself.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{-s} option is a zsh extension to @t{chmod} functionality. It enables
+paranoid behaviour, intended to avoid security problems involving
+a @t{chmod} being tricked into affecting files other than the ones
+intended. It will refuse to follow symbolic links, so that (for example)
+@value{dsbq}@t{chmod 600 /tmp/foo/passwd}@value{dsq} can't accidentally chmod @t{/etc/passwd}
+if @t{/tmp/foo} happens to be a link to @t{/etc}. It will also check
+where it is after leaving directories, so that a recursive chmod of
+a deep directory tree can't end up recursively chmoding @t{/usr} as
+a result of directories being moved up the tree.
+
+@findex chown
+@item @t{chown} [ @t{-hRs} ] @var{user-spec} @var{filename} ...
+Changes ownership and group of files specified.
+
+@noindent
+The @var{user-spec} can be in four forms:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @var{user}
+change owner to @var{user}; do not change group
+@item @var{user}@t{::}
+change owner to @var{user}; do not change group
+@item @var{user}@t{:}
+change owner to @var{user}; change group to @var{user}'s primary group
+@item @var{user}@t{:}@var{group}
+change owner to @var{user}; change group to @var{group}
+@item @t{:}@var{group}
+do not change owner; change group to @var{group}
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+In each case, the `@t{:}' may instead be a `@t{.}'. The rule is that
+if there is a `@t{:}' then the separator is `@t{:}', otherwise
+if there is a `@t{.}' then the separator is `@t{.}', otherwise
+there is no separator.
+
+@noindent
+Each of @var{user} and @var{group} may be either a username (or group name, as
+appropriate) or a decimal user ID (group ID). Interpretation as a name
+takes precedence, if there is an all-numeric username (or group name).
+
+@noindent
+If the target is a symbolic link, the @t{-h} option causes @t{chown} to set
+the ownership of the link instead of its target.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{-R} option causes @t{chown} to recursively descend into directories,
+changing the ownership of all files in the directory after
+changing the ownership of the directory itself.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{-s} option is a zsh extension to @t{chown} functionality. It enables
+paranoid behaviour, intended to avoid security problems involving
+a @t{chown} being tricked into affecting files other than the ones
+intended. It will refuse to follow symbolic links, so that (for example)
+@value{dsbq}@t{chown luser /tmp/foo/passwd}@value{dsq} can't accidentally chown @t{/etc/passwd}
+if @t{/tmp/foo} happens to be a link to @t{/etc}. It will also check
+where it is after leaving directories, so that a recursive chown of
+a deep directory tree can't end up recursively chowning @t{/usr} as
+a result of directories being moved up the tree.
+
+@findex ln
+@item @t{ln} [ @t{-dfhins} ] @var{filename} @var{dest}
+@itemx @t{ln} [ @t{-dfhins} ] @var{filename} ... @var{dir}
+Creates hard (or, with @t{-s}, symbolic) links. In the first form, the
+specified @var{dest}ination is created, as a link to the specified
+@var{filename}. In the second form, each of the @var{filename}s is
+taken in turn, and linked to a pathname in the specified @var{dir}ectory
+that has the same last pathname component.
+
+@noindent
+Normally, @t{ln} will not attempt to create hard links to
+directories. This check can be overridden using the @t{-d} option.
+Typically only the super-user can actually succeed in creating
+hard links to directories.
+This does not apply to symbolic links in any case.
+
+@noindent
+By default, existing files cannot be replaced by links.
+The @t{-i} option causes the user to be queried about replacing
+existing files. The @t{-f} option causes existing files to be
+silently deleted, without querying. @t{-f} takes precedence.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{-h} and @t{-n} options are identical and both exist for
+compatibility; either one indicates that if the target is a symlink
+then it should not be dereferenced.
+Typically this is used in combination with @t{-sf} so that if an
+existing link points to a directory then it will be removed,
+instead of followed.
+If this option is used with multiple filenames and the target
+is a symbolic link pointing to a directory then the result is
+an error.
+
+@findex mkdir
+@item @t{mkdir} [ @t{-p} ] [ @t{-m} @var{mode} ] @var{dir} ...
+Creates directories. With the @t{-p} option, non-existing parent
+directories are first created if necessary, and there will be
+no complaint if the directory already exists.
+The @t{-m} option can be used to specify (in octal) a set of file permissions
+for the created directories, otherwise mode 777 modified by the current
+@t{umask} (see man page umask(2)) is used.
+
+@findex mv
+@item @t{mv} [ @t{-fi} ] @var{filename} @var{dest}
+@itemx @t{mv} [ @t{-fi} ] @var{filename} ... @var{dir}
+Moves files. In the first form, the specified @var{filename} is moved
+to the specified @var{dest}ination. In the second form, each of the
+@var{filename}s is
+taken in turn, and moved to a pathname in the specified @var{dir}ectory
+that has the same last pathname component.
+
+@noindent
+By default, the user will be queried before replacing any file
+that the user cannot write to, but writable files will be silently
+removed.
+The @t{-i} option causes the user to be queried about replacing
+any existing files. The @t{-f} option causes any existing files to be
+silently deleted, without querying. @t{-f} takes precedence.
+
+@noindent
+Note that this @t{mv} will not move files across devices.
+Historical versions of @t{mv}, when actual renaming is impossible,
+fall back on copying and removing files; if this behaviour is desired,
+use @t{cp} and @t{rm} manually. This may change in a future version.
+
+@findex rm
+@item @t{rm} [ @t{-dfiRrs} ] @var{filename} ...
+Removes files and directories specified.
+
+@noindent
+Normally, @t{rm} will not remove directories (except with the @t{-R} or @t{-r}
+options). The @t{-d} option causes @t{rm} to try removing directories
+with @t{unlink} (see man page unlink(2)), the same method used for files.
+Typically only the super-user can actually succeed in unlinking
+directories in this way.
+@t{-d} takes precedence over @t{-R} and @t{-r}.
+
+@noindent
+By default, the user will be queried before removing any file
+that the user cannot write to, but writable files will be silently
+removed.
+The @t{-i} option causes the user to be queried about removing
+any files. The @t{-f} option causes files to be
+silently deleted, without querying, and suppresses all error indications.
+@t{-f} takes precedence.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{-R} and @t{-r} options cause @t{rm} to recursively descend into
+directories, deleting all files in the directory before removing the directory
+with the @t{rmdir} system call (see man page rmdir(2)).
+
+@noindent
+The @t{-s} option is a zsh extension to @t{rm} functionality. It enables
+paranoid behaviour, intended to avoid common security problems involving
+a root-run @t{rm} being tricked into removing files other than the ones
+intended. It will refuse to follow symbolic links, so that (for example)
+@value{dsbq}@t{rm /tmp/foo/passwd}@value{dsq} can't accidentally remove @t{/etc/passwd}
+if @t{/tmp/foo} happens to be a link to @t{/etc}. It will also check
+where it is after leaving directories, so that a recursive removal of
+a deep directory tree can't end up recursively removing @t{/usr} as
+a result of directories being moved up the tree.
+
+@findex rmdir
+@item @t{rmdir} @var{dir} ...
+Removes empty directories specified.
+
+@findex sync
+@item @t{sync}
+Calls the system call of the same name (see man page sync(2)), which
+flushes dirty buffers to disk. It might return before the I/O has
+actually been completed.
+
+@end table
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@node The zsh/langinfo Module, The zsh/mapfile Module, The zsh/files Module, Zsh Modules
+
+@section The zsh/langinfo Module
+@noindent
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/mod_langinfo.yo
+
+The @t{zsh/langinfo} module makes available one parameter:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@vindex langinfo
+@item @t{langinfo}
+An associative array that maps langinfo elements to
+their values.
+
+@noindent
+Your implementation may support a number of the following keys:
+
+@noindent
+@t{CODESET},
+@t{D_T_FMT},
+@t{D_FMT},
+@t{T_FMT},
+@t{RADIXCHAR},
+@t{THOUSEP},
+@t{YESEXPR},
+@t{NOEXPR},
+@t{CRNCYSTR},
+@t{ABDAY_@{1..7@}},
+@t{DAY_@{1..7@}},
+@t{ABMON_@{1..12@}},
+@t{MON_@{1..12@}},
+@t{T_FMT_AMPM},
+@t{AM_STR},
+@t{PM_STR},
+@t{ERA},
+@t{ERA_D_FMT},
+@t{ERA_D_T_FMT},
+@t{ERA_T_FMT},
+@t{ALT_DIGITS}
+
+@noindent
+
+@end table
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@node The zsh/mapfile Module, The zsh/mathfunc Module, The zsh/langinfo Module, Zsh Modules
+
+@section The zsh/mapfile Module
+@noindent
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/mod_mapfile.yo
+
+@cindex parameter, file access via
+The @t{zsh/mapfile} module provides one special associative array parameter of
+the same name.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@vindex mapfile
+@item @t{mapfile}
+This associative array takes as keys the names of files; the resulting
+value is the content of the file. The value is treated identically to any
+other text coming from a parameter. The value may also be assigned to, in
+which case the file in question is written (whether or not it originally
+existed); or an element may be unset, which will delete the file in
+question. For example, `@t{vared mapfile[myfile]}' works as expected,
+editing the file `@t{myfile}'.
+
+@noindent
+When the array is accessed as a whole, the keys are the names of files in
+the current directory, and the values are empty (to save a huge overhead in
+memory). Thus @t{$@{(k)mapfile@}} has the same effect as the glob operator
+@t{*(D)}, since files beginning with a dot are not special. Care must be
+taken with expressions such as @t{rm $@{(k)mapfile@}}, which will delete
+every file in the current directory without the usual `@t{rm *}' test.
+
+@noindent
+The parameter @t{mapfile} may be made read-only; in that case, files
+referenced may not be written or deleted.
+
+@noindent
+A file may conveniently be read into an array as one line per element
+with the form
+`@var{array}@t{=("$@{(f@@)mapfile[}@var{filename}@t{]@}")}'.
+The double quotes and the `@t{@@}' are necessary to prevent empty lines
+from being removed. Note that if the file ends with a newline,
+the shell will split on the final newline, generating an additional
+empty field; this can be suppressed by using
+`@var{array}@t{=("$@{(f@@)$@{mapfile[}@var{filename}@t{]%$'\n'@}@}")}'.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Limitations
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+Although reading and writing of the file in question is efficiently
+handled, zsh's internal memory management may be arbitrarily baroque;
+however, @t{mapfile} is usually very much more efficient than
+anything involving a loop. Note in particular that
+the whole contents of the file will always reside physically in memory when
+accessed (possibly multiple times, due to standard parameter substitution
+operations). In particular, this means handling of sufficiently long files
+(greater than the machine's swap space, or than the range of the pointer
+type) will be incorrect.
+
+@noindent
+No errors are printed or flagged for non-existent, unreadable, or
+unwritable files, as the parameter mechanism is too low in the shell
+execution hierarchy to make this convenient.
+
+@noindent
+It is unfortunate that the mechanism for loading modules does not yet allow
+the user to specify the name of the shell parameter to be given the special
+behaviour.
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@node The zsh/mathfunc Module, The zsh/nearcolor Module, The zsh/mapfile Module, Zsh Modules
+
+@section The zsh/mathfunc Module
+@noindent
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/mod_mathfunc.yo
+
+@cindex functions, mathematical
+@cindex mathematical functions
+The @t{zsh/mathfunc} module provides standard
+mathematical functions for use when
+evaluating mathematical formulae. The syntax agrees with normal C and
+FORTRAN conventions, for example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+(( f = sin(0.3) ))
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+assigns the sine of 0.3 to the parameter f.
+
+@noindent
+Most functions take floating point arguments and return a floating point
+value. However, any necessary conversions from or to integer type will be
+performed automatically by the shell. Apart from @t{atan} with a second
+argument and the @t{abs}, @t{int} and @t{float} functions, all functions
+behave as noted in the manual page for the corresponding C function,
+except that any arguments out of range for the function in question will be
+detected by the shell and an error reported.
+
+@noindent
+The following functions take a single floating point argument: @t{acos},
+@t{acosh}, @t{asin}, @t{asinh}, @t{atan}, @t{atanh}, @t{cbrt}, @t{ceil},
+@t{cos}, @t{cosh}, @t{erf}, @t{erfc}, @t{exp}, @t{expm1}, @t{fabs},
+@t{floor}, @t{gamma}, @t{j0}, @t{j1}, @t{lgamma}, @t{log}, @t{log10},
+@t{log1p}, @t{log2}, @t{logb}, @t{sin}, @t{sinh}, @t{sqrt}, @t{tan},
+@t{tanh}, @t{y0}, @t{y1}. The @t{atan} function can optionally take a
+second argument, in which case it behaves like the C function @t{atan2}.
+The @t{ilogb} function takes a single floating point argument, but
+returns an integer.
+
+@noindent
+The function @t{signgam} takes no arguments, and returns an integer, which
+is the C variable of the same name, as described in man page gamma(3). Note
+that it is therefore only useful immediately after a call to @t{gamma} or
+@t{lgamma}. Note also that `@t{signgam()}' and `@t{signgam}' are
+distinct expressions.
+
+@noindent
+The functions @t{min}, @t{max}, and @t{sum} are defined not in this module
+but in the @t{zmathfunc} autoloadable function, described in
+@ref{Mathematical Functions}.
+
+@noindent
+The following functions take two floating point arguments: @t{copysign},
+@t{fmod}, @t{hypot}, @t{nextafter}.
+
+@noindent
+The following take an integer first argument and a floating point second
+argument: @t{jn}, @t{yn}.
+
+@noindent
+The following take a floating point first argument and an integer second
+argument: @t{ldexp}, @t{scalb}.
+
+@noindent
+The function @t{abs} does not convert the type of its single argument; it
+returns the absolute value of either a floating point number or an
+integer. The functions @t{float} and @t{int} convert their arguments into
+a floating point or integer value (by truncation) respectively.
+
+@noindent
+Note that the C @t{pow} function is available in ordinary math evaluation
+as the `@t{**}' operator and is not provided here.
+
+@noindent
+The function @t{rand48} is available if your system's mathematical library
+has the function @t{erand48(3)}. It returns a pseudo-random floating point
+number between 0 and 1. It takes a single string optional argument.
+
+@noindent
+If the argument is not present, the random number seed is initialised by
+three calls to the @t{rand(3)} function --- this produces the
+same random
+numbers as the next three values of @t{$RANDOM}.
+
+@noindent
+If the argument is present, it gives the name of a scalar parameter where
+the current random number seed will be stored. On the first call, the
+value must contain at least twelve hexadecimal digits (the remainder of the
+string is ignored), or the seed will be initialised in the same manner as
+for a call to @t{rand48} with no argument. Subsequent calls to
+@t{rand48}(@var{param}) will then maintain the seed in the
+parameter @var{param} as a string of twelve hexadecimal digits, with no base
+signifier. The random number sequences for different parameters are
+completely independent, and are also independent from that used by calls to
+@t{rand48} with no argument.
+
+@noindent
+For example, consider
+
+@noindent
+@example
+print $(( rand48(seed) ))
+print $(( rand48() ))
+print $(( rand48(seed) ))
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Assuming @t{$seed} does not exist, it will be initialised by the first
+call. In the second call, the default seed is initialised; note, however,
+that because of the properties of @t{rand()} there is a
+correlation between
+the seeds used for the two initialisations, so for more secure uses, you
+should generate your own 12-byte seed. The third call returns to the same
+sequence of random numbers used in the first call, unaffected by the
+intervening @t{rand48()}.
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@node The zsh/nearcolor Module, The zsh/newuser Module, The zsh/mathfunc Module, Zsh Modules
+
+@section The zsh/nearcolor Module
+@noindent
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/mod_nearcolor.yo
+
+The @t{zsh/nearcolor} module replaces colours specified as hex triplets
+with the nearest colour in the 88 or 256 colour palettes that are widely
+used by terminal emulators. By default, 24-bit true colour escape codes
+are generated when colours are specified using hex triplets. These are
+not supported by all terminals. The purpose of this module is to make
+it easier to define colour preferences in a form that can work across a
+range of terminal emulators.
+
+@noindent
+Aside from the default colour, the ANSI standard for terminal escape
+codes provides for eight colours. The bright attribute brings this to
+sixteen. These basic colours are commonly used in terminal applications
+due to being widely supported. Expanded 88 and 256 colour palettes are
+also common and, while the first sixteen colours vary somewhat between
+terminals and configurations, these add a generally consistent and
+predictable set of colours.
+
+@noindent
+In order to use the @t{zsh/nearcolor} module, it only needs to be
+loaded. Thereafter, whenever a colour is specified using a hex triplet,
+it will be compared against each of the available colours and the
+closest will be selected. The first sixteen colours are never matched in
+this process due to being unpredictable.
+
+@noindent
+It isn't possible to reliably detect support for true colour in the
+terminal emulator. It is therefore recommended to be selective in
+loading the @t{zsh/nearcolor} module. For example, the following
+checks the @t{COLORTERM} environment variable:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+[[ $COLORTERM = *(24bit|truecolor)* ]] || zmodload zsh/nearcolor
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Note that some terminals accept the true color escape codes but map
+them internally to a more limited palette in a similar manner to the
+@t{zsh/nearcolor} module.
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@node The zsh/newuser Module, The zsh/parameter Module, The zsh/nearcolor Module, Zsh Modules
+
+@section The zsh/newuser Module
+@noindent
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/mod_newuser.yo
+
+The @t{zsh/newuser} module is loaded at boot if it is
+available, the @t{RCS} option is set, and the @t{PRIVILEGED} option is not
+set (all three are true by default). This takes
+place immediately after commands in the global @t{zshenv} file (typically
+@t{/etc/zshenv}), if any, have been executed. If the module is not
+available it is silently ignored by the shell; the module may safely be
+removed from @t{$MODULE_PATH} by the administrator if it is not required.
+
+@noindent
+On loading, the module tests if any of the start-up files @t{.zshenv},
+@t{.zprofile}, @t{.zshrc} or @t{.zlogin} exist in the directory given by
+the environment variable @t{ZDOTDIR}, or the user's home directory if that
+is not set. The test is not performed and the module halts processing if
+the shell was in an emulation mode (i.e. had been invoked as some other
+shell than zsh).
+
+@noindent
+If none of the start-up files were found, the module then looks for the
+file @t{newuser} first in a sitewide directory, usually the parent
+directory of the @t{site-functions} directory, and if that is not found the
+module searches in a version-specific directory, usually the parent of the
+@t{functions} directory containing version-specific functions. (These
+directories can be configured when zsh is built using the
+@t{--enable-site-scriptdir=}@var{dir} and @t{--enable-scriptdir=}@var{dir}
+flags to @t{configure}, respectively; the defaults are
+@var{prefix}@t{/share/zsh} and @var{prefix}@t{/share/zsh/$ZSH_VERSION} where
+the default @var{prefix} is @t{/usr/local}.)
+
+@noindent
+If the file @t{newuser} is found, it is then sourced in the same manner as
+a start-up file. The file is expected to contain code to install start-up
+files for the user, however any valid shell code will be executed.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{zsh/newuser} module is then unconditionally unloaded.
+
+@noindent
+Note that it is possible to achieve exactly the same effect as the
+@t{zsh/newuser} module by adding code to @t{/etc/zshenv}. The module
+exists simply to allow the shell to make arrangements for new users without
+the need for intervention by package maintainers and system administrators.
+
+@noindent
+The script supplied with the module invokes the shell function
+@t{zsh-newuser-install}. This may be invoked directly by the user
+even if the @t{zsh/newuser} module is disabled. Note, however, that
+if the module is not installed the function will not be installed either.
+The function is documented in
+@ref{User Configuration Functions}.
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@node The zsh/parameter Module, The zsh/pcre Module, The zsh/newuser Module, Zsh Modules
+
+@section The zsh/parameter Module
+@noindent
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/mod_parameter.yo
+
+@cindex parameters, special
+The @t{zsh/parameter} module gives access to some of the internal hash
+tables used by the shell by defining some special parameters.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@vindex options
+@item @t{options}
+The keys for this associative array are the names of the options that
+can be set and unset using the @t{setopt} and @t{unsetopt}
+builtins. The value of each key is either the string @t{on} if the
+option is currently set, or the string @t{off} if the option is unset.
+Setting a key to one of these strings is like setting or unsetting
+the option, respectively. Unsetting a key in this array is like
+setting it to the value @t{off}.
+
+@vindex commands
+@item @t{commands}
+This array gives access to the command hash table. The keys are the
+names of external commands, the values are the pathnames of the files
+that would be executed when the command would be invoked. Setting a
+key in this array defines a new entry in this table in the same way as
+with the @t{hash} builtin. Unsetting a key as in `@t{unset
+"commands[foo]"}' removes the entry for the given key from the command
+hash table.
+
+@vindex functions
+@item @t{functions}
+This associative array maps names of enabled functions to their
+definitions. Setting a key in it is like defining a function with the
+name given by the key and the body given by the value. Unsetting a key
+removes the definition for the function named by the key.
+
+@vindex dis_functions
+@item @t{dis_functions}
+Like @t{functions} but for disabled functions.
+
+@vindex functions_source
+@item @t{functions_source}
+This readonly associative array maps names of enabled functions to the
+name of the file containing the source of the function.
+
+@noindent
+For an autoloaded function that has already been loaded, or marked for
+autoload with an absolute path, or that has had its path resolved with
+`@t{functions -r}', this is the file found for autoloading, resolved
+to an absolute path.
+
+@noindent
+For a function defined within the body of a script or sourced file,
+this is the name of that file. In this case, this is the exact path
+originally used to that file, which may be a relative path.
+
+@noindent
+For any other function, including any defined at an interactive prompt or
+an autoload function whose path has not yet been resolved, this is
+the empty string. However, the hash element is reported as defined
+just so long as the function is present: the keys to this hash are
+the same as those to @t{$functions}.
+
+@vindex dis_functions_source
+@item @t{dis_functions_source}
+Like @t{functions_source} but for disabled functions.
+
+@vindex builtins
+@item @t{builtins}
+This associative array gives information about the builtin commands
+currently enabled. The keys are the names of the builtin commands and
+the values are either `@t{undefined}' for builtin commands that will
+automatically be loaded from a module if invoked or `@t{defined}' for
+builtin commands that are already loaded.
+
+@vindex dis_builtins
+@item @t{dis_builtins}
+Like @t{builtins} but for disabled builtin commands.
+
+@vindex reswords
+@item @t{reswords}
+This array contains the enabled reserved words.
+
+@vindex dis_reswords
+@item @t{dis_reswords}
+Like @t{reswords} but for disabled reserved words.
+
+@vindex patchars
+@item @t{patchars}
+This array contains the enabled pattern characters.
+
+@vindex dis_patchars
+@item @t{dis_patchars}
+Like @t{patchars} but for disabled pattern characters.
+
+@vindex aliases
+@item @t{aliases}
+This maps the names of the regular aliases currently enabled to their
+expansions.
+
+@vindex dis_aliases
+@item @t{dis_aliases}
+Like @t{aliases} but for disabled regular aliases.
+
+@vindex galiases
+@item @t{galiases}
+Like @t{aliases}, but for global aliases.
+
+@vindex dis_galiases
+@item @t{dis_galiases}
+Like @t{galiases} but for disabled global aliases.
+
+@vindex saliases
+@item @t{saliases}
+Like @t{raliases}, but for suffix aliases.
+
+@vindex dis_saliases
+@item @t{dis_saliases}
+Like @t{saliases} but for disabled suffix aliases.
+
+@vindex parameters
+@item @t{parameters}
+The keys in this associative array are the names of the parameters
+currently defined. The values are strings describing the type of the
+parameter, in the same format used by the @t{t} parameter flag, see
+@ref{Parameter Expansion}
+.
+Setting or unsetting keys in this array is not possible.
+
+@vindex modules
+@item @t{modules}
+An associative array giving information about modules. The keys are the names
+of the modules loaded, registered to be autoloaded, or aliased. The
+value says which state the named module is in and is one of the
+strings `@t{loaded}', `@t{autoloaded}', or `@t{alias:}@var{name}',
+where @var{name} is the name the module is aliased to.
+
+@noindent
+Setting or unsetting keys in this array is not possible.
+
+@vindex dirstack
+@item @t{dirstack}
+A normal array holding the elements of the directory stack. Note that
+the output of the @t{dirs} builtin command includes one more
+directory, the current working directory.
+
+@vindex history
+@item @t{history}
+This associative array maps history event numbers to the full history lines.
+Although it is presented as an associative array, the array of all values
+(@t{$@{history[@@]@}}) is guaranteed to be returned in order from most recent
+to oldest history event, that is, by decreasing history event number.
+
+@vindex historywords
+@item @t{historywords}
+A special array containing the words stored in the history. These also
+appear in most to least recent order.
+
+@vindex jobdirs
+@item @t{jobdirs}
+This associative array maps job numbers to the directories from which the
+job was started (which may not be the current directory of the job).
+
+@noindent
+The keys of the associative arrays are usually valid job numbers,
+and these are the values output with, for example, @t{$@{(k)jobdirs@}}.
+Non-numeric job references may be used when looking up a value;
+for example, @t{$@{jobdirs[%+]@}} refers to the current job.
+
+@vindex jobtexts
+@item @t{jobtexts}
+This associative array maps job numbers to the texts of the command lines
+that were used to start the jobs.
+
+@noindent
+Handling of the keys of the associative array is as described for
+@t{jobdirs} above.
+
+@vindex jobstates
+@item @t{jobstates}
+This associative array gives information about the states of the jobs
+currently known. The keys are the job numbers and the values are
+strings of the form
+`@var{job-state}@t{:}@var{mark}@t{:}@var{pid}@t{=}@var{state}...'. The
+@var{job-state} gives the state the whole job is currently in, one of
+`@t{running}', `@t{suspended}', or `@t{done}'. The @var{mark} is
+`@t{+}' for the current job, `@t{-}' for the previous job and empty
+otherwise. This is followed by one `@t{:}@var{pid}@t{=}@var{state}' for every
+process in the job. The @var{pid}s are, of course, the process IDs and
+the @var{state} describes the state of that process.
+
+@noindent
+Handling of the keys of the associative array is as described for
+@t{jobdirs} above.
+
+@vindex nameddirs
+@item @t{nameddirs}
+This associative array maps the names of named directories to the pathnames
+they stand for.
+
+@vindex userdirs
+@item @t{userdirs}
+This associative array maps user names to the pathnames of their home
+directories.
+
+@vindex usergroups
+@item @t{usergroups}
+This associative array maps names of system groups of which the current
+user is a member to the corresponding group identifiers. The contents
+are the same as the groups output by the @t{id} command.
+
+@vindex funcfiletrace
+@item @t{funcfiletrace}
+This array contains the absolute line numbers and corresponding file
+names for the point where the current function, sourced file, or (if
+@t{EVAL_LINENO} is set) @t{eval} command was
+called. The array is of the same length as @t{funcsourcetrace} and
+@t{functrace}, but differs from @t{funcsourcetrace} in that the line and
+file are the point of call, not the point of definition, and differs
+from @t{functrace} in that all values are absolute line numbers in
+files, rather than relative to the start of a function, if any.
+
+@vindex funcsourcetrace
+@item @t{funcsourcetrace}
+This array contains the file names and line numbers of the
+points where the functions, sourced files, and (if @t{EVAL_LINENO} is set)
+@t{eval} commands currently being executed were
+defined. The line number is the line where the `@t{function} @var{name}'
+or `@var{name} @t{()}' started. In the case of an autoloaded
+function the line number is reported as zero.
+The format of each element is @var{filename}@t{:}@var{lineno}.
+
+@noindent
+For functions autoloaded from a file in native zsh format, where only the
+body of the function occurs in the file, or for files that have been
+executed by the @t{source} or `@t{.}' builtins, the trace information is
+shown as @var{filename}@t{:}@var{0}, since the entire file is the
+definition. The source file name is resolved to an absolute path when
+the function is loaded or the path to it otherwise resolved.
+
+@noindent
+Most users will be interested in the information in the
+@t{funcfiletrace} array instead.
+
+@vindex funcstack
+@item @t{funcstack}
+This array contains the names of the functions, sourced files,
+and (if @t{EVAL_LINENO} is set) @t{eval} commands. currently being
+executed. The first element is the name of the function using the
+parameter.
+
+@noindent
+The standard shell array @t{zsh_eval_context} can be used to
+determine the type of shell construct being executed at each depth:
+note, however, that is in the opposite order, with the most recent
+item last, and it is more detailed, for example including an
+entry for @t{toplevel}, the main shell code being executed
+either interactively or from a script, which is not present
+in @t{$funcstack}.
+
+@vindex functrace
+@item @t{functrace}
+This array contains the names and line numbers of the callers
+corresponding to the functions currently being executed.
+The format of each element is @var{name}@t{:}@var{lineno}.
+Callers are also shown for sourced files; the caller is the point
+where the @t{source} or `@t{.}' command was executed.
+
+@end table
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@node The zsh/pcre Module, The zsh/param/private Module, The zsh/parameter Module, Zsh Modules
+
+@section The zsh/pcre Module
+@noindent
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/mod_pcre.yo
+
+@cindex regular expressions, perl-compatible
+The @t{zsh/pcre} module makes some commands available as builtins:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex pcre_compile
+@item @t{pcre_compile} [ @t{-aimxs} ] @var{PCRE}
+Compiles a perl-compatible regular expression.
+
+@noindent
+Option @t{-a} will force the pattern to be anchored.
+Option @t{-i} will compile a case-insensitive pattern.
+Option @t{-m} will compile a multi-line pattern; that is,
+@t{^} and @t{$} will match newlines within the pattern.
+Option @t{-x} will compile an extended pattern, wherein
+whitespace and @t{#} comments are ignored.
+Option @t{-s} makes the dot metacharacter match all characters,
+including those that indicate newline.
+
+@findex pcre_study
+@item @t{pcre_study}
+Studies the previously-compiled PCRE which may result in faster
+matching.
+
+@findex pcre_match
+@item @t{pcre_match} [ @t{-v} @var{var} ] [ @t{-a} @var{arr} ] [ @t{-n} @var{offset} ] [ @t{-b} ] @var{string}
+Returns successfully if @t{string} matches the previously-compiled
+PCRE.
+
+@noindent
+Upon successful match,
+if the expression captures substrings within parentheses,
+@t{pcre_match} will set the array @t{match} to those
+substrings, unless the @t{-a} option is given, in which
+case it will set the array @var{arr}. Similarly, the variable
+@t{MATCH} will be set to the entire matched portion of the
+string, unless the @t{-v} option is given, in which case the variable
+@var{var} will be set.
+No variables are altered if there is no successful match.
+A @t{-n} option starts searching for a match from the
+byte @var{offset} position in @var{string}. If the @t{-b} option is given,
+the variable @t{ZPCRE_OP} will be set to an offset pair string,
+representing the byte offset positions of the entire matched portion
+within the @var{string}. For example, a @t{ZPCRE_OP} set to "32 45" indicates
+that the matched portion began on byte offset 32 and ended on byte offset 44.
+Here, byte offset position 45 is the position directly after the matched
+portion. Keep in mind that the byte position isn't necessarily the same
+as the character position when UTF-8 characters are involved.
+Consequently, the byte offset positions are only to be relied on in the
+context of using them for subsequent searches on @var{string}, using an offset
+position as an argument to the @t{-n} option. This is mostly
+used to implement the "find all non-overlapping matches" functionality.
+
+@noindent
+A simple example of "find all non-overlapping matches":
+
+@noindent
+@example
+string="The following zip codes: 78884 90210 99513"
+pcre_compile -m "\d@{5@}"
+accum=()
+pcre_match -b -- $string
+while [[ $? -eq 0 ]] do
+ b=($=ZPCRE_OP)
+ accum+=$MATCH
+ pcre_match -b -n $b[2] -- $string
+done
+print -l $accum
+@end example
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+The @t{zsh/pcre} module makes available the following test condition:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex pcre-match
+@item @var{expr} @t{-pcre-match} @var{pcre}
+Matches a string against a perl-compatible regular expression.
+
+@noindent
+For example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+[[ "$text" -pcre-match ^d+$ ]] &&
+print text variable contains only "d's".
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+@pindex REMATCH_PCRE
+@pindex NO_CASE_MATCH
+If the @t{REMATCH_PCRE} option is set, the @t{=~} operator is equivalent to
+@t{-pcre-match}, and the @t{NO_CASE_MATCH} option may be used. Note that
+@t{NO_CASE_MATCH} never applies to the @t{pcre_match} builtin, instead use
+the @t{-i} switch of @t{pcre_compile}.
+
+@end table
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@node The zsh/param/private Module, The zsh/regex Module, The zsh/pcre Module, Zsh Modules
+
+@section The zsh/param/private Module
+@noindent
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/mod_private.yo
+
+The @t{zsh/param/private} module is used to create parameters whose scope
+is limited to the current function body, and @emph{not} to other functions
+called by the current function.
+
+@noindent
+This module provides a single autoloaded builtin:
+
+@table @asis
+@findex private
+@cindex private parameter, creating
+@item @t{private} [ @{@t{+}|@t{-}@}@t{AHUahlprtux} ] [ @{@t{+}|@t{-}@}@t{EFLRZi} [ @var{n} ] ] [ @var{name}[@t{=}@var{value}] ... ]
+The @t{private} builtin accepts all the same options and arguments as @t{local}
+(@ref{Shell Builtin Commands}) except
+for the `@t{-}@t{T}' option. Tied parameters may not be made private.
+
+@noindent
+If used at the top level (outside a function scope), @t{private} creates a
+normal parameter in the same manner as @t{declare} or @t{typeset}. A
+warning about this is printed if @t{WARN_CREATE_GLOBAL} is set
+(@ref{Options}). Used inside a
+function scope, @t{private} creates a local parameter similar to one
+declared with @t{local}, except having special properties noted below.
+
+@noindent
+Special parameters which expose or manipulate internal shell state, such
+as @t{ARGC}, @t{argv}, @t{COLUMNS}, @t{LINES}, @t{UID}, @t{EUID}, @t{IFS},
+@t{PROMPT}, @t{RANDOM}, @t{SECONDS}, etc., cannot be made private unless
+the `@t{-}@t{h}' option is used to hide the special meaning of the
+parameter. This may change in the future.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+As with other @t{typeset} equivalents, @t{private} is both a builtin and a
+reserved word, so arrays may be assigned with parenthesized word list
+@var{name}@t{=(}@var{value}...@t{)} syntax. However, the reserved
+word `@t{private}' is not available until @t{zsh/param/private} is loaded,
+so care must be taken with order of execution and parsing for function
+definitions which use @t{private}. To compensate for this, the module
+also adds the option `@t{-P}' to the `@t{local}' builtin to declare private
+parameters.
+
+@noindent
+For example, this construction fails if @t{zsh/param/private} has not yet
+been loaded when `@t{bad_declaration}' is defined:
+@example
+bad_declaration() @{
+ zmodload zsh/param/private
+ private array=( one two three )
+@}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+This construction works because @t{local} is already a keyword, and the
+module is loaded before the statement is executed:
+@example
+good_declaration() @{
+ zmodload zsh/param/private
+ local -P array=( one two three )
+@}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The following is usable in scripts but may have trouble with @t{autoload}:
+@example
+zmodload zsh/param/private
+iffy_declaration() @{
+ private array=( one two three )
+@}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The @t{private} builtin may always be used with scalar assignments and
+for declarations without assignments.
+
+@noindent
+Parameters declared with @t{private} have the following properties:
+
+@itemize @bullet
+
+@item
+Within the function body where it is declared, the parameter
+behaves as a local, except as noted above for tied or special parameters.
+@item
+The type of a parameter declared private cannot be changed in the
+scope where it was declared, even if the parameter is unset. Thus an
+array cannot be assigned to a private scalar, etc.
+@item
+Within any other function called by the declaring function, the
+private parameter does @emph{NOT} hide other parameters of the same name, so
+for example a global parameter of the same name is visible and may be
+assigned or unset. This includes calls to anonymous functions, although
+that may also change in the future.
+@item
+An exported private remains in the environment of inner scopes but
+appears unset for the current shell in those scopes. Generally, exporting
+private parameters should be avoided.
+@end itemize
+
+@noindent
+Note that this differs from the static scope defined by compiled languages
+derived from C, in that the a new call to the same function creates a new
+scope, i.e., the parameter is still associated with the call stack rather
+than with the function definition. It differs from ksh `@t{typeset -S}'
+because the syntax used to define the function has no bearing on whether
+the parameter scope is respected.
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@node The zsh/regex Module, The zsh/sched Module, The zsh/param/private Module, Zsh Modules
+
+@section The zsh/regex Module
+@noindent
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/mod_regex.yo
+
+@cindex regular expressions
+@cindex regex
+The @t{zsh/regex} module makes available the following test condition:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex regex-match
+@item @var{expr} @t{-regex-match} @var{regex}
+Matches a string against a POSIX extended regular expression.
+On successful match,
+matched portion of the string will normally be placed in the @t{MATCH}
+variable. If there are any capturing parentheses within the regex, then
+the @t{match} array variable will contain those.
+If the match is not successful, then the variables will not be altered.
+
+@noindent
+For example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+[[ alphabetical -regex-match ^a([^a]+)a([^a]+)a ]] &&
+print -l $MATCH X $match
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+If the option @t{REMATCH_PCRE} is not set, then the @t{=~} operator will
+automatically load this module as needed and will invoke the
+@t{-regex-match} operator.
+
+@noindent
+If @t{BASH_REMATCH} is set, then the array @t{BASH_REMATCH} will be set
+instead of @t{MATCH} and @t{match}.
+
+@end table
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@node The zsh/sched Module, The zsh/net/socket Module, The zsh/regex Module, Zsh Modules
+
+@section The zsh/sched Module
+@noindent
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/mod_sched.yo
+
+The @t{zsh/sched} module makes available one builtin command and one
+parameter.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex sched
+@cindex timed execution
+@cindex execution, timed
+@item @t{sched} [@t{-o}] [@t{+}]@var{hh}@t{:}@var{mm}[@t{:}@var{ss}] @var{command} ...
+@itemx @t{sched} [@t{-o}] [@t{+}]@var{seconds} @var{command} ...
+@itemx @t{sched} [ @t{-}@var{item} ]
+Make an entry in the scheduled list of commands to execute.
+The time may be specified in either absolute or relative time,
+and either as hours, minutes and (optionally) seconds separated by a
+colon, or seconds alone.
+An absolute number of seconds indicates the time since the epoch
+(1970/01/01 00:00); this is useful in combination with the features in
+the @t{zsh/datetime} module, see
+@ref{The zsh/datetime Module}.
+
+@noindent
+With no arguments, prints the list of scheduled commands. If the
+scheduled command has the @t{-o} flag set, this is shown at the
+start of the command.
+
+@noindent
+With the argument `@t{-}@var{item}', removes the given item
+from the list. The numbering of the list is continuous and entries are
+in time order, so the numbering can change when entries are added or
+deleted.
+
+@noindent
+Commands are executed either immediately before a prompt, or while
+the shell's line editor is waiting for input. In the latter case
+it is useful to be able to produce output that does not interfere
+with the line being edited. Providing the option @t{-o} causes
+the shell to clear the command line before the event and redraw it
+afterwards. This should be used with any scheduled event that produces
+visible output to the terminal; it is not needed, for example, with
+output that updates a terminal emulator's title bar.
+
+@noindent
+To effect changes to the editor buffer when an event executes, use the
+`@t{zle}' command with no arguments to test whether the editor is active,
+and if it is, then use `@t{zle }@var{widget}' to access the editor via
+the named @var{widget}.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{sched} builtin is not made available by default when the shell
+starts in a mode emulating another shell. It can be made available
+with the command `@t{zmodload -F zsh/sched b:sched}'.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@vindex zsh_scheduled_events
+@item @t{zsh_scheduled_events}
+A readonly array corresponding to the events scheduled by the
+@t{sched} builtin. The indices of the array correspond to the numbers
+shown when @t{sched} is run with no arguments (provided that the
+@t{KSH_ARRAYS} option is not set). The value of the array
+consists of the scheduled time in seconds since the epoch
+(see @ref{The zsh/datetime Module} for facilities for
+using this number), followed by a colon, followed by any options
+(which may be empty but will be preceded by a `@t{-}' otherwise),
+followed by a colon, followed by the command to be executed.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{sched} builtin should be used for manipulating the events. Note
+that this will have an immediate effect on the contents of the array,
+so that indices may become invalid.
+
+@end table
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@node The zsh/net/socket Module, The zsh/stat Module, The zsh/sched Module, Zsh Modules
+
+@section The zsh/net/socket Module
+@noindent
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/mod_socket.yo
+
+The @t{zsh/net/socket} module makes available one builtin command:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex zsocket
+@cindex sockets
+@cindex sockets, Unix domain
+@item @t{zsocket} [ @t{-altv} ] [ @t{-d} @var{fd} ] [ @var{args} ]
+@t{zsocket} is implemented as a builtin to allow full use of shell
+command line editing, file I/O, and job control mechanisms.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Outbound Connections
+@noindent
+@cindex sockets, outbound Unix domain
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{zsocket} [ @t{-v} ] [ @t{-d} @var{fd} ] @var{filename}
+Open a new Unix domain connection to @var{filename}.
+The shell parameter @t{REPLY} will be set to the file descriptor
+associated with that connection. Currently, only stream connections
+are supported.
+
+@noindent
+If @t{-d} is specified, its argument
+will be taken as the target file descriptor for the
+connection.
+
+@noindent
+In order to elicit more verbose output, use @t{-v}.
+
+@noindent
+File descriptors can be closed with normal shell syntax when no longer
+needed, for example:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+exec @{REPLY@}>&-
+@end example
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Inbound Connections
+@noindent
+@cindex sockets, inbound Unix domain
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{zsocket} @t{-l} [ @t{-v} ] [ @t{-d} @var{fd} ] @var{filename}
+@t{zsocket -l} will open a socket listening on @var{filename}.
+The shell parameter @t{REPLY} will be set to the file descriptor
+associated with that listener. The file descriptor remains open in subshells
+and forked external executables.
+
+@noindent
+If @t{-d} is specified, its argument
+will be taken as the target file descriptor for
+the connection.
+
+@noindent
+In order to elicit more verbose output, use @t{-v}.
+
+@item @t{zsocket} @t{-a} [ @t{-tv} ] [ @t{-d} @var{targetfd} ] @var{listenfd}
+@t{zsocket -a} will accept an incoming connection
+to the socket associated with @var{listenfd}.
+The shell parameter @t{REPLY} will
+be set to the file descriptor associated with
+the inbound connection. The file descriptor remains open in subshells
+and forked external executables.
+
+@noindent
+If @t{-d} is specified, its argument
+will be taken as the target file descriptor for the
+connection.
+
+@noindent
+If @t{-t} is specified, @t{zsocket} will return
+if no incoming connection is pending. Otherwise
+it will wait for one.
+
+@noindent
+In order to elicit more verbose output, use @t{-v}.
+
+@end table
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@node The zsh/stat Module, The zsh/system Module, The zsh/net/socket Module, Zsh Modules
+
+@section The zsh/stat Module
+@noindent
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/mod_stat.yo
+
+The @t{zsh/stat} module makes available one builtin command under
+two possible names:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex zstat
+@findex stat
+@cindex files, listing
+@cindex files, examining
+
+@item @t{zstat }[ @t{-gnNolLtTrs} ] [ @t{-f} @var{fd} ] [ @t{-H} @var{hash} ] [ @t{-A} @var{array} ] [ @t{-F} @var{fmt} ]
+@itemx @t{@ @ @ @ @ @ }[ @t{+}@var{element} ] [ @var{file} ... ]
+@itemx @t{stat} @var{...}
+The command acts as a front end to the @t{stat} system call (see
+man page stat(2)). The same command is provided with two names; as
+the name @t{stat} is often used by an external command it is recommended
+that only the @t{zstat} form of the command is used. This can be
+arranged by loading the module with the command `@t{zmodload -F zsh/stat
+b:zstat}'.
+
+@noindent
+If the @t{stat} call fails, the appropriate system error message
+printed and status 1 is returned.
+The fields of @t{struct stat} give information about
+the files provided as arguments to the command. In addition to those
+available from the @t{stat} call, an extra element `@t{link}' is provided.
+These elements are:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{device}
+The number of the device on which the file resides.
+
+@item @t{inode}
+The unique number of the file on this device (`@emph{inode}' number).
+
+@item @t{mode}
+The mode of the file; that is, the file's type and access permissions.
+With the @t{-s} option, this will
+be returned as a string corresponding to the first column in the
+display of the @t{ls -l} command.
+
+@item @t{nlink}
+The number of hard links to the file.
+
+@item @t{uid}
+The user ID of the owner of the file. With the @t{-s}
+option, this is displayed as a user name.
+
+@item @t{gid}
+The group ID of the file. With the @t{-s} option, this
+is displayed as a group name.
+
+@item @t{rdev}
+The raw device number. This is only useful for special devices.
+
+@item @t{size}
+The size of the file in bytes.
+
+@item @t{atime}
+@itemx @t{mtime}
+@itemx @t{ctime}
+The last access, modification and inode change times
+of the file, respectively, as the number of seconds since
+midnight GMT on 1st January, 1970. With the @t{-s} option,
+these are printed as strings for the local time zone; the format
+can be altered with the @t{-F} option, and with the @t{-g}
+option the times are in GMT.
+
+@item @t{blksize}
+The number of bytes in one allocation block on the
+device on which the file resides.
+
+@item @t{block}
+The number of disk blocks used by the file.
+
+@item @t{link}
+If the file is a link and the @t{-L} option is in
+effect, this contains the name of the file linked to, otherwise
+it is empty. Note that if this element is selected (@value{dsbq}@t{zstat +link}@value{dsq})
+then the @t{-L} option is automatically used.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+A particular element may be selected by including its name
+preceded by a `@t{+}' in the option list; only one element is allowed.
+The element may be shortened to any unique set of leading
+characters. Otherwise, all elements will be shown for all files.
+
+@noindent
+Options:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{-A} @var{array}
+Instead of displaying the results on standard
+output, assign them to an @var{array}, one @t{struct stat} element per array
+element for each file in order. In this case neither the name
+of the element nor the name of the files appears in @var{array} unless the
+@t{-t} or @t{-n} options were given, respectively. If @t{-t} is given,
+the element name appears as a prefix to the
+appropriate array element; if @t{-n} is given, the file name
+appears as a separate array element preceding all the others.
+Other formatting options are respected.
+
+@item @t{-H} @var{hash}
+Similar to @t{-A}, but instead assign the values to @var{hash}. The keys
+are the elements listed above. If the @t{-n} option is provided then the
+name of the file is included in the hash with key @t{name}.
+
+@item @t{-f} @var{fd}
+Use the file on file descriptor @var{fd} instead of
+named files; no list of file names is allowed in this case.
+
+@item @t{-F} @var{fmt}
+Supplies a @t{strftime} (see man page strftime(3)) string for the
+formatting of the time elements. The format string supports all of the
+zsh extensions described in
+@ref{Prompt Expansion}.
+The @t{-s} option is implied.
+
+@item @t{-g}
+Show the time elements in the GMT time zone. The
+@t{-s} option is implied.
+
+@item @t{-l}
+List the names of the type elements (to standard
+output or an array as appropriate) and return immediately;
+arguments, and options other than @t{-A}, are ignored.
+
+@item @t{-L}
+Perform an @t{lstat} (see man page lstat(2)) rather than a @t{stat}
+system call. In this case, if the file is a link, information
+about the link itself rather than the target file is returned.
+This option is required to make the @t{link} element useful.
+It's important to note that this is the exact opposite from man page ls(1),
+etc.
+
+@item @t{-n}
+Always show the names of files. Usually these are
+only shown when output is to standard output and there is more
+than one file in the list.
+
+@item @t{-N}
+Never show the names of files.
+
+@item @t{-o}
+If a raw file mode is printed, show it in octal, which is more useful for
+human consumption than the default of decimal. A leading zero will be
+printed in this case. Note that this does not affect whether a raw or
+formatted file mode is shown, which is controlled by the @t{-r} and @t{-s}
+options, nor whether a mode is shown at all.
+
+@item @t{-r}
+Print raw data (the default format) alongside string
+data (the @t{-s} format); the string data appears in parentheses
+after the raw data.
+
+@item @t{-s}
+Print @t{mode}, @t{uid}, @t{gid} and the three time
+elements as strings instead of numbers. In each case the format
+is like that of @t{ls -l}.
+
+@item @t{-t}
+Always show the type names for the elements of
+@t{struct stat}. Usually these are only shown when output is to
+standard output and no individual element has been selected.
+
+@item @t{-T}
+Never show the type names of the @t{struct stat} elements.
+
+@end table
+
+@end table
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@node The zsh/system Module, The zsh/net/tcp Module, The zsh/stat Module, Zsh Modules
+
+@section The zsh/system Module
+@noindent
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/mod_system.yo
+
+The @t{zsh/system} module makes available various builtin commands and
+parameters.
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Builtins
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex syserror
+@item @t{syserror} [ @t{-e} @var{errvar} ] [ @t{-p} @var{prefix} ] [ @var{errno} | @var{errname} ]
+This command prints out the error message associated with @var{errno}, a
+system error number, followed by a newline to standard error.
+
+@noindent
+Instead of the error number, a name @var{errname}, for example
+@t{ENOENT}, may be used. The set of names is the same as the contents
+of the array @t{errnos}, see below.
+
+@noindent
+If the string @var{prefix} is given, it is printed in front of the error
+message, with no intervening space.
+
+@noindent
+If @var{errvar} is supplied, the entire message, without a newline, is
+assigned to the parameter names @var{errvar} and nothing is output.
+
+@noindent
+A return status of 0 indicates the message was successfully printed
+(although it may not be useful if the error number was out of the
+system's range), a return status of 1 indicates an error in the
+parameters, and a return status of 2 indicates the error name was
+not recognised (no message is printed for this).
+
+@findex sysopen
+
+@item @t{sysopen} [ @t{-arw} ] [ @t{-m} @var{permissions} ] [ @t{-o} @var{options} ]
+@itemx @t{@ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ }@t{-u} @var{fd} @var{file}
+This command opens a file. The @t{-r}, @t{-w} and @t{-a} flags indicate
+whether the file should be opened for reading, writing and appending,
+respectively. The @t{-m} option allows the initial permissions to use when
+creating a file to be specified in octal form. The file descriptor is
+specified with @t{-u}. Either an explicit file descriptor in the range 0 to 9 can
+be specified or a variable name can be given to which the file descriptor
+number will be assigned.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{-o} option allows various system specific options to be
+specified as a comma-separated list. The following is a list of possible
+options. Note that, depending on the system, some may not be available.
+@table @asis
+@item @t{cloexec}
+mark file to be closed when other programs are executed (else
+the file descriptor remains open in subshells and forked external
+executables)
+
+@item @t{create}
+@itemx @t{creat}
+create file if it does not exist
+
+@item @t{excl}
+create file, error if it already exists
+
+@item @t{noatime}
+suppress updating of the file atime
+
+@item @t{nofollow}
+fail if @var{file} is a symbolic link
+
+@item @t{sync}
+request that writes wait until data has been physically written
+
+@item @t{truncate}
+@itemx @t{trunc}
+truncate file to size 0
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+To close the file, use one of the following:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+@t{exec @{}@var{fd}@t{@}<&-}
+@t{exec @{}@var{fd}@t{@}>&-}
+@end example
+
+@findex sysread
+
+@item @t{sysread }[ @t{-c} @var{countvar} ] [ @t{-i} @var{infd} ] [ @t{-o} @var{outfd} ]
+@itemx @t{@ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ }[ @t{-s} @var{bufsize} ] [ @t{-t} @var{timeout} ] [ @var{param} ]
+Perform a single system read from file descriptor @var{infd}, or zero if
+that is not given. The result of the read is stored in @var{param} or
+@t{REPLY} if that is not given. If @var{countvar} is given, the number
+of bytes read is assigned to the parameter named by @var{countvar}.
+
+@noindent
+The maximum number of bytes read is @var{bufsize} or 8192 if that is not
+given, however the command returns as soon as any number of bytes was
+successfully read.
+
+@noindent
+If @var{timeout} is given, it specifies a timeout in seconds, which may
+be zero to poll the file descriptor. This is handled by the @t{poll}
+system call if available, otherwise the @t{select} system call if
+available.
+
+@noindent
+If @var{outfd} is given, an attempt is made to write all the bytes just
+read to the file descriptor @var{outfd}. If this fails, because of a
+system error other than @t{EINTR} or because of an internal zsh error
+during an interrupt, the bytes read but not written are stored in the
+parameter named by @var{param} if supplied (no default is used in this
+case), and the number of bytes read but not written is stored in the
+parameter named by @var{countvar} if that is supplied. If it was
+successful, @var{countvar} contains the full number of bytes transferred,
+as usual, and @var{param} is not set.
+
+@noindent
+The error @t{EINTR} (interrupted system call) is handled internally so
+that shell interrupts are transparent to the caller. Any other error
+causes a return.
+
+@noindent
+The possible return statuses are
+@table @asis
+@item 0
+At least one byte of data was successfully read and, if appropriate,
+written.
+
+@item 1
+There was an error in the parameters to the command. This is the only
+error for which a message is printed to standard error.
+
+@item 2
+There was an error on the read, or on polling the input file descriptor
+for a timeout. The parameter @t{ERRNO} gives the error.
+
+@item 3
+Data were successfully read, but there was an error writing them
+to @var{outfd}. The parameter @t{ERRNO} gives the error.
+
+@item 4
+The attempt to read timed out. Note this does not set @t{ERRNO} as this
+is not a system error.
+
+@item 5
+No system error occurred, but zero bytes were read. This usually
+indicates end of file. The parameters are set according to the
+usual rules; no write to @var{outfd} is attempted.
+
+@end table
+
+@item @t{sysseek} [ @t{-u} @var{fd} ] [ @t{-w} @t{start}|@t{end}|@t{current} ] @var{offset}
+The current file position at which future reads and writes will take place is
+adjusted to the specified byte offset. The @var{offset} is evaluated as a math
+expression. The @t{-u} option allows the file descriptor to be specified. By
+default the offset is specified relative to the start or the file but, with the
+@t{-w} option, it is possible to specify that the offset should be relative to
+the current position or the end of the file.
+
+@item @t{syswrite} [ @t{-c} @var{countvar} ] [ @t{-o} @var{outfd} ] @var{data}
+The data (a single string of bytes) are written to the file descriptor
+@var{outfd}, or 1 if that is not given, using the @t{write} system call.
+Multiple write operations may be used if the first does not write all
+the data.
+
+@noindent
+If @var{countvar} is given, the number of byte written is stored in the
+parameter named by @var{countvar}; this may not be the full length of
+@var{data} if an error occurred.
+
+@noindent
+The error @t{EINTR} (interrupted system call) is handled internally by
+retrying; otherwise an error causes the command to return. For example,
+if the file descriptor is set to non-blocking output, an error
+@t{EAGAIN} (on some systems, @t{EWOULDBLOCK}) may result in the command
+returning early.
+
+@noindent
+The return status may be 0 for success, 1 for an error in the parameters
+to the command, or 2 for an error on the write; no error message is
+printed in the last case, but the parameter @t{ERRNO} will reflect
+the error that occurred.
+
+@item @t{zsystem flock} [ @t{-t} @var{timeout} ] [ @t{-f} @var{var} ] [@t{-er}] @var{file}
+@itemx @t{zsystem flock -u} @var{fd_expr}
+The builtin @t{zsystem}'s subcommand @t{flock} performs advisory file
+locking (via the man page fcntl(2) system call) over the entire contents
+of the given file. This form of locking requires the processes
+accessing the file to cooperate; its most obvious use is between two
+instances of the shell itself.
+
+@noindent
+In the first form the named @var{file}, which must already exist, is
+locked by opening a file descriptor to the file and applying a lock to
+the file descriptor. The lock terminates when the shell process that
+created the lock exits; it is therefore often convenient to create file
+locks within subshells, since the lock is automatically released when
+the subshell exits. Note that use of the @t{print} builtin with the
+@t{-u} option will, as a side effect, release the lock, as will redirection
+to the file in the shell holding the lock. To work around this use a
+subshell, e.g. `@t{(print message) >> }@var{file}'. Status 0 is
+returned if the lock succeeds, else status 1.
+
+@noindent
+In the second form the file descriptor given by the arithmetic
+expression @var{fd_expr} is closed, releasing a lock. The file descriptor
+can be queried by using the `@t{-f} @var{var}' form during the lock;
+on a successful lock, the shell variable @var{var} is set to the file
+descriptor used for locking. The lock will be released if the
+file descriptor is closed by any other means, for example using
+`@t{exec @{}@var{var}@t{@}>&-}'; however, the form described here performs
+a safety check that the file descriptor is in use for file locking.
+
+@noindent
+By default the shell waits indefinitely for the lock to succeed.
+The option @t{-t} @var{timeout} specifies a timeout for the lock in
+seconds; currently this must be an integer. The shell will attempt
+to lock the file once a second during this period. If the attempt
+times out, status 2 is returned.
+
+@noindent
+If the option @t{-e} is given, the file descriptor for the lock is
+preserved when the shell uses @t{exec} to start a new process;
+otherwise it is closed at that point and the lock released.
+
+@noindent
+If the option @t{-r} is given, the lock is only for reading, otherwise
+it is for reading and writing. The file descriptor is opened
+accordingly.
+
+@item @t{zsystem supports} @var{subcommand}
+The builtin @t{zsystem}'s subcommand @t{supports} tests whether a
+given subcommand is supported. It returns status 0 if so, else
+status 1. It operates silently unless there was a syntax error
+(i.e. the wrong number of arguments), in which case status 255
+is returned. Status 1 can indicate one of two things: @var{subcommand}
+is known but not supported by the current operating system, or
+@var{subcommand} is not known (possibly because this is an older
+version of the shell before it was implemented).
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Math Functions
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{systell(@var{fd})}
+The systell math function returns the current file position for the file
+descriptor passed as an argument.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Parameters
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@vindex errnos
+@item @t{errnos}
+A readonly array of the names of errors defined on the system. These
+are typically macros defined in C by including the system header file
+@t{errno.h}. The index of each name (assuming the option @t{KSH_ARRAYS}
+is unset) corresponds to the error number. Error numbers @var{num}
+before the last known error which have no name are given the name
+@t{E}@var{num} in the array.
+
+@noindent
+Note that aliases for errors are not handled; only the canonical name is
+used.
+
+@vindex sysparams
+@item @t{sysparams}
+A readonly associative array. The keys are:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{pid}
+@vindex pid, sysparams
+Returns the process ID of the current process, even in subshells. Compare
+@t{$$}, which returns the process ID of the main shell process.
+
+@item @t{ppid}
+@vindex ppid, sysparams
+Returns the process ID of the parent of the current process, even in
+subshells. Compare @t{$PPID}, which returns the process ID of the parent
+of the main shell process.
+
+@item @t{procsubstpid}
+Returns the process ID of the last process started for process
+substitution, i.e. the @t{<(}@var{...}@t{)} and
+@t{>(}@var{...}@t{)} expansions.
+
+@end table
+
+@end table
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@node The zsh/net/tcp Module, The zsh/termcap Module, The zsh/system Module, Zsh Modules
+
+@section The zsh/net/tcp Module
+@noindent
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/mod_tcp.yo
+
+The @t{zsh/net/tcp} module makes available one builtin command:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex ztcp
+@cindex TCP
+@cindex sockets, TCP
+@item @t{ztcp} [ @t{-acflLtv} ] [ @t{-d} @var{fd} ] [ @var{args} ]
+@t{ztcp} is implemented as a builtin to allow full use of shell
+command line editing, file I/O, and job control mechanisms.
+
+@noindent
+If @t{ztcp} is run with no options, it will output
+the contents of its session table.
+
+@noindent
+If it is run with only the option @t{-L}, it will output the contents of
+the session table in a format suitable for automatic parsing. The option
+is ignored if given with a command to open or close a session. The output
+consists of a set of lines, one per session, each containing the following
+elements separated by spaces:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item File descriptor
+The file descriptor in use for the connection. For normal inbound (@t{I})
+and outbound (@t{O}) connections this may be read and written by the usual
+shell mechanisms. However, it should only be close with `@t{ztcp -c}'.
+
+@item Connection type
+A letter indicating how the session was created:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{Z}
+A session created with the @t{zftp} command.
+
+@item @t{L}
+A connection opened for listening with `@t{ztcp -l}'.
+
+@item @t{I}
+An inbound connection accepted with `@t{ztcp -a}'.
+
+@item @t{O}
+An outbound connection created with `@t{ztcp} @var{host} @var{...}'.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@item The local host
+This is usually set to an all-zero IP address as the address of the
+localhost is irrelevant.
+
+@item The local port
+This is likely to be zero unless the connection is for listening.
+
+@item The remote host
+This is the fully qualified domain name of the peer, if available, else an
+IP address. It is an all-zero IP address for a session opened for
+listening.
+
+@item The remote port
+This is zero for a connection opened for listening.
+
+@end table
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Outbound Connections
+@noindent
+@cindex sockets, outbound TCP
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{ztcp} [ @t{-v} ] [ @t{-d} @var{fd} ] @var{host} [ @var{port} ]
+Open a new TCP connection to @var{host}. If the @var{port} is
+omitted, it will default to port 23. The connection will
+be added to the session table and the shell parameter
+@t{REPLY} will be set to the file descriptor associated
+with that connection.
+
+@noindent
+If @t{-d} is specified, its argument will be taken as the target file
+descriptor for the connection.
+
+@noindent
+In order to elicit more verbose output, use @t{-v}.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Inbound Connections
+@noindent
+@cindex sockets, inbound TCP
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{ztcp} @t{-l} [ @t{-v} ] [ @t{-d} @var{fd} ] @var{port}
+@t{ztcp -l} will open a socket listening on TCP
+@var{port}. The socket will be added to the
+session table and the shell parameter @t{REPLY}
+will be set to the file descriptor associated
+with that listener.
+
+@noindent
+If @t{-d} is specified, its argument will be taken as the target file
+descriptor for the connection.
+
+@noindent
+In order to elicit more verbose output, use @t{-v}.
+
+@item @t{ztcp} @t{-a} [ @t{-tv} ] [ @t{-d} @var{targetfd} ] @var{listenfd}
+@t{ztcp -a} will accept an incoming connection
+to the port associated with @var{listenfd}.
+The connection will be added to the session
+table and the shell parameter @t{REPLY} will
+be set to the file descriptor associated with
+the inbound connection.
+
+@noindent
+If @t{-d} is specified, its argument
+will be taken as the target file descriptor for the
+connection.
+
+@noindent
+If @t{-t} is specified, @t{ztcp} will return
+if no incoming connection is pending. Otherwise
+it will wait for one.
+
+@noindent
+In order to elicit more verbose output, use @t{-v}.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Closing Connections
+@noindent
+@cindex sockets, closing TCP
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{ztcp} @t{-cf} [ @t{-v} ] [ @var{fd} ]
+@itemx @t{ztcp} @t{-c} [ @t{-v} ] [ @var{fd} ]
+@t{ztcp -c} will close the socket associated
+with @var{fd}. The socket will be removed from the
+session table. If @var{fd} is not specified,
+@t{ztcp} will close everything in the session table.
+
+@noindent
+Normally, sockets registered by zftp (see
+@ref{The zsh/zftp Module}
+) cannot be closed this way. In order
+to force such a socket closed, use @t{-f}.
+
+@noindent
+In order to elicit more verbose output, use @t{-v}.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Example
+@noindent
+@cindex TCP, example
+Here is how to create a TCP connection between two instances of zsh. We
+need to pick an unassigned port; here we use the randomly chosen 5123.
+
+@noindent
+On @t{host1},
+@example
+zmodload zsh/net/tcp
+ztcp -l 5123
+listenfd=$REPLY
+ztcp -a $listenfd
+fd=$REPLY
+@end example
+The second from last command blocks until there is an incoming connection.
+
+@noindent
+Now create a connection from @t{host2} (which may, of course, be the same
+machine):
+@example
+zmodload zsh/net/tcp
+ztcp host1 5123
+fd=$REPLY
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Now on each host, @t{$fd} contains a file descriptor for talking to the
+other. For example, on @t{host1}:
+@example
+print This is a message >&$fd
+@end example
+and on @t{host2}:
+@example
+read -r line <&$fd; print -r - $line
+@end example
+prints `@t{This is a message}'.
+
+@noindent
+To tidy up, on @t{host1}:
+@example
+ztcp -c $listenfd
+ztcp -c $fd
+@end example
+and on @t{host2}
+@example
+ztcp -c $fd
+@end example
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@node The zsh/termcap Module, The zsh/terminfo Module, The zsh/net/tcp Module, Zsh Modules
+
+@section The zsh/termcap Module
+@noindent
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/mod_termcap.yo
+
+The @t{zsh/termcap} module makes available one builtin command:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex echotc
+@cindex termcap value, printing
+@item @t{echotc} @var{cap} [ @var{arg} ... ]
+Output the termcap value corresponding to the capability
+@var{cap}, with optional arguments.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+The @t{zsh/termcap} module makes available one parameter:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@vindex termcap
+@item @t{termcap}
+An associative array that maps termcap capability codes to
+their values.
+
+@end table
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@node The zsh/terminfo Module, The zsh/zftp Module, The zsh/termcap Module, Zsh Modules
+
+@section The zsh/terminfo Module
+@noindent
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/mod_terminfo.yo
+
+The @t{zsh/terminfo} module makes available one builtin command:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex echoti
+@cindex terminfo value, printing
+@item @t{echoti} @var{cap} [ @var{arg} ]
+Output the terminfo value corresponding to the capability
+@var{cap}, instantiated with @var{arg} if applicable.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+The @t{zsh/terminfo} module makes available one parameter:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@vindex terminfo
+@item @t{terminfo}
+An associative array that maps terminfo capability names to
+their values.
+
+@end table
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@node The zsh/zftp Module, The zsh/zle Module, The zsh/terminfo Module, Zsh Modules
+
+@section The zsh/zftp Module
+@noindent
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/mod_zftp.yo
+
+The @t{zsh/zftp} module makes available one builtin command:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex zftp
+@cindex FTP
+@cindex files, transferring
+@item @t{zftp} @var{subcommand} [ @var{args} ]
+The @t{zsh/zftp} module is a client for FTP (file transfer protocol). It
+is implemented as a builtin to allow full use of shell command line
+editing, file I/O, and job control mechanisms. Often, users will
+access it via shell functions providing a more powerful interface; a set is
+provided with the @t{zsh} distribution and is described in
+@ref{Zftp Function System}. However, the @t{zftp} command is entirely usable in its
+own right.
+
+@noindent
+All commands consist of the command name @t{zftp} followed by the name
+of a subcommand. These are listed below. The return status of each
+subcommand is supposed to reflect the success or failure of the remote
+operation. See a description of the variable @t{ZFTP_VERBOSE} for
+more information on how responses from the server may be printed.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Subcommands
+@noindent
+@cindex zftp, subcommands
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@cindex FTP, starting a session
+@item @t{open} @var{host}[@t{:}@var{port}] [ @var{user} [ @var{password} [ @var{account} ] ] ]
+Open a new FTP session to @var{host}, which may be the name of a TCP/IP
+connected host or an IP number in the standard dot notation. If the
+argument is in the form @var{host}@t{:}@var{port}, open a connection to
+TCP port @var{port} instead of the standard FTP port 21. This may be
+the name of a TCP service or a number: see the description of
+@t{ZFTP_PORT} below for more information.
+
+@noindent
+If IPv6 addresses in colon format are used, the @var{host} should be
+surrounded by quoted square brackets to distinguish it from the @var{port},
+for example @t{'[fe80::203:baff:fe02:8b56]'}. For consistency this is
+allowed with all forms of @var{host}.
+
+@noindent
+Remaining arguments are passed to the @t{login} subcommand. Note that
+if no arguments beyond @var{host} are supplied, @t{open} will @emph{not}
+automatically call @t{login}. If no arguments at all are supplied,
+@t{open} will use the parameters set by the @t{params} subcommand.
+
+@noindent
+After a successful open, the shell variables @t{ZFTP_HOST}, @t{ZFTP_PORT},
+@t{ZFTP_IP} and @t{ZFTP_SYSTEM} are available; see `Variables'
+below.
+
+@item @t{login} [ @var{name} [ @var{password} [ @var{account} ] ] ]
+@itemx @t{user} [ @var{name} [ @var{password} [ @var{account} ] ] ]
+Login the user @var{name} with parameters @var{password} and @var{account}.
+Any of the parameters can be omitted, and will be read from standard
+input if needed (@var{name} is always needed). If
+standard input is a terminal, a prompt for each one will be printed on
+standard error and @var{password} will not be echoed. If any of the
+parameters are not used, a warning message is printed.
+
+@noindent
+After a successful login, the shell variables @t{ZFTP_USER},
+@t{ZFTP_ACCOUNT} and @t{ZFTP_PWD} are available; see `Variables'
+below.
+
+@noindent
+This command may be re-issued when a user is already logged in, and
+the server will first be reinitialized for a new user.
+
+@item @t{params} [ @var{host} [ @var{user} [ @var{password} [ @var{account} ] ] ] ]
+@itemx @t{params} @t{-}
+Store the given parameters for a later @t{open} command with no
+arguments. Only those given on the command line will be remembered.
+If no arguments are given, the parameters currently set are printed,
+although the password will appear as a line of stars; the return status is
+one if no parameters were set, zero otherwise.
+
+@noindent
+Any of the parameters may be specified as a `@t{?}', which
+may need to be quoted to protect it from shell expansion. In this case,
+the appropriate parameter will be read from stdin as with the
+@t{login} subcommand, including special handling of @var{password}. If the
+`@t{?}' is followed by a string, that is used as the prompt for reading the
+parameter instead of the default message (any necessary punctuation and
+whitespace should be included at the end of the prompt). The first letter
+of the parameter (only) may be quoted with a `@t{\}'; hence an argument
+@t{"\\$word"} guarantees that the string from the shell parameter @t{$word}
+will be treated literally, whether or not it begins with a `@t{?}'.
+
+@noindent
+If instead a single `@t{-}' is given, the existing parameters, if any,
+are deleted. In that case, calling @t{open} with no arguments will
+cause an error.
+
+@noindent
+The list of parameters is not deleted after a @t{close}, however it
+will be deleted if the @t{zsh/zftp} module is unloaded.
+
+@noindent
+For example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zftp params ftp.elsewhere.xx juser '?Password for juser: '
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+will store the host @t{ftp.elsewhere.xx} and the user @t{juser} and
+then prompt the user for the corresponding password with the given prompt.
+
+@item @t{test}
+Test the connection; if the server has reported
+that it has closed the connection (maybe due to a timeout), return
+status 2; if no connection was open anyway, return status 1; else
+return status 0. The @t{test} subcommand is
+silent, apart from messages printed by the @t{$ZFTP_VERBOSE}
+mechanism, or error messages if the connection closes. There is no
+network overhead for this test.
+
+@noindent
+The test is only supported on systems with either the
+@t{select(2)} or
+@t{poll(2)} system calls; otherwise the message `@t{not
+supported on this system}' is printed instead.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{test} subcommand will automatically be called at the start of any
+other subcommand for the current session when a connection is open.
+
+@item @t{cd} @var{directory}
+Change the remote directory to @var{directory}. Also alters the shell
+variable @t{ZFTP_PWD}.
+
+@item @t{cdup}
+Change the remote directory to the one higher in the directory tree.
+Note that @t{cd ..} will also work correctly on non-UNIX systems.
+
+@item @t{dir} [ @var{arg} ... ]
+Give a (verbose) listing of the remote directory. The @var{arg}s are
+passed directly to the server. The command's behaviour is implementation
+dependent, but a UNIX server will typically interpret @var{arg}s as
+arguments to the @t{ls} command and with no arguments return the
+result of `@t{ls -l}'. The directory is listed to standard output.
+
+@item @t{ls} [ @var{arg} ... ]
+Give a (short) listing of the remote directory. With no @var{arg},
+produces a raw list of the files in the directory, one per line.
+Otherwise, up to vagaries of the server implementation, behaves
+similar to @t{dir}.
+
+@item @t{type} [ @var{type} ]
+Change the type for the transfer to @var{type}, or print the current type
+if @var{type} is absent. The allowed values are `@t{A}' (ASCII),
+`@t{I}' (Image, i.e. binary), or `@t{B}' (a synonym for `@t{I}').
+
+@noindent
+The FTP default for a transfer is ASCII. However, if @t{zftp} finds
+that the remote host is a UNIX machine with 8-bit byes, it will
+automatically switch to using binary for file transfers upon
+@t{open}. This can subsequently be overridden.
+
+@noindent
+The transfer type is only passed to the remote host when a data
+connection is established; this command involves no network overhead.
+
+@item @t{ascii}
+The same as @t{type A}.
+
+@item @t{binary}
+The same as @t{type I}.
+
+@item @t{mode} [ @t{S} | @t{B} ]
+Set the mode type to stream (@t{S}) or block (@t{B}). Stream mode is
+the default; block mode is not widely supported.
+
+@item @t{remote} @var{file} ...
+@itemx @t{local} [ @var{file} ... ]
+Print the size and last modification time of the remote or local
+files. If there is more than one item on the list, the name of the
+file is printed first. The first number is the file size, the second
+is the last modification time of the file in the format
+@t{CCYYMMDDhhmmSS} consisting of year, month, date, hour, minutes and
+seconds in GMT. Note that this format, including the length, is
+guaranteed, so that time strings can be directly compared via the
+@t{[[} builtin's @t{<} and @t{>} operators, even if they are too long
+to be represented as integers.
+
+@noindent
+Not all servers support the commands for retrieving this information.
+In that case, the @t{remote} command will print nothing and return
+status 2, compared with status 1 for a file not found.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{local} command (but not @t{remote}) may be used with no
+arguments, in which case the information comes from examining file
+descriptor zero. This is the same file as seen by a @t{put} command
+with no further redirection.
+
+@item @t{get} @var{file} ...
+Retrieve all @var{file}s from the server, concatenating them
+and sending them to standard output.
+
+@item @t{put} @var{file} ...
+For each @var{file}, read a file from standard input and send that to
+the remote host with the given name.
+
+@item @t{append} @var{file} ...
+As @t{put}, but if the remote @var{file} already exists, data is
+appended to it instead of overwriting it.
+
+@item @t{getat} @var{file} @var{point}
+@itemx @t{putat} @var{file} @var{point}
+@itemx @t{appendat} @var{file} @var{point}
+Versions of @t{get}, @t{put} and @t{append} which will start the
+transfer at the given @var{point} in the remote @var{file}. This is
+useful for appending to an incomplete local file. However, note that
+this ability is not universally supported by servers (and is not quite
+the behaviour specified by the standard).
+
+@item @t{delete} @var{file} ...
+Delete the list of files on the server.
+
+@item @t{mkdir} @var{directory}
+Create a new directory @var{directory} on the server.
+
+@item @t{rmdir} @var{directory}
+Delete the directory @var{directory} on the server.
+
+@item @t{rename} @var{old-name} @var{new-name}
+Rename file @var{old-name} to @var{new-name} on the server.
+
+@item @t{site} @var{arg} ...
+Send a host-specific command to the server. You will probably
+only need this if instructed by the server to use it.
+
+@item @t{quote} @var{arg} ...
+Send the raw FTP command sequence to the server. You should be
+familiar with the FTP command set as defined in RFC959 before doing
+this. Useful commands may include @t{STAT} and @t{HELP}. Note also
+the mechanism for returning messages as described for the variable
+@t{ZFTP_VERBOSE} below, in particular that all messages from the
+control connection are sent to standard error.
+
+@item @t{close}
+@itemx @t{quit}
+Close the current data connection. This unsets the shell parameters
+@t{ZFTP_HOST}, @t{ZFTP_PORT}, @t{ZFTP_IP}, @t{ZFTP_SYSTEM}, @t{ZFTP_USER},
+@t{ZFTP_ACCOUNT}, @t{ZFTP_PWD}, @t{ZFTP_TYPE} and @t{ZFTP_MODE}.
+
+@item @t{session} [ @var{sessname} ]
+Allows multiple FTP sessions to be used at once. The name of the session
+is an arbitrary string of characters; the default session is called
+`@t{default}'. If this command is called without an argument, it will list
+all the current sessions; with an argument, it will either switch to the
+existing session called @var{sessname}, or create a new session of that name.
+
+@noindent
+Each session remembers the status of the connection, the set of
+connection-specific shell parameters (the same set as are unset when a
+connection closes, as given in the description of @t{close}), and any user
+parameters specified with the @t{params} subcommand. Changing to a
+previous session restores those values; changing to a new session
+initialises them in the same way as if @t{zftp} had just been loaded. The
+name of the current session is given by the parameter @t{ZFTP_SESSION}.
+
+@item @t{rmsession} [ @var{sessname} ]
+Delete a session; if a name is not given, the current session is deleted.
+If the current session is deleted, the earliest existing session becomes
+the new current session, otherwise the current session is not changed.
+If the session being deleted is the only one, a new session called
+`@t{default}' is created and becomes the current session; note that this is
+a new session even if the session being deleted is also called
+`@t{default}'. It is recommended that sessions not be deleted while
+background commands which use @t{zftp} are still active.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Parameters
+@noindent
+@cindex zftp, parameters
+The following shell parameters are used by @t{zftp}. Currently none
+of them are special.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@vindex ZFTP_TMOUT
+@item @t{ZFTP_TMOUT}
+Integer. The time in seconds to wait for a network operation to
+complete before returning an error. If this is not set when the
+module is loaded, it will be given the default value 60. A value of
+zero turns off timeouts. If a timeout occurs on the control
+connection it will be closed. Use a larger value if this occurs too
+frequently.
+
+@vindex ZFTP_IP
+@item @t{ZFTP_IP}
+Readonly. The IP address of the current connection in dot notation.
+
+@vindex ZFTP_HOST
+@item @t{ZFTP_HOST}
+Readonly. The hostname of the current remote server. If the host was
+opened as an IP number, @t{ZFTP_HOST} contains that instead; this
+saves the overhead for a name lookup, as IP numbers are most commonly
+used when a nameserver is unavailable.
+
+@vindex ZFTP_PORT
+@item @t{ZFTP_PORT}
+Readonly. The number of the remote TCP port to which the connection is
+open (even if the port was originally specified as a named service).
+Usually this is the standard FTP port, 21.
+
+@noindent
+In the unlikely event that your system does not have the appropriate
+conversion functions, this appears in network byte order. If your
+system is little-endian, the port then consists of two swapped bytes and the
+standard port will be reported as 5376. In that case, numeric ports passed
+to @t{zftp open} will also need to be in this format.
+
+@vindex ZFTP_SYSTEM
+@item @t{ZFTP_SYSTEM}
+Readonly. The system type string returned by the server in response
+to an FTP @t{SYST} request. The most interesting case is a string
+beginning @t{"UNIX Type: L8"}, which ensures maximum compatibility
+with a local UNIX host.
+
+@vindex ZFTP_TYPE
+@item @t{ZFTP_TYPE}
+Readonly. The type to be used for data transfers , either `@t{A}' or
+`@t{I}'. Use the @t{type} subcommand to change this.
+
+@vindex ZFTP_USER
+@item @t{ZFTP_USER}
+Readonly. The username currently logged in, if any.
+
+@vindex ZFTP_ACCOUNT
+@item @t{ZFTP_ACCOUNT}
+Readonly. The account name of the current user, if any. Most servers
+do not require an account name.
+
+@vindex ZFTP_PWD
+@item @t{ZFTP_PWD}
+Readonly. The current directory on the server.
+
+@vindex ZFTP_CODE
+@item @t{ZFTP_CODE}
+Readonly. The three digit code of the last FTP reply from the server
+as a string. This can still be read after the connection is closed, and
+is not changed when the current session changes.
+
+@vindex ZFTP_REPLY
+@item @t{ZFTP_REPLY}
+Readonly. The last line of the last reply sent by the server. This
+can still be read after the connection is closed, and is not changed when
+the current session changes.
+
+@vindex ZFTP_SESSION
+@item @t{ZFTP_SESSION}
+Readonly. The name of the current FTP session; see the description of the
+@t{session} subcommand.
+
+@vindex ZFTP_PREFS
+@item @t{ZFTP_PREFS}
+A string of preferences for altering aspects of @t{zftp}'s behaviour.
+Each preference is a single character. The following are defined:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{P}
+Passive: attempt to make the remote server initiate data transfers.
+This is slightly more efficient than sendport mode. If the letter
+@t{S} occurs later in the string, @t{zftp} will use sendport mode if
+passive mode is not available.
+
+@item @t{S}
+Sendport: initiate transfers by the FTP @t{PORT} command. If this
+occurs before any @t{P} in the string, passive mode will never be
+attempted.
+
+@item @t{D}
+Dumb: use only the bare minimum of FTP commands. This prevents
+the variables @t{ZFTP_SYSTEM} and @t{ZFTP_PWD} from being set, and
+will mean all connections default to ASCII type. It may prevent
+@t{ZFTP_SIZE} from being set during a transfer if the server
+does not send it anyway (many servers do).
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+If @t{ZFTP_PREFS} is not set when @t{zftp} is loaded, it will be set to a
+default of `@t{PS}', i.e. use passive mode if available, otherwise
+fall back to sendport mode.
+
+@vindex ZFTP_VERBOSE
+@item @t{ZFTP_VERBOSE}
+A string of digits between 0 and 5 inclusive, specifying which
+responses from the server should be printed. All responses go to
+standard error. If any of the numbers 1 to 5 appear in the string,
+raw responses from the server with reply codes beginning with that
+digit will be printed to standard error. The first digit of the three
+digit reply code is defined by RFC959 to correspond to:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item 1.
+A positive preliminary reply.
+
+@item 2.
+A positive completion reply.
+
+@item 3.
+A positive intermediate reply.
+
+@item 4.
+A transient negative completion reply.
+
+@item 5.
+A permanent negative completion reply.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+It should be noted that, for unknown reasons, the reply `Service not
+available', which forces termination of a connection, is classified as
+421, i.e. `transient negative', an interesting interpretation of the word
+`transient'.
+
+@noindent
+The code 0 is special: it indicates that all but the last line of
+multiline replies read from the server will be printed to standard
+error in a processed format. By convention, servers use this
+mechanism for sending information for the user to read. The
+appropriate reply code, if it matches the same response, takes
+priority.
+
+@noindent
+If @t{ZFTP_VERBOSE} is not set when @t{zftp} is loaded, it will be
+set to the default value @t{450}, i.e., messages destined for the user
+and all errors will be printed. A null string is valid and
+specifies that no messages should be printed.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Functions
+@noindent
+@cindex zftp, functions
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex zftp_chpwd, specification
+@item @t{zftp_chpwd}
+If this function is set by the user, it is called every time the
+directory changes on the server, including when a user is logged
+in, or when a connection is closed. In the last case, @t{$ZFTP_PWD}
+will be unset; otherwise it will reflect the new directory.
+
+@findex zftp_progress, specification
+@item @t{zftp_progress}
+If this function is set by the user, it will be called during
+a @t{get}, @t{put} or @t{append} operation each time sufficient data
+has been received from the host. During a @t{get}, the data is sent
+to standard output, so it is vital that this function should write
+to standard error or directly to the terminal, @emph{not} to standard
+output.
+
+@noindent
+When it is called with a transfer in progress, the following
+additional shell parameters are set:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@vindex ZFTP_FILE
+@item @t{ZFTP_FILE}
+The name of the remote file being transferred from or to.
+
+@vindex ZFTP_TRANSFER
+@item @t{ZFTP_TRANSFER}
+A @t{G} for a @t{get} operation and a @t{P} for a @t{put} operation.
+
+@vindex ZFTP_SIZE
+@item @t{ZFTP_SIZE}
+The total size of the complete file being transferred:
+the same as the first value provided by the
+@t{remote} and @t{local} subcommands for a particular file.
+If the server cannot supply this value for a remote file being
+retrieved, it will not be set. If input is from a pipe the value may
+be incorrect and correspond simply to a full pipe buffer.
+
+@vindex ZFTP_COUNT
+@item @t{ZFTP_COUNT}
+The amount of data so far transferred; a number between zero and
+@t{$ZFTP_SIZE}, if that is set. This number is always available.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+The function is initially called with @t{ZFTP_TRANSFER} set
+appropriately and @t{ZFTP_COUNT} set to zero. After the transfer is
+finished, the function will be called one more time with
+@t{ZFTP_TRANSFER} set to @t{GF} or @t{PF}, in case it wishes to tidy
+up. It is otherwise never called twice with the same value of
+@t{ZFTP_COUNT}.
+
+@noindent
+Sometimes the progress meter may cause disruption. It is up to the
+user to decide whether the function should be defined and to use
+@t{unfunction} when necessary.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Problems
+@noindent
+@cindex zftp, problems
+
+@noindent
+A connection may not be opened in the left hand side of a pipe as this
+occurs in a subshell and the file information is not updated in the main
+shell. In the case of type or mode changes or closing the connection in a
+subshell, the information is returned but variables are not updated until
+the next call to @t{zftp}. Other status changes in subshells will not be
+reflected by changes to the variables (but should be otherwise harmless).
+
+@noindent
+Deleting sessions while a @t{zftp} command is active in the background can
+have unexpected effects, even if it does not use the session being deleted.
+This is because all shell subprocesses share information on the state of
+all connections, and deleting a session changes the ordering of that
+information.
+
+@noindent
+On some operating systems, the control connection is not valid after a
+fork(), so that operations in subshells, on the left hand side
+of a pipeline, or in the background are not possible, as they should be.
+This is presumably a bug in the operating system.
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@node The zsh/zle Module, The zsh/zleparameter Module, The zsh/zftp Module, Zsh Modules
+
+@section The zsh/zle Module
+@noindent
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/mod_zle.yo
+
+The @t{zsh/zle} module contains the Zsh Line Editor. See
+@ref{Zsh Line Editor}.
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@node The zsh/zleparameter Module, The zsh/zprof Module, The zsh/zle Module, Zsh Modules
+
+@section The zsh/zleparameter Module
+@noindent
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/mod_zleparameter.yo
+
+@cindex parameters, special
+The @t{zsh/zleparameter} module defines two special parameters that can be
+used to access internal information of the Zsh Line Editor (see
+@ref{Zsh Line Editor}).
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@vindex keymaps
+@item @t{keymaps}
+This array contains the names of the keymaps currently defined.
+
+@vindex widgets
+@item @t{widgets}
+This associative array contains one entry per widget. The name
+of the widget is the key and the value gives information about the
+widget. It is either
+ the string `@t{builtin}' for builtin widgets,
+ a string of the form `@t{user:}@var{name}' for user-defined widgets,
+ where @var{name} is the name of the shell function implementing the widget,
+ a string of the form `@t{completion:}@var{type}@t{:}@var{name}'
+ for completion widgets,
+ or a null value if the widget is not yet fully defined.
+In the penultimate case, @var{type} is the name of the builtin widget the
+completion widget imitates in its behavior and @var{name} is the name
+of the shell function implementing the completion widget.
+
+@end table
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@node The zsh/zprof Module, The zsh/zpty Module, The zsh/zleparameter Module, Zsh Modules
+
+@section The zsh/zprof Module
+@noindent
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/mod_zprof.yo
+
+@cindex functions, profiling
+When loaded, the @t{zsh/zprof} causes shell functions to be profiled.
+The profiling results can be obtained with the @t{zprof}
+builtin command made available by this module. There is no way to turn
+profiling off other than unloading the module.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex zprof
+@item @t{zprof} [ @t{-c} ]
+Without the @t{-c} option, @t{zprof} lists profiling results to
+standard output. The format is comparable to that of commands like
+@t{gprof}.
+
+@noindent
+At the top there is a summary listing all functions that were called
+at least once. This summary is sorted in decreasing order of the
+amount of time spent in each. The lines contain
+the number of the function in order, which is used in
+other parts of the list in suffixes of the form
+`@t{[}@var{num}@t{]}', then the number of calls made to the function.
+The next three columns list the time in
+milliseconds spent in the function and its descendants, the average
+time in milliseconds spent in the function and its descendants per
+call and the percentage of time spent in all shell functions used in
+this function and its descendants. The following three columns give
+the same information, but counting only the time spent in the function
+itself. The final column shows the name of the function.
+
+@noindent
+After the summary, detailed information about every function that was
+invoked is listed, sorted in decreasing order of the amount of time spent
+in each function and its descendants. Each of these entries consists of
+descriptions for the functions that called the function described, the
+function itself, and the functions that were called from it. The
+description for the function itself has the same format as in the summary
+(and shows the same information). The other lines don't show the number of
+the function at the beginning and have their function named indented to
+make it easier to distinguish the line showing the function described in
+the section from the surrounding lines.
+
+@noindent
+The information shown in this case is almost the same as in the summary,
+but only refers to the call hierarchy being displayed. For example, for a
+calling function the column showing the total running time lists the time
+spent in the described function and its descendants only for the times when
+it was called from that particular calling function. Likewise, for a
+called function, this columns lists the total time spent in the called
+function and its descendants only for the times when it was called from the
+function described.
+
+@noindent
+Also in this case, the column showing the number of calls to a function
+also shows a slash and then the total number of invocations made to the
+called function.
+
+@noindent
+As long as the @t{zsh/zprof} module is loaded, profiling will be done and
+multiple invocations of the @t{zprof} builtin command will show the
+times and numbers of calls since the module was loaded. With the
+@t{-c} option, the @t{zprof} builtin command will reset its internal
+counters and will not show the listing.
+
+@end table
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@node The zsh/zpty Module, The zsh/zselect Module, The zsh/zprof Module, Zsh Modules
+
+@section The zsh/zpty Module
+@noindent
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/mod_zpty.yo
+
+The @t{zsh/zpty} module offers one builtin:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex zpty
+@item @t{zpty} [ @t{-e} ] [ @t{-b} ] @var{name} [ @var{arg} ... ]
+The arguments following @var{name} are concatenated with spaces between,
+then executed as a command, as if passed to the @t{eval} builtin. The
+command runs under a newly assigned pseudo-terminal; this is useful for
+running commands non-interactively which expect an interactive
+environment. The @var{name} is not part of the command, but is used to
+refer to this command in later calls to @t{zpty}.
+
+@noindent
+With the @t{-e} option, the pseudo-terminal is set up so that input
+characters are echoed.
+
+@noindent
+With the @t{-b} option, input to and output from the pseudo-terminal are
+made non-blocking.
+
+@noindent
+The shell parameter @t{REPLY} is set to the file descriptor assigned to
+the master side of the pseudo-terminal. This allows the terminal to be
+monitored with ZLE descriptor handlers (see @ref{Zle Builtins}) or manipulated with @t{sysread} and
+@t{syswrite} (see @ref{The zsh/system Module}). @emph{Warning}: Use of @t{sysread}
+and @t{syswrite} is @emph{not} recommended; use @t{zpty -r} and @t{zpty -w}
+unless you know exactly what you are doing.
+
+@item @t{zpty} @t{-d} [ @var{name} ... ]
+The second form, with the @t{-d} option, is used to delete commands
+previously started, by supplying a list of their @var{name}s. If no
+@var{name} is given, all commands are deleted. Deleting a command causes
+the HUP signal to be sent to the corresponding process.
+
+@item @t{zpty} @t{-w} [ @t{-n} ] @var{name} [ @var{string} ... ]
+The @t{-w} option can be used to send the to command @var{name} the given
+@var{string}s as input (separated by spaces). If the @t{-n} option is
+@emph{not} given, a newline is added at the end.
+
+@noindent
+If no @var{string} is provided, the standard input is copied to the
+pseudo-terminal; this may stop before copying the full input if the
+pseudo-terminal is non-blocking. The exact input is always copied:
+the @t{-n} option is not applied.
+
+@noindent
+Note that the command under the pseudo-terminal sees this input as if it
+were typed, so beware when sending special tty driver characters such as
+word-erase, line-kill, and end-of-file.
+
+@item @t{zpty} @t{-r} [ @t{-mt} ] @var{name} [ @var{param} [ @var{pattern} ] ]
+The @t{-r} option can be used to read the output of the command @var{name}.
+With only a @var{name} argument, the output read is copied to the standard
+output. Unless the pseudo-terminal is non-blocking, copying continues
+until the command under the pseudo-terminal exits; when non-blocking, only
+as much output as is immediately available is copied. The return status is
+zero if any output is copied.
+
+@noindent
+When also given a @var{param} argument, at most one line is read and stored
+in the parameter named @var{param}. Less than a full line may be read if
+the pseudo-terminal is non-blocking. The return status is zero if at least
+one character is stored in @var{param}.
+
+@noindent
+If a @var{pattern} is given as well, output is read until the whole string
+read matches the @var{pattern}, even in the non-blocking case. The return
+status is zero if the string read matches the pattern, or if the command
+has exited but at least one character could still be read. If the option
+@t{-m} is present, the return status is zero only if the pattern matches.
+As of this writing, a maximum of one megabyte of output can be consumed
+this way; if a full megabyte is read without matching the pattern, the
+return status is non-zero.
+
+@noindent
+In all cases, the return status is non-zero if nothing could be read, and
+is @t{2} if this is because the command has finished.
+
+@noindent
+If the @t{-r} option is combined with the @t{-t} option, @t{zpty} tests
+whether output is available before trying to read. If no output is
+available, @t{zpty} immediately returns the status @t{1}. When used
+with a @var{pattern}, the behaviour on a failed poll is similar to
+when the command has exited: the return value is zero if at least
+one character could still be read even if the pattern failed to match.
+
+@item @t{zpty} @t{-t} @var{name}
+The @t{-t} option without the @t{-r} option can be used to test
+whether the command @var{name} is still running. It returns a zero
+status if the command is running and a non-zero value otherwise.
+
+@item @t{zpty} [ @t{-L} ]
+The last form, without any arguments, is used to list the commands
+currently defined. If the @t{-L} option is given, this is done in the
+form of calls to the @t{zpty} builtin.
+
+@end table
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@node The zsh/zselect Module, The zsh/zutil Module, The zsh/zpty Module, Zsh Modules
+
+@section The zsh/zselect Module
+@noindent
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/mod_zselect.yo
+
+The @t{zsh/zselect} module makes available one builtin command:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex zselect
+@cindex select, system call
+@cindex file descriptors, waiting for
+@item @t{zselect} [ @t{-rwe} ] [ @t{-t} @var{timeout} ] [ @t{-a} @var{array} ] [ @t{-A} @var{assoc} ] [ @var{fd} ... ]
+The @t{zselect} builtin is a front-end to the `select' system call, which
+blocks until a file descriptor is ready for reading or writing, or has an
+error condition, with an optional timeout. If this is not available on
+your system, the command prints an error message and returns status 2
+(normal errors return status 1). For more information, see your systems
+documentation for man page select(3). Note there is no connection with the
+shell builtin of the same name.
+
+@noindent
+Arguments and options may be intermingled in any order. Non-option
+arguments are file descriptors, which must be decimal integers. By
+default, file descriptors are to be tested for reading, i.e. @t{zselect}
+will return when data is available to be read from the file descriptor, or
+more precisely, when a read operation from the file descriptor will not
+block. After a @t{-r}, @t{-w} and @t{-e}, the given file descriptors are
+to be tested for reading, writing, or error conditions. These options and
+an arbitrary list of file descriptors may be given in any order.
+
+@noindent
+(The presence of an `error condition' is not well defined in the
+documentation for many implementations of the select system call.
+According to recent versions of the POSIX specification, it is really an
+@emph{exception} condition, of which the only standard example is out-of-band
+data received on a socket. So zsh users are unlikely to find the @t{-e}
+option useful.)
+
+@noindent
+The option `@t{-t} @var{timeout}' specifies a timeout in hundredths of a
+second. This may be zero, in which case the file descriptors will simply
+be polled and @t{zselect} will return immediately. It is possible to call
+zselect with no file descriptors and a non-zero timeout for use as a
+finer-grained replacement for `sleep'; note, however, the return status is
+always 1 for a timeout.
+
+@noindent
+The option `@t{-a} @var{array}' indicates that @var{array} should be set to
+indicate the file descriptor(s) which are ready. If the option
+is not
+given, the array @t{reply} will be used for this purpose. The array will
+contain a string similar to the arguments for @t{zselect}. For example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zselect -t 0 -r 0 -w 1
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+might return immediately with status 0 and @t{$reply} containing `@t{-r 0 -w
+1}' to show that both file descriptors are ready for the requested
+operations.
+
+@noindent
+The option `@t{-A} @var{assoc}' indicates that the associative array
+@var{assoc} should be set to indicate the file descriptor(s)
+which are ready. This option overrides the option @t{-a}, nor will
+@t{reply} be modified. The keys of @t{assoc} are the file descriptors, and
+the corresponding values are any of the characters `@t{rwe}' to indicate
+the condition.
+
+@noindent
+The command returns status 0 if some file descriptors are ready for
+reading. If the operation timed out, or a timeout of 0 was given and no
+file descriptors were ready, or there was an error, it returns status 1 and
+the array will not be set (nor modified in any way). If there was an error
+in the select operation the appropriate error message is printed.
+
+@end table
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@node The zsh/zutil Module, , The zsh/zselect Module, Zsh Modules
+
+@section The zsh/zutil Module
+@noindent
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/mod_zutil.yo
+
+@cindex builtins, utility
+The @t{zsh/zutil} module only adds some builtins:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex zstyle
+@item @t{zstyle} [ @t{-L} [ @var{metapattern} [ @var{style} ] ] ]
+@itemx @t{zstyle} [ @t{-e} | @t{-} | @t{-}@t{-} ] @var{pattern} @var{style} @var{string} ...
+@itemx @t{zstyle -d} [ @var{pattern} [ @var{style} ... ] ]
+@itemx @t{zstyle -g} @var{name} [ @var{pattern} [ @var{style} ] ]
+@itemx @t{zstyle -}@{@t{a}|@t{b}|@t{s}@} @var{context} @var{style} @var{name} [ @var{sep} ]
+@itemx @t{zstyle -}@{@t{T}|@t{t}@} @var{context} @var{style} [ @var{string} ... ]
+@itemx @t{zstyle -m} @var{context} @var{style} @var{pattern}
+This builtin command is used to define and lookup styles. Styles are
+pairs of names and values, where the values consist of any number of
+strings. They are stored together with patterns and lookup is done by
+giving a string, called the `@emph{context}', which is matched against the
+patterns. The definition stored for the most specific pattern that matches
+will be returned.
+
+@noindent
+A pattern is considered to be more specific
+than another if it contains more components (substrings separated by
+colons) or if the patterns for the components are more specific, where
+simple strings are considered to be more specific than patterns and
+complex patterns are considered to be more specific than the pattern
+`@t{*}'. A `@t{*}' in the pattern will match zero or more characters
+in the context; colons are not treated specially in this regard.
+If two patterns are equally specific, the tie is broken in favour of
+the pattern that was defined first.
+
+@noindent
+@emph{Example}
+
+@noindent
+For example, to define your preferred form of precipitation depending on which
+city you're in, you might set the following in your @t{zshrc}:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle ':weather:europe:*' preferred-precipitation rain
+zstyle ':weather:europe:germany:* preferred-precipitation none
+zstyle ':weather:europe:germany:*:munich' preferred-precipitation snow
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Then, the fictional `@t{weather}' plugin might run under the hood a command
+such as
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle -s ":weather:$@{continent@}:$@{country@}:$@{county@}:$@{city@}" preferred-precipitation REPLY
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+in order to retrieve your preference into the scalar variable @t{$REPLY}.
+
+@noindent
+@emph{Usage}
+
+@noindent
+The forms that operate on patterns are the following.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{zstyle} [ @t{-L} [ @var{metapattern} [ @var{style} ] ] ]
+Without arguments, lists style definitions. Styles
+are shown in alphabetic order and patterns are shown in the order
+@t{zstyle} will test them.
+
+@noindent
+If the @t{-L} option is given, listing is done in the form of calls to
+@t{zstyle}. The optional first argument, @var{metapattern}, is a pattern which
+will be matched against the string supplied as @var{pattern} when the style was
+defined. Note:
+this means, for example, `@t{zstyle -L ":completion:*"}' will
+match any supplied pattern beginning `@t{:completion:}', not
+just @t{":completion:*"}: use @t{':completion:\*'} to match that.
+The optional second argument limits the output to a specific @var{style} (not a
+pattern). @t{-L} is not compatible with any other options.
+
+@item @t{zstyle} [ @t{-} | @t{-}@t{-} | @t{-e} ] @var{pattern} @var{style} @var{string} ...
+@vindex reply, use of
+Defines the given @var{style} for the @var{pattern} with the @var{string}s as
+the value. If the @t{-e} option is given, the @var{string}s will be
+concatenated (separated by spaces) and the resulting string will be
+evaluated (in the same way as it is done by the @t{eval} builtin
+command) when the style is looked up. In this case the parameter
+`@t{reply}' must be assigned to set the strings returned after the
+evaluation. Before evaluating the value, @t{reply} is unset, and
+if it is still unset after the evaluation, the style is treated as if
+it were not set.
+
+@item @t{zstyle -d} [ @var{pattern} [ @var{style} ... ] ]
+Delete style definitions. Without arguments all definitions are deleted,
+with a @var{pattern} all definitions for that pattern are deleted and if
+any @var{style}s are given, then only those styles are deleted for the
+@var{pattern}.
+
+@item @t{zstyle -g} @var{name} [ @var{pattern} [ @var{style} ] ]
+Retrieve a style definition. The @var{name} is
+used as the name of an array in which the results are stored. Without
+any further arguments, all patterns defined are returned. With a
+@var{pattern} the styles defined for that pattern are returned and with
+both a @var{pattern} and a @var{style}, the value strings of that
+combination is returned.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+The other forms can be used to look up or test styles for a given context.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{zstyle -s} @var{context} @var{style} @var{name} [ @var{sep} ]
+The parameter @var{name} is set to the value of the style interpreted as a
+string. If the value contains several strings they are concatenated with
+spaces (or with the @var{sep} string if that is given) between them.
+
+@noindent
+Return @t{0} if the style is set, @t{1} otherwise.
+
+@item @t{zstyle -b} @var{context} @var{style} @var{name}
+The value is stored in @var{name} as a boolean, i.e. as the string
+`@t{yes}' if the value has only one string and that string is equal to one
+of `@t{yes}', `@t{true}', `@t{on}', or `@t{1}'. If the value is any other
+string or has more than one string, the parameter is set to `@t{no}'.
+
+@noindent
+Return @t{0} if @var{name} is set to `@t{yes}', @t{1} otherwise.
+
+@item @t{zstyle -a} @var{context} @var{style} @var{name}
+The value is stored in @var{name} as an array. If @var{name} is declared
+as an associative array, the first, third, etc. strings are used as the
+keys and the other strings are used as the values.
+
+@noindent
+Return @t{0} if the style is set, @t{1} otherwise.
+
+@item @t{zstyle -t} @var{context} @var{style} [ @var{string} ... ]
+@itemx @t{zstyle -T} @var{context} @var{style} [ @var{string} ... ]
+Test the value of a style, i.e. the @t{-t} option only returns a status
+(sets @t{$?}). Without any @var{string} the return status is zero if the
+style is defined for at least one matching pattern, has only one string in
+its value, and that is equal to one of `@t{true}', `@t{yes}', `@t{on}' or
+`@t{1}'. If any @var{string}s are given the status is zero if and only if
+at least one of the @var{string}s is equal to at least one of the strings
+in the value. If the style is defined but doesn't match, the return status
+is @t{1}. If the style is not defined, the status is @t{2}.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{-T} option tests the values of the style like @t{-t}, but it
+returns status zero (rather than @t{2}) if the style is not defined for any
+matching pattern.
+
+@item @t{zstyle -m} @var{context} @var{style} @var{pattern}
+Match a value. Returns status zero if the
+@var{pattern} matches at least one of the strings in the value.
+
+@end table
+
+@findex zformat
+@item @t{zformat -f} @var{param} @var{format} @var{spec} ...
+@itemx @t{zformat -a} @var{array} @var{sep} @var{spec} ...
+This builtin provides two different forms of formatting. The first form
+is selected with the @t{-f} option. In this case the @var{format}
+string will be modified by replacing sequences starting with a percent
+sign in it with strings from the @var{spec}s. Each @var{spec} should be
+of the form `@var{char}@t{:}@var{string}' which will cause every
+appearance of the sequence `@t{%}@var{char}' in @var{format} to be replaced
+by the @var{string}. The `@t{%}' sequence may also contain optional
+minimum and maximum field width specifications between the `@t{%}' and
+the `@var{char}' in the form `@t{%}@var{min}@t{.}@var{max}@t{c}',
+i.e. the minimum field width is given first and if the maximum field
+width is used, it has to be preceded by a dot. Specifying a minimum field
+width makes the result be padded with spaces to the right if the
+@var{string} is shorter than the requested width. Padding to the left
+can be achieved by giving a negative minimum field width. If a maximum
+field width is specified, the @var{string} will be truncated after that
+many characters. After all `@t{%}' sequences for the given @var{spec}s
+have been processed, the resulting string is stored in the parameter
+@var{param}.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{%}-escapes also understand ternary expressions in the form used by
+prompts. The @t{%} is followed by a `@t{(}' and then an ordinary
+format specifier character as described above. There may be a set of
+digits either before or after the `@t{(}'; these specify a test
+number, which defaults to zero. Negative numbers are also allowed. An
+arbitrary delimiter character follows the format specifier, which is
+followed by a piece of `true' text, the delimiter character again, a piece
+of `false' text, and a closing parenthesis. The complete expression
+(without the digits) thus looks like
+`@t{%(}@var{X}@t{.}@var{text1}@t{.}@var{text2}@t{)}', except that
+the `@t{.}' character is arbitrary. The value given for the format
+specifier in the @var{char}@t{:}@var{string} expressions is evaluated as a
+mathematical expression, and compared with the test number. If they are
+the same, @var{text1} is output, else @var{text2} is output. A parenthesis
+may be escaped in @var{text2} as @t{%)}. Either of @var{text1} or
+@var{text2} may contain nested @t{%}-escapes.
+
+@noindent
+For example:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zformat -f REPLY "The answer is '%3(c.yes.no)'." c:3
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+outputs "The answer is 'yes'." to @t{REPLY} since the value for the format
+specifier @t{c} is 3, agreeing with the digit argument to the ternary
+expression.
+
+@noindent
+The second form, using the @t{-a} option, can be used for aligning
+strings. Here, the @var{spec}s are of the form
+`@var{left}@t{:}@var{right}' where `@var{left}' and `@var{right}' are
+arbitrary strings. These strings are modified by replacing the colons
+by the @var{sep} string and padding the @var{left} strings with spaces
+to the right so that the @var{sep} strings in the result (and hence the
+@var{right} strings after them) are all aligned if the strings are
+printed below each other. All strings without a colon are left
+unchanged and all strings with an empty @var{right} string have the
+trailing colon removed. In both cases the lengths of the strings
+are not used to determine how the other strings are to be aligned.
+A colon in the @var{left} string can be escaped with a backslash.
+The resulting strings are stored in the @var{array}.
+
+@findex zregexparse
+@item @t{zregexparse}
+This implements some internals of the @t{_regex_arguments} function.
+
+@findex zparseopts
+@item @t{zparseopts} [ @t{-D} @t{-E} @t{-F} @t{-K} @t{-M} ] [ @t{-a} @var{array} ] [ @t{-A} @var{assoc} ] [ @t{-} ] @var{spec} ...
+This builtin simplifies the parsing of options in positional parameters,
+i.e. the set of arguments given by @t{$*}. Each @var{spec} describes one
+option and must be of the form `@var{opt}[@t{=}@var{array}]'. If an option
+described by @var{opt} is found in the positional parameters it is copied
+into the @var{array} specified with the @t{-a} option; if the optional
+`@t{=}@var{array}' is given, it is instead copied into that array, which
+should be declared as a normal array and never as an associative array.
+
+@noindent
+Note that it is an error to give any @var{spec} without an
+`@t{=}@var{array}' unless one of the @t{-a} or @t{-A} options is used.
+
+@noindent
+Unless the @t{-E} option is given, parsing stops at the first string
+that isn't described by one of the @var{spec}s. Even with @t{-E},
+parsing always stops at a positional parameter equal to `@t{-}' or
+`@t{-}@t{-}'. See also @t{-F}.
+
+@noindent
+The @var{opt} description must be one of the following. Any of the special
+characters can appear in the option name provided it is preceded by a
+backslash.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @var{name}
+@itemx @var{name}@t{+}
+The @var{name} is the name of the option without the leading `@t{-}'. To
+specify a GNU-style long option, one of the usual two leading `@t{-}' must
+be included in @var{name}; for example, a `@t{-}@t{-file}' option is
+represented by a @var{name} of `@t{-file}'.
+
+@noindent
+If a `@t{+}' appears after @var{name}, the option is appended to @var{array}
+each time it is found in the positional parameters; without the `@t{+}'
+only the @emph{last} occurrence of the option is preserved.
+
+@noindent
+If one of these forms is used, the option takes no argument, so parsing
+stops if the next positional parameter does not also begin with `@t{-}'
+(unless the @t{-E} option is used).
+
+@item @var{name}@t{:}
+@itemx @var{name}@t{:-}
+@itemx @var{name}@t{::}
+If one or two colons are given, the option takes an argument; with one
+colon, the argument is mandatory and with two colons it is optional. The
+argument is appended to the @var{array} after the option itself.
+
+@noindent
+An optional argument is put into the same array element as the option name
+(note that this makes empty strings as arguments indistinguishable). A
+mandatory argument is added as a separate element unless the `@t{:-}' form
+is used, in which case the argument is put into the same element.
+
+@noindent
+A `@t{+}' as described above may appear between the @var{name} and the
+first colon.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+In all cases, option-arguments must appear either immediately following the
+option in the same positional parameter or in the next one. Even an optional
+argument may appear in the next parameter, unless it begins with a `@t{-}'.
+There is no special handling of `@t{=}' as with GNU-style argument parsers;
+given the @var{spec} `@t{-foo:}', the positional parameter `@t{-}@t{-foo=bar}'
+is parsed as `@t{-}@t{-foo}' with an argument of `@t{=bar}'.
+
+@noindent
+When the names of two options that take no arguments overlap, the longest one
+wins, so that parsing for the @var{spec}s `@t{-foo -foobar}' (for example) is
+unambiguous. However, due to the aforementioned handling of option-arguments,
+ambiguities may arise when at least one overlapping @var{spec} takes an
+argument, as in `@t{-foo: -foobar}'. In that case, the last matching
+@var{spec} wins.
+
+@noindent
+The options of @t{zparseopts} itself cannot be stacked because, for
+example, the stack `@t{-DEK}' is indistinguishable from a @var{spec} for
+the GNU-style long option `@t{-}@t{-DEK}'. The options of @t{zparseopts}
+itself are:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{-a} @var{array}
+As described above, this names the default array in which to store the
+recognised options.
+
+@item @t{-A} @var{assoc}
+If this is given, the options and their values are also put into an
+associative array with the option names as keys and the arguments (if any)
+as the values.
+
+@item @t{-D}
+If this option is given, all options found are removed from the positional
+parameters of the calling shell or shell function, up to but not including
+any not described by the @var{spec}s. If the first such parameter is `@t{-}'
+or `@t{-}@t{-}', it is removed as well. This is similar to using the
+@t{shift} builtin.
+
+@item @t{-E}
+This changes the parsing rules to @emph{not} stop at the first string
+that isn't described by one of the @var{spec}s. It can be used to test
+for or (if used together with @t{-D}) extract options and their
+arguments, ignoring all other options and arguments that may be in the
+positional parameters. As indicated above, parsing still stops at the
+first `@t{-}' or `@t{-}@t{-}' not described by a @var{spec}, but it is not
+removed when used with @t{-D}.
+
+@item @t{-F}
+If this option is given, @t{zparseopts} immediately stops at the first
+option-like parameter not described by one of the @var{spec}s, prints an
+error message, and returns status 1. Removal (@t{-D}) and extraction
+(@t{-E}) are not performed, and option arrays are not updated. This
+provides basic validation for the given options.
+
+@noindent
+Note that the appearance in the positional parameters of an option without
+its required argument always aborts parsing and returns an error as described
+above regardless of whether this option is used.
+
+@item @t{-K}
+With this option, the arrays specified with the @t{-a} option and with the
+`@t{=}@var{array}' forms are kept unchanged when none of the @var{spec}s for
+them is used. Otherwise the entire array is replaced when any of the
+@var{spec}s is used. Individual elements of associative arrays specified
+with the @t{-A} option are preserved by @t{-K}. This allows assignment of
+default values to arrays before calling @t{zparseopts}.
+
+@item @t{-M}
+This changes the assignment rules to implement a map among equivalent
+option names. If any @var{spec} uses the `@t{=}@var{array}' form, the
+string @var{array} is interpreted as the name of another @var{spec},
+which is used to choose where to store the values. If no other @var{spec}
+is found, the values are stored as usual. This changes only the way the
+values are stored, not the way @t{$*} is parsed, so results may be
+unpredictable if the `@var{name}@t{+}' specifier is used inconsistently.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+For example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+set -- -a -bx -c y -cz baz -cend
+zparseopts a=foo b:=bar c+:=bar
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+will have the effect of
+
+@noindent
+@example
+foo=(-a)
+bar=(-b x -c y -c z)
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The arguments from `@t{baz}' on will not be used.
+
+@noindent
+As an example for the @t{-E} option, consider:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+set -- -a x -b y -c z arg1 arg2
+zparseopts -E -D b:=bar
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+will have the effect of
+
+@noindent
+@example
+bar=(-b y)
+set -- -a x -c z arg1 arg2
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+I.e., the option @t{-b} and its arguments are taken from the
+positional parameters and put into the array @t{bar}.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{-M} option can be used like this:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+set -- -a -bx -c y -cz baz -cend
+zparseopts -A bar -M a=foo b+: c:=b
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+to have the effect of
+
+@noindent
+@example
+foo=(-a)
+bar=(-a @value{dsq} -b xyz)
+@end example
+
+@end table
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/calsys.yo
+@node Calendar Function System, TCP Function System, Zsh Modules, Top
+
+@chapter Calendar Function System
+@noindent
+@cindex calendar function system
+@cindex zsh/datetime, function system based on
+
+@section Description
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+The shell is supplied with a series of functions to replace and enhance the
+traditional Unix @t{calendar} programme, which warns the user of imminent
+or future events, details of which are stored in a text file (typically
+@t{calendar} in the user's home directory). The version provided here
+includes a mechanism for alerting the user when an event is due.
+
+@noindent
+In addition functions @t{age}, @t{before} and @t{after} are provided
+that can be used in a glob qualifier; they allow files to be selected
+based on their modification times.
+
+@noindent
+The format of the @t{calendar} file and the dates used there in and in
+the @t{age} function are described first, then the functions that can
+be called to examine and modify the @t{calendar} file.
+
+@noindent
+The functions here depend on the availability of the @t{zsh/datetime}
+module which is usually installed with the shell. The library function
+@t{strptime()} must be available; it is present on most recent
+operating systems.
+
+@noindent
+@menu
+* Calendar File and Date Formats::
+* Calendar System User Functions::
+* Calendar Styles::
+* Calendar Utility Functions::
+* Calendar Bugs::
+@end menu
+
+@noindent
+@node Calendar File and Date Formats, Calendar System User Functions, , Calendar Function System
+
+@section File and Date Formats
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Calendar File Format
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+The calendar file is by default @t{~/calendar}. This can be configured
+by the @t{calendar-file} style, see
+@ref{Calendar Styles}. The basic format consists
+of a series of separate lines, with no indentation, each including
+a date and time specification followed by a description of the event.
+
+@noindent
+Various enhancements to this format are supported, based on the syntax
+of Emacs calendar mode. An indented line indicates a continuation line
+that continues the description of the event from the preceding line
+(note the date may not be continued in this way). An initial ampersand
+(@t{&}) is ignored for compatibility.
+
+@noindent
+An indented line on which the first non-whitespace character is @t{#}
+is not displayed with the calendar entry, but is still scanned for
+information. This can be used to hide information useful to the
+calendar system but not to the user, such as the unique identifier
+used by @t{calendar_add}.
+
+@noindent
+The Emacs extension that a date with no description may refer to a number
+of succeeding events at different times is not supported.
+
+@noindent
+Unless the @t{done-file} style has been altered, any events which
+have been processed are appended to the file with the same name as the
+calendar file with the suffix @t{.done}, hence @t{~/calendar.done} by
+default.
+
+@noindent
+An example is shown below.
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Date Format
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+The format of the date and time is designed to allow flexibility without
+admitting ambiguity. (The words `date' and `time' are both used in the
+documentation below; except where specifically noted this implies a string
+that may include both a date and a time specification.) Note that there is
+no localization support; month and day names must be in English and
+separator characters are fixed. Matching is case insensitive, and only the
+first three letters of the names are significant, although as a special
+case a form beginning "month" does not match "Monday". Furthermore, time
+zones are not handled; all times are assumed to be local.
+
+@noindent
+It is recommended that, rather than exploring the intricacies of the
+system, users find a date format that is natural to them and stick to it.
+This will avoid unexpected effects. Various key facts should be noted.
+
+@noindent
+@itemize @bullet
+
+@item
+In particular, note the confusion between
+@var{month}@t{/}@var{day}@t{/}@var{year} and
+@var{day}@t{/}@var{month}@t{/}@var{year} when the month is numeric; these
+formats should be avoided if at all possible. Many alternatives are
+available.
+@item
+The year must be given in full to avoid confusion, and only years
+from 1900 to 2099 inclusive are matched.
+@end itemize
+
+@noindent
+The following give some obvious examples; users finding here
+a format they like and not subject to vagaries of style may skip
+the full description. As dates and times are matched separately
+(even though the time may be embedded in the date), any date format
+may be mixed with any format for the time of day provide the
+separators are clear (whitespace, colons, commas).
+
+@noindent
+@example
+2007/04/03 13:13
+2007/04/03:13:13
+2007/04/03 1:13 pm
+3rd April 2007, 13:13
+April 3rd 2007 1:13 p.m.
+Apr 3, 2007 13:13
+Tue Apr 03 13:13:00 2007
+13:13 2007/apr/3
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+More detailed rules follow.
+
+@noindent
+Times are parsed and extracted before dates. They must use colons
+to separate hours and minutes, though a dot is allowed before seconds
+if they are present. This limits time formats to the following:
+
+@noindent
+@itemize @bullet
+
+@item
+@var{HH}@t{:}@var{MM}[@t{:}@var{SS}[@t{.}@var{FFFFF}]] [@t{am}|@t{pm}|@t{a.m.}|@t{p.m.}]
+@item
+@var{HH}@t{:}@var{MM}@t{.}@var{SS}[@t{.}@var{FFFFF}] [@t{am}|@t{pm}|@t{a.m.}|@t{p.m.}]
+@end itemize
+
+@noindent
+Here, square brackets indicate optional elements, possibly with
+alternatives. Fractions of a second are recognised but ignored. For
+absolute times (the normal format require by the @t{calendar} file and the
+@t{age}, @t{before} and @t{after} functions) a date is mandatory but a
+time of day is not; the time returned is at the start of the date. One
+variation is allowed: if @t{a.m.} or @t{p.m.} or one of their variants
+is present, an hour without a minute is allowed, e.g. @t{3 p.m.}.
+
+@noindent
+Time zones are not handled, though if one is matched following a time
+specification it will be removed to allow a surrounding date to be
+parsed. This only happens if the format of the timezone is not too
+unusual. The following are examples of forms that are understood:
+
+@noindent
+@example
++0100
+GMT
+GMT-7
+CET+1CDT
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Any part of the timezone that is not numeric must have exactly three
+capital letters in the name.
+
+@noindent
+Dates suffer from the ambiguity between @var{DD}@t{/}@var{MM}@t{/}@var{YYYY}
+and @var{MM}@t{/}@var{DD}@t{/}@var{YYYY}. It is recommended this form is
+avoided with purely numeric dates, but use of ordinals,
+eg. @t{3rd/04/2007}, will resolve the ambiguity as the ordinal is always
+parsed as the day of the month. Years must be four digits (and the first
+two must be @t{19} or @t{20}); @t{03/04/08} is not recognised. Other
+numbers may have leading zeroes, but they are not required. The following
+are handled:
+
+@noindent
+@itemize @bullet
+
+@item
+@var{YYYY}@t{/}@var{MM}@t{/}@var{DD}
+@item
+@var{YYYY}@t{-}@var{MM}@t{-}@var{DD}
+@item
+@var{YYYY}@t{/}@var{MNM}@t{/}@var{DD}
+@item
+@var{YYYY}@t{-}@var{MNM}@t{-}@var{DD}
+@item
+@var{DD}[@t{th}|@t{st}|@t{rd}] @var{MNM}[@t{,}] [ @var{YYYY} ]
+@item
+@var{MNM} @var{DD}[@t{th}|@t{st}|@t{rd}][@t{,}] [ @var{YYYY} ]
+@item
+@var{DD}[@t{th}|@t{st}|@t{rd}]@t{/}@var{MM}[@t{,}] @var{YYYY}
+@item
+@var{DD}[@t{th}|@t{st}|@t{rd}]@t{/}@var{MM}@t{/}@var{YYYY}
+@item
+@var{MM}@t{/}@var{DD}[@t{th}|@t{st}|@t{rd}][@t{,}] @var{YYYY}
+@item
+@var{MM}@t{/}@var{DD}[@t{th}|@t{st}|@t{rd}]@t{/}@var{YYYY}
+@end itemize
+
+@noindent
+Here, @var{MNM} is at least the first three letters of a month name,
+matched case-insensitively. The remainder of the month name may appear but
+its contents are irrelevant, so janissary, febrile, martial, apricot,
+maybe, junta, etc. are happily handled.
+
+@noindent
+Where the year is shown as optional, the current year is assumed. There
+are only two such cases, the form @t{Jun 20} or @t{14 September} (the only
+two commonly occurring forms, apart from a "the" in some forms of English,
+which isn't currently supported). Such dates will of course become
+ambiguous in the future, so should ideally be avoided.
+
+@noindent
+Times may follow dates with a colon, e.g. @t{1965/07/12:09:45}; this is in
+order to provide a format with no whitespace. A comma and whitespace are
+allowed, e.g. @t{1965/07/12, 09:45}. Currently the order of these
+separators is not checked, so illogical formats such as @t{1965/07/12, :
+,09:45} will also be matched. For simplicity such variations are not shown
+in the list above. Otherwise, a time is only recognised as being
+associated with a date if there is only whitespace in between, or if the
+time was embedded in the date.
+
+@noindent
+Days of the week are not normally scanned, but will be ignored if they
+occur at the start of the date pattern only. However, in contexts where it
+is useful to specify dates relative to today, days of the week with no
+other date specification may be given. The day is assumed to be either
+today or within the past week. Likewise, the words @t{yesterday},
+@t{today} and @t{tomorrow} are handled. All matches are case-insensitive.
+Hence if today is Monday, then @t{Sunday} is equivalent to @t{yesterday},
+@t{Monday} is equivalent to @t{today}, but @t{Tuesday} gives a date six
+days ago. This is not generally useful within the calendar file.
+Dates in this format may be combined with a time specification; for
+example @t{Tomorrow, 8 p.m.}.
+
+@noindent
+For example, the standard date format:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+Fri Aug 18 17:00:48 BST 2006
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+is handled by matching @var{HH}@t{:}@var{MM}@t{:}@var{SS} and removing it
+together with the matched (but unused) time zone. This leaves the following:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+Fri Aug 18 2006
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+@t{Fri} is ignored and the rest is matched according to the standard rules.
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Relative Time Format
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+In certain places relative times are handled. Here, a date is not allowed;
+instead a combination of various supported periods are allowed, together
+with an optional time. The periods must be in order from most to
+least significant.
+
+@noindent
+In some cases, a more accurate calculation is possible when there is an
+anchor date: offsets of months or years pick the correct day, rather than
+being rounded, and it is possible to pick a particular day in a month as
+`(1st Friday)', etc., as described in more detail below.
+
+@noindent
+Anchors are available in the following cases. If one or two times are
+passed to the function @t{calendar}, the start time acts an anchor for the
+end time when the end time is relative (even if the start time is
+implicit). When examining calendar files, the scheduled event being
+examined anchors the warning time when it is given explicitly by means of
+the @t{WARN} keyword; likewise, the scheduled event anchors a repetition
+period when given by the @t{RPT} keyword, so that specifications such as
+@t{RPT 2 months, 3rd Thursday} are handled properly. Finally, the @t{-R}
+argument to @t{calendar_scandate} directly provides an anchor for relative
+calculations.
+
+@noindent
+The periods handled, with possible abbreviations are:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item Years
+@t{years}, @t{yrs}, @t{ys}, @t{year}, @t{yr}, @t{y}, @t{yearly}.
+A year is 365.25 days unless there is an anchor.
+
+@item Months
+@t{months}, @t{mons}, @t{mnths}, @t{mths}, @t{month}, @t{mon},
+@t{mnth}, @t{mth}, @t{monthly}. Note that @t{m}, @t{ms}, @t{mn}, @t{mns}
+are ambiguous and are @emph{not} handled. A month is a period
+of 30 days rather than a calendar month unless there is an anchor.
+
+@item Weeks
+@t{weeks}, @t{wks}, @t{ws}, @t{week}, @t{wk}, @t{w}, @t{weekly}
+
+@item Days
+@t{days}, @t{dys}, @t{ds}, @t{day}, @t{dy}, @t{d}, @t{daily}
+
+@item Hours
+@t{hours}, @t{hrs}, @t{hs}, @t{hour}, @t{hr}, @t{h}, @t{hourly}
+
+@item Minutes
+@t{minutes}, @t{mins}, @t{minute}, @t{min}, but @emph{not} @t{m},
+@t{ms}, @t{mn} or @t{mns}
+
+@item Seconds
+@t{seconds}, @t{secs}, @t{ss}, @t{second}, @t{sec}, @t{s}
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+Spaces between the numbers are optional, but are required between items,
+although a comma may be used (with or without spaces).
+
+@noindent
+The forms @t{yearly} to @t{hourly} allow the number to be omitted; it is
+assumed to be 1. For example, @t{1 d} and @t{daily} are equivalent. Note
+that using those forms with plurals is confusing; @t{2 yearly} is the same
+as @t{2 years}, @emph{not} twice yearly, so it is recommended they only
+be used without numbers.
+
+@noindent
+When an anchor time is present, there is an extension to handle regular
+events in the form of the @var{n}th @var{some}day of the month. Such a
+specification must occur immediately after any year and month
+specification, but before any time of day, and must be in the form
+@var{n}(@t{th}|@t{st}|@t{rd}) @var{day}, for example @t{1st Tuesday} or
+@t{3rd Monday}. As in other places, days are matched case insensitively,
+must be in English, and only the first three letters are significant except
+that a form beginning `month' does not match `Monday'. No attempt is made
+to sanitize the resulting date; attempts to squeeze too many occurrences
+into a month will push the day into the next month (but in the obvious
+fashion, retaining the correct day of the week).
+
+@noindent
+Here are some examples:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+30 years 3 months 4 days 3:42:41
+14 days 5 hours
+Monthly, 3rd Thursday
+4d,10hr
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Example
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+Here is an example calendar file. It uses a consistent date format,
+as recommended above.
+
+@noindent
+@example
+Feb 1, 2006 14:30 Pointless bureaucratic meeting
+Mar 27, 2006 11:00 Mutual recrimination and finger pointing
+ Bring water pistol and waterproofs
+Mar 31, 2006 14:00 Very serious managerial pontification
+ # UID 12C7878A9A50
+Apr 10, 2006 13:30 Even more pointless blame assignment exercise WARN 30 mins
+May 18, 2006 16:00 Regular moaning session RPT monthly, 3rd Thursday
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The second entry has a continuation line. The third entry has a
+continuation line that will not be shown when the entry is displayed, but
+the unique identifier will be used by the @t{calendar_add} function when
+updating the event. The fourth entry will produce a warning 30 minutes
+before the event (to allow you to equip yourself appropriately). The fifth
+entry repeats after a month on the 3rd Thursday, i.e. June 15, 2006, at the
+same time.
+
+@noindent
+@node Calendar System User Functions, Calendar Styles, Calendar File and Date Formats, Calendar Function System
+
+@section User Functions
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+This section describes functions that are designed to be called
+directly by the user. The first part describes those functions
+associated with the user's calendar; the second part describes
+the use in glob qualifiers.
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Calendar system functions
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex calendar
+
+@item @t{calendar }[ @t{-abdDsv} ] [ @t{-C} @var{calfile} ] [ @t{-n} @var{num} ] [ @t{-S} @var{showprog} ]
+@itemx @t{@ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ }[ [ @var{start} ] @var{end} ]
+@itemx @t{calendar -r} [ @t{-abdDrsv} ] [ @t{-C} @var{calfile} ] [ @t{-n} @var{num} ] [ @t{-S} @var{showprog} ]
+@itemx @t{@ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ }[ @var{start} ]
+Show events in the calendar.
+
+@noindent
+With no arguments, show events from the start of today until the end of
+the next working day after today. In other words, if today is Friday,
+Saturday, or Sunday, show up to the end of the following Monday, otherwise
+show today and tomorrow.
+
+@noindent
+If @var{end} is given, show events from the start of today up to the time
+and date given, which is in the format described in the previous section.
+Note that if this is a date the time is assumed to be midnight at the
+start of the date, so that effectively this shows all events before
+the given date.
+
+@noindent
+@var{end} may start with a @t{+}, in which case the remainder of the
+specification is a relative time format as described in the previous
+section indicating the range of time from the start time that is to
+be included.
+
+@noindent
+If @var{start} is also given, show events starting from that time and date.
+The word @t{now} can be used to indicate the current time.
+
+@noindent
+To implement an alert when events are due, include @t{calendar -s} in your
+@t{~/.zshrc} file.
+
+@noindent
+Options:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{-a}
+Show all items in the calendar, regardless of the @t{start} and
+@t{end}.
+
+@item @t{-b}
+Brief: don't display continuation lines (i.e. indented lines following
+the line with the date/time), just the first line.
+
+@item @t{-B} @var{lines}
+Brief: display at most the first @var{lines} lines of the calendar
+entry. `@t{-B 1}' is equivalent to `@t{-b}'.
+
+@item @t{-C} @var{calfile}
+Explicitly specify a calendar file instead of the value of
+the @t{calendar-file} style or the default @t{~/calendar}.
+
+@item @t{-d}
+Move any events that have passed from the calendar file to the
+"done" file, as given by the @t{done-file} style or the default
+which is the calendar file with @t{.done} appended. This option
+is implied by the @t{-s} option.
+
+@item @t{-D}
+Turns off the option @t{-d}, even if the @t{-s} option is also present.
+
+@item @t{-n} @var{num}, @t{-}@var{num}
+Show at least @var{num} events, if present in the calendar file, regardless
+of the @t{start} and @t{end}.
+
+@item @t{-r}
+Show all the remaining options in the calendar, ignoring the given @var{end}
+time. The @var{start} time is respected; any argument given is treated
+as a @var{start} time.
+
+@item @t{-s}
+Use the shell's @t{sched} command to schedule a timed event that
+will warn the user when an event is due. Note that the @t{sched} command
+only runs if the shell is at an interactive prompt; a foreground task
+blocks the scheduled task from running until it is finished.
+
+@noindent
+The timed event usually runs the programme @t{calendar_show} to show
+the event, as described in
+@ref{Calendar Utility Functions}.
+
+@noindent
+By default, a warning of the event is shown five minutes before it is due.
+The warning period can be configured by the style @t{warn-time} or
+for a single calendar entry by including @t{WARN} @var{reltime} in the first
+line of the entry, where @var{reltime} is one of the usual relative time
+formats.
+
+@noindent
+A repeated event may be indicated by including @t{RPT} @var{reldate} in the
+first line of the entry. After the scheduled event has been displayed
+it will be re-entered into the calendar file at a time @var{reldate}
+after the existing event. Note that this is currently the only use
+made of the repeat count, so that it is not possible to query the schedule
+for a recurrence of an event in the calendar until the previous event
+has passed.
+
+@noindent
+If @t{RPT} is used, it is also possible to specify that certain
+recurrences of an event are rescheduled or cancelled. This is
+done with the @t{OCCURRENCE} keyword, followed by whitespace and the
+date and time of the occurrence in the regular sequence, followed by
+whitespace and either the date and time of the rescheduled event or
+the exact string @t{CANCELLED}. In this case the date and time must
+be in exactly the "date with local time" format used by the
+@t{text/calendar} MIME type (RFC 2445),
+@var{<YYYY><MM><DD>}@t{T}@var{<hh><mm><ss>} (note the presence of the literal
+character @t{T}). The first word (the regular recurrence) may be
+something other than a proper date/time to indicate that the event
+is additional to the normal sequence; a convention that retains
+the formatting appearance is @t{XXXXXXXXTXXXXXX}.
+
+@noindent
+Furthermore, it is useful to record the next regular recurrence
+(as then the displayed date may be for a rescheduled event so cannot
+be used for calculating the regular sequence). This is specified by
+@t{RECURRENCE} and a time or date in the same format. @t{calendar_add}
+adds such an indication when it encounters a recurring event that does not
+include one, based on the headline date/time.
+
+@noindent
+If @t{calendar_add} is used to update occurrences the @t{UID} keyword
+described there should be present in both the existing entry and the added
+occurrence in order to identify recurring event sequences.
+
+@noindent
+For example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+Thu May 6, 2010 11:00 Informal chat RPT 1 week
+ # RECURRENCE 20100506T110000
+ # OCCURRENCE 20100513T110000 20100513T120000
+ # OCCURRENCE 20100520T110000 CANCELLED
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The event that occurs at 11:00 on 13th May 2010 is rescheduled an hour
+later. The event that occurs a week later is cancelled. The occurrences
+are given on a continuation line starting with a @t{#} character so will
+not usually be displayed as part of the event. As elsewhere, no account of
+time zones is taken with the times. After the next event occurs the headline
+date/time will be `@t{Thu May 13, 2010 12:00}' while the @t{RECURRENCE}
+date/time will be `@t{20100513T110000}' (note that cancelled and
+moved events are not taken account of in the @t{RECURRENCE}, which
+records what the next regular recurrence is, but they are accounted for in
+the headline date/time).
+
+@noindent
+It is safe to run @t{calendar -s} to reschedule an existing event
+(if the calendar file has changed, for example), and also to have it
+running in multiples instances of the shell since the calendar file
+is locked when in use.
+
+@noindent
+By default, expired events are moved to the "done" file; see the @t{-d}
+option. Use @t{-D} to prevent this.
+
+@item @t{-S} @var{showprog}
+Explicitly specify a programme to be used for showing events instead
+of the value of the @t{show-prog} style or the default @t{calendar_show}.
+
+@item @t{-v}
+Verbose: show more information about stages of processing. This
+is useful for confirming that the function has successfully parsed
+the dates in the calendar file.
+
+@end table
+
+@findex calendar_add
+@item @t{calendar_add} [ @t{-BL} ] @var{event} ...
+Adds a single event to the calendar in the appropriate location.
+The event can contain multiple lines, as described in
+@ref{Calendar File and Date Formats}.
+Using this function ensures that the calendar file is sorted in date
+and time order. It also makes special arrangements for locking
+the file while it is altered. The old calendar is left in a file
+with the suffix @t{.old}.
+
+@noindent
+The option @t{-B} indicates that backing up the calendar file will be
+handled by the caller and should not be performed by @t{calendar_add}. The
+option @t{-L} indicates that @t{calendar_add} does not need to lock the
+calendar file as it is already locked. These options will not usually be
+needed by users.
+
+@noindent
+If the style @t{reformat-date} is true, the date and time of the
+new entry will be rewritten into the standard date format: see
+the descriptions of this style and the style @t{date-format}.
+
+@noindent
+The function can use a unique identifier stored with each event to ensure
+that updates to existing events are treated correctly. The entry
+should contain the word @t{UID}, followed by whitespace, followed by
+a word consisting entirely of hexadecimal digits of arbitrary length
+(all digits are significant, including leading zeroes). As the UID
+is not directly useful to the user, it is convenient to hide it on
+an indented continuation line starting with a @t{#}, for example:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+Aug 31, 2007 09:30 Celebrate the end of the holidays
+ # UID 045B78A0
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The second line will not be shown by the @t{calendar} function.
+
+@noindent
+It is possible to specify the @t{RPT} keyword followed by @t{CANCELLED}
+instead of a relative time. This causes any matched event or series
+of events to be cancelled (the original event does not have to be marked
+as recurring in order to be cancelled by this method). A @t{UID} is
+required in order to match an existing event in the calendar.
+
+@noindent
+@t{calendar_add} will attempt to manage recurrences and occurrences of
+repeating events as described for event scheduling by @t{calendar -s}
+above. To reschedule or cancel a single event @t{calendar_add} should be
+called with an entry that includes the correct @t{UID} but does @emph{not}
+include the @t{RPT} keyword as this is taken to mean the entry applies to a
+series of repeating events and hence replaces all existing information.
+Each rescheduled or cancelled occurrence must have an @t{OCCURRENCE}
+keyword in the entry passed to @t{calendar_add} which will be merged into
+the calendar file. Any existing reference to the occurrence is replaced.
+An occurrence that does not refer to a valid existing event is added as a
+one-off occurrence to the same calendar entry.
+
+@findex calendar_edit
+@item @t{calendar_edit}
+This calls the user's editor to edit the calendar file. If
+there are arguments, they are taken as the editor to use (the file name
+is appended to the commands); otherwise, the editor is given by the
+variable @t{VISUAL}, if set, else the variable @t{EDITOR}.
+
+@noindent
+If the calendar scheduler was running, then after editing the file
+@t{calendar -s} is called to update it.
+
+@noindent
+This function locks out the calendar system during the edit.
+Hence it should be used to edit the calendar file if there is any
+possibility of a calendar event occurring meanwhile. Note this
+can lead to another shell with calendar functions enabled hanging waiting
+for a lock, so it is necessary to quit the editor as soon as possible.
+
+@findex calendar_parse
+@item @t{calendar_parse} @var{calendar-entry}
+This is the internal function that analyses the parts of a calendar
+entry, which is passed as the only argument. The function returns
+status 1 if the argument could not be parsed as a calendar entry
+and status 2 if the wrong number of arguments were passed; it also sets the
+parameter @t{reply} to an empty associative array. Otherwise,
+it returns status 0 and sets elements of the associative
+array @t{reply} as follows:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{time}
+The time as a string of digits in the same units as
+@t{$EPOCHSECONDS}
+@item @t{schedtime}
+The regularly scheduled time. This may differ from
+the actual event time @t{time} if this is a recurring event and the next
+occurrence has been rescheduled. Then @t{time} gives the actual time
+and @t{schedtime} the time of the regular recurrence before modification.
+@item @t{text1}
+The text from the line not including the date and time of the
+event, but including any @t{WARN} or @t{RPT} keywords and values.
+@item @t{warntime}
+Any warning time given by the @t{WARN} keyword as a string
+of digits containing the time at which to warn in the same units as
+@t{$EPOCHSECONDS}. (Note this is an absolute time, not the relative time
+passed down.) Not set no @t{WARN} keyword and value were
+matched.
+@item @t{warnstr}
+The raw string matched after the @t{WARN} keyword, else unset.
+@item @t{rpttime}
+Any recurrence time given by the @t{RPT} keyword as a string
+of digits containing the time of the recurrence in the same units
+as @t{$EPOCHSECONDS}. (Note this is an absolute time.) Not set if
+no @t{RPT} keyword and value were matched.
+@item @t{schedrpttime}
+The next regularly scheduled occurrence of a recurring
+event before modification. This may differ from @t{rpttime}, which is the
+actual time of the event that may have been rescheduled from the regular
+time.
+@item @t{rptstr}
+The raw string matched after the @t{RPT} keyword, else unset.
+@item @t{text2}
+The text from the line after removal of the date and any
+keywords and values.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+@findex calendar_showdate
+@item @t{calendar_showdate} [ @t{-r} ] [ @t{-f} @var{fmt} ] @var{date-spec} ...
+The given @var{date-spec} is interpreted and the corresponding date and
+time printed. If the initial @var{date-spec} begins with a @t{+} or
+@t{-} it is treated as relative to the current time; @var{date-spec}s after
+the first are treated as relative to the date calculated so far and
+a leading @t{+} is optional in that case. This allows one to
+use the system as a date calculator. For example, @t{calendar_showdate '+1
+month, 1st Friday'} shows the date of the first Friday of next month.
+
+@noindent
+With the option @t{-r} nothing is printed but the value of the date and
+time in seconds since the epoch is stored in the parameter @t{REPLY}.
+
+@noindent
+With the option @t{-f} @var{fmt} the given date/time conversion format
+is passed to @t{strftime}; see notes on the @t{date-format} style below.
+
+@noindent
+In order to avoid ambiguity with negative relative date specifications,
+options must occur in separate words; in other words, @t{-r} and @t{-f}
+should not be combined in the same word.
+
+@findex calendar_sort
+@item @t{calendar_sort}
+Sorts the calendar file into date and time order. The old calendar is
+left in a file with the suffix @t{.old}.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Glob qualifiers
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{age}
+@findex age
+The function @t{age} can be autoloaded and use separately from
+the calendar system, although it uses the function @t{calendar_scandate}
+for date formatting. It requires the @t{zsh/stat} builtin, but uses
+only the builtin @t{zstat}.
+
+@noindent
+@t{age} selects files having a given modification time for use
+as a glob qualifier. The format of the date is the same as that
+understood by the calendar system, described in
+@ref{Calendar File and Date Formats}.
+
+@noindent
+The function can take one or two arguments, which can be supplied either
+directly as command or arguments, or separately as shell parameters.
+
+@noindent
+@example
+print *(e:age 2006/10/04 2006/10/09:)
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The example above matches all files modified between the start of those
+dates. The second argument may alternatively be a relative time
+introduced by a @t{+}:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+print *(e:age 2006/10/04 +5d:)
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The example above is equivalent to the previous example.
+
+@noindent
+In addition to the special use of days of the week, @t{today} and
+@t{yesterday}, times with no date may be specified; these apply to today.
+Obviously such uses become problematic around midnight.
+
+@noindent
+@example
+print *(e-age 12:00 13:30-)
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The example above shows files modified between 12:00 and 13:00 today.
+
+@noindent
+@example
+print *(e:age 2006/10/04:)
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The example above matches all files modified on that date. If the second
+argument is omitted it is taken to be exactly 24 hours after the first
+argument (even if the first argument contains a time).
+
+@noindent
+@example
+print *(e-age 2006/10/04:10:15 2006/10/04:10:45-)
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The example above supplies times. Note that whitespace within the time and
+date specification must be quoted to ensure @t{age} receives the correct
+arguments, hence the use of the additional colon to separate the date and
+time.
+
+@noindent
+@example
+AGEREF=2006/10/04:10:15
+AGEREF2=2006/10/04:10:45
+print *(+age)
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+This shows the same example before using another form of argument
+passing. The dates and times in the parameters @t{AGEREF} and @t{AGEREF2}
+stay in effect until unset, but will be overridden if any argument is
+passed as an explicit argument to age. Any explicit argument
+causes both parameters to be ignored.
+
+@noindent
+Instead of an explicit date and time, it's possible to use the
+modification time of a file as the date and time for either argument
+by introducing the file name with a colon:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+print *(e-age :file1-)
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+matches all files created on the same day (24 hours starting from
+midnight) as @t{file1}.
+
+@noindent
+@example
+print *(e-age :file1 :file2-)
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+matches all files modified no earlier than @t{file1} and
+no later than @t{file2}; precision here is to the nearest second.
+
+@item @t{after}
+@itemx @t{before}
+@findex after
+@findex before
+The functions @t{after} and @t{before} are simpler versions of @t{age}
+that take just one argument. The argument is parsed similarly to an
+argument of @t{age}; if it is not given the variable @t{AGEREF} is
+consulted. As the names of the functions suggest, a file matches if its
+modification time is after or before the time and date specified. If
+a time only is given the date is today.
+
+@noindent
+The two following examples are therefore equivalent:
+@example
+print *(e-after 12:00-)
+print *(e-after today:12:00-)
+@end example
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+@node Calendar Styles, Calendar Utility Functions, Calendar System User Functions, Calendar Function System
+
+@section Styles
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+The zsh style mechanism using the @t{zstyle} command is describe in
+@ref{The zsh/zutil Module}. This is the same mechanism
+used in the completion system.
+
+@noindent
+The styles below are all examined in the context
+@t{:datetime:}@var{function}@t{:}, for example @t{:datetime:calendar:}.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@kindex calendar-file
+@item @t{calendar-file}
+The location of the main calendar. The default is @t{~/calendar}.
+
+@kindex date-format
+@item @t{date-format}
+A @t{strftime} format string (see man page strftime(3)) with the zsh
+extensions providing various numbers with no leading zero or space
+if the number is a single digit as described for the
+@t{%D@{}@var{string}@t{@}} prompt format in
+@ref{Prompt Expansion}.
+
+@noindent
+This is used for outputting dates in @t{calendar}, both to support
+the @t{-v} option and when adding recurring events back to the calendar
+file, and in @t{calendar_showdate} as the final output format.
+
+@noindent
+If the style is not set, the default used is similar the standard system
+format as output by the @t{date} command (also known as `ctime format'):
+`@t{%a %b %d %H:%M:%S %Z %Y}'.
+
+@kindex done-file
+@item @t{done-file}
+The location of the file to which events which have passed are appended.
+The default is the calendar file location with the suffix @t{.done}.
+The style may be set to an empty string in which case a "done" file
+will not be maintained.
+
+@kindex reformat-date
+@item @t{reformat-date}
+Boolean, used by @t{calendar_add}. If it is true, the date and time
+of new entries added to the calendar will be reformatted to the format
+given by the style @t{date-format} or its default. Only the date and
+time of the event itself is reformatted; any subsidiary dates and times
+such as those associated with repeat and warning times are left alone.
+
+@kindex show-prog
+@item @t{show-prog}
+The programme run by @t{calendar} for showing events. It will
+be passed the start time and stop time of the events requested in seconds
+since the epoch followed by the event text. Note that @t{calendar -s} uses
+a start time and stop time equal to one another to indicate alerts
+for specific events.
+
+@noindent
+The default is the function @t{calendar_show}.
+
+@kindex warn-time
+@item @t{warn-time}
+The time before an event at which a warning will be displayed, if the
+first line of the event does not include the text @t{EVENT} @var{reltime}.
+The default is 5 minutes.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+@node Calendar Utility Functions, Calendar Bugs, Calendar Styles, Calendar Function System
+
+@section Utility functions
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex calendar_lockfiles
+@item @t{calendar_lockfiles}
+Attempt to lock the files given in the argument. To prevent
+problems with network file locking this is done in an ad hoc fashion
+by attempting to create a symbolic link to the file with the name
+@var{file}@t{.lockfile}. No other system level functions are used
+for locking, i.e. the file can be accessed and modified by any
+utility that does not use this mechanism. In particular, the user is not
+prevented from editing the calendar file at the same time unless
+@t{calendar_edit} is used.
+
+@noindent
+Three attempts are made to lock the file before giving up. If the module
+@t{zsh/zselect} is available, the times of the attempts are jittered so that
+multiple instances of the calling function are unlikely to retry at the
+same time.
+
+@noindent
+The files locked are appended to the array @t{lockfiles}, which should
+be local to the caller.
+
+@noindent
+If all files were successfully locked, status zero is returned, else status one.
+
+@noindent
+This function may be used as a general file locking function, although
+this will only work if only this mechanism is used to lock files.
+
+@findex calendar_read
+@item @t{calendar_read}
+This is a backend used by various other functions to parse the
+calendar file, which is passed as the only argument. The array
+@t{calendar_entries} is set to the list of events in the file; no
+pruning is done except that ampersands are removed from the start of
+the line. Each entry may contain multiple lines.
+
+@findex calendar_scandate
+@item @t{calendar_scandate}
+This is a generic function to parse dates and times that may be
+used separately from the calendar system. The argument is a date
+or time specification as described in
+@ref{Calendar File and Date Formats}. The parameter @t{REPLY}
+is set to the number of seconds since the epoch corresponding to that date
+or time. By default, the date and time may occur anywhere within the given
+argument.
+
+@noindent
+Returns status zero if the date and time were successfully parsed,
+else one.
+
+@noindent
+Options:
+@table @asis
+@item @t{-a}
+The date and time are anchored to the start of the argument; they
+will not be matched if there is preceding text.
+
+@item @t{-A}
+The date and time are anchored to both the start and end of the argument;
+they will not be matched if the is any other text in the argument.
+
+@item @t{-d}
+Enable additional debugging output.
+
+@item @t{-m}
+Minus. When @t{-R} @var{anchor_time} is also given the relative time is
+calculated backwards from @var{anchor_time}.
+
+@item @t{-r}
+The argument passed is to be parsed as a relative time.
+
+@item @t{-R} @var{anchor_time}
+The argument passed is to be parsed as a relative time. The time is
+relative to @var{anchor_time}, a time in seconds since the epoch,
+and the returned value is the absolute time corresponding to advancing
+@var{anchor_time} by the relative time given.
+This allows lengths of months to be correctly taken into account. If
+the final day does not exist in the given month, the last day of the
+final month is given. For example, if the anchor time is during 31st
+January 2007 and the relative time is 1 month, the final time is the
+same time of day during 28th February 2007.
+
+@item @t{-s}
+In addition to setting @t{REPLY}, set @t{REPLY2} to the remainder of
+the argument after the date and time have been stripped. This is
+empty if the option @t{-A} was given.
+
+@item @t{-t}
+Allow a time with no date specification. The date is assumed to be
+today. The behaviour is unspecified if the iron tongue of midnight
+is tolling twelve.
+
+@end table
+
+@findex calendar_show
+@item @t{calendar_show}
+The function used by default to display events. It accepts a start time
+and end time for events, both in epoch seconds, and an event description.
+
+@noindent
+The event is always printed to standard output. If the command line editor
+is active (which will usually be the case) the command line will be
+redisplayed after the output.
+
+@noindent
+If the parameter @t{DISPLAY} is set and the start and end times are
+the same (indicating a scheduled event), the function uses the
+command @t{xmessage} to display a window with the event details.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+@node Calendar Bugs, , Calendar Utility Functions, Calendar Function System
+
+@section Bugs
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+As the system is based entirely on shell functions (with a little support
+from the @t{zsh/datetime} module) the mechanisms used are not as robust as
+those provided by a dedicated calendar utility. Consequently the user
+should not rely on the shell for vital alerts.
+
+@noindent
+There is no @t{calendar_delete} function.
+
+@noindent
+There is no localization support for dates and times, nor any support
+for the use of time zones.
+
+@noindent
+Relative periods of months and years do not take into account the variable
+number of days.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{calendar_show} function is currently hardwired to use @t{xmessage}
+for displaying alerts on X Window System displays. This should be
+configurable and ideally integrate better with the desktop.
+
+@noindent
+@t{calendar_lockfiles} hangs the shell while waiting for a lock on a file.
+If called from a scheduled task, it should instead reschedule the event
+that caused it.
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/tcpsys.yo
+@node TCP Function System, Zftp Function System, Calendar Function System, Top
+
+@chapter TCP Function System
+@noindent
+@cindex TCP function system
+@cindex ztcp, function system based on
+
+@section Description
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+A module @t{zsh/net/tcp} is provided to provide network I/O over
+TCP/IP from within the shell; see its description in
+@ref{Zsh Modules}. This manual page describes a function suite based on the module.
+If the module is installed, the functions are usually installed at the
+same time, in which case they will be available for
+autoloading in the default function search path. In addition to the
+@t{zsh/net/tcp} module, the @t{zsh/zselect} module is used to implement
+timeouts on read operations. For troubleshooting tips, consult the
+corresponding advice for the @t{zftp} functions described in
+@ref{Zftp Function System}.
+
+@noindent
+There are functions corresponding to the basic I/O operations open, close,
+read and send, named @t{tcp_open} etc., as well as a function
+@t{tcp_expect} for pattern match analysis of data read as input. The
+system makes it easy to receive data from and send data to multiple named
+sessions at once. In addition, it can be linked with the shell's line
+editor in such a way that input data is automatically shown at the
+terminal. Other facilities available including logging, filtering and
+configurable output prompts.
+
+@noindent
+To use the system where it is available, it should be enough to
+`@t{autoload -U tcp_open}' and run @t{tcp_open} as documented below to
+start a session. The @t{tcp_open} function will autoload the remaining
+functions.
+
+@noindent
+@menu
+* TCP Functions::
+* TCP Parameters::
+* TCP Examples::
+* TCP Bugs::
+@end menu
+
+@noindent
+@node TCP Functions, TCP Parameters, , TCP Function System
+
+@section TCP User Functions
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Basic I/O
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex tcp_open
+@item @t{tcp_open} [ @t{-qz} ] @var{host port} [ @var{sess} ]
+@itemx @t{tcp_open} [ @t{-qz} ] [ @t{-s} @var{sess} | @t{-l} @var{sess}[@t{,}...] ] ...
+@itemx @t{tcp_open} [ @t{-qz} ] [ @t{-a} @var{fd} | @t{-f} @var{fd} ] [ @var{sess} ]
+Open a new session. In the first and simplest form, open a TCP connection
+to host @var{host} at port @var{port}; numeric and symbolic forms are
+understood for both.
+
+@noindent
+If @var{sess} is given, this becomes the name of the session which can be
+used to refer to multiple different TCP connections. If @var{sess} is
+not given, the function will invent a numeric name value (note this is
+@emph{not} the same as the file descriptor to which the session is attached).
+It is recommended that session names not include `funny' characters, where
+funny characters are not well-defined but certainly do not include
+alphanumerics or underscores, and certainly do include whitespace.
+
+@noindent
+In the second case, one or more sessions to be opened are given by name.
+A single session name is given after @t{-s} and a comma-separated list
+after @t{-l}; both options may be repeated as many times as necessary.
+A failure to open any session causes @t{tcp_open} to abort.
+The host and port are read from the file @t{.ztcp_sessions} in the same
+directory as the user's zsh initialisation files, i.e. usually the home
+directory, but @t{$ZDOTDIR} if that is set. The file consists of lines
+each giving a session name and the corresponding host and port, in that
+order (note the session name comes first, not last), separated by
+whitespace.
+
+@noindent
+The third form allows passive and fake TCP connections. If the option
+@t{-a} is used, its argument is a file descriptor open for listening for
+connections. No function front-end is provided to open such a file
+descriptor, but a call to `@t{ztcp -l} @var{port}' will create one with the
+file descriptor stored in the parameter @t{$REPLY}. The listening port can
+be closed with `@t{ztcp -c} @var{fd}'. A call to `@t{tcp_open -a} @var{fd}'
+will block until a remote TCP connection is made to @var{port} on the local
+machine. At this point, a session is created in the usual way and is
+largely indistinguishable from an active connection created with one of the
+first two forms.
+
+@noindent
+If the option @t{-f} is used, its argument is a file descriptor which is
+used directly as if it were a TCP session. How well the remainder of the
+TCP function system copes with this depends on what actually underlies this
+file descriptor. A regular file is likely to be unusable; a FIFO (pipe) of
+some sort will work better, but note that it is not a good idea for two
+different sessions to attempt to read from the same FIFO at once.
+
+@noindent
+If the option @t{-q} is given with any of the three forms, @t{tcp_open}
+will not print informational messages, although it will in any case exit
+with an appropriate status.
+
+@noindent
+If the line editor (zle) is in use, which is typically the case if the
+shell is interactive, @t{tcp_open} installs a handler inside zle which
+will check for new data at the same time as it checks for keyboard input.
+This is convenient as the shell consumes no CPU time while waiting; the
+test is performed by the operating system. Giving the option @t{-z} to
+any of the forms of @t{tcp_open} prevents the handler from being
+installed, so data must be read explicitly. Note, however, this is not
+necessary for executing complete sets of send and read commands from a
+function, as zle is not active at this point. Generally speaking, the
+handler is only active when the shell is waiting for input at a command
+prompt or in the @t{vared} builtin. The option has no effect if zle is not
+active; `@t{[[ -o zle]]}' will test for this.
+
+@noindent
+The first session to be opened becomes the current session and subsequent
+calls to @t{tcp_open} do not change it. The current session is stored
+in the parameter @t{$TCP_SESS}; see below for more detail about the
+parameters used by the system.
+
+@noindent
+The function @t{tcp_on_open}, if defined, is called when a session
+is opened. See the description below.
+
+@findex tcp_close
+@item @t{tcp_close} [ @t{-qn} ] [ @t{-a} | @t{-l} @var{sess}[@t{,}...] | @var{sess} ... ]
+Close the named sessions, or the current session if none is given,
+or all open sessions if @t{-a} is given. The options @t{-l} and @t{-s} are
+both handled for consistency with @t{tcp_open}, although the latter is
+redundant.
+
+@noindent
+If the session being closed is the current one, @t{$TCP_SESS} is unset,
+leaving no current session, even if there are other sessions still open.
+
+@noindent
+If the session was opened with @t{tcp_open -f}, the file descriptor is
+closed so long as it is in the range 0 to 9 accessible directly from the
+command line. If the option @t{-n} is given, no attempt will be made to
+close file descriptors in this case. The @t{-n} option is not used for
+genuine @t{ztcp} session; the file descriptors are always closed with the
+session.
+
+@noindent
+If the option @t{-q} is given, no informational messages will be printed.
+
+@findex tcp_read
+
+@item @t{tcp_read }[ @t{-bdq} ] [ @t{-t} @var{TO} ] [ @t{-T} @var{TO} ]
+@itemx @t{@ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ }[ @t{-a} | @t{-u} @var{fd}[@t{,}...] | @t{-l} @var{sess}[@t{,}...] | @t{-s} @var{sess} ... ]
+Perform a read operation on the current session, or on a list of
+sessions if any are given with @t{-u}, @t{-l} or @t{-s}, or all open
+sessions if the option @t{-a} is given. Any of the @t{-u}, @t{-l} or
+@t{-s} options may be repeated or mixed together. The @t{-u} option
+specifies a file descriptor directly (only those managed by this system
+are useful), the other two specify sessions as described for
+@t{tcp_open} above.
+
+@noindent
+The function checks for new data available on all the sessions listed.
+Unless the @t{-b} option is given, it will not block waiting for new data.
+Any one line of data from any of the available sessions will be read,
+stored in the parameter @t{$TCP_LINE}, and displayed to standard output
+unless @t{$TCP_SILENT} contains a non-empty string. When printed to
+standard output the string @t{$TCP_PROMPT} will be shown at the start of
+the line; the default form for this includes the name of the session being
+read. See below for more information on these parameters. In this mode,
+@t{tcp_read} can be called repeatedly until it returns status 2 which
+indicates all pending input from all specified sessions has been handled.
+
+@noindent
+With the option @t{-b}, equivalent to an infinite timeout, the function
+will block until a line is available to read from one of the specified
+sessions. However, only a single line is returned.
+
+@noindent
+The option @t{-d} indicates that all pending input should be drained. In
+this case @t{tcp_read} may process multiple lines in the manner given
+above; only the last is stored in @t{$TCP_LINE}, but the complete set is
+stored in the array @t{$tcp_lines}. This is cleared at the start of each
+call to @t{tcp_read}.
+
+@noindent
+The options @t{-t} and @t{-T} specify a timeout in seconds, which may be a
+floating point number for increased accuracy. With @t{-t} the timeout is
+applied before each line read. With @t{-T}, the timeout applies to the
+overall operation, possibly including multiple read operations if the
+option @t{-d} is present; without this option, there is no distinction
+between @t{-t} and @t{-T}.
+
+@noindent
+The function does not print informational messages, but if the option
+@t{-q} is given, no error message is printed for a non-existent session.
+
+@noindent
+A return status of 2 indicates a timeout or no data to read. Any other
+non-zero return status indicates some error condition.
+
+@noindent
+See @t{tcp_log} for how to control where data is sent by @t{tcp_read}.
+
+@findex tcp_send
+@item @t{tcp_send} [ @t{-cnq} ] [ @t{-s} @var{sess} | @t{-l} @var{sess}[@t{,}...] ] @var{data} ...
+@itemx @t{tcp_send} [ @t{-cnq} ] @t{-a} @var{data} ...
+Send the supplied data strings to all the specified sessions in turn. The
+underlying operation differs little from a `@t{print -r}' to the session's
+file descriptor, although it attempts to prevent the shell from dying owing
+to a @t{SIGPIPE} caused by an attempt to write to a defunct session.
+
+@noindent
+The option @t{-c} causes @t{tcp_send} to behave like @t{cat}. It reads
+lines from standard input until end of input and sends them in turn to the
+specified session(s) exactly as if they were given as @var{data}
+arguments to individual @t{tcp_send} commands.
+
+@noindent
+The option @t{-n} prevents @t{tcp_send} from putting a newline at the end
+of the data strings.
+
+@noindent
+The remaining options all behave as for @t{tcp_read}.
+
+@noindent
+The data arguments are not further processed once they have been passed to
+@t{tcp_send}; they are simply passed down to @t{print -r}.
+
+@noindent
+If the parameter @t{$TCP_OUTPUT} is a non-empty string and logging is
+enabled then the data sent to each session will be echoed to the log
+file(s) with @t{$TCP_OUTPUT} in front where appropriate, much
+in the manner of @t{$TCP_PROMPT}.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Session Management
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex tcp_alias
+@item @t{tcp_alias} [ @t{-q} ] @var{alias}@t{=}@var{sess} ...
+@itemx @t{tcp_alias} [ @t{-q} ] [ @var{alias} ... ]
+@itemx @t{tcp_alias} @t{-d} [ @t{-q} ] @var{alias} ...
+This function is not particularly well tested.
+
+@noindent
+The first form creates an alias for a session name; @var{alias} can then be
+used to refer to the existing session @var{sess}. As many aliases may be
+listed as required.
+
+@noindent
+The second form lists any aliases specified, or all aliases if none.
+
+@noindent
+The third form deletes all the aliases listed. The underlying sessions are
+not affected.
+
+@noindent
+The option @t{-q} suppresses an inconsistently chosen subset of error
+messages.
+
+@findex tcp_log
+@item @t{tcp_log} [ @t{-asc} ] [ @t{-n} | @t{-N} ] [ @var{logfile} ]
+With an argument @var{logfile}, all future input from @t{tcp_read} will be
+logged to the named file. Unless @t{-a} (append) is given, this file will
+first be truncated or created empty. With no arguments, show the current
+status of logging.
+
+@noindent
+With the option @t{-s}, per-session logging is enabled. Input from
+@t{tcp_read} is output to the file @var{logfile}@t{.}@var{sess}. As the
+session is automatically discriminated by the filename, the contents are
+raw (no @t{$TCP_PROMPT}). The option @t{-a} applies as above.
+Per-session logging and logging of all data in one file are not mutually
+exclusive.
+
+@noindent
+The option @t{-c} closes all logging, both complete and per-session logs.
+
+@noindent
+The options @t{-n} and @t{-N} respectively turn off or restore output of
+data read by @t{tcp_read} to standard output; hence `@t{tcp_log -cn}' turns
+off all output by @t{tcp_read}.
+
+@noindent
+The function is purely a convenient front end to setting the parameters
+@t{$TCP_LOG}, @t{$TCP_LOG_SESS}, @t{$TCP_SILENT}, which are described below.
+
+@findex tcp_rename
+@item @t{tcp_rename} @var{old} @var{new}
+Rename session @var{old} to session @var{new}. The old name becomes invalid.
+
+@findex tcp_sess
+@item @t{tcp_sess} [ @var{sess} [ @var{command} [ @var{arg} ... ] ] ]
+With no arguments, list all the open sessions and associated file
+descriptors. The current session is marked with a star. For use in
+functions, direct access to the parameters @t{$tcp_by_name}, @t{$tcp_by_fd}
+and @t{$TCP_SESS} is probably more convenient; see below.
+
+@noindent
+With a @var{sess} argument, set the current session to @var{sess}.
+This is equivalent to changing @t{$TCP_SESS} directly.
+
+@noindent
+With additional arguments, temporarily set the current session while
+executing `@var{command} @var{arg} ...'. @var{command} is re-evaluated
+so as to expand aliases etc., but the remaining @var{arg}s are passed
+through as that appear to @t{tcp_sess}. The original session is restored
+when @t{tcp_sess} exits.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Advanced I/O
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex tcp_command
+@item @t{tcp_command} @var{send-option} ... @var{send-argument} ...
+This is a convenient front-end to @t{tcp_send}. All arguments are passed
+to @t{tcp_send}, then the function pauses waiting for data. While data is
+arriving at least every @t{$TCP_TIMEOUT} (default 0.3) seconds, data is
+handled and printed out according to the current settings. Status 0 is
+always returned.
+
+@noindent
+This is generally only useful for interactive use, to prevent the display
+becoming fragmented by output returned from the connection. Within a
+programme or function it is generally better to handle reading data by a
+more explicit method.
+
+@findex tcp_expect
+
+@item @t{tcp_expect }[ @t{-q} ] [ @t{-p} @var{var} | @t{-P} @var{var} ] [ @t{-t} @var{TO} | @t{-T} @var{TO} ]
+@itemx @t{@ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ }[ @t{-a} | @t{-s} @var{sess} | @t{-l} @var{sess}[@t{,}...] ] @var{pattern} ...
+Wait for input matching any of the given @var{pattern}s from any of the
+specified sessions. Input is ignored until an input line matches one of
+the given patterns; at this point status zero is returned, the matching
+line is stored in @t{$TCP_LINE}, and the full set of lines read during the
+call to @t{tcp_expect} is stored in the array @t{$tcp_expect_lines}.
+
+@noindent
+Sessions are specified in the same way as @t{tcp_read}: the default is to
+use the current session, otherwise the sessions specified by @t{-a},
+@t{-s}, or @t{-l} are used.
+
+@noindent
+Each @var{pattern} is a standard zsh extended-globbing pattern; note that it
+needs to be quoted to avoid it being expanded immediately by filename
+generation. It must match the full line, so to match a substring there
+must be a `@t{*}' at the start and end. The line matched against includes
+the @t{$TCP_PROMPT} added by @t{tcp_read}. It is possible to include the
+globbing flags `@t{#b}' or `@t{#m}' in the patterns to make backreferences
+available in the parameters @t{$MATCH}, @t{$match}, etc., as described in
+the base zsh documentation on pattern matching.
+
+@noindent
+Unlike @t{tcp_read}, the default behaviour of @t{tcp_expect} is to block
+indefinitely until the required input is found. This can be modified by
+specifying a timeout with @t{-t} or @t{-T}; these function as in
+@t{tcp_read}, specifying a per-read or overall timeout, respectively, in
+seconds, as an integer or floating-point number. As @t{tcp_read}, the
+function returns status 2 if a timeout occurs.
+
+@noindent
+The function returns as soon as any one of the patterns given match. If
+the caller needs to know which of the patterns matched, the option @t{-p}
+@var{var} can be used; on return, @t{$var} is set to the number of the
+pattern using ordinary zsh indexing, i.e. the first is 1, and so on. Note
+the absence of a `@t{$}' in front of @var{var}. To avoid clashes, the
+parameter cannot begin with `@t{_expect}'. The index -1 is used if
+there is a timeout and 0 if there is no match.
+
+@noindent
+The option @t{-P} @var{var} works similarly to @t{-p}, but instead of
+numerical indexes the regular arguments must begin with a prefix
+followed by a colon: that prefix is then used as a tag to which @var{var}
+is set when the argument matches. The tag @t{timeout} is used if there
+is a timeout and the empty string if there is no match. Note it is
+acceptable for different arguments to start with the same prefix if the
+matches do not need to be distinguished.
+
+@noindent
+The option @t{-q} is passed directly down to @t{tcp_read}.
+
+@noindent
+As all input is done via @t{tcp_read}, all the usual rules about output of
+lines read apply. One exception is that the parameter @t{$tcp_lines} will
+only reflect the line actually matched by @t{tcp_expect}; use
+@t{$tcp_expect_lines} for the full set of lines read during the function
+call.
+
+@findex tcp_proxy
+@item @t{tcp_proxy}
+This is a simple-minded function to accept a TCP connection and execute a
+command with I/O redirected to the connection. Extreme caution should be
+taken as there is no security whatsoever and this can leave your computer
+open to the world. Ideally, it should only be used behind a firewall.
+
+@noindent
+The first argument is a TCP port on which the function will listen.
+
+@noindent
+The remaining arguments give a command and its arguments to execute with
+standard input, standard output and standard error redirected to the
+file descriptor on which the TCP session has been accepted.
+If no command is given, a new zsh is started. This gives everyone on
+your network direct access to your account, which in many cases will be a
+bad thing.
+
+@noindent
+The command is run in the background, so @t{tcp_proxy} can then accept new
+connections. It continues to accept new connections until interrupted.
+
+@findex tcp_spam
+@item @t{tcp_spam} [ @t{-ertv} ] [ @t{-a} | @t{-s} @var{sess} | @t{-l} @var{sess}[@t{,}...] ] @var{cmd} [ @var{arg} ... ]
+Execute `@var{cmd} [ @var{arg} ... ]' for each session in turn. Note this executes
+the command and arguments; it does not send the command line as data
+unless the @t{-t} (transmit) option is given.
+
+@noindent
+The sessions may be selected explicitly with the standard @t{-a}, @t{-s} or
+@t{-l} options, or may be chosen implicitly. If none of the three options
+is given the rules are: first, if the array @t{$tcp_spam_list} is set, this
+is taken as the list of sessions, otherwise all sessions are taken.
+Second, any sessions given in the array @t{$tcp_no_spam_list} are removed
+from the list of sessions.
+
+@noindent
+Normally, any sessions added by the `@t{-a}' flag or when all sessions are
+chosen implicitly are spammed in alphabetic order; sessions given by the
+@t{$tcp_spam_list} array or on the command line are spammed in the order
+given. The @t{-r} flag reverses the order however it was arrived it.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{-v} flag specifies that a @t{$TCP_PROMPT} will be output before each
+session. This is output after any modification to @t{TCP_SESS} by the
+user-defined @t{tcp_on_spam} function described below. (Obviously that
+function is able to generate its own output.)
+
+@noindent
+If the option @t{-e} is present, the line given as `@var{cmd} [ @var{arg} ... ]' is executed
+using @t{eval}, otherwise it is executed without any further processing.
+
+@findex tcp_talk
+@item @t{tcp_talk}
+This is a fairly simple-minded attempt to force input to the line editor to
+go straight to the default @t{TCP_SESS}.
+
+@noindent
+An escape string, @t{$TCP_TALK_ESCAPE}, default `@t{:}', is used to allow
+access to normal shell operation. If it is on its own at the start of the
+line, or followed only by whitespace, the line editor returns to normal
+operation. Otherwise, the string and any following whitespace are skipped
+and the remainder of the line executed as shell input without any change of
+the line editor's operating mode.
+
+@noindent
+The current implementation is somewhat deficient in terms of use of the
+command history. For this reason, many users will prefer to use some form
+of alternative approach for sending data easily to the current session.
+One simple approach is to alias some special character (such as `@t{%}') to
+`@t{tcp_command -}@t{-}'.
+
+@findex tcp_wait
+@item @t{tcp_wait}
+The sole argument is an integer or floating point number which gives the
+seconds to delay. The shell will do nothing for that period except wait
+for input on all TCP sessions by calling @t{tcp_read -a}. This is similar
+to the interactive behaviour at the command prompt when zle handlers are
+installed.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection `One-shot' file transfer
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{tcp_point} @var{port}
+@itemx @t{tcp_shoot} @var{host} @var{port}
+This pair of functions provide a simple way to transfer a file between
+two hosts within the shell. Note, however, that bulk data transfer is
+currently done using @t{cat}. @t{tcp_point} reads any data arriving at
+@var{port} and sends it to standard output; @t{tcp_shoot} connects to
+@var{port} on @var{host} and sends its standard input. Any unused @var{port}
+may be used; the standard mechanism for picking a port is to think of a
+random four-digit number above 1024 until one works.
+
+@noindent
+To transfer a file from host @t{woodcock} to host @t{springes}, on
+@t{springes}:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+tcp_point 8091 >output_file
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+and on @t{woodcock}:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+tcp_shoot springes 8091 <input_file
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+As these two functions do not require @t{tcp_open} to set up a TCP
+connection first, they may need to be autoloaded separately.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@section TCP User-defined Functions
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+Certain functions, if defined by the user, will be called by the function
+system in certain contexts. This facility depends on the module
+@t{zsh/parameter}, which is usually available in interactive shells as the
+completion system depends on it. None of the functions need be defined;
+they simply provide convenient hooks when necessary.
+
+@noindent
+Typically, these are called after the requested action has been taken, so
+that the various parameters will reflect the new state.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex tcp_on_alias
+@item @t{tcp_on_alias} @var{alias} @var{fd}
+When an alias is defined, this function will be called with two arguments:
+the name of the alias, and the file descriptor of the corresponding session.
+
+@findex tcp_on_awol
+@item @t{tcp_on_awol} @var{sess} @var{fd}
+If the function @t{tcp_fd_handler} is handling input from the line
+editor and detects that the file descriptor is no longer reusable,
+by default it removes it from the list of file descriptors handled
+by this method and prints a message. If the function @t{tcp_on_awol}
+is defined it is called immediately before this point. It may
+return status 100, which indicates that the normal handling should
+still be performed; any other return status indicates that no further
+action should be taken and the @t{tcp_fd_handler} should return
+immediately with the given status. Typically the action of @t{tcp_on_awol}
+will be to close the session.
+
+@noindent
+The variable @t{TCP_INVALIDATE_ZLE} will be a non-empty string if it is
+necessary to invalidate the line editor display using `@t{zle -I}' before
+printing output from the function.
+
+@noindent
+(`AWOL' is military jargon for `absent without leave' or some
+variation. It has no pre-existing technical meaning known to the author.)
+
+@findex tcp_on_close
+@item @t{tcp_on_close} @var{sess} @var{fd}
+This is called with the name of a session being closed and the file
+descriptor which corresponded to that session. Both will be invalid by
+the time the function is called.
+
+@findex tcp_on_open
+@item @t{tcp_on_open} @var{sess} @var{fd}
+This is called after a new session has been defined with the session name
+and file descriptor as arguments. If it returns a non-zero status,
+opening the session is assumed to fail and the session is closed
+again; however, @t{tcp_open} will continue to attempt to open any
+remaining sessions given on the command line.
+
+@findex tcp_on_rename
+@item @t{tcp_on_rename} @var{oldsess} @var{fd} @var{newsess}
+This is called after a session has been renamed with the three arguments
+old session name, file descriptor, new session name.
+
+@findex tcp_on_spam
+@item @t{tcp_on_spam} @var{sess} @var{command ...}
+This is called once for each session spammed, just @emph{before} a command is
+executed for a session by @t{tcp_spam}. The arguments are the session name
+followed by the command list to be executed. If @t{tcp_spam} was called
+with the option @t{-t}, the first command will be @t{tcp_send}.
+
+@noindent
+This function is called after @t{$TCP_SESS} is set to reflect the session
+to be spammed, but before any use of it is made. Hence it is possible to
+alter the value of @t{$TCP_SESS} within this function. For example, the
+session arguments to @t{tcp_spam} could include extra information to be
+stripped off and processed in @t{tcp_on_spam}.
+
+@noindent
+If the function sets the parameter @t{$REPLY} to `@t{done}', the command
+line is not executed; in addition, no prompt is printed for the @t{-v}
+option to @t{tcp_spam}.
+
+@findex tcp_on_unalias
+@item @t{tcp_on_unalias} @var{alias} @var{fd}
+This is called with the name of an alias and the corresponding session's
+file descriptor after an alias has been deleted.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@section TCP Utility Functions
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+The following functions are used by the TCP function system but will rarely
+if ever need to be called directly.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex tcp_fd_handler
+@item @t{tcp_fd_handler}
+This is the function installed by @t{tcp_open} for handling input from
+within the line editor, if that is required. It is in the format
+documented for the builtin `@t{zle -F}' in
+@ref{Zle Builtins}
+.
+
+@noindent
+While active, the function sets the parameter @t{TCP_HANDLER_ACTIVE} to 1.
+This allows shell code called internally (for example, by setting
+@t{tcp_on_read}) to tell if is being called when the shell is otherwise
+idle at the editor prompt.
+
+@findex tcp_output
+@item @t{tcp_output} [ @t{-q} ] @t{-P} @var{prompt} @t{-F} @var{fd} @t{-S} @var{sess}
+This function is used for both logging and handling output to standard
+output, from within @t{tcp_read} and (if @t{$TCP_OUTPUT} is set)
+@t{tcp_send}.
+
+@noindent
+The @var{prompt} to use is specified by @t{-P}; the default is the empty
+string. It can contain:
+@table @asis
+@item @t{%c}
+Expands to 1 if the session is the current session, otherwise 0. Used
+with ternary expressions such as `@t{%(c.-.+)}' to
+output `@t{+}' for the current session and `@t{-}' otherwise.
+
+@item @t{%f}
+Replaced by the session's file descriptor.
+
+@item @t{%s}
+Replaced by the session name.
+
+@item @t{%%}
+Replaced by a single `@t{%}'.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+The option @t{-q} suppresses output to standard output, but not to any log
+files which are configured.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{-S} and @t{-F} options are used to pass in the session name and file
+descriptor for possible replacement in the prompt.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+@node TCP Parameters, TCP Examples, TCP Functions, TCP Function System
+
+@section TCP User Parameters
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+Parameters follow the usual convention that uppercase is used for scalars
+and integers, while lowercase is used for normal and associative array.
+It is always safe for user code to read these parameters. Some parameters
+may also be set; these are noted explicitly. Others are included in this
+group as they are set by the function system for the user's benefit,
+i.e. setting them is typically not useful but is benign.
+
+@noindent
+It is often also useful to make settable parameters local to a function.
+For example, `@t{local TCP_SILENT=1}' specifies that data read during the
+function call will not be printed to standard output, regardless of the
+setting outside the function. Likewise, `@t{local TCP_SESS=}@var{sess}'
+sets a session for the duration of a function, and `@t{local
+TCP_PROMPT=}' specifies that no prompt is used for input during the
+function.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@vindex tcp_expect_lines
+@item @t{tcp_expect_lines}
+Array. The set of lines read during the last call to @t{tcp_expect},
+including the last (@t{$TCP_LINE}).
+
+@vindex tcp_filter
+@item @t{tcp_filter}
+Array. May be set directly. A set of extended globbing patterns which,
+if matched in @t{tcp_output}, will cause the line not to be printed to
+standard output. The patterns should be defined as described for the
+arguments to @t{tcp_expect}. Output of line to log files is not affected.
+
+@vindex TCP_HANDLER_ACTIVE
+@item @t{TCP_HANDLER_ACTIVE}
+Scalar. Set to 1 within @t{tcp_fd_handler} to indicate to functions
+called recursively that they have been called during an editor session.
+Otherwise unset.
+
+@vindex TCP_LINE
+@item @t{TCP_LINE}
+The last line read by @t{tcp_read}, and hence also @t{tcp_expect}.
+
+@vindex TCP_LINE_FD
+@item @t{TCP_LINE_FD}
+The file descriptor from which @t{$TCP_LINE} was read.
+@t{$@{tcp_by_fd[$TCP_LINE_FD]@}} will give the corresponding session name.
+
+@vindex tcp_lines
+@item @t{tcp_lines}
+Array. The set of lines read during the last call to @t{tcp_read},
+including the last (@t{$TCP_LINE}).
+
+@vindex TCP_LOG
+@item @t{TCP_LOG}
+May be set directly, although it is also controlled by @t{tcp_log}.
+The name of a file to which output from all sessions will be sent.
+The output is proceeded by the usual @t{$TCP_PROMPT}. If it is not an
+absolute path name, it will follow the user's current directory.
+
+@findex TCP_LOG_SESS
+@item @t{TCP_LOG_SESS}
+May be set directly, although it is also controlled by @t{tcp_log}.
+The prefix for a set of files to which output from each session separately
+will be sent; the full filename is @t{$@{TCP_LOG_SESS@}.}@var{sess}.
+Output to each file is raw; no prompt is added. If it is not an absolute
+path name, it will follow the user's current directory.
+
+@vindex tcp_no_spam_list
+@item @t{tcp_no_spam_list}
+Array. May be set directly. See @t{tcp_spam} for how this is used.
+
+@vindex TCP_OUTPUT
+@item @t{TCP_OUTPUT}
+May be set directly. If a non-empty string, any data sent to a session by
+@t{tcp_send} will be logged. This parameter gives the prompt to be used
+in a file specified by @t{$TCP_LOG} but not in a file generated from
+@t{$TCP_LOG_SESS}. The prompt string has the same format as
+@t{TCP_PROMPT} and the same rules for its use apply.
+
+@vindex TCP_PROMPT
+@item @t{TCP_PROMPT}
+May be set directly. Used as the prefix for data read by @t{tcp_read}
+which is printed to standard output or to the log file given by
+@t{$TCP_LOG}, if any. Any `@t{%s}', `@t{%f}' or `@t{%%}' occurring in the
+string will be replaced by the name of the session, the session's
+underlying file descriptor, or a single `@t{%}', respectively. The
+expression `@t{%c}' expands to 1 if the session being read is the current
+session, else 0; this is most useful in ternary expressions such as
+`@t{%(c.-.+)}' which outputs `@t{+}' if the session is
+the current one, else `@t{-}'.
+
+@noindent
+If the prompt starts with @t{%P}, this is stripped and the complete
+result of the previous stage is passed through standard prompt @t{%}-style
+formatting before being output.
+
+@vindex TCP_READ_DEBUG
+@item @t{TCP_READ_DEBUG}
+May be set directly. If this has non-zero length, @t{tcp_read} will give
+some limited diagnostics about data being read.
+
+@vindex TCP_SECONDS_START
+@item @t{TCP_SECONDS_START}
+This value is created and initialised to zero by tcp_open.
+
+@noindent
+The functions @t{tcp_read} and @t{tcp_expect} use the shell's
+@t{SECONDS} parameter for their own timing purposes. If that parameter
+is not of floating point type on entry to one of the functions, it will
+create a local parameter @t{SECONDS} which is floating point and set the
+parameter @t{TCP_SECONDS_START} to the previous value of @t{$SECONDS}.
+If the parameter is already floating point, it is used without a local
+copy being created and @t{TCP_SECONDS_START} is not set. As the global
+value is zero, the shell elapsed time is guaranteed to be the sum of
+@t{$SECONDS} and @t{$TCP_SECONDS_START}.
+
+@noindent
+This can be avoided by setting @t{SECONDS} globally to a floating point
+value using `@t{typeset -F SECONDS}'; then the TCP functions will never
+make a local copy and never set @t{TCP_SECONDS_START} to a non-zero value.
+
+@vindex TCP_SESS
+@item @t{TCP_SESS}
+May be set directly. The current session; must refer to one of the
+sessions established by @t{tcp_open}.
+
+@vindex TCP_SILENT
+@item @t{TCP_SILENT}
+May be set directly, although it is also controlled by @t{tcp_log}.
+If of non-zero length, data read by @t{tcp_read} will not be written to
+standard output, though may still be written to a log file.
+
+@vindex tcp_spam_list
+@item @t{tcp_spam_list}
+Array. May be set directly. See the description of the function
+@t{tcp_spam} for how this is used.
+
+@vindex TCP_TALK_ESCAPE
+@item @t{TCP_TALK_ESCAPE}
+May be set directly. See the description of the function @t{tcp_talk} for
+how this is used.
+
+@vindex TCP_TIMEOUT
+@item @t{TCP_TIMEOUT}
+May be set directly. Currently this is only used by the function
+@t{tcp_command}, see above.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@section TCP User-defined Parameters
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+The following parameters are not set by the function system, but have
+a special effect if set by the user.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@vindex tcp_on_read
+@item @t{tcp_on_read}
+This should be an associative array; if it is not, the behaviour is
+undefined. Each key is the name of a shell function or other command,
+and the corresponding value is a shell pattern (using @t{EXTENDED_GLOB}).
+Every line read from a TCP session directly or indirectly using
+@t{tcp_read} (which includes lines read by @t{tcp_expect}) is compared
+against the pattern. If the line matches, the command given in the key is
+called with two arguments: the name of the session from which the line was
+read, and the line itself.
+
+@noindent
+If any function called to handle a line returns a non-zero status, the
+line is not output. Thus a @t{tcp_on_read} handler containing only
+the instruction `@t{return 1}' can be used to suppress output of
+particular lines (see, however, @t{tcp_filter} above). However, the line
+is still stored in @t{TCP_LINE} and @t{tcp_lines}; this occurs after all
+@t{tcp_on_read} processing.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@section TCP Utility Parameters
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+These parameters are controlled by the function system; they may be read
+directly, but should not usually be set by user code.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex tcp_aliases
+@item @t{tcp_aliases}
+Associative array. The keys are the names of sessions established with
+@t{tcp_open}; each value is a space-separated list of aliases which refer
+to that session.
+
+@findex tcp_by_fd
+@item @t{tcp_by_fd}
+Associative array. The keys are session file descriptors; each
+value is the name of that session.
+
+@findex tcp_by_name
+@item @t{tcp_by_name}
+Associative array. The keys are the names of sessions; each value is the
+file descriptor associated with that session.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+@node TCP Examples, TCP Bugs, TCP Parameters, TCP Function System
+
+@section TCP Examples
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+Here is a trivial example using a remote calculator.
+
+@noindent
+To create a calculator server on port 7337 (see the @t{dc} manual page for
+quite how infuriating the underlying command is):
+
+@noindent
+@example
+tcp_proxy 7337 dc
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+To connect to this from the same host with a session also named `@t{dc}':
+
+@noindent
+@example
+tcp_open localhost 7337 dc
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+To send a command to the remote session and wait a short while for output
+(assuming @t{dc} is the current session):
+
+@noindent
+@example
+tcp_command 2 4 + p
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+To close the session:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+tcp_close
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The @t{tcp_proxy} needs to be killed to be stopped. Note this will not
+usually kill any connections which have already been accepted, and also
+that the port is not immediately available for reuse.
+
+@noindent
+The following chunk of code puts a list of sessions into an xterm header,
+with the current session followed by a star.
+
+@noindent
+@example
+print -n "\033]2;TCP:" $@{(k)tcp_by_name:/$TCP_SESS/$TCP_SESS\*@} "\a"
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+@node TCP Bugs, , TCP Examples, TCP Function System
+
+@section TCP Bugs
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+The function @t{tcp_read} uses the shell's normal @t{read} builtin. As
+this reads a complete line at once, data arriving without a terminating
+newline can cause the function to block indefinitely.
+
+@noindent
+Though the function suite works well for interactive use and for data
+arriving in small amounts, the performance when large amounts of data are
+being exchanged is likely to be extremely poor.
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/zftpsys.yo
+@node Zftp Function System, User Contributions, TCP Function System, Top
+
+@chapter Zftp Function System
+@noindent
+@cindex zftp function system
+@cindex FTP, functions for using shell as client
+
+@section Description
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+This describes the set of shell functions supplied with the source
+distribution as an interface to the @t{zftp} builtin command, allowing you
+to perform FTP operations from the shell command line or within functions
+or scripts. The interface is similar to a traditional FTP client (e.g. the
+@t{ftp} command itself, see man page ftp(1)), but as it is entirely done
+within the shell all the familiar completion, editing and globbing features,
+and so on, are present, and macros are particularly simple to write as they
+are just ordinary shell functions.
+
+@noindent
+The prerequisite is that the @t{zftp} command, as described in
+@ref{The zsh/zftp Module}
+, must be available in the
+version of @t{zsh} installed at your site. If the shell is configured to
+load new commands at run time, it probably is: typing `@t{zmodload zsh/zftp}'
+will make sure (if that runs silently, it has worked). If this is not the
+case, it is possible @t{zftp} was linked into the shell anyway: to test
+this, type `@t{which zftp}' and if @t{zftp} is available you will get the
+message `@t{zftp: shell built-in command}'.
+
+@noindent
+Commands given directly with @t{zftp} builtin may be interspersed between
+the functions in this suite; in a few cases, using @t{zftp} directly may
+cause some of the status information stored in shell parameters to become
+invalid. Note in particular the description of the variables
+@t{$ZFTP_TMOUT}, @t{$ZFTP_PREFS} and @t{$ZFTP_VERBOSE} for @t{zftp}.
+
+@noindent
+@menu
+* Installation::
+* Zftp Functions::
+* Miscellaneous Features::
+@end menu
+
+@noindent
+@node Installation, Zftp Functions, , Zftp Function System
+
+@section Installation
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+You should make sure all the functions from the @t{Functions/Zftp}
+directory of the source distribution are available; they all begin with the
+two letters `@t{zf}'. They may already have been installed on your system;
+otherwise, you will need to find them and copy them. The directory should
+appear as one of the elements of the @t{$fpath} array (this should already
+be the case if they were installed), and at least the function @t{zfinit}
+should be autoloaded; it will autoload the rest. Finally, to initialize
+the use of the system you need to call the @t{zfinit} function. The
+following code in your @t{.zshrc} will arrange for this; assume the
+functions are stored in the directory @t{~/myfns}:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+fpath=(~/myfns $fpath)
+autoload -U zfinit
+zfinit
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Note that @t{zfinit} assumes you are using the @t{zmodload} method to
+load the @t{zftp} command. If it is already built into the shell, change
+@t{zfinit} to @t{zfinit -n}. It is helpful (though not essential) if the
+call to @t{zfinit} appears after any code to initialize the new completion
+system, else unnecessary @t{compctl} commands will be given.
+
+@noindent
+@node Zftp Functions, Miscellaneous Features, Installation, Zftp Function System
+
+@section Functions
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+The sequence of operations in performing a file transfer is essentially the
+same as that in a standard FTP client. Note that, due to a quirk of the
+shell's @t{getopts} builtin, for those functions that handle options you
+must use `@t{-}@t{-}' rather than `@t{-}' to ensure the remaining arguments
+are treated literally (a single `@t{-}' is treated as an argument).
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Opening a connection
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex zfparams
+@item @t{zfparams} [ @var{host} [ @var{user} [ @var{password} ... ] ] ]
+Set or show the parameters for a future @t{zfopen} with no arguments. If
+no arguments are given, the current parameters are displayed (the password
+will be shown as a line of asterisks). If a @var{host} is given, and either the
+@var{user} or @var{password} is not, they will be prompted for; also, any
+parameter given as `@t{?}' will be prompted for, and if the `@t{?}' is
+followed by a string, that will be used as the prompt. As @t{zfopen} calls
+@t{zfparams} to store the parameters, this usually need not be called
+directly.
+
+@noindent
+A single argument `@t{-}' will delete the stored parameters. This will
+also cause the memory of the last directory (and so on) on the other host
+to be deleted.
+
+@findex zfopen
+@item @t{zfopen} [ @t{-1} ] [ @var{host} [ @var{user} [ @var{password} [ @var{account} ] ] ] ]
+If @var{host} is present, open a connection to that host under username
+@var{user} with password @var{password} (and, on the rare occasions when it
+is necessary, account @var{account}). If a necessary parameter is missing or
+given as `@t{?}' it will be prompted for. If @var{host} is not present, use
+a previously stored set of parameters.
+
+@noindent
+If the command was successful, and the terminal is compatible with
+@t{xterm} or is @t{sun-cmd}, a summary will appear in the title bar,
+giving the local @t{host:directory} and the remote @t{host:directory};
+this is handled by the function @t{zftp_chpwd}, described below.
+
+@noindent
+Normally, the @var{host}, @var{user} and @var{password} are internally
+recorded for later re-opening, either by a @t{zfopen} with no arguments, or
+automatically (see below). With the option `@t{-1}', no information is
+stored. Also, if an open command with arguments failed, the parameters
+will not be retained (and any previous parameters will also be deleted).
+A @t{zfopen} on its own, or a @t{zfopen -1}, never alters the stored
+parameters.
+
+@noindent
+Both @t{zfopen} and @t{zfanon} (but not @t{zfparams}) understand URLs of
+the form @t{ftp://}@var{host}/@var{path...} as meaning to connect to the
+@var{host}, then change directory to @var{path} (which must be a directory,
+not a file). The `@t{ftp://}' can be omitted; the trailing `@t{/}' is enough
+to trigger recognition of the @var{path}. Note prefixes other than
+`@t{ftp:}' are not recognized, and that all characters after the first
+slash beyond @var{host} are significant in @var{path}.
+
+@findex zfanon
+@item @t{zfanon} [ @t{-1} ] @var{host}
+Open a connection @var{host} for anonymous FTP. The username used is
+`@t{anonymous}'. The password (which will be reported the first time) is
+generated as @var{user}@t{@@}@var{host}; this is then stored in the shell
+parameter @t{$EMAIL_ADDR} which can alternatively be set manually to a
+suitable string.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Directory management
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex zfcd
+@item @t{zfcd} [ @var{dir} ]
+@itemx @t{zfcd -}
+@itemx @t{zfcd} @var{old} @var{new}
+Change the current directory on the remote server: this is implemented to
+have many of the features of the shell builtin @t{cd}.
+
+@noindent
+In the first form with @var{dir} present, change to the directory @var{dir}.
+The command `@t{zfcd ..}' is treated specially, so is guaranteed to work on
+non-UNIX servers (note this is handled internally by @t{zftp}). If @var{dir}
+is omitted, has the effect of `@t{zfcd ~}'.
+
+@noindent
+The second form changes to the directory previously current.
+
+@noindent
+The third form attempts to change the current directory by replacing the
+first occurrence of the string @var{old} with the string @var{new} in the
+current directory.
+
+@noindent
+Note that in this command, and indeed anywhere a remote filename is
+expected, the string which on the local host corresponds to `@t{~}' is
+converted back to a `@t{~}' before being passed to the remote machine.
+This is convenient because of the way expansion is performed on the command
+line before @t{zfcd} receives a string. For example, suppose the command
+is `@t{zfcd ~/foo}'. The shell will expand this to a full path such as
+`@t{zfcd /home/user2/pws/foo}'. At this stage, @t{zfcd} recognises the
+initial path as corresponding to `@t{~}' and will send the directory to
+the remote host as @t{~/foo}, so that the `@t{~}' will be expanded by the
+server to the correct remote host directory. Other named directories of
+the form `@t{~name}' are not treated in this fashion.
+
+@findex zfhere
+@item @t{zfhere}
+Change directory on the remote server to the one corresponding to the
+current local directory, with special handling of `@t{~}' as in @t{zfcd}.
+For example, if the current local directory is @t{~/foo/bar}, then
+@t{zfhere} performs the effect of `@t{zfcd ~/foo/bar}'.
+
+@findex zfdir
+@item @t{zfdir} [ @t{-rfd} ] [ @t{-} ] [ @var{dir-options} ] [ @var{dir} ]
+Produce a long directory listing. The arguments @var{dir-options} and
+@var{dir} are passed directly to the server and their effect is
+implementation dependent, but specifying a particular remote directory
+@var{dir} is usually possible. The output is passed through a pager
+given by the environment variable @t{$PAGER}, or `@t{more}' if that is not
+set.
+
+@noindent
+The directory is usually cached for re-use. In fact, two caches are
+maintained. One is for use when there is no @var{dir-options} or @var{dir},
+i.e. a full listing of the current remote directory; it is flushed
+when the current remote directory changes. The other is
+kept for repeated use of @t{zfdir} with the same arguments; for example,
+repeated use of `@t{zfdir /pub/gnu}' will only require the directory to be
+retrieved on the first call. Alternatively, this cache can be re-viewed with
+the @t{-r} option. As relative directories will confuse
+@t{zfdir}, the @t{-f} option can be used to force the cache to be flushed
+before the directory is listed. The option @t{-d} will delete both
+caches without showing a directory listing; it will also delete the cache
+of file names in the current remote directory, if any.
+
+@findex zfls
+@item @t{zfls} [ @var{ls-options} ] [ @var{dir} ]
+List files on the remote server. With no arguments, this will produce a
+simple list of file names for the current remote directory. Any arguments
+are passed directly to the server. No pager and no caching is used.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Status commands
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex zftype
+@item @t{zftype} [ @var{type} ]
+With no arguments, show the type of data to be transferred, usually ASCII
+or binary. With an argument, change the type: the types `@t{A}' or
+`@t{ASCII}' for ASCII data and `@t{B}' or `@t{BINARY}', `@t{I}' or
+`@t{IMAGE}' for binary data are understood case-insensitively.
+
+@findex zfstat
+@item @t{zfstat} [ @t{-v} ]
+Show the status of the current or last connection, as well as the status of
+some of @t{zftp}'s status variables. With the @t{-v} option, a more
+verbose listing is produced by querying the server for its version of
+events, too.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Retrieving files
+@noindent
+The commands for retrieving files all take at least two options. @t{-G}
+suppresses remote filename expansion which would otherwise be performed
+(see below for a more detailed description of that). @t{-t} attempts
+to set the modification time of the local file to that of the remote file:
+see the description of the function @t{zfrtime} below for more information.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex zfget
+@item @t{zfget} [ @t{-Gtc} ] @var{file1} ...
+Retrieve all the listed files @var{file1} ... one at a time from the remote
+server. If a file contains a `@t{/}', the full name is passed to the
+remote server, but the file is stored locally under the name given by the
+part after the final `@t{/}'. The option @t{-c} (cat) forces all files to
+be sent as a single stream to standard output; in this case the @t{-t}
+option has no effect.
+
+@findex zfuget
+@item @t{zfuget} [ @t{-Gvst} ] @var{file1} ...
+As @t{zfget}, but only retrieve files where the version on the remote
+server is newer (has a later modification time), or where the local file
+does not exist. If the remote file is older but the files have different
+sizes, or if the sizes are the same but the remote file is newer, the user
+will usually be queried. With the option @t{-s}, the command runs silently
+and will always retrieve the file in either of those two cases. With the
+option @t{-v}, the command prints more information about the files while it
+is working out whether or not to transfer them.
+
+@findex zfcget
+@item @t{zfcget} [ @t{-Gt} ] @var{file1} ...
+As @t{zfget}, but if any of the local files exists, and is shorter than
+the corresponding remote file, the command assumes that it is the result of
+a partially completed transfer and attempts to transfer the rest of the
+file. This is useful on a poor connection which keeps failing.
+
+@noindent
+Note that this requires a commonly implemented, but non-standard, version
+of the FTP protocol, so is not guaranteed to work on all servers.
+
+@findex zfgcp
+@item @t{zfgcp} [ @t{-Gt} ] @var{remote-file} @var{local-file}
+@itemx @t{zfgcp} [ @t{-Gt} ] @var{rfile1} ... @var{ldir}
+This retrieves files from the remote server with arguments behaving
+similarly to the @t{cp} command.
+
+@noindent
+In the first form, copy @var{remote-file} from the server to the local file
+@var{local-file}.
+
+@noindent
+In the second form, copy all the remote files @var{rfile1} ... into the
+local directory @var{ldir} retaining the same basenames. This assumes UNIX
+directory semantics.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Sending files
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex zfput
+@item @t{zfput} [ @t{-r} ] @var{file1} ...
+Send all the @var{file1} ... given separately to the remote server. If a
+filename contains a `@t{/}', the full filename is used locally to find the
+file, but only the basename is used for the remote file name.
+
+@noindent
+With the option @t{-r}, if any of the @var{files} are directories they are
+sent recursively with all their subdirectories, including files beginning
+with `@t{.}'. This requires that the remote machine understand UNIX file
+semantics, since `@t{/}' is used as a directory separator.
+
+@findex zfuput
+@item @t{zfuput} [ @t{-vs} ] @var{file1} ...
+As @t{zfput}, but only send files which are newer than their remote
+equivalents, or if the remote file does not exist. The logic is the same
+as for @t{zfuget}, but reversed between local and remote files.
+
+@findex zfcput
+@item @t{zfcput} @var{file1} ...
+As @t{zfput}, but if any remote file already exists and is shorter than the
+local equivalent, assume it is the result of an incomplete transfer and
+send the rest of the file to append to the existing part. As the FTP
+append command is part of the standard set, this is in principle more
+likely to work than @t{zfcget}.
+
+@findex zfpcp
+@item @t{zfpcp} @var{local-file} @var{remote-file}
+@itemx @t{zfpcp} @var{lfile1} ... @var{rdir}
+This sends files to the remote server with arguments behaving similarly to
+the @t{cp} command.
+
+@noindent
+With two arguments, copy @var{local-file} to the server as
+@var{remote-file}.
+
+@noindent
+With more than two arguments, copy all the local files @var{lfile1} ... into
+the existing remote directory @var{rdir} retaining the same basenames. This
+assumes UNIX directory semantics.
+
+@noindent
+A problem arises if you attempt to use @t{zfpcp} @var{lfile1} @var{rdir},
+i.e. the second form of copying but with two arguments, as the command has
+no simple way of knowing if @var{rdir} corresponds to a directory or a
+filename. It attempts to resolve this in various ways. First, if the
+@var{rdir} argument is `@t{.}' or `@t{..}' or ends in a slash, it is assumed
+to be a directory. Secondly, if the operation of copying to a remote file
+in the first form failed, and the remote server sends back the expected
+failure code 553 and a reply including the string `@t{Is a directory}',
+then @t{zfpcp} will retry using the second form.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Closing the connection
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex zfclose
+@item @t{zfclose}
+Close the connection.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Session management
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex zfsession
+@item @t{zfsession} [ @t{-lvod} ] [ @var{sessname} ]
+Allows you to manage multiple FTP sessions at once. By default,
+connections take place in a session called `@t{default}'; by giving the
+command `@t{zfsession} @var{sessname}' you can change to a new or existing
+session with a name of your choice. The new session remembers its own
+connection, as well as associated shell parameters, and also the host/user
+parameters set by @t{zfparams}. Hence you can have different sessions set
+up to connect to different hosts, each remembering the appropriate host,
+user and password.
+
+@noindent
+With no arguments, @t{zfsession} prints the name of the current session;
+with the option @t{-l} it lists all sessions which currently exist, and
+with the option @t{-v} it gives a verbose list showing the host and
+directory for each session, where the current session is marked with an
+asterisk. With @t{-o}, it will switch to the most recent previous session.
+
+@noindent
+With @t{-d}, the given session (or else the current one) is removed;
+everything to do with it is completely forgotten. If it was the only
+session, a new session called `@t{default}' is created and made current.
+It is safest not to delete sessions while background commands using
+@t{zftp} are active.
+
+@findex zftransfer
+@item @t{zftransfer} @var{sess1}@t{:}@var{file1} @var{sess2}@t{:}@var{file2}
+Transfer files between two sessions; no local copy is made. The file
+is read from the session @var{sess1} as @var{file1} and written to session
+@var{sess2} as file @var{file2}; @var{file1} and @var{file2} may be relative to
+the current directories of the session. Either @var{sess1} or @var{sess2}
+may be omitted (though the colon should be retained if there is a
+possibility of a colon appearing in the file name) and defaults to the
+current session; @var{file2} may be omitted or may end with a slash, in
+which case the basename of @var{file1} will be added. The sessions
+@var{sess1} and @var{sess2} must be distinct.
+
+@noindent
+The operation is performed using pipes, so it is required that the
+connections still be valid in a subshell, which is not the case under
+versions of some operating systems, presumably due to a system bug.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Bookmarks
+@noindent
+The two functions @t{zfmark} and @t{zfgoto} allow you to `bookmark' the
+present location (host, user and directory) of the current FTP connection
+for later use. The file to be used for storing and retrieving bookmarks is
+given by the parameter @t{$ZFTP_BMFILE}; if not set when one of the two
+functions is called, it will be set to the file @t{.zfbkmarks} in the
+directory where your zsh startup files live (usually @t{~}).
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex zfmark
+@item @t{zfmark} [ @var{bookmark} ]
+If given an argument, mark the current host, user and directory under the
+name @var{bookmark} for later use by @t{zfgoto}. If there is no connection
+open, use the values for the last connection immediately before it was
+closed; it is an error if there was none. Any existing bookmark
+under the same name will be silently replaced.
+
+@noindent
+If not given an argument, list the existing bookmarks and the points to
+which they refer in the form @var{user}@t{@@}@var{host}@t{:}@var{directory};
+this is the format in which they are stored, and the file may be edited
+directly.
+
+@findex zfgoto
+@item @t{zfgoto} [ @t{-n} ] @var{bookmark}
+Return to the location given by @var{bookmark}, as previously set by
+@t{zfmark}. If the location has user `@t{ftp}' or `@t{anonymous}', open
+the connection with @t{zfanon}, so that no password is required. If the
+user and host parameters match those stored for the current session, if
+any, those will be used, and again no password is required. Otherwise a
+password will be prompted for.
+
+@noindent
+With the option @t{-n}, the bookmark is taken to be a nickname stored by
+the @t{ncftp} program in its bookmark file, which is assumed to be
+@t{~/.ncftp/bookmarks}. The function works identically in other ways.
+Note that there is no mechanism for adding or modifying @t{ncftp} bookmarks
+from the zftp functions.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Other functions
+@noindent
+Mostly, these functions will not be called directly (apart from
+@t{zfinit}), but are described here for completeness. You may wish to
+alter @t{zftp_chpwd} and @t{zftp_progress}, in particular.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex zfinit
+@item @t{zfinit} [ @t{-n} ]
+As described above, this is used to initialize the zftp function system.
+The @t{-n} option should be used if the zftp command is already built into
+the shell.
+
+@findex zfautocheck
+@item @t{zfautocheck} [ @t{-dn} ]
+This function is called to implement automatic reopening behaviour, as
+described in more detail below. The options must appear in the first
+argument; @t{-n} prevents the command from changing to the old directory,
+while @t{-d} prevents it from setting the variable @t{do_close}, which it
+otherwise does as a flag for automatically closing the connection after a
+transfer. The host and directory for the last session are stored in the
+variable @t{$zflastsession}, but the internal host/user/password parameters
+must also be correctly set.
+
+@findex zfcd_match
+@item @t{zfcd_match @var{prefix} @var{suffix}}
+This performs matching for completion of remote directory names. If the
+remote server is UNIX, it will attempt to persuade the server to list the
+remote directory with subdirectories marked, which usually works but is not
+guaranteed. On other hosts it simply calls @t{zfget_match} and hence
+completes all files, not just directories. On some systems, directories
+may not even look like filenames.
+
+@findex zfget_match
+@item @t{zfget_match @var{prefix} @var{suffix}}
+This performs matching for completion of remote filenames. It caches files
+for the current directory (only) in the shell parameter @t{$zftp_fcache}.
+It is in the form to be called by the @t{-K} option of @t{compctl}, but
+also works when called from a widget-style completion function with
+@var{prefix} and @var{suffix} set appropriately.
+
+@findex zfrglob
+@item @t{zfrglob @var{varname}}
+Perform remote globbing, as describes in more detail below. @var{varname}
+is the name of a variable containing the pattern to be expanded; if there
+were any matches, the same variable will be set to the expanded set of
+filenames on return.
+
+@findex zfrtime
+@item @t{zfrtime} @var{lfile} @var{rfile} [ @var{time} ]
+Set the local file @var{lfile} to have the same modification time as the
+remote file @var{rfile}, or the explicit time @var{time} in FTP format
+@t{CCYYMMDDhhmmSS} for the GMT timezone. This uses the shell's
+@t{zsh/datetime} module to perform the conversion from
+GMT to local time.
+
+@findex zftp_chpwd, supplied version
+@item @t{zftp_chpwd}
+This function is called every time a connection is opened, or closed, or
+the remote directory changes. This version alters the title bar of an
+@t{xterm}-compatible or @t{sun-cmd} terminal emulator to reflect the
+local and remote hostnames and current directories. It works best when
+combined with the function @t{chpwd}. In particular, a function of
+the form
+
+@noindent
+@example
+chpwd() @{
+ if [[ -n $ZFTP_USER ]]; then
+ zftp_chpwd
+ else
+ # usual chpwd e.g put host:directory in title bar
+ fi
+@}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+fits in well.
+
+@findex zftp_progress, supplied version
+@item @t{zftp_progress}
+This function shows the status of the transfer. It will not write anything
+unless the output is going to a terminal; however, if you transfer files in
+the background, you should turn off progress reports by hand using
+`@t{zstyle ':zftp:*' progress none}'. Note also that if you alter it, any
+output @emph{must} be to standard error, as standard output may be a file
+being received. The form of the progress meter, or whether it is used at
+all, can be configured without altering the function, as described in the
+next section.
+
+@findex zffcache
+@item @t{zffcache}
+This is used to implement caching of files in the current directory for
+each session separately. It is used by @t{zfget_match} and @t{zfrglob}.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+@node Miscellaneous Features, , Zftp Functions, Zftp Function System
+
+@section Miscellaneous Features
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Configuration
+@noindent
+@cindex zftp function system, configuration
+@cindex zftp function system, styles
+@cindex styles in zftp functions
+
+@noindent
+Various styles are available using the standard shell style mechanism,
+described in
+@ref{The zsh/zutil Module}. Briefly, the
+command `@t{zstyle ':zftp:*'} @var{style} @var{value} ...'.
+defines the @var{style} to have value @var{value}; more than one value may be
+given, although that is not useful in the cases described here. These
+values will then be used throughout the zftp function system. For more
+precise control, the first argument, which gives a context in which the
+style applies, can be modified to include a particular function, as for
+example `@t{:zftp:zfget}': the style will then have the given value only
+in the @t{zfget} function. Values for the same style in different contexts
+may be set; the most specific function will be used, where
+strings are held to be more specific than patterns, and longer patterns and
+shorter patterns. Note that only the top level function name, as called by
+the user, is used; calling of lower level functions is transparent to the
+user. Hence modifications to the title bar in @t{zftp_chpwd} use the
+contexts @t{:zftp:zfopen}, @t{:zftp:zfcd}, etc., depending where it was
+called from. The following styles are understood:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@kindex progress, zftp style
+@item @t{progress}
+Controls the way that @t{zftp_progress} reports on the progress of a
+transfer. If empty, unset, or `@t{none}', no progress report is made; if
+`@t{bar}' a growing bar of inverse video is shown; if `@t{percent}' (or any
+other string, though this may change in future), the percentage of the file
+transferred is shown. The bar meter requires that the width of the
+terminal be available via the @t{$COLUMNS} parameter (normally this is set
+automatically). If the size of the file being transferred is not
+available, @t{bar} and @t{percent} meters will simply show the number of
+bytes transferred so far.
+
+@noindent
+When @t{zfinit} is run, if this style is not defined for the context
+@t{:zftp:*}, it will be set to `bar'.
+
+@kindex update, zftp style
+@item @t{update}
+Specifies the minimum time interval between updates of the progress meter
+in seconds. No update is made unless new data has been received, so the
+actual time interval is limited only by @t{$ZFTP_TIMEOUT}.
+
+@noindent
+As described for @t{progress}, @t{zfinit} will force this to default to 1.
+
+@kindex remote-glob, zftp style
+@item @t{remote-glob}
+If set to `@t{1}', `@t{yes}' or `@t{true}', filename generation (globbing) is
+performed on the remote machine instead of by zsh itself; see below.
+
+@kindex titlebar, zftp style
+@item @t{titlebar}
+If set to `@t{1}', `@t{yes}' or `@t{true}', @t{zftp_chpwd} will put the remote host and
+remote directory into the titlebar of terminal emulators such as xterm or
+sun-cmd that allow this.
+
+@noindent
+As described for @t{progress}, @t{zfinit} will force this to default to 1.
+
+@kindex chpwd, zftp style
+@item @t{chpwd}
+If set to `@t{1}' `@t{yes}' or `@t{true}', @t{zftp_chpwd} will call the function
+@t{chpwd} when a connection is closed. This is useful if the remote host
+details were put into the terminal title bar by @t{zftp_chpwd} and your
+usual @t{chpwd} also modifies the title bar.
+
+@noindent
+When @t{zfinit} is run, it will determine whether @t{chpwd} exists and if
+so it will set the default value for the style to 1 if none exists
+already.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+Note that there is also an associative array @t{zfconfig} which contains
+values used by the function system. This should not be modified or
+overwritten.
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Remote globbing
+@noindent
+@cindex zftp function system, remote globbing
+
+@noindent
+The commands for retrieving files usually perform filename generation
+(globbing) on their arguments; this can be turned off by passing the option
+@t{-G} to each of the commands. Normally this operates by retrieving a
+complete list of files for the directory in question, then matching these
+locally against the pattern supplied. This has the advantage that the full
+range of zsh patterns (respecting the setting of the option
+@t{EXTENDED_GLOB}) can be used. However, it means that the directory part
+of a filename will not be expanded and must be given exactly. If the
+remote server does not support the UNIX directory semantics, directory
+handling is problematic and it is recommended that globbing only be used
+within the current directory. The list of files in the current directory,
+if retrieved, will be cached, so that subsequent globs in the same
+directory without an intervening @t{zfcd} are much faster.
+
+@noindent
+If the @t{remote-glob} style (see above) is set, globbing is instead
+performed on the remote host: the server is asked for a list of matching
+files. This is highly dependent on how the server is implemented, though
+typically UNIX servers will provide support for basic glob patterns. This
+may in some cases be faster, as it avoids retrieving the entire list of
+directory contents.
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Automatic and temporary reopening
+@noindent
+@cindex zftp function system, automatic reopening
+
+@noindent
+As described for the @t{zfopen} command, a subsequent @t{zfopen} with no
+parameters will reopen the connection to the last host (this includes
+connections made with the @t{zfanon} command). Opened in this fashion, the
+connection starts in the default remote directory and will remain open
+until explicitly closed.
+
+@noindent
+Automatic re-opening is also available. If a connection is not currently
+open and a command requiring a connection is given, the last connection is
+implicitly reopened. In this case the directory which was current when the
+connection was closed again becomes the current directory (unless, of
+course, the command given changes it). Automatic reopening will also take
+place if the connection was close by the remote server for whatever reason
+(e.g. a timeout). It is not available if the @t{-1} option to @t{zfopen}
+or @t{zfanon} was used.
+
+@noindent
+Furthermore, if the command issued is a file transfer, the connection will
+be closed after the transfer is finished, hence providing a one-shot mode
+for transfers. This does not apply to directory changing or listing
+commands; for example a @t{zfdir} may reopen a connection but will leave it
+open. Also, automatic closure will only ever happen in the same command as
+automatic opening, i.e a @t{zfdir} directly followed by a @t{zfget} will
+never close the connection automatically.
+
+@noindent
+Information about the previous connection is given by the @t{zfstat}
+function. So, for example, if that reports:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+Session: default
+Not connected.
+Last session: ftp.bar.com:/pub/textfiles
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+then the command @t{zfget file.txt} will attempt to reopen a connection to
+@t{ftp.bar.com}, retrieve the file @t{/pub/textfiles/file.txt}, and
+immediately close the connection again. On the other hand, @t{zfcd ..}
+will open the connection in the directory @t{/pub} and leave it open.
+
+@noindent
+Note that all the above is local to each session; if you return to a
+previous session, the connection for that session is the one which will be
+reopened.
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Completion
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+Completion of local and remote files, directories, sessions and bookmarks
+is supported. The older, @t{compctl}-style completion is defined when
+@t{zfinit} is called; support for the new widget-based completion system is
+provided in the function @t{Completion/Zsh/Command/_zftp}, which should be
+installed with the other functions of the completion system and hence
+should automatically be available.
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/contrib.yo
+@node User Contributions, , Zftp Function System, Top
+
+@chapter User Contributions
+@noindent
+@cindex user contributions
+
+@section Description
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+The Zsh source distribution includes a number of items contributed by the
+user community. These are not inherently a part of the shell, and some
+may not be available in every zsh installation. The most significant of
+these are documented here. For documentation on other contributed items
+such as shell functions, look for comments in the function source files.
+
+@noindent
+@menu
+* Utilities::
+* Recent Directories::
+* Other Directory Functions::
+* Version Control Information::
+* Prompt Themes::
+* ZLE Functions::
+* Exception Handling::
+* MIME Functions::
+* Mathematical Functions::
+* User Configuration Functions::
+* Other Functions::
+@end menu
+
+@noindent
+@node Utilities, Recent Directories, , User Contributions
+
+@section Utilities
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Accessing On-Line Help
+@noindent
+@cindex helpfiles utility
+
+@noindent
+The key sequence @t{ESC h} is normally bound by ZLE to execute the
+@t{run-help} widget (see
+@ref{Zsh Line Editor}). This invokes the @t{run-help} command with the command word from the
+current input line as its argument. By default, @t{run-help} is an alias
+for the @t{man} command, so this often fails when the command word is a
+shell builtin or a user-defined function. By redefining the @t{run-help}
+alias, one can improve the on-line help provided by the shell.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{helpfiles} utility, found in the @t{Util} directory of the
+distribution, is a Perl program that can be used to process the zsh manual
+to produce a separate help file for each shell builtin and for many other
+shell features as well. The autoloadable @t{run-help} function, found in
+@t{Functions/Misc}, searches for these helpfiles and performs several
+other tests to produce the most complete help possible for the command.
+
+@noindent
+Help files are installed by default to a subdirectory of @t{/usr/share/zsh}
+or @t{/usr/local/share/zsh}.
+
+@noindent
+To create your own help files with @t{helpfiles}, choose or create a
+directory where the individual command help files will reside. For
+example, you might choose @t{~/zsh_help}. If you unpacked the zsh
+distribution in your home directory, you would use the commands:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+mkdir ~/zsh_help
+perl ~/zsh-5.8/Util/helpfiles ~/zsh_help
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+@vindex HELPDIR
+The @t{HELPDIR} parameter tells @t{run-help} where to look for the help
+files. When unset, it uses the default installation path.
+To use your own set of help files, set this to the appropriate path
+in one of your startup files:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+HELPDIR=~/zsh_help
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+@findex run-help, use of
+To use the @t{run-help} function, you need to add lines something
+like the following to your @t{.zshrc} or equivalent startup file:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+unalias run-help
+autoload run-help
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Note that in order for `@t{autoload run-help}' to work, the @t{run-help}
+file must be in one of the directories named in your @t{fpath} array (see
+@ref{Parameters Used By The Shell}). This should already be the case if you have a standard zsh
+installation; if it is not, copy @t{Functions/Misc/run-help} to an
+appropriate directory.
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Recompiling Functions
+@noindent
+@cindex functions, recompiling
+@cindex zrecompile utility
+
+@noindent
+If you frequently edit your zsh functions, or periodically update your zsh
+installation to track the latest developments, you may find that function
+digests compiled with the @t{zcompile} builtin are frequently out of date
+with respect to the function source files. This is not usually a problem,
+because zsh always looks for the newest file when loading a function, but
+it may cause slower shell startup and function loading. Also, if a digest
+file is explicitly used as an element of @t{fpath}, zsh won't check whether
+any of its source files has changed.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{zrecompile} autoloadable function, found in @t{Functions/Misc}, can
+be used to keep function digests up to date.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex zrecompile
+@item @t{zrecompile} [ @t{-qt} ] [ @var{name} ... ]
+@itemx @t{zrecompile} [ @t{-qt} ] @t{-p} @var{arg} ... [ @t{-}@t{-} @var{arg} ... ]
+This tries to find @t{*.zwc} files and automatically re-compile them if at
+least one of the original files is newer than the compiled file. This
+works only if the names stored in the compiled files are full paths or are
+relative to the directory that contains the @t{.zwc} file.
+
+@noindent
+In the first form, each @var{name} is the name of a compiled file or a
+directory containing @t{*.zwc} files that should be checked. If no
+arguments are given, the directories and @t{*.zwc} files in @t{fpath} are
+used.
+
+@noindent
+When @t{-t} is given, no compilation is performed, but a return status of
+zero (true) is set if there are files that need to be re-compiled and
+non-zero (false) otherwise. The @t{-q} option quiets the chatty output
+that describes what @t{zrecompile} is doing.
+
+@noindent
+Without the @t{-t} option, the return status is zero if all files that
+needed re-compilation could be compiled and non-zero if compilation for at
+least one of the files failed.
+
+@noindent
+If the @t{-p} option is given, the @var{arg}s are interpreted as one
+or more sets of arguments for @t{zcompile}, separated by `@t{-}@t{-}'.
+For example:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zrecompile -p \
+ -R ~/.zshrc -- \
+ -M ~/.zcompdump -- \
+ ~/zsh/comp.zwc ~/zsh/Completion/*/_*
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+This compiles @t{~/.zshrc} into @t{~/.zshrc.zwc} if that doesn't exist or
+if it is older than @t{~/.zshrc}. The compiled file will be marked for
+reading instead of mapping. The same is done for @t{~/.zcompdump} and
+@t{~/.zcompdump.zwc}, but this compiled file is marked for mapping. The
+last line re-creates the file @t{~/zsh/comp.zwc} if any of the files
+matching the given pattern is newer than it.
+
+@noindent
+Without the @t{-p} option, @t{zrecompile} does not create function digests
+that do not already exist, nor does it add new functions to the digest.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+The following shell loop is an example of a method for creating function
+digests for all functions in your @t{fpath}, assuming that you have write
+permission to the directories:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+for ((i=1; i <= $#fpath; ++i)); do
+ dir=$fpath[i]
+ zwc=$@{dir:t@}.zwc
+ if [[ $dir == (.|..) || $dir == (.|..)/* ]]; then
+ continue
+ fi
+ files=($dir/*(N-.))
+ if [[ -w $dir:h && -n $files ]]; then
+ files=($@{$@{(M)files%/*/*@}#/@})
+ if ( cd $dir:h &&
+ zrecompile -p -U -z $zwc $files ); then
+ fpath[i]=$fpath[i].zwc
+ fi
+ fi
+done
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The @t{-U} and @t{-z} options are appropriate for functions in the default
+zsh installation @t{fpath}; you may need to use different options for your
+personal function directories.
+
+@noindent
+Once the digests have been created and your @t{fpath} modified to refer to
+them, you can keep them up to date by running @t{zrecompile} with no
+arguments.
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Keyboard Definition
+@noindent
+@cindex keyboard definition
+
+@noindent
+@findex zkbd
+The large number of possible combinations of keyboards, workstations,
+terminals, emulators, and window systems makes it impossible for zsh to
+have built-in key bindings for every situation. The @t{zkbd} utility,
+found in @t{Functions/Misc}, can help you quickly create key bindings for your
+configuration.
+
+@noindent
+Run @t{zkbd} either as an autoloaded function, or as a shell script:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zsh -f ~/zsh-5.8/Functions/Misc/zkbd
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+When you run @t{zkbd}, it first asks you to enter your terminal type; if
+the default it offers is correct, just press return. It then asks you to
+press a number of different keys to determine characteristics of your
+keyboard and terminal; @t{zkbd} warns you if it finds anything out of the
+ordinary, such as a Delete key that sends neither @t{^H} nor @t{^?}.
+
+@noindent
+The keystrokes read by @t{zkbd} are recorded as a definition for an
+associative array named @t{key}, written to a file in the subdirectory
+@t{.zkbd} within either your @t{HOME} or @t{ZDOTDIR} directory. The name
+of the file is composed from the @t{TERM}, @t{VENDOR} and @t{OSTYPE}
+parameters, joined by hyphens.
+
+@noindent
+You may read this file into your @t{.zshrc} or another startup file with
+the `@t{source}' or `@t{.}' commands, then reference the @t{key} parameter
+in bindkey commands, like this:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+source $@{ZDOTDIR:-$HOME@}/.zkbd/$TERM-$VENDOR-$OSTYPE
+[[ -n $@{key[Left]@} ]] && bindkey "$@{key[Left]@}" backward-char
+[[ -n $@{key[Right]@} ]] && bindkey "$@{key[Right]@}" forward-char
+# etc.
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Note that in order for `@t{autoload zkbd}' to work, the @t{zkdb} file must
+be in one of the directories named in your @t{fpath} array (see
+@ref{Parameters Used By The Shell}). This should already be the case if you have a standard zsh
+installation; if it is not, copy @t{Functions/Misc/zkbd} to an
+appropriate directory.
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Dumping Shell State
+@noindent
+@cindex reporter utility
+
+@noindent
+Occasionally you may encounter what appears to be a bug in the shell,
+particularly if you are using a beta version of zsh or a development
+release. Usually it is sufficient to send a description of the
+problem to one of the zsh mailing lists (see
+@ref{Mailing Lists}), but sometimes one of the zsh developers will need to recreate your
+environment in order to track the problem down.
+
+@noindent
+The script named @t{reporter}, found in the @t{Util} directory of the
+distribution, is provided for this purpose. (It is also possible to
+@t{autoload reporter}, but @t{reporter} is not installed in @t{fpath}
+by default.) This script outputs a detailed dump of the shell state,
+in the form of another script that can be read with `@t{zsh -f}' to
+recreate that state.
+
+@noindent
+To use @t{reporter}, read the script into your shell with the `@t{.}'
+command and redirect the output into a file:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+. ~/zsh-5.8/Util/reporter > zsh.report
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+You should check the @t{zsh.report} file for any sensitive information
+such as passwords and delete them by hand before sending the script to the
+developers. Also, as the output can be voluminous, it's best to wait for
+the developers to ask for this information before sending it.
+
+@noindent
+You can also use @t{reporter} to dump only a subset of the shell state.
+This is sometimes useful for creating startup files for the first time.
+Most of the output from reporter is far more detailed than usually is
+necessary for a startup file, but the @t{aliases}, @t{options}, and
+@t{zstyles} states may be useful because they include only changes from
+the defaults. The @t{bindings} state may be useful if you have created
+any of your own keymaps, because @t{reporter} arranges to dump the keymap
+creation commands as well as the bindings for every keymap.
+
+@noindent
+As is usual with automated tools, if you create a startup file with
+@t{reporter}, you should edit the results to remove unnecessary commands.
+Note that if you're using the new completion system, you should @emph{not}
+dump the @t{functions} state to your startup files with @t{reporter}; use
+the @t{compdump} function instead (see
+@ref{Completion System}).
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{reporter} [ @var{state} ... ]
+@findex reporter
+Print to standard output the indicated subset of the current shell state.
+The @var{state} arguments may be one or more of:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{all}
+Output everything listed below.
+@item @t{aliases}
+Output alias definitions.
+@item @t{bindings}
+Output ZLE key maps and bindings.
+@item @t{completion}
+Output old-style @t{compctl} commands.
+New completion is covered by @t{functions} and @t{zstyles}.
+@item @t{functions}
+Output autoloads and function definitions.
+@item @t{limits}
+Output @t{limit} commands.
+@item @t{options}
+Output @t{setopt} commands.
+@item @t{styles}
+Same as @t{zstyles}.
+@item @t{variables}
+Output shell parameter assignments, plus @t{export}
+commands for any environment variables.
+@item @t{zstyles}
+Output @t{zstyle} commands.
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+If the @var{state} is omitted, @t{all} is assumed.
+
+
+@noindent
+With the exception of `@t{all}', every @var{state} can be abbreviated by
+any prefix, even a single letter; thus @t{a} is the same as @t{aliases},
+@t{z} is the same as @t{zstyles}, etc.
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Manipulating Hook Functions
+@noindent
+@cindex hook function utility
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex add-zsh-hook
+@item @t{add-zsh-hook} [ @t{-L} | @t{-dD} ] [ @t{-Uzk} ] @var{hook} @var{function}
+Several functions are special to the shell, as described in the section
+Special Functions, @ref{Functions},
+in that they are automatically called at specific points during shell execution.
+Each has an associated array consisting of names of functions to be
+called at the same point; these are so-called `hook functions'.
+The shell function @t{add-zsh-hook} provides a simple way of adding or
+removing functions from the array.
+
+@noindent
+@var{hook} is one of @t{chpwd}, @t{periodic}, @t{precmd}, @t{preexec},
+@t{zshaddhistory}, @t{zshexit}, or @t{zsh_directory_name},
+the special functions in question. Note that @t{zsh_directory_name}
+is called in a different way from the other functions, but may
+still be manipulated as a hook.
+
+@noindent
+@var{function} is name of an ordinary shell function. If no options
+are given this will be added to the array of functions to be executed
+in the given context.
+Functions are invoked in the order they were added.
+
+@noindent
+If the option @t{-L} is given, the current values for the hook arrays
+are listed with @t{typeset}.
+
+@noindent
+If the option @t{-d} is given, the @var{function} is removed from
+the array of functions to be executed.
+
+@noindent
+If the option @t{-D} is given, the @var{function} is treated as a pattern
+and any matching names of functions are removed from the array of
+functions to be executed.
+
+@noindent
+The options @t{-U}, @t{-z} and @t{-k} are passed as arguments to
+@t{autoload} for @var{function}. For functions contributed with zsh, the
+options @t{-Uz} are appropriate.
+
+@findex add-zle-hook-widget
+@item @t{add-zle-hook-widget} [ @t{-L} | @t{-dD} ] [ @t{-Uzk} ] @var{hook} @var{widgetname}
+Several widget names are special to the line editor, as described in the section
+Special Widgets, @ref{Zle Widgets},
+in that they are automatically called at specific points during editing.
+Unlike function hooks, these do not use a predefined array of other names
+to call at the same point; the shell function @t{add-zle-hook-widget}
+maintains a similar array and arranges for the special widget to invoke
+those additional widgets.
+
+@noindent
+@var{hook} is one of @t{isearch-exit}, @t{isearch-update},
+@t{line-pre-redraw}, @t{line-init}, @t{line-finish}, @t{history-line-set},
+or @t{keymap-select}, corresponding to each of the special widgets
+@t{zle-isearch-exit}, etc. The special widget names are also accepted
+as the @var{hook} argument.
+
+@noindent
+@var{widgetname} is the name of a ZLE widget. If no options are given this
+is added to the array of widgets to be invoked in the given hook context.
+Widgets are invoked in the order they were added, with
+@example
+@t{zle }@var{widgetname}@t{ -Nw -- "$@@"}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+@vindex WIDGET, in hooks
+Note that this means that the `@t{WIDGET}' special parameter tracks the
+@var{widgetname} when the widget function is called, rather than tracking
+the name of the corresponding special hook widget.
+
+@noindent
+If the option @t{-d} is given, the @var{widgetname} is removed from
+the array of widgets to be executed.
+
+@noindent
+If the option @t{-D} is given, the @var{widgetname} is treated as a pattern
+and any matching names of widgets are removed from the array.
+
+@noindent
+If @var{widgetname} does not name an existing widget when added to the
+array, it is assumed that a shell function also named @var{widgetname} is
+meant to provide the implementation of the widget. This name is therefore
+marked for autoloading, and the options @t{-U}, @t{-z} and @t{-k} are
+passed as arguments to @t{autoload} as with @t{add-zsh-hook}. The
+widget is also created with `@t{zle -N }@var{widgetname}' to cause the
+corresponding function to be loaded the first time the hook is called.
+
+@noindent
+The arrays of @var{widgetname} are currently maintained in @t{zstyle}
+contexts, one for each @var{hook} context, with a style of `@t{widgets}'.
+If the @t{-L} option is given, this set of styles is listed with
+`@t{zstyle -L}'. This implementation may change, and the special widgets
+that refer to the styles are created only if @t{add-zle-hook-widget} is
+called to add at least one widget, so if this function is used for any
+hooks, then all hooks should be managed only via this function.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+@node Recent Directories, Other Directory Functions, Utilities, User Contributions
+@cindex recent directories, maintaining list of
+@cindex directories, maintaining list of recent
+@findex cdr
+@findex _cdr
+@findex chpwd_recent_add
+@findex chpwd_recent_dirs
+@findex chpwd_recent_filehandler
+
+@section Remembering Recent Directories
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+The function @t{cdr} allows you to change the working directory to a
+previous working directory from a list maintained automatically. It is
+similar in concept to the directory stack controlled by the @t{pushd},
+@t{popd} and @t{dirs} builtins, but is more configurable, and as it stores
+all entries in files it is maintained across sessions and (by default)
+between terminal emulators in the current session. Duplicates are
+automatically removed, so that the list reflects the single most recent
+use of each directory.
+
+@noindent
+Note that the @t{pushd} directory stack is not actually modified or used
+by @t{cdr} unless you configure it to do so as described in the
+configuration section below.
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Installation
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+The system works by means of a hook function that is called every time the
+directory changes. To install the system, autoload the required functions
+and use the @t{add-zsh-hook} function described above:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+autoload -Uz chpwd_recent_dirs cdr add-zsh-hook
+add-zsh-hook chpwd chpwd_recent_dirs
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Now every time you change directly interactively, no matter which
+command you use, the directory to which you change will be remembered
+in most-recent-first order.
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Use
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+All direct user interaction is via the @t{cdr} function.
+
+@noindent
+The argument to cdr is a number @var{N} corresponding to the @var{N}th most
+recently changed-to directory. 1 is the immediately preceding directory;
+the current directory is remembered but is not offered as a destination.
+Note that if you have multiple windows open 1 may refer to a directory
+changed to in another window; you can avoid this by having per-terminal
+files for storing directory as described for the
+@t{recent-dirs-file} style below.
+
+@noindent
+If you set the @t{recent-dirs-default} style described below @t{cdr}
+will behave the same as @t{cd} if given a non-numeric argument, or more
+than one argument. The recent directory list is updated just the same
+however you change directory.
+
+@noindent
+If the argument is omitted, 1 is assumed. This is similar to @t{pushd}'s
+behaviour of swapping the two most recent directories on the stack.
+
+@noindent
+Completion for the argument to @t{cdr} is available if compinit has been
+run; menu selection is recommended, using:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle ':completion:*:*:cdr:*:*' menu selection
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+to allow you to cycle through recent directories; the order is preserved,
+so the first choice is the most recent directory before the current one.
+The verbose style is also recommended to ensure the directory is shown; this
+style is on by default so no action is required unless you have changed it.
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Options
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+The behaviour of @t{cdr} may be modified by the following options.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{-l}
+lists the numbers and the corresponding directories in
+abbreviated form (i.e. with @t{~} substitution reapplied), one per line.
+The directories here are not quoted (this would only be an issue if a
+directory name contained a newline). This is used by the completion
+system.
+
+@item @t{-r}
+sets the variable @t{reply} to the current set of directories. Nothing
+is printed and the directory is not changed.
+
+@item @t{-e}
+allows you to edit the list of directories, one per line. The
+list can be edited to any extent you like; no sanity checking is
+performed. Completion is available. No quoting is necessary (except for
+newlines, where I have in any case no sympathy); directories are in
+unabbreviated from and contain an absolute path, i.e. they start with @t{/}.
+Usually the first entry should be left as the current directory.
+
+@item @t{-p '}@var{pattern}@t{'}
+Prunes any items in the directory list that match the given extended glob
+pattern; the pattern needs to be quoted from immediate expansion on the
+command line. The pattern is matched against each completely expanded
+file name in the list; the full string must match, so wildcards at the
+end (e.g. @t{'*removeme*'}) are needed to remove entries with a given
+substring.
+
+@noindent
+If output is to a terminal, then the function will print the new list
+after pruning and prompt for confirmation by the user. This output and
+confirmation step can be skipped by using @t{-P} instead of @t{-p}.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Configuration
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+Configuration is by means of the styles mechanism that should be familiar
+from completion; if not, see the description of the @t{zstyle} command in
+@ref{The zsh/zutil Module}. The context for setting styles
+should be @t{':chpwd:*'} in case the meaning of the context is extended in
+future, for example:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle ':chpwd:*' recent-dirs-max 0
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+sets the value of the @t{recent-dirs-max} style to 0. In practice the
+style name is specific enough that a context of '*' should be fine.
+
+@noindent
+An exception is @t{recent-dirs-insert}, which is used exclusively by the
+completion system and so has the usual completion system context
+(@t{':completion:*'} if nothing more specific is needed), though again
+@t{'*'} should be fine in practice.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{recent-dirs-default}
+If true, and the command is expecting a recent directory index, and
+either there is more than one argument or the argument is not an
+integer, then fall through to "cd". This allows the lazy to use only
+one command for directory changing. Completion recognises this, too;
+see recent-dirs-insert for how to control completion when this option
+is in use.
+
+@item @t{recent-dirs-file}
+The file where the list of directories is saved. The default
+is @t{$@{ZDOTDIR:-$HOME@}/.chpwd-recent-dirs}, i.e. this is in your
+home directory unless you have set the variable @t{ZDOTDIR} to point
+somewhere else. Directory names are saved in @t{$'}@var{...}@t{'} quoted
+form, so each line in the file can be supplied directly to the shell as an
+argument.
+
+@noindent
+The value of this style may be an array. In this case, the first
+file in the list will always be used for saving directories while any
+other files are left untouched. When reading the recent directory
+list, if there are fewer than the maximum number of entries in the
+first file, the contents of later files in the array will be appended
+with duplicates removed from the list shown. The contents of the two
+files are not sorted together, i.e. all the entries in the first file
+are shown first. The special value @t{+} can appear in the list to
+indicate the default file should be read at that point. This allows
+effects like the following:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle ':chpwd:*' recent-dirs-file \
+~/.chpwd-recent-dirs-$@{TTY##*/@} +
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Recent directories are read from a file numbered according to
+the terminal. If there are insufficient entries the list
+is supplemented from the default file.
+
+@noindent
+It is possible to use @t{zstyle -e} to make the directory configurable
+at run time:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle -e ':chpwd:*' recent-dirs-file pick-recent-dirs-file
+pick-recent-dirs-file() @{
+ if [[ $PWD = ~/text/writing(|/*) ]]; then
+ reply=(~/.chpwd-recent-dirs-writing)
+ else
+ reply=(+)
+ fi
+@}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+In this example, if the current directory is @t{~/text/writing} or a
+directory under it, then use a special file for saving recent
+directories, else use the default.
+
+@item @t{recent-dirs-insert}
+Used by completion. If @t{recent-dirs-default} is true, then setting
+this to @t{true} causes the actual directory, rather than its index, to
+be inserted on the command line; this has the same effect as using
+the corresponding index, but makes the history clearer and the line
+easier to edit. With this setting, if part of an argument was
+already typed, normal directory completion rather than recent
+directory completion is done; this is because recent directory
+completion is expected to be done by cycling through entries menu
+fashion.
+
+@noindent
+If the value of the style is @t{always}, then only recent directories will
+be completed; in that case, use the @t{cd} command when you want to
+complete other directories.
+
+@noindent
+If the value is @t{fallback}, recent directories will be tried first, then
+normal directory completion is performed if recent directory completion
+failed to find a match.
+
+@noindent
+Finally, if the value is @t{both} then both sets of completions are
+presented; the usual tag mechanism can be used to distinguish results, with
+recent directories tagged as @t{recent-dirs}. Note that the recent
+directories inserted are abbreviated with directory names where appropriate.
+
+@item @t{recent-dirs-max}
+The maximum number of directories to save to the file. If
+this is zero or negative there is no maximum. The default is 20.
+Note this includes the current directory, which isn't offered,
+so the highest number of directories you will be offered
+is one less than the maximum.
+
+@item @t{recent-dirs-prune}
+This style is an array determining what directories should (or should
+not) be added to the recent list. Elements of the array can include:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{parent}
+Prune parents (more accurately, ancestors) from the recent list.
+If present, changing directly down by any number of directories
+causes the current directory to be overwritten. For example,
+changing from ~pws to ~pws/some/other/dir causes ~pws not to be
+left on the recent directory stack. This only applies to direct
+changes to descendant directories; earlier directories on the
+list are not pruned. For example, changing from ~pws/yet/another
+to ~pws/some/other/dir does not cause ~pws to be pruned.
+
+@item @t{pattern:@var{pattern}}
+Gives a zsh pattern for directories that should not be
+added to the recent list (if not already there). This element
+can be repeated to add different patterns. For example,
+@t{'pattern:/tmp(|/*)'} stops @t{/tmp} or its descendants
+from being added. The @t{EXTENDED_GLOB} option is always turned on
+for these patterns.
+
+@end table
+
+@item @t{recent-dirs-pushd}
+If set to true, @t{cdr} will use @t{pushd} instead of @t{cd} to change the
+directory, so the directory is saved on the directory stack. As the
+directory stack is completely separate from the list of files saved
+by the mechanism used in this file there is no obvious reason to do
+this.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Use with dynamic directory naming
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+It is possible to refer to recent directories using the dynamic directory
+name syntax by using the supplied function @t{zsh_directory_name_cdr}
+a hook:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+autoload -Uz add-zsh-hook
+add-zsh-hook -Uz zsh_directory_name zsh_directory_name_cdr
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+When this is done, @t{~[1]} will refer to the most recent
+directory other than $PWD, and so on. Completion after @t{~[}@var{...}
+also works.
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Details of directory handling
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+This section is for the curious or confused; most users will not
+need to know this information.
+
+@noindent
+Recent directories are saved to a file immediately and hence are
+preserved across sessions. Note currently no file locking is applied:
+the list is updated immediately on interactive commands and nowhere else
+(unlike history), and it is assumed you are only going to change
+directory in one window at once. This is not safe on shared accounts,
+but in any case the system has limited utility when someone else is
+changing to a different set of directories behind your back.
+
+@noindent
+To make this a little safer, only directory changes instituted from the
+command line, either directly or indirectly through shell function calls
+(but not through subshells, evals, traps, completion functions and the
+like) are saved. Shell functions should use @t{cd -q} or @t{pushd -q} to
+avoid side effects if the change to the directory is to be invisible at the
+command line. See the contents of the function @t{chpwd_recent_dirs} for
+more details.
+
+@noindent
+@node Other Directory Functions, Version Control Information, Recent Directories, User Contributions
+@cindex directories, named, dynamic, helper function
+@cindex dynamic directory naming, helper function
+@cindex named directories, dynamic, helper function
+@findex zsh_directory_name_generic
+
+@section Abbreviated dynamic references to directories
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+The dynamic directory naming system is described in the subsection
+@emph{Dynamic named directories} of
+@ref{Filename Expansion}. In this, a reference to
+@t{~[}@var{...}@t{]} is expanded by a function found by the hooks
+mechanism.
+
+@noindent
+The contributed function @t{zsh_directory_name_generic} provides a
+system allowing the user to refer to directories with only a limited
+amount of new code. It supports all three of the standard interfaces
+for directory naming: converting from a name to a directory, converting
+in the reverse direction to find a short name, and completion of names.
+
+@noindent
+The main feature of this function is a path-like syntax,
+combining abbreviations at multiple levels separated by ":".
+As an example, ~[g:p:s] might specify:
+@table @asis
+@item @t{g}
+The top level directory for your git area. This first component
+has to match, or the function will return indicating another
+directory name hook function should be tried.
+
+@item @t{p}
+The name of a project within your git area.
+
+@item @t{s}
+The source area within that project.
+
+@end table
+This allows you to collapse references to long hierarchies to a very
+compact form, particularly if the hierarchies are similar across different
+areas of the disk.
+
+@noindent
+Name components may be completed: if a description is shown at the top
+of the list of completions, it includes the path to which previous
+components expand, while the description for an individual completion
+shows the path segment it would add. No additional configuration is
+needed for this as the completion system is aware of the dynamic
+directory name mechanism.
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Usage
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+To use the function, first define a wrapper function for your specific
+case. We'll assume it's to be autoloaded. This can have any name but
+we'll refer to it as zdn_mywrapper. This wrapper function will define
+various variables and then call this function with the same arguments
+that the wrapper function gets. This configuration is described below.
+
+@noindent
+Then arrange for the wrapper to be run as a zsh_directory_name hook:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+autoload -Uz add-zsh-hook zsh_diretory_name_generic zdn_mywrapper
+add-zsh-hook -U zsh_directory_name zdn_mywrapper
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Configuration
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+The wrapper function should define a local associative array zdn_top.
+Alternatively, this can be set with a style called @t{mapping}. The
+context for the style is @t{:zdn:}@var{wrapper-name} where
+@var{wrapper-name} is the function calling zsh_directory_name_generic;
+for example:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle :zdn:zdn_mywrapper: mapping zdn_mywrapper_top
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The keys in this associative array correspond to the first component of
+the name. The values are matching directories. They may have an
+optional suffix with a slash followed by a colon and the name of a
+variable in the same format to give the next component. (The slash
+before the colon is to disambiguate the case where a colon is needed in
+the path for a drive. There is otherwise no syntax for escaping this,
+so path components whose names start with a colon are not supported.) A
+special component @t{:default:} specifies a variable in the form
+@t{/:}@var{var} (the path section is ignored and so is usually empty)
+that will be used for the next component if no variable is given for the
+path. Variables referred to within @t{zdn_top} have the same format as
+@t{zdn_top} itself, but contain relative paths.
+
+@noindent
+For example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+local -A zdn_top=(
+ g ~/git
+ ga ~/alternate/git
+ gs /scratch/$USER/git/:second2
+ :default: /:second1
+)
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+This specifies the behaviour of a directory referred to as @t{~[g:...]}
+or @t{~[ga:...]} or @t{~[gs:...]}. Later path components are optional;
+in that case @t{~[g]} expands to @t{~/git}, and so on. @t{gs} expands
+to @t{/scratch/$USER/git} and uses the associative array @t{second2} to
+match the second component; @t{g} and @t{ga} use the associative array
+@t{second1} to match the second component.
+
+@noindent
+When expanding a name to a directory, if the first component is not @t{g} or
+@t{ga} or @t{gs}, it is not an error; the function simply returns 1 so that a
+later hook function can be tried. However, matching the first component
+commits the function, so if a later component does not match, an error
+is printed (though this still does not stop later hooks from being
+executed).
+
+@noindent
+For components after the first, a relative path is expected, but note that
+multiple levels may still appear. Here is an example of @t{second1}:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+local -A second1=(
+ p myproject
+ s somproject
+ os otherproject/subproject/:third
+)
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The path as found from @t{zdn_top} is extended with the matching
+directory, so @t{~[g:p]} becomes @t{~/git/myproject}. The slash between
+is added automatically (it's not possible to have a later component
+modify the name of a directory already matched). Only @t{os} specifies
+a variable for a third component, and there's no @t{:default:}, so it's
+an error to use a name like @t{~[g:p:x]} or @t{~[ga:s:y]} because
+there's nowhere to look up the @t{x} or @t{y}.
+
+@noindent
+The associative arrays need to be visible within this function; the
+generic function therefore uses internal variable names beginning
+@t{_zdn_} in order to avoid clashes. Note that the variable @t{reply}
+needs to be passed back to the shell, so should not be local in the
+calling function.
+
+@noindent
+The function does not test whether directories assembled by component
+actually exist; this allows the system to work across automounted
+file systems. The error from the command trying to use a non-existent
+directory should be sufficient to indicate the problem.
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Complete example
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+Here is a full fictitious but usable autoloadable definition of the
+example function defined by the code above. So @t{~[gs:p:s]} expands
+to @t{/scratch/$USER/git/myscratchproject/top/srcdir} (with @t{$USER}
+also expanded).
+
+@noindent
+@example
+local -A zdn_top=(
+ g ~/git
+ ga ~/alternate/git
+ gs /scratch/$USER/git/:second2
+ :default: /:second1
+)
+
+local -A second1=(
+ p myproject
+ s somproject
+ os otherproject/subproject/:third
+)
+
+local -A second2=(
+ p myscratchproject
+ s somescratchproject
+)
+
+local -A third=(
+ s top/srcdir
+ d top/documentation
+)
+
+# autoload not needed if you did this at initialisation...
+autoload -Uz zsh_directory_name_generic
+zsh_directory_name_generic "$@@
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+It is also possible to use global associative arrays, suitably named,
+and set the style for the context of your wrapper function to
+refer to this. Then your set up code would contain the following:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+typeset -A zdn_mywrapper_top=(...)
+# ... and so on for other associative arrays ...
+zstyle ':zdn:zdn_mywrapper:' mapping zdn_mywrapper_top
+autoload -Uz add-zsh-hook zsh_directory_name_generic zdn_mywrapper
+add-zsh-hook -U zsh_directory_name zdn_mywrapper
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+and the function @t{zdn_mywrapper} would contain only the following:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zsh_directory_name_generic "$@@"
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+@node Version Control Information, Prompt Themes, Other Directory Functions, User Contributions
+
+@section Gathering information from version control systems
+@noindent
+@cindex version control utility
+
+@noindent
+In a lot of cases, it is nice to automatically retrieve information from
+version control systems (VCSs), such as subversion, CVS or git, to be able
+to provide it to the user; possibly in the user's prompt. So that you can
+instantly tell which branch you are currently on, for example.
+
+@noindent
+In order to do that, you may use the @t{vcs_info} function.
+
+@noindent
+The following VCSs are supported, showing the abbreviated name by which
+they are referred to within the system:
+@table @asis
+@item Bazaar (@t{bzr})
+@t{@uref{https://bazaar.canonical.com/}}
+@item Codeville (@t{cdv})
+@t{@uref{http://freecode.com/projects/codeville/}}
+@item Concurrent Versioning System (@t{cvs})
+@t{@uref{https://www.nongnu.org/cvs/}}
+@item Darcs (@t{darcs})
+@t{@uref{http://darcs.net/}}
+@item Fossil (@t{fossil})
+@t{@uref{https://fossil-scm.org/}}
+@item Git (@t{git})
+@t{@uref{https://git-scm.com/}}
+@item GNU arch (@t{tla})
+@t{@uref{https://www.gnu.org/software/gnu-arch/}}
+@item Mercurial (@t{hg})
+@t{@uref{https://www.mercurial-scm.org/}}
+@item Monotone (@t{mtn})
+@t{@uref{https://monotone.ca/}}
+@item Perforce (@t{p4})
+@t{@uref{https://www.perforce.com/}}
+@item Subversion (@t{svn})
+@t{@uref{https://subversion.apache.org/}}
+@item SVK (@t{svk})
+@t{@uref{https://svk.bestpractical.com/}}
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+There is also support for the patch management system @t{quilt}
+(@t{@uref{https://savannah.nongnu.org/projects/quilt}}). See
+@ref{vcs_info Quilt Support}
+below for details.
+
+@noindent
+To load @t{vcs_info}:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+autoload -Uz vcs_info
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+It can be used in any existing prompt, because it does not require any
+specific @t{$psvar} entries to be available.
+
+@noindent
+@menu
+* vcs_info Quickstart::
+* vcs_info Configuration::
+* vcs_info Oddities::
+* vcs_info Quilt Support::
+* vcs_info API::
+* vcs_info Variables::
+* vcs_info Hooks::
+* vcs_info Examples::
+@end menu
+
+@noindent
+@node vcs_info Quickstart, vcs_info Configuration, , Version Control Information
+
+@subsection Quickstart
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+To get this feature working quickly (including colors), you can do the
+following (assuming, you loaded @t{vcs_info} properly - see above):
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle ':vcs_info:*' actionformats \
+ '%F@{5@}(%f%s%F@{5@})%F@{3@}-%F@{5@}[%F@{2@}%b%F@{3@}|%F@{1@}%a%F@{5@}]%f '
+zstyle ':vcs_info:*' formats \
+ '%F@{5@}(%f%s%F@{5@})%F@{3@}-%F@{5@}[%F@{2@}%b%F@{5@}]%f '
+zstyle ':vcs_info:(sv[nk]|bzr):*' branchformat '%b%F@{1@}:%F@{3@}%r'
+precmd () @{ vcs_info @}
+PS1='%F@{5@}[%F@{2@}%n%F@{5@}] %F@{3@}%3~ $@{vcs_info_msg_0_@}%f%# '
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Obviously, the last two lines are there for demonstration. You need to
+call @t{vcs_info} from your @t{precmd} function. Once that is done you need
+a @emph{single quoted} @t{'$@{vcs_info_msg_0_@}'} in your prompt.
+
+@noindent
+To be able to use @t{'$@{vcs_info_msg_0_@}'} directly in your prompt like
+this, you will need to have the @t{PROMPT_SUBST} option enabled.
+
+@noindent
+Now call the @t{vcs_info_printsys} utility from the command line:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+% vcs_info_printsys
+## list of supported version control backends:
+## disabled systems are prefixed by a hash sign (#)
+bzr
+cdv
+cvs
+darcs
+fossil
+git
+hg
+mtn
+p4
+svk
+svn
+tla
+## flavours (cannot be used in the enable or disable styles; they
+## are enabled and disabled with their master [git-svn -> git])
+## they *can* be used in contexts: ':vcs_info:git-svn:*'.
+git-p4
+git-svn
+hg-git
+hg-hgsubversion
+hg-hgsvn
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+You may not want all of these because there is no point in running the
+code to detect systems you do not use. So there is a way to disable
+some backends altogether:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle ':vcs_info:*' disable bzr cdv darcs mtn svk tla
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+You may also pick a few from that list and enable only those:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle ':vcs_info:*' enable git cvs svn
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+If you rerun @t{vcs_info_printsys} after one of these commands, you will
+see the backends listed in the @t{disable} style (or backends not in the
+@t{enable} style - if you used that) marked as disabled by a hash sign.
+That means the detection of these systems is skipped @emph{completely}. No
+wasted time there.
+
+@noindent
+@node vcs_info Configuration, vcs_info Oddities, vcs_info Quickstart, Version Control Information
+
+@subsection Configuration
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+The @t{vcs_info} feature can be configured via @t{zstyle}.
+
+@noindent
+First, the context in which we are working:
+@example
+:vcs_info:@var{vcs-string}:@var{user-context}:@var{repo-root-name}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @var{vcs-string}
+is one of: @t{git}, @t{git-svn}, @t{git-p4}, @t{hg}, @t{hg-git},
+@t{hg-hgsubversion}, @t{hg-hgsvn}, @t{darcs}, @t{bzr}, @t{cdv}, @t{mtn},
+@t{svn}, @t{cvs}, @t{svk}, @t{tla}, @t{p4} or @t{fossil}.
+This is followed by `@t{.quilt-}@var{quilt-mode}' in Quilt mode
+(see @ref{vcs_info Quilt Support} for details)
+and by `@t{+}@var{hook-name}' while hooks are active
+(see @ref{vcs_info Hooks} for details).
+
+@noindent
+
+Currently, hooks in quilt mode don't add the `@t{.quilt-}@var{quilt-mode}' information.
+This may change in the future.
+
+@item @var{user-context}
+is a freely configurable string, assignable by
+the user as the first argument to @t{vcs_info} (see its description
+below).
+
+@item @var{repo-root-name}
+is the name of a repository in which you want a
+style to match. So, if you want a setting specific to @t{/usr/src/zsh},
+with that being a CVS checkout, you can set @var{repo-root-name} to
+@t{zsh} to make it so.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+There are three special values for @var{vcs-string}: The first is named
+@t{-init-}, that is in effect as long as there was no decision what VCS
+backend to use. The second is @t{-preinit-}; it is used @emph{before}
+@t{vcs_info} is run, when initializing the data exporting variables. The
+third special value is @t{formats} and is used by the @t{vcs_info_lastmsg}
+for looking up its styles.
+
+@noindent
+The initial value of @var{repo-root-name} is @t{-all-} and it is replaced
+with the actual name, as soon as it is known. Only use this part of the
+context for defining the @t{formats}, @t{actionformats} or
+@t{branchformat} styles, as it is guaranteed that @var{repo-root-name} is
+set up correctly for these only. For all other styles, just use @t{'*'}
+instead.
+
+@noindent
+There are two pre-defined values for @var{user-context}:
+@table @asis
+@item @t{default}
+the one used if none is specified
+@item @t{command}
+used by vcs_info_lastmsg to lookup its styles
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+You can of course use @t{':vcs_info:*'} to match all VCSs in all
+user-contexts at once.
+
+@noindent
+This is a description of all styles that are looked up.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@kindex formats
+@item @t{formats}
+A list of formats, used when actionformats is not used
+(which is most of the time).
+
+@kindex actionformats
+@item @t{actionformats}
+A list of formats, used if there is a special
+action going on in your current repository; like an interactive rebase or
+a merge conflict.
+
+@kindex branchformat
+@item @t{branchformat}
+Some backends replace @t{%b} in the formats and
+actionformats styles above, not only by a branch name but also by a
+revision number. This style lets you modify how that string should look.
+
+@kindex nvcsformats
+@item @t{nvcsformats}
+These "formats" are set when we didn't detect a version control system
+for the current directory or @t{vcs_info} was disabled. This is useful if
+you want @t{vcs_info} to completely take over the generation of your
+prompt. You would do something like @t{PS1='$@{vcs_info_msg_0_@}'} to
+accomplish that.
+
+@kindex hgrevformat
+@item @t{hgrevformat}
+@t{hg} uses both a hash and a revision number to reference a specific
+changeset in a repository. With this style you can format the revision
+string (see @t{branchformat}) to include either or both. It's only
+useful when @t{get-revision} is true. Note, the full 40-character revision id
+is not available (except when using the @t{use-simple} option) because
+executing hg more than once per prompt is too slow; you may customize this
+behavior using hooks.
+
+@kindex max-exports
+@item @t{max-exports}
+Defines the maximum number of
+@t{vcs_info_msg_*_} variables @t{vcs_info} will set.
+
+@kindex enable
+@item @t{enable}
+A list of backends you want to use. Checked in the @t{-init-} context. If
+this list contains an item called @t{NONE} no backend is used at all and
+@t{vcs_info} will do nothing. If this list contains @t{ALL}, @t{vcs_info}
+will use all known backends. Only with @t{ALL} in @t{enable} will the
+@t{disable} style have any effect. @t{ALL} and @t{NONE} are case insensitive.
+
+@kindex disable
+@item @t{disable}
+A list of VCSs you don't want @t{vcs_info} to test for
+repositories (checked in the @t{-init-} context, too). Only used if
+@t{enable} contains @t{ALL}.
+
+@kindex disable-patterns
+@item @t{disable-patterns}
+A list of patterns that are checked against @t{$PWD}. If a pattern
+matches, @t{vcs_info} will be disabled. This style is checked in the
+@t{:vcs_info:-init-:*:-all-} context.
+
+@noindent
+Say, @t{~/.zsh} is a directory under version control, in which you do
+not want @t{vcs_info} to be active, do:
+@example
+zstyle ':vcs_info:*' disable-patterns "$@{(b)HOME@}/.zsh(|/*)"
+@end example
+
+@kindex use-quilt
+@item @t{use-quilt}
+If enabled, the @t{quilt} support code is active in `addon' mode.
+See @ref{vcs_info Quilt Support} for details.
+
+@kindex quilt-standalone
+@item @t{quilt-standalone}
+If enabled, `standalone' mode detection is attempted if no VCS is active
+in a given directory. See @ref{vcs_info Quilt Support} for details.
+
+@kindex quilt-patch-dir
+@item @t{quilt-patch-dir}
+Overwrite the value of the @t{$QUILT_PATCHES} environment variable. See
+@ref{vcs_info Quilt Support} for details.
+
+@kindex quiltcommand
+@item @t{quiltcommand}
+When @t{quilt} itself is called in quilt support, the value of this style
+is used as the command name.
+
+@kindex check-for-changes
+@item @t{check-for-changes}
+If enabled, this style causes the @t{%c} and @t{%u} format escapes to show
+when the working directory has uncommitted changes. The strings displayed by
+these escapes can be controlled via the @t{stagedstr} and @t{unstagedstr}
+styles. The only backends that currently support this option are @t{git},
+@t{hg}, and @t{bzr} (the latter two only support unstaged).
+
+@noindent
+For this style to be evaluated with the @t{hg} backend, the @t{get-revision}
+style needs to be set and the @t{use-simple} style needs to be unset. The
+latter is the default; the former is not.
+
+@noindent
+With the @t{bzr} backend, @emph{lightweight checkouts} only honor this style if
+the @t{use-server} style is set.
+
+@noindent
+Note, the actions taken if this style is enabled are potentially expensive
+(read: they may be slow, depending on how big the current repository is).
+Therefore, it is disabled by default.
+
+@kindex check-for-staged-changes
+@item @t{check-for-staged-changes}
+This style is like @t{check-for-changes}, but it never checks the worktree
+files, only the metadata in the @t{.$@{vcs@}} dir. Therefore,
+this style initializes only the @t{%c} escape (with @t{stagedstr}) but
+not the @t{%u} escape. This style is faster than @t{check-for-changes}.
+
+@noindent
+In the @t{git} backend, this style checks for changes in the index.
+Other backends do not currently implement this style.
+
+@noindent
+This style is disabled by default.
+
+@kindex stagedstr
+@item @t{stagedstr}
+This string will be used in the @t{%c} escape if there are staged changes in
+the repository.
+
+@kindex unstagedstr
+@item @t{unstagedstr}
+This string will be used in the @t{%u} escape if there are unstaged changes
+in the repository.
+
+@kindex command
+@item @t{command}
+This style causes @t{vcs_info} to use the supplied string as the command
+to use as the VCS's binary. Note, that setting this in '@t{:vcs_info:*}' is
+not a good idea.
+
+@noindent
+If the value of this style is empty (which is the default), the used binary
+name is the name of the backend in use (e.g. @t{svn} is used in an @t{svn}
+repository).
+
+@noindent
+The @t{repo-root-name} part in the context is always the default @t{-all-}
+when this style is looked up.
+
+@noindent
+For example, this style can be used to use binaries from non-default
+installation directories. Assume, @t{git} is installed in /usr/bin but
+your sysadmin installed a newer version in /usr/local/bin. Instead of
+changing the order of your @t{$PATH} parameter, you can do this:
+@example
+zstyle ':vcs_info:git:*:-all-' command /usr/local/bin/git
+@end example
+
+@kindex use-server
+@item @t{use-server}
+This is used by the Perforce backend (@t{p4}) to decide if it should
+contact the Perforce server to find out if a directory is managed
+by Perforce. This is the only reliable way of doing this, but runs
+the risk of a delay if the server name cannot be found. If the
+server (more specifically, the @t{host}@t{:}@t{port} pair describing the
+server) cannot be contacted, its name is put into the associative array
+@t{vcs_info_p4_dead_servers} and is not contacted again during the session
+until it is removed by hand. If you do not set this style, the @t{p4}
+backend is only usable if you have set the environment variable
+@t{P4CONFIG} to a file name and have corresponding files in the root
+directories of each Perforce client. See comments in the function
+@t{VCS_INFO_detect_p4} for more detail.
+
+@noindent
+The Bazaar backend (@t{bzr}) uses this to permit contacting the server
+about lightweight checkouts, see the @t{check-for-changes} style.
+
+@kindex use-simple
+@item @t{use-simple}
+If there are two different ways of gathering
+information, you can select the simpler one by setting this style to true;
+the default is to use the not-that-simple code, which is potentially a lot
+slower but might be more accurate in all possible cases. This style is
+used by the @t{bzr} and @t{hg} backends. In the case of @t{hg} it will invoke
+the external hexdump program to parse the binary dirstate cache file; this
+method will not return the local revision number.
+
+@kindex get-revision
+@item @t{get-revision}
+If set to true, vcs_info goes the extra mile to figure out the revision of
+a repository's work tree (currently for the @t{git} and @t{hg} backends,
+where this kind of information is not always vital). For @t{git}, the
+hash value of the currently checked out commit is available via the @t{%i}
+expansion. With @t{hg}, the local revision number and the corresponding
+global hash are available via @t{%i}.
+
+@kindex get-mq
+@item @t{get-mq}
+If set to true, the @t{hg} backend will look for a Mercurial Queue (@t{mq})
+patch directory. Information will be available via the `@t{%m}' replacement.
+
+@kindex get-bookmarks
+@item @t{get-bookmarks}
+If set to true, the @t{hg} backend will try to get a list of current
+bookmarks. They will be available via the `@t{%m}' replacement.
+
+@noindent
+The default is to generate a comma-separated list of all bookmark names
+that refer to the currently checked out revision. If a bookmark is active,
+its name is suffixed an asterisk and placed first in the list.
+
+@kindex use-prompt-escapes
+@item @t{use-prompt-escapes}
+Determines if we assume that the assembled
+string from @t{vcs_info} includes prompt escapes. (Used by
+@t{vcs_info_lastmsg}.)
+
+@kindex debug
+@item @t{debug}
+Enable debugging output to track possible problems. Currently this style
+is only used by @t{vcs_info}'s hooks system.
+
+@kindex hooks
+@item @t{hooks}
+A list style that defines hook-function names. See @ref{vcs_info Hooks}
+below for details.
+
+@kindex patch-format
+@kindex nopatch-format
+@item @t{patch-format}
+@itemx @t{nopatch-format}
+This pair of styles format the patch information used by the @t{%m} expando in
+formats and actionformats for the @t{git} and @t{hg} backends. The value is
+subject to certain @t{%}-expansions described below.
+The expanded value is made available in the global @t{backend_misc} array as
+@t{$@{backend_misc[patches]@}} (also if a @t{set-patch-format} hook is used).
+
+@kindex get-unapplied
+@item @t{get-unapplied}
+This boolean style controls whether a backend should attempt to gather a list
+of unapplied patches (for example with Mercurial Queue patches).
+
+@noindent
+Used by the @t{quilt} and @t{hg} backends.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+The default values for these styles in all contexts are:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{formats}
+" (%s)-[%b]%u%c-"
+@item @t{actionformats}
+" (%s)-[%b|%a]%u%c-"
+@item @t{branchformat}
+"%b:%r" (for bzr, svn, svk and hg)
+@item @t{nvcsformats}
+""
+@item @t{hgrevformat}
+"%r:%h"
+@item @t{max-exports}
+2
+@item @t{enable}
+ALL
+@item @t{disable}
+(empty list)
+@item @t{disable-patterns}
+(empty list)
+@item @t{check-for-changes}
+false
+@item @t{check-for-staged-changes}
+false
+@item @t{stagedstr}
+(string: "S")
+@item @t{unstagedstr}
+(string: "U")
+@item @t{command}
+(empty string)
+@item @t{use-server}
+false
+@item @t{use-simple}
+false
+@item @t{get-revision}
+false
+@item @t{get-mq}
+true
+@item @t{get-bookmarks}
+false
+@item @t{use-prompt-escapes}
+true
+@item @t{debug}
+false
+@item @t{hooks}
+(empty list)
+@item @t{use-quilt}
+false
+@item @t{quilt-standalone}
+false
+@item @t{quilt-patch-dir}
+empty - use @t{$QUILT_PATCHES}
+@item @t{quiltcommand}
+quilt
+@item @t{patch-format}
+@var{backend dependent}
+@item @t{nopatch-format}
+@var{backend dependent}
+@item @t{get-unapplied}
+false
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+In normal @t{formats} and @t{actionformats} the following replacements are
+done:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{%s}
+The VCS in use (git, hg, svn, etc.).
+@item @t{%b}
+Information about the current branch.
+@item @t{%a}
+An identifier that describes the action. Only makes sense in
+@t{actionformats}.
+@item @t{%i}
+The current revision number or identifier. For @t{hg}
+the @t{hgrevformat} style may be used to customize the output.
+@item @t{%c}
+The string from the @t{stagedstr} style if there are staged
+changes in the repository.
+@item @t{%u}
+The string from the @t{unstagedstr} style if there are
+unstaged changes in the repository.
+@item @t{%R}
+The base directory of the repository.
+@item @t{%r}
+The repository name. If @t{%R} is @t{/foo/bar/repoXY}, @t{%r}
+is @t{repoXY}.
+@item @t{%S}
+A subdirectory within a repository. If @t{$PWD} is
+@t{/foo/bar/repoXY/beer/tasty}, @t{%S} is @t{beer/tasty}.
+@end table
+@table @asis
+@item @t{%m}
+A "misc" replacement. It is at the discretion of the backend to
+decide what this replacement expands to.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{hg} and @t{git} backends use this expando to display patch information.
+@t{hg} sources patch information from the @t{mq} extensions; @t{git} from in-progress
+@t{rebase} and @t{cherry-pick} operations and from the @t{stgit} extension. The @t{patch-format}
+and @t{nopatch-format} styles control the generated string. The former is used
+when at least one patch from the patch queue has been applied, and the latter
+otherwise.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{hg} backend displays bookmark information in this expando (in addition
+to @t{mq} information). See the @t{get-mq} and @t{get-bookmarks} styles. Both
+of these styles may be enabled at the same time. If both are enabled, both
+resulting strings will be shown separated by a semicolon (that cannot currently
+be customized).
+
+@noindent
+The @t{quilt} `standalone' backend sets this expando to the same value as the
+@t{%Q} expando.
+
+@item @t{%Q}
+Quilt series information.
+When quilt is used (either in `addon' mode or as a `standalone' backend),
+this expando is set to quilt series' @t{patch-format} string.
+The @t{set-patch-format} hook and @t{nopatch-format} style are honoured.
+
+@noindent
+See @ref{vcs_info Quilt Support} below for details.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+In @t{branchformat} these replacements are done:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{%b}
+The branch name.
+@item @t{%r}
+The current revision number or the @t{hgrevformat} style for
+@t{hg}.
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+In @t{hgrevformat} these replacements are done:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{%r}
+The current local revision number.
+@item @t{%h}
+The current global revision identifier.
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+In @t{patch-format} and @t{nopatch-format} these replacements are done:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{%p}
+The name of the top-most applied patch; may be overridden by the @t{applied-string} hook.
+@item @t{%u}
+The number of unapplied patches; may be overridden by the @t{unapplied-string} hook.
+@item @t{%n}
+The number of applied patches.
+@item @t{%c}
+The number of unapplied patches.
+@item @t{%a}
+The number of all patches (@t{%a = %n + %c}).
+@item @t{%g}
+The names of active @t{mq} guards (@t{hg} backend).
+@item @t{%G}
+The number of active @t{mq} guards (@t{hg} backend).
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+Not all VCS backends have to support all replacements. For @t{nvcsformats}
+no replacements are performed at all, it is just a string.
+
+@noindent
+@node vcs_info Oddities, vcs_info Quilt Support, vcs_info Configuration, Version Control Information
+
+@subsection Oddities
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+If you want to use the @t{%b} (bold off) prompt expansion in @t{formats},
+which expands @t{%b} itself, use @t{%%b}. That will cause the @t{vcs_info}
+expansion to replace @t{%%b} with @t{%b}, so that zsh's prompt expansion
+mechanism can handle it. Similarly, to hand down @t{%b} from
+@t{branchformat}, use @t{%%%%b}. Sorry for this inconvenience, but it
+cannot be easily avoided. Luckily we do not clash with a lot of prompt
+expansions and this only needs to be done for those.
+
+@noindent
+When one of the @t{gen-applied-string}, @t{gen-unapplied-string}, and
+@t{set-patch-format} hooks is defined,
+applying @t{%}-escaping (`@t{foo=$@{foo//'%'/%%@}}') to the interpolated values
+for use in the prompt is the responsibility of those hooks (jointly);
+when neither of those hooks is defined, @t{vcs_info} handles escaping by itself.
+We regret this coupling, but it was required for backwards compatibility.
+
+@noindent
+@node vcs_info Quilt Support, vcs_info API, vcs_info Oddities, Version Control Information
+
+@subsection Quilt Support
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+@cite{Quilt} is not a version control system, therefore this is not implemented
+as a backend. It can help keeping track of a series of patches. People use it
+to keep a set of changes they want to use on top of software packages (which
+is tightly integrated into the package build process - the Debian project
+does this for a large number of packages). Quilt can also help individual
+developers keep track of their own patches on top of real version control
+systems.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{vcs_info} integration tries to support both ways of using quilt by
+having two slightly different modes of operation: `addon' mode and
+`standalone' mode).
+
+@noindent
+Quilt integration is off by default; to enable it, set the @t{use-quilt} style,
+and add @t{%Q} to your @t{formats} or @t{actionformats} style:
+@example
+zstyle ':vcs_info:*' use-quilt true
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Styles looked up from the Quilt support code include `@t{.quilt-}@var{quilt-mode}'
+in the @var{vcs-string} part of the context, where @var{quilt-mode} is either
+@t{addon} or @t{standalone}.
+Example: @t{:vcs_info:git.quilt-addon:default:}@var{repo-root-name}.
+
+@noindent
+For `addon' mode to become active @t{vcs_info} must have already detected a
+real version control system controlling the directory. If that is the case,
+a directory that holds quilt's patches needs to be found. That directory is
+configurable via the `@t{QUILT_PATCHES}' environment variable. If that
+variable exists its value is used, otherwise the value `@t{patches}' is
+assumed. The value from @t{$QUILT_PATCHES} can be overwritten using the
+`@t{quilt-patches}' style. (Note: you can use @t{vcs_info} to keep the value
+of @t{$QUILT_PATCHES} correct all the time via the @t{post-quilt} hook).
+
+@noindent
+When the directory in question is found, quilt is assumed to be active. To
+gather more information, @t{vcs_info} looks for a directory called `.pc';
+Quilt uses that directory to track its current state. If this directory does
+not exist we know that quilt has not done anything to the working directory
+(read: no patches have been applied yet).
+
+@noindent
+If patches are applied, @t{vcs_info} will try to find out which. If you want
+to know which patches of a series are not yet applied, you need to activate
+the @t{get-unapplied} style in the appropriate context.
+
+@noindent
+@t{vcs_info} allows for very detailed control over how the gathered
+information is presented (see
+@ref{vcs_info Configuration} and @ref{vcs_info Hooks}),
+all of which are documented below. Note there are a number of
+other patch tracking systems that work on top of a certain version control
+system (like @t{stgit} for @cite{git}, or @t{mq} for @cite{hg}); the configuration
+for systems like that are generally configured the same way as the @cite{quilt}
+support.
+
+@noindent
+If the @cite{quilt} support is working in `addon' mode, the produced string is
+available as a simple format replacement (@t{%Q} to be precise), which can
+be used in @t{formats} and @t{actionformats}; see below for details).
+
+@noindent
+If, on the other hand, the support code is working in `standalone' mode,
+@t{vcs_info} will pretend as if @t{quilt} were an actual version control
+system. That means that the version control system identifier (which
+otherwise would be something like `svn' or `cvs') will be set to
+`@t{-quilt-}'. This has implications on the used style context where this
+identifier is the second element. @t{vcs_info} will have filled in a proper
+value for the "repository's" root directory and the string containing the
+information about quilt's state will be available as the `misc' replacement
+(and @t{%Q} for compatibility with `addon' mode).
+
+@noindent
+What is left to discuss is how `standalone' mode is detected. The detection
+itself is a series of searches for directories. You can have this detection
+enabled all the time in every directory that is not otherwise under version
+control. If you know there is only a limited set of trees where you would
+like @t{vcs_info} to try and look for Quilt in `standalone' mode to minimise
+the amount of searching on every call to @t{vcs_info}, there are a number of
+ways to do that:
+
+@noindent
+Essentially, `standalone' mode detection is controlled by a style called
+`@t{quilt-standalone}'. It is a string style and its value can have different
+effects. The simplest values are: `@t{always}' to run detection every time
+@t{vcs_info} is run, and `@t{never}' to turn the detection off entirely.
+
+@noindent
+If the value of @t{quilt-standalone} is something else, it is interpreted
+differently. If the value is the name of a scalar variable the value of that
+variable is checked and that value is used in the same `always'/`never' way
+as described above.
+
+@noindent
+If the value of @t{quilt-standalone} is an array, the elements of that array
+are used as directory names under which you want the detection to be active.
+
+@noindent
+If @t{quilt-standalone} is an associative array, the keys are taken as
+directory names under which you want the detection to be active, but only if
+the corresponding value is the string `@t{true}'.
+
+@noindent
+Last, but not least, if the value of @t{quilt-standalone} is the name of a
+function, the function is called without arguments and the return value
+decides whether detection should be active. A `0' return value is true; a
+non-zero return value is interpreted as false.
+
+@noindent
+Note, if there is both a function and a variable by the name of
+@t{quilt-standalone}, the function will take precedence.
+
+@noindent
+@node vcs_info API, vcs_info Variables, vcs_info Quilt Support, Version Control Information
+
+@subsection Function Descriptions (Public API)
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex vcs_info
+@item @t{vcs_info} [@var{user-context}]
+The main function, that runs all backends and assembles all data into
+@t{$@{vcs_info_msg_*_@}}. This is the function you want to call from
+@t{precmd} if you want to include up-to-date information in your prompt (see
+@ref{vcs_info Variables}
+below). If an argument is given, that string will be
+used instead of @t{default} in the @var{user-context} field of the style
+context.
+
+@findex vcs_info_hookadd
+@item @t{vcs_info_hookadd}
+Statically registers a number of functions to a given hook. The hook needs
+to be given as the first argument; what follows is a list of hook-function
+names to register to the hook. The `@t{+vi-}' prefix needs to be left out
+here. See @ref{vcs_info Hooks}
+below for details.
+
+@findex vcs_info_hookdel
+@item @t{vcs_info_hookdel}
+Remove hook-functions from a given hook. The hook needs to be given as the
+first non-option argument; what follows is a list of hook-function
+names to un-register from the hook. If `@t{-a}' is used as the first
+argument, @t{all} occurrences of the functions are unregistered. Otherwise
+only the last occurrence is removed (if a function was registered to a hook
+more than once). The `@t{+vi-}' prefix needs to be left out here.
+See @ref{vcs_info Hooks}
+below for details.
+
+@findex vcs_info_lastmsg
+@item @t{vcs_info_lastmsg}
+Outputs the last @t{$@{vcs_info_msg_*_@}} value.
+Takes into account the value of the @t{use-prompt-escapes} style in
+@t{':vcs_info:formats:command:-all-'}. It also only prints @t{max-exports}
+values.
+
+@findex vcs_info_printsys
+@item @t{vcs_info_printsys} [@var{user-context}]
+Prints a list of all
+supported version control systems. Useful to find out possible contexts
+(and which of them are enabled) or values for the @t{disable} style.
+
+@findex vcs_info_setsys
+@item @t{vcs_info_setsys}
+Initializes @t{vcs_info}'s internal list of
+available backends. With this function, you can add support for new VCSs
+without restarting the shell.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+All functions named @t{VCS_INFO_*} are for internal use only.
+
+@noindent
+@node vcs_info Variables, vcs_info Hooks, vcs_info API, Version Control Information
+
+@subsection Variable Description
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{$@{vcs_info_msg_}@var{N}@t{_@}} (Note the trailing underscore)
+Where @var{N} is an integer, e.g., @t{vcs_info_msg_0_}. These variables
+are the storage for the informational message the last @t{vcs_info} call
+has assembled. These are strongly connected to the @t{formats},
+@t{actionformats} and @t{nvcsformats} styles described above. Those styles
+are lists. The first member of that list gets expanded into
+@t{$@{vcs_info_msg_0_@}}, the second into @t{$@{vcs_info_msg_1_@}}
+and the Nth into @t{$@{vcs_info_msg_N-1_@}}. (See the @t{max-exports}
+style above.)
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+All variables named @t{VCS_INFO_*} are for internal use only.
+
+@noindent
+@node vcs_info Hooks, vcs_info Examples, vcs_info Variables, Version Control Information
+
+@subsection Hooks in vcs_info
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+Hooks are places in @t{vcs_info} where you can run your own code. That
+code can communicate with the code that called it and through that,
+change the system's behaviour.
+
+@noindent
+For configuration, hooks change the style context:
+@example
+:vcs_info:@var{vcs-string}+@var{hook-name}:@var{user-context}:@var{repo-root-name}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+To register functions to a hook, you need to list them in the @t{hooks}
+style in the appropriate context.
+
+@noindent
+Example:
+@example
+zstyle ':vcs_info:*+foo:*' hooks bar baz
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+This registers functions to the hook `foo' for all backends. In order to
+avoid namespace problems, all registered function names are prepended by
+a `@t{+vi-}', so the actual functions called for the `foo' hook are
+`@t{+vi-bar}' and `@t{+vi-baz}'.
+
+@noindent
+If you would like to register a function to a hook regardless of the
+current context, you may use the @t{vcs_info_hookadd} function. To remove
+a function that was added like that, the @t{vcs_info_hookdel} function
+can be used.
+
+@noindent
+If something seems weird, you can enable the `debug' boolean style in
+the proper context and the hook-calling code will print what it tried
+to execute and whether the function in question existed.
+
+@noindent
+When you register more than one function to a hook, all functions are
+executed one after another until one function returns non-zero or until
+all functions have been called. Context-sensitive hook functions are
+executed @t{before} statically registered ones (the ones added by
+@t{vcs_info_hookadd}).
+
+@noindent
+You may pass data between functions via an associative array, @t{user_data}.
+For example:
+@example
+
++vi-git-myfirsthook()@{
+ user_data[myval]=$myval
+@}
++vi-git-mysecondhook()@{
+ # do something with $@{user_data[myval]@}
+@}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+There are a number of variables that are special in hook contexts:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{ret}
+The return value that the hooks system will return to the caller. The
+default is an integer `zero'. If and how a changed @t{ret} value changes
+the execution of the caller depends on the specific hook. See the hook
+documentation below for details.
+
+@item @t{hook_com}
+An associated array which is used for bidirectional communication from
+the caller to hook functions. The used keys depend on the specific hook.
+
+@item @t{context}
+The active context of the hook. Functions that wish to change this
+variable should make it local scope first.
+
+@item @t{vcs}
+The current VCS after it was detected. The same values as in the
+enable/disable style are used. Available in all hooks except @t{start-up}.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+Finally, the full list of currently available hooks:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{start-up}
+Called after starting @t{vcs_info} but before the VCS in this directory is
+determined. It can be used to deactivate @t{vcs_info} temporarily if
+necessary. When @t{ret} is set to @t{1}, @t{vcs_info} aborts and does
+nothing; when set to @t{2}, @t{vcs_info} sets up everything as if no
+version control were active and exits.
+
+@item @t{pre-get-data}
+Same as @t{start-up} but after the VCS was detected.
+
+@item @t{gen-hg-bookmark-string}
+Called in the Mercurial backend when a bookmark string is generated; the
+@t{get-revision} and @t{get-bookmarks} styles must be true.
+
+@noindent
+This hook gets the names of the Mercurial bookmarks that
+@t{vcs_info} collected from `hg'.
+
+@noindent
+If a bookmark is active, the key @t{$@{hook_com[hg-active-bookmark]@}} is
+set to its name. The key is otherwise unset.
+
+@noindent
+When setting @t{ret} to non-zero, the string in
+@t{$@{hook_com[hg-bookmark-string]@}} will be used in the @t{%m} escape in
+@t{formats} and @t{actionformats} and will be available in the global
+@t{backend_misc} array as @t{$@{backend_misc[bookmarks]@}}.
+
+@item @t{gen-applied-string}
+Called in the @t{git} (with @t{stgit} or during rebase or merge), and @t{hg}
+(with @t{mq}) backends and in @t{quilt} support when the @t{applied-string}
+is generated; the @t{use-quilt} zstyle must be true for @t{quilt} (the @t{mq}
+and @t{stgit} backends are active by default).
+
+@noindent
+This hook gets the names of all applied patches which @t{vcs_info} collected
+so far in the opposite order, which means that the first argument is the
+top-most patch and so forth.
+
+@noindent
+When setting @t{ret} to non-zero, the string in
+@t{$@{hook_com[applied-string]@}} will be
+available as @t{%p} in the @t{patch-format} and @t{nopatch-format} styles.
+This hook is, in concert with @t{set-patch-format}, responsible for
+@t{%}-escaping that value for use in the prompt.
+(See @ref{vcs_info Oddities}.)
+
+@item @t{gen-unapplied-string}
+Called in the @t{git} (with @t{stgit} or during rebase), and @t{hg} (with
+@t{mq}) backend and in @t{quilt} support when the @t{unapplied-string} is
+generated; the @t{get-unapplied} style must be true.
+
+@noindent
+This hook gets the names of all unapplied patches which @t{vcs_info}
+collected so far in order, which means that the first argument is
+the patch next-in-line to be applied and so forth.
+
+@noindent
+When setting @t{ret} to non-zero, the string in
+@t{$@{hook_com[unapplied-string]@}} will be available as @t{%u} in the
+@t{patch-format} and @t{nopatch-format} styles.
+This hook is, in concert with @t{set-patch-format}, responsible for
+@t{%}-escaping that value for use in the prompt.
+(See @ref{vcs_info Oddities}.)
+
+@item @t{gen-mqguards-string}
+Called in the @t{hg} backend when @t{guards-string} is generated; the
+@t{get-mq} style must be true (default).
+
+@noindent
+This hook gets the names of any active @t{mq} guards.
+
+@noindent
+When setting @t{ret} to non-zero, the string in
+@t{$@{hook_com[guards-string]@}} will be used in the @t{%g} escape in the
+@t{patch-format} and @t{nopatch-format} styles.
+
+@item @t{no-vcs}
+This hooks is called when no version control system was detected.
+
+@noindent
+The `@t{hook_com}' parameter is not used.
+
+@item @t{post-backend}
+Called as soon as the backend has finished collecting information.
+
+@noindent
+The `@t{hook_com}' keys available are as for the @t{set-message} hook.
+
+@item @t{post-quilt}
+Called after the @t{quilt} support is done. The following information
+is passed as arguments to the hook: 1. the quilt-support mode (`addon' or
+`standalone'); 2. the directory that contains the patch series; 3. the
+directory that holds quilt's status information (the `.pc' directory) or
+the string @t{"-nopc-"} if that directory wasn't found.
+
+@noindent
+The `hook_com' parameter is not used.
+
+@item @t{set-branch-format}
+Called before `@t{branchformat}' is set. The only argument to the
+hook is the format that is configured at this point.
+
+@noindent
+The `@t{hook_com}' keys considered are `@t{branch}' and `@t{revision}'.
+They are set to the values figured out so far by @t{vcs_info} and any
+change will be used directly when the actual replacement is done.
+
+@noindent
+If @t{ret} is set to non-zero, the string in
+@t{$@{hook_com[branch-replace]@}} will be used unchanged as the
+`@t{%b}' replacement in the variables set by @t{vcs_info}.
+
+@item @t{set-hgrev-format}
+Called before a `@t{hgrevformat}' is set. The only argument to the
+hook is the format that is configured at this point.
+
+@noindent
+The `@t{hook_com}' keys considered are `@t{hash}' and `@t{localrev}'.
+They are set to the values figured out so far by @t{vcs_info} and any
+change will be used directly when the actual replacement is done.
+
+@noindent
+If @t{ret} is set to non-zero, the string in
+@t{$@{hook_com[rev-replace]@}} will be used unchanged as the
+`@t{%i}' replacement in the variables set by @t{vcs_info}.
+
+@item @t{pre-addon-quilt}
+This hook is used when @t{vcs_info}'s quilt functionality is active in "addon"
+mode (quilt used on top of a real version control system). It is activated
+right before any quilt specific action is taken.
+
+@noindent
+Setting the `@t{ret}' variable in this hook to a non-zero value avoids any
+quilt specific actions from being run at all.
+
+@item @t{set-patch-format}
+This hook is used to control some of the possible expansions in
+@t{patch-format} and @t{nopatch-format} styles with patch queue systems such as
+quilt, mqueue and the like.
+
+@noindent
+This hook is used in the @t{git}, @t{hg} and @t{quilt} backends.
+
+@noindent
+The hook allows the control of the @t{%p} (@t{$@{hook_com[applied]@}}) and @t{%u}
+(@t{$@{hook_com[unapplied]@}}) expansion in all backends that use the hook. With
+the mercurial backend, the @t{%g} (@t{$@{hook_com[guards]@}}) expansion is
+controllable in addition to that.
+
+@noindent
+If @t{ret} is set to non-zero, the string in @t{$@{hook_com[patch-replace]@}}
+will be used unchanged instead of an expanded format from @t{patch-format} or
+@t{nopatch-format}.
+
+@noindent
+This hook is, in concert with the @t{gen-applied-string} or
+@t{gen-unapplied-string} hooks if they are defined, responsible for
+@t{%}-escaping the final @t{patch-format} value for use in the prompt.
+(See @ref{vcs_info Oddities}.)
+
+@item @t{set-message}
+Called each time before a `@t{vcs_info_msg_}@var{N}@t{_}' message is set.
+It takes two arguments; the first being the `@var{N}' in the message
+variable name, the second is the currently configured @t{formats} or
+@t{actionformats}.
+
+@noindent
+There are a number of `@t{hook_com}' keys, that are used here:
+`@t{action}', `@t{branch}', `@t{base}', `@t{base-name}', `@t{subdir}',
+`@t{staged}', `@t{unstaged}', `@t{revision}', `@t{misc}', `@t{vcs}'
+and one `@t{miscN}' entry for each backend-specific data field (@t{N}
+starting at zero). They are set to the values figured out so far by
+@t{vcs_info} and any change will be used directly when the actual
+replacement is done.
+
+@noindent
+Since this hook is triggered multiple times (once for each configured
+@t{formats} or @t{actionformats}), each of the `@t{hook_com}' keys mentioned
+above (except for the @t{miscN} entries) has an `@t{_orig}' counterpart,
+so even if you changed a value to your liking you can still get the
+original value in the next run. Changing the `@t{_orig}' values is
+probably not a good idea.
+
+@noindent
+If @t{ret} is set to non-zero, the string in
+@t{$@{hook_com[message]@}} will be used unchanged as the message by
+@t{vcs_info}.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+If all of this sounds rather confusing, take a look at
+@ref{vcs_info Examples}
+and also in the @t{Misc/vcs_info-examples} file in the Zsh source.
+They contain some explanatory code.
+
+@noindent
+@node vcs_info Examples, , vcs_info Hooks, Version Control Information
+
+@subsection Examples
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+Don't use @t{vcs_info} at all (even though it's in your prompt):
+@example
+zstyle ':vcs_info:*' enable NONE
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Disable the backends for @t{bzr} and @t{svk}:
+@example
+zstyle ':vcs_info:*' disable bzr svk
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Disable everything @emph{but} @t{bzr} and @t{svk}:
+@example
+zstyle ':vcs_info:*' enable bzr svk
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Provide a special formats for @t{git}:
+@example
+zstyle ':vcs_info:git:*' formats ' GIT, BABY! [%b]'
+zstyle ':vcs_info:git:*' actionformats ' GIT ACTION! [%b|%a]'
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+All @t{%x} expansion in all sorts of formats (@t{formats}, @t{actionformats},
+@t{branchformat}, you name it) are done using the `@t{zformat}' builtin from
+the `@t{zsh/zutil}' module. That means you can do everything with these
+@t{%x} items what zformat supports. In particular, if you want something
+that is really long to have a fixed width, like a hash in a mercurial
+branchformat, you can do this: @t{%12.12i}. That'll shrink the 40 character
+hash to its 12 leading characters. The form is actually
+`@t{%}@var{min}@t{.}@var{max}@t{x}'. More is possible.
+See @ref{The zsh/zutil Module} for details.
+
+@noindent
+Use the quicker @t{bzr} backend
+@example
+zstyle ':vcs_info:bzr:*' use-simple true
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+If you do use @t{use-simple}, please report if it does `the-right-thing[tm]'.
+
+@noindent
+Display the revision number in yellow for @t{bzr} and @t{svn}:
+@example
+zstyle ':vcs_info:(svn|bzr):*' \
+ branchformat '%b%@{'$@{fg[yellow]@}'%@}:%r'
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+If you want colors, make sure you enclose the color codes in @t{%@{}@var{...}@t{%@}}
+if you want to use the string provided by @t{vcs_info} in prompts.
+
+@noindent
+Here is how to print the VCS information as a command (not in a prompt):
+@example
+alias vcsi='vcs_info command; vcs_info_lastmsg'
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+This way, you can even define different formats for output via
+@t{vcs_info_lastmsg} in the '@t{:vcs_info:*:command:*}' namespace.
+
+@noindent
+Now as promised, some code that uses hooks:
+say, you'd like to replace the string `svn' by `subversion' in
+@t{vcs_info}'s @t{%s} @t{formats} replacement.
+
+@noindent
+First, we will tell @t{vcs_info} to call a function when populating
+the message variables with the gathered information:
+@example
+zstyle ':vcs_info:*+set-message:*' hooks svn2subversion
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Nothing happens. Which is reasonable, since we didn't define the actual
+function yet. To see what the hooks subsystem is trying to do, enable the
+`@t{debug}' style:
+@example
+zstyle ':vcs_info:*+*:*' debug true
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+That should give you an idea what is going on. Specifically, the function
+that we are looking for is `@t{+vi-svn2subversion}'. Note, the `@t{+vi-}'
+prefix. So, everything is in order, just as documented. When you are done
+checking out the debugging output, disable it again:
+@example
+zstyle ':vcs_info:*+*:*' debug false
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Now, let's define the function:
+@example
+
+function +vi-svn2subversion() @{
+ [[ $@{hook_com[vcs_orig]@} == svn ]] && hook_com[vcs]=subversion
+@}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Simple enough. And it could have even been simpler, if only we had
+registered our function in a less generic context. If we do it only in
+the `@t{svn}' backend's context, we don't need to test which the active
+backend is:
+@example
+zstyle ':vcs_info:svn+set-message:*' hooks svn2subversion
+@end example
+@example
+
+function +vi-svn2subversion() @{
+ hook_com[vcs]=subversion
+@}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+And finally a little more elaborate example, that uses a hook to create
+a customised bookmark string for the @t{hg} backend.
+
+@noindent
+Again, we start off by registering a function:
+@example
+zstyle ':vcs_info:hg+gen-hg-bookmark-string:*' hooks hgbookmarks
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+And then we define the `@t{+vi-hgbookmarks}' function:
+@example
+
+function +vi-hgbookmarks() @{
+ # The default is to connect all bookmark names by
+ # commas. This mixes things up a little.
+ # Imagine, there's one type of bookmarks that is
+ # special to you. Say, because it's *your* work.
+ # Those bookmarks look always like this: "sh/*"
+ # (because your initials are sh, for example).
+ # This makes the bookmarks string use only those
+ # bookmarks. If there's more than one, it
+ # concatenates them using commas.
+ # The bookmarks returned by `hg' are available in
+ # the function's positional parameters.
+ local s="$@{(Mj:,:)@@:#sh/*@}"
+ # Now, the communication with the code that calls
+ # the hook functions is done via the hook_com[]
+ # hash. The key at which the `gen-hg-bookmark-string'
+ # hook looks is `hg-bookmark-string'. So:
+ hook_com[hg-bookmark-string]=$s
+ # And to signal that we want to use the string we
+ # just generated, set the special variable `ret' to
+ # something other than the default zero:
+ ret=1
+ return 0
+@}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Some longer examples and code snippets which might be useful are available in
+the examples file located at Misc/vcs_info-examples in the Zsh source
+directory.
+
+@noindent
+This concludes our guided tour through zsh's @t{vcs_info}.
+
+@noindent
+@node Prompt Themes, ZLE Functions, Version Control Information, User Contributions
+
+@section Prompt Themes
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Installation
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+You should make sure all the functions from the @t{Functions/Prompts}
+directory of the source distribution are available; they all begin with
+the string `@t{prompt_}' except for the special function`@t{promptinit}'.
+You also need the `@t{colors}' and `@t{add-zsh-hook}' functions from
+@t{Functions/Misc}.
+All these functions may already be installed on your system; if not,
+you will need to find them and copy them. The directory should appear as
+one of the elements of the @t{fpath} array (this should already be the
+case if they were installed), and at least the function @t{promptinit}
+should be autoloaded; it will autoload the rest. Finally, to initialize
+the use of the system you need to call the @t{promptinit} function. The
+following code in your @t{.zshrc} will arrange for this; assume the
+functions are stored in the directory @t{~/myfns}:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+fpath=(~/myfns $fpath)
+autoload -U promptinit
+promptinit
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Theme Selection
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+Use the @t{prompt} command to select your preferred theme. This command
+may be added to your @t{.zshrc} following the call to @t{promptinit} in
+order to start zsh with a theme already selected.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{prompt} [ @t{-c} | @t{-l} ]
+@itemx @t{prompt} [ @t{-p} | @t{-h} ] [ @var{theme} ... ]
+@itemx @t{prompt} [ @t{-s} ] @var{theme} [ @var{arg} ... ]
+Set or examine the prompt theme. With no options and a @var{theme}
+argument, the theme with that name is set as the current theme. The
+available themes are determined at run time; use the @t{-l} option to see
+a list. The special @var{theme} `@t{random}' selects at random one of the
+available themes and sets your prompt to that.
+
+@noindent
+In some cases the @var{theme} may be modified by one or more arguments,
+which should be given after the theme name. See the help for each theme
+for descriptions of these arguments.
+
+@noindent
+Options are:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{-c}
+Show the currently selected theme and its parameters, if any.
+@item @t{-l}
+List all available prompt themes.
+@item @t{-p}
+Preview the theme named by @var{theme}, or all themes if no
+@var{theme} is given.
+@item @t{-h}
+Show help for the theme named by @var{theme}, or for the
+@t{prompt} function if no @var{theme} is given.
+@item @t{-s}
+Set @var{theme} as the current theme and save state.
+@end table
+
+@item @t{prompt_}@var{theme}@t{_setup}
+Each available @var{theme} has a setup function which is called by the
+@t{prompt} function to install that theme. This function may define
+other functions as necessary to maintain the prompt, including functions
+used to preview the prompt or provide help for its use. You should not
+normally call a theme's setup function directly.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Utility Themes
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{prompt off}
+The theme `@t{off}' sets all the prompt variables to minimal values with
+no special effects.
+
+@item @t{prompt default}
+The theme `@t{default}' sets all prompt variables to the same state as
+if an interactive zsh was started with no initialization files.
+
+@item @t{prompt restore}
+The special theme `@t{restore}' erases all theme settings and sets prompt
+variables to their state before the first time the `@t{prompt}' function
+was run, provided each theme has properly defined its cleanup (see below).
+
+@noindent
+Note that you can undo `@t{prompt off}' and `@t{prompt default}' with
+`@t{prompt restore}', but a second restore does not undo the first.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Writing Themes
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+The first step for adding your own theme is to choose a name for it,
+and create a file `@t{prompt_@var{name}_setup}' in a directory in your
+@t{fpath}, such as @t{~/myfns} in the example above. The file should
+at minimum contain assignments for the prompt variables that your
+theme wishes to modify. By convention, themes use @t{PS1}, @t{PS2},
+@t{RPS1}, etc., rather than the longer @t{PROMPT} and @t{RPROMPT}.
+
+@noindent
+The file is autoloaded as a function in the current shell context, so
+it may contain any necessary commands to customize your theme, including
+defining additional functions. To make some complex tasks easier, your
+setup function may also do any of the following:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item Assign @t{prompt_opts}
+The array @t{prompt_opts} may be assigned any of @t{"bang"}, @t{"cr"},
+@t{"percent"}, @t{"sp"}, and/or @t{"subst"} as values. The corresponding
+setopts (@t{promptbang}, etc.) are turned on, all other prompt-related
+options are turned off. The @t{prompt_opts} array preserves setopts even
+beyond the scope of @t{localoptions}, should your function need that.
+
+@item Modify precmd and preexec
+Use of @t{add-zsh-hook} is recommended. The @t{precmd} and @t{preexec}
+hooks are automatically adjusted if the prompt theme changes or is
+disabled.
+
+@item Declare cleanup
+If your function makes any other changes that should be undone when the
+theme is disabled, your setup function may call
+@example
+prompt_cleanup @var{command}
+@end example
+where @var{command} should be suitably quoted. If your theme is ever
+disabled or replaced by another, @var{command} is executed with @t{eval}.
+You may declare more than one such cleanup hook.
+
+@item Define preview
+Define or autoload a function @t{prompt_@var{name}_preview} to display
+a simulated version of your prompt. A simple default previewer is
+defined by @t{promptinit} for themes that do not define their own.
+This preview function is called by `@t{prompt -p}'.
+
+@item Provide help
+Define or autoload a function @t{prompt_@var{name}_help} to display
+documentation or help text for your theme.
+This help function is called by `@t{prompt -h}'.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+@node ZLE Functions, Exception Handling, Prompt Themes, User Contributions
+
+@section ZLE Functions
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Widgets
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+These functions all implement user-defined ZLE widgets (see
+@ref{Zsh Line Editor}) which can be bound to keystrokes in interactive shells. To use them,
+your @t{.zshrc} should contain lines of the form
+
+@noindent
+@example
+autoload @var{function}
+zle -N @var{function}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+followed by an appropriate @t{bindkey} command to associate the function
+with a key sequence. Suggested bindings are described below.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item bash-style word functions
+If you are looking for functions to implement moving over and editing
+words in the manner of bash, where only alphanumeric characters are
+considered word characters, you can use the functions described in
+the next section. The following is sufficient:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+autoload -U select-word-style
+select-word-style bash
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+
+@tindex forward-word-match
+@tindex backward-word-match
+@tindex kill-word-match
+@tindex backward-kill-word-match
+@tindex transpose-words-match
+@tindex capitalize-word-match
+@tindex up-case-word-match
+@tindex down-case-word-match
+@tindex delete-whole-word-match
+@tindex select-word-match
+@tindex select-word-style
+@tindex match-word-context
+@tindex match-words-by-style
+@item @t{forward-word-match}, @t{backward-word-match}
+@itemx @t{kill-word-match}, @t{backward-kill-word-match}
+@itemx @t{transpose-words-match}, @t{capitalize-word-match}
+@itemx @t{up-case-word-match}, @t{down-case-word-match}
+@itemx @t{delete-whole-word-match}, @t{select-word-match}
+@itemx @t{select-word-style}, @t{match-word-context}, @t{match-words-by-style}
+The first eight `@t{-match}' functions are drop-in replacements for the
+builtin widgets without the suffix. By default they behave in a similar
+way. However, by the use of styles and the function @t{select-word-style},
+the way words are matched can be altered. @t{select-word-match} is intended
+to be used as a text object in vi mode but with custom word styles. For
+comparison, the widgets described in @ref{Text Objects} use fixed definitions of words, compatible
+with the @t{vim} editor.
+
+@noindent
+The simplest way of configuring the functions is to use
+@t{select-word-style}, which can either be called as a normal function with
+the appropriate argument, or invoked as a user-defined widget that will
+prompt for the first character of the word style to be used. The first
+time it is invoked, the first eight @t{-match} functions will automatically
+replace the builtin versions, so they do not need to be loaded explicitly.
+
+@noindent
+The word styles available are as follows. Only the first character
+is examined.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{bash}
+Word characters are alphanumeric characters only.
+
+@item @t{normal}
+As in normal shell operation: word characters are alphanumeric characters
+plus any characters present in the string given by the parameter
+@t{$WORDCHARS}.
+
+@item @t{shell}
+Words are complete shell command arguments, possibly including complete
+quoted strings, or any tokens special to the shell.
+
+@item @t{whitespace}
+Words are any set of characters delimited by whitespace.
+
+@item @t{default}
+Restore the default settings; this is usually the same as `@t{normal}'.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+All but `@t{default}' can be input as an upper case character, which has
+the same effect but with subword matching turned on. In this case, words
+with upper case characters are treated specially: each separate run of
+upper case characters, or an upper case character followed by any number of
+other characters, is considered a word. The style @t{subword-range}
+can supply an alternative character range to the default `@t{[:upper:]}';
+the value of the style is treated as the contents of a `@t{[}@var{...}@t{]}'
+pattern (note that the outer brackets should not be supplied, only
+those surrounding named ranges).
+
+@noindent
+More control can be obtained using the @t{zstyle} command, as described in
+@ref{The zsh/zutil Module}. Each style is looked up in the
+context @t{:zle:}@var{widget} where @var{widget} is the name of the
+user-defined widget, not the name of the function implementing it, so in
+the case of the definitions supplied by @t{select-word-style} the
+appropriate contexts are @t{:zle:forward-word}, and so on. The function
+@t{select-word-style} itself always defines styles for the context
+`@t{:zle:*}' which can be overridden by more specific (longer) patterns as
+well as explicit contexts.
+
+@noindent
+The style @t{word-style} specifies the rules to use. This may have the
+following values.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{normal}
+Use the standard shell rules, i.e. alphanumerics and @t{$WORDCHARS}, unless
+overridden by the styles @t{word-chars} or @t{word-class}.
+
+@item @t{specified}
+Similar to @t{normal}, but @emph{only} the specified characters, and not also
+alphanumerics, are considered word characters.
+
+@item @t{unspecified}
+The negation of specified. The given characters are those which will
+@emph{not} be considered part of a word.
+
+@item @t{shell}
+Words are obtained by using the syntactic rules for generating shell
+command arguments. In addition, special tokens which are never command
+arguments such as `@t{()}' are also treated as words.
+
+@item @t{whitespace}
+Words are whitespace-delimited strings of characters.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+The first three of those rules usually use @t{$WORDCHARS}, but the value
+in the parameter can be overridden by the style @t{word-chars}, which works
+in exactly the same way as @t{$WORDCHARS}. In addition, the style
+@t{word-class} uses character class syntax to group characters and takes
+precedence over @t{word-chars} if both are set. The @t{word-class} style
+does not include the surrounding brackets of the character class; for
+example, `@t{-:[:alnum:]}' is a valid @t{word-class} to include all
+alphanumerics plus the characters `@t{-}' and `@t{:}'. Be careful
+including `@t{]}', `@t{^}' and `@t{-}' as these are special inside
+character classes.
+
+@noindent
+@t{word-style} may also have `@t{-subword}' appended to its value to
+turn on subword matching, as described above.
+
+@noindent
+The style @t{skip-chars} is mostly useful for
+@t{transpose-words} and similar functions. If set, it gives a count of
+characters starting at the cursor position which will not be considered
+part of the word and are treated as space, regardless of what they actually
+are. For example, if
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle ':zle:transpose-words' skip-chars 1
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+has been set, and @t{transpose-words-match} is called with the cursor on
+the @var{X} of @t{foo}@var{X}@t{bar}, where @var{X} can be any character, then
+the resulting expression is @t{bar}@var{X}@t{foo}.
+
+@noindent
+Finer grained control can be obtained by setting the style @t{word-context}
+to an array of pairs of entries. Each pair of entries consists of a
+@var{pattern} and a @var{subcontext}. The shell argument the cursor is on is
+matched against each @var{pattern} in turn until one matches; if it does,
+the context is extended by a colon and the corresponding @var{subcontext}.
+Note that the test is made against the original word on the line, with no
+stripping of quotes. Special handling is done between words: the current
+context is examined and if it contains the string @t{between} the word
+is set to a single space; else if it is contains the string @t{back},
+the word before the cursor is considered, else the word after cursor is
+considered. Some examples are given below.
+
+@noindent
+The style @t{skip-whitespace-first} is only used with the
+@t{forward-word} widget. If it is set to true, then @t{forward-word}
+skips any non-word-characters, followed by any non-word-characters:
+this is similar to the behaviour of other word-orientated widgets,
+and also that used by other editors, however it differs from the
+standard zsh behaviour. When using @t{select-word-style} the widget
+is set in the context @t{:zle:*} to @t{true} if the word style is
+@t{bash} and @t{false} otherwise. It may be overridden by setting it in
+the more specific context @t{:zle:forward-word*}.
+
+@noindent
+It is possible to create widgets with specific behaviour by defining
+a new widget implemented by the appropriate generic function, then
+setting a style for the context of the specific widget. For example,
+the following defines a widget @t{backward-kill-space-word} using
+@t{backward-kill-word-match}, the generic widget implementing
+@t{backward-kill-word} behaviour, and ensures that the new widget
+always implements space-delimited behaviour.
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zle -N backward-kill-space-word backward-kill-word-match
+zstyle :zle:backward-kill-space-word word-style space
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The widget @t{backward-kill-space-word} can now be bound to a key.
+
+@noindent
+Here are some further examples of use of the styles, actually taken from the
+simplified interface in @t{select-word-style}:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle ':zle:*' word-style standard
+zstyle ':zle:*' word-chars @value{dsq}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Implements bash-style word handling for all widgets, i.e. only
+alphanumerics are word characters; equivalent to setting
+the parameter @t{WORDCHARS} empty for the given context.
+
+@noindent
+@example
+style ':zle:*kill*' word-style space
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Uses space-delimited words for widgets with the word `kill' in the name.
+Neither of the styles @t{word-chars} nor @t{word-class} is used in this case.
+
+@noindent
+Here are some examples of use of the @t{word-context} style to extend
+the context.
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle ':zle:*' word-context \
+ "*/*" filename "[[:space:]]" whitespace
+zstyle ':zle:transpose-words:whitespace' word-style shell
+zstyle ':zle:transpose-words:filename' word-style normal
+zstyle ':zle:transpose-words:filename' word-chars @value{dsq}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+This provides two different ways of using @t{transpose-words} depending on
+whether the cursor is on whitespace between words or on a filename, here
+any word containing a @t{/}. On whitespace, complete arguments as defined
+by standard shell rules will be transposed. In a filename, only
+alphanumerics will be transposed. Elsewhere, words will be transposed
+using the default style for @t{:zle:transpose-words}.
+
+@noindent
+The word matching and all the handling of @t{zstyle} settings is actually
+implemented by the function @t{match-words-by-style}. This can be used to
+create new user-defined widgets. The calling function should set the local
+parameter @t{curcontext} to @t{:zle:}@var{widget}, create the local
+parameter @t{matched_words} and call @t{match-words-by-style} with no
+arguments. On return, @t{matched_words} will be set to an array with the
+elements: (1) the start of the line (2) the word before the cursor (3) any
+non-word characters between that word and the cursor (4) any non-word
+character at the cursor position plus any remaining non-word characters
+before the next word, including all characters specified by the
+@t{skip-chars} style, (5) the word at or following the cursor (6) any
+non-word characters following that word (7) the remainder of the line. Any
+of the elements may be an empty string; the calling function should test
+for this to decide whether it can perform its function.
+
+@noindent
+If the variable @t{matched_words} is defined by the caller to
+@t{match-words-by-style} as an associative array (@t{local -A
+matched_words}), then the seven values given above should be retrieved
+from it as elements named @t{start}, @t{word-before-cursor},
+@t{ws-before-cursor}, @t{ws-after-cursor}, @t{word-after-cursor},
+@t{ws-after-word}, and @t{end}. In addition the element
+@t{is-word-start} is 1 if the cursor is on the start of a word or
+subword, or on white space before it (the cases can be distinguished by
+testing the @t{ws-after-cursor} element) and 0 otherwise. This form is
+recommended for future compatibility.
+
+@noindent
+It is possible to pass options with arguments to @t{match-words-by-style}
+to override the use of styles. The options are:
+@table @asis
+@item @t{-w}
+@var{word-style}
+@item @t{-s}
+@var{skip-chars}
+@item @t{-c}
+@var{word-class}
+@item @t{-C}
+@var{word-chars}
+@item @t{-r}
+@var{subword-range}
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+For example, @t{match-words-by-style -w shell -c 0} may be used to
+extract the command argument around the cursor.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{word-context} style is implemented by the function
+@t{match-word-context}. This should not usually need to be called
+directly.
+
+@tindex bracketed-paste-magic
+@item @t{bracketed-paste-magic}
+The @t{bracketed-paste} widget (see @ref{Miscellaneous} in @ref{Zle Widgets})
+inserts pasted text literally into the editor buffer rather than interpret
+it as keystrokes. This disables some common usages where the self-insert
+widget is replaced in order to accomplish some extra processing. An
+example is the contributed @t{url-quote-magic} widget described below.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{bracketed-paste-magic} widget is meant to replace @t{bracketed-paste}
+with a wrapper that re-enables these self-insert actions, and other
+actions as selected by zstyles. Therefore this widget is installed with
+
+@example
+autoload -Uz bracketed-paste-magic
+zle -N bracketed-paste bracketed-paste-magic
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Other than enabling some widget processing, @t{bracketed-paste-magic}
+attempts to replicate @t{bracketed-paste} as faithfully as possible.
+
+@noindent
+The following zstyles may be set to control processing of pasted text.
+All are looked up in the context `@t{:bracketed-paste-magic}'.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{active-widgets}
+A list of patterns matching widget names that should be activated during
+the paste. All other key sequences are processed as self-insert-unmeta.
+The default is `@t{self-*}' so any user-defined widgets named with that
+prefix are active along with the builtin self-insert.
+
+@noindent
+If this style is not set (explicitly deleted) or set to an empty value,
+no widgets are active and the pasted text is inserted literally. If the
+value includes `@t{undefined-key}', any unknown sequences are discarded
+from the pasted text.
+
+@item @t{inactive-keys}
+The inverse of @t{active-widgets}, a list of key sequences that always use
+@t{self-insert-unmeta} even when bound to an active widget. Note that
+this is a list of literal key sequences, not patterns.
+
+@item @t{paste-init}
+A list of function names, called in widget context (but not as widgets).
+The functions are called in order until one of them returns a non-zero
+status. The parameter `@t{PASTED}' contains the initial state of the
+pasted text. All other ZLE parameters such as `@t{BUFFER}' have their
+normal values and side-effects, and full history is available, so for
+example @t{paste-init} functions may move words from @t{BUFFER} into
+@t{PASTED} to make those words visible to the @t{active-widgets}.
+
+@noindent
+A non-zero return from a @t{paste-init} function does @emph{not} prevent the
+paste itself from proceeding.
+
+@noindent
+Loading @t{bracketed-paste-magic} defines @t{backward-extend-paste}, a
+helper function for use in @t{paste-init}.
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle :bracketed-paste-magic paste-init \
+ backward-extend-paste
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+When a paste would insert into the middle of a word or append text to a
+word already on the line, @t{backward-extend-paste} moves the prefix
+from @t{LBUFFER} into @t{PASTED} so that the @t{active-widgets} see the
+full word so far. This may be useful with @t{url-quote-magic}.
+
+@item @t{paste-finish}
+Another list of function names called in order until one returns non-zero.
+These functions are called @emph{after} the pasted text has been processed
+by the @t{active-widgets}, but @emph{before} it is inserted into `@t{BUFFER}'.
+ZLE parameters have their normal values and side-effects.
+
+@noindent
+A non-zero return from a @t{paste-finish} function does @emph{not} prevent
+the paste itself from proceeding.
+
+@noindent
+Loading @t{bracketed-paste-magic} also defines @t{quote-paste}, a helper
+function for use in @t{paste-finish}.
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle :bracketed-paste-magic paste-finish \
+ quote-paste
+zstyle :bracketed-paste-magic:finish quote-style \
+ qqq
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+When the pasted text is inserted into @t{BUFFER}, it is quoted per the
+@t{quote-style} value. To forcibly turn off the built-in numeric prefix
+quoting of @t{bracketed-paste}, use:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle :bracketed-paste-magic:finish quote-style \
+ none
+@end example
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+@emph{Important:} During @t{active-widgets} processing of the paste (after
+@t{paste-init} and before @t{paste-finish}), @t{BUFFER} starts empty and
+history is restricted, so cursor motions, etc., may not pass outside of
+the pasted content. Text assigned to @t{BUFFER} by the active widgets
+is copied back into @t{PASTED} before @t{paste-finish}.
+
+@tindex copy-earlier-word
+@item @t{copy-earlier-word}
+This widget works like a combination of @t{insert-last-word} and
+@t{copy-prev-shell-word}. Repeated invocations of the widget retrieve
+earlier words on the relevant history line. With a numeric argument
+@var{N}, insert the @var{N}th word from the history line; @var{N} may be
+negative to count from the end of the line.
+
+@noindent
+If @t{insert-last-word} has been used to retrieve the last word on a
+previous history line, repeated invocations will replace that word with
+earlier words from the same line.
+
+@noindent
+Otherwise, the widget applies to words on the line currently being edited.
+The @t{widget} style can be set to the name of another widget that should
+be called to retrieve words. This widget must accept the same three
+arguments as @t{insert-last-word}.
+
+@tindex cycle-completion-positions
+@item @t{cycle-completion-positions}
+After inserting an unambiguous string into the command line, the new
+function based completion system may know about multiple places in
+this string where characters are missing or differ from at least one
+of the possible matches. It will then place the cursor on the
+position it considers to be the most interesting one, i.e. the one
+where one can disambiguate between as many matches as possible with as
+little typing as possible.
+
+@noindent
+This widget allows the cursor to be easily moved to the other interesting
+spots. It can be invoked repeatedly to cycle between all positions
+reported by the completion system.
+
+@tindex delete-whole-word-match
+@item @t{delete-whole-word-match}
+This is another function which works like the @t{-match} functions
+described immediately above, i.e. using styles to decide the word
+boundaries. However, it is not a replacement for any existing function.
+
+@noindent
+The basic behaviour is to delete the word around the cursor. There is no
+numeric argument handling; only the single word around the cursor is
+considered. If the widget contains the string @t{kill}, the removed text
+will be placed in the cutbuffer for future yanking. This can be obtained
+by defining @t{kill-whole-word-match} as follows:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zle -N kill-whole-word-match delete-whole-word-match
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+and then binding the widget @t{kill-whole-word-match}.
+
+@tindex down-line-or-beginning-search
+@tindex up-line-or-beginning-search
+@item @t{up-line-or-beginning-search}, @t{down-line-or-beginning-search}
+These widgets are similar to the builtin functions @t{up-line-or-search}
+and @t{down-line-or-search}: if in a multiline buffer they move up or
+down within the buffer, otherwise they search for a history line matching
+the start of the current line. In this case, however, they search for
+a line which matches the current line up to the current cursor position, in
+the manner of @t{history-beginning-search-backward} and @t{-forward}, rather
+than the first word on the line.
+
+@tindex edit-command-line
+@item @t{edit-command-line}
+Edit the command line using your visual editor, as in @t{ksh}.
+
+@noindent
+@example
+bindkey -M vicmd v edit-command-line
+@end example
+
+@tindex expand-absolute-path
+@item @t{expand-absolute-path}
+Expand the file name under the cursor to an absolute path, resolving
+symbolic links. Where possible, the initial path segment is turned
+into a named directory or reference to a user's home directory.
+
+@tindex history-beginning-search-backward-end
+@tindex history-beginning-search-forward-end
+@item @t{history-search-end}
+This function implements the widgets
+@t{history-beginning-search-backward-end} and
+@t{history-beginning-search-forward-end}. These commands work by first
+calling the corresponding builtin widget (see
+@ref{History Control}) and then moving the cursor to the end of the line. The original cursor
+position is remembered and restored before calling the builtin widget a
+second time, so that the same search is repeated to look farther through
+the history.
+
+@noindent
+Although you @t{autoload} only one function, the commands to use it are
+slightly different because it implements two widgets.
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zle -N history-beginning-search-backward-end \
+ history-search-end
+zle -N history-beginning-search-forward-end \
+ history-search-end
+bindkey '\e^P' history-beginning-search-backward-end
+bindkey '\e^N' history-beginning-search-forward-end
+@end example
+
+@tindex history-beginning-search-menu
+@item @t{history-beginning-search-menu}
+This function implements yet another form of history searching. The
+text before the cursor is used to select lines from the history,
+as for @t{history-beginning-search-backward} except that all matches are
+shown in a numbered menu. Typing the appropriate digits inserts the
+full history line. Note that leading zeroes must be typed (they are only
+shown when necessary for removing ambiguity). The entire history is
+searched; there is no distinction between forwards and backwards.
+
+@noindent
+With a numeric argument, the search is not anchored to the start of
+the line; the string typed by the use may appear anywhere in the line
+in the history.
+
+@noindent
+If the widget name contains `@t{-end}' the cursor is moved to the end of
+the line inserted. If the widget name contains `@t{-space}' any space
+in the text typed is treated as a wildcard and can match anything (hence
+a leading space is equivalent to giving a numeric argument). Both
+forms can be combined, for example:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zle -N history-beginning-search-menu-space-end \
+ history-beginning-search-menu
+@end example
+
+@tindex history-pattern-search
+@tindex history-pattern-search-backward
+@tindex history-pattern-search-forward
+@item @t{history-pattern-search}
+The function @t{history-pattern-search} implements widgets which prompt
+for a pattern with which to search the history backwards or forwards. The
+pattern is in the usual zsh format, however the first character may be
+@t{^} to anchor the search to the start of the line, and the last character
+may be @t{$} to anchor the search to the end of the line. If the
+search was not anchored to the end of the line the cursor is positioned
+just after the pattern found.
+
+@noindent
+The commands to create bindable widgets are similar to those in the
+example immediately above:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+autoload -U history-pattern-search
+zle -N history-pattern-search-backward history-pattern-search
+zle -N history-pattern-search-forward history-pattern-search
+@end example
+
+@tindex incarg
+@vindex incarg, use of
+@item @t{incarg}
+Typing the keystrokes for this widget with the cursor placed on or to the
+left of an integer causes that integer to be incremented by one. With a
+numeric argument, the number is incremented by the amount of the
+argument (decremented if the numeric argument is negative). The shell
+parameter @t{incarg} may be set to change the default increment to
+something other than one.
+
+@noindent
+@example
+bindkey '^X+' incarg
+@end example
+
+@tindex incremental-complete-word
+@item @t{incremental-complete-word}
+This allows incremental completion of a word. After starting this
+command, a list of completion choices can be shown after every character
+you type, which you can delete with @t{^H} or @t{DEL}. Pressing return
+accepts the completion so far and returns you to normal editing (that is,
+the command line is @emph{not} immediately executed). You can hit @t{TAB} to
+do normal completion, @t{^G} to abort back to the state when you started,
+and @t{^D} to list the matches.
+
+@noindent
+This works only with the new function based completion system.
+
+@noindent
+@example
+bindkey '^Xi' incremental-complete-word
+@end example
+
+@tindex insert-composed-char
+@item @t{insert-composed-char}
+This function allows you to compose characters that don't appear on the
+keyboard to be inserted into the command line. The command is followed by
+two keys corresponding to ASCII characters (there is no prompt). For
+accented characters, the two keys are a base character followed by a code
+for the accent, while for other special characters the two characters
+together form a mnemonic for the character to be inserted. The
+two-character codes are a subset of those given by RFC 1345 (see for
+example @t{@uref{http://www.faqs.org/rfcs/rfc1345.html}}).
+
+@noindent
+The function may optionally be followed by up to two characters which
+replace one or both of the characters read from the keyboard; if both
+characters are supplied, no input is read. For example,
+@t{insert-composed-char a:} can be used within a widget to insert an a with
+umlaut into the command line. This has the advantages over use of a
+literal character that it is more portable.
+
+@noindent
+For best results zsh should have been built with support for multibyte
+characters (configured with @t{--enable-multibyte}); however, the function
+works for the limited range of characters available in single-byte
+character sets such as ISO-8859-1.
+
+@noindent
+The character is converted into the local representation and
+inserted into the command line at the cursor position.
+(The conversion is done within the shell, using whatever facilities
+the C library provides.) With a numeric argument, the character and its
+code are previewed in the status line
+
+@noindent
+The function may be run outside zle in which case it prints the character
+(together with a newline) to standard output. Input is still read from
+keystrokes.
+
+@noindent
+See @t{insert-unicode-char} for an alternative way of inserting Unicode
+characters using their hexadecimal character number.
+
+@noindent
+The set of accented characters is reasonably complete up to Unicode
+character U+0180, the set of special characters less so. However, it
+is very sporadic from that point. Adding new characters is easy,
+however; see the function @t{define-composed-chars}. Please send any
+additions to @t{zsh-workers@@zsh.org}.
+
+@noindent
+The codes for the second character when used to accent the first are as
+follows. Note that not every character can take every accent.
+@table @asis
+@item @t{!}
+Grave.
+@item @t{'}
+Acute.
+@item @t{>}
+Circumflex.
+@item @t{?}
+Tilde. (This is not @t{~} as RFC 1345 does not assume that
+character is present on the keyboard.)
+@item @t{-}
+Macron. (A horizontal bar over the base character.)
+@item @t{(}
+Breve. (A shallow dish shape over the base character.)
+@item @t{.}
+Dot above the base character, or in the case of @t{i} no dot,
+or in the case of @t{L} and @t{l} a centered dot.
+@item @t{:}
+Diaeresis (Umlaut).
+@item @t{c}
+Cedilla.
+@item @t{_}
+Underline, however there are currently no underlined characters.
+@item @t{/}
+Stroke through the base character.
+@item @t{"}
+Double acute (only supported on a few letters).
+@item @t{;}
+Ogonek. (A little forward facing hook at the bottom right
+of the character.)
+@item @t{<}
+Caron. (A little v over the letter.)
+@item @t{0}
+Circle over the base character.
+@item @t{2}
+Hook over the base character.
+@item @t{9}
+Horn over the base character.
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+The most common characters from the Arabic, Cyrillic, Greek and Hebrew
+alphabets are available; consult RFC 1345 for the appropriate sequences.
+In addition, a set of two letter codes not in RFC 1345 are available for
+the double-width characters corresponding to ASCII characters from @t{!}
+to @t{~} (0x21 to 0x7e) by preceding the character with @t{^}, for
+example @t{^A} for a double-width @t{A}.
+
+@noindent
+The following other two-character sequences are understood.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item ASCII characters
+These are already present on most keyboards:
+@table @asis
+@item @t{<(}
+Left square bracket
+@item @t{//}
+Backslash (solidus)
+@item @t{)>}
+Right square bracket
+@item @t{(!}
+Left brace (curly bracket)
+@item @t{!!}
+Vertical bar (pipe symbol)
+@item @t{!)}
+Right brace (curly bracket)
+@item @t{'?}
+Tilde
+@end table
+
+@item Special letters
+Characters found in various variants of the Latin alphabet:
+@table @asis
+@item @t{ss}
+Eszett (scharfes S)
+@item @t{D-}, @t{d-}
+Eth
+@item @t{TH}, @t{th}
+Thorn
+@item @t{kk}
+Kra
+@item @t{'n}
+'n
+@item @t{NG}, @t{ng}
+Ng
+@item @t{OI}, @t{oi}
+Oi
+@item @t{yr}
+yr
+@item @t{ED}
+ezh
+@end table
+
+@item Currency symbols
+@table @asis
+@item @t{Ct}
+Cent
+@item @t{Pd}
+Pound sterling (also lira and others)
+@item @t{Cu}
+Currency
+@item @t{Ye}
+Yen
+@item @t{Eu}
+Euro (N.B. not in RFC 1345)
+@end table
+
+@item Punctuation characters
+References to "right" quotes indicate the shape (like a 9 rather than 6)
+rather than their grammatical use. (For example, a "right" low double
+quote is used to open quotations in German.)
+@table @asis
+@item @t{!I}
+Inverted exclamation mark
+@item @t{BB}
+Broken vertical bar
+@item @t{SE}
+Section
+@item @t{Co}
+Copyright
+@item @t{-a}
+Spanish feminine ordinal indicator
+@item @t{<<}
+Left guillemet
+@item @t{-}@t{-}
+Soft hyphen
+@item @t{Rg}
+Registered trade mark
+@item @t{PI}
+Pilcrow (paragraph)
+@item @t{-o}
+Spanish masculine ordinal indicator
+@item @t{>>}
+Right guillemet
+@item @t{?I}
+Inverted question mark
+@item @t{-1}
+Hyphen
+@item @t{-N}
+En dash
+@item @t{-M}
+Em dash
+@item @t{-3}
+Horizontal bar
+@item @t{:3}
+Vertical ellipsis
+@item @t{.3}
+Horizontal midline ellipsis
+@item @t{!2}
+Double vertical line
+@item @t{=2}
+Double low line
+@item @t{'6}
+Left single quote
+@item @t{'9}
+Right single quote
+@item @t{.9}
+"Right" low quote
+@item @t{9'}
+Reversed "right" quote
+@item @t{"6}
+Left double quote
+@item @t{"9}
+Right double quote
+@item @t{:9}
+"Right" low double quote
+@item @t{9"}
+Reversed "right" double quote
+@item @t{/-}
+Dagger
+@item @t{/=}
+Double dagger
+@end table
+
+@item Mathematical symbols
+@table @asis
+@item @t{DG}
+Degree
+@item @t{-2}, @t{+-}, @t{-+}
+- sign, +/- sign, -/+ sign
+@item @t{2S}
+Superscript 2
+@item @t{3S}
+Superscript 3
+@item @t{1S}
+Superscript 1
+@item @t{My}
+Micro
+@item @t{.M}
+Middle dot
+@item @t{14}
+Quarter
+@item @t{12}
+Half
+@item @t{34}
+Three quarters
+@item @t{*X}
+Multiplication
+@item @t{-:}
+Division
+@item @t{%0}
+Per mille
+@item @t{FA}, @t{TE}, @t{/0}
+For all, there exists, empty set
+@item @t{dP}, @t{DE}, @t{NB}
+Partial derivative, delta (increment), del
+(nabla)
+@item @t{(-}, @t{-)}
+Element of, contains
+@item @t{*P}, @t{+Z}
+Product, sum
+@item @t{*-}, @t{Ob}, @t{Sb}
+Asterisk, ring, bullet
+@item @t{RT}, @t{0(}, @t{00}
+Root sign, proportional to, infinity
+@end table
+
+@item Other symbols
+@table @asis
+@item @t{cS}, @t{cH}, @t{cD}, @t{cC}
+Card suits: spades, hearts, diamonds,
+clubs
+@item @t{Md}, @t{M8}, @t{M2}, @t{Mb}, @t{Mx}, @t{MX}
+Musical notation:
+crotchet (quarter note), quaver (eighth note), semiquavers (sixteenth
+notes), flag sign, natural sign, sharp sign
+@item @t{Fm}, @t{Ml}
+Female, male
+@end table
+
+@item Accents on their own
+@table @asis
+@item @t{'>}
+Circumflex (same as caret, @t{^})
+@item @t{'!}
+Grave (same as backtick, @t{`})
+@item @t{',}
+Cedilla
+@item @t{':}
+Diaeresis (Umlaut)
+@item @t{'m}
+Macron
+@item @t{''}
+Acute
+@end table
+
+@end table
+
+@tindex insert-files
+@item @t{insert-files}
+This function allows you type a file pattern, and see the results of the
+expansion at each step. When you hit return, all expansions are inserted
+into the command line.
+
+@noindent
+@example
+bindkey '^Xf' insert-files
+@end example
+
+@tindex insert-unicode-char
+@item @t{insert-unicode-char}
+When first executed, the user inputs a set of hexadecimal digits.
+This is terminated with another call to @t{insert-unicode-char}.
+The digits are then turned into the corresponding Unicode character.
+For example, if the widget is bound to @t{^XU}, the character sequence
+`@t{^XU 4 c ^XU}' inserts @t{L} (Unicode U+004c).
+
+@noindent
+See @t{insert-composed-char} for a way of inserting characters
+using a two-character mnemonic.
+
+@tindex narrow-to-region
+@tindex narrow-to-region-invisible
+
+@item @t{narrow-to-region }[ @t{-p} @var{pre} ] [ @t{-P} @var{post} ]
+@itemx @t{@ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ }[ @t{-S} @var{statepm} | @t{-R} @var{statepm} | [ @t{-l} @var{lbufvar} ] [ @t{-r} @var{rbufvar} ] ]
+@itemx @t{@ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ }[ @t{-n} ] [ @var{start} @var{end} ]
+@itemx @t{narrow-to-region-invisible}
+Narrow the editable portion of the buffer to the region between the cursor
+and the mark, which may be in either order. The region may not be empty.
+
+@noindent
+@t{narrow-to-region} may be used as a widget or called as a function from a
+user-defined widget; by default, the text outside the editable area remains
+visible. A @t{recursive-edit} is performed and the original widening
+status is then restored. Various options and arguments are available when
+it is called as a function.
+
+@noindent
+The options @t{-p} @var{pretext} and @t{-P} @var{posttext} may be
+used to replace the text before and after the display for the duration of
+the function; either or both may be an empty string.
+
+@noindent
+If the option @t{-n} is also given, @var{pretext} or @var{posttext} will only
+be inserted if there is text before or after the region respectively which
+will be made invisible.
+
+@noindent
+Two numeric arguments may be given which will be used instead of the cursor
+and mark positions.
+
+@noindent
+The option @t{-S} @var{statepm} is used to narrow according to the other
+options while saving the original state in the parameter with name
+@var{statepm}, while the option @t{-R} @var{statepm} is used to restore the
+state from the parameter; note in both cases the @emph{name} of the parameter
+is required. In the second case, other options and arguments are
+irrelevant. When this method is used, no @t{recursive-edit} is performed;
+the calling widget should call this function with the option @t{-S},
+perform its own editing on the command line or pass control to the user
+via `@t{zle recursive-edit}', then call this function with the option
+@t{-R}. The argument @var{statepm} must be a suitable name for an ordinary
+parameter, except that parameters beginning with the prefix @t{_ntr_} are
+reserved for use within @t{narrow-to-region}. Typically the parameter will
+be local to the calling function.
+
+@noindent
+The options @t{-l} @var{lbufvar} and @t{-r} @var{rbufvar} may be used to
+specify parameters where the widget will store the resulting text from
+the operation. The parameter @var{lbufvar} will contain @t{LBUFFER}
+and @var{rbufvar} will contain @t{RBUFFER}. Neither of these two options
+may be used with @t{-S} or @t{-R}.
+
+@noindent
+@t{narrow-to-region-invisible} is a simple widget which calls
+@t{narrow-to-region} with arguments which replace any text outside the
+region with `@t{...}'. It does not take any arguments.
+
+@noindent
+The display is restored (and the widget returns) upon any zle command
+which would usually cause the line to be accepted or aborted. Hence an
+additional such command is required to accept or abort the current line.
+
+@noindent
+The return status of both widgets is zero if the line was accepted, else
+non-zero.
+
+@noindent
+Here is a trivial example of a widget using this feature.
+@example
+local state
+narrow-to-region -p $'Editing restricted region\n' \
+ -P @value{dsq} -S state
+zle recursive-edit
+narrow-to-region -R state
+@end example
+
+@tindex predict-on
+@tindex predict-off
+@item @t{predict-on}
+This set of functions implements predictive typing using history search.
+After @t{predict-on}, typing characters causes the editor to look backward
+in the history for the first line beginning with what you have typed so
+far. After @t{predict-off}, editing returns to normal for the line found.
+In fact, you often don't even need to use @t{predict-off}, because if the
+line doesn't match something in the history, adding a key performs
+standard completion, and then inserts itself if no completions were found.
+However, editing in the middle of a line is liable to confuse prediction;
+see the @t{toggle} style below.
+
+@noindent
+With the function based completion system (which is needed for this), you
+should be able to type @t{TAB} at almost any point to advance the cursor
+to the next @value{dsbq}interesting@value{dsq} character position (usually the end of the
+current word, but sometimes somewhere in the middle of the word). And of
+course as soon as the entire line is what you want, you can accept with
+return, without needing to move the cursor to the end first.
+
+@noindent
+The first time @t{predict-on} is used, it creates several additional
+widget functions:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{delete-backward-and-predict}
+Replaces the @t{backward-delete-char}
+widget. You do not need to bind this yourself.
+@item @t{insert-and-predict}
+Implements predictive typing by replacing the
+@t{self-insert} widget. You do not need to bind this yourself.
+@item @t{predict-off}
+Turns off predictive typing.
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+Although you @t{autoload} only the @t{predict-on} function, it is
+necessary to create a keybinding for @t{predict-off} as well.
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zle -N predict-on
+zle -N predict-off
+bindkey '^X^Z' predict-on
+bindkey '^Z' predict-off
+@end example
+
+@tindex read-from-minibuffer
+@item @t{read-from-minibuffer}
+This is most useful when called as a function from inside a widget, but will
+work correctly as a widget in its own right. It prompts for a value
+below the current command line; a value may be input using all of the
+standard zle operations (and not merely the restricted set available
+when executing, for example, @t{execute-named-cmd}). The value is then
+returned to the calling function in the parameter @t{$REPLY} and the
+editing buffer restored to its previous state. If the read was aborted
+by a keyboard break (typically @t{^G}), the function returns status 1
+and @t{$REPLY} is not set.
+
+@noindent
+If one argument is supplied to the function it is taken as a prompt,
+otherwise `@t{? }' is used. If two arguments are supplied, they are the
+prompt and the initial value of @t{$LBUFFER}, and if a third argument is
+given it is the initial value of @t{$RBUFFER}. This provides a default
+value and starting cursor placement. Upon return the entire buffer is the
+value of @t{$REPLY}.
+
+@noindent
+One option is available: `@t{-k} @var{num}' specifies that @var{num}
+characters are to be read instead of a whole line. The line editor is not
+invoked recursively in this case, so depending on the terminal settings
+the input may not be visible, and only the input keys are placed in
+@t{$REPLY}, not the entire buffer. Note that unlike the @t{read} builtin
+@var{num} must be given; there is no default.
+
+@noindent
+The name is a slight misnomer, as in fact the shell's own minibuffer is
+not used. Hence it is still possible to call @t{executed-named-cmd} and
+similar functions while reading a value.
+
+@tindex replace-argument
+@tindex replace-argument-edit
+@item @t{replace-argument}, @t{replace-argument-edit}
+The function @t{replace-argument} can be used to replace a command
+line argument in the current command line or, if the current command
+line is empty, in the last command line executed (the new command line
+is not executed). Arguments are as delimited by standard shell syntax,
+
+@noindent
+If a numeric argument is given, that specifies the argument to be
+replaced. 0 means the command name, as in history expansion.
+A negative numeric argument counts backward from the last word.
+
+@noindent
+If no numeric argument is given, the current argument is replaced;
+this is the last argument if the previous history line is being used.
+
+@noindent
+The function prompts for a replacement argument.
+
+@noindent
+If the widget contains the string @t{edit}, for example is defined as
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zle -N replace-argument-edit replace-argument
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+then the function presents the current value of the argument for
+editing, otherwise the editing buffer for the replacement is
+initially empty.
+
+@tindex replace-string
+@tindex replace-string-again
+@tindex replace-pattern
+@item @t{replace-string}, @t{replace-pattern}
+@itemx @t{replace-string-again}, @t{replace-pattern-again}
+The function @t{replace-string} implements three widgets.
+If defined under the same name as the function, it prompts for two
+strings; the first (source) string will be replaced by the second
+everywhere it occurs in the line editing buffer.
+
+@noindent
+If the widget name contains the word `@t{pattern}', for example by
+defining the widget using the command `@t{zle -N replace-pattern
+replace-string}', then the matching is performed using zsh patterns. All
+zsh extended globbing patterns can be used in the source string; note
+that unlike filename generation the pattern does not need to match an
+entire word, nor do glob qualifiers have any effect. In addition, the
+replacement string can contain parameter or command substitutions.
+Furthermore, a `@t{&}' in the replacement string will be replaced with
+the matched source string, and a backquoted digit `@t{\}@var{N}' will be
+replaced by the @var{N}th parenthesised expression matched. The form
+`@t{\@{}@var{N}@t{@}}' may be used to protect the digit from following
+digits.
+
+@noindent
+If the widget instead contains the word `@t{regex}' (or `@t{regexp}'),
+then the matching is performed using regular expressions, respecting
+the setting of the option @t{RE_MATCH_PCRE} (see the description of the
+function @t{regexp-replace} below). The special replacement facilities
+described above for pattern matching are available.
+
+@noindent
+By default the previous source or replacement string will not be offered
+for editing. However, this feature can be activated by setting the style
+@t{edit-previous} in the context @t{:zle:}@var{widget} (for example,
+@t{:zle:replace-string}) to @t{true}. In addition, a positive
+numeric argument forces the previous values to be offered, a negative or
+zero argument forces them not to be.
+
+@noindent
+The function @t{replace-string-again} can be used to repeat the previous
+replacement; no prompting is done. As with @t{replace-string}, if the name
+of the widget contains the word `@t{pattern}' or `@t{regex}', pattern or
+regular expression matching is performed, else a literal string
+replacement. Note that the previous source and replacement text are the
+same whether pattern, regular expression or string matching is used.
+
+@noindent
+In addition, @t{replace-string} shows the previous replacement above
+the prompt, so long as there was one during the current session; if the
+source string is empty, that replacement will be repeated without
+the widget prompting for a replacement string.
+
+@noindent
+For example, starting from the line:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+print This line contains fan and fond
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+and invoking @t{replace-pattern} with the source string
+`@t{f(?)n}' and
+the replacement string `@t{c\1r}' produces the not very useful line:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+print This line contains car and cord
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The range of the replacement string can be limited by using the
+@t{narrow-to-region-invisible} widget. One limitation of the current
+version is that @t{undo} will cycle through changes to the replacement
+and source strings before undoing the replacement itself.
+
+@tindex send-invisible
+@item @t{send-invisible}
+This is similar to read-from-minibuffer in that it may be called as a
+function from a widget or as a widget of its own, and interactively reads
+input from the keyboard. However, the input being typed is concealed and
+a string of asterisks (`@t{*}') is shown instead. The value is saved in
+the parameter @t{$INVISIBLE} to which a reference is inserted into the
+editing buffer at the restored cursor position. If the read was aborted
+by a keyboard break (typically @t{^G}) or another escape from editing such
+as @t{push-line}, @t{$INVISIBLE} is set to empty and the original buffer
+is restored unchanged.
+
+@noindent
+If one argument is supplied to the function it is taken as a prompt,
+otherwise `@t{Non-echoed text: }' is used (as in emacs). If a second and
+third argument are supplied they are used to begin and end the reference
+to @t{$INVISIBLE} that is inserted into the buffer. The default is to
+open with @t{$@{}, then @t{INVISIBLE}, and close with @t{@}}, but many
+other effects are possible.
+
+@tindex smart-insert-last-word
+@item @t{smart-insert-last-word}
+This function may replace the @t{insert-last-word} widget, like so:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zle -N insert-last-word smart-insert-last-word
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+With a numeric argument, or when passed command line arguments in a call
+from another widget, it behaves like @t{insert-last-word}, except that
+words in comments are ignored when @t{INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS} is set.
+
+@noindent
+Otherwise, the rightmost @value{dsbq}interesting@value{dsq} word from the previous command is
+found and inserted. The default definition of @value{dsbq}interesting@value{dsq} is that the
+word contains at least one alphabetic character, slash, or backslash.
+This definition may be overridden by use of the @t{match} style. The
+context used to look up the style is the widget name, so usually the
+context is @t{:insert-last-word}. However, you can bind this function to
+different widgets to use different patterns:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zle -N insert-last-assignment smart-insert-last-word
+zstyle :insert-last-assignment match '[[:alpha:]][][[:alnum:]]#=*'
+bindkey '\e=' insert-last-assignment
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+If no interesting word is found and the @t{auto-previous} style is set to
+a true value, the search continues upward through the history. When
+@t{auto-previous} is unset or false (the default), the widget must be
+invoked repeatedly in order to search earlier history lines.
+
+@tindex transpose-lines
+@item @t{transpose-lines}
+Only useful with a multi-line editing buffer; the lines here are
+lines within the current on-screen buffer, not history lines.
+The effect is similar to the function of the same name in Emacs.
+
+@noindent
+Transpose the current line with the previous line and move the cursor
+to the start of the next line. Repeating this (which can be done by
+providing a positive numeric argument) has the effect of moving
+the line above the cursor down by a number of lines.
+
+@noindent
+With a negative numeric argument, requires two lines above the
+cursor. These two lines are transposed and the cursor moved to the
+start of the previous line. Using a numeric argument less than -1
+has the effect of moving the line above the cursor up by minus that
+number of lines.
+
+@tindex url-quote-magic
+@item @t{url-quote-magic}
+This widget replaces the built-in @t{self-insert} to make it easier to
+type URLs as command line arguments. As you type, the input character is
+analyzed and, if it may need quoting, the current word is checked for a
+URI scheme. If one is found and the current word is not already in
+quotes, a backslash is inserted before the input character.
+
+@noindent
+Styles to control quoting behavior:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{url-metas}
+This style is looked up in the context `@t{:url-quote-magic:}@var{scheme}'
+(where @var{scheme} is that of the current URL, e.g. "@t{ftp}"). The value
+is a string listing the characters to be treated as globbing
+metacharacters when appearing in a URL using that scheme. The default is
+to quote all zsh extended globbing characters, excluding '@t{<}' and
+'@t{>}' but including braces (as in brace expansion). See also
+@t{url-seps}.
+
+@item @t{url-seps}
+Like @t{url-metas}, but lists characters that should be considered command
+separators, redirections, history references, etc. The default is to
+quote the standard set of shell separators, excluding those that overlap
+with the extended globbing characters, but including '@t{<}' and
+'@t{>}' and the first character of @t{$histchars}.
+
+@item @t{url-globbers}
+This style is looked up in the context `@t{:url-quote-magic}'. The values
+form a list of command names that are expected to do their own globbing
+on the URL string. This implies that they are aliased to use the
+`@t{noglob}' modifier. When the first word on the line matches one of the
+values @emph{and} the URL refers to a local file (see @t{url-local-schema}),
+only the @t{url-seps} characters are quoted; the @t{url-metas} are left
+alone, allowing them to affect command-line parsing, completion, etc. The
+default values are a literal `@t{noglob}' plus (when the @t{zsh/parameter}
+module is available) any commands aliased to the helper function
+`@t{urlglobber}' or its alias `@t{globurl}'.
+
+@item @t{url-local-schema}
+This style is always looked up in the context `@t{:urlglobber}', even
+though it is used by both url-quote-magic and urlglobber. The values form
+a list of URI schema that should be treated as referring to local files by
+their real local path names, as opposed to files which are specified
+relative to a web-server-defined document root. The defaults are
+"@t{ftp}" and "@t{file}".
+
+@item @t{url-other-schema}
+Like @t{url-local-schema}, but lists all other URI schema upon which
+@t{urlglobber} and @t{url-quote-magic} should act. If the URI on the
+command line does not have a scheme appearing either in this list or in
+@t{url-local-schema}, it is not magically quoted. The default values are
+"@t{http}", "@t{https}", and "@t{ftp}". When a scheme appears both here
+and in @t{url-local-schema}, it is quoted differently depending on whether
+the command name appears in @t{url-globbers}.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+Loading @t{url-quote-magic} also defines a helper function `@t{urlglobber}'
+and aliases `@t{globurl}' to `@t{noglob urlglobber}'. This function takes
+a local URL apart, attempts to pattern-match the local file portion of the
+URL path, and then puts the results back into URL format again.
+
+@tindex vi-pipe
+@item @t{vi-pipe}
+This function reads a movement command from the keyboard and then
+prompts for an external command. The part of the buffer covered by
+the movement is piped to the external command and then replaced by
+the command's output. If the movement command is bound to vi-pipe,
+the current line is used.
+
+@noindent
+The function serves as an example for reading a vi movement command
+from within a user-defined widget.
+
+@tindex which-command
+@item @t{which-command}
+This function is a drop-in replacement for the builtin widget
+@t{which-command}. It has enhanced behaviour, in that it correctly
+detects whether or not the command word needs to be expanded as an
+alias; if so, it continues tracing the command word from the expanded
+alias until it reaches the command that will be executed.
+
+@noindent
+The style @t{whence} is available in the context @t{:zle:$WIDGET}; this
+may be set to an array to give the command and options that will be used to
+investigate the command word found. The default is @t{whence -c}.
+
+@tindex zcalc-auto-insert
+@item @t{zcalc-auto-insert}
+This function is useful together with the @t{zcalc} function described in
+@ref{Mathematical Functions}.
+It should be bound to a key representing a binary operator such
+as `@t{+}', `@t{-}', `@t{*}' or `@t{/}'. When running in zcalc,
+if the key occurs at the start of the line or immediately following
+an open parenthesis, the text @t{"ans "} is inserted before the
+representation of the key itself. This allows easy use of the
+answer from the previous calculation in the current line. The
+text to be inserted before the symbol typed can be modified by setting
+the variable @t{ZCALC_AUTO_INSERT_PREFIX}.
+
+@noindent
+Hence, for example, typing `@t{+12}' followed by return adds 12
+to the previous result.
+
+@noindent
+If zcalc is in RPN mode (@t{-r} option) the effect of this binding is
+automatically suppressed as operators alone on a line are meaningful.
+
+@noindent
+When not in zcalc, the key simply inserts the symbol itself.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Utility Functions
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+These functions are useful in constructing widgets. They
+should be loaded with `@t{autoload -U} @var{function}' and called
+as indicated from user-defined widgets.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@tindex split-shell-arguments
+@item @t{split-shell-arguments}
+This function splits the line currently being edited into shell arguments
+and whitespace. The result is stored in the array @t{reply}. The array
+contains all the parts of the line in order, starting with any whitespace
+before the first argument, and finishing with any whitespace after the last
+argument. Hence (so long as the option @t{KSH_ARRAYS} is not set)
+whitespace is given by odd indices in the array and arguments by
+even indices. Note that no stripping of quotes is done; joining together
+all the elements of @t{reply} in order is guaranteed to produce the
+original line.
+
+@noindent
+The parameter @t{REPLY} is set to the index of the word in @t{reply} which
+contains the character after the cursor, where the first element has index
+1. The parameter @t{REPLY2} is set to the index of the character under the
+cursor in that word, where the first character has index 1.
+
+@noindent
+Hence @t{reply}, @t{REPLY} and @t{REPLY2} should all be made local to
+the enclosing function.
+
+@noindent
+See the function @t{modify-current-argument}, described below, for
+an example of how to call this function.
+
+@tindex modify-current-argument
+@item @t{modify-current-argument} [ @var{expr-using-}@t{$ARG} | @var{func} ]
+This function provides a simple method of allowing user-defined widgets
+to modify the command line argument under the cursor (or immediately to the
+left of the cursor if the cursor is between arguments).
+
+@noindent
+The argument can be an expression which when evaluated operates on the shell
+parameter @t{ARG}, which will have been set to the command line argument
+under the cursor. The expression should be suitably quoted to prevent
+it being evaluated too early.
+
+@noindent
+Alternatively, if the argument does not contain the string @t{ARG}, it
+is assumed to be a shell function, to which the current command line
+argument is passed as the only argument. The function should set the
+variable @t{REPLY} to the new value for the command line argument.
+If the function returns non-zero status, so does the calling function.
+
+@noindent
+For example, a user-defined widget containing the following code
+converts the characters in the argument under the cursor into all upper
+case:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+modify-current-argument '$@{(U)ARG@}'
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The following strips any quoting from the current word (whether backslashes
+or one of the styles of quotes), and replaces it with single quoting
+throughout:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+modify-current-argument '$@{(qq)$@{(Q)ARG@}@}'
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The following performs directory expansion on the command line
+argument and replaces it by the absolute path:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+expand-dir() @{
+ REPLY=$@{~1@}
+ REPLY=$@{REPLY:a@}
+@}
+modify-current-argument expand-dir
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+In practice the function @t{expand-dir} would probably not be defined
+within the widget where @t{modify-current-argument} is called.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Styles
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+The behavior of several of the above widgets can be controlled by the use
+of the @t{zstyle} mechanism. In particular, widgets that interact with
+the completion system pass along their context to any completions that
+they invoke.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@kindex break-keys, widget style
+@item @t{break-keys}
+This style is used by the @t{incremental-complete-word} widget. Its value
+should be a pattern, and all keys matching this pattern will cause the
+widget to stop incremental completion without the key having any further
+effect. Like all styles used directly by
+@t{incremental-complete-word}, this style is looked up using the
+context `@t{:incremental}'.
+
+@kindex completer, completion style
+@item @t{completer}
+The @t{incremental-complete-word} and @t{insert-and-predict} widgets set
+up their top-level context name before calling completion. This allows
+one to define different sets of completer functions for normal completion
+and for these widgets. For example, to use completion, approximation and
+correction for normal completion, completion and correction for
+incremental completion and only completion for prediction one could use:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle ':completion:*' completer \
+ _complete _correct _approximate
+zstyle ':completion:incremental:*' completer \
+ _complete _correct
+zstyle ':completion:predict:*' completer \
+ _complete
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+It is a good idea to restrict the completers used in prediction, because
+they may be automatically invoked as you type. The @t{_list} and
+@t{_menu} completers should never be used with prediction. The
+@t{_approximate}, @t{_correct}, @t{_expand}, and @t{_match} completers may
+be used, but be aware that they may change characters anywhere in the word
+behind the cursor, so you need to watch carefully that the result is what
+you intended.
+
+@kindex cursor, completion style
+@item @t{cursor}
+The @t{insert-and-predict} widget uses this style, in the context
+`@t{:predict}', to decide where to place the cursor after completion has
+been tried. Values are:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{complete}
+The cursor is left where it was when completion finished, but only if
+it is after a character equal to the one just inserted by the user. If
+it is after another character, this value is the same as `@t{key}'.
+
+@item @t{key}
+The cursor is left
+after the @var{n}th occurrence of the character just inserted, where
+@var{n} is the number of times that character appeared in the word
+before completion was attempted. In short, this has the effect of
+leaving the cursor after the character just typed even if the
+completion code found out that no other characters need to be inserted
+at that position.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+Any other value for this style unconditionally leaves the cursor at the
+position where the completion code left it.
+
+@kindex list, widget style
+@item @t{list}
+When using the @t{incremental-complete-word} widget, this style says
+if the matches should be listed on every key press (if they fit on the
+screen). Use the context prefix `@t{:completion:incremental}'.
+
+@noindent
+The @t{insert-and-predict} widget uses this style to decide if the
+completion should be shown even if there is only one possible completion.
+This is done if the value of this style is the string @t{always}. In this
+case the context is `@t{:predict}' (@emph{not} `@t{:completion:predict}').
+
+@kindex match, widget style
+@item @t{match}
+This style is used by @t{smart-insert-last-word} to provide a pattern
+(using full @t{EXTENDED_GLOB} syntax) that matches an interesting word.
+The context is the name of the widget to which @t{smart-insert-last-word}
+is bound (see above). The default behavior of @t{smart-insert-last-word}
+is equivalent to:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle :insert-last-word match '*[[:alpha:]/\\]*'
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+However, you might want to include words that contain spaces:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle :insert-last-word match '*[[:alpha:][:space:]/\\]*'
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Or include numbers as long as the word is at least two characters long:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle :insert-last-word match '*([[:digit:]]?|[[:alpha:]/\\])*'
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The above example causes redirections like "2>" to be included.
+
+@kindex prompt, widget style
+@item @t{prompt}
+The @t{incremental-complete-word} widget shows the value of this
+style in the status line during incremental completion. The string
+value may contain any of the following substrings in the manner of
+the @t{PS1} and other prompt parameters:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{%c}
+Replaced by the name of the completer function that generated the
+matches (without the leading underscore).
+
+@item @t{%l}
+When the @t{list} style is set,
+replaced by `@t{...}' if the list of matches is too long to fit on the
+screen and with an empty string otherwise. If the @t{list} style is
+`false' or not set, `@t{%l}' is always removed.
+
+@item @t{%n}
+Replaced by the number of matches generated.
+
+@item @t{%s}
+Replaced by `@t{-no match-}', `@t{-no prefix-}', or an empty string
+if there is no completion matching the word on the line, if the
+matches have no common prefix different from the word on the line, or
+if there is such a common prefix, respectively.
+
+@item @t{%u}
+Replaced by the unambiguous part of all matches, if there
+is any, and if it is different from the word on the line.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+Like `@t{break-keys}', this uses the `@t{:incremental}' context.
+
+@kindex stop-keys, widget style
+@item @t{stop-keys}
+This style is used by the @t{incremental-complete-word} widget. Its value
+is treated similarly to the one for the @t{break-keys} style (and uses
+the same context: `@t{:incremental}'). However, in
+this case all keys matching the pattern given as its value will stop
+incremental completion and will then execute their usual function.
+
+@kindex toggle, widget style
+@item @t{toggle}
+This boolean style is used by @t{predict-on} and its related widgets in
+the context `@t{:predict}'. If set to one of the standard `true' values,
+predictive typing is automatically toggled off in situations where it is
+unlikely to be useful, such as when editing a multi-line buffer or after
+moving into the middle of a line and then deleting a character. The
+default is to leave prediction turned on until an explicit call to
+@t{predict-off}.
+
+@kindex verbose, widget style
+@item @t{verbose}
+This boolean style is used by @t{predict-on} and its related widgets in
+the context `@t{:predict}'. If set to one of the standard `true' values,
+these widgets display a message below the prompt when the predictive state
+is toggled. This is most useful in combination with the @t{toggle} style.
+The default does not display these messages.
+
+@kindex widget, widget style
+@item @t{widget}
+This style is similar to the @t{command} style: For widget functions that
+use @t{zle} to call other widgets, this style can sometimes be used to
+override the widget which is called. The context for this style is the
+name of the calling widget (@emph{not} the name of the calling function,
+because one function may be bound to multiple widget names).
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle :copy-earlier-word widget smart-insert-last-word
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Check the documentation for the calling widget or function to determine
+whether the @t{widget} style is used.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+@node Exception Handling, MIME Functions, ZLE Functions, User Contributions
+
+@section Exception Handling
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+Two functions are provided to enable zsh to provide exception handling in a
+form that should be familiar from other languages.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex throw
+@item @t{throw} @var{exception}
+The function @t{throw} throws the named @var{exception}. The name is
+an arbitrary string and is only used by the @t{throw} and @t{catch}
+functions. An exception is for the most part treated the same as a
+shell error, i.e. an unhandled exception will cause the shell to abort all
+processing in a function or script and to return to the top level in an
+interactive shell.
+
+@item @t{catch} @var{exception-pattern}
+The function @t{catch} returns status zero if an exception was thrown and
+the pattern @var{exception-pattern} matches its name. Otherwise it
+returns status 1. @var{exception-pattern} is a standard
+shell pattern, respecting the current setting of the @t{EXTENDED_GLOB}
+option. An alias @t{catch} is also defined to prevent the argument to the
+function from matching filenames, so patterns may be used unquoted. Note
+that as exceptions are not fundamentally different from other shell errors
+it is possible to catch shell errors by using an empty string as the
+exception name. The shell variable @t{CAUGHT} is set by @t{catch} to the
+name of the exception caught. It is possible to rethrow an exception by
+calling the @t{throw} function again once an exception has been caught.
+@findex catch
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+The functions are designed to be used together with the @t{always} construct
+described in
+@ref{Complex Commands}. This is important as only this
+construct provides the required support for exceptions. A typical example
+is as follows.
+
+@noindent
+@example
+@{
+ # "try" block
+ # ... nested code here calls "throw MyExcept"
+@} always @{
+ # "always" block
+ if catch MyExcept; then
+ print "Caught exception MyExcept"
+ elif catch @value{dsq}; then
+ print "Caught a shell error. Propagating..."
+ throw @value{dsq}
+ fi
+ # Other exceptions are not handled but may be caught further
+ # up the call stack.
+@}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+If all exceptions should be caught, the following idiom might be
+preferable.
+
+@noindent
+@example
+@{
+ # ... nested code here throws an exception
+@} always @{
+ if catch *; then
+ case $CAUGHT in
+ (MyExcept)
+ print "Caught my own exception"
+ ;;
+ (*)
+ print "Caught some other exception"
+ ;;
+ esac
+ fi
+@}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+In common with exception handling in other languages, the exception may be
+thrown by code deeply nested inside the `try' block. However, note that it
+must be thrown inside the current shell, not in a subshell forked for a
+pipeline, parenthesised current-shell construct, or some form of
+command or process substitution.
+
+@noindent
+The system internally uses the shell variable @t{EXCEPTION} to record the
+name of the exception between throwing and catching. One drawback of this
+scheme is that if the exception is not handled the variable @t{EXCEPTION}
+remains set and may be incorrectly recognised as the name of an exception
+if a shell error subsequently occurs. Adding @t{unset EXCEPTION} at the
+start of the outermost layer of any code that uses exception handling will
+eliminate this problem.
+
+@noindent
+@node MIME Functions, Mathematical Functions, Exception Handling, User Contributions
+
+@section MIME Functions
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+Three functions are available to provide handling of files recognised by
+extension, for example to dispatch a file @t{text.ps} when executed as a
+command to an appropriate viewer.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex zsh-mime-setup
+@findex zsh-mime-handler
+@item @t{zsh-mime-setup} [ @t{-fv} ] [ @t{-l} [ @var{suffix} ... ] ]
+@itemx @t{zsh-mime-handler} [ @t{-l} ] @var{command argument} ...
+These two functions use the files @t{~/.mime.types} and @t{/etc/mime.types},
+which associate types and extensions, as well as @t{~/.mailcap} and
+@t{/etc/mailcap} files, which associate types and the programs that
+handle them. These are provided on many systems with the Multimedia
+Internet Mail Extensions.
+
+@noindent
+To enable the system, the function @t{zsh-mime-setup} should be
+autoloaded and run. This allows files with extensions to be treated
+as executable; such files be completed by the function completion system.
+The function @t{zsh-mime-handler} should not need to be called by the
+user.
+
+@noindent
+The system works by setting up suffix aliases with `@t{alias -s}'.
+Suffix aliases already installed by the user will not be overwritten.
+
+@noindent
+For suffixes defined in lower case, upper case variants will also
+automatically be handled (e.g. @t{PDF} is automatically handled if
+handling for the suffix @t{pdf} is defined), but not vice versa.
+
+@noindent
+Repeated calls to @t{zsh-mime-setup} do not override the existing
+mapping between suffixes and executable files unless the option @t{-f}
+is given. Note, however, that this does not override existing suffix
+aliases assigned to handlers other than @t{zsh-mime-handler}.
+
+@noindent
+Calling @t{zsh-mime-setup} with the option @t{-l} lists the existing
+mappings without altering them. Suffixes to list (which may contain
+pattern characters that should be quoted from immediate interpretation
+on the command line) may be given as additional arguments, otherwise
+all suffixes are listed.
+
+@noindent
+Calling @t{zsh-mime-setup} with the option
+@t{-v} causes verbose output to be shown during the setup operation.
+
+@noindent
+The system respects the @t{mailcap} flags @t{needsterminal} and
+@t{copiousoutput}, see man page mailcap(4).
+
+@noindent
+The functions use the following styles, which are defined with the
+@t{zstyle} builtin command (@ref{The zsh/zutil Module}). They should be defined
+before @t{zsh-mime-setup} is run. The contexts used all
+start with @t{:mime:}, with additional components in some cases.
+It is recommended that a trailing @t{*} (suitably quoted) be appended
+to style patterns in case the system is extended in future. Some
+examples are given below.
+
+@noindent
+For files that have multiple suffixes, e.g. @t{.pdf.gz}, where the
+context includes the suffix it will be looked up starting with the
+longest possible suffix until a match for the style is found.
+For example, if @t{.pdf.gz} produces a match for the handler, that
+will be used; otherwise the handler for @t{.gz} will be used. Note
+that, owing to the way suffix aliases work, it is always required that
+there be a handler for the shortest possible suffix, so in this example
+@t{.pdf.gz} can only be handled if @t{.gz} is also handled (though
+not necessarily in the same way). Alternatively, if no handling
+for @t{.gz} on its own is needed, simply adding the command
+
+@noindent
+@example
+alias -s gz=zsh-mime-handler
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+to the initialisation code is sufficient; @t{.gz} will not be handled
+on its own, but may be in combination with other suffixes.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@kindex current-shell, MIME style
+@item @t{current-shell}
+If this boolean style is true, the mailcap handler for the context in
+question is run using the @t{eval} builtin instead of by starting a new
+@t{sh} process. This is more efficient, but may not work in the occasional
+cases where the mailcap handler uses strict POSIX syntax.
+
+@kindex disown, MIME style
+@item @t{disown}
+If this boolean style is true, mailcap handlers started in the
+background will be disowned, i.e. not subject to job control within
+the parent shell. Such handlers nearly always produce their own
+windows, so the only likely harmful side effect of setting the style is
+that it becomes harder to kill jobs from within the shell.
+
+@kindex execute-as-is, MIME style
+@item @t{execute-as-is}
+This style gives a list of patterns to be matched against files
+passed for execution with a handler program. If the file matches
+the pattern, the entire command line is executed in its current form,
+with no handler. This is useful for files which might have suffixes
+but nonetheless be executable in their own right. If the style
+is not set, the pattern @t{*(*) *(/)} is used;
+hence executable files are executed directly and not passed to a
+handler, and the option @t{AUTO_CD} may be used to change to directories
+that happen to have MIME suffixes.
+
+@kindex execute-never, MIME style
+@item @t{execute-never}
+This style is useful in combination with @t{execute-as-is}. It is
+set to an array of patterns corresponding to full paths to files that
+should never be treated as executable, even if the file passed to
+the MIME handler matches @t{execute-as-is}. This is useful for file
+systems that don't handle execute permission or that contain executables
+from another operating system. For example, if @t{/mnt/windows} is a
+Windows mount, then
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle ':mime:*' execute-never '/mnt/windows/*'
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+will ensure that any files found in that area will be executed as MIME
+types even if they are executable. As this example shows, the complete
+file name is matched against the pattern, regardless of how the file
+was passed to the handler. The file is resolved to a full path using
+the @t{:P} modifier described in
+@ref{Modifiers};
+this means that symbolic links are resolved where possible, so that
+links into other file systems behave in the correct fashion.
+
+@kindex file-path, MIME style
+@item @t{file-path}
+Used if the style @t{find-file-in-path} is true for the same context.
+Set to an array of directories that are used for searching for the
+file to be handled; the default is the command path given by the
+special parameter @t{path}. The shell option @t{PATH_DIRS} is respected;
+if that is set, the appropriate path will be searched even if the
+name of the file to be handled as it appears on the command line contains
+a `@t{/}'.
+The full context is @t{:mime:.}@var{suffix}@t{:}, as described for the style
+@t{handler}.
+
+@kindex find-file-in-path, MIME style
+@item @t{find-file-in-path}
+If set, allows files whose names do not contain absolute paths
+to be searched for in the command path or the path specified by the
+@t{file-path} style. If the file is not found in the path, it is looked
+for locally (whether or not the current directory is in the path); if it is
+not found locally, the handler will abort unless the @t{handle-nonexistent}
+style is set. Files found in the path are tested as described for
+the style @t{execute-as-is}.
+The full context is @t{:mime:.}@var{suffix}@t{:}, as described for the style
+@t{handler}.
+
+@kindex flags, MIME style
+@item @t{flags}
+Defines flags to go with a handler; the context is as for the
+@t{handler} style, and the format is as for the flags in @t{mailcap}.
+
+@kindex handle-nonexistent, MIME style
+@item @t{handle-nonexistent}
+By default, arguments that don't correspond to files are not passed
+to the MIME handler in order to prevent it from intercepting commands found
+in the path that happen to have suffixes. This style may be set to
+an array of extended glob patterns for arguments that will be passed to the
+handler even if they don't exist. If it is not explicitly set it
+defaults to @t{[[:alpha:]]#:/*} which allows URLs to be passed to the MIME
+handler even though they don't exist in that format in the file system.
+The full context is @t{:mime:.}@var{suffix}@t{:}, as described for the style
+@t{handler}.
+
+@kindex handler, MIME style
+@item @t{handler}
+Specifies a handler for a suffix; the suffix is given by the context as
+@t{:mime:.}@var{suffix}@t{:}, and the format of the handler is exactly
+that in @t{mailcap}. Note in particular the `@t{.}' and trailing colon
+to distinguish this use of the context. This overrides any handler
+specified by the @t{mailcap} files. If the handler requires a terminal,
+the @t{flags} style should be set to include the word @t{needsterminal},
+or if the output is to be displayed through a pager (but not if the
+handler is itself a pager), it should include @t{copiousoutput}.
+
+@kindex mailcap, MIME style
+@item @t{mailcap}
+A list of files in the format of @t{~/.mailcap} and
+@t{/etc/mailcap} to be read during setup, replacing the default list
+which consists of those two files. The context is @t{:mime:}.
+A @t{+} in the list will be replaced by the default files.
+
+@kindex mailcap-priorities, MIME style
+@item @t{mailcap-priorities}
+This style is used to resolve multiple mailcap entries for the same MIME
+type. It consists of an array of the following elements, in descending
+order of priority; later entries will be used if earlier entries are
+unable to resolve the entries being compared. If none of the tests
+resolve the entries, the first entry encountered is retained.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{files}
+The order of files (entries in the @t{mailcap} style) read. Earlier
+files are preferred. (Note this does not resolve entries in the same file.)
+
+@item @t{priority}
+The priority flag from the mailcap entry. The priority is an integer
+from 0 to 9 with the default value being 5.
+
+@item @t{flags}
+The test given by the @t{mailcap-prio-flags} option is used to resolve
+entries.
+
+@item @t{place}
+Later entries are preferred; as the entries are strictly ordered, this
+test always succeeds.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+Note that as this style is handled during initialisation, the context
+is always @t{:mime:}, with no discrimination by suffix.
+
+@kindex mailcap-prio-flags, MIME style
+@item @t{mailcap-prio-flags}
+This style is used when the keyword @t{flags} is encountered in the
+list of tests specified by the @t{mailcap-priorities} style.
+It should be set to a list of patterns, each of which is tested against
+the flags specified in the mailcap entry (in other words, the sets of
+assignments found with some entries in the mailcap file). Earlier
+patterns in the list are preferred to later ones, and matched patterns
+are preferred to unmatched ones.
+
+@kindex mime-types, MIME style
+@item @t{mime-types}
+A list of files in the format of @t{~/.mime.types} and
+@t{/etc/mime.types} to be read during setup, replacing the default list
+which consists of those two files. The context is @t{:mime:}.
+A @t{+} in the list will be replaced by the default files.
+
+@kindex never-background, MIME style
+@item @t{never-background}
+If this boolean style is set, the handler for the given context is
+always run in the foreground, even if the flags provided in the mailcap
+entry suggest it need not be (for example, it doesn't require a
+terminal).
+
+@kindex pager, MIME style
+@item @t{pager}
+If set, will be used instead of @t{$PAGER} or @t{more} to handle
+suffixes where the @t{copiousoutput} flag is set. The context is
+as for @t{handler}, i.e. @t{:mime:.}@var{suffix}@t{:} for handling
+a file with the given @var{suffix}.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+Examples:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle ':mime:*' mailcap ~/.mailcap /usr/local/etc/mailcap
+zstyle ':mime:.txt:' handler less %s
+zstyle ':mime:.txt:' flags needsterminal
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+When @t{zsh-mime-setup} is subsequently run, it will look for
+@t{mailcap} entries in the two files given. Files of suffix @t{.txt}
+will be handled by running `@t{less} @var{file.txt}'. The flag
+@t{needsterminal} is set to show that this program must run attached to a
+terminal.
+
+@noindent
+As there are several steps to dispatching a command, the following
+should be checked if attempting to execute a file by extension
+@t{.}@var{ext} does not have the expected effect.
+
+@noindent
+The command `@t{alias -s} @var{ext}' should show
+`@t{ps=zsh-mime-handler}'. If it shows something else, another suffix
+alias was already installed and was not overwritten. If it shows
+nothing, no handler was installed: this is most likely because no
+handler was found in the @t{.mime.types} and @t{mailcap} combination for
+@t{.ext} files. In that case, appropriate handling should be added to
+@t{~/.mime.types} and @t{mailcap}.
+
+@noindent
+If the extension is handled by @t{zsh-mime-handler} but the file is
+not opened correctly, either the handler defined for the type is
+incorrect, or the flags associated with it are in appropriate. Running
+@t{zsh-mime-setup -l} will show the handler and, if there are any, the
+flags. A @t{%s} in the handler is replaced by the file (suitably quoted
+if necessary). Check that the handler program listed lists and can
+be run in the way shown. Also check that the flags @t{needsterminal} or
+@t{copiousoutput} are set if the handler needs to be run under a
+terminal; the second flag is used if the output should be sent to a pager.
+An example of a suitable @t{mailcap} entry for such a program is:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+text/html; /usr/bin/lynx '%s'; needsterminal
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Running `@t{zsh-mime-handler -l} @var{command line}' prints the command
+line that would be executed, simplified to remove the effect of any
+flags, and quoted so that the output can be run as a complete zsh
+command line. This is used by the completion system to decide how to
+complete after a file handled by @t{zsh-mime-setup}.
+
+@findex pick-web-browser
+@item @t{pick-web-browser}
+This function is separate from the two MIME functions described above
+and can be assigned directly to a suffix:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+autoload -U pick-web-browser
+alias -s html=pick-web-browser
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+It is provided as an intelligent front end to dispatch a web browser.
+It may be run as either a function or a shell script. The status
+255 is returned if no browser could be started.
+
+@noindent
+Various styles are available to customize the choice of browsers:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{browser-style}
+The value of the style is an array giving preferences in decreasing order
+for the type of browser to use. The values of elements may be
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{running}
+Use a GUI browser that is already running when an X Window display is
+available. The browsers listed in the @t{x-browsers} style are tried
+in order until one is found; if it is, the file will be displayed in
+that browser, so the user may need to check whether it has appeared.
+If no running browser is found, one is not started. Browsers other than
+Firefox, Opera and Konqueror are assumed to understand the Mozilla
+syntax for opening a URL remotely.
+
+@item @t{x}
+Start a new GUI browser when an X Window display is available. Search for
+the availability of one of the browsers listed in the @t{x-browsers} style
+and start the first one that is found. No check is made for an already
+running browser.
+
+@item @t{tty}
+Start a terminal-based browser. Search for the availability of one
+of the browsers listed in the @t{tty-browsers} style and start the
+first one that is found.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+If the style is not set the default @t{running x tty} is used.
+
+@item @t{x-browsers}
+An array in decreasing order
+of preference of browsers to use when running under the X Window System.
+The array consists of the command name under which to start the
+browser. They are looked up in the context @t{:mime:} (which may
+be extended in future, so appending `@t{*}' is recommended). For
+example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle ':mime:*' x-browsers opera konqueror firefox
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+specifies that @t{pick-web-browser} should first look for a running
+instance of Opera, Konqueror or Firefox, in that order, and if it
+fails to find any should attempt to start Opera. The default is
+@t{firefox mozilla netscape opera konqueror}.
+
+@item @t{tty-browsers}
+An array similar to @t{x-browsers}, except that it gives browsers to
+use when no X Window display is available. The default is
+@t{elinks links lynx}.
+
+@item @t{command}
+If it is set this style is used to pick the command
+used to open a page for a browser. The context is
+@t{:mime:browser:new:$browser:} to start a new browser or
+@t{:mime:browser:running:$browser:} to open a URL in a browser already
+running on the current X display, where @t{$browser} is the value matched
+in the @t{x-browsers} or @t{tty-browsers} style. The escape sequence
+@t{%b} in the style's value will be replaced by the browser, while @t{%u}
+will be replaced by the URL. If the style is not set, the default for all
+new instances is equivalent to @t{%b %u} and the defaults for using running
+browsers are equivalent to the values @t{kfmclient openURL %u} for
+Konqueror, @t{firefox -new-tab %u} for Firefox, @t{opera -newpage %u}
+for Opera, and @t{%b -remote "openUrl(%u)"} for all others.
+
+@end table
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+@node Mathematical Functions, User Configuration Functions, MIME Functions, User Contributions
+
+@section Mathematical Functions
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex zcalc
+@item @t{zcalc} [ @t{-erf} ] [ @var{expression} ... ]
+A reasonably powerful calculator based on zsh's arithmetic evaluation
+facility. The syntax is similar to that of formulae in most programming
+languages; see
+@ref{Arithmetic Evaluation} for details.
+
+@noindent
+Non-programmers should note that, as in many other programming
+languages, expressions involving only integers (whether constants
+without a `@t{.}', variables containing such constants as strings, or
+variables declared to be integers) are by default evaluated using
+integer arithmetic, which is not how an ordinary desk calculator
+operates. To force floating point operation, pass the option @t{-f};
+see further notes below.
+
+@noindent
+If the file @t{~/.zcalcrc} exists it will be sourced inside the function
+once it is set up and about to process the command line. This
+can be used, for example, to set shell options; @t{emulate -L zsh}
+and @t{setopt extendedglob} are in effect at this point. Any
+failure to source the file if it exists is treated as fatal.
+As with other initialisation files, the directory @t{$ZDOTDIR} is used
+instead of @t{$HOME} if it is set.
+
+@noindent
+The mathematical library @t{zsh/mathfunc} will be loaded if it is
+available; see
+@ref{The zsh/mathfunc Module}. The mathematical functions
+correspond to the raw system libraries, so trigonometric functions are
+evaluated using radians, and so on.
+
+@noindent
+Each line typed is evaluated as an expression. The prompt shows a number,
+which corresponds to a positional parameter where the result of that
+calculation is stored. For example, the result of the calculation on the
+line preceded by `@t{4> }' is available as @t{$4}. The last value
+calculated is available as @t{ans}. Full command line editing, including
+the history of previous calculations, is available; the history is saved in
+the file @t{~/.zcalc_history}. To exit, enter a blank line or type `@t{:q}'
+on its own (`@t{q}' is allowed for historical compatibility).
+
+@noindent
+A line ending with a single backslash is treated in the same fashion
+as it is in command line editing: the backslash is removed, the
+function prompts for more input (the prompt is preceded by `@t{...}'
+to indicate this), and the lines are combined into one to get the final
+result. In addition, if the input so far contains more open than
+close parentheses @t{zcalc} will prompt for more input.
+
+@noindent
+If arguments are given to @t{zcalc} on start up, they are used to prime the
+first few positional parameters. A visual indication of this is given when
+the calculator starts.
+
+@noindent
+The constants @t{PI} (3.14159...) and @t{E} (2.71828...) are provided.
+Parameter assignment is possible, but note that all parameters will be
+put into the global namespace unless the @t{:local} special command is
+used. The function creates local variables whose names start with
+@t{_}, so users should avoid doing so. The variables @t{ans} (the last
+answer) and @t{stack} (the stack in RPN mode) may be referred to
+directly; @t{stack} is an array but elements of it are numeric. Various
+other special variables are used locally with their standard meaning,
+for example @t{compcontext}, @t{match}, @t{mbegin}, @t{mend}, @t{psvar}.
+
+@noindent
+The output base can be initialised by passing the option `@t{-#}@var{base}',
+for example `@t{zcalc -#16}' (the `@t{#}' may have to be quoted, depending
+on the globbing options set).
+
+@noindent
+If the option `@t{-e}' is set, the function runs non-interactively:
+the arguments are treated as expressions to be evaluated as if entered
+interactively line by line.
+
+@noindent
+If the option `@t{-f}' is set, all numbers are treated as floating
+point, hence for example the expression `@t{3/4}' evaluates to 0.75
+rather than 0. Options must appear in separate words.
+
+@noindent
+If the option `@t{-r}' is set, RPN (Reverse Polish Notation) mode is
+entered. This has various additional properties:
+@table @asis
+@item Stack
+Evaluated values are maintained in a stack; this is contained in
+an array named @t{stack} with the most recent value in @t{$@{stack[1]@}}.
+
+@item Operators and functions
+If the line entered matches an operator (@t{+}, @t{-}, @t{*},
+@t{/}, @t{**}, @t{^}, @t{|} or @t{&}) or a function supplied by the
+@t{zsh/mathfunc} library, the bottom element or elements of the stack
+are popped to use as the argument or arguments. The higher elements
+of stack (least recent) are used as earlier arguments. The result is
+then pushed into @t{$@{stack[1]@}}.
+
+@item Expressions
+Other expressions are evaluated normally, printed, and added to the
+stack as numeric values. The syntax within expressions on a single line
+is normal shell arithmetic (not RPN).
+
+@item Stack listing
+If an integer follows the option @t{-r} with no space, then
+on every evaluation that many elements of the stack, where available,
+are printed instead of just the most recent result. Hence, for example,
+@t{zcalc -r4} shows @t{$stack[4]} to @t{$stack[1]} each time results
+are printed.
+
+@item Duplication: @t{=}
+The pseudo-operator @t{=} causes the most recent element of
+the stack to be duplicated onto the stack.
+
+@item @t{pop}
+The pseudo-function @t{pop} causes the most recent element of
+the stack to be popped. A `@t{>}' on its own has the same effect.
+
+@item @t{>}@var{ident}
+The expression @t{>} followed (with no space) by a shell identifier
+causes the most recent element of the stack to be popped and
+assigned to the variable with that name. The variable is
+local to the @t{zcalc} function.
+
+@item @t{<}@var{ident}
+The expression @t{<} followed (with no space) by a shell identifier
+causes the value of the variable with that name to be pushed
+onto the stack. @var{ident} may be an integer, in which
+case the previous result with that number (as shown before
+the @t{>} in the standard @t{zcalc} prompt) is put on the stack.
+
+@item Exchange: @t{xy}
+The pseudo-function @t{xy} causes the most recent two elements of
+the stack to be exchanged. `@t{<>}' has the same effect.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+The prompt is configurable via the parameter @t{ZCALCPROMPT}, which
+undergoes standard prompt expansion. The index of the current entry is
+stored locally in the first element of the array @t{psvar}, which can be
+referred to in @t{ZCALCPROMPT} as `@t{%1v}'. The default prompt is
+`@t{%1v> }'.
+
+@noindent
+The variable @t{ZCALC_ACTIVE} is set within the function and can
+be tested by nested functions; it has the value @t{rpn} if RPN mode is
+active, else 1.
+
+@noindent
+A few special commands are available; these are introduced by a colon.
+For backward compatibility, the colon may be omitted for certain
+commands. Completion is available if @t{compinit} has been run.
+
+@noindent
+The output precision may be specified within zcalc by special commands
+familiar from many calculators.
+@table @asis
+@item @t{:norm}
+The default output format. It corresponds to the printf @t{%g}
+specification. Typically this shows six decimal digits.
+
+@item @t{:sci} @var{digits}
+Scientific notation, corresponding to the printf @t{%g} output format with
+the precision given by @var{digits}. This produces either fixed point or
+exponential notation depending on the value output.
+
+@item @t{:fix} @var{digits}
+Fixed point notation, corresponding to the printf @t{%f} output format with
+the precision given by @var{digits}.
+
+@item @t{:eng} @var{digits}
+Exponential notation, corresponding to the printf @t{%E} output format with
+the precision given by @var{digits}.
+
+@item @t{:raw}
+Raw output: this is the default form of the output from a math
+evaluation. This may show more precision than the number actually
+possesses.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+Other special commands:
+@table @asis
+@item @t{:!}@var{line...}
+Execute @var{line...} as a normal shell command line. Note that it
+is executed in the context of the function, i.e. with local variables.
+Space is optional after @t{:!}.
+
+@item @t{:local} @var{arg} ...
+Declare variables local to the function. Other variables
+may be used, too, but they will be taken from or put into the global
+scope.
+
+@item @t{:function} @var{name} [ @var{body} ]
+Define a mathematical function or (with no @var{body}) delete it.
+@t{:function} may be abbreviated to @t{:func} or simply @t{:f}.
+The @var{name} may contain the same characters as a shell function name.
+The function is defined using @t{zmathfuncdef}, see below.
+
+@noindent
+Note that @t{zcalc} takes care of all quoting. Hence for example:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+:f cube $1 * $1 * $1
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+defines a function to cube the sole argument. Functions so defined, or
+indeed any functions defined directly or indirectly using @t{functions
+-M}, are available to execute by typing only the name on the line in RPN
+mode; this pops the appropriate number of arguments off the stack
+to pass to the function, i.e. 1 in the case of the example @t{cube}
+function. If there are optional arguments only the mandatory
+arguments are supplied by this means.
+
+@item @t{[#}@var{base}@t{]}
+This is not a special command, rather part of normal arithmetic
+syntax; however, when this form appears on a line by itself the default
+output radix is set to @var{base}. Use, for example, `@t{[#16]}' to display
+hexadecimal output preceded by an indication of the base, or `@t{[##16]}'
+just to display the raw number in the given base. Bases themselves are
+always specified in decimal. `@t{[#]}' restores the normal output format.
+Note that setting an output base suppresses floating point output; use
+`@t{[#]}' to return to normal operation.
+
+@item @t{$}@var{var}
+Print out the value of var literally; does not affect the calculation.
+To use the value of var, omit the leading `@t{$}'.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+See the comments in the function for a few extra tips.
+
+@findex max
+@findex min
+@findex sum
+@findex zmathfunc
+@item @t{min(}@var{arg}@t{, ...)}
+@itemx @t{max(}@var{arg}@t{, ...)}
+@itemx @t{sum(}@var{arg}@t{, ...)}
+@itemx @t{zmathfunc}
+The function @t{zmathfunc} defines the three mathematical functions
+@t{min}, @t{max}, and @t{sum}. The functions @t{min} and @t{max} take
+one or more arguments. The function @t{sum} takes zero or more arguments.
+Arguments can be of different types (ints and floats).
+
+@noindent
+Not to be confused with the @t{zsh/mathfunc} module, described in
+@ref{The zsh/mathfunc Module}.
+
+@findex zmathfuncdef
+@item @t{zmathfuncdef} [ @var{mathfunc} [ @var{body} ] ]
+A convenient front end to @t{functions -M}.
+
+@noindent
+With two arguments, define a mathematical function named @var{mathfunc}
+which can be used in any form of arithmetic evaluation. @var{body}
+is a mathematical expression to implement the function. It may
+contain references to position parameters @t{$1}, @t{$2}, ...
+to refer to mandatory parameters and @t{$@{1:-}@var{defvalue}@t{@}} ...
+to refer to optional parameters. Note that the forms must be
+strictly adhered to for the function to calculate the correct number
+of arguments. The implementation is held in a shell function named
+@t{zsh_math_func_}@var{mathfunc}; usually the user will not need
+to refer to the shell function directly. Any existing function
+of the same name is silently replaced.
+
+@noindent
+With one argument, remove the mathematical function @var{mathfunc}
+as well as the shell function implementation.
+
+@noindent
+With no arguments, list all @var{mathfunc} functions in a form
+suitable for restoring the definition.
+The functions have not necessarily been defined by @t{zmathfuncdef}.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+@node User Configuration Functions, Other Functions, Mathematical Functions, User Contributions
+
+@section User Configuration Functions
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+The @t{zsh/newuser} module comes with a function to aid in configuring
+shell options for new users. If the module is installed, this function can
+also be run by hand. It is available even if the module's default
+behaviour, namely running the function for a new user logging in without
+startup files, is inhibited.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{zsh-newuser-install} [ @t{-f} ]
+The function presents the user with various options for customizing
+their initialization scripts. Currently only @t{~/.zshrc} is handled.
+@t{$ZDOTDIR/.zshrc} is used instead if the parameter @t{ZDOTDIR} is
+set; this provides a way for the user to configure a file without
+altering an existing @t{.zshrc}.
+
+@noindent
+By default the function exits immediately if it finds any of the files
+@t{.zshenv}, @t{.zprofile}, @t{.zshrc}, or @t{.zlogin} in the appropriate
+directory. The option @t{-f} is required in order to force the function
+to continue. Note this may happen even if @t{.zshrc} itself does not
+exist.
+
+@noindent
+As currently configured, the function will exit immediately if the
+user has root privileges; this behaviour cannot be overridden.
+
+@noindent
+Once activated, the function's behaviour is supposed to be
+self-explanatory. Menus are present allowing the user to alter
+the value of options and parameters. Suggestions for improvements are
+always welcome.
+
+@noindent
+When the script exits, the user is given the opportunity to save the new
+file or not; changes are not irreversible until this point. However,
+the script is careful to restrict changes to the file only to a group
+marked by the lines `@t{# Lines configured by zsh-newuser-install}' and
+`@t{# End of lines configured by zsh-newuser-install}'. In addition,
+the old version of @t{.zshrc} is saved to a file with the suffix
+@t{.zni} appended.
+
+@noindent
+If the function edits an existing @t{.zshrc}, it is up to the user
+to ensure that the changes made will take effect. For example, if
+control usually returns early from the existing @t{.zshrc} the lines
+will not be executed; or a later initialization file may override
+options or parameters, and so on. The function itself does not attempt to
+detect any such conflicts.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+@node Other Functions, , User Configuration Functions, User Contributions
+
+@section Other Functions
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+There are a large number of helpful functions in the @t{Functions/Misc}
+directory of the zsh distribution. Most are very simple and do not
+require documentation here, but a few are worthy of special mention.
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Descriptions
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex colors
+@item @t{colors}
+This function initializes several associative arrays to map color names to
+(and from) the ANSI standard eight-color terminal codes. These are used
+by the prompt theme system (@ref{Prompt Themes}). You seldom should need to run
+@t{colors} more than once.
+
+@noindent
+The eight base colors are: @t{black}, @t{red}, @t{green}, @t{yellow},
+@t{blue}, @t{magenta}, @t{cyan}, and @t{white}. Each of these has codes for
+foreground and background. In addition there are seven intensity attributes:
+@t{bold}, @t{faint}, @t{standout}, @t{underline}, @t{blink}, @t{reverse},
+and @t{conceal}. Finally, there are seven codes used to negate attributes:
+@t{none} (reset all attributes to the defaults), @t{normal}
+(neither bold nor faint), @t{no-standout}, @t{no-underline}, @t{no-blink},
+@t{no-reverse}, and @t{no-conceal}.
+
+@noindent
+Some terminals do not support all combinations of colors and intensities.
+
+@noindent
+The associative arrays are:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{color}
+@itemx @t{colour}
+Map all the color names to their integer codes, and integer codes to the
+color names. The eight base names map to the foreground color codes, as
+do names prefixed with `@t{fg-}', such as `@t{fg-red}'. Names prefixed
+with `@t{bg-}', such as `@t{bg-blue}', refer to the background codes. The
+reverse mapping from code to color yields base name for foreground codes
+and the @t{bg-} form for backgrounds.
+
+@noindent
+Although it is a misnomer to call them `colors', these arrays also map the
+other fourteen attributes from names to codes and codes to names.
+
+@item @t{fg}
+@itemx @t{fg_bold}
+@itemx @t{fg_no_bold}
+Map the eight basic color names to ANSI terminal escape sequences that set
+the corresponding foreground text properties. The @t{fg} sequences change
+the color without changing the eight intensity attributes.
+
+@item @t{bg}
+@itemx @t{bg_bold}
+@itemx @t{bg_no_bold}
+Map the eight basic color names to ANSI terminal escape sequences that set
+the corresponding background properties. The @t{bg} sequences change the
+color without changing the eight intensity attributes.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+In addition, the scalar parameters @t{reset_color} and @t{bold_color} are
+set to the ANSI terminal escapes that turn off all attributes and turn on
+bold intensity, respectively.
+
+@findex fned
+@item @t{fned} [ @t{-x} @var{num} ] @var{name}
+Same as @t{zed -f}. This function does not appear in the zsh
+distribution, but can be created by linking @t{zed} to the name @t{fned}
+in some directory in your @t{fpath}.
+
+@findex is-at-least
+@item @t{is-at-least} @var{needed} [ @var{present} ]
+Perform a greater-than-or-equal-to comparison of two strings having the
+format of a zsh version number; that is, a string of numbers and text with
+segments separated by dots or dashes. If the @var{present} string is not
+provided, @t{$ZSH_VERSION} is used. Segments are paired left-to-right in
+the two strings with leading non-number parts ignored. If one string has
+fewer segments than the other, the missing segments are considered zero.
+
+@noindent
+This is useful in startup files to set options and other state that are
+not available in all versions of zsh.
+
+@noindent
+@example
+is-at-least 3.1.6-15 && setopt NO_GLOBAL_RCS
+is-at-least 3.1.0 && setopt HIST_REDUCE_BLANKS
+is-at-least 2.6-17 || print "You can't use is-at-least here."
+@end example
+
+@findex nslookup
+@item @t{nslookup} [ @var{arg} ... ]
+This wrapper function for the @t{nslookup} command requires the
+@t{zsh/zpty} module (see
+@ref{The zsh/zpty Module}). It behaves exactly like the standard @t{nslookup}
+except that it provides customizable prompts (including a right-side
+prompt) and completion of nslookup commands, host names, etc. (if you use
+the function-based completion system). Completion styles may be set with
+the context prefix `@t{:completion:nslookup}'.
+
+@noindent
+See also the @t{pager}, @t{prompt} and @t{rprompt} styles below.
+
+@findex regexp-replace
+@item @t{regexp-replace} @var{var} @var{regexp} @var{replace}
+Use regular expressions to perform a global search and replace operation
+on a variable. POSIX extended regular expressions are used,
+unless the option @t{RE_MATCH_PCRE} has been set, in which case
+Perl-compatible regular expressions are used
+(this requires the shell to be linked against the @t{pcre}
+library).
+
+@noindent
+@var{var} is the name of the variable containing the string to be matched.
+The variable will be modified directly by the function. The
+variables @t{MATCH}, @t{MBEGIN}, @t{MEND}, @t{match}, @t{mbegin}, @t{mend}
+should be avoided as these are used by the regular expression code.
+
+@noindent
+@var{regexp} is the regular expression to match against the string.
+
+@noindent
+@var{replace} is the replacement text. This can contain parameter, command
+and arithmetic expressions which will be replaced: in particular, a
+reference to @t{$MATCH} will be replaced by the text matched by the pattern.
+
+@noindent
+The return status is 0 if at least one match was performed, else 1.
+
+@findex run-help
+@item @t{run-help} @var{cmd}
+This function is designed to be invoked by the @t{run-help} ZLE widget,
+in place of the default alias. See `Accessing On-Line Help'
+(@ref{Utilities}) for setup instructions.
+
+@noindent
+In the discussion which follows, if @var{cmd} is a file system path, it is
+first reduced to its rightmost component (the file name).
+
+@noindent
+Help is first sought by looking for a file named @var{cmd} in the directory
+named by the @t{HELPDIR} parameter. If no file is found, an assistant
+function, alias, or command named @t{run-help-@var{cmd}} is sought. If
+found, the assistant is executed with the rest of the current command line
+(everything after the command name @var{cmd}) as its arguments. When
+neither file nor assistant is found, the external command
+`@t{man} @var{cmd}' is run.
+
+@noindent
+An example assistant for the "ssh" command:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+run-help-ssh() @{
+ emulate -LR zsh
+ local -a args
+ # Delete the "-l username" option
+ zparseopts -D -E -a args l:
+ # Delete other options, leaving: host command
+ args=($@{@@:#-*@})
+ if [[ $@{#args@} -lt 2 ]]; then
+ man ssh
+ else
+ run-help $args[2]
+ fi
+@}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+Several of these assistants are provided in the @t{Functions/Misc}
+directory. These must be autoloaded, or placed as executable scripts in
+your search path, in order to be found and used by @t{run-help}.
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@findex run-help-git
+@findex run-help-ip
+@findex run-help-openssl
+@findex run-help-p4
+@findex run-help-sudo
+@findex run-help-svk
+@findex run-help-svn
+@item run-help-git
+@itemx run-help-ip
+@itemx run-help-openssl
+@itemx run-help-p4
+@itemx run-help-sudo
+@itemx run-help-svk
+@itemx @t{run-help-svn}
+Assistant functions for the
+@t{git},
+@t{ip},
+@t{openssl},
+@t{p4},
+@t{sudo},
+@t{svk},
+and
+@t{svn},
+commands.
+
+@end table
+
+@item @t{tetris}
+Zsh was once accused of not being as complete as Emacs,
+because it lacked a Tetris game. This function was written to
+refute this vicious slander.
+
+@noindent
+This function must be used as a ZLE widget:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+autoload -U tetris
+zle -N tetris
+bindkey @var{keys} tetris
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+To start a game, execute the widget by typing the @var{keys}. Whatever command
+line you were editing disappears temporarily, and your keymap is also
+temporarily replaced by the Tetris control keys. The previous editor state
+is restored when you quit the game (by pressing `@t{q}') or when you lose.
+
+@noindent
+If you quit in the middle of a game, the next invocation of the @t{tetris}
+widget will continue where you left off. If you lost, it will start a new
+game.
+
+@item @t{tetriscurses}
+This is a port of the above to zcurses. The input handling is improved
+a bit so that moving a block sideways doesn't automatically advance a
+timestep, and the graphics use unicode block graphics.
+
+@noindent
+This version does not save the game state between invocations, and is not
+invoked as a widget, but rather as:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+autoload -U tetriscurses
+tetriscurses
+@end example
+
+@findex zargs
+@item @t{zargs} [ @var{option} ... @t{-}@t{-} ] [ @var{input} ... ] [ @t{-}@t{-} @var{command} [ @var{arg} ... ] ]
+This function has a similar purpose to GNU xargs. Instead of
+reading lines of arguments from the standard input, it takes them from
+the command line. This is useful because zsh, especially with recursive
+glob operators, often can construct a command line for a shell function
+that is longer than can be accepted by an external command.
+
+@noindent
+The @var{option} list represents options of the @t{zargs} command itself,
+which are the same as those of @t{xargs}. The @var{input} list is the
+collection of strings (often file names) that become the arguments of the
+@t{command}, analogous to the standard input of @t{xargs}. Finally, the
+@var{arg} list consists of those arguments (usually options) that are
+passed to the @var{command} each time it runs. The @var{arg} list precedes
+the elements from the @t{input} list in each run. If no @var{command} is
+provided, then no @var{arg} list may be provided, and in that event the
+default command is `@t{print}' with arguments `@t{-r -}@t{-}'.
+
+@noindent
+For example, to get a long @t{ls} listing of all non-hidden plain files
+in the current directory or its subdirectories:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+autoload -U zargs
+zargs -- **/*(.) -- ls -ld --
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+The first and third occurrences of `@t{-}@t{-}' are used to mark the end
+of options for @t{zargs} and @t{ls} respectively to guard against
+filenames starting with `@t{-}', while the second is used to separate the
+list of files from the command to run (`@t{ls -ld --}').
+
+@noindent
+The first `@t{-}@t{-}' would also be needed if there was a chance the
+list might be empty as in:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zargs -r -- ./*.back(#qN) -- rm -f
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+In the event that the string `@t{-}@t{-}' is or may be an @var{input}, the
+@t{-e} option may be used to change the end-of-inputs marker. Note that
+this does @emph{not} change the end-of-options marker. For example, to use
+`@t{..}' as the marker:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zargs -e.. -- **/*(.) .. ls -ld --
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+This is a good choice in that example because no plain file can be named
+`@t{..}', but the best end-marker depends on the circumstances.
+
+@noindent
+The options @t{-i}, @t{-I}, @t{-l}, @t{-L}, and @t{-n} differ slightly
+from their usage in @t{xargs}. There are no input lines for @t{zargs} to
+count, so @t{-l} and @t{-L} count through the @var{input} list, and @t{-n}
+counts the number of arguments passed to each execution of @var{command},
+@emph{including} any @var{arg} list. Also, any time @t{-i} or @t{-I} is used,
+each @var{input} is processed separately as if by `@t{-L} @t{1}'.
+
+@noindent
+For details of the other @t{zargs} options, see man page xargs(1) (but note
+the difference in function between @t{zargs} and @t{xargs}) or run
+@t{zargs} with the @t{-}@t{-help} option.
+
+@findex zed
+@item @t{zed} [ @t{-f} [ @t{-x} @var{num} ] ] @var{name}
+@itemx @t{zed -b}
+This function uses the ZLE editor to edit a file or function.
+
+@noindent
+Only one @var{name} argument is allowed.
+If the @t{-f} option is given, the name is taken to be that of
+a function; if the function is marked for autoloading, @t{zed} searches
+for it in the @t{fpath} and loads it. Note that functions edited this way
+are installed into the current shell, but @emph{not} written back to the
+autoload file. In this case the @t{-x} option specifies that leading
+tabs indenting the function according to syntax should be converted into
+the given number of spaces; `@t{-x 2}' is consistent with the layout
+of functions distributed with the shell.
+
+@noindent
+Without @t{-f}, @var{name} is the path name of the file to edit, which need
+not exist; it is created on write, if necessary.
+
+@noindent
+While editing, the function sets the main keymap to @t{zed} and the
+vi command keymap to @t{zed-vicmd}. These will be copied from the existing
+@t{main} and @t{vicmd} keymaps if they do not exist the first time @t{zed}
+is run. They can be used to provide special key bindings used only in zed.
+
+@noindent
+If it creates the keymap, @t{zed} rebinds the return key to insert a line
+break and `@t{^X^W}' to accept the edit in the @t{zed} keymap, and binds
+`@t{ZZ}' to accept the edit in the @t{zed-vicmd} keymap.
+
+@noindent
+The bindings alone can be installed by running `@t{zed -b}'. This is
+suitable for putting into a startup file. Note that, if rerun,
+this will overwrite the existing @t{zed} and @t{zed-vicmd} keymaps.
+
+@noindent
+Completion is available, and styles may be set with the context prefix
+`@t{:completion:zed}'.
+
+@noindent
+A zle widget @t{zed-set-file-name} is available. This can be called by
+name from within zed using `@t{\ex zed-set-file-name}' (note, however, that
+because of zed's rebindings you will have to type @t{^j} at the end instead
+of the return key), or can be bound to a key in either of the @t{zed} or
+@t{zed-vicmd} keymaps after `@t{zed -b}' has been run. When the widget is
+called, it prompts for a new name for the file being edited. When zed
+exits the file will be written under that name and the original file will
+be left alone. The widget has no effect with `@t{zed -f}'.
+
+@noindent
+While @t{zed-set-file-name} is running, zed uses the keymap
+@t{zed-normal-keymap}, which is linked from the main keymap in effect
+at the time zed initialised its bindings. (This is to make the return key
+operate normally.) The result is that if the main keymap has been changed,
+the widget won't notice. This is not a concern for most users.
+
+@findex zcp
+@findex zln
+@item @t{zcp} [ @t{-finqQvwW} ] @var{srcpat} @var{dest}
+@itemx @t{zln} [ @t{-finqQsvwW} ] @var{srcpat} @var{dest}
+Same as @t{zmv -C} and @t{zmv -L}, respectively. These functions do not
+appear in the zsh distribution, but can be created by linking @t{zmv} to
+the names @t{zcp} and @t{zln} in some directory in your @t{fpath}.
+
+@item @t{zkbd}
+See `Keyboard Definition'
+(@ref{Utilities}).
+
+@findex zmv
+
+@item @t{zmv} [ @t{-finqQsvwW} ] [ @t{-C} | @t{-L} | @t{-M} | -@{@t{p}|@t{P}@} @var{program} ] [ @t{-o} @var{optstring} ]
+@itemx @t{@ @ @ @ }@var{srcpat} @var{dest}
+Move (usually, rename) files matching the pattern @var{srcpat} to
+corresponding files having names of the form given by @var{dest}, where
+@var{srcpat} contains parentheses surrounding patterns which will be
+replaced in turn by @t{$1}, @t{$2}, ... in @var{dest}. For example,
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zmv '(*).lis' '$1.txt'
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+renames `@t{foo.lis}' to `@t{foo.txt}', `@t{my.old.stuff.lis}' to
+`@t{my.old.stuff.txt}', and so on.
+
+@noindent
+The pattern is always treated as an @t{EXTENDED_GLOB} pattern. Any file
+whose name is not changed by the substitution is simply ignored. Any
+error (a substitution resulted in an empty string, two substitutions gave
+the same result, the destination was an existing regular file and @t{-f}
+was not given) causes the entire function to abort without doing
+anything.
+
+@noindent
+In addition to pattern replacement, the variable @t{$f} can be referrred
+to in the second (replacement) argument. This makes it possible to
+use variable substitution to alter the argument; see examples below.
+
+@noindent
+Options:
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@item @t{-f}
+Force overwriting of destination files. Not currently
+passed down to the @t{mv}/@t{cp}/@t{ln} command due to vagaries of
+implementations (but you can use @t{-o-f} to do that).
+@item @t{-i}
+Interactive: show each line to be executed and ask the user
+whether to execute it. `@t{Y}' or `@t{y}' will execute it, anything else will
+skip it. Note that you just need to type one character.
+@item @t{-n}
+No execution: print what would happen, but don't do it.
+@item @t{-q}
+Turn bare glob qualifiers off: now assumed by default, so
+this has no effect.
+@item @t{-Q}
+Force bare glob qualifiers on. Don't turn this on unless
+you are actually using glob qualifiers in a pattern.
+@item @t{-s}
+Symbolic, passed down to @t{ln}; only works with @t{-L}.
+@item @t{-v}
+Verbose: print each command as it's being executed.
+@item @t{-w}
+Pick out wildcard parts of the pattern, as described above,
+and implicitly add parentheses for referring to them.
+@item @t{-W}
+Just like @t{-w}, with the addition of turning wildcards in
+the replacement pattern into sequential @t{$@{1@}} .. @t{$@{N@}} references.
+@item @t{-C}
+@itemx @t{-L}
+@itemx @t{-M}
+Force @t{cp}, @t{ln} or @t{mv}, respectively, regardless of
+the name of the function.
+@item @t{-p} @var{program}
+Call @var{program} instead of @t{cp}, @t{ln} or
+@t{mv}. Whatever it does, it should at least understand the form
+@example
+@var{program} @t{-}@t{-} @var{oldname} @var{newname}
+@end example
+where @var{oldname} and @var{newname} are filenames generated by @t{zmv}.
+@var{program} will be split into words, so might be e.g. the name
+of an archive tool plus a copy or rename subcommand.
+@item @t{-P} @var{program}
+As @t{-p} @var{program}, except that
+@var{program} does not accept a following @t{-}@t{-} to indicate the
+end of options. In this case filenames must already be in a sane
+form for the program in question.
+@item @t{-o} @var{optstring}
+The @var{optstring} is split into words and
+passed down verbatim to the @t{cp}, @t{ln} or @t{mv} command called to
+perform the work. It should probably begin with a `@t{-}'.
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+Further examples:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zmv -v '(* *)' '$@{1// /_@}'
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+For any file in the current directory with at least one space in the name,
+replace every space by an underscore and display the commands executed.
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zmv -v '* *' '$@{f// /_@}'
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+This does exactly the same by referring to the file name stored in @t{$f}.
+
+@noindent
+For more complete examples and other implementation details, see the
+@t{zmv} source file, usually located in one of the directories named in
+your @t{fpath}, or in @t{Functions/Misc/zmv} in the zsh distribution.
+
+@item @t{zrecompile}
+See `Recompiling Functions'
+(@ref{Utilities}).
+
+@findex zstyle+
+@item @t{zstyle+} @var{context} @var{style} @var{value} [ @t{+} @var{subcontext} @var{style} @var{value} ... ]
+This makes defining styles a bit simpler by using a single `@t{+}' as a
+special token that allows you to append a context name to the previously
+used context name. Like this:
+
+@noindent
+@example
+zstyle+ ':foo:bar' @var{style1} @var{value1} \
+ +':baz' @var{style2} @var{value2} \
+ +':frob' @var{style3} @var{value3}
+@end example
+
+@noindent
+This defines @var{style1} with @var{value1} for the context @t{:foo:bar} as usual,
+but it also defines @var{style2} with @var{value2} for the context
+@t{:foo:bar:baz} and @var{style3} with @var{value3} for @t{:foo:bar:frob}. Any
+@var{subcontext} may be the empty string to re-use the first context
+unchanged.
+
+@end table
+
+@noindent
+
+@subsection Styles
+@noindent
+
+@noindent
+@table @asis
+@kindex insert-tab, completion style
+@item @t{insert-tab}
+The @t{zed} function @emph{sets} this style in context `@t{:completion:zed:*}'
+to turn off completion when @t{TAB} is typed at the beginning of a line.
+You may override this by setting your own value for this context and style.
+
+@kindex pager, nslookup style
+@item @t{pager}
+The @t{nslookup} function looks up this style in the context
+`@t{:nslookup}' to determine the program used to display output that does
+not fit on a single screen.
+
+@kindex prompt, nslookup style
+@kindex rprompt, nslookup style
+@item @t{prompt}
+@itemx @t{rprompt}
+The @t{nslookup} function looks up this style in the context
+`@t{:nslookup}' to set the prompt and the right-side prompt, respectively.
+The usual expansions for the @t{PS1} and @t{RPS1} parameters may be used
+(see
+@ref{Prompt Expansion}).
+
+@end table
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+@c Yodl file: Zsh/index.yo
+@node Concept Index, Variables Index, Top, Top
+@page
+@unnumbered Concept Index
+
+@printindex cp
+
+@noindent
+@node Variables Index, Options Index, Concept Index, Top
+@page
+@unnumbered Variables Index
+
+@printindex vr
+
+@noindent
+@node Options Index, Functions Index, Variables Index, Top
+@page
+@unnumbered Options Index
+
+@printindex pg
+
+@noindent
+@node Functions Index, Editor Functions Index, Options Index, Top
+@page
+@unnumbered Functions Index
+
+@printindex fn
+
+@noindent
+@node Editor Functions Index, Style and Tag Index, Functions Index, Top
+@page
+@unnumbered Editor Functions Index
+
+@printindex tp
+
+@noindent
+@node Style and Tag Index, , Editor Functions Index, Top
+@page
+@unnumbered Style and Tag Index
+
+@printindex ky
+@c (avoiding a yodl bug)
+
+@bye